6-K
Table of Contents

 

 

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

Form 6-K

 

 

Report of Foreign Private Issuer

Pursuant to Rule 13a-16 or 15d-16 of

the Securities Exchange Act 1934

Report on Form 6-K dated May 24, 2018

 

 

BT GROUP PLC

(Translation of registrant’s name into English)

 

 

BT Centre

81 Newgate Street

London EC1A 7AJ

England

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant files or will file annual reports under cover of Form 20-F or Form 40-F.

Form 20-F  ☑             Form 40-F  ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant by furnishing the information contained in this Form is also thereby furnishing the information to the Commission pursuant to Rule 12g3-2(b) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

Yes  ☐            No  ☑

Enclosure: BT Group plc – Annual Report & Form 20-F 2018 as sent to shareholders

 

 

 


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

BT Group plc
By:   

/s/ Dan Fitz

  Name: Dan Fitz
  Title: Company Secretary

Date: May 24, 2018

 

2


Table of Contents

LOGO


Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Where to find

more information

 

LOGO

btplc.com

bt.com/annualreport

 

Delivering our Purpose Report

We’re using the power of

communications to make a

better world. That’s our purpose.

Read our annual update.

btplc.com/purposefulbusiness

   LOGO


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Welcome to BT Group plc’s

Annual Report & Form 20-F for 2018

This is the BT Annual Report for the year

ended 31 March 2018. It complies

with UK regulations and is part of the

Annual Report and Form 20-F for the

US Securities and Exchange Commission

to meet US regulations.

 

 

Throughout the report

look out for these:

 

LOGO

Reference to other pages

within the report

 

LOGO

Reference to further

reading online

 

LOGO

Critical accounting

estimates and key

judgements

 

This Strategic Report was

approved by the Board on

9 May 2018

By order of the Board

Dan Fitz

Company Secretary

9 May 2018

Please see the cautionary statement regarding forward-looking statements on page 296.

Pages 1 to 130 form the Strategic Report. It includes Our strategy, Our business model, Our risks, the Operating review and the Group performance section.

The Governance section on pages 131 to 188 forms the Report of the Directors.

 

 

 

 The Strategic Report

  

 Highlights

     2  

 A welcome from our Chairman

     12  

 A message from  our Chief Executive

     14  

 How we’re organised

     16  

 Executive Committee

     18  

 Our strategy

  

 Our strategy

     20  

 How we performed

  

 – Delivering great customer experience

     21  

 – Investing for growth

     22  

 – Transforming our costs

     23  

 Key performance indicators

     24  

 Our non-financial performance

     26  

 Our evolving strategy

     27  

 Our business model

  

 Our business model

     30  

 What we do

     32  

 Our resources and culture

  

 Financial strength

     35  

 Our networks and physical assets

     35  

 Properties

     37  

 Research and development

     37  

 Brand and reputation

     39  

 Our culture

     40  

 Respecting human rights

     41  

 Our stakeholders

  

 Our people

     43  

 Customers

     47  

 Communities and society

     47  

 Shareholders

     48  

 Lenders

     49  

 Pension schemes

     49  

 Suppliers

     49  

 HM Government

     50  

 Regulators

     51  

 The environment

     54  

 Our risks

  

 Our approach to risk management

     56  

 Our principal risks and uncertainties

     57  

 Our viability statement

     71  

 Operating review

  

 BT Consumer

     72  

 EE

     80  

 Business and Public Sector

     86  

 Global Services

     92  

 Wholesale and Ventures

     98  

 Openreach

     104  

 – Openreach chairman’s introduction

     105  

 Technology, Service and Operations

     114  

 Group performance

  

 Chief Financial Officer’s introduction

     118  

 Group performance

     119  

 Governance

     131  

 Financial statements

     189  

 Additional information

     287  

    

  
 

 

 


Table of Contents

    

 

LOGO


Table of Contents

LOGO


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
4    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
5    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
6    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
7    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
8    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
9    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
10    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
11    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

A welcome from our Chairman

 

 

LOGO

 

My first impressions of BT are that we have great strength in our assets, people and capabilities, and this positions us well to deal with the challenges and opportunities ahead. It is important that we maintain our market leadership and play our part in supporting the UK as a world-class digital economy. As chairman I intend to support our people, engage with our stakeholders collaboratively, and build an even stronger reputation for our company.

      

Strong first impressions

I am honoured to be chairman of your company, BT.

 

I would like to take this opportunity to thank my predecessor, Sir Mike Rake, for his ten years of outstanding service to BT. I also want to thank the many people at BT who have made me feel so welcome.

 

BT is well positioned; we are leaders in fixed and mobile networks, in both our consumer and enterprise markets. We have four powerful brands, and we are financially robust. We have great people with wide-ranging skills and a healthy culture.

 

That said, this is a complex business; we operate in some tough markets and we have significant challenges ahead. For instance, volume growth in many of our markets is slowing, and we face increasing competition in our consumer, business and wholesale operations.

 

Initial priorities

It is important to me that we secure investment in integrated networks, the digital infrastructure of the future, and maintain a relentless focus on improving the experience of our customers.

 

We need to continue to play our part to ensure the UK remains one of the world’s leading digital economies. This requires us to invest in new technologies and opportunities; in fibre-to-the-premises (FTTP), 5G, cybersecurity and the Internet of Things.

 

It is also vital to continue to invest in our people to make sure we have the right skills to take our company forward. In 2017/18, we hired almost 2,400 new engineers in Openreach, and more than 2,500 apprentices and graduates.

 

At BT we have always looked after our people. My future focus will be to ensure we have a culture that rewards innovation, teamwork, customer orientation, and bold decision making.

 

And I want to make sure we give customers exemplary service. We have made significant improvements in customer experience across the group, but we are still not where we need to be. This is not just about speed, coverage, or value for money; it is about giving customers the best possible experience when dealing with BT so that they become advocates for our company.

      
      

 

 
12    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

I also believe an important part of my role will be to enhance the reputation of BT. In particular, it is critical that we build and maintain constructive and trusted relationships with government and the regulator.

Key achievements

Your company took a number of significant steps in 2017/18.

We announced a large-scale FTTP deployment, and achieved 90% geographic coverage with 4G. We obtained a good allocation of 3.4GHz spectrum as part of our overall planning for 5G.

We launched ultrafast broadband products with minimum speed guarantees, and we secured another three years of Premier League football at lower cost. We entered into a supply arrangement with Sky that ensures our TV customers will enjoy the best possible content.

We have increasing clarity on key aspects of regulation, with the completion of the wholesale local access market review, the decision by the regulator not to mandate a dark fibre product for the time being, and with the implementation of a new governance structure for Openreach. After a detailed consultation process, and in agreement with our pension scheme members and their unions, we closed the defined benefit pension scheme to further accrual, whilst increasing the company’s contribution rates to our main defined contribution pension scheme. In May we also reached agreement with the pension trustee on the 2017 triennial valuation and recovery plan, giving us certainty over the contributions we need to make to support the fund for the next three years.

And we used technology to support communities and society. Under our 2020 ambitions, we work to promote digital inclusion and build skills for the next generation. This year we also helped to raise around £109m for good causes.

Capital allocation and the transformation ahead

Connectivity today sits at the centre of most people’s lives and has become critical to homes and businesses alike. Consumption of data and bandwidth continues to expand at ever increasing rates, and at the same time technology continues to evolve as we move from copper to fibre, from 4G to 5G and from analogue to digital.

As the UK’s incumbent provider we are determined to lead this transition from old to new technologies, but in order to do so our strategy will need to evolve to provide ever greater focus on our customers’ experiences, and on network investment, whilst transforming our operating model to become a lean and agile organisation.

We have a comprehensive transformation programme in place to improve our operational and financial performance in what remains a competitive market environment, and we are increasing our investment to drive convergence and sustain our network leadership. We are confident in our strategy and the benefits we expect from the decisive actions we are taking to strengthen our competitive position.

Given the current market and regulatory headwinds and our investment plans, the Board has decided to hold the dividend unchanged for this year at 15.4p per share. The Board also expects to hold the dividend unchanged in respect of the next two financial years, given our outlook for earnings and cash flow over this period.

The Board remains committed to our dividend policy, which is to maintain or grow the dividend each year, whilst reflecting a number of factors including underlying medium term earnings expectations and levels of business reinvestment.

Board changes

Karen Richardson and Tony Ball will step down from the Board at the conclusion of the Annual General Meeting in July, having served as non-executive directors for six and nine years respectively. I would like to thank Karen and Tony for their significant contribution during their time at BT. We have begun the process of finding successors to Karen and Tony and have appointed external consultants to assist with the search process.    

Looking to the future

I am delighted to be working with Gavin, and I know I have the support of a first-class Board. I am also confident we have the right leadership team in place to take our business forward and meet the challenges we face in the years ahead.

The Board has full confidence in the transformation programme that we have put in place. We believe that successful execution of our evolved strategy will serve the long-term interests of all our stakeholders and will ensure that we play our part in keeping the UK a leading digital economy.

Above all, we are confident that it will allow us to build trust and confidence and drive sustainable growth in value for our shareholders.

 

LOGO

Jan du Plessis

Chairman

9 May 2018

 

 

 
13    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

A message from our Chief Executive

 

 

LOGO

 

In a challenging year we have delivered on our strategy, made important investments for the future, competed effectively in the marketplace, and made great improvements to the experience we deliver to our customers. Our operational and financial results were overall broadly in line with expectations. We will accelerate our transformation with a three-year plan, and I remain tremendously optimistic about the future for our company and its stakeholders.

 

      

Robust business performance in a tough environment

The market environment got tougher in the last year. Volumes have slowed in our consumer businesses, as the markets for broadband, pay-TV and mobile subscribers reach maturity. Our customers responded well to our ‘more for more’ strategy which focuses on value versus volume as customers upgrade to fibre and 4G.

 

In our enterprise operations, customers are seeking shorter, more flexible contracts and more digital solutions. Openreach has come under pressure from regulation. Competition – from new entrants as well as established players – remains intense wherever we operate.

 

Against this, we recorded financial results overall broadly in line with expectations. BT is extremely well positioned in all of its markets; we have met the challenges and taken opportunities in a disciplined way.

 

Delivering our strategy in 2017/18

Here’s how we delivered against the three pillars of our strategy.

 

Deliver great customer experience. In 2017/18 we drove the best improvements in our customer metrics for many years. At the group level NPS (Net Promoter Score) was up by 8.3 points and RFT (Right First Time) was up by 4.3%. We reduced network faults by 3.7%, cut installation times for key products like Ethernet (by a third), and installed a record 2.1 million fibre broadband net connections. In BT Consumer we’ve reduced call waiting times by a minute and complaints to Ofcom about consumer broadband have fallen by 18%. At EE we now cover significantly more of the UK’s geography with 4G than any other operator, and we are delighted to have been found by RootMetrics to have the highest quality network, winning the UK Overall RootScore award for the ninth consecutive time. While we are proud of these achievements, we know there is much more still to do.

 

 

 
14    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Invest for growth. We made significant investments across the business in 2017/18. In Openreach we’ve started the rollout of ultrafast broadband delivering speeds of over 100Mbps with the announcement of the accelerated deployment of FTTP to three million homes by 2020, accompanied by a rapid rollout of Gfast. We believe we will make a return on this initial programme and we want to go further to reach 10 million premises by the mid 2020s, although this will depend on support from the Government and the regulator.

In BT Consumer we have invested to improve customer experience, and also to secure the best possible content for our BT Sport and TV customers. Our continued investments in EE have positioned us as the pre-eminent UK mobile operator, including in network coverage, store formats and online. In our enterprise businesses we’ve continued to invest to reposition our product set based on digital solutions, unified communications and our mobile capabilities. And our investment in many of our ventures is leading to impressive growth.

Looking ahead, we will continue to invest to secure growth in the medium term. This will include investment in our integrated fixed and mobile networks, fibre, 4G and eventually 5G, and investment to make our network, operations, and product set increasingly digital and converged.

Transform our costs. We have delivered on our existing cost-saving initiatives. Our restructuring programme has removed over 2,800 roles and delivered £180m of savings during the year. And we made good progress with our pension fund. The steps we took include closing the defined benefit scheme to new accruals and agreeing the triennial funding valuation and recovery plan with the Trustee.

Accelerating our strategic transformation

Our performance in 2017/18 has created a platform and position of strength from which to begin the next phase of our strategic transformation. We need to accelerate the process in order to meet the challenges ahead.

We have updated our strategy and will implement a new three-year plan, which we will deliver through three strategic priorities:

 

delivering differentiated customer experiences

 

investing in integrated network leadership

 

transforming our operating model.

We’ll create innovative new propositions, improve value for money, offer better service and make it easier to do business with us.

In UK fixed, we’ll speed up our investments in ultrafast and in UK mobile we’ll expand our leadership in 4G coverage and capacity. We intend to lead the market to 5G too.

We are creating a more lean, agile and flexible organisation with a simpler operating model. We have already brought together BT Consumer and EE – to form Consumer – to be managed and operated as one, with a new set of converged products. And now we’re combining our Business and Public Sector and Wholesale and Ventures units to create Enterprise. These are positive changes, designed to transform BT for the next chapter of its history.

We also need to make sure we have the right blend of skills for the challenges and opportunities ahead. We recently announced the creation of 6,000 new roles in frontline engineering, customer service and cybersecurity. More difficult has been the decision to remove 13,000 roles; largely from middle management and back-office functions. We’re also rationalising the number of our sites – including plans to exit BT Centre in London.

And we will accelerate the delivery of digital Global Services, by focusing on the leading multinational customers, standardising solutions, strengthening our security services, enhancing our cloud solutions, and divesting non-core assets.

My thanks, and an exciting future

I believe BT is a strong business that is well placed to continue to lead the UK communications market, in converged connectivity and services. The plans we are implementing will ensure our company is more efficient, incrementally productive, equipped with the right skill sets, and better able to meet the challenges and capitalise on the opportunities that lie ahead. Ultimately, we will be able to offer our customers the products and services they deserve.

And, following a number of additions to my Executive Committee in the year, I am confident I have a strong leadership team ready to deliver on our transformation programme.

I would like to thank everyone at BT for everything they have delivered over the last year and for their support as we implement the next phase of BT’s transformation.

 

LOGO

Gavin Patterson

Chief Executive

9 May 2018

 

 

 
15    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

How we’re organised

 

 

BT operates as a single business, made up of different organisational units.

There are two types of

organisational unit in BT:

customer-facing ones that

sell products and services and

corporate ones that support

the whole of the group.

Customer-facing units

The customer-facing units (CFUs) in the year were:

BT Consumer

LOGO  P72

EE

LOGO  P80

Business and Public Sector

LOGO  P86

Global Services

LOGO  P92

Wholesale and Ventures

LOGO  P98

Openreach

LOGO  P104

 

   New Consumer business

 

  
        

 

In July 2017 we announced the creation of a new Consumer business – bringing together BT Consumer and EE.

    
 

BT Consumer and EE operated separately during the year (which is why they have separate sections in this Annual Report) but in September the management team came together under Marc Allera to develop the integration plans for the new business.

 

   LOGO
  Consumer will report as a single business from April 2018.   

LOGO

 

 

 

   New Enterprise business

 

  
        

 

In April 2018 we announced the creation of a new customer-facing unit called Enterprise. It will bring Business and Public Sector and Wholesale and Ventures into one

  team. It will mean we can make faster, better decisions for the benefit of all our business customers across the UK and Ireland.
    
 

The new unit will provide

products and services to

small-to-medium sized

businesses, corporates

and the public sector.

 

It will also provide wholesale services to communications providers in the UK and Republic of Ireland. And it will include our Ventures business.

 

Enterprise is being led by Gerry McQuade (from 1 May 2018) and will start reporting as a single business from 1 October 2018.

  

LOGO

 

LOGO

    
 

 

 
16    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

 

   Global Services

 

  
        

 

Global Services is a leading business communications provider with customers in 180 countries.

    
  ‘Digital GS’ is Global Services’ strategy to become a more profitable, predictable and customer-focused business. (see page 93).   

LOGO

 

    

 

 

   Openreach

 

  
        

 

Openreach builds and operates the fixed access network that connects Britain’s homes and businesses.

Its customers include hundreds of communications providers in the UK.

 
 
 
    
  Openreach is different to the other CFUs because it’s strategically and operationally independent from the rest of BT, in line with the agreement reached with Ofcom, following its strategic review of digital communications (see page 52).   

LOGO

 

    

 

   Corporate units

 

  
        

 

Technology, Service

and Operations (TSO)

 

 

TSO is our technology delivery unit responsible for creating and operating our global networks, platforms and IT systems.

    
  It also works with the CFUs to develop and roll out products and services for their customers. You can read more about TSO on page 114.   

LOGO

 

    
 

Strategy and

Transformation (S&T)

 

S&T develops and sets corporate, network and product strategies for the group.

    
  It also drives pan-BT transformation programmes. S&T is being led by Michael Sherman (from 1 May 2018).   

LOGO

 

    
 

Corporate functions

 

The remaining corporate units carry out central activities on behalf of the group.

    
  We benefit from shared expertise and economies of scale. They include: Finance; HR; Legal; Governance; Compliance; Corporate Affairs; Regulatory Affairs; and Central Business Services.   

LOGO

 

 

 

 
17    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Executive Committee

 

This is our Executive Committee. It meets weekly and is chaired by the chief executive.

The Executive Committee provides input and recommendations to support the chief executive (or his delegate) in exercising their authority delegated by the Board to run the business of the group day to day.

More specifically, the Executive Committee assists the chief executive in:

 

developing the group strategy and budget for the Board’s approval

 

executing the strategic plan once agreed by the Board

 

providing assurance to the Board in relation to overall performance and risk management.

All decisions are taken by the chief executive, or his delegate, in keeping with the principle of single point accountability.

Luis Alvarez, formerly CEO Global Services; John Petter, formerly CEO BT Consumer; and Sean Williams, formerly chief strategy officer left during the year. Graham Sutherland, formerly CEO Business and Public Sector will leave in 2018/19.

Bas Burger, Cathryn Ross, Sabine Chalmers and Michael Sherman have all joined the Executive Committee.

LOGO

Gavin Patterson

Chief executive

Appointed as chief executive in September 2013 and on the Board since June 2008.

Gavin was previously CEO, BT Retail and from 2004 to 2008 was managing director, BT Consumer, (BT Retail). Before joining BT, Gavin was managing director of the consumer division of Telewest (now Virgin Media). Prior to that, he spent nine years at Procter & Gamble, rising to become European marketing director.

 

LOGO

Gerry McQuade

CEO, Enterprise

Appointed CEO, Wholesale and Ventures in March 2016 and became CEO, Enterprise in May 2018.

Gerry was formerly chief sales and marketing officer at EE responsible for the business, wholesale and product development which he had overseen since the merger in 2010 of Orange and T-Mobile. He joined the board of Orange in January 2008, and prior to Orange he was founding director of Virgin Mobile.

 

LOGO

Alison Wilcox

HR director

Appointed July 2015.

Alison was formerly regional HR director for Vodafone Europe and before that, Regional HR Director for Vodafone’s Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific footprint. Alison joined Vodafone in 2006 as group director of leadership following a career in consulting.

LOGO

Simon Lowth

Chief financial officer

Appointed to the Board as chief financial officer in July 2016.

Simon was CFO and executive director of BG Group before the takeover by Royal Dutch Shell in February 2016. Previously Simon was CFO and an executive director of AstraZeneca, and an executive director of ScottishPower. Prior to that, Simon was a director of McKinsey & Company.

 

LOGO

Ed Petter

Corporate affairs director

Appointed November 2016.

Ed was formerly deputy director of corporate affairs at Lloyds Banking Group and prior to that had held corporate affairs roles at McDonald’s Europe, McKinsey & Company and the Blue Rubicon communications consultancy, having previously worked as a news producer and editor at the BBC.

 

 

 
18    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

LOGO      LOGO    LOGO

Marc Allera

CEO, Consumer

Appointed February 2016 as CEO, EE and became CEO, Consumer in September 2017.

 

Marc was formerly chief commercial officer for EE from 2011 to 2015. Before EE, Marc spent ten years at Three UK where he held a number of senior positions, including chief commercial officer and sales and marketing director. Prior to his 16 years’ experience in the mobile industry Marc was GM for Sega UK and Europe.

    

Bas Burger

CEO, Global Services

Appointed June 2017.

 

Bas was formerly president, BT in the Americas, BT Global Services. Bas joined BT in 2008 as CEO Benelux.

 

Before joining BT, Bas was executive president and a member of the management committee of Getronics NV, where he ran global sales, channels and partnerships, developing the company’s international business. He was also CEO and managing director of KPN Entercom Solutions.

  

Sabine Chalmers

General counsel

Appointed April 2018.

 

Sabine joined BT in April 2018. Before joining BT she was chief legal and corporate affairs officer and company secretary of Anheuser-Busch InBev for 12 years. She also held various legal leadership roles at Diageo. Sabine is qualified to practise law in England and NY State.

LOGO      LOGO    LOGO

Cathryn Ross

Director of regulatory affairs

Appointed January 2018.

 

Cathryn was formerly chief executive of Ofwat, the independent economic regulator for the water and waste water sector in England and Wales. Cathryn is an experienced regulatory and competition economist and has worked across a number of different sectors advising on economic, regulatory and competition issues.

    

Michael Sherman

Chief strategy and transformation officer

Appointed May 2018.

 

Prior to joining BT, Michael was partner and managing director at Boston Consulting Group, focusing on advising clients on growth strategies and operational efficiency. Before that, he spent nearly eight years as executive vice president at enterprise software company Viewlocity.

  

Howard Watson

Chief technology and information officer

Appointed February 2016.

 

Howard was formerly chief architect and managing director global IT systems and led the technical teams behind the launch of BT Sport in 2013.

 

Howard joined BT in 2011 and has 30 years of telecoms experience having spent time at Telewest (now Virgin Media) and Cartesian, a telecommunications consultancy and software company.

 

   LOGO      LOGO   

Dan Fitz

Company secretary

Dan is the company secretary of BT Group plc. He joined BT in April 2010 as its group general counsel and was appointed company secretary in November 2012. Dan previously spent six years at Misys and 12 years at Cable & Wireless. Dan attends all

Executive Committee meetings.

 

    

Clive Selley

Invitee, CEO, Openreach

Clive was appointed CEO, Openreach in February 2016. He was formerly CEO, BT Technology, Service & Operations, CEO BT Innovate & Design and before that president, BT Global Services Portfolio & Service Design. He is an ‘invitee’ because the CEO of Openreach cannot be a member of the Executive Committee under the provisions of the Undertakings and Commitments.

 

  

 

 
19    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

    Our strategy

 

Our strategy in the year had three pillars: deliver great customer experience, invest for growth and transform our costs.

They work together: the better our customers’ experience, the more we sell and the less time and money we spend putting things right. And the better we manage our costs, the more we can invest in improving our customers’ experience and in products and services that will create growth.

Pages 21 to 25 describe our performance against the strategy.

Looking ahead, we’re evolving our strategy to build on our strengths and allow us to respond to market opportunities and challenges. You can find more detail on page 28.

 

 

 

The graphic below shows the main elements of

our strategy in the year. You’ll find more details

on our purpose and goal, in the context of our

business model, on page 32.

           

 

   LOGO

 

  

 

 

 

 
20    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Our strategy - how we performed

 

LOGO

Customer experience remains central to our strategy and long-term growth – whether that’s improving our service levels, providing a more reliable network or introducing new products. We’re making good progress but we know there is still much more to do.

We believe that continuously improving customer experience drives growth. That’s why progress on customer experience is central to judging the group’s performance. We have two main measures of customer experience: customer perception (based on Net Promoter Score) and doing things Right First Time.

How we did in the year

We’ve built on earlier progress and have delivered seven quarters of continuous growth in customer perception. This year we saw an 8.3 point improvement on last year’s result.

Right First Time performance has improved by 4.3%, helped by better planning and resourcing. This means our network has had fewer faults and we’ve delivered high levels of service despite some terrible weather.

Everyone in BT has a role to play in delivering these results and every CFU has improved its customer perception and Right First Time scores.

We’ve also seen a drop in complaints made to Ofcom over the last year. EE saw complaints fall to their lowest level while complaints about BT Consumer broadband have fallen by 18%.

What difference did our customers see?

Our customers tell us they expect a reliable service, great networks and products that fit their digital, mobile and ‘always-on’ lives. We‘ve made progress in all of these areas:

Deliver a consistent and reliable service

On average we answered calls from BT Consumer customers in 41 seconds, a minute quicker than last year.

 

EE won the What Mobile award for Best Customer Support for the third year running.

 

We now have more than 600 EE shops including five new ‘showcase’ stores offering face-to-face chats with advisers and highlighting the best of our network and technology partners.

 

Our customers are using our digital channels more, with online chat up 20% this year and more than 2m downloads of the ‘My BT’ app.

 

Openreach achieved all 60 of Ofcom’s copper Minimum Service Levels.

 

Ethernet performance keeps improving – with delivery times cut by a third since last year.

 

We’re continuing our transparent approach to performance by publishing quarterly updates on service levels via bt.com and ee.co.uk.

Great customer experience from our network

We’ve hired almost 2,400 more engineers into Openreach. We’ve also improved our resource planning so that we meet network repair targets more than 80% of the time.

 

We’ve continued to weatherproof our networks leading to 3.7% fewer network faults this year.

 

BT Consumer customers are now getting faster broadband speeds with average download speeds improving by 20% to 43Mbps.

Products that fit our customers’ lives

BT Consumer launched ultrafast products at 152Mbps and 314Mbps with minimum speed guarantees.

 

EE launched a new 4G antenna service that brings superfast broadband speeds to rural areas where fixed broadband is slow or not available.

 

A year after the launch of our BT Call Protect service we’ve protected 2.5m customers by diverting more than 90m nuisance calls.

 

And we’ve launched a new ‘BT Business’ app for business customers who want to interact with us digitally.
 

 

 
21    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Our strategy - How we performed continued

 

LOGO

We’ve been putting money and resources into five strategic areas. Together, they underpin our strategy and our operational and financial performance, which in turn contribute to our KPIs (on page 24).

With good progress on the integration of EE within the group and with a fast-paced digitisation of the UK economy, we’ve placed a particular focus this year on enabling convergence and on infrastructure leadership as key drivers of future growth.

 

 

LOGO

 

 
22    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

LOGO

Our approach

Rigorous analysis, leadership and strong governance help us stay focused on both transforming costs and improving customer experience.

We benchmark the costs of doing business against other companies inside and outside our sector to see where we can do even better.

Most improvement initiatives are owned and run within individual business units. Our largest programmes span multiple business units or drive complex changes in a single business unit and often need central coordination.

How we did in the year

This year we’ve increased the cumulative EE integration savings to £290m and we’re on track to deliver on our £400 million commitment by the end of 2019/20.

The first phase of our restructuring activities has produced £180m of savings against our commitment to deliver £300 million over two years.

Key achievements included:

 

creating more synergies from integrating BT and EE. We’ve done this by combining functions, making good use of our increased purchasing power, and completing accommodation moves to bring teams together and save money from closing unneeded buildings

 

establishing a new unit, Customer and Enterprise Transformation, within the Strategy and Transformation team. The new unit helps us make investments and take decisions that better support our customer experience and productivity priorities

 

becoming even more efficient by creating a Central Business Services unit which brings together customer contact management services, contract delivery services, revenue assurance and billing.

Looking ahead

We will continue to deliver against our EE integration and first phase restructuring commitments.

We’re also launching new cost transformation initiatives within each individual business unit, as well as some larger cross-business programmes.

The combination of new and existing initiatives will ensure we deliver against our new strategic target of £1.5bn gross cost reduction over the next three years.

 

 

 
23    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Key performance indicators

 

We hit our financial guidance set in May 2017 for adjusted EBITDA and exceeded it for normalised free cash flow. We fell short of our target for underlying revenue excluding transit due to demanding market conditions and actions we have taken to exit lower margin business in our enterprise divisions. We’ve achieved our customer experience goal for the year, but want to go further.

 

Progress against our KPIs

We use four key performance indicators (KPIs) to measure how we’re doing against our strategy. Our financial KPIs include: the trend in underlying revenue excluding transit; our adjusted earnings per share; and normalised free cash flow. Customer service improvement is the key non-financial KPI for us.

 

Our KPIs are chosen because they reflect the key elements of our strategy. We use these to measure the variable elements of our senior executives’ pay each year, as we’ve explained in the Report on Directors’ Remuneration (see page 156).

 

We’ve outlined our performance against each KPI here, together with an explanation of how we define each measure.

 

You can find reconciliations of the financial measures to the closest IFRS measure in the Additional information section on pages

288 to 290.

 

 

Underlying revenue excluding transit

 

Underlying revenue reflects the overall performance of the group that will contribute to sustainable profitable revenue growth. We exclude the impact of specific items, foreign exchange movements, acquisitions and disposals. We focus on the trend in underlying revenue excluding transit because transit traffic is low margin and is affected by reductions in mobile termination rates, which are outside our control.

 

 

Our key measure of the group’s revenue trend, underlying revenue excluding transit was down 1.0% (2016/17: down 0.2%) which is below our outlook of broadly flat.

 

Trend in underlying revenue excluding transit

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

 

  

-1.0%

2018 trend in underlying revenue excluding transit

 

Performance

Our revenue performance has been impacted by challenges in our enterprise businesses, particularly in Global Services where revenue declined due to ongoing demanding market conditions and lower IP Exchange volumes and equipment sales in line with our strategy to reduce low margin business. We explain more about the performance of our customer-facing units from page 72.

 

a  Calculated as though EE was not part of the group until 1 April 2016.

b  Calculated as though EE had been part of the group from 1 April 2015.

 

 

 

Customer service measure

Right First Time is our key measure of customer service. This tracks how often we keep the promises we make to our customers. This could be about keeping to appointment times, completing orders when we agreed or fixing faults within an agreed period. As well as improving service and the customer experience, keeping our promises should mean that there is less work to do to correct our mistakes, and so reduces our costs.

 

 

Our customer service measure Right First Time was up 4.3% compared with up 6.4% last year.

 

Customer service improvementa

At 31 March

 

LOGO

 

  

+4.3%

2018 customer service measure

 

Performance

Improving the service we deliver is key. Our Right First Time measure was up 4.3% (2016/17: up 6.4%). We’re making good progress in some areas and every customer-facing unit has improved its Right First Time scores. Despite these improvements, we’re looking ahead at improving customer experience further. You can read more about our customer service on page 21.

 

a  Cumulative improvement from 1 April 2009.

 

 

 
24    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Adjusted earnings per share

 

Adjusted earnings per share is the adjusted profit after tax attributable to our shareholders, divided by the weighted average number of shares in issue. Being an ‘adjusted’ measure, it excludes the impact of specific items and as such it is a comparable consistent way to measure the performance of our business over time.

 

  

 

Adjusted earnings per share decreased 3% to 27.9p compared with down 9% last year.

 

Adjusted earnings per share

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

  

27.9p

2018 adjusted earnings

per share

 

Performance

Adjusted profit after tax decreased 3% to £2,773m this year reflecting our investment in mobile devices and customer experience, along with higher business rates and pension costs, partly offset by cost savings.

 

Adjusted earnings per share decreased 3% to 27.9p.

 

The weighted average number of shares in the market was in line with the previous year.

 

  

 

Normalised free cash flow

 

Free cash flow is the cash we generate from our operations, less capital expenditure and finance costs. It represents the cash available to invest in the business, repay debt, support the pension scheme and pay dividends to our shareholders.

 

Normalised free cash flow excludes significant non-operational payments and receipts that distort the trend in our cash flow. So in calculating normalised free cash flow we take out the impact of specific items, purchases of telecommunications licences, pension deficit payments and the tax benefit from pension deficit payments.

 

  

We generated normalised free cash flow of £2,973m. This was up £191m compared with last year and is above our outlook of £2.7bn to £2.9bn due to favourable working capital movements.

 

Normalised free cash flow

Year ended 31 March

LOGO

 

  

£2,973m

2018 normalised free cash flow

 

Performance

The increase of £191m or 7% in our normalised free cash flow primarily reflects favourable working capital movements.

  

 

 
25    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Our non-financial performance as a

sustainable and responsible business

 

Our integrated approach to reporting means that the requirements of the new Non-Financial Reporting Directive are addressed throughout the Strategic Report.

For ease of reference, information pertaining to each of the matters addressed by the new regulation can be found on the following pages: Human rights (page 41); Employees (page 43); Social (page 47); Environmental (page 54); Anti-corruption and bribery (page 57).

Additionally, non-financial matters have long been embedded in our business model as stakeholder outcomes on page 31, and within our principal risks and uncertainties on pages 57 to 70. Non-financial performance indicators are linked to our ambitions and foundation measures as a sustainable and responsible business and can be seen in the table below.

LOGO   Target met   LOGO   Target failed   LOGO   Ongoing

 

 

    Our ambitions   2016/17 performance   2017/18 performance       Status               Page        

 

 

Creating a connected society

 

 

By 2020, more than 9/10 people in the UK will have access to our fibre-based products and services

 

 

8.8 out of 10 UK

premises passed

 

Ambition superseded: 95% of premises now passed by superfast broadbanda

 

  n/m   47
 

 

 

 

By 2020, to help 10m people overcome social disadvantage through the benefits our products and services can bring

 

 

 

3.9m people reached

  4.6m people reached   LOGO   47

 

 

Creating a culture of tech literacy

 

 

By 2020, to help 5m children to receive better teaching in computer skills

 

 

 

1.1m children reached

  1.6m children reached   LOGO   48

 

 

Supporting charities and communities

 

 

By 2020, to use our skills and technology to help generate more than £1bn for good causes

 

 

£95m raised for good causes

  £109m raised for good causes   LOGO   48
    Cumulative total: £422m since 2012  

Cumulative total:

£531m since 2012

   
 

 

 

 

By 2020, to inspire 66% (two-thirds) of our people to volunteer

 

 

 

31% of BT people volunteering

  39% of BT people volunteering   LOGO   45

 

 

Delivering environmental benefits

 

 

By 2020, to enable customers to reduce their carbon emissions by at least three times the end-to-end carbon impact of our business

 

 

 

1.8:1 achieved

  2.2:1 achieved   LOGO   54
 

 

 

 

By 2030, to cut our carbon emissions intensity by 87%, compared with 2016/17 levels

 

 

 

n/m (new ambition)

  6.8% reduction   LOGO   54

 

 

a including other network operators.

       
    Our foundation measures   2016/17 performance   2017/18 performance   Status   Page

 

 

Investment in society

 

 

Investment to accelerate our purposeful business approach; to be more than 1% of adjusted profit before tax (PBT)

 

 

 

1.03% of PBT invested

 

1.08% 5-year average

 

1.02% of PBT invested

 

1.06% 5-year average

  LOGO   47

 

 

Customers

 

 

Customer service: to consistently improve RFT across our entire customer base

 

 

 

6.4% improvement

  4.3% improvement   LOGO   21

 

 

Employees

 

 

Employee engagement index: to maintain or improve our relationship with our employees

 

 

 

71% favourable

  74% favourable   LOGO   44
 

 

 

 

Sickness absence rate: to maintain or reduce % of calendar days lost to sickness

 

 

 

2.32% calendar days lost to sickness

  2.30% calendar days lost to sickness   LOGO   46
 

 

 

 

Ethical performance: to maintain or improve our employees’ perception of our ethical performance

 

 

 

76% favourable

  83% favourable   LOGO   57
 

 

 

 

 

Ethics training: all employeesb to complete annual training on our ethics code (including our zero tolerance approach to Anti-Corruption & Bribery)

 

 

 

99.3% trained

  99.5% trained   LOGO   57

 

 

Supply chain

 

 

Ethical trading: across our supply chain, with focus on human rights. Achieve 100% follow-up within three months, for all suppliers identified as high or medium risk, through our ethical standards questionnaire

 

 

 

100% follow-up within three months

  100% follow-up within three months   LOGO   50
 

 

 

 

Renewable electricity: by 2020 to buy 100% of our electricity worldwide from renewable sources, wherever markets allow

 

 

 

77%c bought from renewable sources

  81% bought from renewable sources   LOGO   55
 

 

 

 

Carbon emissions: by 2030, to reduce our supply chain carbon emissions by 29%, compared with 2016/17 levels

 

 

 

n/m (new target)

  6.3% reduction   LOGO   55

 

n/m - not meaningful.

LOGO  To find out more about these measures, our methodologies and how our results are calculated, take a look at bt.com/deliveringourpurpose

b At least 99.5%, excluding those on maternity, paternity or long-term sick leave or with other extenuating circumstances.

c 2016/17 energy figures restated – see bt.com/deliveringourpurpose for details.

 

 
26    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

Our evolving strategy

 

“Like every chief executive, my job is to create value for shareholders. But what we’re doing differently is creating value in a sustainable way that we can repeat year after year.

 

BT is uniquely positioned to be a leader in converged connectivity and services. This position of strength will enable us to build on the disciplined delivery and risk reduction of the last financial year and enter an exciting new phase in its transformation.”

     

What’s our plan?

Our industry is changing and so is our business. We’re building a company which delivers a unique and compelling proposition for our customers – offering the ability to communicate, work, discover, buy, socialise, play, and watch.

 

It starts with our evolving strategy (see page 28) which is focused on:

 

– delivering differentiated customer experiences

 

– investing in integrated network leadership

 

– transforming BT’s operating model

 

What’s next?

It’s been a year of disciplined delivery and risk reduction but we know we’re only at the beginning. We’re operating in a demanding environment and we’ve still got plenty to do. So we’re scrutinising and transforming all aspects of our business to deliver the strongest returns and benefits to all our stakeholders.

 

For our customers...

It means creating a joined-up, reliable and secure network that connects them to everything they need, wherever they are.

 

For our people...

It means creating roles, teams and workplaces in which they can flourish and develop their skills.

 

For our shareholders...

It means driving growth in long-term value while maintaining our dividend policy.

 

For the UK...

It means continuing to play our part in ensuring the UK remains one of the world’s leading digital economies.

 

This report is about what we’re doing and the investments we’re making. Actions that will help us navigate our challenges and make the most of our opportunities.

 

I’m really excited to be delivering the next stage of BT’s transformation and have put in place the team that will support me in achieving these objectives.

 

LOGO

 

 

 
27    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents

Our evolving strategy

We have evolved our strategy

to focus on converged connectivity

and services

 

Well positioned to drive sustained growth in value

We have a strong set of assets, including a leading position in the UK in fixed and mobile access networks, with strong and clearly segmented brands. We have deep relationships with a wide range of customers including 30m consumers, 1m businesses and around 1,500 multinational corporations. We also enjoy close strategic partnerships with key content, technology, device and service vendors.

Combined, this means that we are uniquely positioned to lead network, product and service convergence across the consumer and enterprise markets, which we see as a critical market trend and an opportunity to drive further value for our business.

 

Navigating a demanding environment

Like all businesses, we must continually adapt to our market environment. Data consumption and network capacity requirements are increasing exponentially and our enterprise customers want to migrate from legacy communications products towards digital, converged and secure products and solutions. Competition remains intense across the sector from both established players and new entrants.

We are also seeing a new wave of infrastructure investment in fibre-to-the-premises and mobile coverage and technology. And recent regulatory outcomes are reducing Openreach’s returns towards its allowed cost of capital.

 

 

An evolution of our strategy

We have evolved our strategy to build on our strengths and

allow us to respond to market opportunities and challenges.

 

LOGO

 

 
28    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Our purpose remains to use the power of communications to make a better world. This drives everything that we do.

Our vision is leadership in converged connectivity and services, delivered brilliantly in the UK and for multinational corporations. This highlights our commitment to convergence as a growing category of products and service.

Our goal is to drive sustainable growth in value. This reflects our commitment to balance top and bottom-line growth and to create value from our investment in our integrated network and differentiated products and services.

We will deliver these through three strategic priorities:

1. Deliver differentiated customer experiences

We will further differentiate our propositions, to retain and expand value. We’ll do this by creating innovative new propositions, improving value for money, offering better service, and making it easier to do business with us. We’ve made progress with customer experience in recent years, but there’s much more to do.

2. Invest in integrated network leadership

In UK fixed, we’ll drive take-up of our superfast network and accelerate our investments in ultrafast through fibre to the premises to 3m homes by 2020 and through Gfast.

In UK mobile, we’ll expand our leadership in 4G coverage and capacity, and we intend to lead the market to 5G too.

Ultimately our aim is to build a single, integrated all-IP fibre network. Our investment will allow us to progressively close down legacy products such as the public switched telephone network, lead the market in advanced digital products, improve customer experience, and reduce our operating costs.

3. Transform our operating model

We’re creating a more lean and agile organisation, with a simplified operating model, and more straightforward decision-making.

The steps we’re taking to achieve this include:

 

simplifying our operating model by creating four customer- facing units focused on Consumer, Enterprise, multinational corporations through Global Services and fixed access networks through Openreach

 

having fewer, bigger, more accountable leadership roles and simplifying and delayering our management structures

 

accelerating the delivery of Digital GS, introducing new digital products with a greater focus on our top global customers

 

reducing inefficiencies from being housed in numerous sites across the UK to focus on around 30 modern, fit-for-purpose sites to create a more collaborative, open and customer- focused working culture

 

move from buying to strategic sourcing, consolidating our spend and standardising our products

 

make better use of digitalisation to improve customer- experience and reduce costs to serve.

These strategic priorities will be tailored to the different needs of our key customers in each of our customer-facing units:

 

for UK Consumer and Enterprise, our focus will be on accelerating the development of converged services

 

in Global Services, our focus will be on evolving towards a more digital proposition and operating model

 

Openreach will focus on delivering unmatched UK-wide fixed access to all CPs.

Outcomes from our transformation

As a result of our transformation we’ll be more efficient, productive, focused, and better able to deliver excellent experiences to our customers. There should be a substantial positive impact on our financial performance, albeit offset in the short term by recent regulatory outcomes: Over three years we’re targeting improvements in our customer experience metrics, revenue generating units per customer, converged product penetration and digital interaction with our customers. We’ll deliver a three-year reduction of around 13,000 mainly back office and middle management roles, partially offset by new hires to support customer service and network deployment. We expect the programme to cost £800m and have a two-year payback.

Ultimately, we will create a fit-for-future organisation to drive sustainable growth in value for all our stakeholders as the leader in convergent connectivity and service in the UK and for multinational corporations.

 

 

 
29    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Our business model

    

    

 

We create value for our stakeholders by developing and selling products and services that are an essential part of modern life.

Who we are

We’re one of the world’s leading communications services companies. We’re based in the UK and serve customers in 180 countries (see page 92).

International Integrated Reporting Council’s capitals

This key provides a mapping to the ‘capitals’ of the IIRC’s Integrated Reporting (IR) Framework.

LOGO You can find out more at: theiirc.org

LOGO   Financial

LOGO   Human

LOGO   Manufactured

LOGO   Intellectual

LOGO   Social

LOGO   Natural

LOGO Find out more:

Our strategy

The main elements of our strategy in the year are on page 20.

This business model section reflects our evolved strategy which is described on page 28.

Our principal risks and uncertainties

We describe our approach to risk management and principal risks and uncertainties on page 57.

Our viability statement

Our directors’ assessment of the prospects and viability of the group is on page 71.

Governance

How we govern the group is described from page 131.

Remuneration

The directors’ remuneration report is on page 156.

What sets us apart

 

      

LOGO

  LOGO   Financial strength          £3.0bn                        
    We’re focused on growing our cash flow over the long term.    

normalised free cash flow generated

in 2017/18

  
          
          
 

 

  
  LOGO   Our people     105,800   
    Their commitment, expertise     employees   
    and diversity are key to our success.     82,200   
        in the UK   
          
          
 

 

  
  LOGO   Networks and physical assets     27.5m   
    We continue to invest in these to improve the experience we offer our customers.    

premises passed by our

fibre footprint

  
        90%   
        4G geographic coverage   
          
 

 

  
  LOGO   Research and development     c£510m   
    We’re one of the largest investors in research and development in the UK.     R&D spend   
        97   
        patents filed   
          
          
 

 

  
  LOGO   Our culture     Personal   
    ‘The BT Way’ and our values express how we work together and what we expect from our people.    

Simple

Brilliant

  
          
          
 

 

  
  LOGO   Our brand       
    Our brands are a key asset.       
    LOGO   
          
 

 

  
  LOGO   Natural resources     81%   
    We use some natural resources in doing business.     of the electricity we buy worldwide comes from renewable sources   
          
          
 

 

 
30    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 
31    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

What we do

This section details our purpose, goal and strategy in the

context of our business model. It also explains how we

create value for our stakeholders by providing services

that are integral to modern life.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

Our purpose,

goal and strategy

Our purpose

Our business model is built around our purpose, which is as simple as it is ambitious: to use the power of communications to make a better world.

Sustainability, ethics and human rights

To achieve our purpose, we must do business responsibly. That means behaving ethically, respecting people and the environment. We are a signatory to the UN Global Compact principles and we’re actively contributing to the UN Sustainable Development Goals.

We have a steering group that oversees human rights governance and policies and we’re committed to implementing the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights.

Every year we publish a statement which sets out our stance on modern slavery and human trafficking. And we don’t tolerate bribery or corruption.

 

Non-financial information reporting

New regulations on non-financial information mean we must report on the following topics:

 

LOGO  P41 Respect for human

             rights

  

LOGO  P54 Environmental

             matters

LOGO  P43 Employee matters

  

LOGO  P57 Anti-corruption and

             bribery

LOGO  P47 Social matters

  

There are references to our policies in these areas, along with how we’ve done against various measures, throughout the Strategic Report. Some of the outcomes feature in the business model graphic on page 31. We’ve listed others in the summary of our non-financial performance on page 26.

LOGO  Read more in our Delivering our Purpose report.

Our goal

Our goal is to drive sustainable growth in value. We’ll achieve this by giving our customers a great experience and products and services they value.

Our strategy

To follow our purpose and achieve our goal, our strategy is built around the three pillars outlined on page 29: delivering differentiated customer experiences, investing in integrated network leadership, and transforming our operating model.

They work together. The better our customers’ experience, the more we’ll sell and the less time and money we’ll spend putting things right. And the leaner and more agile we are, and the better we manage our costs, the more we can invest in the business while maintaining a strong balance sheet (page 35). It’s a virtuous circle that balances short-term performance with long-term value creation.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

Investing in what

sets us apart

We invest in building and maintaining communications networks in the UK and overseas. We also invest in differentiated products, services and applications to run over those networks.

Customer expectations are rising all the time. We believe that getting customer experience right is a competitive advantage. So we’re investing in our people (eg more contact centre roles, more multi-skilled advisors) and our processes (eg reducing missed appointments).

Some of our investments, like TV sports rights, last just a few years. Other investments, like our fibre broadband network, are much longer term, with pay-back periods of more than a decade.

We have a distinct combination of people, technology, content, networks and other physical assets that sets us apart from competitors. Importantly, we also have the financial strength to keep investing in these areas while balancing short, medium and long-term interests

 

 

 
32    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO  

Providing services

integral to modern life

We sell fixed-voice, broadband, mobile and TV products and services to individuals and households in the UK. For businesses we offer communications services ranging from phone and broadband through to complex managed networks and IT services and cybersecurity protection. Many public services rely on our technologies and in the UK and Ireland we help other communications providers to serve their own customers. And underpinning all this, we provide the connectivity that’s essential in a digital economy.

There’s growing demand for a lot of our products and services because they play such an integral role in modern life. And we’ll benefit as customers use more digital services and increasingly want value, reliability and consistent service.

Market context

Consumer broadband continues to switch to fibre, to meet customers’ demands for higher bandwidth. Meanwhile people are making fewer landline calls, replacing them with mobile phones, voice over IP or instant messaging. In mobile, there’s continuing growth in data use – and postpaid subscriptions are growing at the expense of prepaid.

At the same time, SIM-only tariffs are becoming more popular because people are keeping their phones for longer. In TV, there’s growth in subscription video-on-demand (SVoD), largely as a complement to pay-TV services. And customers are increasingly using digital service channels, like apps and online chat, to interact with their service provider. Business customers are using landlines, leased lines and traditional voice services less as the market moves to data and IP voice. Other growing areas include cloud services, hosting, security and data protection. Business broadband is switching to fibre. And Ethernet and dedicated internet access services are also becoming more widespread as businesses rely more and more on connectivity.

‘Digitalisation’ or digital transformation is now a top priority for many businesses, particularly multinational corporations. It’s not an end in itself. But it does help companies achieve objectives like transforming costs, operating more efficiently or improving customer experience. Our Cloud of Clouds strategy (page 94) positions us well to be a trusted partner in our customers’ digital future.

We aim to be the UK’s leading converged operator – bringing together our fixed and mobile network assets to make sure our customers are always connected to the best possible network, and selling converged propositions that offer much more than simple ‘bundles’. We’re uniquely placed to do it – with the brands, scale and breadth of capabilities to benefit from convergence.

Our strategy puts us in a strong position to drive, and benefit from, these market trends. You can find out more in the customer-facing unit sections from page 72.

Channels to market

We sell our products and services through our customer-facing units.

We do it through a range of channels including online, contact centres and account managers. We also have around 600 EE stores in the UK.

Multibrand strategy

We have three retail brands (page 39). They let us serve different sectors of the market and lead to higher consideration by potential customers when they’re deciding whether to buy from us or one of our competitors. Add to that the cross-selling between our retail brands and we have an opportunity to sell more to more people.

Diverse revenue streams

Our revenue mostly comes from subscriptions or contracts. Individuals, households and SMEs pay for standalone or bundled services, typically on 12- to 24-month contracts. ‘Pay-as-you-go’ mobile services are also available.

Large corporate and public sector customers usually buy managed networked IT services on contracts spanning several years. Wholesale customer contracts range from one month for regulated products, to five years or more for major managed services deals.

Other sources of revenue include our ventures (page 100), consultancy, device sales and advertising (online, BT Sport TV channels and InLinkUK kiosks).

 

 

 
33    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

What we do continued

 

 

 

LOGO  

Creating value for

all our stakeholders

What we do, matters – to millions of people. We help them communicate, enjoy entertainment, do business and generally live their lives. And we contribute directly to communities and the health of the UK by providing jobs, supporting suppliers, paying tax and encouraging our people to volunteer.

Sustainability is integral to our purpose and the value we create. We’re committed to using 100% renewable electricity (where markets allow) and we’re encouraging our suppliers, customers and people to do the same. At the same time, our products and services are helping to tackle climate change.

Our business generates emissions. From our operations, supply chain, and through the energy our customers use to power our products. But we’re contributing to a lower-carbon economy by cutting our own carbon footprint and helping customers cut theirs. The emission savings for our customers outweigh our own footprint. This means we’re a ‘net positive’ business (see page 54).

From a purely financial perspective, our carbon-saving products and services contribute £5.3bn revenue to our businessa.

LOGO  

Oversight

and governance

The markets we operate in are dynamic and very competitive, particularly the UK. There are many risks and opportunities, so it’s important that our strategy and business model are flexible and sustainable. To help us we:

 

have a risk management framework to identify and mitigate the challenges we face (page 56)

 

use insight teams to keep us in tune with market drivers and customer expectations

 

talk and listen to our stakeholders to understand what’s important to them

 

use governance committees to ensure we’re making the right investments and investing with discipline.

Together, these things help us anticipate and respond to changes in our markets including macro events like Brexit and the prospect of the UK leaving the single European market.

We know we can deliver value over the short, medium and long term. It’s this confidence that underpins our assessment of the future prospects and viability of the group (see page 71).

 

The Design Council and BT Investment Board

The Design Council was a sub-committee of our Operating Committee. It was responsible for making sure capital investments in our networks, systems, platforms and products reflected our strategy, served the needs of our customers and were delivered cost-effectively. The Design Council was dissolved in October 2017 following the creation of the Executive Committee (page 18).

From December 2017 the BT Investment Board has been responsible for providing input and recommendations to support the chief executive on major capex and opex decisions (see page 133).

 

 

 

a The list of our carbon-saving products and services is established and verified by Carbon Trust; the associated revenue is based on total external sales, independently verified by Lloyd’s Register.

 

 
34    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

Our resources and culture

In this section we talk about the resources that set us apart

and underpin our business model. We also describe our

culture and approach, and commitment to respecting

human rights.

 

Financial strength

Our financial strength means we can make long-term investments while supporting other areas of the business.

Our financial strategy has been consistent for a number of years:

 

LOGO

We have a prudent financial policy and adhere to a disciplined process for the allocation of capital between four main uses: investment in the business; supporting the pension funds; paying dividends to shareholders; and maintaining a strong balance sheet. We also have strong governance and investment processes/controls. Together, they help us make the right decisions when it comes to planning investments, growing our business, and managing our level of debt and credit metrics.

Healthy finances also mean we can support the business in other ways. For example we continue to invest in R&D to stay at the forefront of a rapidly-changing industry, and in training, developing and supporting our people.

Our networks and physical assets

Our network, service and IT platforms support the products our customers rely on around the world.

Network platforms

Our UK fixed-line network is one of our most valuable assets and our investment in fibre broadband is key to providing services to UK consumers and businesses. Our fibre broadband network now passes more than 27.5m UK premises, and we provide fibre-to-the-premises to more customers than any other UK service provider. To meet the demand from businesses, we’re continuing to expand Ethernet availability.

This year we’ve again had record levels of traffic across our UK network, with a peak demand of 9.75Tbps. The investments we’ve made in broadband technology mean that more customers get faster speeds and better reliability over our network.

We’ve also developed new technology that should more than double our previous records for data transmission speeds. Our latest breakthrough should deliver speeds of up to 13Tbps over a single fibre. This more than doubles the world record of 5.6Tbps we set last year.

Our global reach

Our global network is supported by in-country networks and infrastructure. The UK has our widest range of network services, access technologies and coverage. But we also have extensive networks in Brazil, Germany, Italy, the Netherlands, the Republic of Ireland and Spain.

The scale and reach of our global multi-protocol label switching (MPLS) network gives us a competitive advantage. Our virtual private network (VPN) services offer customers the convenience and security of a private network but over the public internet. We use our MPLS network, plus a combination of owned and leased fibre connections, to connect our points of presence (PoPs) around the world. For the final connection into the customers’ premises, we either use our own circuits, or lease connections from telecoms operators in that country. If customers need service in very remote places, we make use of our extensive satellite connections.

Security is an important part of our business. The expertise we’ve gained from protecting our own networks helps us secure our customers’ networks. We’ve seen that hacking tools, phishing scams and disruptive malware are becoming more sophisticated yet more accessible – so we’ve responded by continuing to develop our cyberdefence capability.

 

 

 
35    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Our resources and culture continued

 

Mobile network

We are investing in 4G geographic coverage and capability, consolidating the EE network’s position as the biggest and fastest in the UK. We aim to expand 4G to reach 95% of the UK’s geography by the end of 2020.

Wi-fi

We run one of the world’s biggest wi-fi networks, with around 5.9m hotspots.

 

LOGO

Progress this year

This year we’ve:

 

achieved 99.999% availability in our core network for broadband customers

 

deployed Ethernet and optical nodes into 38 data centres belonging to other companies to help grow business connectivity services.

 

upgraded 935 exchanges and migrated more than 309,000 customers to faster broadband services that are cheaper and more energy efficient for us to run

 

launched the BT Agile Connect service (see case study)

 

reached more than 90% of the UK’s geography with our 4G network, giving many rural and remote areas access to 4G

 

built 323 new sites on the Emergency Service Network (ESN)

 

installed 138 InLinkUK units, providing users with free wi-fi at up to 1Gbps, free UK phone calls, rapid mobile device charging and touchscreen access to local digital services.

Service platforms

We run a number of service platforms that combine our network and IT resources. They underpin many of our products. Our five core service platforms are voice and mobile, broadband and internet access, TV, Ethernet and managed data, and emerging services.

Our TV platform supports a growing number of customers. Our voice and mobile platform supports EE, BT Mobile and Plusnet Mobile; it also underpins the Emergency Services Network (ESN).

Progress this year

This year we’ve:

 

shown the Ashes live from Australia – with enhanced digital experience, so BT Sport customers watching online or via the app can skip straight to key moments

 

carried over one billion minutes a month on our BT Conferencing platform.

IT systems platforms

Our IT systems let us manage processes, handle customer information and deliver products and services. They’re critical to serving customers and running our business.

We’ve completed the first phase of our EE integration programme. This involved moving EE people to BT systems so all our people could benefit from a single, consistent set of applications.

Progress this year

We’re simplifying the different technologies we use. This year we’ve:

 

brought together BT and EE datacentre and core IT applications management

 

deployed robotic process automation, using software robots to carry out automated tasks, including order entry and order management, to cut costs and improve our back-office processes.

 

LOGO

 

 

 
36    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Properties

We have around 7,000 properties in the UK and 1,700 across the rest of the world.

We lease most of our UK properties from Telereal Trillium, part of the William Pears group. We signed a sale and leaseback arrangement with them in 2001. The majority (88%) of our UK properties are operational sites housing fixed and mobile telecoms and broadband kit. The rest are retail outlets, offices, contact centres, depots and data centres. We also have the BT Sport TV studios in London.

In the UK, we’ve rationalised and disposed of office, depot and data centre space in Croydon, Harrogate, Oxford and Wolverhampton.

Outside the UK, we’ve consolidated key office and operational locations in New York, Cincinnati, São Paulo, Frankfurt and Munich.

BT property portfolio (UK)a

 

LOGO

Research and development

Commercial success increasingly depends on innovation – that’s why we invest in R&D. The result is an enviable track record of scientific breakthroughs, engineering successes and commercial progress.

A proud history of innovation

In 1837, Sir William Fothergill Cooke and Sir Charles Wheatstone filed a patent for the world’s first practical electric telegraph. From this they founded The Electric Telegraph Company. This business eventually grew into BT.

Ingenuity transforms the world

Our innovation has continued to transform communications since Cooke and Wheatstone’s electric telegraph. Often that impact has been wider than just communications. Colossus was the world’s first electronic programmable computer. It was created by GPO engineer Tommy Flowers in 1943, and heralded the start of the computer age. In 1984, we deployed the world’s first commercial 140Mbps single-mode optical fibre link. This technology is now the backbone of communications, carrying huge volumes of internet traffic around the globe. We made the world’s first live data call over GPRS (a mobile technology) in 1999. Less than 20 years later, mobile data has transformed the way people live.

LOGO You can read more about our innovation at btplc.com/innovation

We showcased our innovation at two major events this year. Innovation 2017 was held at Adastral Park, our global R&D headquarters in Suffolk, UK. It was attended by 625 customers and influencers, including government, investors, journalists and analysts. New Scientist Live hosted 30,000 visitors over four days. We sponsored its technology zone.

This year we invested around £510m (2016/17: around £520m) in R&D. Over the last decade we’ve been one of the largest investors in R&D both in the UK, and globally in the telecoms sector.b

Our research keeps producing new inventions. In 2017/18 we filed patent applications for 97 inventions (2016/17: 102), and as of 31 March 2018 had a worldwide portfolio of more than 5,000 patents and applications.

97

patent applications filed in 2017/18

5,000

patents and applications in our worldwide portfolio

 

 

b  Comparison based on total R&D spend 2007/8 to 2016/17. Source: EU Industrial R&D Investment Scoreboard, http://iri.jrc.ec.europa.eu/scoreboard.html

 

 
37    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Our resources and culture continued

 

Open innovation

No-one has a monopoly on good ideas. That’s why we work with partners, universities and customers from around the world.

There are eight BT global development centres. Our biggest is the innovation campus Adastral Park. Around 3,600 people work there and we share it with more than 90 other high-tech companies.

We have extensive, long-standing, joint-research programmes with Cambridge University (UK), Massachusetts Institute of Technology (USA), Tsinghua University (China), Khalifa University (UAE) and more than 30 other universities globally.

We’ve used ideas inspired by our collaboration with MIT or Artificial Intelligence (AI) and machine learning to create algorithms that give us a deeper understanding of our access network. This year we launched a five-year research collaboration with Huawei and the University of Cambridge. It will focus on photonics, digital and access network infrastructure and media technologies, alongside work aimed at boosting the impact of communications technologies in society.

We’ve opened the BT Ireland Innovation Centre with Ulster University in Belfast. It will work alongside the Belfast Global Development Centre and BT Labs at Adastral Park in Suffolk on projects including Internet of Things, artificial intelligence and data analytics for customer experience and cybersecurity.

Repurposed innovation

We like to repurpose innovations from other industries and apply them to our business. This year we flew a drone across a river in a Welsh valley to deliver a fibre. We’re looking into new ways to roll out fibre without so much digging. These include new directional drilling techniques and autonomous robots that propel themselves through the ground like worms.

 

LOGO

Our researchers are investigating the application of artificial intelligence and machine learning techniques to the operation of 5G networks.

We’re also exploring how we can use a technique from the mobile world – called beamforming – to improve our copper lines’ performance. It exploits the interference or ‘crosstalk’ between copper cable pairs to boost the speed achievable on a line.

Awards for our research and development

We’re proud that our R&D is recognised outside BT. Here are some of the awards we’ve won this year.

 

UK IT Awards: Best IoT (Internet of Things) Project

 

TM Forum 2017: Excellence Award for Smart City Innovator of the Year

 

TM Forum 2017: Outstanding Achievement Award

 

The Engineer magazine: Collaborate to Innovate Awards 2017

Here are two examples of BT R&D this year:

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

 

 
38    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Brand and reputation

We own three strong retail brands:

BT, EE and Plusnet. Between them, they cover UK and global markets for consumers, businesses and the public sector. We’ve positioned these three brands to maximise their customer reach and minimise overlap. This multi-brand approach makes us more agile in our markets and broadens our overall appeal. We also own the Openreach brand, with which we serve communication providers.

Lots of things affect our brands and reputation. But peoples’ direct interactions with us play a big part. That’s why we’re committed to optimising every aspect of customer experience: from our products to our service experience to our communication. For more on how we’re improving customer experience, see page 21 and our customer-facing units from page 72.

 

 

 

 

 

 

a  Gartner does not endorse any vendor, product or service depicted in its research publications, and does not advise technology users to select only those vendors with the highest ratings or other designation. Gartner research publications consist of the opinions of Gartner’s research organisation and should not be construed as statements of fact. Gartner disclaims all warranties, expressed or implied, with respect to this research, including any warranties of merchantability or fitness for a particular purpose.
b  MarketScape for Global Managed Security Services Vendor Assessment 2017, Martha Vazquez, 1 December 2017.
LOGO   The BT brand stretches across consumer, business and public sector markets within the UK and across multinational business markets in 180 countries.
 

 

This year, we unveiled Ultrafast Fibre, the first and only fibre broadband with a 100Mbps speed guarantee, and we were host broadcaster of the UEFA Champions League Final in Cardiff.

 

 

In the UK business market, we have the highest awareness of any telecoms, networks and IT services brand. Strong business wins included network services for Severn Trent Water and mobility services for FirstGroup Plc.

 

 

BT was recognised as a leader for the 14th consecutive time in Gartner’s Magic Quadrant for Network Service Providers, Globala. (See page 95.)

 

 

And BT was named a ‘Leader’ in the IDC MarketScape for Worldwide Managed Security Services 2017 Vendor Assessmentb.

 

LOGO   EE is the UK’s biggest mobile network operator, positioned at the cutting edge of technology.
 

 

With around 600 retail stores across the UK, we are also first for spontaneous brand awareness, despite being the youngest major UK mobile brand by almost a decade.

 

 

EE’s mobile network has been independently recognised as the best overall network by RootMetrics and in 2017, it was the only network in the UK able to offer mobile connectivity for the new Apple Watch.

 

LOGO   Plusnet offers UK customers a great value range of broadband and mobile services.
 

 

In 2018, Plusnet’s outstanding customer service continued to be acknowledged with industry awards, including uSwitch’s Best Customer Service for the fifth consecutive year.

 

 

At the same awards, we also won Best Value for Money, Best Home Broadband and – despite only launching mobile in 2016 – Best Value Mobile (SIM-only).

 

LOGO  

Openreach (page 104) builds and maintains Britain’s digital communications network.

 

More than 25,000 engineers take care of 165 million kilometres of network, working in every community, every day.

 

 

This year, Openreach launched a new brand identity, reflecting commitments made as part of the DCR settlement (page 52). The programme to change all assets has already begun, including our buildings, vans and uniforms.

 

 

 
39    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Our resources and culture continued

 

Our culture

We want our culture to reflect our values of personal, simple and brilliant, for our people and our customers.

Our values

 

LOGO

We’re proudly personal, simple and brilliant in many ways already. That includes our history of pioneering innovation, a strong volunteering ethos, diverse career development for our people, and our ability to disrupt the market and reinvent ourselves when we need to – as through ventures like BT Sport, the 2012 Olympics and the acquisition of EE.

Embedding our values further

There’s more to do to be personal, simple and brilliant every day.

So we’ve launched a multi-year transformation programme to simplify our organisation, improve business performance, and reform our culture and capabilities.

This year we’ve begun simplifying how we do things –by helping our people take personal ownership to resolve their customers’ issues and introducing new ways to make better and faster decisions. That means making sure accountabilities are clear and decisions are made at the right level of the organisation, as close to customers as possible.

We’ve encouraged more diverse thinking in the business by attracting more diverse talent. This year we doubled our graduate intake and quadrupled our apprentice intake across the group. We’re offering more career development opportunities for our people, as well as inspiring fresh perspectives.

LOGO

We’re also building new programmes and resources to help our people be brilliant, clarifying the key skills and behaviours they need now and in the future (including Management Essentials, Business Essentials and Connected Leaders (see page 44).

Finally, we’ve been helping our people do the right thing by:

 

regularly reaffirming our expectation that everyone acts with integrity through our ethical code

 

creating a safe environment where everyone can speak up about risks and concerns

 

equipping our leaders to have more regular open and honest conversations so they make better-informed decisions.

The BT Way

All of this will come together in ‘The BT Way’ – a three-part guide to reflect how we work together as a company, how we treat each other and how we expect everyone to behave. It will include:

 

how we’re organised and how we deliver for our customers

 

what we expect from our people through our updated ethical code

 

what’s important to us and how we do things as expressed through our values.

Our efforts are having a positive impact

In January’s BT-wide ‘Your Say’ employee engagement survey, we did better than previous years on all our values scores:

 

+4%     +3%     +3%

improvement

in our Personal

score (75%)

    improvement in our Simple score (62%)    

improvement

in our Brilliant

score (70%)

 

 

 
40    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Respecting human rights

We’re committed to respecting human rights in our own business and through our broader relationships.

We believe that everyone is entitled to basic rights and freedoms, whoever they are and wherever they live. These are established in The International Bill of Human Rights and the International Labour Organisation’s Declaration on Fundamental Principles and Rights at Work.

We’ve been a signatory to the UN Global Compact since it was established in 2000 – this is the world’s largest corporate sustainability initiative. We use the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights (UN Guiding Principles) to guide our approach.

How could we impact human rights?

As a global company we could impact human rights either directly, or indirectly through our business relationships. Our biggest impact could be on customers’ rights to privacy and free expression.

We must comply with lawful government requests for information about how people use our services and the content of their communications, but this could impact our customers’ rights to privacy.

Free expression includes the right to access information. As a communications company, we need to consider situations where we might need to limit people’s access to content. We could also affect: our people’s rights if our employment standards fall short; workers in our supply chain through our buying practices; and communities where we operate, if we don’t stick to environmental standards.

How do we manage human rights in BT?

Our ethical code sets out the standards we expect of our people and those who work on our behalf, including how they respect human rights.

We have a team dedicated to human rights integration and a Human Rights Steering Group chaired by a member of our Executive Committee. This year it considered a range of issues, including:

 

contracts we’re monitoring for human rights issues

 

our second Modern Slavery Act statement and programme

 

our second privacy and free expression report

 

the impact on human rights when broadcasting large sporting events.

What we’ve been doing this year

We’ve been pulling together our existing policies on human rights issues into one overarching policy. As part of that we’ve reviewed our operations in key countries outside the UK with the help of a leading law firm.

Due diligence

In April 2017 we launched our enhanced customer due diligence process. To embed the key principles with our sales teams we held calls and face-to-face training.

In our due diligence checks we look for whether:

 

our product/service could be used for defence, military, law enforcement, security or cybersecurity purposes

 

the customer or end user is a government, government agency or state-owned company

 

the service is being provided in an extreme or high-risk country (based on external measures).

If these criteria are met we look into things in more detail – which might include contractual protections or internal monitoring arrangements.

Modern slavery

In June 2017 we co-sponsored a residential summit of international experts which explored the role of technology in tackling modern slavery. Building on the findingsa we’re establishing an industry collaboration to address the challenges and opportunities for technology to help end modern slavery.

We published our second Modern Slavery Act statementb in August 2017. It explained our progress and the steps we’ve taken to prevent modern slavery in our business and supply chain. We’re also reviewing our policies, processes and procedures with the help of external experts.

We’ve continued to support the UK Modern Slavery Helpline partnering with anti-slavery charity Unseen – for more details see our Delivering Our Purpose Report.

In October 2017 Gavin Patterson joined the first Business Against Slavery Forumc hosted by the Home Office. The forum is a way for companies to collaborate and drive change on identifying and tackling modern slavery.

Sport and human rights

Big sporting events have a hugely positive social impact. But they can also carry human rights risks like labour rights violations and community displacement.

Throughout the year we’ve continued working with the participants in the Mega-Sporting Events Platform for Human Rights. With input from other broadcasters, we’ve created a tool to help identify human rights risks when broadcasting. We presented it at the second Sporting Chance Forumd in November 2017. The team at BT Sport are trialling the tool in their compliance processes.

Priorities for the year ahead

We’ll launch our overarching human rights policy and embed it in our business having reviewed our existing metrics to support the new policy.

We’ll be refreshing our privacy and free expression report with data on information requests in countries outside the UK. We’ll also cover what we do on cybersecurity.

 

 

a  wiltonpark.org.uk/wp-content/uploads/WP1546-Report.pdf
b  btplc.com/Thegroup/Ourcompany/Ourvalues/ModernSlaveryAct
c  gov.uk/government/news/leading-businesses-unite-to-tackle-slavery
d  ihrb.org/focus-areas/mega-sporting-events/2017-sporting-chance-forum-meeting-report

 

 
41    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
42    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

LOGO

People are the key to transforming our business. We want BT to be a place where people feel engaged and inspired to be the best they can be. We want them to use their skills and our technology to deliver great products and services for customers, communities and societies around the world.

Our people strategy is summed up by our ambition to be a great place to work. We want to deliver a great customer experience by getting our employee experience right. That means making BT a place where our people can do brilliant things. At the heart of this are our values.

Personal. Simple. Brilliant.

They guide our decisions and behaviours.

All of our people have a role to play in bringing our values to life – wherever they are and whatever job they do.

 

LOGO

Our workforce

At 31 March 2018 we had 105,800 full-time equivalent (FTE) employees in 59 countries, with 82,200 based in the UK.

As our business evolves to meet our customers’ needs, we aim to reskill and redeploy our people to avoid redundancies where possible. Last year in the UK we redeployed almost 850 people, letting us keep experienced people with the skills we need for the future. More than a third of our redeployed people are in engineering or customer service. We’ve further developed their skills through training programmes.

Hiring talented people

We’ve increased awareness of BT as a brilliant employer by publishing engaging and informative careers content on social media. It’s making a difference. In 2017 we were recognised by Marketing Week as one of the ‘Best Places For Marketeers To Work’. Our content is continually liked and shared across social media and we’ve had over 1.3 million visits to our careers site.

This year, excluding acquisitions, we hired almost 14,100 people, of which almost 10,100 were UK-based.

We’ve hired almost 2,400 engineers into Openreach as improving the quality of our customer relationships remains central to our people strategy.

Finally, we have converted almost 840 skilled agency workers to permanent employees because we recognise how important it is to keep experience inside our business.

Hiring more apprentices

We hired more than 2,100 new apprentices across the group in 2017/18. This is more than double the previous year’s intake, following the introduction of the apprenticeship levy in April 2017. We plan to take on a further 4,600 apprentices next year.

Hiring more graduates

This year, we recruited 460 graduates globally, and we plan to hire more than 480 next year.

Awards

Once again we’re in The Times Top 100 Graduate Employers. We’re one of only three companies in the IT and telecoms sector to feature in the top 100.

Recognition

We’ve been named ‘large employer of the year’ at the Scottish Training Federation and the BPP awards, and ‘creative and digital employer of the year’ at the Asian apprentice awards.

Reputation

We’re extremely proud our apprenticeship programmes have recently been graded ‘excellent’ in all areas in the latest Education Scotland audit.

 

 

 
43    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our stakeholders continued

    

    

 

Investing for growth

We never stop learning – whether that’s on the job or in face-to-face training. Our digital academy platform enables our people to solve problems and share knowledge and ideas with colleagues.

It’s how we adapt to a changing world and rise to tomorrow’s challenges. This year we’ve launched these new learning programmes:

 

Global new

joiner programme

 

A refreshed induction for new hires, globally. We’ve rolled out corporate induction events and launched a new website for new joiners, which gets 14,000 visits a month.

 

Business Essentials

 

A suite of foundation-level online learning resources for everyone in BT, covering 18 core skills.

 

Management Essentials

 

These workshops help people managers to have better conversations with their team. The online platform helps them get to grips with the fundamentals of managing people at BT.

 

Following 2016’s launch of the Fibre Academy and showcase, we’ve opened a new training centre called ‘Open Street’. It replicates the Openreach fibre and copper network from exchange to customer premises, with a working exchange, street cabinets, houses and business premises. It includes the end-to-end underground and overground accessible network for our engineers to train and accredit on. It’s open for network demonstrations for BT as well as our external customers.

Investing for change

In such a fast moving industry we must invest in the skills, capabilities, methods and tools to define and deliver change in the right way. We’ve developed a new change approach to improve our customer experience, growing our business and making BT an even better place to work.

Our change approach

We define change by understanding where we are today and what we and our customers need. We create a solution to deliver the change. And through this cycle, we take steps to engage our people.

Leadership

This year, we’ve invested heavily in leaders. We’ve appointed 42 senior leaders, with 19 of these coming from other organisations. We’ve launched the Connected Leaders development programme to identify the type of leaders we want to attract and develop internally. It’s been a huge success; with over 39,000 people accessing the online development platform, 8,000 leaders completing a personal development assessment and more than 700 attending our learning programmes.

We’ve also launched two new development programmes targeted at people with high potential.

 

Future Leaders

 

In 2017/18, we’ve taken on more than 300 people with high potential and developed them to become leaders for the first time. More than 40% of the 2016/17 cohort have gone on to become managers.

 

Senior Talent Programmes

 

We’ve identified more than 80 senior leaders as having high potential for the future, and started accelerating their career development.

 

Engaging our people

Around 93,000 (86%) of our people responded to our ‘Your Say’ engagement survey in January 2018. It’s our highest ever completion rate. The survey results show improved overall engagement at 74%. This is encouraging. There’s been a steady improvement in many categories since June 2017.

 

 

 
44    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

     

BT

     % Fav.        Change  

 

Engagement outcome

 

  

 

74%

 

    

 

+2%

 

 

 

Leading our people

 

  

 

59%

 

    

 

+5%

 

 

 

Managing our people

 

  

 

81%

 

    

 

+2%

 

 

 

Empowering and equipping our people

 

  

 

61%

 

    

 

+2%

 

 

 

Enabling outstanding customer experience

 

  

 

64%

 

    

 

+3%

 

 

 

Working together

 

  

 

65%

 

    

 

+2%

 

 

 

Personal growth

 

  

 

73%

 

    

 

+3%

 

 

 

We tell our people about company results, major business decisions and other things that affect them through lots of different channels. Leaders regularly meet their teams through roundtables, town hall debates, site visits, webcasts and blogs.

We also listen to our people’s concerns through more formal engagement with our European Consultative Council, the Communication Workers Union, Prospect and EE employee representatives in the UK.

Volunteering

 

  Our 2020 ambition

  
 66%    Inspire two-thirds of
  

our people to volunteer

 

As part of our commitment to support charities and communities, (page 48), our people get up to three working days a year to volunteer. Volunteering means they can use their skills, energy and enthusiasm to tackle an issue or make a practical difference in their communities. Our volunteering website lists opportunities and lets everyone log activities centrally.

This year more than 2,000 of our people spent almost 5,000 days supporting our work to build a culture of tech literacy as Barefoot and Work Ready volunteers (see page 48).

Overall, 39% of our people registered their volunteering activity this year.

Diversity at work

We want a diverse workforce that matches our customers and delivers our business goals.

In March 2018 we reported our first gender pay gap data under new government guidelines, relating to data from April 2017. Our gap is below the UK average. But we are still working hard to be more diverse and inclusive, and to have women better represented at all levels in our business.

 

LOGO

 

LOGO   You can find out more at btplc.com

Around 26% of our workforce and 28% of our management are women. Three out of eleven Board members are women (27%). And 42% of our new executive hires have been women.

By 2020 we want women in 40% of our most senior roles. To support this, we’re widening our Tech Women programme which develops talented BT women into senior roles where they’re underrepresented. This year we extended the programme to 172% more women than last year, including those outside the UK. In March, the programme won the BQF ‘Innovation in Diversity’ award.

 

 

 
45    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our stakeholders continued

    

    

 

We’ve also launched an extra employee network to connect mums who are returning to work. Our maternity return rate is 86%, measured one year after women returned to work.

 

LOGO

We’ve been named in the Business in the Community’s 100 Top Employers for Best Employers for Race 2017.

Around 12% of our people have a Black, Asian or Minority Ethnic (BAME) background. Around 19% of our external appointments come from a BAME background.

Sponsorship helps build an environment where diversity is valued. So our senior leaders have had Inclusive Leadership workshops to help them overcome unintentional bias in decision making. We’ve also appointed executive sponsors for women, women in tech, race, disability and LGBT+.

Health, safety and wellbeing

Improving our people’s wellbeing is just the right thing to do. But it also drives better business performance.

The latest research is helping us determine what we need to do to foster good physical, psychological and emotional health in our workplace – beyond our commitment to ‘zero avoidable harm’. Our global health, safety and wellbeing policy sets out our approach and the Executive Committee and Board regularly monitor progress.

Our accident rate has dropped by a further 11% to its lowest-ever level and far fewer injuries are serious. Our risk profile is changing as we recruit more young people and we’ve responded by enhancing training and improving health and safety systems.

Fewer people took time off sick this year and our absence rate has dropped by 1% to 2.3% (against our 2.24% target).

Mental health is still our biggest focus. We endorse all the recommendations of the UK Government’s Stevenson/Farmer review. Prevention is key. Today work-related problems account for 16% of people seeking psychological support, compared with 36% five years ago. We’ve strengthened our wellbeing support services through a peer-to-peer scheme and our success rate in getting people with mental illness back to their normal work has risen to 97%.

Pay and benefits

We regularly review our pay and benefits to make sure they’re competitive compared with similar companies.

Most of our UK-based engineering and support people’s pay is negotiated through collective bargaining with our recognised trade unions. This means everyone gets treated fairly. Our managers’ pay ranges are also set at competitive levels. We work out bonuses through a mix of business performance and personal contribution.

Our executives may also get long-term share awards. These are discretionary and aligned to the long-term strategy of the company. What they get is determined by the group’s performance over a three-year period. Executive directors must keep hold of those shares for two more years.

In line with regulation, incentives for Openreach people are tied to a combination of personal contribution and Openreach’s performance, not the wider group. And these are paid in cash, not BT shares.

We support our people through retirement savings plans and country-specific benefits.

In the UK, after extensive consultation, we’ll be removing the eligibility for the majority of BT Pension Scheme members to accrue future benefits in that defined benefit scheme. Instead, these members and existing members will benefit from an enhanced contribution structure in our UK defined contribution plan – the BT Retirement Saving Scheme. This will provide more equal benefits across BT people in the UK and keep our pensions fair, flexible and affordable.

 

LOGO   You can read more about this on page 235.
 

 

 
46    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

LOGO

We listen to our customers, and have been investing to improve the experience they get from BT.

Our customers include UK individuals, households, businesses of all sizes and public sector organisations, plus companies around the globe.

You can read about our markets, customers and the services we offer them in our customer-facing units section, from page 72.

Some of our customers are also competitors. That’s because we sell wholesale products and services to other communications providers in the UK and overseas.

 

LOGO

We’re at the heart of the UK’s digital strategya.

We use the power of communications to make a better world. The greatest impact we make to society and the economy is through our products and services, underpinned by our networks.

This year we invested nearly £36m in initiatives that further our societal and environmental ambitions and contribute to economic growth. That figure includes cash, time volunteered, and other in-kind contributions. Over the last five years we’ve invested a total of £166m, averaging 1.06% of our adjusted profit before tax.

Total investment in society

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

Our Board Committee for Sustainable and Responsible Business (page 153) oversees these initiatives, in line with our shared value policy. We summarise progress on our societal ambitions below, with our environmental ambitions reported on page 54.

 

LOGO  And there are more details in our Delivering our Purpose report: bt.com/deliveringourpurpose

Providing access to fast broadband

 

  Our 2020 ambition   
 9/10    More than 9 out of 10 people
   in the UK will have access to
   our fibre-based products and
  

services

 

This year we supported the Government’s initiative to deliver superfast speeds (24Mbps or higher) to 95% of UK homes and businesses. Thanks in part to community fibre partnerships, our fibre broadband network now passes more than 27.5m premises.

Our original 2020 ambition (above) has now been superseded by the new Openreach targets for fibre access (page 110). We are also extending our mobile network coverage across the country (page 83).

Promoting digital inclusion

 

  Our 2020 ambition   
 10m    We will help 10m people
   overcome social disadvantage,
   through the benefits our
  

products and services can bring

 

Society is changing. ‘Digital’ is at the heart of this. Everybody should have both the access and skills to make the most of the digital world. Since setting this ambition in 2015, we’ve helped 4.6m people overcome social disadvantage:

 

Our portfolio includes a lot of products and services for elderly, disabled and financially-disadvantaged people. And this year we established a partnership with the charity Action on Hearing Loss, to develop new propositions for their customers.

 

 
a  gov.uk/government/publications/uk-digital-strategy

 

 
47    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our stakeholders continued

    

    

 

We’ve connected vulnerable communities in many parts of the world, bringing access to education, employment, financial support and healthcare. Our Connecting Africa initiative this year won the World Economic Forum’s ‘New Vision for Development’ award.

We collaborate with our industry partners to develop new products to help the most vulnerable. This year saw two highlights through our partnership with TechHub:

 

We launched Zone V (zonev.com) to make it easier for elderly or disabled people to use smartphones.

 

Tackling cybersecurity, we also ran a competition to ‘Secure the nation’. The winning SME – Chorus Intelligence – uses data analytics to support police in building intelligence cases to help solve crimes.

Through our collaboration with Doteveryone, we continue to research public attitudes towards digital technologies. We use the results to help get more people online and develop the skills to make the most of technology – safely.

Our advisory role to the Government’s digital skills partnership means we can inform policy development and help shape the work of the public sector, NGOs and industry.

Building skills for the next generation

 

  Our 2020 ambition      
 5m   We will help 5m children receive
  better teaching in computing
 

and tech skills

 

Young people need tech know-how to thrive in the digital world. But there’s a risk that the next generation won’t have the skills to do the jobs of the future or shape a more inclusive society. As we build the UK’s future digital infrastructure, we can use our national footprint to help the next generation make the most of technology in life and work.

Starting in primary schools, the Barefoot Computing Project helps to equip teachers to teach children computational thinking like logic, sequencing, abstraction and programming – the building blocks of tech literacy. With our partners BCS, the chartered institute for IT, we’ve now helped train more than 57,000 teachers and, through them, more than 1.6 million children.

As children get older, we want to help them make more conscious choices in their online lives. So this year we’ve worked with 5Rights on an innovation hothouse to find new ways to help 8-13 year olds navigate the commercial realities of the internet.

As they prepare to leave school, Work Ready gives 16-24 year-olds – particularly from disadvantaged backgrounds – the skills development and work experience opportunities they’ll need to succeed in a tech-enabled workforce.

Supporting charities and communities

 

  Our 2020 ambition      

 £1bn

  We will use our skills and
  technology to help generate
 

more than £1bn for good causes

 

This year we helped to raise around £109m for good causes. MyDonate, our commission-free online fundraising and donations platform, covered nearly £63m of this.

Our fundraising activities focused on three main charity partners, Cancer Research UK, Comic Relief and Unicef UK. We provided ‘Text to donate’ for the charity appeals we supported. They included big regular appeals like the BBC’s Children in Need and raising money for the victims of the Grenfell Tower fire and Manchester Arena bombing.

Since setting this ambition in 2012, we’ve helped generate a total of £531m toward our £1bn target.

 

LOGO

All of our shareholders are important, be they institutions or private individuals.

We have roughly 763,000 shareholders.

Most of our shares are held by institutional investors. We have an extensive investor relations programme aimed at keeping existing and prospective investors informed. It includes things like:

 

reporting quarterly, interim and full year results, accompanied by a conference call or presentation from senior management

 

site visits, presentations from our business units, and ‘teach-ins’ on key topics

 

meetings and conference calls with investors both in the UK and around the world

 

regular communication between our Investor Relations team, investors and analysts that follow BT

 

In 2017/18, we held 450 meetings or events with institutional investors. This compares with 507 in 2016/17.
 

 

 
48    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Some investors care deeply about social, environmental and ethical issues. We give particular attention to these ‘socially responsible investors’ via a programme designed to meet their specific needs.

As well as the Annual Report and Annual General Meeting, we keep all shareholders up to date with how we’re doing through our website which has a comprehensive set of press releases, newsletters, presentations and webcasts.

Each year we survey a random sample of private shareholders to help us improve shareholder engagement. And we offer them exclusive deals on our products and services.

 

LOGO

We pay close attention to our credit metrics.

Our lenders, mainly banking institutions and bondholders, play an important role in our treasury and balance sheet strategy.

These relationships are vital as we finance our business.

 

LOGO   You can read more about this on page 250.

 

LOGO

Our pension schemes need to be fair, flexible and affordable.

We must make sure our pension schemes are fair, flexible and affordable for all members. We operate defined contribution and defined benefit pension schemes. Most BT people working today are in the BTRSS defined contribution scheme. We also operate the BTPS defined benefit scheme which has around 300,000 members.

 

LOGO   You can read more about this on page 235.

LOGO

We use suppliers from across the world. We only choose ones that operate ethically and responsibly.

Our suppliers provide products and services that help us execute our strategy. We source from across the world and have suppliers in more than 150 countries. We spent around £13.7bn with suppliers this year (2016/17: £14.1bn). Around 92% of our spend is with our top 1,000 suppliers.

We have around 450 procurement people in 29 countries working with these suppliers.

This year we made a significant investment in our presence, capability and skill set within India, growing our team by 66. It now makes up 32% of our procurement organisation. Around 50 of our people took part in exchange visits to share best practice across cultures and enhance our capability. This is moving us towards our ambition of having a single global procurement team.

Procurement transformation

This year there was a major reshuffle of our procurement team, with a lot of changes:

 

We created three buying teams – two focusing on our indirect (own use) and direct (customer) procurement needs and a third focusing on all our non-UK spend.

 

We appointed new CFU-focused experts to manage conversations between procurement and CFUs.

 

We created a new scorecard which balances our performance between cost savings and things like risk, innovation and people.

 

We used external consultants and international benchmarks to understand the full range of commercial opportunities of our procurement categories and improve efficiency.

 

We carried out a detailed cost analysis of our complex networking equipment to identify further opportunities to reduce component costs.

 

With the University of Cambridge and a strategic supplier, we are collaborating on research to investigate how technology could be used to help vulnerable communities affected by climate change, and bridge digital divisions in society.
 

 

 
49    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our stakeholders continued

    

    

 

Choosing our suppliers

We want to know who we’re doing business with and who’s acting on our behalf. So we:

 

pick suppliers using principles that make sure we act ethically and responsibly

 

check that the goods and services we buy are made, delivered and disposed of in a socially and environmentally responsible way

 

measure things like suppliers’ energy use, environmental impact and labour standards as well as working with them to improve these.

 

LOGO   You can find out more at www. selling2bt.bt.com

Ethical standards in our supply chain

We want our suppliers’ people to work in safe and fair conditions. To help us assess the risks, we send an ethical standards questionnaire through an online portal or an industry standard self-assessment tool, Ecovadis. We follow up with anyone identified as high or medium risk, based on their responses.

We also visit supplier sites to make sure they meet our standards. This year we visited 52 sites (2016/17: 63 sites) around the world. To add to our resources, we trained four people in our India team to international audit standards. And they have since contributed to the assessments carried out this year.

We published our second Modern Slavery Act Statement in August. This year the focus was on due diligence practices in our supply chain.

We continued complying with the Dodd-Frank Act and the Security and Exchange Commission (SEC) requirements, by checking whether suppliers’ products contained minerals from conflict areas. In June 2017 we filed with the SEC our report for 2016, which described our conflict minerals approach and reflected the responses we received from suppliers.

Paying our suppliers

This year the average time between a supplier invoice and us paying them was 62 days (2016/17: 67 days).

Suppliers can also choose to use the BT Supplier Finance scheme which offers contracted suppliers the chance to be paid early. This cuts financing costs for whoever participates, large or small, and is particularly good for SMEs (who make up around 50% of our supply base). We remain a signatory of the UK Prompt Payment Code and support government initiatives to encourage small business growth.

LOGO

We’re one of the largest suppliers of networked IT services to the UK public sector.

We work with almost 1,800 organisations across central, local and devolved government. And we support some of the UK’s most vital services – including critical infrastructure, welfare, tax, health and social care, police and defence.

Our public affairs team look after our UK political relationships. They’re responsible for Westminster (politicians and policy advisers) and Whitehall (the Government, including civil servants) on all issues of policy. They’re not responsible for operational issues like selling or maintaining contracts and services. That’s the job of Business and Public Sector (see page 86).

We have solutions designed for both central and local government. One of our most important contributions is helping organisations deliver better public services while keeping data secure. For example, this year we’ve supported the Metropolitan Police with the world’s largest rollout of body-worn video cameras. We’re also rolling out wi-fi which will allow frontline officers and more than 20,000 civilian staff to work more flexibly.

Supporting the armed forces community

The Government recognises us as one of the UK’s leading supporters of the armed forces community. This year:

 

the MoD renewed the Employer Recognition Scheme (ERS) Gold Award it first gave us in 2014

 

we helped make the MoD’s new Military Mental Health Helpline a reality. Launched in February 2018, it’s targeted at serving personnel and their families – allowing them to access the help, advice and support they need outside of work, anytime, anywhere in the UK.

Civil resilience and other obligations

Another aspect of our relationship with government is that we can be required by law to do certain things and provide certain services. For example, under the Communications Act, we (and others) have to run or restore services during disasters. The Civil Contingencies Act 2004 also states that the Government can impose obligations on us (and others) at times of emergency or in connection with civil contingency planning.

The Secretary of State for the Home Department can also require us to take certain actions if they’re in the interests of national security.

 

 

 
50    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

LOGO

We advocate clear, predictable and proportionate regulation.

Communications and TV services are regulated in the UK and around the world. This is to make sure that communication providers (CPs) and broadcasters stick to common standards and rules, and that nobody is disadvantaged by providers with strong positions in their market.

Overseas regulation

The degree of regulation in international markets varies widely. This can hinder our ability to compete and provide the services our customers want. We continue to press incumbent operators around the world, and their regulators, for fairer, cost-related wholesale access to their networks.

European Union (EU) regulation

In EU countries, electronic communications networks and services are governed by Directives and Regulations set by the European Institutions. These create an EU-wide framework (the Common Regulatory Framework) for fixed and wireless telecoms, internet, broadcasting and transmission services.

The Directives are there to encourage competition, which in turn leads to better investment, lower prices and increased quality of service in fixed and mobile networks, and better protection for consumers. They require national regulators to review markets for significant market power (SMP) every three years and where relevant, to put in place appropriate and proportionate remedies. They also include rules covering spectrum, consumer protection and universal service obligations.

Review of European rules for the communications sector

  

In September 2016 the European Commission (EC) proposed a review of the Common Regulatory Framework. As part of this review, the EC wants to encourage investment in very high-capacity networks and update consumer protection rules to reflect new types of services such as ‘over-the-top’ providers. Negotiations are ongoing.

 

To protect audiences in an on-demand, internet environment, the EC is reviewing copyright and rules for audio-visual media services. Negotiations are ongoing.

 

The UK’s exit from

the EU

  

The UK is due to leave the EU in March 2019. Depending on any transition period or trade agreements, it may no longer have to follow the EU Regulatory Framework and other rules.

 

Existing regulations are recognised as having helped make the UK communications market one of the most competitive in the world. UK consumers get low prices and the best superfast broadband coverage in the major EU countries. So while existing regulations might be fine-tuned to suit specific UK market conditions, we don’t expect fundamental changes.

 

 

 

 
51    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our stakeholders continued

    

    

 

UK regulation and Ofcom

The UK telecoms and broadcasting industries are regulated primarily by Ofcom (the UK’s independent regulator), within the framework set by European rules and UK regulations.

Ofcom operates under the Communications Act 2003, which gives it its powers and duties.

Ofcom’s main duties are to champion citizens’ interests on communications matters, and to further consumers’ interests by promoting competition.

Under the 2003 Act, Ofcom sets conditions that CPs must stick to. Some of these (the General Conditions) apply to all CPs. They deal mainly with things like protecting consumers, access and interconnection, and allocating and transferring phone numbers.

Other conditions apply only to certain companies who are universal service providers or who are found to have SMP in a particular market.

We’re the designated universal service provider in the UK (except for the Hull area where that role is taken by KCOM Group) and have to provide basic, affordable fixed-line services to all consumers. We also have to provide public payphones.

We have SMP in a number of markets including Business Connectivity (such as Ethernet and backhaul), Fixed Access (including LLUa, GEAb and WLRc), Wholesale Broadband Access and Narrowband (such as Call Origination). That’s why Ofcom’s market reviews are so important to us.

 

Ofcom’s strategic review of digital communications  

In July 2017 Ofcom confirmed it would release us from the Undertakings once the arrangements for our voluntary commitments were all in place. This included the employees working for Openreach being transferred to Openreach Limited and adopting the new model of functional separation for Openreach to secure greater strategic and operational independence.

 

Implementation of the new arrangements has gone well. Openreach Limited has been legally incorporated and the members of the Openreach Board were appointed as Directors of Openreach Limited in December 2017. The Openreach senior leadership team voluntarily transferred to Openreach Limited in January 2018.

 

 

We have worked hard to implement all of the necessary changes that we can at this stage, and on 9 April 2018 BT formally adopted all the elements of the Commitments and Governance Protocol that can be adopted without triggering the TUPE transfer. We continue to work towards the TUPE of all employees working for Openreach to Openreach Limited as soon as practicable.

 

Price regulation of our main wholesale products

The following table shows which wholesale products provided to CPs are subject to price controls in markets where we have SMP.

 

  Products

 

Annual charge

control

(2018/19)

     

Current charge     

control ends     

 

Fixed call termination

 

 

 

0.0323 ppm*

 

     

 

31 March 2021

 

 

Mobile call termination

 

 

0.495 ppm*

(0.489 ppm

from 1 June

2018)

 

     

 

31 March 2021

 

ISDN2

 

 

 

CPI-CPI

 

     

 

31 March 2021

 

 

ISDN30

 

 

 

CPI-CPI

 

     

 

31 March 2021

 

 

Metallic Path Facility (MPF)

 

 

 

£85.46

     

 

31 March 2021

 

Ethernet (up to and including 1Gbps in geographies where BT has SMPd)

 

 

 

CPI-13.5%

     

 

31 March 2019

 

Generic Ethernet Access (GEA) 40/10

 

 

 

£69.59

     

 

31 March 2021

 

Partial Private Circuit (PPC)e

 

 

 

CPI-3.5%

     

 

31 March 2019

 

Interconnect circuits

 

 

 

CPI+0%

 

     

 

31 March 2021

 

 

* pence per minute.

Other regulatory decisions and activities this year

Business connectivity market review (BCMR)

In April 2016 Ofcom published its Final Statement on its Business Connectivity Market Review. We disagreed with some aspects of this and appealed these to the Competition Appeal Tribunal (CAT). In July 2017 the CAT upheld our appeal on product market, geographic market and core network grounds. In November 2017, the CAT quashed Ofcom’s decisions on these aspects and told it to reconsider.

In response, Ofcom revoked the relevant parts of the 2016 BCMR. It then imposed temporary SMP findings and obligations on Ethernet services until March 2019 – using ‘exceptional’ and ‘emergency’ powers.

Ofcom consulted on adding dark fibre to the temporary obligations with effect from April 2018. On 12 April 2018 Ofcom confirmed that it would not be adding a dark fibre remedy to the temporary SMP remedies imposed in November 2017.

 

 

 

a  Local Loop Unbundling.
b  Generic Ethernet Access.
c  Wholesale Line Rental.
d  The whole of the UK except the Central London Area, the central business districts of Birmingham, Glasgow and Leeds, and the Hull Area.
e  <8Mbps.
 

 

 
52    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Wholesale local access market review (WLA)

Following the WLA market review in 2017, Ofcom made changes to Local Loop Unbundling (LLU ) and Virtual Unbundled Local Access (VULA ) product regulation. MPFa is still subject to a CPI-based charge control. SMPFb had its charge control removal and replaced with a fair and reasonable pricing obligation.

Ofcom has introduced a charge control for the GEA 40/10 lower speed product. The 55/10 and 80/20 products are subject to fair, reasonable and non-discriminatory obligations, though not subject to a charge control – which means we still have some flexibility in how we price these other products.

Along with charge controls, Ofcom has implemented new minimum service level obligations (MSL) and a cap on duct and pole access prices.

Wholesale broadband access market review (WBA)

In June 2017 Ofcom consulted on the wholesale broadband access market. It proposed that the area with SMP (Market A) should be reduced from 10% to 2%. Ofcom has also proposed removing the charge control on our IP Stream Connect product. We’ve responded to the proposals and expect a final statement from Ofcom in summer 2018.

Narrowband market review (NBMR)

Ofcom completed a review of the narrowband market on 30 November 2017. This covered fixed call origination, call termination and WLR. It found that we held SMP in all these areas.

But it also recognised that alternative voice services were strengthening competition.

Ofcom decided to deregulate charge controls to ‘fair and reasonable’ charges, remove ‘undue discrimination obligations’ for Wholesale Call Origination (WCO) and bring in extra obligations on Wholesale Call Termination (including price controls and no undue discrimination).

Mobile regulation

On 24 September 2015 Ofcom published its final spectrum annual licence fees statement for 1800MHz and 900MHz spectrum. It trebled EE’s 1800MHz spectrum fees from c£25m to c£75m per year.

EE, supported by other mobile network operators, challenged that. The Court of Appeal quashed the Statement on 22 November 2017. It found that Ofcom should have considered its wider European law duties when setting the licence fees. EE will pay licence fees at the previous level until Ofcom issues a new determination. EE, along with other mobile network operators, is seeking repayment of the historical overpaid licence fees.

On 20 March 2018 the auction for both bands went ahead with results announced on 5 April 2018. BT/EE were awarded 40MHz of 3.4GHz spectrum. The location of the spectrum assignments within the 3.4GHz band were determined after further bidding in an assignment round on 10 April. BT/EE were allocated the 3540 – 3580 MHz spectrum frequencies. This result supports our 5G leadership ambitions.

Standalone landline telephone services

After a review of the Standalone Landline Telephone Services market, Ofcom has accepted our voluntary proposal to reduce line rental prices by £7 a month.

This price cut works with our further promise to only raise call and line rental prices in line with inflation (CPI) each year. It also sits alongside our commitment to engage with voice-only and ‘split purchase’ customers (who use us for landline and someone else for broadband) to make sure they are fully aware of potential savings available to them. Reduced line rental for voice-only customers came into effect from 1 April 2018.

Broadband Universal Service Obligation (USO)

In December 2017 the UK Government rejected our proposal to deliver universal broadband voluntarily.

Instead, the Government used secondary legislation to introduce a USO on broadband. It will give consumers the right to request at least a 10Mbps broadband connection from 2020. We’ll work closely with government, Ofcom and industry to make it happen.

Deemed Consent

In March 2017 Ofcom found that Openreach had breached certain contractual and regulatory obligations by inadequately and retrospectively applying Deemed Consent to reduce compensation payments to CPs between January 2013 and December 2014.

Deemed Consent is an agreed contractual process between Openreach and its CP customers, which allows Openreach to reschedule the delivery date for providing dedicated business services (known as Ethernet) in a number of specific circumstances.

On 27 March 2018 Openreach reported to Ofcom that it had, in its view, complied with the requirements set out in Ofcom’s decision.

We estimate the total compensation payments will amount to around £300m.

Automatic compensation

Following commencement of the Digital Economy Act 2017, Ofcom now has greater powers on automatic compensation. In March 2017, it consulted on proposals for introducing automatic compensation. It has accepted an updated industry scheme from leading communications providers, including us.

This voluntary scheme will automatically compensate fixed voice and broadband customers if they lose service, have a delayed order, or get a missed appointment. The scheme is due to start in February 2019, following extensive systems development.

 

 

a  Metallic Path Facility (MPF).
b  Shared Metallic Path Facility (SMPF).

 

 
53    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our stakeholders continued

    

    

 

LOGO

For over 25 years we’ve been a leader in tackling climate change.

We set our first carbon reduction target in 1992. In 2008 we were one of the first companies in the world to set a science-based target to cut our carbon emissions intensity, by 80%. We achieved that four years early. Now we’ve gone a step further, setting an ambitious new target in line with the Paris Agreement on climate change.

Our leadership in sustainability and how to report it is widely recognised: we kept our place in the top 10 of Newsweek’s Green rankings, which track the environmental performance of the 500 largest publicly-traded global companies. Carbon Clear rated us as the second-best FTSE 100 company for carbon reporting. We achieved ‘A’ ratings from CDP on climate change and supply chain engagement.

On top of that, we continue to manage energy and water use, support the principles of a circular economy, and take seriously our responsibilities for the environment:

 

Our Environmental Management Compliance Steering Board monitors performance against our environmental policy. It reports to the Audit & Risk committees of our business units, to regional governance committees outside the UK, and to our Executive Committee.

 

We assess climate-related and other environmental risks within our enterprise risk management framework (page 56).

 

This year our environmental management systems have been certified to ISO14001 standards in Belgium, Colombia, France, Germany, Ireland, Italy, the Netherlands, Spain and the UK.

 

We’re a signatory to the Climate Disclosure Standards Board’s fiduciary duty and climate change disclosure.

LOGO Our Delivering our Purpose report at bt.com/deliveringourpurpose has more details.

Our net positive carbon impact

We’re already a net positive company. That means we help our customers cut their carbon footprints by more than double our own emissions (including our supply chain). We’re aiming for a 3:1 ratio by 2020.

 

 

    Our 2020 ambition

 3:1   

Enable customers to reduce their

carbon emissions by at least

three times the end-to-end

carbon impact of our business

  

 

   3:1 ambition

         2016/17                2017/18  

 

  Customer savings (Mt CO2e)

 

  

10.0

 

    

11.3

 

 

 

  Our impact (Mt CO2e)

 

  

5.6

 

    

5.1

 

 

 

  Ratio

 

  

1.8:1

 

    

2.2:1

 

 

 

Cutting our customers’ carbon footprints

Many of our products and services help reduce our customers’ carbon footprints. This year we earned £5.3bn from these products, 22% of our total revenue.

Reducing our own emissions

This year we’ve set a new ambition, which has been approved by the Science-Based Targets Initiative. It aligns our impact with the most ambitious aim of the Paris Agreement – to limit global warming to 1.5°C by the end of the century.

 

 

    Our new 1.5°C ambition

 87%   

By 2030, we aim to cut our

carbon emissions intensitya by

87%, compared with 2016/17

levels

 

  

a measured by tonnes CO2e per £ value added, for scope 1 & 2 emissions.

 

 

To meet this target, we’re speeding up plans to cut our vehicle fleet emissions. This year we’ve added more plug-in hybrid models to our company car list. We’re also exploring new ways to decarbonise our property estate and improve efficiency through technologies like IoT.
We report our greenhouse gas emission sources in line with UK regulations. In the last year we’ve reduced our total worldwide CO2 equivalent (CO2e) emissions by 8.9%. This year our scope 1 & 2 intensity totalled 26 tonnes CO2e per £m gross value added; a decrease of 6.8% from last year.
 

 

 
54    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Our worldwide greenhouse gas emissionsa

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

 

CO2e Ktonnes

   2016        2017          2018  

Scope 3

   4,391        5,233          4,758  

Scope 2

   51        184          160  

Scope 1

   172        179          180  

Total

   4,614        5,596          5,099  

Scope 1 + 2 intensity:

   21        28          26  

(CO2e tonnes per £m value added)

         

We now include all scope 3 emissions in our reporting. EE data is included from 2017 onwards. Figures exclude third-party consumption. Scope 2 data uses market-based calculation. For full methodology, and further data, see bt.com/deliveringourpurpose.

About two-thirds of our emissions come from our supply chain. We’re working with our suppliers to reduce their impacts too. By 2030 we want to cut their emissions by 29% compared with 2016/17. This year, we’ve seen their emissions fall by 6.3%.

Cutting our energy use

This year our overall energy consumption dropped by 1.7%. We’ve cut our energy bill by nearly £29m, cumulatively saving £250m since our base year of 2009/10. In Great Britain, we spent around £370m on energy and fuel (2016/17: £341m).

Our worldwide energy use

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

100% renewable electricity

We maintain our commitment that by 2020 we will buy all our electricity from renewable sources, wherever markets allow.

We’ve now renegotiated most of the electricity contracts we took on when we acquired EE, in line with that commitment, and we’re working on the rest. Overall this year 82% of our UK electricity, and 81% worldwide, came from renewable contracts (up from 78% and 77% respectively last yearb).

We also launched campaigns to encourage our suppliers, employees and home-mover customers to switch to buying renewable energy.

Other environmental impacts

Beyond our carbon footprint, we manage a range of other impacts, including the following:

Water use

We mainly use water in our offices and canteens, and in the cooling systems in our data centres and exchanges. We continue to monitor water use and target leaks. We’ve seen a 1% increase in our overall consumption this year, largely due to the adiabatic cooling systems we’re introducing to cut our reliance on refrigerant gases.

Waste and recycling

We work with our suppliers to minimise whatever materials we use, and we reuse or recycle equipment and materials whenever we can. We offer take-back schemes on many consumer products, including mobile phones. Complying with national regulations, we use specialist contractors to manage hazardous waste responsibly.

 

 

a We restate previous years’ data when we think subsequent information is materially significant (like replacing estimates with measured figures).

b 2016/17 energy figures restated – see bt.com/deliveringourpurpose for details.

 

 
55    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our approach to risk management

    

    

 

Like any business, we face a number of risks and uncertainties. Some come from outside our organisation, others from within. Some we can’t control, some we can. Many of our risks are similar to those felt by similar businesses.

Principal risks and uncertainties

The principal risks and uncertainties that affect us could have an impact on our business, brand, assets, revenue, profits, liquidity or capital resources. The principal risks we described last year have evolved, and so has our response to them.

Our Enterprise Risk Management framework gives reasonable (but cannot give absolute) assurance that we’ve identified and addressed our biggest risks. However, there may be some risks that are either currently unknown, or currently seen as less important but with the potential to become more so in the future.

Events outside BT present both risks and opportunities. We focus our efforts on predicting and reducing risks while aiming to take advantage of any opportunities that may emerge.

We recognise the uncertainty that political and geopolitical risks present, and have continued to operate a specific Brexit programme across BT that looks at how we might be affected and what our response should be. This programme is keeping a close watch on developments, and reports to a steering group chaired by our group CFO.

In the section below, we explain what we’re doing to prevent our main risks from materialising, or to limit their impact if they’re unavoidable. Our biggest risks and uncertainties should be considered alongside the risk management process, the forward-looking statements in this document and the associated cautionary statement (see page 296).

How we manage risk

To meet our objectives, build shareholder value and promote our stakeholders’ interests, it’s essential we manage risk. To help us, we’ve developed a group-wide risk management process with four stages:

 

LOGO

Changes over the year

In 2016/17 we improved the way we manage risk through focusing on risks to our investment cases, developing an enhanced approach to root cause analysis, and identifying new ways to share good practice across the organisation. Specific further improvements this year included:

Three lines of defence

We’ve revisited our three lines of defence model (our approach to governing and assuring our business) and how we apply it to our key areas of risk. This has helped us identify areas where we can optimise our assurance. We’re also developing training around the three lines of defence to help our people better understand the model and how they support it.

External benchmarking/Internal review

We’ve been reviewing our risk management arrangements, using some external benchmarking and discussions with key internal stakeholders. This has helped highlight areas of strength and also areas where we can develop further. We’ll be addressing those findings next year.

Real-time war gaming

We’ve continued our cycle of war gaming during 2017/18, and this year also tested a crisis scenario in real time. This exercise involved numerous colleagues from across the business and the learnings will help us become more resilient to future events.

 

 

 

Enterprise risk framework

 

     
LOGO              LOGO
Customer-facing unit    Group Risk Panel    Executive Committee    Board
and TSO leadership teams    The Group Risk Panel supports    The Executive Committee    The Board has overall
Our customer-facing units and    the Board and the Executive    identifies, evaluates, responds    responsibility for making
TSO follow our process for    Committee. Every three months    to and monitors risks.    sure we manage risks
managing risk as part of our    it reviews the Group Risk    Significant risks are reported    appropriately. It regularly
Enterprise Risk Management    Register (which summarises    and monitored through the    reviews, either directly or
framework. That means    those risks of greatest    Group Risk Register. The    through the Audit & Risk
identifying and responding to    significance across our    Executive Committee assigns a    Committee, how we’re doing
the key risks affecting their    business), considers the    management owner to take    across the group, in our
business. They record the risks    inclusion of new or emerging    charge of monitoring and    customer-facing units and

for their leadership teams to

   risks, and recommends ways to    managing each risk. It monitors    in TSO.
review. Audit & risk committees    tackle them. It also oversees the    risks through regular detailed   
in each customer-facing unit,    work of the group risk    reviews as well as six-monthly   
TSO and our group functions,    management function.    reviews of the Group Risk   
make sure this process is       Register.   
effective.         

 

 
56    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

Our principal risks and uncertainties

Compliance risks

                  

Trend indicates        LOGO   Increasing/worsening

our perception of     LOGO   Lessening/improving

pre-mitigation risk   LOGO    At a similar level

     
     

 

Significant control failure
     

  Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

  

 Trend                                

 

   LOGO  – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO  – Financial capital   

LOGO                                 

 

   LOGO  – Transform our costs

   LOGO  – Human capital   
  

LOGO  – Social capital

 

  

 

It’s crucial that we maintain high ethical standards. We respect human rights and we don’t tolerate fraud, bribery, any form of corruption or any illegal or unethical activity.

We follow local and international law, including anti-corruption and bribery laws. The UK Bribery Act and US Foreign Corrupt Practices Act (FCPA) have extraterritorial reach, so cover our global operations. We also have to make sure we follow trade sanctions and import and export controls. We comply with the Modern Slavery Act and follow international standards on human rights, such as the International Labour Organisation’s Principles and the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights.

We also face the risks associated with inappropriate and unethical behaviour in local and other markets by our people or associates, such as suppliers or agents, which can be difficult to detect. There is also a risk that our controls, which are designed to prevent, detect and correct such behaviour, may be circumvented. Controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving their objectives and there can be no assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential conditions, regardless of how remote.

Financial controls, and the assurance that exists over them, play an important part in our ability to prevent and detect inappropriate behaviour. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Therefore even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation.

Potential impact

If our people, or associates like suppliers or agents, breach anti-corruption, bribery, sanctions or other legislation there could be significant penalties, criminal prosecution and damage to our brand. This could have an impact on future revenue and cash flow depending on the nature of the breach, the legislation concerned and any penalties. If we were accused of corruption, bribery, human rights abuses, violating sanctions regulations or other laws, it could lead to reputational damage with investors, regulators, civil society and customers. A breakdown in our financial control framework could result in financial misstatement.

What’s changed over the last year?

We’ve seen an increase in Speak Up (BT’s confidential hotline service) reports and conflict of interest registrations. In 2017/18 Speak Up reports increased by 63% on the previous year. This is indicative of a culture where people are more aware and confident to tell us about their concerns.

In terms of anti-corruption and bribery enforcement generally, we’ve continued to see a steady flow of significant cases from both the UK Bribery Act and the FCPA. In the US 11 companies paid a total of $1.92 billion to resolve FCPA cases in 2017.

There’s also been an increase in legislation (either enacted or proposed) to address and report on human rights abuses by companies.

How we’re mitigating the risks

This year we’ve implemented a major programme of work to strengthen our controls and compliance activities, and ensure awareness of the standards we expect. Following the identification of inappropriate behaviours in our Italian business in the summer of 2016, we have also implemented wider controls that monitor our overseas operations in our shared service centres, Global Services and at a group level, see page 145.

We’ve redefined and communicated our three lines of defence model, and strengthened our controls policies and procedures. This covered both financial and non-financial controls, and we’ve re-mapped our assurance coverage across the three lines of defence for our principal risks and uncertainties. This helped us identify opportunities to improve our controls policies and procedures, as well as to extend the assurance that operates over the controls. We’re also building awareness and understanding, and all finance employees have completed Financial Statement Fraud awareness training, including a module on how to escalate concerns.

We’ve also put a number of other controls in place to address risk in this area. These include an anti-corruption and bribery programme and ‘The Way We Work’, our ethical code, available in 14 languages. We ask all our people to complete training and sign up to The Way We Work which includes our zero tolerance to bribery and corruption. We’ve developed a new guide this year, ‘The BT Way’, which brings together for our people how we’re organised and deliver for our customers, our ethical code and our values.

We have policies covering conflicts of interest, gifts and hospitality, charitable donations and sponsorship. We also run tailored training for people in higher-risk roles like procurement and sales.

We regularly weigh up our business integrity risks to make sure we’ve got the right mitigation in place. We’ve introduced an Ethics & Compliance Integrity Risk Dashboard. It brings together various indicators to better identify possible emerging trends or particular hotspots. The approach draws together various themes to look for patterns and establish any outliers across our business.

All Speak Up reports are passed to the director of ethics and compliance for action. Our confidential hotline is operated by a third party and is available to employees and third-party contractors who can remain anonymous if they choose to. Any reports received direct by BT are also dealt with in accordance with our Speak Up procedures.

Our internal audit team regularly runs checks on our business. External providers also assess areas we think are higher risk (such as the use of agents), to make sure people understand our policies and that controls are working. We do due diligence checks on third parties like suppliers, agents, resellers and distributors. In 2017/18

 

 

 
57    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our principal risks and uncertainties continued

Compliance risks continued

    

 

 

we completed 32 reviews of our existing agents resellers and distributors. We take a risk-based approach to these reviews, which include external reviews, internal on-site reviews and desk-based reviews. Our procurement contracts include anti-corruption and bribery clauses. In addition all new suppliers, agents, resellers and distributors go through an on-boarding process which includes financial checks and the use of our due diligence screening tool. Existing suppliers, agents, resellers and distributors are additionally screened on a weekly basis.

Our sanctions policy helps us keep track of trade sanctions and export controls that apply to us. That means all bids involving a country which is subject to our sanctions policy requires approval. The policy also mandates everyone in BT to use our internal shipping system to arrange international exports, as it runs compliance checks and flags any orders which need an export licence.

We launched a customer due diligence tool which we use when bidding for customer contracts. It identifies human rights risks and links them to the sanctions approval process. We’ve run training and calls to raise awareness of the tool. We’ve also carried out human rights impact assessments on our operations in India, Russia and China, and have developed an overarching human rights policy for imminent launch. We reported publicly on our most salient human rights risks in our Privacy and Free Expression Report in 2015, which we’re updating in 2018 to include parts of our international business. Our Human Rights Steering Group reviews our programme and discusses current issues. We’ve also been working closely with peers through organisations like the Business Against Slavery Forum and Global Network Initiative.

Despite our efforts, unfortunately not everyone gets it right every time. We disciplined 205 employees in the UK as a result of ethical misconduct this year, and 98 left the companya. The most common issues related to inappropriate use of company vehicles.

 

 

Processing our customers’ data

  Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

                          Trend                             
   LOGO  – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO  – Financial capital   

 

LOGO                             

  

LOGO  – Social capital

 

  

 

We control and process huge quantities of customer data around the world, so observing data privacy laws is something we take extremely seriously. It’s essential that individuals and businesses can trust us to do the right thing with their data.

We make sure our customers’ data is secure, and protected against both internal and external threats (eg cyber attacks). Being trusted with our customers’ data goes further than that though. It means preserving the integrity of the personal data we process, and only keeping the things we need to provide customers with the services they’ve signed up for. It also means being transparent around how we use customer data, who we share it with, making sure the way we process personal data is legal, fair and in line with customers’ rights and wishes, and ensuring that we fulfil the legal obligations we have when customers want to exercise their rights under data legislation.

As a communications provider we currently operate under a stringent reporting regime to tell the UK Information Commissioner’s Office (ICO) if we become aware of a personal data security breach. We must also tell any affected individuals as quickly as possible if the incident is likely to have a significant impact on them. On 25 May 2018 EU General Data Protection Regulation (GDPR) will come into force. We are in the process of implementing more stringent procedures around data protection in order to comply with the GDPR requirements, which may lead to higher regulatory compliance costs.

An individual’s fundamental right to privacy is reflected in the fact that data privacy laws are in force in more than 100 countries. The nature of those laws vary across different parts of the world. Increasingly we (and other multinationals) have to show that we’re handling personal data in line with a complex web of national data laws and society’s ethical expectations.

Potential impact

Failing to stick to data protection and privacy laws could result in regulatory enforcement action, significant fines, class-action, prison sentences and the regulator telling us to stop processing data.

a UK only, excluding EE and Plusnet.

On top of that, we could see huge reputational damage and big financial losses. Those losses could come from fines and damages if we fail to meet our legal requirements, as well as costs resulting from having to terminate customer contracts and the subsequent customer churn. Companies who’ve had high profile data incidents have seen a significant impact to their share price and suffered ongoing costs from their non-compliance.

What’s changed over the last year?

The GDPR is deemed one of the biggest shake ups in data law for over a decade. It’s been created to update the existing law to ensure that individuals’ data is protected and secured and gives people a greater say as to how their data is used. It also increases their rights as to how their personal data is kept, used and retained by businesses. The sanctions for breaching the GDPR are significantly higher than under the previous regime, which could result in a substantial fine in the event of a breach.

Scrutiny from national regulators is increasing as companies are monitored to ensure they’re working towards compliance with the new law. In addition within the last 12 months several large companies have suffered further well-publicised data incidents and the general trend towards bigger financial penalties has increased.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We’ve created a compliance programme to review all activities that involve customer data across the business in light of the new regulatory requirements. Our focus will be on protecting our systems, enhancing our operational processes to protect customer data, and refreshing our training so that our people understand the importance of the data they handle.

We also want to give our people the tools they need to make everyday risk-based decisions around privacy and data protection without it being a burden or making their job more complicated.

If we do that, there’s a much better chance of data compliance becoming ‘business as usual’. For example, using Privacy Impact Assessments when we develop new products and services makes

 

 

 
58    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

sure everyone understands privacy issues from the start and builds in the right controls, without any operational impact.

The Chief Privacy Officer and her team champion privacy awareness, and are responsible for undertaking monitoring and

assurance to make sure data compliance is embedded within the business.

Our mitigations against cyber attacks are described in our Security and resilience risk (page 66).

 

 

Health, safety and wellbeing

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

   Trend                                 
   LOGO  – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO – Financial capital   

 

LOGO                                   

   LOGO  – Transform our costs

   LOGO – Human capital   
   LOGO – Social capital   
  

LOGO – Natural capital

 

  

 

Our people are crucial to our business and if they feel safe, healthy and happy they will perform better for our customers and our shareholders. Working to reduce the risk of harm to our people helps us comply with health and safety laws wherever we operate.

Many of our people, especially our UK engineers, work for much of the time in community settings where we have limited control over the working environment. Much of the network is carried above ground level and temporary work at height is a major risk for us – over the course of a year our people will undertake millions of climbing jobs. All of our people work in a fast-paced and highly competitive sector where change is constant and psychological pressures are significant. Managing physical and psychological hazards is therefore complex.

Potential impact

We work to make sure our people go home safely every day. Any health and safety failure could result in injury to our people or members of the public, financial penalties, and/or reputational damage.

The wellbeing of our colleagues is important if we’re to transform our business while continuing to recruit, retain and engage our workforce to deliver a great customer experience and grow the business. An adverse reaction to change could impact talent retention, resulting in a loss of critical skills and greater need for external recruitment, which would add cost to the business. Poor engagement also raises the risk of general industrial unrest and action.

What’s changed over the last year?

Changes in technology and working practices help to reduce the physical risks to our people. For example, the shift from copper to fibre in the network means our work involves less heavy manual labour, reducing the risk of musculo-skeletal disorders as a result. Conversely, people increasingly seek to attribute common health problems to past work activity with the aim of securing compensation, and the regulatory environment is getting harsher.

In parallel, a change in our workforce is increasing risks in areas such as driving. We’ve had a mature workforce with little labour turnover for many years. That cadre is reaching retirement age at the same time as demand for our products and services is increasing, and so we’re recruiting large numbers of younger people. The new intake has a different risk attitude, combined with less experience, so we need to make sure we put in additional safeguards with less reliance on expertise and individual judgement.

The pace of upgrading the network, fixed and mobile, has continued to accelerate. That increases our civil engineering workload and the hazards and risks associated with that type of work. The Grenfell Tower fire has raised awareness of fire

issues – we’ve reviewed cladding across the BT estate and we’re examining a range of other aspects of fire safety.

The pace and scale of change within the business has also continued to accelerate and we’re aware this has a psychological impact on our people. The risk of epidemic disease is constant; this year our main focus has been on pneumonic plague and influenza.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We’ve got a companywide and Board-endorsed health, safety and wellbeing strategy which has been refreshed this year. The Board receives a bi-annual report which tracks key performance indicators and which forms the basis of a discussion of emerging issues. The strategy is cascaded through the chief executive to the operational businesses, each of which formulates its own plans and targets on an annual basis.

At an operational level, our managers take responsibility for making sure their teams know how to comply with health and safety standards. We monitor compliance using annual licensing, scheduled refresher training, competency assessments and accreditation processes for higher-risk groups. All our people undertake training in basic health and safety. Progress is monitored by a companywide health, safety and wellbeing forum chaired by the Group HR Director. Professional input is provided through a central centre of expertise which supplements advisers in the operational units.

This year we’ve completed a liability review and a material controls audit, both of which highlighted competency, accreditation and assurance as areas for attention. We’re undertaking a comprehensive revision of our health and safety training, with an emphasis on higher-risk activities. We make sure that training is externally accredited where possible and we’re extending the accreditation of our management systems where appropriate. We’ve adopted a three lines of defence approach and we’re enhancing our first and second lines of assurance as a result of audit recommendations. We’re procuring a new IT system which will help us better capture and share information.

We provide comprehensive support to our people to enhance their wellbeing. We provide extensive guidance on promoting good physical, psychological and emotional health. We launched this year a major programme on healthy change management. We train our managers to identify the early signs of distress and how to deal with them. This year we’ve supplemented that with a peer support scheme that uses our peoples’ experience of mental ill health to help their colleagues. We provide funded treatment services for mental health and musculo-skeletal disorders and have achieved a 95% rehabilitation rate.

 

 

 
59    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our principal risks and uncertainties continued

Strategic and financial risks

    

 

 

 

Competition and technology risks

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

   Trend                               
   LOGO – Invest for growth    LOGO – Financial capital   

 

LOGO                             

  

LOGO – Intellectual capital

 

  

 

Our markets are characterised by intensifying competition from established players and new entrants. This competition compounds some of the external challenges that we see in the market place, notably:

 

fixed broadband and mobile connectivity nearing saturation, with most segments of the UK telecoms markets now growing below the rate of inflation

 

customers seeking fast migration from higher-margin legacy products to fully digitised, converged, secure, faultless solutions

 

efficient markets demanding clear differentiation for premium pricing, driving price deflation of basic connectivity and data

 

high exit barriers, prolonging and intensifying competition even when selected companies in the sector are struggling to generate economic returns.

Technology change is also a key characteristic of our sector. We need to be able to identify emerging technologies, assess how customers will adopt these technologies, and invest accordingly, frequently a long-time before the demand materialises. We also need to respond to changes in the use of existing technology, such as the exponential growth the sector has seen in data consumption and network capacity requirements.

Potential impact

Intensified competition can result in lower volumes and/or prices than we currently forecast. If we do not respond effectively to competition then we can lose market share, revenue and/or profit.

In addition, new technology developments can lead to accelerated obsolescence of our current products, increased investment requirements, new sources of competition and/or the deterioration of our competitive position. This in turn can result in lower volumes and prices, stranded assets and higher costs. A failure to invest optimally in technology today can have implications for our market position and ability to generate future returns.

What’s changed over the last year?

Set against a challenging economic climate, in which the outlook for the UK economy has deteriorated, our leading competitors have been very active over the last 12 months. Important developments included:

 

a move into fibre through a partnership with an existing provider

 

expansion of existing UK fibre networks

 

the launch of ‘zero-rated’ mobile data propositions.

Technological developments and changing customer preferences also continue to create risk to our business model. For example:

 

While mobile data usage continues to grow, prices per gigabyte of network traffic have continued to fall. The ongoing profitability of our mobile operations hinges on our being able to successfully monetise mobile data growth in the face of strong competition.

 

Support for a large-scale deployment of FTTP infrastructure among key stakeholders has increased. However, there is still material uncertainty as to whether a viable economic case can be found for large-scale deployment. The economic case for FTTP remains challenging given superfast broadband coverage now exceeds 90% and the majority of end users are currently only willing to pay a low premium for additional speeds.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We’ve evolved our strategy to reflect this environment, with renewed focus on:

 

delivering differentiated customer experiences

 

investing in integrated network leadership

 

transforming our operating model.

We believe this is the best way for us to stay ahead of our competitors and to generate long-term, sustainable value growth. We’re also working with stakeholders to help develop an environment that both encourages and facilitates investment in a large-scale FTTP environment.

We also keep a close eye on technology developments that could impact us achieving our strategic goals, including through our Board Technology Committee. This committee, chaired by the CEO, agrees our technology strategies, monitors emerging trends and oversees technology risk management across the group.

 

 

 
60    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

Communications industry regulation

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

  

Trend                               

 

   LOGO  – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO – Financial capital   

LOGO                             

   LOGO  – Transform our costs

  

LOGO – Manufactured capital

 

  

 

Regulation affects much of what we do.

In the UK, where Ofcom identifies competition concerns in communications markets, it can set rules requiring us to provide certain services on specified terms to our customers. Ofcom reviews markets regularly and can introduce, extend, relax or remove rules as a result of its findings. It has powers to conduct specific investigations about market behaviour, including price levels. In addition, Ofcom can set out rules for spectrum auctions and to ensure consumer protection in the sector.

Ofcom will investigate our compliance with regulatory requirements and can impose fines and restitution on us if we fail to comply.

Following the Government’s rejection of our voluntary commitment, a broadband universal service will now be delivered through a regulatory obligation. We acknowledge the impact that this will have on industry and the risks attached to a regulatory broadband USO. We will work hard with Ofcom to find a solution that works for our customers and society, and that minimises the distortions for industry.

Ofcom also has powers to regulate the terms on which we’re supplied with certain services by others – for instance, mobile call termination – and can sort out disputes between us and other communications providers about the terms on which services are supplied. Appeals of regulatory decisions also give rise to risks (and opportunities).

Outside the UK, regulation defines where and how we are able to compete through licensing rules and defining the terms on which we are able to access networks of incumbent operators.

Potential impact

Some of our revenue comes from supplying wholesale services to markets where Ofcom has found us to have significant market power. Most of this revenue relates to services where regulation requires us to cut average prices each year by a specific, real-term percentage for a three-year period.

Where other telecoms providers ask Ofcom to resolve disputes with us, there is a risk that Ofcom may set the prices at which we supply services, make us provide additional services and/or impact how we structure our business. In some circumstances, Ofcom can adjust past prices and make us pay back amounts to wholesale customers.

Regulation outside the UK can hit our revenue too. For example, overly-restrictive licensing requirements or ineffective regulation of access to other networks mean we might not be able to compete fairly. Regulation can also define and control the terms of access to necessary regulated inputs, which raises our costs.

What’s changed over the last year?

Ofcom has concluded market reviews in relation to wholesale narrowband access, wholesale local access and wholesale

broadband access. They have also decided not to impose a temporary remedy requiring BT to provide a restricted form of dark fibre (at and below 1Gbit/s) in the leased lines markets, but will consider this again in their upcoming business connectivity market review. We have summarised this on page 52.

We successfully appealed Ofcom’s Business Connectivity Market Review (BCMR) statement to the Competition Appeal Tribunal which found in our favour and remitted the decision back to Ofcom. It has also started its next market review on BCMR.

In the retail market, Ofcom also expressed concerns in relation to the prices charged to voice-only customers. We’ve responded to Ofcom’s concerns by agreeing to cut those prices. We’ve also introduced an automatic compensation scheme for slow repairs, missed appointments and delayed installations. Ofcom has also revised the General Conditions and the changes will come into force in October 2018.

Alongside the standard cycle of market reviews, we’ve been working hard to deliver on the Commitments made to Ofcom in March 2017 as part of its Digital Communications Review. We’ve made significant progress in this area, and have now introduced changes to our internal processes to ensure that we comply with both the letter and spirit of the commitments.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We have a strong team of regulatory and policy specialists. Together with legal experts, compliance and operational teams they guard against potential risks and look for opportunities to positively shape the regulatory regime at the right time and in the right way. They engage regularly with regulators, government, consumer organisations and other key stakeholders to build trust and to understand their outlook. They communicate our positions in a clear, consistent and straightforward way. Their insight also helps us to forecast future regulatory outcomes. We can then build sensible assumptions into our financial plans and investment decisions.

We push for clear, predictable and proportionate regulation that enables BT to succeed by delivering what customers and society want. Whenever there are market reviews, charge controls, disputes or investigations, we submit evidence and analysis. This helps us manage the risks around decisions in any particular year.

We can judicially review regulatory decisions and appeal to the Competition Appeal Tribunal. We can also raise disputes or complain (under the relevant regulatory framework or competition law) where we have problems getting access to wholesale services or to other access networks.

We’re also working hard to deliver a great customer experience, going beyond our minimum regulatory obligations.

 

 

 
61    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our principal risks and uncertainties continued

Strategic and financial risks continued

    

 

 

Political risk

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

  

Trend                               

 

   LOGO – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO – Financial capital   

LOGO                                 

   LOGO – Invest for growth

   LOGO – Human capital   
  

LOGO – Social capital

 

  

 

Across our operations we are exposed to the effects of political and geopolitical risks, in particular:

 

In the UK, internet access is increasingly seen as an essential part of people’s lives. As a result, political debate continues to focus on network coverage, quality and speed of service, as well as broader issues of online safety and security. As well as providing a critical element of the UK’s national infrastructure, both fixed and wireless, we’re also engaged in supporting high-profile programmes such as BDUK and the Emergency Services Network.

 

The result of the UK referendum to leave the European Union (‘Brexit’) significantly increased political uncertainty. This continues to impact political debates around the United Kingdom, such as the possibility of a second Scottish Independence referendum and the complex situation in Northern Ireland including border matters.

 

Outside the UK, political and geopolitical risk can impact our business through changes in the regulatory and competitive landscape – an example is the US Administration’s changed approach to trade policy - but also as a direct threat to our people and assets as a result of social unrest or a breakdown in the rule of law.

Potential impact

Political uncertainty can have direct financial consequences across the economy, impacting for example foreign exchange rates, the availability and cost of capital, interest rates and also resulting in changes in the tax regime. For BT specifically, the most significant impact of political risk is its potential interaction with some of our other Principal Risks. In the UK, we’re seeing an increasing overlap between political debate and the regulatory environment, with the potential that our Communications Industry Regulation risk increases as a result.

The impacts of Brexit are still uncertain while the UK’s future trading and transition relationship with the EU is determined, albeit the agreement in principle on a number of withdrawal measures was welcome, notably the commitment to protect the rights of EU citizens living in the UK and vice versa. There is the potential for our costs to increase, for example through any changes required to our systems to reflect new taxes or customs duties or other processes. Our regulatory risk could increase if there were to be future divergence with the EU regime. Our suppliers may face disruption as a result of challenges in their own organisations and supply chains. Also, delivering a great customer experience and great network will become more challenging if it is harder for us to recruit and retain skilled talent and to source sufficient construction workforce. The UK economy may also suffer as a result of this uncertainty.

Geopolitical risk outside the UK can most clearly impact our Communications Industry Regulation risk, but also our Security and Resilience risks where it poses a threat to the continuity of our operations.

What’s changed over the last year?

This has been a complex year, given the 2017 General Election, EU Withdrawal Bill, Brexit negotiations and other policy measures. A second Scottish Independence Referendum became less imminent as the SNP has a significantly reduced number of Scottish seats (albeit a majority still). In December 2017, the Government reached agreement in principle with the EU on divorce measures around people, money and Irish border principles; negotiations early in 2018 focused on finalising withdrawal issues and also moved on to transition and trading arrangements. What trading relationship the UK/EU will end up with and by when is unclear.

In the UK, the conclusion of Ofcom’s Digital Communications Review (DCR) has resolved some of the uncertainties that affected BT 12 months ago. The agreement we reached with Ofcom at the conclusion of the review has led to the creation of a new, independent board for Openreach, which is working well. Openreach is doing its own independent work to plan its fibre rollout, in open consultation with the rest of the industry. The Government has now established a Future Telecoms Infrastructure Review, which we hope can provide additional certainty for companies and investors about how the policy and regulatory framework can promote long-term decision-making and, as a consequence, underpin future 5G and fibre deployment.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We maintain strong engagement with the UK Government, key departments, MPs, peers, the media and with business and consumer bodies. We also engage closely with governments and politicians in Brussels and in our key markets around the world. We seek to inform public debate around telecommunications through fact-based evidence concerning the market and our role within it.

As explained in the case study on page 63, we’ve progressed the programme across the business to help us understand and manage the risks associated with Brexit. This also considered other potential impacts such as those associated with a second Scottish Independence referendum, and the border questions on the island of Ireland, and is led by a steering group chaired by the group CFO. We’ve also offered our views to Government, Parliament and business groups on related policy areas, such as R&D, data flows, trade and people/skills matters.

Outside the UK, our Public Affairs and regulatory teams work to help support governments and regulators in ensuring that markets work in an open and fairly regulated way for the benefit of customers and competition. Geopolitical risks are closely monitored, with our security and business continuity teams particularly focused on protecting our people and our assets.

 

 

 
62    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 
63    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our principal risks and uncertainties continued

Strategic and financial risks continued

    

 

 

Pensions

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

   Trend                                
   LOGO – Transform our costs    LOGO – Financial capital   

 

LOGO                             

   LOGO – Human capital   
  

LOGO – Social capital

 

  

 

We have a large funding obligation to our defined benefit (DB) pension schemes. The largest of these, the BT Pension Scheme (BTPS or Scheme), represents over 97% of our pension obligations. The BTPS faces similar risks to other UK DB schemes: things like future low investment returns, high inflation, longer life expectancy and regulatory changes may all mean the BTPS becomes more of a financial burden.

Potential impact

The next valuation of the BTPS is scheduled to take place as at 30 June 2020 and an increase in the pension deficit may have an impact on the level of deficit payments we are required to make into the Scheme. Indirectly it may also have an adverse impact on our share price and credit rating.

Any deterioration in our credit rating would increase our cost of borrowing and may limit the availability or flexibility of future funding for the group, thereby affecting our ability to invest, pay dividends or repay debt as it matures.

What’s changed over the last year?

The actuarial valuation of the Scheme as at 30 June 2017 was announced in May 2018. This provides certainty over the level of cash contributions required until the next triennial valuation is concluded, taking place no later than as at 30 June 2020.

As part of the actuarial valuation, we discussed the Scheme’s approach to investing assets with the Trustee. The resulting changes should help protect the BTPS from volatile investment returns and high inflation by investing in a way which provides greater certainty over the Scheme’s ability to meet benefit payments over the longer term.

When a valuation is calculated, the funding position is affected by the financial market conditions at the valuation date. When determining expected future returns on the Scheme assets,

 

different factors are taken into account, including yields (or returns) on government bonds. If assets returns are lower than expected over the period to the next valuation, or a lower future investment return assumption is adopted at the 30 June 2020 valuation, the deficit would likely increase, potentially leading to a higher level of future deficit payments.

In March 2018, we announced the closure of Sections B and C of the BTPS to future benefit accrual (which represents more than 99% of the BTPS active membership), having reached agreement with the relevant Unions. Although we will establish a new hybrid pension arrangement for non-management employees in the BTPS at closure, the changes reduce the financial risks associated with providing future defined benefit pension accrual. We currently expect to close Sections B and C of the BTPS from 30 June 2018 when employees will join the BT Retirement Savings Scheme, our main defined contribution arrangement, for future pension accrual.

How we’re mitigating the risks

The investment performance and liability experience are regularly reviewed by both us and the Trustee of the BTPS. We also consider the associated risks and possible mitigations. The investment strategy aims to partly mitigate the impact of increases in the liabilities, for example by investing in assets that will increase in value if future inflation expectations rise. The assets held are also well diversified, softening the impact of sharp drops in the value of individual asset classes. This helps maintain a reasonable balance of risk and return.

Our financial strength and cash generation provide a level of protection against the impact of changes in the funding position of the BTPS. The funding liabilities also include a buffer against future negative experience, as legislation requires that we calculate liabilities on a prudent basis.

 

 

 
64    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financial risk

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

   Trend                                  

   LOGO – Transform our costs

   LOGO – Invest for growth

  

LOGO – Financial capital

LOGO – Social capital

 

  

 

LOGO                                   

 

     

 

In common with other major international businesses, we’re exposed to a variety of financial risks. These include treasury risks, which arise principally from market risk (including interest rate risk and foreign exchange risk), credit risk, and liquidity risk. They also include tax risk, principally that we need to understand fully the current and future tax consequences of business decisions to comply with tax rules and avoid financial and reputational damage.

Potential impact

If there is an adverse movement in foreign exchange and interest rates there could be a negative impact on the group’s profitability, cash flow, and balance sheet. Sensitivity in the income statement and shareholders’ equity arising from interest rate and foreign exchange volatility is shown in note 27 to the consolidated financial statements.

The failure of Treasury counterparties to honour financial obligations could have an adverse impact on the group’s liquidity (for example from the loss of cash deposits) and profitability (for example from increased finance expenses). A deterioration in liquidity could have an adverse impact on the Board’s assessment of going concern, particularly if combined with an inability to refinance maturing debt.

If we fail to comply with tax rules then we could face financial penalties and reputational damage. Beyond compliance, if we don’t adequately reflect the current and future tax consequences in our business decisions, we might make bad decisions resulting in financial loss and potentially financial misstatements, as well as reputational damage.

What’s changed over the last year?

We continue to face the same treasury risks as in financial year 2016/17.

From a taxation perspective, our business continues to evolve rapidly, creating different tax consequences, for example the bringing together of EE and the BT Consumer customer-facing units, the Openreach industry consultation on large-scale FTTP, and a review of our pension provision. During the year, new UK legislation was introduced, which restricts deductions for interest expense and which reduced the ability to offset profits with prior year losses. Accounting changes can also have tax consequences, for example, forthcoming changes to accounting for revenue from contracts with customers and accounting for leases. Global tax rules also continue to evolve, for example the OECD’s Base Erosion and Profit Shifting project, US tax reform, the European Commission’s challenge to tax practices under state aid provisions, and EC and UK proposals for the introduction of an interim digital services tax. All these change the current and future tax consequences of business decisions.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We have a centralised treasury function whose primary role is to manage liquidity and funding requirements as well as our exposure to associated financial and market risks, including credit risk, interest rate risk and foreign exchange risk, in line with Board-approved policies. These risk management policies are described in detail in note 27 to the consolidated financial statements. The Board reviews liquidity and funding requirements of the group on an ongoing basis.

A strong governance framework is also at the heart of our mitigation approach to tax risk. We’ve a framework for managing taxes that is set centrally and agreed by the Board. We employ suitably qualified professionals to manage and assure the operation of this framework. We seek to pay tax in accordance with the laws of the countries where we do business. However, in some areas these laws are unclear, and it can take many years to agree an outcome with a tax authority or through litigation. Nevertheless, we always seek open and constructive working relationships with tax authorities worldwide, engaging reputable independent advice where required.

 

 

 
65    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our principal risks and uncertainties continued

Operational risks

    

 

 

 

Security and resilience

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

   Trend                               
   LOGO – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO – Financial capital   

 

LOGO                             

   LOGO – Intellectual capital   
  

LOGO – Manufactured capital

 

  

 

Our commercial success is firmly rooted in our reputation for the security and resilience of our services. So we strive to maintain the highest standards of protection and incident management in order to confront the natural perils, network and system faults, and malicious acts that threaten our operations.

By monitoring cyber attacks on our networks and systems and our peers and customers, we see that hacking tools, phishing scams and disruptive malware are becoming more sophisticated and yet more accessible to attackers. In response, we continue to develop our cyber defence capability and invest more in automatic detection and prevention systems. We recognise that services can also be interrupted by events such as supply chain failure, software changes, equipment faults, fire, flood, infrastructure outages and sabotage.

Potential impact

The consequences of security and resilience risks can include major financial loss, long-term damage to reputation and loss of market share. Regulatory sanctions, fines and contract penalties might be applied, contracts might be terminated, and costly concessions might be needed, together with unplanned and rapid improvements to retain business and rebuild trust. We might also miss opportunities to grow revenue and launch new services ahead of the competition.

What’s changed over the last year?

Cyber attackers are learning how to defeat conventional defences such as Anti-Virus (AV), proxy servers, and basic authentication. They are changing malware signatures faster than AV vendors can deliver matching identity files, launching Denial of Service (DoS) attacks that are disguised as legitimate traffic at the application level, and using increasingly convincing phishing emails to trick users into giving access to restricted systems. The growth in ransomware attacks has made headline news and caused significant disruption to some of our corporate customers, but we have so far managed to avoid such consequences. Our incident management teams are gaining experience from these events and applying lessons learned to improve our responses. We’re also helping customers by sharing this expertise.

We’ve increased the use of Artificial Intelligence (AI) in our cybersecurity operations to process the vast amount of data available. We use our own Saturn system to visually filter the information and help our analysts perform investigations. We’re trialling further AI innovations that will detect network anomalies in large volumes of data, and learn patterns of how malware propagates.

Looking at other drivers of service interruption, 2017/18 has been relatively benign for the UK in terms of extreme weather events. However, accepting that the risk is increasing, we’ve continued to enhance our overall flood/storm preparedness. We’ve also been working with the Government and other utilities in planning for a ‘Black Start’ (major shutdown of the national power transmission system) scenario.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We’re making risk improvements involving people, processes and technology - prioritising the work according to our assessments of security and resilience exposure. The proportion of our network and systems that is monitored and logged continuously is rising steadily, and the security awareness of our employees is being enhanced by advanced training modules and mock phishing exercises.

Segmentation of our IT estate at the data centre level is now complete, and we’re turning our attention to micro-segmentation at the applications level as we provision new cloud-based systems. The results of ‘Red Team’ exercises by our ethical hackers are driving improvements across BT, particularly where access controls are found to need upgrading. We’ve also been tightening our control of sensitive personal data in preparation for the EU GDPR. This has prompted significant improvements in our IT inventory, which in turn makes it easier to manage major cyber incidents.

Mobile, geographically dispersed, emergency response capabilities are now operating at full designed capability. We’ve built on our site-specific flood defence plans, and completed specialist flood surveys of our most critical at risk assets, with a view during 2018/19 to deploying permanent flood defences as appropriate.

Members of our Emergency Response Team were deployed to the Caribbean to utilise their skills in providing emergency communications in response to hurricanes Irma and Maria. They were also able to use our improved approach to supporting community isolation situations in assisting the emergency services following the Grenfell Tower tragedy.

 

 

 
66    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

 

Employee engagement

   Link to strategy in year

   Link to business model    Trend                              
   LOGO  – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO  – Human capital   

 

LOGO                             

     
     

 

Our people are central to everything we do and a vital part of our ambition to deliver a great customer experience and sustainable, profitable revenue growth. Our people strategy supports this ambition by creating an inclusive and enjoyable workplace so that our people can thrive as part of a dynamic business. Great employee engagement is necessary to ensure we meet our strategic aims.

Potential impact

We need to transform our business while also continuing to recruit, retain and engage our workforce to deliver a great customer experience and grow the business. An adverse reaction to change could impact talent retention resulting in a loss of critical skills and greater need for external recruitment, which would add cost to the business. Poor engagement also raises the risk of general industrial unrest and action.

What’s changed over the last year?

We limited pensionable pay increases for some members of the BT pension scheme and subsequently initiated a review of our UK pension arrangements. Following the review, we decided to close the BTPS to ensure that our pension arrangements are fair, flexible and affordable for both employees and BT, which included enhancements to our defined contribution pension scheme.

 

We continue to work through the people implications of making Openreach a separate legal entity in response to the outcome of the Digital Communications Review. We also announced the creation of a new Consumer team that brings together the BT Consumer and EE businesses.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We’ve undertaken extensive consultation with unions, works councils and employee representatives as part of a comprehensive global engagement strategy designed to engender positive employee relations. We help employees understand the reasons for change and the impact it may have on them, while also working to protect service to customers.

The review of pension arrangements includes a proposal to enhance our defined contribution pension scheme to help provide an adequate income in retirement for all of our employees. We’ve continued to streamline our management structure to move decision making closer to the frontline customer teams and speed up the decision-making process to deliver better customer outcomes. We’ve also simplified our performance appraisal process, reducing the frequency of assessment and the number of performance categories to free up time for line managers to talk with their people and focus on developing their capabilities.

 

 

Change management

   Link to strategy in year

  

Link to business model

 

  

Trend                               

 

   LOGO  – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO  – Human capital   

LOGO                             

 

   LOGO  – Transform our costs

     

   LOGO  – Invest for growth

 

     

 

We are implementing a wide-ranging change programme across the entire organisation known as One BT. We need to continue to deliver differentiated customer experiences, whilst being able to have the financial capacity to invest in integrated network leadership. At the same time, we want BT to be a simple and agile business where our people can thrive.    

In transforming our operating model, we need to manage this change carefully to ensure it delivers the desired outcomes. We recognise that such extensive change can also be a distraction and can cause uncertainty amongst our colleagues, so it’s important that we keep focused on delivering for our customers.

Potential impact

If we do not manage our change programmes carefully then they will not deliver the business outcomes that we are trying to achieve. That could result in poorer customer experiences, negative impacts on employee engagement, or potential overspend on the projects themselves, and at the end of the programmes we may not have achieved the efficient processes needed to deliver a great customer experience, the desired cost savings, or differentiated products and services we were trying to launch.

As we describe elsewhere in the Annual Report, we’ve been working hard on improving our customers’ experiences, and have

seen significant improvements over the last year. If our transformation programmes do not deliver their intended customer benefits, or divert colleagues’ attention away from serving our customers, then we may suffer a reduction in the quality of the service we provide, and as a result incur customer churn and even financial penalties in some cases.

What’s changed over the last year?

Over the past year, our key changes have included:

 

the launch of a pan-BT transformation programme, One BT, which is designed to help our businesses deliver to their full potential

 

bringing together BT Consumer, EE and Plusnet into a new Consumer business

 

ongoing work to deliver a new Digital Global Services

 

announcing the integration of our Wholesale and Ventures and Business and Public Sector businesses into a new Enterprise business

 

announcing our plans to introduce a new People Framework, which will include a particular focus on our middle and senior- management grades

 

as we describe elsewhere in the Annual Report, we’ve also been making changes to our Openreach business to implement Ofcom’s Digital Communications Review.
 

 

 
67    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our principal risks and uncertainties continued

Operational risks continued

    

 

How we’re mitigating the risks

We apply a formal structure and governance to our key change programmes – for example, One BT has a full-time Programme Office and a Transformation Committee. Change programmes are also supported by our Customer and Enterprise Transformation team. By bringing together several transformation teams into one, we are able to ensure that our internal change programmes are coordinated and remain focused on delivering for our customers. The Customer and Enterprise Transformation team tracks programme delivery against targets for the Transformation Committee, Executive Committee and Board. The Transformation Committee meets weekly to make key decisions and to set the pace of change.

We recognise the importance of having the skills, capabilities, methods and tools to define and deliver change in the right way. So we’ve developed a new change approach, and have put in

place an expert team that is building capability and providing direct support to HR, communications, change teams and our leaders in the business.

We’ve also maintained a close focus on our people and our culture, launching a number of specific and focused leadership capability development programmes to help our leaders manage their people through a period of extensive change whilst also delivering the best possible customer experiences.

Organisational change can cause uncertainty amongst colleagues, and we communicate closely with our unions and works councils in designing, announcing and implementing changes. Our engagement strategy allows us to monitor employee engagement on a regular basis, informing any interventions that we feel necessary.

 

 

Supply chain

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

  

Trend                             

 

   LOGO  – Deliver great customer experience    LOGO  – Financial capital   

LOGO                             

   LOGO  – Transform our costs

   LOGO  – Social capital   
   LOGO  – Human capital   
  

LOGO  – Natural capital

 

  

 

We operate in a global supply market. Our supply chains range from simple to very complex. It’s critical to our operations that we can guarantee their integrity and continuity.

Global markets expose us to global risks, including different standards in labour, environmental and climate change practices, increasing regulation and geopolitical events. We weigh up the impact and likelihood of external market forces on our suppliers’ ability to support us.

Globalisation means better sourcing opportunities, but brings challenges if suppliers become more geographically and culturally remote from our customers – or if governments put barriers in the way of doing business to protect national or regional economic interests.

Our dealings with suppliers follow our trading and ethical policies. From the way we choose them, to the contracts we sign and how we pay them. For more detail, see page 49.

Potential impact

If something goes wrong in our supply chain, the speed and scale of impact can vary. We need to determine the potential damage to customer experience, the likelihood of higher costs and the potential damage to our brand. If substituting a failing supplier meant that we had to disrupt our business, it could cost us a lot of time and money. If we couldn’t find an alternative supplier, it might compromise the commitments we make to our customers, which could in turn lead to breach of contract, lost revenue or penalties.

If any link in our supply chain falls foul of the law, or fails to meet our ethical expectations, that could damage our reputation – possibly leading to legal action and lost revenue.

If we don’t meet the expectations of regulators that govern us and the data we manage, it could result in significant penalties. In the case of EU General Data Protection Regulation 2018, this could amount to 4% of our global annual turnover.

 

What’s changed over the last year?

We dedicate time to assessing emerging geopolitical threats and the impact they could have on our supply chain. These include the impacts of the UK leaving the EU in March 2019; the threat of modern slavery and human trafficking; and the growing threat of cyber attacks on our systems and networks.

We continue to monitor the trend for mergers and acquisitions in some of the global markets we do business in. It highlights the risk of us becoming too dependent on single or monopolistic suppliers. We also try to make sure that suppliers do not become too dependent on us. Both scenarios are unhealthy for our business.

This year one of our more significant suppliers, Carillion, went into liquidation. However, by implementing our risk and governance arrangements we were able to manage and reduce the disruption to our business.

How we’re mitigating the risks

We have a few really critical suppliers. We keep a close watch on our relationships, their performance and their ability to meet their obligations. We tell the business when to prepare for the risk of a supplier failing, and our senior leaders continually review how ready we are for such events.

We make sure we exercise the right amount of due diligence when it comes to introducing new suppliers and continuing to do business with existing ones. That includes checks on company finances, business systems, accreditations, media reputation and ethical practices. The standards we apply to our suppliers are available on selling2bt.bt.com

We manage our top suppliers according to the contracts they’ve signed. We work with them to find better ways of working, reducing our exposure to risks around poor supplier practices in the process.

We’re also continually looking to improve our response to disruptive events.

 

 

 
68    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

Major contracts

   Link to strategy in year

 

  

Link to business model

 

   `Trend                                 

   LOGO  – Deliver great customer experience

   LOGO  – Transform our costs

   LOGO  – Invest for growth

   LOGO  – Financial capital   

 

LOGO                                 

     
     
     

 

We have a number of complex and high-value national and multinational customer contracts. The revenue and profitability of these contracts are affected by things like: variation in cost; achieving cost savings anticipated in contract pricing (both in terms of scale and time); delays in achieving agreed milestones owing to factors either in or out of our control; changes in customers’ needs, their budgets, strategies or businesses; and our suppliers’ performance. Any of these factors could make a contract less profitable or even loss-making.

The degree of risk varies with the scope and life of the contract and is typically higher in the early stages. Some customer contracts need investment in the early stages, which we then expect to recover over the life of the contract.

Major contracts often involve implementing new systems and communications networks, transforming legacy networks, managing customer networks and developing new technologies. Delays or missed milestones might have an impact on us recovering these upfront costs. There’s a substantial performance risk throughout the term of some of these highly-complex contracts.

Potential impact

If we don’t manage to meet our commitments under these contracts – or if customers’ needs, budgets, strategies or businesses change – then our expected future revenue, profitability and cash generation may go down. Unexpectedly high costs associated with fulfilling particular transformational contracts could also hit profitability. Earnings may drop. Contracts may even become loss-making through loss of revenue, changes to customers’ businesses (due to, for example, mergers or acquisitions), business failure or contract termination.

One of our highest profile contracts is providing a key element of the UK Emergency Services Network (ESN) on our EE mobile network. The complexities described above all apply to this programme. This service is delivered with several partners and managed by the Home Office. The Home Office has delayed the launch date and further delays will impact the expected income. Furthermore, the criticality of this service increases our risk exposure once it’s live, and given the network provides emergency services communications for the UK, performance in life of the network could have reputational consequences for BT.

We’re continuing to deliver contracts with local authorities through regional fibre deployment programmes, including the Broadband Delivery UK programme (BDUK). As with our other major contracts, if we fail to deliver these contracts successfully it might lead to reduced future revenue, profitability and cash generation. As well as carrying a higher reputational risk, these contracts present specific risks around deployment, delivery and our ability to recover public funding. We also have an obligation to potentially either reinvest or repay grant funding depending on lots of different factors – including how many customers take up a new service.

 

What’s changed over the last year?

We have extended our ‘Gold Standard’ quality programme to our Contract Accounting and financial management activities. Our major contracts are assessed against strict ‘gold standard’ criteria and those contract teams below the benchmark will be developed/ coached for improvement in order to attain the standard.

Tough market conditions continue and the impact of the UK voting to leave the EU has meant some customer programmes have been delayed, which has had an impact on the business. Customers are asking for more flexibility in their contracts.

The majority of our first phase of BDUK contracts have now completed their deployment commitments. We’re now nearing the contractual end dates of the second phase of contracts (SEP). In addition, we have further extended numerous existing contracts and begun deployment of the third phase of contracts. While these later phase contracts are smaller in scale and coverage, the deployment challenges are significantly greater in terms of the geography encountered as we reach further into the final 5% of households.

While our broadband contracts and ESN carry a different risk profile to other major corporate contracts, we apply our governance and reporting processes to make sure we identify risks and mitigation activities and report them to management.

How we’re mitigating the risks

At both group and corporate unit level we have governance, risk management and reporting processes in place. Independent audits and the checks and balances in individual contracts provide assurance through an independent review programme. To track progress, we monitor how we’re doing on these risks and mitigation actions, and report the result to senior management. A separate, dedicated team provides assurance for our BDUK and ESN projects.

The BT Academy supports skills development and learning initiatives. These help our Contract Management Profession to better identify and manage risk. We also update new training collateral whenever we learn something new. In 2017/18 we introduced a Gold Standard sustainability measure to ensure our contracts continue to operate at the highest possible standard.

We continue to invest in risk training, and assess the management of our contracts against a best practice framework we’ve developed based on our knowledge of running and managing major programmes. We’re also investing and growing our contract management expertise through the provision of accredited contract management training.

 

 

 
69    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our principal risks and uncertainties continued

    

    

 

 

LOGO

 

 
70    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

Our viability statement

 

 

Assessment of prospects

An understanding of the group’s strategy and business model is central to assessing its prospects, and details can be found on pages 20 to 34.

Our business model provides resilience that is relevant to any consideration of our prospects and viability. In the UK, we benefit from diversification across a number of markets and products, which increased through the launch of BT Sport and the acquisition of EE. We also have a broad spread of customers and suppliers across different geographic areas and market sectors, serving the needs of customers in 180 countries worldwide.

Our strategy of delivering differentiated customer experiences, investing in integrated network leadership and transforming our operating model is designed to support long-term and sustainable cash flow growth.

We assess our prospects on a regular basis through our financial planning process. Our Medium Term Plan forecasts the group’s profitability, cash flows and funding requirements, and is reviewed by the Board during the year. The Medium Term Plan is built from the bottom-up forecasts of each of our customer-facing units, supplemented by items managed at a group level and assumptions such as macro-economic activity and exchange rates. The performance of the group and our customer-facing units against these forecasts is monitored monthly and this is supplemented each quarter through a series of Quarterly Business Reviews performed by the Executive Committee.

Beyond our Medium Term Planning horizon, the group also makes investments that have business cases covering a longer time period, such as our network investments. Significant capital expenditure investment cases are reviewed by the BT Investment Board and, where appropriate, the Executive Committee and the Board, after taking into account longer-term risks and opportunities such as the economy, technology and regulation.

Finally, our business and financial planning also takes into account our longer-term obligations, including the funding of our defined benefit pension schemes.

Viability Statement

In accordance with provision C2.2 of the 2016 UK Corporate Governance Code, the Directors have assessed the prospects and viability of the group.

Although the Directors have no reason to believe that the group will not be viable over a longer period, the Board has chosen to conduct this review for a period of three years to 31 March 2021. The Board believes this is an appropriate timeframe as it aligns with the primary focus of our business planning and the underpinning time cycles of a number of our principal risks: for example the pension scheme funding valuation and Ofcom’s market review cycle.

In support of this statement we’ve stress tested our forecast cash flows by assessing, through a probabilistic analysis, the range of potential combined impacts our most significant risks could have on these forecasts. This assessment was informed by our judgements as to the potential financial impact of these risks if they materialise, together with their likelihood of occurrence.

Our stress testing confirmed that existing projected cash flows and cash management activities provide us with a buffer against the impact of our most likely risks. In the most extreme scenarios we tested, where all of our principal risks are assumed to materialise over the three-year period, we have considered the further actions we could take to mitigate the negative cash flow impact and ensure additional liquidity. These actions could include, for example, sale of assets, limiting or delaying discretionary capital expenditure and marketing activities, restricting share buyback programmes and reducing or ceasing dividend payments.

In our viability assessment we’ve adopted a number of assumptions designed to stress test our resilience. For example, in making our assessments of the impact and likelihood of our risks, we’ve only taken into account the control activities that we have in place today. We’ve not factored in any of the extensive future mitigation activity that we’re undertaking to address these risks, thereby assuming such activity proves ineffective. While we do not expect this to happen, we’ve adopted these pessimistic assumptions to add greater stress to our viability testing.

We’ve also assumed that, should the need arise, we would have both the ability to renew existing debt facilities which mature over the three-year period and be able to raise new debt.

Based on the results of this analysis, the Directors have a reasonable expectation that the group will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the three-year period of their assessment.

 

 

 
71    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

    

LOGO

 

 
72    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

BT Consumer and Plusnet (our value brand) connect customers to information, entertainment, friends and family, at home and on the move.

We buy access to fixed-line and broadband infrastructure from Openreach, and we use EE’s mobile network to provide mobile phone services.

BT Consumer and Plusnet both provide home phone, broadband, TV and mobile services. EE do too (page 82).

BT Consumer brands

 

LOGO

BT Consumer sells products and services from BT and Plusnet. Subscriber numbers and market share data for home phone, retail broadband and pay-TV are reported at group level and can be found later in this section. Figures for mobile (also reported at group level) are in the EE section on page 80.

We sell a wide range of devices – including phones, wi-fi extenders and baby monitors via high street retailers and our website.

Sustainability is important to us; we work closely with suppliers to make our products and business as sustainable as possible, from the first link in the supply chain through to our customers.

We also sell services to commercial premises like pubs and hotels, so they can get BT Sport or BT Wi-fi.

We employ around 9,000 full-time equivalent people. Roughly 6,500 of these directly help customers in our contact centres.

Markets and customers

Our broadband (copper and fibre) products are available to more than 99% of UK premises; our home phone and mobile services are available to all. Anyone with fast enough BT broadband can get BT TV.

Wholesale: Fixed network services

The UK consumer communications market is highly competitive. In December 2017, Ofcom found that UK prices for communications and TV services compared well to international benchmarks. In 2017 the UK ranked third overall among six comparator countries (France, Germany, Italy, Spain, UK and the US) and second for prices for triple-play bundles.

Within the UK market, our three consumer brands mean we’re well placed to compete with the likes of Sky, Virgin Media, Talk Talk and Vodafone.

BT retail market share

 

LOGO

 

a  Home phone includes BT Consumer and EE analogue and ISDN channels (WLR), including customers in Northern Ireland and Plusnet.
b  Retail broadband – BT Consumer (including Plusnet and Northern Ireland), EE, B&Ps, and broadband lines sold by Global Services.
c  TV refers to the total number of customers either with a BT TV, YouView or EE TV box registered and enabled to receive video on demand including YouView from Plusnet.

Home phone

According to Ofcom, the number of home phone lines in the UK was 26.7m in December 2017.

But people are increasingly using mobiles, voice over IP or instant messaging services instead of landlines. The number of minutes of home phone calls made in 2017 fell by 19% year on year to 35bn.

Broadband

There were 26m fixed broadband (home and SME) connections in December 2017, an increase of 2.1% from the previous year. Superfast speeds are available to 95% of the UK.

TV and content

There are roughly 18m pay-TV subscriptions in the UK. Subscription video on demand (SVoD) content providers like Netflix and Amazon Prime are becoming increasingly popular. They usually complement traditional pay-TV rather than replace it – Ofcom found that 74% of SVoD users had pay-TV too.

Mobile

We describe the UK mobile market, including BT’s overall position, in the EE section of this report which starts on page 80.

 

 

 
73    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

BT Consumer continued

    

 

 

Products and services

One size rarely fits all. That’s why we sell home phone, broadband, TV and mobile to our customers in a variety of packages.

Home phone

Our range of home phone products and calling plans lets our customers pick the right service for them. We offer unlimited calls, and add-ons like discounted international calls or calls to mobiles.

Here are a few examples of BT Consumer home phone services:

 

BT Basic – discounted line rental and inclusive calls to people on certain state benefits. We’re the only company to offer this service in the UK.

 

BT Call Protect – a free service for customers which diverts nuisance calls to a junk voicemail box. We’ve now diverted more than 90m nuisance calls.

 

Discounts for standalone voice customers – this year we agreed with Ofcom to cut the price of line rental for BT home-phone-only customers who don’t have broadband with BT or anyone else. From 1 April 2018 this line rental is £11.99 a month.

Plusnet and EE also offer a home phone service with a variety of different calling plans.

Broadband

We offer ADSL broadband, delivered over copper lines. Our BT Infinity superfast broadband uses fibre to deliver higher speeds and a more reliable service.

Two examples of our broadband services are BT Broadband Unlimited (speeds up to 17Mbps) and BT Unlimited Infinity 2 (speeds up to 76Mbps). In January 2018 we launched two new Ultrafast Fibre packages with speeds of up to 152Mbps and up to 314Mbps. Both come with a speed guarantee of 100Mbps, backed by £20 compensation.

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

To supercharge their home wi-fi, customers can buy Whole Home Wi-Fi. It uses an intelligent network of three wi-fi repeaters to extend connectivity to every corner of the home – automatically switching to the fastest, strongest and most reliable signal. We launched on the high street in December 2016 and by the second half of 2017/18, sales reached nearly 50% of the market by value, outperforming brands like Google and Netgear.

Our broadband packages also include:

 

BT Wi-fi – free, unlimited wi-fi access at around 5.9m UK hotspots

 

BT Cloud – secure online and on-the-go access to data and photos

 

BT Web Protect – security tools to help keep customers and their families safe online.

We offer special support to vulnerable customers and work with industry groups like Internet Matters to promote internet safety. Plusnet broadband is sold three ways with three different download speeds – unlimited with up to 17Mbps; fibre unlimited with up to 38Mbps; and unlimited fibre extra with up to 76Mbps.

EE broadband offers three similar products.

BT TV is available exclusively to our broadband customers. They can watch via a choice of three YouView set-top boxes (non-recording, recording and 4K UHD).

TV content includes programmes for the whole family from all the big Hollywood Studios; AMC (a BT UK exclusive), Sky, BT Sport and Netflix. We aim to offer a selection of the best pay content at attractive prices.

 

 

 
74    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

BT TV comes in three different packages

Starter + BT Sport

Up to 80 Freeview channels, BT Sport channels, AMC and BoxNation – plus BT Store for renting or buying movies and shows. Includes a non-recording set-top box and access to apps like BBC iPlayer, All 4, ITV Hub and My5.

Entertainment

Includes up to 99 channels, as well as a set-top box which can record up to 300 hours of programmes, pause and rewind live TV, and access seven days’ worth of catch-up TV. Includes BT TV app access.

Max

More than 140 channels, including 21 in HD. Also includes extra recording space on the set-top box, BT Kids TV and BT Sport in 4K Ultra HD.

This year we launched an award-winning TV user interface to make it even easier for customers to find their favourite programmes. There’s also a companion BT TV app so they can watch shows when they’re out and about.

Plusnet TV is available to Plusnet’s fibre customers. It includes over 70 Freeview channels, plus BT Sport and popular pay-TV channels.

EE TV provides more than 70 Freeview channels, as well as pay-TV channels and access to a number of apps.

BT Sport

The BT Sport channels are available on BT TV, the BT Sport App (to BT, Plusnet and EE customers), Sky and TalkTalk. Virgin Media TV customers can also access BT Sport. There’s a discount on BT Sport for current BT broadband customers, and an even bigger discount if they take BT TV too.

BT Sport 4K UHD was the UK’s first Ultra HD TV channel. It has four times the detail of HD and is available exclusively to BT TV Max customers with BT Infinity broadband.

BT Sport is the exclusive live broadcaster of the UEFA Champions League and UEFA Europa League in the UK. And it has the rights secured until the end of the 2020/21 season.

In January we won Premier League rights for a further three years until the end of 2021/22. We also broadcast FA Cup, FA Women’s Super League and Scottish Premiership games. As well as football, BT Sport covers sports like Aviva Premiership Rugby, MotoGP, WTA tennis, Cricket Australia, UFC and boxing. This year, we broadcast over 13,000 hours of live sport.

Innovation is intrinsic to our strategy at BT Sport. Our coverage of the 2017 UEFA Champions League final was the UK’s first-ever live 4K broadcast on YouTube.

We also achieved a world first by covering the live match using High Dynamic Range (HDR) technology in ultra-high definition with Dolby ‘Atmos’ sound.

And on YouTube and the BT Sport app we screened the match in 360-degree virtual reality (VR) for the first time. Within the app viewers could choose between a 360-degree produced programme or pick their own camera viewpoint.

LOGO

In January we added HD streams to the BT Sport app for all our sport customers too. Both the app and Ultra HD channel have won awards for innovation.

BT Mobile

BT Mobile is available SIM-only or with a service plan and choice of market-leading phones. Our broadband customers get a £5 a month discount on mobile service plans. There’s also BT Family SIM which lets customers buy two or more SIM cards at a discount.

We launched Wi-Fi Calling in March 2018 so customers can text or call over wi-fi when they can’t get a mobile signal (one of their biggest bugbears).

Plusnet offers SIM-only mobile plans at different prices. Plusnet broadband customers get ‘mates’ rates’ packages with extra mobile data.

Performance in the year – strategic

Customer experience is still our top priority

 

LOGO  

Delivering great customer experience

This year we’ve continued to make important investments in customer care. We are seeing progress.

Customer care is getting better. The Institute of Customer Service ranked BT within the top 15 most improved organisations this year.

This is because of the money we’re spending on improving our systems. They are now being used by 6,000 advisers and are improving the number of faults we fix and speeding up the time it takes to do it.

 

 

 
75    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

BT Consumer continued

    

 

 

Customers’ opinion that BT is easy to deal with was four points higher in Q4 2017/18 than it was a year earlier. Right First Time improved by 1.1%, driven by a 7% reduction in Propensity to Contact.

Simpler organisation

We’ve reorganised our teams around the different moments in customers’ relationships with us – ‘joining’, ‘early life’ and ‘in-life support’.

Thousands of agents now follow this new operating model. It’s widening and deepening their knowledge and letting them own and solve issues. For more complex stuff, we’ve introduced bespoke, dedicated support which is helping thousands of customers a week. This has been key to cutting Ofcom broadband complaints by 18%.

New diagnostics help detect and resolve faults

We’ve introduced pre-emptive broadband diagnostics. This now means we can often detect and fix faults automatically – before a customer finds there’s a problem and gets in touch.

Getting to customers quicker

Through extra investment in people and systems, we’ve cut the average wait to speak to us on the phone from 103 seconds in Q4 2016/17 to 41 seconds in Q4 2017/18.

Following our customers onto digital

The number of customers using online chat has grown. It now accounts for around a quarter of interactions.

 

LOGO     

Investing for growth                 

This year we kept our focus on sustainable long-term growth, making several investments for the future. The table below summarises our progress on the priorities we set out last year.

Review of last year’s priorities

 

   What we said   What we did

 

  Keeping the household connected

 

Move current customers from copper to fibre broadband and grow our base through acquiring new customers.

 

 

61% of our broadband customer base is now on fibre compared with 53% last year.

 

Our fibre customer base has grown by nearly 800,000 to 5.7m.

Launch ultrafast broadband.

 

We launched two new Ultrafast Fibre packages with speeds of up to 152Mbps and 314Mbps.

 

Keep promoting BT Mobile to give existing customers more for their money.

 

 

We’ve significantly grown our mobile base.

 

We launched wi-fi calling in March 2018.

   What we said   What we did

 

  Enhance sport and content

 

Provide exclusive sport giving potential customers a brilliant reason to choose BT.

  We added UK and Irish international hockey and broadcast our first live boxing match with two World Championship fights.
    We broadcast the UEFA Champions
League Final in 4K UHD and with 360
degree VR experience.
    

On the BT Sport app we introduced
free HD streams for all our customers.

 

Improve our customers’ TV viewing experience.

  We launched three new TV channels and expanded our boxset range with exclusive AMC productions.
    We launched a BT TV App for
customers to watch their favourite
shows on the go and record
programmes remotely.
    

We announced a deal to offer all of Sky
Sports, Sky Cinema and Sky’s most
popular entertainment channels
through Now TV from 2019.

 

  Transform customer experience

 

   

Finish deploying our new frontline systems and operating structure to simplify the way we work.

 

We rolled out new systems and a simpler way of working to our contact centre advisers.

 

We created a dedicated case management function for complex problems.

 

Make further investments to cut the time it takes to get through to a contact centre agent.

 

  Wait times have dropped by more than a minute to 41 seconds in Q4 2017/18.

 

LOGO     

Transforming our costs

Costs went up 3% this year. This reflects our ongoing investment in improving overall customer experience, bringing fibre broadband to more customers and contractual sports rights increases.

To partly offset this, we cut costs by:

 

finding economies of scale in our network infrastructure

 

negotiating improved contract terms with key broadband hub suppliers

 

improving customer care processes to cut the number of engineer visits.
 

 

 
76    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

Performance in the year – operating

We won quite a few awards for our products and services this year.

 

LOGO

 

 
77    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

BT Consumer continued

    

 

Plusnet also won several awards:

 

LOGO

 

The section below gives figures for home phone, broadband and TV across the group.

Mobile performance – also reported group-wide – is in the EE section on page 84.

Home phone

As of 31 March 2018, BT Group had a combined total of 10.1m home phone customers, at 31 December 2017 we had 38% market share.

Broadband

We held our position as the UK’s largest provider of home broadband services with 9.3m customers and 36% market share.

Around 61% of our home broadband customers have fibre broadband, getting faster speeds than ever before.

TV

We have 1.7m TV customers across BT, Plusnet and EE. Around 30,000 commercial premises have BT Sport.

BT Sport viewing figures across all platforms were up 19% in Q4 2017/18. We’ve seen a 31% increase in the proportion of our BT Sport base engaging with the app.

 

 

 
78    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Performance in the year – financial

In 2017/18, our revenue went up by 3%, with particularly strong growth in mobile, broadband, TV and sport. EBITDA grew 1%, because of revenue growth being partly offset by extra investment in customer experience.

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

Revenue

       5,066        4,934        4,608  

Operating costs

     4,043            3,922            3,553  

EBITDA

     1,023        1,012        1,055  

Depreciation and amortisation

     216        209        207  

Operating profit

     807        803        848  

Capital expenditure

     291        237        207  

Normalised free cash flow

     635        709        781  

Calls and lines revenue increased 2% (2016/17: up 4%) as mobile growth more than offset lower revenue from home phones.

Broadband and TV revenue increased 4% (2016/17: 13%) reflecting both revenue and product growth in the year. BT Consumer 12-month ARPU increased by 5% to £41.7 driven by mobile and BT Sport, as well as an increase in revenue generating units per customer from 1.98 to 2.03.

Operating costs increased 3% as a result of extra investment in customer experience as we brought contact centre jobs back to the UK, a higher proportion of customers taking fibre broadband and sports rights costs – specifically the Ashes and Premier League.

EBITDA increased 1% as revenue growth in mobile, broadband, TV and sport more than offset our increased investment in customer service, fibre broadband and content.

Capital expenditure also increased by 23%, which reflects our ongoing investment in improving our network.

LOGO

Launch new products and establish convergence

 

Launch BT Plus, bringing together the best of broadband and mobile for the whole family.

 

BT Plus will offer the best speeds with ultrafast broadband and the best usage allowances.

 

Give our customers access to the best TV content through partnerships eg Now TV.

Improve customer experience

100% of calls answered in the UK for our BT Plus customers.

 

Continue investing in our systems to offer personalised online interactions with us.

 

Increase our investment in pro-active repair.

Improve the way we communicate with customers

 

Refresh our advertising style to create a more personal connection with our customers.

 

Re-focus our priorities to sell more services to our existing customers, rather than focus on attracting new customers.

 

Offer BT products in EE stores so customers can experience and buy our products face to face.
 

 

 
79    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

    

LOGO

 

 
80    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

At BT we report mobile customer numbers for the whole group, including those from other customer-facing units. We have more than 29m connections, 19.6m of which are 4G.

In EE, new mobile customers all join the EE brand, but we still have a number of customers on old Orange and T-Mobile tariffs. We acquire and retain customers through our chain of around 600 shops, website and contact centres – as well as through third parties like Dixons Carphone. To improve customer experience, since the end of 2016 we’ve handled all EE service calls in the UK and Ireland.

We have 9,600 people, with 66% directly helping customers in shops and contact centres. We were named best employer in the Sunday Times Best Big Companies to Work For 2018 awards, up from third in 2017.

Our mobile network has been independently recognised as the fastest network by OpenSignal, and best overall network by RootMetrics – for the ninth consecutive time – in its report for the second half of 2017. We’re getting our 4G Emergency Services Network (ESN) ready for use by emergency services workers.

On 1 April 2018 the BT Consumer and EE customer-facing businesses were brought together into a new combined unit.

Markets and customers

With four mobile network operators and plenty of mobile virtual network operators (MVNOs), the UK mobile market is competitive. Of the UK’s 84m mobile connections, two-thirds are postpaid.

Our main competitors are O2, Vodafone, Three, Tesco Mobile, Virgin Media and Sky. Competition for customers is boosted by third-party distributors. These businesses sell mobile services on behalf of mobile operators, from high street shops and online.

Around 94% of adults in the UK use a mobile. Over 75% of UK adults use a smartphone. According to Ofcom, 66% of mobile connections are on postpaid tariffs. And 58% of homes also have a tablet.

Smartphones are now the most widely-used device by UK adults for getting online. Consequently, total mobile data use went up 44% in 2017.

By September 2017, total UK mobile call volumes were steady at around 38bn minutes a quarter. Texts and multimedia messages were down 16% to an average of 20bn a quarter. Mobile phone services generated £3.9bn in retail revenue in the quarter to September 2017, up 1% compared with last year.

LOGO

The market is dealing with some existing and potential structural changes:

 

increased customer expectations as we become more dependent on mobile services

 

huge growth in mobile data use

 

a continued slide in the prepaid market as customers move to postpaid tariffs

 

popularity of SIM-only tariffs. (Smartphones are evolving more slowly so people are keeping their phones longer.)

 

regulatory pressure on the prices charged to customers and other telecoms companies.

BT has a 28% share of the UK mobile market, measured by subscribers.

Mobile subscriber UK market share by operator

At 31 December 2017

 

LOGO

Source: EE and market data.

There’s more detail on our consumer home phone and broadband markets on page 73.

 

 

 
81    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

EE continued

    

 

Products and services

We provide mobile services in the UK, now bringing 4G to over 99% of the population, or 90% geographically. We also reach 99% of the population with 3G and 2G. We sell broadband, home phone and a TV service too.

Postpaid

We put new customers, and those renewing their contracts, on 4G tariffs. If that includes a phone, the contract is typically for 24 months. Our tariffs include a bundle of monthly voice, texts and data. Prices vary with the size of the data bundle, the device type and 4G speed. The tariffs are split into two main groups:

 

Essential packs for unlimited calls and texts plus tiered bundles of data over a 30-day period, at speeds of up to 60Mbps.

 

4GEE Max plans which combine the largest data bundles, inclusive access to the BT Sport App and ‘roam like home’ calls, texts and data in more than 50 countries around the world. We also offer an annual upgrade option on selected flagship phones.

Prepaid

Prepaid customers buy a phone and then add a ‘pay-as-you-go’ pack of 4G. The packs are split into three groups:

 

Everything packs for unlimited texts and tiered bundles of calls and data over a 30-day period.

 

Talk and text packs for tiered bundles of calls and text use over 7 to 30-day periods.

 

Data packs ranging from 100MB to 5GB over 7 to 30-day periods. Some automatically rollover unused data to the next month, so customers get a second chance to use it.

We also have a loyalty programme where customers can get extra data, calls or texts added to their packs in return for staying with us and topping up.

Devices

We offer a wide range of 4G mobile phones, tablets, connected devices and mobile broadband devices from leading brands like Apple, Samsung and Google. Or customers can use their own phone with a SIM-only plan.

Broadband and TV

We sell home phone, broadband (including superfast fibre broadband) and TV services. To reward their loyalty, our postpaid customers get bigger data allowances if they also buy EE broadband.

EE TV comes with more than 70 free channels simultaneously on up to four devices, as well as access to pay-TV channels. The EE TV set-top box has one terabyte of storage. Customers can control it from their mobile phone or tablet via the EE TV app.

Emergency Services Network

In December 2015 we were awarded the network part of the Emergency Services Network (ESN).

Our 4G network may enable lots of applications. For instance:

 

ambulance crews may be able to send vital data to a hospital to help staff prepare for a patient’s arrival

 

a police officer may be able to record an arrest on a body-worn camera and live-stream to nearby officers for support

 

fire and rescue crews may be able to assess a burning building based on live helicopter camera footage and digital blueprints viewed on a tablet.

We’ve increased 4G coverage, including building more than 100 new mobile basestations in remote areas.

We’ve enabled and successfully tested specific services, like ‘push to talk’, ready for the contract.

Ahead of the launch of the ESN we’ve been working closely with the people who’ll actually use it every day. More than 500 have visited our Technology Operations Centre in Bristol. We expect the first emergency services workers to start using the network later in 2018.

 

LOGO

 

 

 
82    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Performance in the year – strategic

We’ve grown financially, improved customer experience and extended our mobile network while integrating with the group.

 

LOGO     Delivering great customer experience

We’re working hard to deliver the best customer experience in the UK. While we continue to make strong progress, we know there will always be more we can do.

This year we focused on four areas:

 

call centres – we’ve made customer service more personal by coaching staff to be more empathetic

 

self-service – we’re always improving My EE functionality, with a new dedicated top-up tab and personalised recommendations

 

shops – we’ve launched our new Showcase stores, which give a more personal and immersive experience

 

network – we’ve increased 4G geographic coverage to give customers 4G in more places.

We’re putting customers in the centre of our decisions. We want every interaction they have with us to feel personal – for example we’re now using video-calling in our stores and call centres.

Thanks to these steps, Ofcom has scored us second lowest for complaints on postpaid mobile and broadband, following 25% and 54% improvements.

Our call centres are now ranked top for postpaid mobile and broadband customer satisfaction, and our net promoter scores keep climbing, up 10 points for postpaid and 16 points for broadband.

 

LOGO

  LOGO      Investing for growth

We’ve built the UK’s best mobile network. And we’re still investing to stay number one.

 

LOGO

Our 4G geographic coverage is now at 90% and we have an ambition to increase this to 95% by the end of December 2020. We’re also improving more than 1,000 sites in major cities, boosting their supported maximum speeds to over 400Mbps. We’re also preparing to lead the way on 5G, the next generation of mobile network technology.

 

LOGO      Transforming our costs

We’re now two years into the cost transformation programme we started after we joined the BT family.

We saved money this year by:

 

improving interconnect, transit and roaming rates as part of larger group deals

 

further improving customer self-service to cut the volume of calls into our contact centres

 

continuing to reduce the number of people in our head office.
 

 

 
83    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

EE continued

    

 

Performance in the year – operating

We report mobile customer numbers for the whole of BT Group, including those from other customer-facing units.

In last year’s report, we set out our top priorities for this year. The table below explains what progress we’ve made.

Review of last year’s priorities

 

  What we said    What we did

Maintain network leadership.

  

We’ve now extended 4G geographic coverage to 90% of the UK.

 

EE is still ranked as the best UK mobile network by RootMetrics.

 

 

Carry on improving customer service.

  

 

Our postpaid net promoter score is up by 10 points. We’ve cut complaints to Ofcom by 25% for postpaid mobile and 54% for broadband.

 

 

Deliver the EE part of the ESN contract.

  

 

We’ve been able to recognise revenues since September 2017. The first users are due to start using the network later in 2018.

 

At 31 March 2018 we had more than 29m connections. Here’s how they break down:

Customer base by type

000

 

LOGO

Our postpay customer base grew by 679,000 to 17.6m, supported by growth in all BT brands. The number of prepay customers continued to fall in line with industry trends (like people switching to postpay).

Our machine-to-machine customer base was up 290,000 to 2.7m, due to success in the automotive sector.

Our base of MVNO customers was steady at 3.7m.

LOGO

Customer base movements

000

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 
84    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Performance in the year – financial

In 2017/18, our revenue went up by 4%, with particularly strong postpaid growth. EBITDA increased 17%.

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

    2016a

£m

 

Revenue

       5,294            5,090        841  

Operating costs

     3,941        3,934        668  

EBITDA

     1,353        1,156        173  

Depreciation and amortisation

     776        780        146  

Operating profit

     577        376        27  

Capital expenditure

     628        616        96  

Normalised free cash flow

     754        570        238  

a Includes EE results from acquisition on 29 January 2016.

Postpaid revenue grew by 6%, as customers paid more for bigger bundles of data, ‘more for more’ pricing and we started to recognise ESN revenues.

Fixed broadband revenue was up 14%, reflecting our higher number of customers, and more customers wanting fibre broadband.

Our overall revenue growth was partially offset by an 11% drop in prepaid revenue as the number of customers fell by 20%. Monthly mobile ARPUs for the final quarter of the year were £26.0 for postpaid customers, down 1%, prepaid ARPUs were £4.8, up 9%.

Operating costs were flat because to win and keep customers in the face of increased smartphone costs we had to spend more, but this was offset by overheads savings.

Our EBITDA grew by 17%, with strong postpaid performance compensating for higher smartphone costs.

Capital expenditure increased by 2%. This was because of our work on extending 4G geographic coverage to 90%.

Normalised free cash flow went up by 32% reflecting the higher EBITDA, partly offset by increased capital expenditure.

LOGO

Maintain network leadership

– Keep extending 4G geographic coverage.

– Get the ESN ready for use by emergency service workers.

– Keep working with suppliers and partners to run live customer

   trials to prepare for 5G’s commercial launch.

Carry on improving customer experience

 

Hold our top spot on call centre customer satisfaction.

 

Launch a new service to set up customers’ new smartphones in their homes.

 

Add more shops as we work towards our ambition of providing 95% of the population with access to an EE store within a 20-minute drive.

Form partnerships with third parties

We’ll look to work with other companies to generate new revenue streams, by using our:

– shops, contact centres and billing platforms

– relationships with millions of mobile customers.

 

 

 
85    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
86    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

We’re passionate about helping all our customers succeed – whether they’re large government departments, big household names, public sector organisations, small businesses or start-ups. Our 10,000 people work locally, regionally and nationally, serving those customers wherever they are in the UK.

We have three trading units. They offer customers fixed, mobile, networking and IT services over the biggest UK fixed and mobile communications network.

 

   Trading unit    Customers

 

Small and Medium Enterprises

  

 

UK businesses typically with up to 100 people, ranging from sole traders to more complex organisations (like schools and colleges).

 

 

Corporate

  

 

UK businesses typically with 100-1,000 people.

 

 

Public Sector and Major Business

  

 

UK businesses with more than 1,000 people.

   Multinationals who do the majority of business with BT in the UK.
   Public sector (central and local government, health, higher education, defence).
   Corporates and public sector in Northern Ireland.
    

Corporates, public sector and wholesale customers in the Republic of Ireland.

 

Markets and customers

We have around 1.2m customers and serve over half of the FTSE 350.

Major customers include:

 

retailers like Debenhams

 

utilities like Severn Trent

 

public sector organisations like Surrey Police

 

healthcare providers like Nuffield Health

 

sports companies like Williams Martini Racing

 

construction companies like Anglian Home Improvements

 

financial organisations like e-sure

 

educational institutions like University Of Warwick.

We cover both the communications and IT Services markets. Overall we’re focused on four main product markets: Fixed voice; Mobility; Fibre and connectivity; and Networked IT services.

We think these markets will converge over the next few years as technology and customer needs change. And as they do, we’ll be able to grow our market share.

Public sector is a big part of what we do. But it faces continuing challenges.

Larger systems integration contracts are still being disaggregated and replaced by smaller contracts. Devolution is increasingly shifting procurement decisions and spend to the regions. There is uncertainty over Brexit. The public sector is under increasing pressure – financial cutbacks, higher service expectations, demographic shifts, and economic dynamics.

Fixed voice

The overall number of fixed voice seats in the market will keep growing. For some time, there’s been a switch from traditional voice to IP Voice. Market analysts think that by 2019 IP Voice will dominate the UK business voice market in spending terms.

That’s because it offers customers a combination of flexibility, cost efficiency and new features like integration with collaboration tools.

The fixed voice market is fragmented. We’re the market leader – competing with more than 950 resellers and fixed network operators, including companies such as Unicom, Azzurri, Colt Group, Daisy Group, Gamma, KCOM Group and O2.

Mobility

Mobility and mobile device use keeps growing. Customers use them to cut costs, increase productivity and flexibility, and get richer work experiences.

 

LOGO

Our customers’ employees are using mobile phones and technologies to work together better, not just to connect. But this is against a backdrop of increasing risks around security, privacy and compliance.

Our main competitors are O2 and Vodafone. Both offer fixed products as well as mobile and are increasingly selling converged services.

 

 

 
87    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Business and Public Sector continued

    

 

Fibre and connectivity

We’re the largest business broadband provider in the UK. Broadband services continue to migrate to fibre to meet businesses’ growing bandwidth needs for higher downstream and upstream speeds. Third-party business applications are increasingly being offered alongside communications provider broadband services, typically via an app store.

Ethernet and dedicated internet access services are growing strongly, with businesses becoming increasingly reliant on connectivity. We’re the leading provider of fixed networking services in the UK.

Networked IT services

The IT services market is diverse. It stretches from off-the-shelf hardware sales to large outsourced solutions.

Some areas are growing fast – like cloud services, hosting, infrastructure and security. These all present attractive opportunities for us to grow our market share.

Networking is moving from physical provision to software-based, virtual provision. And it’s expanding into wide area networking through technologies like Software Defined Networking (SDN).

We think SDN will grow quickly. Customers see the benefits – faster service activation, simpler WAN management and more flexible bandwidth. This growth will boost demand for connectivity but also for hybrid networks especially (combined public and private networks).

As more businesses ‘go virtual’, networks will evolve. For example, WANs will need to become more flexible, manageable, scalable and cost effective.

Cybersecurity remains a key priority for companies; there were a lot of high profile cyber attacks in 2017.

In May 2018 the General Data Protection Regulation comes into force. Companies will have to stick to a strict set of data privacy and security measures. Another growing priority for our customers is the Internet of Things.

Competition is fragmented, with providers often focused on specific types of customer, industry or technology.

Products and services

We offer a wide choice of voice, connectivity and IT-related services.

The things we sell range from standalone products and converged propositions to managed services and customised solutions. Together these meet the needs of our customers, from small start-ups to large enterprises and public sector organisations.

Fixed voice

Our fixed-voice services range from calls and lines to fully-managed office phone systems and contact centre solutions.

Our portfolio spans traditional and IP Voice. IP Voice services include Cloud Unified Communications, BT Cloud Phone and BT Cloud Voice – which we can offer to the full spectrum of customers we serve.

Mobility

We offer a range of mobile phones and tablets, a choice of voice and data tariffs and mobile office solutions, provided over the UK’s fastest 4G network.

BT One Phone is a converged proposition for businesses with a mobile workforce. It effectively creates an office switchboard in the cloud, then pushes those functions to a customer’s mobile phone.

Fibre and connectivity

Customers have lots of options for internet access. They include BT Business Broadband (over copper connections); BT Business Infinity over fibre-to-the-cabinet (FTTC) and fibre-to-the-premises (FTTP); and BTnet dedicated internet access.

Our networking solutions are perfect for customers connecting offices together or connecting to the internet over dedicated leased lines. They buy products like Ethernet, IP Virtual Private Network services, SIP trunking (which transports voice calls over IP networks), leased lines, cabling infrastructure and local area networking solutions.

 

LOGO

We offer value-added services to complement our fibre and connectivity offerings. These include: computing apps to get customers online and running and marketing their websites effectively; security and backup; and cloud software access via our Business Apps Store to enable them to work effectively without needing to buy extra IT resource or hardware.

Networked IT services

Our IT services team designs and delivers solutions, manages services and provides in-life support. They specialise in four areas:

end-user computing

– Local Area Networking (LAN) and wi-fi infrastructure

– security

– data centres and cloud.

Partnerships with brands like Cisco, Apple, HP and Microsoft help to support these services.

We resell computing, networking and software products on BT Business Direct, our IT product website. It offers 20,000 hardware and software products from the world’s leading IT vendors.

 

 

 
88    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Performance in the year – strategic

We continually invest in our people, portfolio and digital capabilities. This helps improve customer experience and provides a platform for us to grow.

 

LOGO     Delivering great customer experience

We want our customer experience to lead the market. We’re making good progress.

This year our Net Promoter Score went up 12.1 points. That’s eight quarters of consistent improvement. Our Right First Time (RFT) measure improved by more than 5%. We are fixing faults an average of 16% quicker. And on our Ethernet portfolio, we’ve cut the time it takes for our customers to get their orders by 14%.

We’ve continued to bring our contact centres back to the UK with 86% of our people now here. The number of calls into our contact centres has fallen by 15% from last year. This is because customers need to get in touch less. When they do, we’re giving them more ways to do it. And our complaints team won ‘Team Of The Year’ in the UK Complaint Handling Awards 2018.

This year, we’ve:

 

launched a Business Service app, which more than 25,000 customers have downloaded

 

successfully completed more than 1,600 improvement actions for Major and Public Sector customers

 

invested in our people, completing 28,000 hours of training across sales and service on having great conversations with customers

 

launched the BT Smart Hub for broadband customers, with better diagnostics to help us fix faults proactively and more quickly

 

updated the BT OnePhone portal to make it easier for customers to self-serve

 

launched BTnet Express – a simplified, fixed-pricing approach for our market-leading dedicated internet access product.

 

LOGO     Investing for growth

We continue to futureproof our cloud, connectivity, mobile and networked IT offerings. This is underpinned by our investments in digital capabilities.

This year we’ve launched:

 

BT Business Ultrafast broadband with download speeds of up to 314Mbps, upload speeds of up to 48Mbps, and a minimum speed guarantee

 

BT Guest Wi-Fi, to protect our customers’ broadband speeds and provide extra security

 

BT Sport as part of the Infinity Broadband bundle

 

Business-grade end-point security in conjunction with Symantec
Cloud Voice SIP-Trunking within our IP Voice portfolio. This gives customers the cost benefits of IP telephony through existing on-premises equipment

 

SIP phones and SIP endpoints within the BT OnePhone portfolio to expand its capabilities

 

new Mobile Sharer plans with extended international roaming options and new mobile security management.

We have continued to invest more in our digital and online capabilities. This has helped us do more business online, made it easier for customers to do business with us, and delivered a more personalised experience.

 

LOGO   Transforming our costs

Building on last year’s work integrating EE with Business and Public Sector, we’re still finding big cost savings through bringing customer service, sales and support closer together.

We’ve combined the business elements of BT and EE – finding overlaps in the structures and delivering the financial savings.

We’ve also shared and adopted the best working practices of each organisation – using this to improve customer service levels and overall NPS.

Performance in the year – operating

Our order intake of £3.4bn was up 1%. Although we signed a large wholesale contract in Republic of Ireland this was offset by declining fixed voice revenue and by us deciding to move away from low-margin equipment sales.

Business and Public Sector 12-month rolling order intake

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

 

 

 
89    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Business and Public Sector continued

    

 

In last year’s report, we set out our top priorities for this year. There’s a summary of how we did in the table below.

Review of last year’s priorities

 

  What we said    What we did

 

Drive growth from broader sales coverage, winning new customers and cross-selling to existing ones.

  

 

We’re increasing the average number of products our customers buy from us. We’re doing that through multi-product combinations and by using the BT and EE brands to target existing customers who don’t have both fixed and mobile solutions with us.

 

We strengthened our leadership in our regional teams.

 

 

Stand out through integrating our portfolio and delivering it on the best network.

 

  

We integrated BT OnePhone with our BTnet Internet Access product.

 

We launched Skype Integration with BT OnePhone for presence.

 

Keep improving our customer experience.

  

 

Customer experience scores are all going in the right direction – NPS (+12.1), RFT (+5%), and call volumes (-15%).

    

 

We enhanced our portfolio to make our products more customer-friendly. Our broadband Smart Hub now comes with better diagnostics and we’ve simplified our pricing for BTnet.

 

 

 

LOGO

We won or re-signed a lot of contracts this year, including:

 

  Customer    Contract

 

WSP UK

  

 

We were picked as preferred network partner for extra internet connectivity. The solution will provide additional bandwidth to help its people work together better, and enhance end-user experience as well as resilience to ensure business continuity.

 

 

Severn Trent Water

  

 

We’ll be providing core communications infrastructure, including Managed WAN, Voice, SIP and LAN services.

 

London Borough of Bromley

 

  

 

A multi-million pound contract. It covers all the council’s IT services. We’ll provide new voice and data networks, mobile phones, internet access and support for business software applications to be used by more than 2,000 council people.

 

 

First Group

  

 

We were chosen as its preferred Mobility Partner to provide a full range of mobility services.

 

The number of business lines we provide fell by 10% as customers continue to migrate to IP Voice. This has been partly balanced by our base of IP Voice lines going up 42% (against market growth of 21%).

There’s been a strong take-up of BT Cloud Voice and BT Cloud Phone. User numbers are up 102% and 74% respectively.

We’re adapting to changes in the public sector market. We’ve bolstered our regional leadership and aligned our health team with local governments – reflecting the disaggregation of the centralised N3 contract.

We’ve reached agreement to end contracts with customers in areas we said last year weren’t core to our future. And we’ve also brought together our central government, defence and police organisations under new leadership.

 

 

 
90    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Performance in the year – financial

Revenue was down 4% (2016/17: up 11%) with underlying revenue excluding transit also down 4% (2016/17: down 6%). Profits fell – mainly because of declining fixed voice revenues. But the rest of our business did well, especially mobile.

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£ m

    

2016

£m

 

Revenue

     4,563        4,758        4,294  

Change in underlying revenue excluding transit

     (4)%        (6)%        (2)%  

Operating costs

       3,145            3,230            2,880  

EBITDA

     1,418        1,528        1,414  

Depreciation and amortisation

     365        352        284  

Operating profit

     1,053        1,176        1,130  

Capital expenditure

     304        275        153  

Normalised free cash flow

     1,136        1,293        1,101  

SME revenue was down 1%. Strong growth in mobile didn’t quite offset falling fixed voice revenues. As customers shift to IP Voice, they need fewer lines than with traditional voice, so overall line totals fall.

Corporate revenue was down 5%. Our growing mobile revenues were balanced by the decline in fixed voice revenue and falling equipment sales resulting from our decision to move away from lower-margin business.

Public Sector and Major Business revenue was down 7%. We sold less equipment and we are still feeling the impact of a few large public sector contracts coming to an end, as highlighted last year.

Foreign exchange movements had an £18m positive impact on Republic of Ireland revenue, where underlying revenue excluding transit was down 6%.

Operating costs were down 3% (2016/17: up 12%) and EBITDA was down 7% (2016/17: up 8%) because of lower revenues, operational efficiencies and cost savings. Depreciation and amortisation rose by 4% (2016/17: up 24%).

Capital expenditure went up by £29m (2016/17: £122m increase). Normalised free cash flow went down 12% (2016/17: up 17%) reflecting the lower EBITDA, increased capital expenditure and the timing of working capital movements.

LOGO

Drive growth from broader sales coverage, winning new customers and cross-selling to existing ones

 

Develop innovative tools to boost cross-selling.

 

Create new bundles that are simpler to upsell.

 

Increase our reach through indirect partners.

Stand out through integrating our portfolio and delivering it on the best network

 

Build new converged propositions.

 

Standardise our solutions across the portfolio.

 

Offer higher capacity data services.

Keep improving our customer experience, especially digital

 

Provide a more consistent, personalised digital experience for each customer.

 

Transform our service model.

 

Focus more on proactive care.
 

 

 
91    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
92    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Our business is all about transformation. Transformation affects our customers and their customers. It affects our competitors and the markets in which we operate. It affects our strategic partners and the race to roll out new technology and solutions. And it affects our people and how they serve our customers.

Ultimately transformation is what we do for our customers, so they can embrace the opportunities of digitisation. And embrace them trusting their networks, systems and applications to a reliable partner.

This year we’ve been carrying out our own transformation. We’re investing in scalable, repeatable platforms for a specific type of truly global company or organisation. We are also investing in differentiating our service, rolling out and managing software-defined network solutions, strengthening our security practice, and building on our Cloud of Clouds strategy.

We’re focusing on a smaller number of markets and a more select set of repeatable solutions. And we’re making our service model work more efficiently. These things will deliver the long-term value our customers deserve.

Our strategic review

Last year we announced a strategic review of Global Services. Today we’ve already made the first moves to becoming a more profitable, predictable and customer-focused business, which we’re calling Digital GS.

Digital GS is our strategy to create a better future for Global Services, our people and our customers. Our business will focus on a set of named global customers and a portfolio of scalable repeatable solutions, supported by outstanding customer service and market-leading security.

Markets and customers

Customers

We have 5,500 customers around the world. Major accounts are our focus – they generated 81% of our revenue in 2017/18. Around 78% of our revenue came from serving customers operating in multiple geographies.

Regions

We have more than 17,000 people worldwide in 59 countries. Our 20 highest priority countries, including the UK and other key countries where our major customers are based, generate more than 95% of our revenue.

Continental Europe is our largest region by revenue. We have offices in 17 countries, and an extensive network serving customers across the continent.

In the UK, we focus on financial services organisations and multinationals, where we benefit from BT’s extensive UK network and mobile infrastructure.

Around 73% of our major customers have a presence in the Americas. So we operate in the USA, Canada and 28 countries across Latin America and the Caribbean. We do this from offices in 17 countries.

In Asia, Middle East and Africa we help multinationals expand their operations and we support local companies as they grow internationally. We have offices in 23 countries across the region.

Outside the UK, markets are liberalised to widely varying degrees. In many countries, this can constrain our ability to compete, to a greater or lesser degree.

We continue to press national incumbent operators and regulators around the world (including in the EU) for cost-related non-discriminatory wholesale access to their networks, where appropriate. We also ask for notice of any changes to network design or technology which would affect our ability to serve our customers.

Global Services revenue by region

Year ended 31 March 2018

 

LOGO

Key market trends

Our customers are facing new disruptions and challenges. They include:

 

switching from old self-managed data centres to cloud-based infrastructure

 

responding to the explosion of data traffic, particularly to and from public clouds

 

the increased complexity of managing growing numbers of internet and network providers

 

increasing risk of cyber attacks and increased exposure as use of the internet grows.

As our customers digitally transform themselves, they rely on us. We must keep them connected to increasingly vital IT infrastructure and applications, help them enrich their customer interactions and boost their people’s productivity.

Customers tell us they want a strategic partner. They want more commercial flexibility (eg usage-based billing) with reliable quoting and delivery. And they want faster innovation and time to market for new services.

 

 

 
93    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Global Services continued

    

 

So, we’re making our business more focused, straightforward and agile by investing and focusing on what our customers need:

 

secure, flexible hybrid network solutions with faster deployment via our Dynamic Network Services portfolio

 

dedicated access to a rich digital ecosystem of the world’s leading cloud service providers through our Cloud Landing Zone

 

best-in-class customer service using the latest automation and information tools – flexible enough to cover self-service through to fully managed solutions.

Our competitors include global telecoms companies like AT&T, NTT, Orange and Vodafone and regional operators like Singtel.

Products and services

We call our portfolio strategy Cloud of Clouds. It brings together our six core product families with our ecosystem of partners to deliver global network and IT services.

Dynamic Network Services are the heart of Cloud of Clouds. Our strategy brings together:

– strength in intelligent hybrid networks

– a wide portfolio, especially in security

– a focus on service

– investments in the latest technology.

We’re working with leading technology companies and cloud services providers like Amazon Web Services (AWS) and IBM. Together we’re helping customers get the most from cloud and transform their businesses more quickly.

Our six core product families

 

LOGO

BT Connect

Our network services connect our customers to their people, to their own customers – and to the cloud. We offer flexible, intelligent hybrid and secure IP, Ethernet and internet virtual private network services, as well as connectivity to third-party cloud services providers.

Our Dynamic Network Services programme combines our global infrastructure with the latest technologies. They include network function virtualisation (NFV) and software-defined wide area networking (SD-WAN) solutions. These underpin the digital transformation of large organisations.

BT Security

Cyber attacks now happen every day, sparking cybersecurity conversations in the boardrooms of our customers.

We’ve learned a lot protecting our own organisation. And we use this knowledge to provide consultancy and managed security services, threat intelligence analysis and management to customers. This helps them protect themselves from ever-evolving threats and maximise the opportunities of digital transformation securely.

We work with more than 200 vendors. So our services are powered by leading technologies. We get intelligence from our global network and intelligence-sharing partnerships. So the services we offer are informed by real-time threat intelligence.

We’ve been at the forefront of cybersecurity for more than 70 years, working in close partnerships with government and law enforcement to make the internet safer for everyone.

BT One

People use technology to communicate in lots of different ways – phone, messaging, email, conferencing and data-sharing solutions, either at their desks or on the move.

Our collaboration services help businesses work together better and cut costs by transforming interactions with customers, colleagues, partners and suppliers.

BT Contact

Our contact centre services help our customers build richer relationships with their customers. We offer lots of ways to communicate – email, web chat, video, social media and phone – via automated systems or dedicated advisers.

Our cloud contact solutions give companies more control over costs, letting them change capacity depending on demand.

BT Compute

Businesses want reliable, flexible IT platforms and services for their applications, data storage and security.

We provide IT services from 48 data centres around the world, 22 of which deliver cloud services. We offer traditional telehousing and colocation through to the latest public, private and hybrid cloud solutions.

 

 

 
94    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

BT Advise

Our global team of consultants work with customers to understand their issues and current capabilities and make recommendations based on our portfolio.

The plans we develop and support for customers help them do things like cut costs or increase productivity.

BT for Financial Markets

To help the global financial community with its regulatory, technological, and infrastructure challenges, we’ve built industry-specific solutions.

 

The BT Radianz Cloud is the world’s largest secure, financial services community. It helps customers cut costs and get to market faster.

 

Traders worldwide rely on our specialist Unified Trading voice devices. We’ve recently added IP Trade’s portfolio – giving customers more options to integrate new compliance and unified communications tools.

 

We provide secure financial messaging to more than 100 companies in the post-trade sector.

 

We combine our Radianz and Unified Trading platforms to offer flexible cloud-trading services to more than 50,000 users.

Performance in the year

We remain a global leader for managed network and IT services.

In the last year we’ve been named as:

 

a Leader for the 14th consecutive time in Gartner’s Magic Quadrant for Network Service Providers, Global (February 2018)a

 

a Leader for the fifth consecutive year in Gartner’s Magic Quadrant for Managed Hybrid Cloud Hosting (MHCH), in Europe (June 2017)a

 

a Leader for the third year in a row in Gartner’s 2017 Magic Quadrant for Contact Center as a Service, Western Europe (October 2017)a

 

a Leader for the second year in a row in Gartner’s 2017 Magic Quadrant for Unified Communications as a Service, Worldwide (September 2017)a

 

a Leader in the IDC MarketScape Global Managed Security Services 2017 Vendor Assessment (August 2017).

We were also voted number one financial services network provider in the 2017 Waters Rankings. This is the 15th year running Waters have recognised us for innovation in the BT Radianz Cloud.

 

a  Gartner does not endorse any vendor, product or service depicted in its research publications, and does not advise technology users to select only those vendors with the highest ratings or other designation. Gartner research publications consist of the opinions of Gartner’s research organisation and should not be construed as statements of fact. Gartner disclaims all warranties, expressed or implied, with respect to this research, including any warranties of merchantability or fitness for a particular purpose.

 

  The Gartner Report(s) described herein, (the ‘Gartner Report(s)’) represent(s) research opinion or viewpoints published, as part of a syndicated subscription service, by Gartner, Inc. (‘Gartner’), and are not representations of fact. Each Gartner Report speaks as of its original publication date (and not as of the date of this Annual Report) and the opinions expressed in the Gartner Report(s) are subject to change without notice.

Performance in the year – strategic

 

LOGO     Delivering great customer experience

The feedback and insight we get from customers helps us make the right decisions to enhance their experience with us.

 

We measure loyalty and identify the things we need to improve through monthly net promoter score (NPS) surveys.

 

We use ‘Customer Thermometer’ to track how they feel about their interactions with us.

 

And we use Right First Time measures, like how quickly we deliver orders or fix faults, to monitor how we’re doing.

During the year:

 

Our NPS 12-month rolling average rose 17 points (nine points ahead of our year-end target). More customers feel we understand them and proactively offer solutions.

 

Our RFT performance improved 8.2% (ahead of our 4.5% target), driven by strong performance in service delivery.

 

LOGO     Investing for growth

Network and services

 

We opened a new cybersecurity research and development hub in Sydney, Australia – our first outside the UK. We also opened a new Security Operations Centre near Frankfurt, Germany – part of a global network of 15.

 

As part of our Dynamic Network Services programme, we launched BT Agile Connect. It’s a new SD-WAN service giving customers control of infrastructure and traffic flows, faster and more secure set-up, and lower costs.

We also launched:

 

BT Connect Intelligence InfoVista-as-a-Service – we were first to market with Infovista’s latest application performance management solution. It gives customers a new, commercially- flexible approach.

 

BT Bandwidth on Demand – helps our customers be nimbler by letting them flex network bandwidth in real-time.

 

BT One Collaborate Spark – integrates the new Cisco Spark services platform into our voice network. This is designed to deliver market-leading audio quality and user experience.

 

Internet Connect Global DDoS – offers critical security protection for internet-based WAN networking.

Service agility

 

We’re investing in new systems for service assurance and delivery like our Service Intelligence platform.

 

Our 360° portfolio reviews streamline how we deliver our products.
 

 

 
95    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Global Services continued

    

 

Partnerships

 

We announced a strategic collaboration with Amazon Web Services to help customers adopt cloud services.

 

We extended our strategic partnership with Cisco, under the Dynamic Network Services programme.

 

We launched a new service, BT Cloud Connect Direct for IBM, to give global businesses direct access to IBM Cloud via our network.

 

We partnered with Symantec to provide our customers with best-in-class endpoint security.

 

LOGO     Transforming our costs

We continue to focus on reducing costs. Operating costs were 8% lower this year.

Last year we said we’d transform Global Services. Since then we’ve streamlined and simplified our business to be more efficient and effective and to more tightly control our costs. For example:

 

Restructuring our European operations. We’ve pressed ahead with a restructuring programme to help us compete more effectively, especially in Europe. By getting rid of duplication and working more efficiently we have been able to rationalise the number of management and back-office roles.

 

Rationalising our domestic portfolio. We’re switching from legacy and domestic portfolio platforms onto a set of globally scalable ones. This year we closed or migrated eleven domestic product platforms.

 

Re-designing our global network. We’re improving the performance and efficiency of our core European network.

 

Reducing low-margin business. In line with our strategy, we’ve reduced IP Exchange volumes and equipment sales, leading to lower operating costs.

Performance in the year – operating

We took £3.8bn worth of orders, down 16% from last year. This fall was due to our decision to stop pursuing non-strategic opportunities and to changes in buying habits. Customers want more flexible commercial terms – like shorter contract lengths and more usage-based services.

The table below shows the progress we’ve made on the priorities we set ourselves last year:

Review of last year’s priorities

 

  What we said    What we did

 

Implement a leaner and more customer- focused operating model.

 

  

 

From April 2018 our top accounts have a new global account management model in place.

 

Grow our cloud-based services and security portfolio at double-digit rates.

  

 

We grew our security and Cloud Compute services by double-digits. (One Cloud and Cloud Contact services didn’t grow as much – but we’re aiming for double-digit growth in future.)

 

 

Launch a new digital customer experience, using automation and portfolio innovations like NFV and SDN.

  

 

We launched Dynamic Network Services, including BT Agile Connect and Bandwidth on Demand.

 

We introduced the Service Intelligence platform. Now our people can view customers’ networks and applications in real-time.

 

And we brought in tools like MI Kitchen (a unified data source for better management insight) and Service Orchestration (to automate how we manage incidents).

 

This year we won   

Customer

   Contract

 

Anglo American BT Security

 

  

 

Security operating centre capability and endpoint monitoring service.

 

 

AWE BT Security

 

  

 

Cybersecurity.

 

 

Deloitte BT One

 

  

 

Video streaming to 35,000 employees across North West Europe.

 

 

Deutsche Post DHL BT One

 

  

 

Fixed voice services serving around 3,000 employees in 45 locations.

 

 

Fujitsu BT Connect

  

 

WAN services providing connectivity between their own and customers’ premises.

 

 

Hella Group BT Connect

  

 

Global WAN services connecting locations in 12 countries through Europe and Asia.

 

 

Mastercard BT Connect

 

  

 

IP Connect managed network services in the UK, US and Europe.

 

 

Wallenius Wilhelmsen Logistics BT Connect

 

  

 

Network connecting more than 100 locations in 40 countries.

 

 

 

 
96    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Performance in the year – financial

Revenue fell 9% (2016/17: up 8%). This decline principally reflects lower IP Exchange volumes and equipment sales from our strategic decision to reduce low-margin business, reduced revenue from our Italian business, lower general trading across all regions and some large contracts ending.

These factors were partly offset by a positive £68m impact from foreign exchange movements. Our key revenue measure, underlying revenue excluding transit, fell 8%.

 

Year ended 31 March  

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

Revenue

      5,013           5,479            5,074  

Change in underlying revenue excluding transit

    (8)%       (2)%        0%  

Operating costs

    4,579       4,984        4,595  

EBITDA

    434       495        479  

Depreciation and amortisation

    424       439        422  

Operating profit

    10       56        57  

Capital expenditure

    278       361        355  

Normalised free cash flow

    118       (245)        151  

Underlying revenuea in AMEAb fell by 5% (2016/17: down 4%). In the Americasc it fell by 11% (2016/17: fell 6%), reflecting the ongoing impact of a major customer insourcing services in the US and a large contract in Brazil completing in early 2017/18.

In Continental Europe underlying revenue excluding transit dropped by 9% (2016/17: down 5%), reflecting lower IP Exchange volumes, lower equipment sales and lower revenue from our Italian business. In the UK revenue fell by 6% (2016/17: was up 5%) reflecting lower IP Exchange volumes.

Operating costs fell by 8% (2016/17: up 8%). This mainly reflected lower IP Exchange volumes and lower equipment sales.

EBITDA fell 12% (2016/17: up 3%) reflecting certain one-off items in the current year and the prior year benefit arising from a revision of the annual bonus. Excluding these one-off items, EBITDA was broadly flat. Depreciation and amortisation was down 3% (2016/17: up 4%). Operating profit fell by £46m (2016/17: down £1m).

Capital expenditure was down 23% (2016/17: up 2%). EBITDA less capital expenditure rose by £22m to £156m compared with last year’s rise of £10m.

Our normalised free cash flow of £118m was £363m higher. This was mainly due to the prior year impact of unwinding improper working capital transactions in our Italian business.

 

a  Excludes specific items and foreign exchange movements and acquisitions.
b  Asia Pacific, the Middle East and Africa.
c  United States & Canada and Latin America.

 

LOGO

Improve service agility and

customer experience

 

Automate manually-intensive service processes.

 

Harmonise our systems so there’s better end-to-end ownership of processes.

 

Introduce new tools to enrich our customer service interactions.

Deliver our global transformation priorities

 

Implement our global operating model faster.

 

Complete our organisational redesign in line with our global strategy.

 

Help our people be more productive through investment in simplification, tools and process automation.

Make our high-growth strategic portfolio more repeatable

 

Embed BT Security features more deeply into the rest of our global portfolio.

 

Expand our portfolio of standardised Dynamic Network Services solutions.

 

Simplify commercial offers for cloud solutions.
 

 

 
97    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

    

LOGO

 

 
98    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Our 4,700 people combine unique expertise in fixed and wholesale network solutions with operational knowledge in our venture businesses. This year we created a new unit dedicated to the Internet of Things, serving the wider BT Group.

Markets and customers

Our wholesale business helps communications providers (CPs) and other organisations provide fixed or mobile phone services. Our ventures provide mass-market services like directory enquiries and payphones, and enterprise services including BT Fleet and BT Redcare.

Wholesale: Fixed network services

We provide wholesale fixed network services to more than 1,400 customers. They include Sky, TalkTalk, Telefonica O2, Three and Virgin Media – and overseas CPs operating in the UK.

We also provide specialist media and broadcast services to companies like the BBC, Channel 4, ITV, Sky, Premier League Productions and Viacom18.

Wholesale: Mobile network services

We help Mobile Virtual Network Operators (MVNOs) offer their own-brand mobile plans. Today our MVNO business supports 3.7m customers. They access the EE mobile network under our partners’ brands.

Wholesale: Market trends

The key trends this year were:

 

rising demand for bandwidth and superfast connectivity, especially fibre broadband

 

higher MVNO subscription volumes, coupled with slightly lower average prices

 

more price competition for wholesale data products like Ethernet and broadband

 

the UK market’s fastest ever growth in cloud communication business users in the last six months – with more than 3m business users for the first time.

Ventures

Our ventures provide solutions to more than 1,000 enterprise customers. They include law firms, energy providers and mobile payment companies.

We also handle millions of directory enquiries and 999 calls and deliver the Phone Book to more than 21m homes and businesses.

Internet of Things

The Internet of Things (IoT) is a network of connected objects that exchange data to drive insight and action. Our IoT propositions, coupled with solutions from our partners, serve high street retailers, large logistics groups and utilities.

We also offer IoT connectivity to our wholesale partners in the UK, using the EE mobile network.

Products and services

Broadband and Ethernet

We provide CPs with broadband and Ethernet connections between their core network and their customers.

Wholesale Broadband Connect can now serve 98% of premises with copper-based broadband (2016/17: 96%) and more than 29m premises with fibre. Combined with our older broadband network, we can reach 99% of premises.

Wholesale Ethernet lets customers connect at speeds of up to 10Gbps. Wholesale Optical boosts those speeds to 100Gbps. This year we extended our own fibre-based Ethernet to more third-party datacentres.

Our Managed Ethernet Access Service (MEAS) carries mobile voice and data traffic to and from mobile operators’ transmission masts.

 

LOGO

Voice

Our IP Exchange platform helps CPs carry their customers’ voice calls beyond the reach of their own voice network. It’s used by more than 170 CPs, including most of the UK’s biggest operators.

CPs without their own voice network can use Wholesale Calls, which routes calls for them from start to finish. They keep their customer relationships through their own sales, service and billing.

Hosted communications

Traditionally, businesses made and received calls over phone lines via a switchboard.

Wholesale SIP-Trunking delivers calls over broadband or Ethernet, while Wholesale Hosted Centrex puts switchboard capabilities into our network.

Similarly, our Hosted Contact Centres replace the systems and services needed to handle large numbers of inbound or outbound customer calls.

 

 

 
99    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Wholesale and Ventures continued

    

 

Mobile Virtual Network Operator (MVNO)

We have kept our focus on supporting MVNOs, helping them give their customers access to the EE mobile network under their own brand. In 2017/18 we signed a new agreement with China Mobile. It launched a mobile proposition for Chinese communities, students and travellers in the UK.

Managed solutions

We’ve designed a range of fully-managed solutions, including access infrastructure, backhaul and core services. This means greater flexibility to meet CPs’ needs and includes the migration path to next generation technologies.

Our portfolio includes Managed Install (quick and efficient Ethernet circuit installation) and Managed Wayleave – a solution that streamlines getting landowners’ rights of way.

Machine-to-machine and Internet of Things

We have four products in our Internet of Things portfolio. And we’re actively building new ones.

Machine-to-machine and IoT network solutions: these use our mobile and fixed networks to help companies communicate securely with their devices and improve their services’ features and reliability.

Intelligent Retail Solution: this helps high street retailers better understand customer footfall in their stores. It’s powered by the Acuitas Alliance of BT, Intel, RetailNext, SATO and other partners.

Asset Intelligence: these solutions let customers track, monitor and control assets via RFID, low power networks and cellular radio technology.

 

LOGO

Smart Cities starter kit: this gives UK cities a bundle of pre-configured use cases in things like transport management, lighting and operations. We’re involved in two big projects transforming Milton Keynes (MK Smart) and Manchester (City Verve).

Roaming

We help BT and EE mobile customers use their mobiles abroad through roaming agreements in more than 200 destinations.

Media services

Our media network connects major spots around the world where broadcast or film content is created or distributed.

In the UK it carries all the nation’s digital terrestrial TV, as well as TV broadcasts from more than 150 sports and news locations. Elsewhere, local partners help us link TV stations to major sports venues worldwide.

We also offer media services like cloud-based content playout and media file acceleration.

 

LOGO

Ventures

Our ventures provide well-known services nationwide:

999: we handle 999 and 112 (the European equivalent) calls on BT and other CPs’ behalf. In 2017/18, we answered more than 32 million 999 and 112 calls. Despite the fires, terrorism incidents and bad weather that hit the UK, we answered these calls in an average time of 0.45 seconds – a big achievement.

Next Generation text calls: we deal with the next generation text calls that support deaf, hard of hearing or speech-impaired people. We answered 700,000 calls in 2017/18.

Directory Enquiries: we offer six services. They include 118 500 (for people to get listed phone numbers easily) and 195 (for directory access for people who can’t use a phone book due to disability).

Payphones: we provide most of the UK’s payphones, whether in public places or on private premises. In 2017, we launched InLinkUK, our new digital kiosks, see page 101.

 

 

 
100    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

The Phone Book: we deliver this to 21.7m UK homes and businesses. Roughly 200,000 UK businesses advertise in the Phone Book’s print and digital editions.

Our other ventures are more enterprise-oriented:

BT Cables: we manufacture, source and supply cabling for telcos, railways and other industries.

BT Fleet: we source, manage and maintain BT’s fleet of 33,000 vehicles. And we manage a further 58,000 vehicles for brands like the AA and National Grid.

BT Redcare: we link on-site alarm systems and central alarm receiving centres to secure more than 200,000 UK homes and businesses.

BT Supply Chain: we hold and dispatch products like mobile phones and smart meters. For customers with big field engineering teams, we manage vehicles, supply engineers, return any surplus supplies to base and provide real-time data for route management.

Tikit: we provide IT solutions to law and accountancy firms in the UK. We sell to more than two-thirds of the top 100 law firms, and across Europe, North America and Australia.

Messaging: we offer bulk text messaging to major UK and public sector customers. This year we sold 2.7 billion texts (25% more than last year). We also sent 0.5 billion text appointment reminders and alerts for NHS patients and staff.

Performance in the year – strategic

 

  LOGO   Delivering great customer experience

We’re making progress in giving our customers a better and simpler experience.

Net satisfaction measures our customers’ views on how we’re doing. It’s the difference between those who score us very high (9+) and those who score us lower (six or less) on the net promoter scale of 0-10.

During the year we improved our website and online service platforms. For example, we launched a new online capability for buying Ethernet services online – meaning faster and simpler ordering. We also improved our Fleet Solutions booking experience and the quality of our information updates for our customers. These initiatives boosted net satisfaction, up 4.3 points from last year.

Our Right First Time measure continues to improve, increasing 3.4% on last year. This was helped by us achieving 100% of contractual milestone dates for Managed Ethernet commitments during Q4, and a 9% improvement in our Ethernet delivery to first customer promise date.

  LOGO  

Investing for growth                                 

This year we’ve invested in both new connectivity options for wholesale networks and in the services to run those networks. Looking ahead, we’re implementing a new strategy for our ventures and for the Internet of Things for the wider BT Group.

Wholesale

We’re developing our sales channels, changing our sales organisation and investing more in people, processes and systems.

Ventures

In fleet, we bought SEV (a mobile vehicle maintenance business) and integrated it with our fleet operations. We grew our team of mobile technicians by 18%. And we launched a suite of mobile apps: driver daily defect checker, self-service booking, accident management and garage locator.

 

LOGO

In supply chain this year, we finished integrating Pelipod (the smart locker company we bought in 2016). We installed 264 Pelipod-lockers and 2,518 Pelipod-boxes at 332 sites. And we established a nationwide network for field operations – supporting BT engineers and external customers like EDF Energy.

In payphones, we launched InLinkUK in June 2017. These kiosks replace old phone boxes and provide free digital services for the public and advertising for businesses. They feature the UK’s fastest free public wi-fi and a pair of 55” HD digital displays. There are now 138 InLink kiosks installed in London and Leeds with hundreds more due in 2018/19.

Our new Internet of Things team is engaging with major customers and partners across BT Group. Building on our partnership with the Williams F1 team, we recently hosted a transport ecosystem event for 100+ customers.

 

 

 
101    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Wholesale and Ventures continued

    

 

The team also supports internal IoT initiatives to improve customer experience and cut costs and carbon emissions. There have been initiatives in EE datacentres, trials for smart building solutions and solutions to track BT’s fleet.

 

  LOGO  

Transforming our costs

Ongoing cost transformation projects continued to save us money. We’ve:

 

audited, renegotiated and consolidated suppliers, especially in new areas of Wholesale and Ventures

 

consolidated old or end-of-life platforms

 

reviewed our structure to make sure we’re the right size and fit for what our customers need.

Performance in the year – operating

Our product mix is changing. Customers used traditional products less, as expected. But that was balanced by a healthy order book and growing revenues in other areas.

This year we signed £1,418bn of orders. They included:

 

extending our Managed Services Contract with Virgin Media to operate its UK voice network

 

rolling out a new managed service contract with InLinkUK

 

signing a multi-year product and professional services framework deal with KCOM

 

deploying IoT asset tracking solutions for logistics and utility customers

 

delivering a new MVNO partnership with China Mobile

 

signing a new multi-year deal with Daisy to manage its end-to-end supply chain and logistics.

Review of last year’s priorities

 

   What we said   What we did

  Start deploying our

  new digital street   kiosks.

 

InLinkUK launched in June 2017.

There are now 138 kiosks installed in London and Leeds – with hundreds more due across the UK in 2018/19.

 

     

Expand our managed services capacity, to help customers run their networks and operations.

 

  We launched our new portfolio of Professional Services.

Help mobile network operators prepare for the next generation of 5G networks.

  We’re providing advanced mobile- focused products and managed services to our mobile network operator customers as they deploy 4G networks and plan for 5G.
   

We’ve evolved our portfolio to include small cells and are deploying them at more than 50 UK sites. They’re used by mobile operators to improve 4G coverage and for future 5G capacity.

 

 

Add 4G mobile

 

 

We’re currently launching a new and

access to our hosted

  improved mobile application called

communications

  Office UC on our hosted Centrex

portfolio.

 

 

products.

 

Develop new solutions for the Internet of Things.

 

There are now IoT solutions in some datacentres. They’ve helped us anticipate and fix faults which might have affected broadband customers and optimise our energy consumption.

 

We’re rolling out components of our intelligent retail solution in our retail estate (around 600 EE stores) to

  improve customer experience and store
  operations.
  We’re developing more IoT propositions
  – with major product launches in the
   

coming months.

 

Improve customer experience – especially RFT delivery for Wholesale Ethernet and Hosted Communications Services.

 

RFT has increased significantly with a 3.4% increase in the year.

 

We improved Ethernet delivery by the ‘customer required-by date’ by 9%.

 

We delivered Managed Ethernet Access Service (MEAS) 100% on time during Q4.

       
 

 

 
102    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Performance in the year – financial

Revenue was down 5% compared with a 7% decline last year. This included £12m or 25% less transit revenue than the year before.

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

Revenue

         2,009            2,109            2,274  

Change in underlying revenue excluding transit adjusted for the acquisition of EE

     (4)%        (3)%         

Operating costs

     1,255        1,275        1,519  

EBITDA

     754        834        755  

Depreciation and amortisation

     311        306        253  

Operating profit

     443        528        502  

Capital expenditure

     229        226        209  

Normalised free cash flow

     509        587        536  

Revenue was down 5%, this reflects the market decline in legacy products partially offset by growth in Ventures.

Managed Solutions revenue declined 9% as MEAS saw a 13% fall. Mobile network operators have now largely completed the 4G build phase, so they added capacity at fewer sites and connected fewer new sites. This was partially offset by growth in other contracts.

Data and Broadband revenue was down 8%, due to the continuing decline in legacy Partial Private Circuits and price pressure in an increasingly competitive wholesale broadband market. Ethernet saw a 2% increase. Voice revenue was down 6% due to the market decline in call volumes.

Wholesale Mobile revenue was up 2% at £229m supported by growing data usage and more customers moving to 4G.

Ventures revenue of £321m was up 3% compared with last year. This was driven by growth in BT Fleet, both organic and through acquisition (for example the SEV acquisition that allows Fleet to have mobile repair capacity). Bulk messaging services also grew significantly. These were offset by reductions in BT Cables because of falling demand for copper cabling, and further reductions in our Phone Book, Payphones and BT Redcare businesses which continued to decline in line with their markets.

Operating costs were flat reflecting the change in product mix as higher-margin legacy products continue to decline.

EBITDA was down 10% on last year reflecting the lower revenue on high-margin legacy services, continuing migration to lower-margin IP services in Wholesale, and the change in product mix.

Depreciation and amortisation was up 2% (2016/17: 21%), primarily due to the BT Fleet vehicle replacement programme. Operating profit went down by 16% (2016/17: up by 5%).

Capital expenditure was up 1% and normalised free cash flow was £509m.

 

LOGO

Roll out new services in our wholesale and venture businesses

 

Continue the rollout of our digital kiosks (InLinkUK).

 

Keep expanding managed services.

Expand our growth portfolio

 

Keep building Internet of Things solutions and strengthening our position in this area.

 

Carry on developing and rolling out our nationwide final mile network.

Improve customer experience

 

Roll out a new programme to improve customer experience on our website and digital platforms.

 

Improve the multi-product experience.
 

 

 
103    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
104    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

LOGO

Another hugely eventful year at Openreach

It’s been a busy twelve months. We’ve been simultaneously laying the foundations for Britain’s ultrafast future; setting more ambitious targets for rolling out fibre-to-the-premises; and investing in a better and broader network.

And we’ve made big strides towards becoming the distinct, legally separate company within BT Group that we committed to after Ofcom’s Digital Communications Review (DCR) in 2017.

Decent broadband for everyone

This year we continued to grow our superfast broadband network. Today it delivers speeds of at least 24Mbps to more than 27.5 million premises. We were proud to do the heavy lifting on the Government’s commitment to make superfast available to 95% of UK homes and businesses by the end of 2017.

This is no mean feat. Few countries around the world can point to such a widespread superfast footprint. But everyone in Britain should be able to get decent broadband speeds and we’re still a few per cent short of good enough.

We won’t stop until we close the gap. And we fully support the Government’s plan to deliver a Universal Service Obligation that will give everyone the right to request 10Mbps broadband as a minimum by 2020.

Delivering an ultrafast future

Having achieved such widespread access to superfast broadband, it’s right that we shift our focus to the next generation of ultrafast (100Mbps+) infrastructure.

Let me be clear – we believe in an FTTP future. In fact I think it’s essential to the UK’s productivity and prosperity that we build a future-proofed digital network that will serve our people and businesses for decades to come.

This year we’ve made big progress – honing our skills, tools and techniques, taking our overall ultrafast footprint to more than 1.5m homes and businesses. Having consulted our communications provider customers during the summer, we now have an accelerated plan to make FTTP connections available to three million homes and businesses by the end of 2020. But we want to go a lot further – to 10 million premises and ultimately most of the UK. So we now have a ‘Fibre First’ approach to every network expansion decision we make.

We’ve begun work in eight major cities and I firmly believe that with the right conditions we can reach 10 million premises by the mid- 2020s and the majority of the UK thereafter.

We’ve also continued to innovate with Gfast technology. It will play an important role getting ultrafast speeds to people quickly and cost effectively.

Investing in our people

Improving the service we deliver will always be our top priority. I’m encouraged by the persistent progress we’ve made this year in cutting the number of faults, keeping missed appointments to a minimum and fixing the faults we find much faster.

We’ve kept investing heavily in our people, training and systems, and we hired 2,392 extra engineers to maintain our network and connect our customers throughout Britain. We’ll hire a further 3,000 this coming year in support of our ‘Fibre First’ plans. And we’ve introduced a lot of new training and career opportunities to help us develop and keep hold of the very best engineering talent.

A bright independent future

Openreach is a very different business from this time last year. We’re now a separate company, Openreach Limited, wholly owned by BT, with our own board responsible for setting strategy and overseeing performance.

We’re tracking well against all of the commitments BT made as a result of the DCR and we’re ahead on many, including our governance and rebrand.

I hope by now you’ll have spotted one of our new vans, or our people sporting the new Openreach identity – more and more are appearing every week. But the changes go far deeper than that.

We’re developing stronger relationships with our customers through our confidential consultations, and we’re forging closer ties with the industry, regulators and government for the good of the UK. We know there’s a lot more to do and we’re excited to be driving Britain’s digital revolution.

 

LOGO

Mike McTighe

Chairman

9 May 2018

 

 

 
105    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Openreach continued

    

 

We build the network that connects Britain’s homes and businesses to the future.

We’re responsible for providing services over the local access network (sometimes called ‘the last mile’), and installing and maintaining the fibre and copper communications networks that connect homes and businesses.

Communications providers (CPs) access our network on equivalent terms. That means they all get the same products, prices and levels of service. They use our network to deliver services ranging from home phone, broadband and TV to high-speed data connections for businesses of all sizes.

Delivering a more independent Openreach

Openreach has now been incorporated (Openreach Ltd). This follows the long-term regulatory agreement between BT and Ofcom under the Digital Communications Review (DCR). When all DCR preconditions have been met, Openreach will operate as a distinct, legally separate company within BT Group.

We now have more control of our strategy, investments and plans within a strategic and financial framework defined by BT, making it more autonomous, transparent, and accountable to customers and stakeholders alike.

Openreach local access network

More than 27.5m premises

can access superfast fibre

 

LOGO

Greater independence also strengthens our ability to work more closely with all our customers. These stronger partnerships will deliver a future communications infrastructure that will remain the foundation of the UK’s vibrant internet economy.

The DCR agreement with Ofcom is based on voluntary commitments from BT. Once they’re fully implemented, it means:

 

Openreach becoming a distinct company

 

a new Openreach board with an independent chair and majority of independent directors setting the direction and overseeing the company

 

executives being accountable to the new Openreach board

 

Openreach having control over strategy and budget allocation within an overall framework set by BT

 

Openreach consulting widely with communication providers to inform its network investments, including through a new confidential consultation phase

 

distinct Openreach branding.

Over the past 12 months, we’ve already taken big steps to meet the commitments quickly and work in a new way. They include establishing the Openreach board, consulting with customers on FTTP investment and launching a new, distinct brand. In fact we’ve delivered many of the commitments ahead of the original schedule agreed with the regulator.

Markets and customers

The UK has the highest share of GDP generated by the digital economy of any country in the G20. It also has higher superfast availability and take-up than any major European peer. We’re playing our part in this success story by building and running the largest superfast network in the country.

At the end of December 2017 there were 26m connected broadband lines in the UK. 80% of these – excluding Hull – use Openreach’s network. (The rest are mainly on Virgin Media’s cable network.)

Total UK broadband market

As at 31 March

 

LOGO

 

 

 
106    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

LOGO

Our customers are the communication providers (CPs) who provide communications services to homes and business across the UK. We also work closely with property developers building new properties to deliver our network to ‘new sites’.

There are 600 CPs using our network. They operate in three markets:

 

Consumer – made up of households using fixed-line broadband and home phone services. Our largest customers include BT Consumer, Sky and TalkTalk.

 

Business – consisting of the 5.5m businesses in the UK. Most of our customers serve business clients.

 

Infrastructure – including firms building network infrastructure to data centres and mobile cell sites, and property developers building new developments.

Recent market trends include:

 

strong and growing demand for superfast fibre as consumers’ lives become more data-hungry

 

major investment in CPs’ backhaul capacity – spurred by more data usage and network reach to make sure everyone gets superfast speeds

 

more demand from consumers for high-capacity and reliable connectivity, and from businesses investing in cloud computing and IoT

 

a dynamic mobile connectivity market which is investing in greater capacity and coverage – driving innovative solutions

 

a fast-growing data centre market, creating a new need for high-capacity circuits (1Gbps or more).

Competitors

Our main competitors also build networks. Virgin Media is the largest. Its cable network covers roughly half of UK homes, with plans to reach around 17m premises by 2019.

Other companies are building their own fibre access networks. CityFibre, Hyperoptic and Gigaclear are deploying fibre-to-the-premises across urban and rural areas, making our market more competitive.

In November 2017 CityFibre announced plans to bring FTTP to up to 5m premises by 2025, working in partnership with Vodafone.

In February 2018 TalkTalk announced it was investing in a joint venture with Infracapital to deploy FTTP to over 3m premises. Competitors in the business and infrastructure markets include Virgin Media, Colt Group and Vodafone.

Pricing, service delivery and product innovation remain competitive themes. ‘Price per Gigabit’ is falling because of intense competition – particularly in urban areas. New products like our OSA Filter

Connect reflect the market’s competitive nature and the need to innovate to best meet customers’ needs.

Products and services

We provide network access and engineering services. They deliver phone, broadband and higher bandwidth data services through four main products: copper access, fibre access, Ethernet and optical, and infrastructure solutions.

Copper access

 

Wholesale Line Rental (WLR) lets CPs offer phone services to their customers using our equipment and copper network. They pay for lines between our exchanges and their customers’ premises.

 

Local Loop Unbundling (LLU) provides CPs with a direct connection to the local network (or local loop). CPs can install their own equipment in, or near to, our exchanges, and use it to provide phone and broadband services to their customers.

 

LOGO

 

 

 
107    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Openreach continued

    

 

Fibre access

Our wholesale fibre product is called Generic Ethernet Access. We offer a few versions:

 

Fibre-to-the-cabinet (FTTC) uses fibre from the exchange to the street cabinet, then the existing copper network for the final link to customers.

 

Gfast uses fibre from the exchange to the street cabinet, then uses high performance equipment to generate ultrafast speeds over the existing copper network for the final link to customers.

 

Fibre-to-the-premises (FTTP) uses fibre all the way from the exchange to the premises. We also offer speed tiers for smaller businesses needing ultrafast speeds at less cost than Ethernet.

Fibre access allows us to offer superfast broadband (24Mbps+) via FTTC and FTTP and ultrafast broadband (100Mbps+) via Gfast and FTTP.

Ethernet and Optical high-bandwidth services

These are high-speed fibre connections. CPs use them to build and extend their networks, providing high-quality, high-bandwidth services to businesses and the public sector.

 

Ethernet Access Direct (EAD) offers competitive services – from 10Mbps to 10Gbps – to all UK businesses and infrastructure markets.

 

Optical Spectrum Services (OSS) are scalable wavelength solutions offering up to 100Gbps at any distance. In 2018 we launched OSA Filter Connect to offer good value high-bandwidth pricing with lower incremental scaling costs.

 

LOGO

Infrastructure solutions

CPs use our infrastructure solutions to build their own networks. Third parties can ask us to rearrange our network or work on their networks.

 

Flexible Co-mingling lets CPs put their equipment in our exchanges.

 

Physical Infrastructure Access (PIA) lets CPs use our ducts and telephone poles to roll out their own fibre networks. PIA has been available since 2011.

 

Mobile Infill Infrastructure Solution (MiiS) lets CPs install their radio equipment in special cabinets linked to antennas on telephone poles and use their spectrum to improve mobile coverage.

 

Network rearrangements help third parties progress their projects by moving or removing our network.

Performance in the year – strategic

 

  LOGO   Delivering great customer experience

The table on page 113 shows how we’re doing on service. It includes a few key measures called Minimum Service Levels (MSLs).

MSLs are quality of service standards for installation and repair which are set by Ofcom and increase annually. Every quarter we publish our performance data with extra levels of detail.

We recognise the MSLs represent the minimum service standard and we are set to deliver performance ahead of these. This year we have again delivered ahead of Ofcom’s copper MSLs.

On-time customer provisions are now at just under 95% – meaning nearly all our customers get service when they want it, significantly ahead of Ofcom’s MSL of 89%. Our average first available appointment date is well below our 12-day service level target.

 

LOGO

 

 

 
108    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Our investments in people and processes are working. They’re helping us keep up our performance during tough, high-demand patches like bad winter weather. We had fewer faults this year than last year. And we invested more than £30m to boost resilience and stop network faults rising like they have in the past.

We’re improving our customer service. There were 29.7% fewer missed appointments than last year (where we were responsible).

Customer satisfaction increased by 3.8% during the year, from a half-year baseline when our measures changed. And our Right First Time programme helped us to beat our targets to improve key service indicators by 3.7%.

Our service for large businesses keeps getting better. We’re providing more Ethernet circuits than ever before, and cutting the backlog of jobs. On average it takes us 40 days to install an Ethernet line, and we fix 95% of Ethernet faults in five hours.

In July 2017, the Competition Appeal Tribunal ruled there were errors in Ofcom’s Business Connectivity Market Review market assessment. So Ethernet MSLs were removed. Ofcom then used emergency powers to reimpose remedies on us – including MSLs – covering the period up to the end of March 2019.

We are currently outperforming four of the six temporary Ethernet

MSLs. We remain concerned that the two remaining MSLs aren’t operationally achievable. We’re making further representations to Ofcom about this but that in no way weakens our resolve to further improve Ethernet service.

 

  LOGO   Investing for growth

Our ambition is to deliver ultrafast speeds to homes and businesses – using FTTP and Gfast. We’re committed to bringing FTTP to 3m premises by 2020.

We’ll avoid building Gfast, only to rebuild later with FTTP – that would be a waste of money.

Our FTTP technology delivers ultrafast speeds of 1Gbps. It’s the technology of choice for all new homes and businesses. We’ve proposed to industry that 10m homes and businesses could have FTTP by the mid-2020s – under the right conditions. That means cutting the cost of rolling it out, the right market demand, and government support through regulation.

Gfast delivers ultrafast speeds of 300-500Mbps on our existing copper network. It’s a really important part of our ultrafast strategy and we’ll deploy it to millions of UK premises.

For CP customers serving larger businesses, we launched a new managed fibre product – OSA Filter Connect – in April 2018.

Also in April 2018, Ofcom announced its decision not to impose a regulated Dark Fibre product for business connectivity during the period to March 2019.

Investing in our people

More than 30,000 people work for Openreach, including network engineers and planners who look after our access network.

To help us better meet customer demands, we’ve hired 2,392 new engineers this year. This boost in our people has helped us to both deliver beyond our MSLs and reduce missed appointments for a second successive year.

Nearly 300 of these new engineers are focused solely on cutting network faults – contributing this year to 104,400 fewer faults. We trained around 400 as fibre engineers – delivering ultrafast to newly-built properties and government-funded BDUK contracts.

Our people are telling us they’re able to serve our customers better. Our latest people survey showed a 20% increase in pride in our service, and a 17% increase in confidence in the health of our network.

 

LOGO

We want our best engineers to stay in the field, developing their skills, delivering for customers and supporting others to do the same.

That’s why this year, in response to engineer feedback, we’ve created and launched Engineering Career Pathways. Part of this is the introduction of a new Senior Engineer role – top engineers who can solve the most complex customer problems and pass on their skills and experience to their teams.

We’ve also modernised our training centres to include more varied and realistic training environments. This helps engineers learn the skills they need to serve customers in lots of different scenarios, in one location. We’re building 12 new fibre training centres – the first of which opened in Bradford in March 2018.

 

 

 
109    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Openreach continued

    

 

LOGO

These things, and other interventions to positively influence our culture, have boosted our people’s engagement levels by 17% compared with last year.

 

  LOGO  

Transforming our costs

We’ve continued to review the way we work, simplifying our business to cut the cost of delivery while improving customer experience.

This year we:

 

introduced new ‘connectorised’ technology to make the job of connecting up FTTP simpler. This plug-and-play approach means we can deploy more engineers to build networks and connect customers cheaper and quicker

 

used innovative technologies to speed up network build. Our new mechanised diggers can dig a trench, lay fibre, then fill the trench back in automatically. And we’re using drones to connect up fibre cable in hard-to-reach locations

 

invested in new technology to go inside customer homes. This includes ‘invisible’ cable and extendable plug-ins, which cut the time spent connecting customers to fibre

 

trialled the use of mobile planners who can survey and plan jobs out and about on a tablet – meaning customers wait less time for service

 

launched an engineer accreditation scheme for fibre to help share learning on how to cut the cost of building networks and time to install.

Performance in the year – operating

Our superfast fibre network is now available to more than 27.5m premises. And 9.8m are now fibre customers. We also grew our Ethernet customer base by 11.6%.

Investing in fibre

We’ve helped the government achieve its ambition of making superfast speeds available to 95% of the UK. We’ve done it by over-delivering. We committed to bring superfast speeds to more than 730,000 premises between January and December 2017 (where it wasn’t already available). In fact, we brought speeds of 24Mbps or more to 774,000 premises.

We’re investing heavily in our fibre network. Superfast broadband

(of over 24Mbps) is today available to more than 27.5m homes and businesses nationwide.

Our FTTP network is the UK’s biggest. We delivered more FTTP this year than ever before. Our footprint of 567,000 premises, combined with over 1m on Gfast, means that more than 1.5m premises can get ultrafast.

We’re extending our FTTP rollout to reach 3m premises by the end of 2020. If conditions are right we’ll go well beyond that – bringing the benefits of FTTP to nearly all UK homes and businesses.

To stimulate adoption, we provide free FTTP to all developments of 30+ properties. Since April 2017, 99% of plots on these sites are contracted to be built with FTTP.

 

LOGO

 

 

 
110    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Extending our reach

We’ve completed the build of superfast fibre in the BDUK programme to more than 4.8m homes and businesses. To reach more remote communities, we’ve partnered with local bodies and the BDUK programme.

We’ve made available £129m of reinvestment funding, earlier than planned. And we’ve worked with UK Government and local body partnerships to secure further funding to bring fibre to even more homes and businesses.

 

LOGO

Our Community Fibre Partnerships programme uses co-funding to deliver high-speed fibre broadband. To date we’ve signed deals with more than 500 communities. And 250 now have superfast and ultrafast access for over 65,000 premises.

We work with communities to secure funding from lots of different sources. They include the Government’s ‘Local Full Fibre Network’ and ‘Better Broadband’ voucher schemes and property developers. We’ve helped more than 60 school communities through our grant scheme to get access to a faster network.

The table below shows how we’re doing against the priorities we set for ourselves last year.

Review of last year’s priorities

 

   What we said   What we did

Connecting Britain to the future

Expand our ultrafast broadband network with Gfast and FTTP, reaching 2m homes and businesses with FTTP by the end of 2020.

 

 

We’ve passed 1m premises with Gfast and 567,000 with FTTP. By 2020 our ‘Fibre First’ programme will give FTTP access to 3m premises. And we’re continuing to deliver our Gfast platform at scale.

 

Work to deploy FTTP using microfibre technology.

 

 

We’ve made the most of our existing underground ducts by blowing through microfibre. This means we can build the fibre network more quickly and cheaply.

 

Delivering a great customer experience

Achieve our RFT goal of 95% on-time installations by the end of 2017, ahead of Ofcom’s Minimum Service Level.

 

 

We achieved 95% on-time installations for new lines, significantly ahead of Ofcom’s Minimum Service Level.

 

Hire 1,500 frontline engineers to further improve service.

 

 

This year we hired 2,392 extra frontline engineers.

 

Drive higher investment in fibre skills and grow our Fibre Academy.

 

 

We trained around 400 new recruits as fibre engineers this year. And we modernised our training centres so engineers could learn the right skills.

 

Working with government and industry

Work with the Government to support its objective for universal broadband coverage.

 

 

In December 2017 the Government opted for a broadband Universal Service Obligation (USO) rather than the voluntary offer we’d proposed. We’ll now work closely with them, Ofcom and industry to develop the USO.

 

Launch a consultation with industry to shape future FTTP plans.

 

 

We consulted with customers and announced our ‘Fibre First’ programme. It will bring FTTP to 3m homes and businesses by 2020. We’ll begin building FTTP in eight major cities during 2018.

 

 

 

 
111    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our customer-facing units continued

Openreach continued

    

 

Performance in the year – financial

Revenue stayed flat. Strong demand for our fibre products was offset by regulatory price cuts and lower copper line rental. EBITDA fell 4% due to higher business rates and pension charges.

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

Revenue

         5,123            5,098            5,100  

Operating costs

     2,603        2,465        2,441  

EBITDA

     2,520        2,633        2,659  

Depreciation and amortisation

     1,360        1,369        1,301  

Operating profit

     1,160        1,264        1,358  

Capital expenditure

     1,658        1,573        1,447  

Normalised free cash flow

     1,048        1,349        1,415  

Revenue was flat (2016/17: flat). The 22% growth in fibre broadband was offset by a reduction in our copper line base and regulatory price cuts.

Operating costs went up 6% (2016/17: up 1%) driven mainly by a rise in business rates charged on network assets and higher pension charges.

EBITDA fell 4% (2016/17: 1% fall). Depreciation and amortisation was down 1% (2016/17: up 5%) and operating profit down 8% (2016/17: down 7%).

Capital expenditure was £1,658m, up £85m or 5% (2016/17: up £126m or 9%). This reflects our ongoing investment in fibre broadband speed and coverage which helped us contribute to the Government’s ambition to get superfast to 95% of the UK by December 2017.

This was after gross grant income of £179m (2016/17: £159m) directly related to building the BDUK programme. It was offset by an increase in our grant funding deferral of £110m (2016/17: £185m) because of good fibre broadband take-up.

Normalised free cash flow fell 22% (2016/17: 5%) due mainly to higher operating costs and capital expenditure.

LOGO

Investment in fibre technology

 

We’ll invest further in FTTP, starting in eight UK cities and building to 10m premises by the mid-2020s (as long as conditions are right).
We’ll launch Gfast at scale in the UK to millions of premises, as a critical component of our ultrafast strategy.

Decent broadband for all

 

We’ll support government aims to bring at least 10Mbps broadband speeds to everyone in the UK, and the Scottish Parliament’s aim to deliver 30Mbps speeds in Scotland.
Where we can, we’ll deliver superfast or ultrafast speeds higher than the minimum speed.

Improving customer experience

 

We’ll aim to speed up our fibre repair by 3% – ahead of Ofcom’s MSLs.
We’ll hire 3,000 extra engineers to support our ‘Fibre First’ initiative to deliver FTTP across the UK.
 

 

 
112    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Openreach performance against service responsibilities

LOGO   Improvement     LOGO   Steady performance – staying focused   LOGO   Improvement needed – with plans in place to get back on track

 

      Ofcom minimum standard              Movement                 2017/18           2016/17a    
Home and smaller businesses          
                           
Average time to install with an engineer (working days)         LOGO     13.29   13.65
                           
Average time to install without an engineer (working days)         LOGO     8.72   9.54
                           
Installations needing an engineer waiting 22 days or longer for an appointment         LOGO     0.2%   0.24%
                           
Average time for first available appointment date for a new installation (working days)         LOGO     7.87   7.65
                           
New lines needing an engineer visit not installed 31 days past target date         LOGO     1.00%   1.32%
                           
Average time to fix faults Maintenance level 1 (working days)         LOGO     2.14   1.23
                           
Average time to fix faults Maintenance level 2 (working days)         LOGO     1.66   1.80
                           
Faults not fixed after 31 days or more Maintenance level 1         LOGO     0.05%   0.55%
                           
Faults not fixed after 31 days or more Maintenance level 2         LOGO     0.07%   0.64%
                           
Home and smaller business MSLs          
                           
New lines installed on time (WLR3)      89%        LOGO     95.44%   93.50%
                           
New lines installed on time (MPF)      89%        LOGO     94.41%   93.76%
                           
First available appointment date for a new installation (working days) 12 days or less (WLR3)      79%        LOGO     92.10%   90.00%
                           
First available appointment date for a new installation (working days) 12 days or less (MPF)      79%        LOGO     91.90%   92.40%
                           
Faults fixed within agreed time Maintenance level 1      77%        LOGO     84.88%   83.39%
                           
Faults fixed within agreed time Maintenance level 2      77%        LOGO     80.37%   78.12%
                           
Larger business MSLs          
                           
Average time to install (working days)         n/m     40   n/m
                           
Delivery date certainty         n/m     78.4%   n/m
                           
Circuits provided in 30 working days         n/m     61.1%   n/m
                           
Circuits provided in more than 118 working days         n/m     6.6%   n/m
                           
Faults fixed within agreed time         n/m     95.2%   n/m
                           

n/m – The products and areas that Openreach is regulated in for Business Connectivity services changed in 2017/18, making the comparison not meaningful.

a The figures in last year’s Annual Report were for the fourth quarter, these figures are full-year figures for 2016/17.

 

 
113    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
114    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

We work with each of our customer-facing units. We create new products for them and make sure services evolve to meet their customers’ changing needs. And we make sure BT’s networks and systems stay reliable, resilient and secure.

There are more than 11,700 people in TSO. Most of them work in the UK, but we also have 3,300 people in 24 other countries. This year we hired more than 240 graduates and apprentices.

In the UK, most of our teams are based at Global Development Centres in Belfast, Bristol, Cardiff, Glasgow, London and Adastral Park in Suffolk; as well as Hatfield, Sheffield, Walsall and Oswestry.

 

LOGO

Our teams give vital support to the rest of BT.

TSO in action

Mobile coverage

We’ve extended both our 4G and ESN coverage.

LOGO  Read more on P36

EE integration

We’ve brought together BT and EE IT systems to reduce costs.

LOGO  Read more on P36

Patent filings

We’ve filed 97 applications for new inventions.

LOGO  Read more on P37

Products and services

We manage the critical infrastructure for BT’s products, services and internal systems. That means our IT systems, voice, data and TV networks. We also invent, design and develop new services for customers.

Our responsibilities

 

   Responsibilities   What we do

We’re responsible for BT’s technical strategy.

 

 

Covering our technology estate, IT systems, processes and networks. Everything we use to deliver our technology capabilities to the rest of BT.

 

We manage BT’s end-to-end technical delivery processes.

 

 

Working with the customer-facing units and BT Group.

 

We design, test, build and run BT’s main global physical asset – our network and its critical supporting infrastructure.

 

 

That includes the group’s broadband, Ethernet, VPN, internet, wi-fi and mobile platforms in the UK. It also includes all non-UK IP, data, voice, multimedia, cloud and transmission platforms.

 

 

We also deliver and manage the Emergency Services Network (ESN) contract. You can read more about our networks on page 35.

 

We design, build, test and run BT’s service and IT platforms.

 

 

Supporting services like TV and broadband, interactions with customers, and the services our people use to do their jobs. You can find out more on page 36.

 

We’re responsible for BT’s R&D and worldwide patent portfolio.

 

 

You can read more about our R&D on page 37.

 

We manage networks for many of the world’s top companies.

 

 

These companies depend on us for their communications.

 

We manage BT’s relationships with standards bodies.

 

 

Our job is to make sure national, regional and international standards support our commercial strategy.

 

 

 

 
115    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Our corporate units continued

Technology, Service and Operations continued

    

 

Our responsibilities continued

 

   Responsibilities   What we do

We combine the latest innovations from around the world, with work from our own world-leading researchers.

 

 

Running programmes to find new and exciting ways to use technology to generate revenues or cut costs.

 

We monitor cyber attacks on our networks and systems.

 

 

Enhancing our cyber defence capabilities and investing more in automatic detection and prevention systems.

 

Performance in the year – strategic

TSO helps deliver BT strategy.

We’re responsible for the technology that the rest of the group relies on. We are constantly on the lookout for ways to improve our networks, platforms and IT systems.

 

LOGO  

Delivering great customer experience

    

By developing technologies to enable new services (and make existing ones better) we’re transforming our customers’ experience.

We use two sets of measures to monitor how our network and platforms are doing.

This year we’ve improved our broadband performance score. That means broadband customers are getting better service despite higher traffic levels.

We’ve also improved our IT and network service availability score, making it easier for customers to do business with us.

We’ve diverted more than 90m unwanted or nuisance calls for the 2.5m customers using BT Call Protect.

Working with EE, we’ve driven the adoption of eSIM (electronic SIM) technology. Instead of being a removable card, eSIM sits on a chip inside a device – which lets smaller gadgets like watches connect to a mobile network. This technology was instrumental in the launch of the Apple Watch Series 3 on EE’s 4G network. The watch lets wearers leave their phone at home and still be connected.

LOGO  

Investing for growth

    

We’re investing in our network to provide greater speeds and capacity for our customers.

Thanks to our investments, we were able to satisfy peak demand in our core network of 9.75Tbps this year. And at Glastonbury festival we served EE customers with over 54TB of mobile data, twice as much as the year before.

 

LOGO

 

LOGO  

Transforming our costs

    

By removing old technologies and consolidating IT equipment we are trimming back our operating costs.

We’ve removed 100 System-X switches from our network – saving 60,000 tonnes of C02 and £6m on energy every year.

In our exchanges we’re continuing to install water-based adiabatic cooling. It’s more energy-efficient than the air-based systems of the past and costs less to run.

Performance in the year – operating

We never stop looking for new ways to maintain and improve our networks and service platforms.

We’ve reduced the group’s energy consumption. There are more details on page 55.

Our customers’ demand for data keeps rising. This year consumer data traffic jumped 45%. We’ve seen sustained, record levels over the last 12 months. So we’ve focused our investments on keeping performance and coverage levels high.

 

 

 
116    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

This year we completed one of the largest ever Global Services migration programmes. We worked with vendors, other service providers and some of our biggest multinational customers – updating network equipment to the latest versions, protecting and securing services for the future.

You can read more on page 35 about the improvements we’ve been making to our network, service and IT platforms.

The table below shows how we’ve done against the priorities we set out in last year’s report.

Review of last year’s priorities

 

   What we said   What we did

Enhance the UK broadband experience.

 

We’ve upgraded around 935 exchanges and switched more than 309,000 customers to faster broadband services overnight with no impact on their service. These customers now have a better service on more energy-efficient technology that’s cheaper to run.

 

Extend 4G coverage to support the ESN contract.

 

 

We’ve expanded our geographic coverage to over 90%, with 323 new sites deployed for the ESN.

 

Make our systems more reliable.

  We’ve improved our IT and network service availability.
   

And we’ve achieved 99.999% availability in our core network for broadband customers.

 

 

LOGO

LOGO

Improving customer experience

 

We’ll continue to drive Right First Time as our quality methodology.
We’ll enhance the ways customers can talk to us. We want them to be able to use the internet, mobile apps and Alexa-like voice-based interfaces for service queries.
To get deeper customer insights we’ll combine new tools with Big Data techniques.

Innovating for new products and services

 

We will create new converged products that seamlessly blend fixed, mobile and TV.
For business customers we’ll offer flexible software-based network solutions with powerful analytical capabilities.
We’ll work with industry partners to bring innovative products, services, devices and capabilities to our customers.

Investing in our network

 

We’ll use the latest FTTP innovations to improve how our ultrafast products perform and extend the reach of our NGA network platform.
While continuing to lead the way in 4G, we’ll begin deployment of 5G at pace across the country, enabling exciting new opportunities like Smart Cities and Industrial Automation.
We will increase network automation using telemetry and model-based technologies. This will improve network provisioning and capacity planning. We’ll also use more artificial intelligence technologies to manage the network.
 

 

 
117    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Group performance

Chief Financial Officer’s introduction

 

Strong results in EE and BT Consumer were offset by declines in our enterprise units. Our results were also impacted by the settlements we reached in respect of warranty claims under the 2015 EE acquisition agreement and the restructuring costs associated with our transformation programmes.

LOGO

 

 

Alternative Performance Measures

We assess the performance of the group using a variety of performance measures. These measures are not defined under IFRS and are therefore termed ‘non-GAAP’ measures. A reconciliation from these non-GAAP measures to the nearest prepared measure in accordance with IFRS is presented on pages 288 to 290. The alternative performance measures we use may not be directly comparable with similarly titled measures used by other companies.

 

Reported revenue decreased by 1% to £23.7bn. Our key measure of the group’s revenue trend, underlying revenuea excluding transit, was down 1.0%.

Our reported operating profit, which includes specific items, was up 7%. Our adjustedb operating profit was down 3% reflecting increased pension costs, business rates, sports rights and increased customer investment partly offset by reduced payments to other telecoms operators and cost savings.

Reported profit before tax was up 11% to £2.6bn and adjustedb profit before tax was £3.4bn, down 2%. Reported EPS of 20.5 pence was up 7% and adjusted EPS of 27.9 pence was down 3%.

 

a  Excludes specific items, foreign exchange movements and disposals.
b  Before specific items, which are defined on page 288.
c  Before specific items, pension deficit payments and the cash tax benefit of pension deficit payments.

Net cash inflow from operating activities was £4.9bn, down 20%, while normalised free cash flowc was £3.0bn, up 7% mainly due to favourable working capital movements.

Our specific items include a charge of £225m in relation to full and final settlements with Deutsche Telekom and Orange in respect of any warranty claims under the 2015 EE acquisition agreement, arising from the issues previously announced regarding our operations in Italy.

The first phase of our restructuring programme, which we announced in May 2017 and which focused principally in Global Services, TSO and Corporate Functions, is firmly on track. We have incurred costs of £241m, removing over 2,800 roles mainly from managerial and back office areas. This restructuring programme delivered savings of £180m in 2017/18.

We also remain firmly on track to deliver our EE integration targets, having delivered a run-rate of £290m of annual cost synergies by the end of 2017/18.

The next phase of our restructuring programme includes transforming BT’s operating model, driving productivity improvements in core UK operations, and repositioning Global Services as a more focused, digital business. This restructuring programme will deliver a reduction of c13,000 roles over three years, and a gross cash cost reduction of £1.5bn in the third year, with costs to achieve of £800m and two-year payback. The cost reductions will help offset near term cost and revenue pressures, provide capacity to invest in value enhancing projects and drive longer term profit growth.

 

LOGO

Simon Lowth

Chief Financial Officer

9 May 2018

 

 

 
118    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

Group performance

Summary financial performance for the year

 

Performance against our outlook

We achieved the financial guidance we set out at the beginning of the year for adjusted EBITDA and exceeded it for normalised free cash flow. We were below our outlook of broadly flat for underlying revenue excluding transit.

2017/18 performance against our outlook

 

     

Outlook provided

in May 2017

   Result  

Change in underlying revenue excluding transita

   Broadly flat      (1.0)%  

Adjusted EBITDAa

   £7.5bn–£7.6bn      £7.5bn  

Normalised free cash flowa

   £2.7bn–£2.9bn          £3.0bn  

Reported revenue decreased by 1% to £23.7bn. Underlying revenue excluding transit was down 1.0%, which was below our outlook of broadly flat.

Adjusted EBITDA decreased 2% to £7.5bn. This was within our outlook of £7.5bn–£7.6bn.

Normalised free cash flow was £3.0bn, up 7% and above our original outlook, mainly due to favourable working capital movements.

 

Change in underlying revenuea,b,c

     Down c2%  

Adjusted EBITDAa,c

     £7.3bn–£7.4bn  

Capital expenditured

     c£3.7bn  

Normalised free cash flowa

     £2.3bn–£2.5bn  
 

 

Revenue

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

Cash flow

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

 

 

Profit

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

Net debt

At 31 March

 

LOGO

 

 

a  Defined on pages 288 to 290.
b  Including transit, but excluding specific items, foreign exchange movements and the effect of acquisitions and disposals.
c  On an IAS 18 basis.
d  Excluding BDUK clawback.
e  Items presented as adjusted are stated before specific items. See page 288 for further details.
f  Calculated as though EE had been part of the group from 1 April 2015. From 2016/17, no separate measure is shown as EE was part of the group for the full years and there is no difference to the adjusted measures.
g See definition on page 289 and summarised cash flow statement on page 123.
 

 

 
119    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Group performance continued

Summary financial performance for the year continued

    

 

Outlook for 2018/19

For 2018/19, we expect underlying revenue to be down around 2% year on year mainly as a result of significant regulatory price reductions in Openreach, along with the possible consequential impacts on non charge controlled products. We also expect an impact from our decision to de-emphasise lower margin products, particularly in the enterprise businesses.

Following tougher minimum service levels and significant regulatory price reductions for Openreach coming into effect in 2018/19, along with the possible consequential impacts on non charge controlled products, adjusted group EBITDA in 2018/19 is expected to be in the range £7.3bn to £7.4bn.

Reported capital expenditure, excluding BDUK clawback, is expected to be around £3.7bn in 2018/19 and then to remain at that level in 2019/20 (on an IAS 17 basis) as the business increases network investment through Openreach’s Fibre First

Earnings per share

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

Proposed full year dividend

Year ended 31 March

15.4p

2018

15.4p

2017

programme and further 4G and 5G mobile network build. Having delivered normalised free cash flow in 2017/18 of £2,973m, almost £200m above the midpoint of our outlook, we expect normalised free cash flow for 2018/19 to be in the range £2.3bn to £2.5bn.

We have a comprehensive transformation programme in place to improve our operational and financial performance in what remains a competitive market environment, and we are increasing investment to drive convergence and sustain our network leadership. We are confident in our strategy and the benefits we expect from the decisive actions we are taking to strengthen our competitive position.

However, given the current market and regulatory headwinds and our investment plans, the Board has decided to hold the dividend unchanged for this year at 15.4p per share. The Board also expects to hold the dividend unchanged in respect of the next two financial years, given our outlook for earnings and cash flow over this period.

The Board remains committed to our dividend policy, which is to maintain or grow the dividend each year whilst reflecting a number of factors including underlying medium-term earnings expectations and levels of business reinvestment.

From this year, 2018/19, the interim dividend per share will be fixed at 30% of the prior year’s full year dividend per share.

We expect to buy back only a small number of shares, in connection with our employee share plans, in 2018/19 following the £221m purchased in 2017/18. This was in excess of the £100m initially expected for the 2017/18 buyback as we decided to take advantage of market conditions and the opportunity to purchase a significant number of shares in a single transaction by participating in the Orange offering in the first half of the year.

Transforming our costs

The first phase of our restructuring programme, which we announced in May 2017 and which focused principally in Global Services, TSO and Corporate Functions, is firmly on track. We have incurred costs of £241m, removing over 2,800 roles mainly from managerial and back office areas. This restructuring programme delivered savings of £180m in 2017/18.

We also remain firmly on track to deliver our EE integration targets, having delivered a run-rate of £290m of annual cost synergies by the end of 2017/18.

Our strategy will drive sustainable growth in value by focusing on delivering differentiated customer experiences, investing in integrated network leadership, and transforming our operating model. The next phase of our restructuring programme will deliver the transformation of our operating model. It will include driving productivity improvements in core UK operations, focusing on around 30 modern, strategic sites in the UK, and repositioning Global Services as a more focused, lower cost, digital business. This restructuring programme will deliver a reduction of c13,000 mainly back office and middle management roles over three years, and a gross cash cost reduction of £1.5bn in the third year, with costs to achieve of £800m and two-year payback. The cost reductions will help offset near term cost and revenue pressures, drive longer term profit growth, and provide the capacity to invest in value enhancing projects, including the recruitment of c6,000 new employees to support network deployment and customer service.

 

 

a  Items presented as adjusted are stated before specific items. See page 288 for details.

 

 
120    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Summarised income statement

 

Year ended 31 March

Before specific items

  

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

   

2016

£m

 

Revenue

     23,746       24,082       18,879  

Operating costsa

       (16,241       (16,437       (12,420

EBITDA

     7,505       7,645       6,459  

Depreciation and amortisation

     (3,514     (3,510     (2,631

Operating profit

     3,991       4,135       3,828  

Net finance expense

     (546     (594     (483

Associates and joint ventures

     (1     (9     6  

Profit before taxation

     3,444       3,532       3,351  

Taxation

     (671     (663     (607

Profit for the year

     2,773       2,869       2,744  

Revenue

Reported revenue, which includes specific items, was down 1%. Adjusted revenue was also down 1% at £23,746m. Both of these decreases were driven by challenges in our enterprise businesses, particularly in Global Services where ongoing challenging market conditions and lower IP Exchange volumes and equipment sales, weighed on our results.

We had an £87m favourable impact from foreign exchange movements and a £157m reduction in transit revenue. Excluding these, underlying revenue excluding transit was down 1.0% (2016/17: down 0.2%) which is below our expectation of being broadly flat in the current year.

BT Consumer revenue was up 3% due to strong growth in mobile, broadband, TV and sport. EE revenue was up 4% due to strong postpaid and fixed broadband revenue growth. Openreach revenue was flat with growth in fibre broadband offset by a reduction in copper line base and regulatory price cuts. Revenue was down 5% in Wholesale and Ventures as a result of market decline in legacy products partially offset by growth in Ventures. Business and Public Sector underlying revenue excluding transit was down 4% due to the decline in the fixed voice market and lower equipment sales, partially offset by continued growth in mobile and networking. Global Services’ underlying revenue excluding transit was down 8% reflecting ongoing challenging market conditions, lower IP exchange volumes and equipment sales in line with our strategy to reduce low margin business.

You can see a full breakdown of reported revenue by major product and service category in note 4 to the consolidated financial statements.

Operating costs

Reported operating costs were down 3% while adjusted operating costs before depreciation and amortisation decreased 1%.

Our adjusted operating costs before depreciation and amortisation were £16,241m, down £196m (2016/17: up

£4,017m) driven by decline in volumes and cost savings partially offset by increased investment in mobile devices, customer experience, higher business rates and pension costs. The increase in 2016/17 reflects the impact of the acquisition of EE.

Operating costs before depreciation,

amortisation and specific items

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

Net labour costs increased by 3% due to pay inflation, a higher pension operating charge and investment in right-shoring, partially offset by efficiencies and lower leavers’ costs. Payments to telecommunications operators (POLOs) were down 13% due to lower IP exchange volumes. Property and energy costs were up 7% due to higher business rates. Network, operating and IT costs were down 2% and programme rights charges increased by £49m to £763m, primarily reflecting our investment in BT Sport. For the group, other operating costs were down £101m or 2%, primarily reflecting lower revenue in our business and wholesale activities.

2017/18 operating costsc

 

LOGO

You can see a detailed breakdown of our operating costs in note 5 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

 

a Excluding depreciation and amortisation.

b Includes all other movements in costs.

c Excluding depreciation, amortisation and specific items.

 

 
121    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Group performance continued

Summary financial performance for the year continued

    

 

EBITDA

Adjusted EBITDA, which is before specific items, was down 2% at £7.5bn, which is in line with our 2017/18 outlook. This reflects the decline in volumes in our business and wholesale activities, higher business rates and pension costs, partly offset by cost savings.

You can see further details for EBITDA for the customer-facing units on pages 72 to 117.

Specific items

As we’ve explained on page 118, in this performance review we primarily explain our results before specific items reflecting the way we measure the sustainable performance of our business.

The table below outlines items we’ve treated as specific items:

 

Year to 31 March   

      2018

£m

   

      2017

£m

   

      2016

£m

 

Specific revenue

      

Italian business investigation

           22        

Regulatory matters

     23       (2     (203

EE fair value adjustment

                 70  

Specific revenue

     23       20       (133

Specific operating costs

      

EE acquisition warranty claims

     225              

Restructuring charges

     241              

EE acquisition and integration costsa

     46       215       116  

Property rationalisation costs

     28             29  

Regulatory matters

     26       481       203  

Italian business investigation

     22       238        

Out of period irrecoverable VAT

           30        

Profit on disposal of businesses

     (1     (16      

Specific operating costs

     587       948       348  

Specific net finance expense

     218       210       229  

Tax credit

     (87     (217     (166

Net specific items charged after tax

     741       961       278  

a 2017/18 and 2016/17 costs wholly relate to integration.

This year, specific items resulted in a net charge after tax of £741m (2016/17: £961m).

During the year, we reached full and final settlements with Deutsche Telekom and Orange in respect of any warranty claims arising under the 2015 EE acquisition agreement, arising from the issues previously announced regarding our operations in Italy. We recognised a £225m (2016/17: £nil) specific item charge for these full and final settlements. We also recognised £22m for investigation costs into our Italian business.

We’ve incurred restructuring charges of £241m (2016/17: £nil) in relation to our cost transformation programme.

We’ve reassessed our regulatory risk provision in light of recent regulatory decisions by Ofcom. Accordingly we have recognised £49m (2016/17: £479m) of net costs in relation to regulatory matters.

We incurred £46m of EE integration costs (2016/17: £215m). The costs include EE integration related restructuring and leaver costs in the year.

In addition to the above, we also treated a number of other items as specific, such as the net interest expense on pensions of £218m (2016/17: £209m). The increase from 2016/17 mainly reflects an increase in the BT Pension Scheme deficit over the year to 31 March 2017 partly offset by a lower discount rate as at 31 March 2017.

The tax credit on specific items was £87m (2016/17: £217m).

You can see details of all revenue and costs that we have treated as specific items in the income statement in the last three years in note 8 to the consolidated financial statements.

Profit before tax

Reported profit before tax (which includes specific items) was up 11% to £2,616m while adjusted profit before tax was down 2% at £3,444m.

We discuss depreciation, net finance expense and tax in later sections of this performance review.

Earnings per share

Reported earnings per share, which includes specific items, was 20.5p, up 7%, while adjusted earnings per share decreased 3% to 27.9p.

Adjusted earnings per share is one of our key performance indicators (see pages 24 and 25) and has decreased by 12% over the past two years. The graph below shows the key drivers of this decrease.

Adjusted earnings per share

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

 

 

 
122    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Dividends

The Board is proposing a final dividend to shareholders of 10.55p. This brings the full year dividend to 15.4p, unchanged from the prior year, and compares with an increase in the 2016/17 full year dividend of 10%. It will be paid, subject to shareholder approval, on 3 September 2018 to shareholders on the register on 10 August 2018.

Dividends per share

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

We have a comprehensive transformation programme in place to improve our operational and financial performance in what remains a competitive market environment, and we are increasing investment to drive convergence and sustain our network leadership. We are confident in our strategy and the benefits we expect from the decisive actions we are taking to strengthen our competitive position.

However, given the current market and regulatory headwinds and our investment plans, the Board has decided to hold the dividend unchanged for this year at 15.4p per share. The Board also expects to hold the dividend unchanged in respect of the next two financial years, given our outlook for earnings and cash flow over this period.

The Board remains committed to our dividend policy, which is to maintain or grow the dividend each year whilst reflecting a number of factors including underlying medium-term earnings expectations and levels of business reinvestment.

From next year, 2018/19, the interim dividend per share will be fixed at 30% of the prior year’s full year dividend per share.

We’ve set out our dividend expectations for 2018/19 in our Outlook on page 119.

Cash flow

We generated a net cash inflow from operating activities of £4,927m and normalised free cash flow of £2,973m, up £191m or 7%, which is above our outlook for the year, mainly due to working capital phasing.

Free cash flow

Normalised free cash flow increased 7% to £2,973m, mainly due to favourable working capital phasing.

The net cash cost of specific items was £828m (2016/17: £205m). This included payments related to the settlement of warranty claims arising from the 2015 EE acquisition agreement of £225m (2016/17: £nil), regulatory payments of £267m (2016/17: £3m) primarily reflecting payments in respect of

 

Deemed Consent, restructuring payments of £193m (2016/17: £51m) and EE integration cost payments of £54m (2016/17: £72m).

Summarised cash flow statement

 

Year ended 31 March

Before specific items

  

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

   

2016

£m

 

EBITDA

     7,505       7,645       6,459  

Capital expenditurea

       (3,341       (3,119       (2,431

Net interest

     (548     (622     (541

Taxationb

     (582     (661     (459

Working capital movements

     (170     (382     (12

Other non-cash and non-current liabilities movements

     109       (79     82  

Normalised free cash flow

     2,973       2,782       3,098  

Cash tax benefit of pension deficit payments

     109       110       203  

Payments in respect of acquisition of spectrum

     (325            

Specific items

     (828     (205     (232

Free cash flow

     1,929       2,687       3,069  

Pension deficit payments

     (872     (274     (880

Dividends

     (1,523     (1,435     (1,075

Disposals and acquisitions

     (23     51       (3,379

Share buyback programme

     (221     (206     (315

Proceeds from issue of own shares

     53       70       90  

(Increase) reduction in net debt from cash flows

     (657     893       (2,490

Net debt at 1 April

     (8,932     (9,838     (5,113

(Increase) reduction in net debt from cash flows

     (657     893       (2,490

Non-cash movements

     (38     13       (2,235

Net debt at 31 March

     (9,627     (8,932     (9,838

a Net of government grants.

b Excluding cash tax benefit of pension deficit payments.

Free cash flow, which includes specific item outflows of £828m (2016/17: £205m), payments in respect of the acquisition of spectrum of £325m (2016/17: £nil) and a £109m (2016/17: £110m) tax benefit from pension deficit payments, was £1,929m (2016/17: £2,687m). We made pension deficit payments of £872m (2016/17: £274m) and paid dividends to our shareholders of £1,523m (2016/17: £1,435m).

We spent £221m (2016/17: £206m) on our share buyback programme to help counteract the dilutive effect of our all-employee share option plans maturing. This includes the £200m spent following a sell-down by Orange of its BT shares which we took advantage of given the current market conditions and the opportunity to purchase a significant number of shares in a single transaction. Exercises of share options generated proceeds of £53m (2016/17: £70m).

You can see a reconciliation to normalised free cash flow from the net cash inflow from operating activities, the most directly comparable IFRS measure, on page 289.

 

 

 
123    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Group performance continued

Summary financial performance for the year continued

    

 

Capital expenditure

We continue to invest in our strategy of network leadership, across both fixed and mobile networks, to deliver differentiated customer experience and transform our cost base.

For the year, our capital expenditure, inclusive of net grant deferral was £3,522m (2016/17: £3,454m, 2015/16: £2,622m). The table below shows the split of our investments by major category.

Capital expenditurea

Year ended 31 March

 

LOGO

 

a  Capacity/network includes BDUK grant funding deferral of 2017/18: £112m, 2016/17: £188m and 2015/16: £229m.
b  The comparative information of the current period results has been revised to reflect the latest internal categorisation.
c  2016/17 is the first full year including EE Ltd.

In recent years we’ve prioritised our capital expenditure to underpin our strategy, and to expand coverage and capacity whilst enhancing the speed and resilience of both our fixed access network and our mobile network. Key investments in 2017/18 include:

Capacity/network investment, proactive investment in our integrated network to:

improve the coverage and reliability of our superfast broadband network, including extending the reach of superfast broadband to rural areas under the BDUK programme. We’ve now passed more than 27.5m homes and businesses representing over three-quarters of UK premises
increase the deployment of ultrafast broadband, across both FTTP and Gfast technologies, with over 1.5m of ultrafast homes to date
enhance and expand our mobile network coverage, speed and capacity, including the delivery of the ESN contract
deliver a truly integrated network that supports converged products and services.

Customer driven investment that directly

generates revenue from:

continued development of customer contract-specific infrastructure for our UK and global clients
deployment of Ethernet and broadband connections for homes and businesses, including reduction in the existing workstacks.

Systems/IT investments that develop:

differentiated customer experience
new products and services
transformation initiatives to drive cost savings.

Non-network infrastructure that covers, for example:

investment in our property estate
power and cooling investments to drive energy savings
specialist vehicle replacement.

Capital expenditure was £3,522m (2016/17: £3,454m). This consists of gross expenditure of £3,596m (2016/17: £3,426m) which has been reduced by net grant funding of £74m (2016/17: £28m increase in net grant deferral). We have recognised gross grant funding of £168m (2016/17: £160m) in line with network build, re-invested grant funding of £18m (2016/17: £nil) and also deferred £112m (2016/17: £188m) of the total grant funding to reflect an increase in the base case take-up assumption to 41% following our review of the level of customer take-up. The increase in take-up assumption shows the high demand on our fibre network driven by customers taking advantage of faster speeds to consume more data. Grant funding deferral repaid throughout the year was £4m, giving a balance at 31 March 2018 of £536m (Q4 2016/17: £446m).

Of the total group capital expenditure, £90m (2016/17: £69m) is related to the integration of EE. Additionally, £154m (2016/17: £272m, 2015/16: £248m) was invested outside of the UK. Capital expenditure contracted but not yet incurred was £993m at 31 March 2018 (2016/17: £889m, 2015/16: £922m).

Depreciation and amortisation

Depreciation and amortisation is flat at £3,514m (2016/17: £3,510m, 2015/16: £2,631m).

 

 

 
124    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Net debt

Net debt increased by £695m to £9,627m, reflecting our investments for the future of our business including research and development, sports and TV content, supporting our pension funds and funding our share buyback programme. We have also paid progressive dividends to our shareholders.

Gross debt, translated at swap rates and excluding fair value adjustments, at 31 March 2018 was £13,175m. This comprises term debt of £12,401m, finance leases of £219m and other loans of £555m.

Debt maturities in June 2017, December 2017 and January 2018 resulted in a total cash outflow of £1,399m.

We issued bonds of £2,025m in June 2017 and £1,728m in November 2017 to generate funding for general corporate purpose. These issuances have resulted in an increase in our current investments and cash and cash equivalents to £3,550m.

 

 

The table below shows the key movements in net debt over the past two years.

 

LOGO

 

 
125    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Group performance continued

Summary financial performance for the year continued

    

 

Financing and debt maturity

The main source of our cash inflow in recent years has been the cash generated from our operations.

During the year we cancelled a £1.5bn committed facility. This facility provided us with a bridge to capital market issuance and was cancelled in June 2017 when we issued Euro bonds in the debt capital markets. Our £2.1bn facility with 14 high quality syndicate banks (£150m each) remains undrawn at 31 March 2018. This facility matures in September 2021.

We have term debt of £1,406m, at swap rates, and other debt of £575m maturing in 2018/19.

 

LOGO

 

Net finance expense

Reported net finance expense has decreased £40m to £764m. Adjusted net finance expense of £546m also decreased by £48m.

We’ve shown below an overview of our average gross debt, investments and cash balances, and net debt and the related weighted average interest rates over the past three years. The weighted average interest rate on net debt reduced from 5.9% to 5.8% as the new debt issuances are at a lower rate than the existing debt.

You can see a reconciliation of net finance expense to net interest cash outflow in note 26 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Year ended 31 March

Before specific items

  

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

Average gross debt

       12,462          12,217            9,030  

Weighted average interest rate on gross debt

     4.2%        4.6%        5.4%  

Average investments and cash balances

     3,528        2,817        2,616  

Weighted average interest rate on investments

     0.2%        0.3%        0.4%  

Average net debt

     8,934        9,400        6,414  

Weighted average interest rate on net debta

     5.8%        5.9%        7.4%  

 

a  Excludes interest relating to unwinding of discount on provisions and derivatives not in a designated hedge relationship.

Taxation

Our effective tax rate before specific items was 19.5% (2016/17: 18.8%). We paid income taxes of £473m (2016/17: £551m).

Our tax contribution

Our tax strategy sits at the heart of our business responsibility agenda. It ensures that we pay our fair share of taxes back into the societies in which we operate, and that we conduct our tax affairs ethically and with integrity. It is published at btplc.com/Purposefulbusiness/Ourapproach/Ourpolicies/ BTTaxReport2018.pdf.

We are proud to be a major contributor of taxes to the UK economy. In 2017 we bore UK taxes of £1,065m and collected £2,956m of taxes. The One Hundred Group 2017 Total Tax Contribution Survey ranked us as the 5th highest contributor in the UK.

We paid UK corporation tax of £374m. We benefited from £111m of EE’s historical tax losses (2016/17: £117m) and £217m from tax deductions associated with employee pension and share schemes (2016/17: £110m).

 

 

 
126    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Tax expense

Our tax expense recognised in the income statement before specific items was £671m (2016/17: £663m). In addition we recognised a £345m tax expense (2016/17: £445m credit) in the statement of comprehensive income, principally in relation to our pension scheme.

We expect our income statement effective tax rate before specific items to be around the UK rate of corporation tax, as the majority of our business occurs in the UK. In the current year, our rate has been increased by the impact of US tax reform.

The UK tax rate will fall from 19% to 17% on 1 April 2020, which should reduce our expected effective tax rate. Recognition of further deferred tax assets on historical overseas tax losses would also reduce our future rate. Changes to our estimates of uncertain tax positions may increase or reduce our future rate.

 

Year ended 31 March

Before specific items

  

2018

%

   

2017

%

   

2016

%

 

Tax at UK statutory rate

           19.0             20.0             20.0  

Non-UK results taxed at different rates

     0.2       0.3       (0.2

Net permanent differences

     0.6       0.7       0.3  
     19.8       21.0       20.1  

Changes to prior year estimates

     (0.1     (1.1     (2.5

Deferred tax accounting for non-UK losses

     (0.2     (1.1     0.5  

Effective tax rate

     19.5       18.8       18.1  

We have booked a tax benefit of £37m in respect of UK patent incentives (2016/17: £39m).

Key tax risks

Our key uncertainties are whether EE’s tax losses will be available to us, whether our intra-group trading model will be accepted by a particular tax authority and whether intra-group payments are subject to withholding taxes.

Additionally we have extensive and long standing UK operations that necessarily require the use of estimates in calculating our tax liabilities. We routinely work with HMRC to validate these estimates.

Tax losses

We have an asset on our balance sheet of £183m relating to tax losses. This relates mainly to historical tax losses acquired with EE. We expect to be able to use this against future profits of EE.

In addition we have £4.0bn of income tax losses that we’ve not given any value to on our balance sheet. We might be able to use these losses to offset future profits, however we currently do not consider this probable. We also have £16.9bn of UK capital losses, which we have no expectation of being able to use.

We’ve given more details in note 9 to the consolidated financial statements.

Summarised balance sheet

Our balance sheet reflects our significant investment in the network infrastructure assets that are the foundation of our business, as well as the working capital with which we manage our business day by day. It also reflects the longer-term strategy with which we finance our investment, and our obligation to the pension funds.

 

At 31 March

  

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

   

Movement

£m

 

Property, plant & equipment, software and telecommunications licences

     21,283       20,884       399  

Goodwill and other intangible assets

     10,164       10,643       (479

Other non-current and current assets

     2,350       3,067       (717

Trade and other receivables

     4,331       4,195       136  

Investments, cash and cash equivalents

     3,550       2,048       1,502  

Total assetsa

     41,678       40,837       841  

Loans and other borrowings

     (14,275     (12,713     (1,562

Trade and other payables

     (7,168     (7,437     269  

Other current and non-current liabilities

     (2,246     (2,398     152  

Provisions

     (1,055     (1,161     106  

Deferred tax liability

     (1,340     (1,240     (100

Pensions, net of deferred tax

     (5,290     (7,553     2,263  

Total liabilities

       (31,374       (32,502        1,128  

Total equity

     10,304       8,335       1,969  

 

a  Excluding deferred tax asset relating to BT’s defined benefit pension schemes.

Our core fixed and mobile network infrastructure is included within property, plant and equipment, software and telecommunications licences. These assets were held at a net book value of £21.3bn at 31 March 2018. The net increase of £399m in the year primarily reflects capital expenditure of £3,522m exceeding the related depreciation and amortisation charge of £3,134m.

Goodwill and other acquisition-related intangible assets decreased by £479m, primarily reflecting the amortisation of customer relationships.

 

 

 
127    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Group performance continued

Summary financial performance for the year continued

    

 

We review the recoverable amounts of goodwill annually across our cash generating units which hold goodwill, which are BT Consumer, EE, Business and Public Sector, Global Services, and Wholesale and Ventures, and are satisfied that these support the carrying value of goodwill (see note 12 to the consolidated financial statements).

Other non-current and current assets and liabilities relate primarily to our financial instruments, which we’ve described in note 27 to the consolidated financial statements.

Trade and other receivables increased by £136m to £4,331m while trade and other payables of £7,168m were £269m lower. Investments, cash and cash equivalents, loans and other borrowings are reconciled to net debt of £9,627m in note 25 to the consolidated financial statements. We’ve discussed net debt on page 125.

Provisions decreased by £106m to £1,055m mainly due to a decrease in regulatory provisions due to Deemed Consent payments made during the year. We have a significant property portfolio which includes both office buildings and former telephone exchanges (see page 37). Property provisions, which mainly comprise onerous lease provisions, amounted to £294m. There are also asset retirement obligations of £71m relating to leased mobile sites forming part of the EE network. You can find more information about these provisions in note 19 to the consolidated financial statements.

We’ve shown deferred tax movements in note 9 to the consolidated financial statements. Pensions, net of deferred tax, decreased by £2.3bn to £5.3bn and are discussed below.

Pensions

Overview

We provide a number of retirement plans for our employees:

The BT Pension Scheme (BTPS), a defined benefit plan in the UK, is the largest of these plans. Although closed to new members since 2001, at 31 March 2018 the BTPS had around 30,000 active members, 202,500 pensioners and 60,500 deferred members. In March 2018, BT announced the closure of Sections B and C of the BTPS to future benefit accrual (which represents over 99% of the BTPS active membership), having reached agreement with the relevant Unions. BT currently expects to close the BTPS to future accrual from 30 June 2018 when employees will join the BT Retirement Savings Scheme (BTRSS), for future pension accrual.
The BTRSS is a contract-based, defined contribution arrangement operated by Standard Life. This is the current arrangement for UK employees who joined BT after 1 April 2001. It has around 35,000 active members. As part of the recent review of pension benefits, BT will increase its standard maximum contribution rate to 10% for employees building up benefits in the BTRSS, taking effect from 1 June 2018.
EE operates the EE Pension Scheme (EEPS), which has a defined benefit section that is closed to future accrual and a defined contribution section which has around 11,500 active members.
We also maintain retirement arrangements around the world with a focus on these being appropriate for the local market and culture.

The BTPS, BTRSS and EEPS are not controlled by the Board. The BTPS and EEPS are managed by separate and independent Trustee bodies while savings in the BTRSS are managed directly by members.

Details of the governance of the BTPS, its financial position and the performance of its investments are available in the BTPS Annual Report published by the Trustee in October 2017, on the BTPS Trustee website (btpensions.net).

We’ve given more information on our pension arrangements, on the funding and accounting valuations and the recent review of pensions benefits in note 20 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

 

 
128    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
  THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   

 

   

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

BTPS funding valuation and future funding obligations

The funding of the BTPS is subject to legal agreement between BT and the Trustee of the BTPS and is determined at the conclusion of each triennial valuation. The most recent triennial funding valuation at 30 June 2017 and the associated deficit contribution plan was agreed with the Trustee in May 2018.

At 30 June 2017, the market value of assets was £49.1bn and the funding deficit was £11.3bn. There are a wide range of assumptions that could be adopted for measuring pension liabilities. Legislation requires that this deficit is based on a prudent view – for example, assuming a lower future investment return than might be expected in practice.

The deficit will be met over a 13 year period, maintaining the remaining period of the previous recovery plan. The deficit contributions have three components:

Payments within the three years to 31 March 2020 totalling £2.1bn, in line with the amount due under the previous recovery plan. £850m of this was paid in March 2018 and the remaining £1,250m is to be paid by 30 June 2019.
A further £2.0bn contribution, due to be funded from the proceeds of the issuance of bonds which will be held by the BTPS. The bonds will be issued as soon as practicable.
For the 10 years from 1 April 2020 to 31 March 2030, annual payments of around £900m.

Accounting position under IAS 19

The accounting deficit, net of tax, decreased over the year from £7.6bn to £5.3bn. The movements in the deficit for the group’s defined benefit plans are shown below.

Key movements in IAS 19 deficit

 

LOGO

The actual investment return in the year to 31 March 2018 of around 2.4% was broadly in line with the discount rate assumption at 31 March 2017.

The actuarial gain on liabilities in 2017/18 was largely driven by an update to the discount rate model to better reflect yields on corporate bonds, reducing the liabilities by £2.1bn. Further detail is set out on page 241.

 

 

 
129    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Group performance continued

Summary financial performance for the year continued

    

 

Contractual obligations and commitments

We’ve shown in the table below our principal undiscounted contractual financial obligations and commitments at 31 March

2018. You can see further details on these items in notes 20, 25 and 30 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

At 31 March 2018  

Total

£m

   

Less

than

1 year

£m

   

Between

1 and

3 years

£m

   

Between

3 and

5 years

£m

   

More

than

5 years

£m

 

Loans and other borrowingsa

      13,983       2,254       2,492       1,469       7,768  

Finance lease obligations

    219       18       32       38       131  

Operating lease obligations

    6,597       600       1,063       949       3,985  

Capital commitments

    993       977       15       1        

Other commitments

    362       213       141       8        

Device purchase commitments

    262       260       2              

Programme rights commitments

    2,823             663       1,703       457  

Pension deficit obligations

    12,374       2,025       2,191       1,808       6,350  

Total

    37,613       6,347       6,599       5,976       18,691  

a Excludes fair value adjustments.

We have unused committed borrowing facilities totalling £2.1bn. We expect that these resources and our future cash generation will allow us to settle our obligations as they fall due.

Adoption of new accounting standards

IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’

We adopted this standard on a modified retrospective basis. This means that on adoption we will recognise the cumulative effect of initially applying the standard as an adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings at 1 April 2018, ie the date of initial application. We are in the process of finalising the impact on transition at 1 April 2018 but we have estimated this will produce a cumulative increase in retained earnings of between £1.1bn and £1.5bn before tax. The corresponding impact will primarily be recorded as a contract asset and will lead to additional one-off cash tax payments equally split between 2018/19 and 2019/20.

IFRS 16 ‘Leases’

IFRS 16 ‘Leases’ will be effective for BT from 1 April 2019. We are planning to adopt IFRS 16 on a modified retrospective basis and the group will recognise the cumulative effect of initially applying the standard as an adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings at 1 April 2019. We are still in the process of quantifying the implications of this standard. However, our operating lease obligations set out in the table opposite, which are currently off balance sheet, will be valued in accordance with the requirements of IFRS 16 and recorded on balance sheet after adoption, along with a corresponding right of use asset.

IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’

IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ will be adopted concurrently with IFRS 15 and on the same basis. With the exception of the impact of recording expected lifetime losses on recognised IFRS 15 contract assets we do not expect the standard to have a material impact on our results. The effect of expected lifetime losses after IFRS 15 adoption has been included in the cumulative impact on retained earnings in the IFRS 15 section above.

More detail over our approach to these new standards is outlined in note 1 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

 

 
130    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

    

  Chairman’s governance report      132     
  Our governance framework      133                            
  Board of directors      134     
  The Board      136     
  Relations with shareholders      142     
  Reports of the Board committees      
    Audit & Risk Committee chairman’s report      144     
    Nominating & Governance Committee chairman’s report      150     
    BT Pensions Committee chair’s report      152     
    Committee for Sustainable and Responsible Business chair’s report      153     
    Investigatory Powers Governance Committee chairman’s report      154     
    Technology Committee chairman’s report      155     
  Report on directors’ remuneration      156     
    Remuneration Committee chairman’s letter      157     
    Focus on remuneration      158     
    Annual remuneration report      161     
    Remuneration policy      173     
  Directors’ information      181     
  General information      183     
  Financial statements      189     
  Additional information      287     

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Chairman’s governance report

 

 

LOGO

“We have embraced change and transformation across many areas of the business, and I believe BT is well positioned both to address its immediate challenges and to plan for the future.”

First, I would like to thank my predecessor, Sir Mike Rake, for the support and guidance he provided to me in my role as non-executive director before I became chairman on 1 November 2017. Sir Mike left a legacy of strong corporate governance and, before he left, had started to implement a number of important reforms I’ve been proud to continue and expand. We are already starting to see the positive effects of these across our business.

The Board adopted a refreshed set of delegations of authority. This has created clearer personal accountability and enabled better decision making at the top of the business. We are embedding the same principles across the group. The Executive Committee has replaced the Operating Committee, advising the chief executive or his delegate on the decisions for which they are individually accountable.

We have also created the BT Investment Board to provide recommendations and input to support the chief executive with his decision making on investment proposals.

As part of the DCR settlement with Ofcom, we have successfully created a more independent Openreach. Our agreement with Ofcom enhances the independence of the Openreach board, whilst maintaining the unit as an integral part of our business. We have created the BT Compliance Committee as a sub-committee of the Audit & Risk Committee to help ensure BT delivers the intended outcomes of the DCR settlement. As we look ahead, I believe we are in a strong position to address regulatory and structural challenges.

We have progressed well with our integration of EE into the BT group, to the point that we have agreed with Deutsche Telekom that the Integration Committee is no longer needed. The Integration Committee was therefore dissolved in October 2017.

Karen Richardson and Tony Ball will step down from the Board at the end of the 2018 AGM. I would like to thank Karen and Tony for their significant contribution to BT. We have begun a search process to replace the skills and experience that Karen and Tony bring to the Board, and will continue to strengthen our succession plans for the years ahead.

I would also like to thank the Board and executive team for all their efforts this year. We have embraced change and transformation across many areas of the business, and I believe BT is well positioned both to address its immediate challenges and to plan for the future. Indeed, I’m looking forward to the role we will all play in delivering this.

 

LOGO

Jan du Plessis

Chairman

9 May 2018

 

 

 
132    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

Our governance framework

Our governance framework is designed to support timely, effective decision making throughout our organisation.

 

LOGO

 

 
133    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Board of Directors

 

LOGO

Jan du Plessis

Chairman

Appointed chairman in November 2017 and on the Board since June 2017.

Age 64.

Skills and experience

Jan has significant experience on the boards of major UK public companies, having served as chairman and non-executive director of various FTSE100 companies across a range of sectors. Jan stepped down as chairman of Rio Tinto in March 2018 having served in that role since 2009. Until October 2016 he was chairman of SABMiller, a role he held since July 2015, having been with the company since 2014. He was also a director and senior independent director of Marks & Spencer from 2008 and 2012 respectively until March 2015.

Other appointments

None outside BT.

LOGO

Gavin Patterson

Chief executive

Appointed chief executive in September 2013 and on the Board since June 2008. Age 50.

Skills and experience

Gavin has experience in sales, marketing, technology and operations. He was previously CEO of BT Retail and from 2004 to 2008 was managing director of BT Consumer (BT Retail). Before joining BT, Gavin was managing director of the consumer division of Telewest (now Virgin Media). Prior to that he spent nine years at Procter & Gamble, rising to become European marketing director.

Other appointments include

Non-executive director of British Airways and a member of the CBI President’s Committee.

LOGO

Simon Lowth

Chief financial officer

Appointed to the Board as chief financial officer in July 2016. Age 56.

Skills and experience

Simon has experience in finance, accounting, risk, corporate strategy and mergers and acquisitions. He was CFO and executive director of BG Group before the takeover by Royal Dutch Shell in February 2016. Simon was CFO and an executive director of AstraZeneca from 2007 to 2013, and an executive director of ScottishPower from 2003 to 2007, and was appointed finance director in 2005. Prior to that, Simon was a director of McKinsey & Company.

Other appointments

None outside BT.

 

 

LOGO

Isabel Hudson

Independent non-executive director

Appointed to the Board in November 2014. Age 58.

Skills and experience

Isabel has experience in the financial sector as well as pensions, risk, control, governance and international business. Isabel was previously a non-executive director of The Pensions Regulator, MGM Advantage, QBE Insurance, Standard Life and an executive director of Prudential Assurance Company in the UK.

Other appointments include

Non-executive chair of National House Building Council and senior independent director of RSA Insurance. Isabel is also an ambassador for the disability charity, SCOPE.

LOGO

Mike Inglis

Independent non-executive director

Appointed to the Board in September 2015. Age 58.

Skills and experience

Mike’s technology experience includes serving on the board of ARM Holdings from 2002 to 2013, with roles including chief commercial officer, executive vice president and general manager of the processor division and executive vice president of sales and marketing. Prior to joining ARM, Mike worked in management consultancy with AT Kearney and held a number of senior operational and marketing positions at Motorola. Mike was previously a director at Pace.

Other appointments include

Non-executive chairman of Ilika and a director of Advanced Micro Devices.

LOGO

Karen Richardson

Independent non-executive director

Appointed to the Board in November 2011. Age 55.

Skills and experience

With a career over 30 years in the technology and software industry, Karen brings experience in technology having held a number of senior operating roles in both the public and private technology sector. She is a former adviser to Silver Lake Partners, was with NASDAQ-listed software company Epiphany Inc, latterly as chief executive, and has served on a number of corporate boards including VirtuOz, Proofpoint, Hi5 Networks, Convercent and AYASDI.

Other appointments include

Director of Exponent and Worldpay Group.

 

 

 
134    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

Key to membership of Board committees

 

ARC   Audit & Risk   EC     Executive   REM     Remuneration     Committee chair
                  
CC   BT Compliance   IPGC     Investigatory Powers Governance   CSRB     Sustainable & Responsible Business    
                  
PEN   BT Pensions   NAG     Nominating & Governance   TC     Technology    
                  
EAB   Equality of Access Board            

 

LOGO

Tony Ball

Independent non-executive director

Appointed to the Board in July 2009.

Age 62.

Skills and experience

Tony brings international business expertise in addition to financial, operational, sales, marketing and media experience. From 1999 to 2003 Tony was chief executive of BSkyB and until 2013 was chairman of Germany’s largest cable operator, Kabel Deutschland GmbH. He has held a number of senior executive positions in broadcasting and telecoms businesses in the UK, US and Continental Europe.

Other appointments include

Chairman of Ambassadors Theatre Group and Bité Group. Director of Banco Sabadell. Senior adviser to Providence Equity Partners and chairman of the advisory council of Portland PR.

LOGO

Iain Conn

Independent non-executive director

Appointed to the Board in June 2014.

Age 55.

Skills and experience

Iain has international experience, and an understanding of technology, energy and regulated consumer markets. Iain joined Centrica as chief executive in January 2015, having been with BP since 1986. From 2004 to 2014 Iain was executive director of BP and chief executive downstream from 2007 to 2014. Until May 2014, Iain was a non-executive director of Rolls-Royce for nine years, and senior independent director.

Other appointments include

Member of the CBI President’s Committee, chairman of the advisory board of the Imperial College Business School and member of the Imperial College Council.

LOGO

Tim Höttges

Non-independent, non-executive director

Appointed to the Board in January 2016. Age 55.

Skills and experience

Tim has international telecoms experience having been CEO of Deutsche Telekom since January 2014, and with the company since 2000. From 2009 until his appointment as CEO, he was a member of the board of management responsible for finance and controlling. From 2006 to 2009 he was a member of the board of management responsible for the T-Home unit. In this position, he was in charge of the fixed-network and broadband business, as well as integrated sales and service in Germany.

Other appointments include

Chairman of T-Mobile US and a supervisory board member of FC Bayern München AG and of Henkel AG & Co. KGaA.

 

 

LOGO

Nick Rose

Independent non-executive director

Appointed to the Board in January 2011 and senior independent director since March 2014. Age 60.

Skills and experience

Nick brings experience in finance, risk, control, governance and international business expertise. He was chief financial officer of Diageo prior to his retirement in December 2010, having joined the board in 1999.

Other appointments include

Chairman of Williams Grand Prix Holdings, senior independent director of BAE Systems and non-executive chairman of Loch Lomond Scotch Whisky.

LOGO

Jasmine Whitbread

Independent non-executive director

Appointed to the Board in January 2011. Age 54.

Skills and experience

Jasmine has experience in transforming large complex organisations in the UK and internationally and brings an understanding of corporate social responsibility and sustainable business. She was previously chief executive of Save the Children International and has a background in technology marketing.

Other appointments include

Chief executive of London First and non-executive director of Standard Chartered.

 

LOGO

Dan Fitz

Company secretary

Dan is the company secretary. He joined BT in April 2010 and was appointed company secretary in November 2012.

 

 

 
135    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

The Board

Leadership

   Read more about our Board directors and the skills and experience they bring to BT on pages 134 and 135.

 

LOGO

 

 
136    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

Board activities over the year

The Board is responsible for deciding the group’s strategy and overseeing its performance, while passing the responsibility for day-to-day operations to the chief executive. The Board is directly involved with approving major acquisitions, providing oversight and control, growing shareholder value and promoting corporate governance.

 

 Operational

 performance

 

  The chief executive provided an operational report at each Board meeting
  CEOs of customer-facing units and the CTIO presented updates on their respective business areas
  The Board reviewed customer experience performance.

 

 Governance and

 compliance

  Committee chairs reported on key matters discussed at the Board committees
  The company secretary reported on key governance developments at each Board meeting
  The Board reviewed and discussed feedback from the Board evaluation (see page 140).

The Board reviewed and approved:

  extensions to the appointments of Iain Conn, Isabel Hudson and Karen Richardson
  changes to committee membership (detailed in the committee reports) and terms of reference
  governance changes set out in the chairman’s letter on page 132
  the creation of the BT Compliance Committee as a sub-committee of the Audit & Risk Committee. See page 145 for more details.

 

 Finance and investor

 relations

  The chief financial officer presented a financial report at each Board meeting.

The Board approved the:

  quarterly financial results and press releases
  Medium Term Financial Plan
  2017 Annual Report and Form 20-F
  dividend policy
  tax strategy and control framework
  capital structure and liquidity
  settlement of warranty claims with Deutsche Telekom and Orange under the EE acquisition agreement for £225m.

 

 

 Strategy

We held a full strategy day in March which covered:

  market developments
  corporate strategy
  fixed and mobile network strategy
  Consumer strategy
  Global Services strategy.

During the year the Board also discussed:

  fixed and mobile network strategy
  TV, content and sports strategy
  customer experience strategy
  business transformation
  site strategy
  spectrum strategy.

 

 

 

 Audit and risk

  The chair of the Audit & Risk Committee reported to the Board on the proceedings of each meeting.

The Board approved:

  the Audit & Risk Committee’s recommendation to appoint KPMG as the external auditor, subject to approval by shareholders at the 2018 Annual General Meeting
  remuneration of our external auditors, for audit and non-audit work
  our Group Risk Register.

See our Audit & Risk Committee chairman’s report on pages 144 to 149 for more details.

 

 

 Stakeholders

The Board considered:

  customer experience
  health and safety reports
  organisational culture
  relationship with government and regulators including the implementation of the DCR settlement
  human rights
  pensions.

 

 

 

 

 

Attendance at meetings

This table shows each director’s attendance at Board meetings during the year. The chairman meets privately with independent non-executive directors before most scheduled Board meetings. Typically, directors who are unable to attend a Board meeting provide the chairman with their views and comments in advance.

 

a  Jan was appointed to the Board as a non-executive director on 1 June 2017 and became chairman on 1 November 2017.
b  Sir Michael Rake stepped down from the Board on 31 October 2017.
     Meetings
  Member  

Eligible

    to attend    

      Attended    

Jan du Plessis (chairman) a

  8   8

Sir Michael Rake (chairman) b

  7   7

Gavin Patterson

  10   10

Simon Lowth

  10   10

Tony Ball

  10   9

Iain Conn

  10   9

Tim Höttges

  10   9

Isabel Hudson

  10   10

Mike Inglis

  10   10

Karen Richardson

  10   9

Nick Rose

  10   9

Jasmine Whitbread

  10   9
 

 

 
137    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

The Board continued

Effectiveness

Director election and re-election

All directors will be proposed for re-election by shareholders at the 2018 AGM in line with the Code, apart from Karen Richardson and Tony Ball who will step down at the end of the 2018 AGM.

Length of appointment of chairman and non-executive directors

 

LOGO

All non-executive appointments can be terminated on three months’ notice and are subject to automatic termination if a director isn’t elected or re-elected by shareholders at the AGM. We include details of all directors’ contracts/letters of appointment in the Report on directors’ remuneration on page 172.

 

Training and information

We encourage all directors to keep their skills and knowledge up to date, and to help them we provide the Board and individual directors with any training they need. We take an equally proactive approach to management information, with the chief executive including business updates and insights in his regular report to the Board. These ensure directors have a sound understanding of BT’s operational matters, the competitive and regulatory environment that affects the group and the wider communications industry, group and business unit performance, investor relations and corporate responsibility. In 2017 we held a governance seminar to update the Board on recent developments, including corporate governance reform initiatives and the Market Abuse Regulation. The company secretary also provides briefings during the year on any significant developments in legal, governance and compliance areas.

The chairman works with individual directors to identify any specific training they need to successfully fulfil their role.

Non-executive directors regularly meet with management and increase their understanding of the business through formal briefing sessions. The chairman typically holds private sessions with our independent non-executive directors before Board meetings, and holds Board dinners before most Board meetings, which are also attended by the non-independent, non-executive director, the chief executive and the chief financial officer. We hold a dinner at least once a year for members of the Board with the Executive Committee.

Diversity of the Board

Regional experience

As well as experience in the UK, our directors also have the following regional experience:

 

LOGO

Gender diversity

 

LOGO

Balance of Board membership

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 
138    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Board induction

Following their appointment, directors take part in an induction programme designed to increase their understanding of our business. After we announced Jan du Plessis’s appointment in March 2017, Jan undertook a comprehensive induction programme which is described below.

Chairman induction

The chairman’s induction programme was designed to:

 

  build an understanding of our company, our people, our business and the markets in which we operate

 

  develop an understanding of BT’s main relationships
  gain a thorough understanding of BT’s governance framework.

 

Jan du Plessis joined as a non-executive director on 1 June 2017, which allowed Jan to familiarise himself with the company and the Board, and start his induction before becoming chairman on 1 November 2017. To achieve the above objectives, the tailored, ongoing induction programme included:

 

  meetings with each non-executive director (including the senior independent director), the executive directors and the company secretary

 

  meetings with Executive Committee members and other senior executives from areas across the business, such as finance, pensions, investor relations, corporate and regulatory affairs, security, legal and human resources

 

  visits to our sites, including Adastral Park, the BT Tower, the BT Archives, telephone exchanges and EE stores

 

  briefings on legal, governance and compliance matters, and guidance on BT policies covering anti-corruption and bribery, gifts and hospitality, charitable donations, sponsorship, and The Way We Work

 

  meetings with BT’s external advisers and stakeholders, including our auditors, the regulator, remuneration consultants and investors.

 

Integration Committee

We created the Integration Committee following BT’s acquisition of EE in January 2016, as required by the terms of the Relationship Agreement entered into by BT and Deutsche Telekom (DT). The committee’s role was to monitor and oversee the integration of EE into BT. Its members were the chief executive, chief financial officer, non-executive directors Tony Ball and Nick Rose, and DT representative Thomas Dannenfeldt.

The integration of EE is progressing well, delivering £292m of cost synergies after the second year. We’re on track to meet our £400m commitment by the end of 2019/20.

As a result we’ve agreed with DT that the Integration Committee is no longer required. In October 2017, the Board approved BT’s entry into a Deed of Amendment to the Relationship Agreement, dissolving the Integration Committee with immediate effect.

Our integration team continues to oversee the successful integration of EE and reports to the Executive Committee, focusing on our customers, people, technology and the synergies we can realise through effective integration.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
139    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

The Board continued

Board evaluation 2017/18

 

LOGO

 

 
140    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

Effectiveness in action

Ofcom’s Digital Communications Review – implementing the settlement

Over the last two years, BT has been working closely with Ofcom to reach a conclusion on their review of the UK’s digital communications, and implement the outcome. Among other things, the review looked at the independence of Openreach as part of the BT group.

In March 2017 the BT Group plc Board authorised British Telecommunications plc (BT plc) to notify Ofcom of its intent to enhance the functional separation of Openreach, to make sure that Openreach will secure greater strategic and operational independence by means of Commitments and a new Governance Protocol. We had already, in the course of 2016/17, created the independent Openreach board and Openreach board audit & risk compliance committee.

LOGO A letter from the Openreach chairman can be found on page 105.

Here are the further steps the Board and its committees have taken to implement the settlement.

 

LOGO

 

 
141    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Relations with shareholders

Individual shareholders

We have a large number of individual shareholders. They are regular users of our website, receive electronic communications, and all are invited to attend our AGM. The company secretary oversees communications with private shareholders, making sure we respond directly as appropriate to any matters regarding their shareholding, and a dedicated team at Equiniti (our share registrar) also looks after their needs. We encourage direct payment of dividends and e-communications – this improves the security and efficiency of our communications and reduces the amount of paper we use.

Institutional shareholders

Our executive management team aims to meet with institutional investors regularly. The chairman, senior independent director and other Board members also meet investors where appropriate. We do this via an investor relations programme that includes one-to-one meetings, roadshows, group meetings, conferences and industry events. During 2017/18 we held around 450 meetings with investors, covering a wide range of topics including our strategy, operational performance, capital investment, pension, relations with government and our regulator, and capital allocation policy. We gather feedback from our main shareholders and this is regularly considered by management and the Board.

Here are some of the ways we engage with our shareholders:

 

 

  AGM

 

 

The AGM provides an opportunity for directors to engage with shareholders, answer their questions and meet them informally. The 2018 AGM will take place on Wednesday 11 July in Edinburgh. We invite all shareholders to attend and use the opportunity to ask questions. We encourage those who can’t attend to vote by proxy on all the resolutions put forward. All votes (with the exception of procedural resolutions) are taken by a poll. In 2017, voting levels at the AGM were over 70% of the company’s issued share capital, the same level as in 2016.

 

 

  Annual Report

 

 

We publish a full annual report and accounts each year which contains a strategic report, governance section, financial statements, and additional information. The report is available in paper format and online.

 

 

  Annual shareholder survey    

 

 

During the year, we surveyed 13,000 private shareholders selected at random to help us improve shareholder engagement. We’ve continued to include more information on our financial performance, strategy, purpose and future plans in our shareholder communications.

 

 

  Press releases

 

 

We issue press releases for all substantive news relating to BT’s financial and operational performance. You can find press releases on our website.

 

 

  Results announcements

 

 

From the first quarter of 2018/19 we will be changing the way we report. We will continue to release a full set of financial and operational results at the interim and full year stage. We will release trading statements at the first and third quarter with reduced disclosure, whilst still providing sufficient information to allow investors to model and value our business. The interim and full year results will be accompanied by presentations hosted by senior management, and the Q1 and Q3 results will be webcast. All our results events provide the opportunity for investors to ask questions of management.

 

 

  Website

 

 

Our website is regularly updated and contains a comprehensive range of information on our company. There is a section dedicated to investors, which has our investor calendar, financial results, presentation, press releases and contact details. The area dedicated to individual shareholders is an essential communications channel. It includes information on shareholder news, administration services, contact information, and information for UK shareholders on capital gains tax.

    

btplc.com

 

 

 

 
142    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

Substantial shareholdings

At 9 May 2018, BT had received notice, under the Financial Conduct Authority’s Disclosure Guidance & Transparency Rules, in respect of the following holdings of shares:

 

      Date of
notification
   Shares    % of total
    voting rights    

Orange SA

   22 June 2017    265,725,107    2.66%

BlackRock Inc

   4 May 2018    495,542,444    4.99%

At 31 March 2018, BlackRock’s interest was 572,491,666 shares representing 5.77% of total voting rights. No requirement to notify the company of any increase or decrease would have arisen unless the holding moved up or down a whole number percentage level. The percentage level may decrease on the transfer of treasury shares for any of the company’s share plans.

In addition, T-Mobile Holdings Limited holds 1,196,175,322 shares representing 12% of total voting rights. On 23 March 2018, we received notification from Deutsche Telekom AG (as nominee for T-Mobile Holdings Limited) that the 12% holding had transferred into their pension trust.

As partial consideration for our purchase of EE Limited in January 2016, we issued 1,594,900,429 new ordinary shares to T-Mobile Holdings Limited and Orange Telecommunications Group Limited.

Annual General Meeting

Resolutions

We’ll ask our shareholders to vote on both the Annual Report and the Report on directors’ remuneration at our AGM.

As part of our policy to involve shareholders fully in the affairs of the company, at our AGM we give them the opportunity to ask questions about BT’s activities. We also give shareholders the opportunity to vote on every important issue by proposing a separate resolution for each. Before the AGM, we count the proxy votes for and against each resolution, as well as votes withheld, and make the results available at the meeting. As at previous AGMs, we’ll take votes on all matters at the 2018 AGM on a poll, except procedural issues. We’ll count every vote cast, whether in person or by proxy at the meeting, and post the outcome of voting on the resolutions on our website as soon as possible after the meeting. It’s our policy for all directors to attend the AGM if possible. While, because of ill health or other pressing reasons, this may not always be possible, in normal circumstances this means that the chairs of the Audit & Risk, Nominating & Governance and Remuneration Committees are at the AGM and are available to answer questions. Mike Inglis did not attend the 2017 AGM due to family circumstances. All other directors attended.

The separate Notice of meeting 2018, which we send to all shareholders who have requested shareholder documents by post, contains the 19 resolutions (with explanatory notes) we will propose at the 2018 AGM on 11 July in Edinburgh. We notify all shareholders of the publication of these documents, which we send out in the most cost-effective way. We aim to give as much notice of our AGM as possible and at least 21 clear days’ notice, as required by our Articles of Association. In practice, we send these documents to shareholders more than 20 working days before the AGM. (For other general meetings this should be at least 14 working days in advance.)

At each meeting at which the company’s accounts are presented to its members, the company is required to appoint auditors to serve until the next such meeting. In June 2017, we announced completion of a formal tender process for external audit services, details of which can be found on page 148. On the recommendation of the Audit & Risk Committee, the Board proposes that KPMG LLP be appointed as the company’s new auditors.

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (PwC) will stand down as the company’s auditors at the conclusion of the AGM.

Authority to purchase shares

The authority given at last year’s AGM for BT to purchase in the market 996m of its shares, representing 10% of the issued share capital, expires on 11 July 2018. We’ll ask shareholders to give a similar authority at the 2018 AGM.

During 2017/18, we purchased 43m shares of 5p each under this authority (0.43% of the share capital) for a consideration of £125m, at an average price of £2.88 per share. During 2017/18, we transferred 4.9m treasury shares to meet BT’s obligations under our employee share plans. We purchased all of the 43m shares in an Offering of BT shares by Orange in June 2017. At 9 May 2018, we held a total of 46.2m shares as treasury shares.

In addition, the BT Group Employee Share Ownership Trust (the Trust) purchased 32.4m BT shares for a total consideration of

£95m. The Trust purchased 26m of those shares in the Offering of BT shares by Orange in June 2017. The Trust continued to hold 12.8m shares at 9 May 2018.

 

 

 
143    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Audit & Risk Committee

Chairman’s report

 

LOGO

“Much of the committee’s work over the past year has focused on the implementation of the improvement actions identified following the issues in Italy, as well as improving our risk, controls and compliance agenda, and the selection and transition to KPMG, our new external auditors. We undoubtedly finished the year with a stronger control and governance environment.”

Our key responsibilities

Effective governance over the appropriateness of the group’s financial reporting, including the adequacy of related disclosures
Oversight of the group’s system of internal control, including risk management
Oversight of the work and findings of internal and external audit
Review of the effectiveness of processes for compliance with laws, regulations and ethical codes of practice, including the company’s Speak Up arrangements.

The committee meeting agendas include standing items that are considered regularly, in addition to any specific matters that require the committee’s attention.

Membership and attendance

 

                                                         
      Meetings
   Member    Eligible
to attend
   Attended

  Nick Rose (chairman)

   9    9

  Iain Conn

   9    7

  Karen Richardson

   9    9

  Jasmine Whitbread

   9    9

The committee acts independently of the executive and all its members are non-executive directors of the company, with diverse skills and experiences. I continue to have recent and relevant financial experience as required by the provisions of the current UK Corporate Governance Code and I am the designated financial expert for Sarbanes-Oxley Act purposes.

The company secretary is secretary to the committee and attends all meetings. Other attendees include:

 

                                                         
     
      Regular
attendee
   Attends as
required

Chief financial officer

   LOGO     

Director group finance

   LOGO     

Director internal audit

   LOGO     

External auditor

   LOGO     

Director enterprise risk management

        LOGO

Director group ethics, compliance & governance

        LOGO

As chairman of the Audit & Risk Committee, I meet with the regular attendees ahead of meetings to discuss key areas of focus for the committee. The external auditors were not present at meetings when we discussed their performance and/ or their remuneration.

The chairman, chief executive and KPMG have attended some of our meetings during the year.

The committee met nine times during the year. Meetings are scheduled in line with the financial reporting timetable and, after each meeting, I report to the Board on the activity of the committee, the main issues discussed and matters of particular relevance, with the Board receiving copies of the committee minutes.

During the year, we hold separate sessions with the internal and external auditors in the absence of management.

 

 

 
144    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

Activities in 2017/18

BT Italy

Last year, I reported to you on the improper practices that came to light in our Italian business and that we had instructed KPMG to perform an independent investigation, directly reporting to me and the BT chairman, while management conducted its own review.

Management identified a number of internal control deficiencies related to our Italian business. Together these deficiencies constituted a material weakness in the control environment and management concluded that, as at 31 March 2017, our internal control over financial reporting was not effective. This resulted in the implementation of a number of changes across the group, including steps to improve processes and controls, not only in Italy, but also in our shared service centres, in Global Services and across the wider group.

During the year, we’ve overseen the implementation of these changes with regular updates to committee meetings. During the year, we’ve also overseen management’s reassessment of the accounting for judgements and estimates they’ve made as a result of the investigation. This concluded that the total adjustments recorded in 2016/17, either as part of the prior year revision or as a specific item, remain appropriate and thus no further adjustment is required (see note 8 to the Financial Statements).

In relation to the matters that gave rise to the material weakness in the control environment, which existed as at 31 March 2017, management have strengthened the review of reconciliations, journals, results and the financial position for Italy.

Specifically, management:

 

introduced enhanced and detailed policies and procedures, including a detailed checklist that must be followed when reviewing any journals in Italy and in our Budapest shared service centre
enhanced the review of reconciliations including the review of significant and aged reconciling items within balance sheet account reconciliations
introduced new detailed oversight controls to holistically review the results and financial position of Italy and other material overseas territories.

We also introduced similar enhancements to journals, reconciliation and oversight controls (assessing the results and financial position) in relation to other material overseas territories and provided additional control guidance and procedures to local finance teams, including a clear policy as to when and whom concerns should be escalated.

Each of these enhanced and new controls is operating effectively.

Management have also sought to improve the capabilities of our functions outside the UK. They have reviewed the talent mix on international leadership teams, including establishing an ex-pat programme. Within Italy, management have made further senior finance appointments including a new deputy CFO and financial controller. They have established monitoring to detect early warning signs and assessed target setting and remuneration to ensure it reflects balanced risks and opportunities.

Management have continued their programme of detailed balance sheet reviews in our operations in Global Services outside of the UK. Combined with the reviews performed in 2016/17, these have now covered around 80% by asset value of the operations outside the UK. These reviews have not identified any similar issues or areas of concern elsewhere, giving us comfort that the inappropriate behaviours were isolated to Italy. The reviews continued to be supported by EY. Management are creating a new central financial controls and compliance team, who will perform these reviews and set and maintain controls policies and standards going forward.

Across the group, management have enhanced the controls and compliance programmes to strengthen awareness of the standards we expect, and reinforced the importance of doing business in an ethical and disciplined way. Management have also sought to enhance the capabilities of our people. All finance employees have completed financial statement fraud awareness training which includes a module on how to escalate concerns. Management have redefined and communicated our three lines of defence model and developed and communicated these enhanced controls, policies and procedures.

At the group level, management have introduced enhanced integrated financial risk and assurance reviews which combine a review of controls and compliance issues, external and internal audit findings, risk registers and legal matters, alongside the reviews of performance, financial position, business and accounting issues and quality of earnings analysis of each of our customer-facing units and corporate units.

While we are satisfied with the improvements to processes and controls we have implemented in the year, we recognise that further system and process improvement opportunities exist which will continue to be a focus in 2018/19.

The committee has focused on understanding and challenging management on these improvements to governance, compliance and financial safeguards.

BT Compliance Committee

The Board approved the creation of the BT Compliance Committee, as a sub-committee of the Audit & Risk Committee, to oversee BT’s compliance with the Commitments, as part of the 2017 Digital Communications Review (DCR) settlement with Ofcom. This committee helps ensure BT delivers the intended outcomes of the settlement and reviews the culture and behaviours across BT and whether these are conducive to BT’s adherence, and the delivery of, the DCR objectives.

As chairman of the Audit & Risk Committee, I see the agendas, minutes and discussions of the BT Compliance Committee, of which there were two meetings in 2017/18. The chair of the BT Compliance Committee will present to the Audit & Risk Committee later in 2018/19, on the work of the committee.

 

 

 
145    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Audit & Risk Committee continued

Chairman’s report continued

Other key matters considered by the committee

A summary of key matters we considered and discussed at each meeting during the financial year and the year to date are set out below:

 

LOGO

 

 
146    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

Financial reporting

The committee:

reviewed the Annual Report & Form 20-F, together with annual, half-year and quarterly results announcements for recommendation to the Board
considered the quality and appropriateness of accounting policies and practices and critical accounting estimates and key judgements
assessed whether the Annual Report, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the group’s position and performance, business model and strategy. This formed the basis of the advice given to the Board.

In addition to BT Italy, other significant issues the committee considered in relation to the financial statements for the year ended 31 March 2018 are set out below. We discussed these with the external auditors during the year.

Group accounting policies, critical accounting estimates and judgements

We reviewed the accounting policies and the disclosures in the consolidated financial statements that relate to critical accounting estimates and judgements, and re-confirmed that they remain appropriate for the group. In particular, we reviewed and challenged the key judgements and assumptions in relation to provisions, including restructuring, regulatory risks and litigation, and the assumed level of take-up in the BDUK programme which affects the value of potential obligation to re-invest or repay grant funding.

The committee, on receiving reports from management, discussed the implementation processes for the adoption of IFRS 9 “Financial Instruments”, IFRS 15 “Revenue from Contracts with Customers” and IFRS 16 “Leases”, and the impacts and key judgements of these on the group’s accounting when adopted. In regards to IFRS 15, which we adopted from 1 April 2018, the committee reviewed a summary of the process on the creation and validation of the IFRS 15 models, which have been built in each of our customer-facing units.

Going concern

We considered management’s forecasts of group cash flows and net debt, as well as our liquidity requirements and the borrowing facilities available to the group. Following this review and a discussion of the sensitivities, we confirmed that the going concern basis of accounting continues to be an appropriate basis of preparation for the financial statements. Further detail on the basis of the going concern assessment by the directors is set out on page 182.

Viability statement

As part of the committee’s responsibility to provide advice to the Board on the form and basis underlying the viability statement, the committee reviewed the process and assessment of the group’s prospects made by management. This summarised the time horizon and how this aligned with the group’s long-term forecasts and how we meet the requirement in the current UK Corporate Governance Code. The committee discussed BT’s approach to developing the statement and how we propose to take account of the company’s current position and principal risks in informing the statement. The committee also considered the Group Risks included in management’s stress testing model.

The committee was satisfied that the viability statement could be provided, and endorsed the continued selection of a three-year time horizon as a basis for the statement and the approach to its development. Further detail on the assessment of viability and the viability statement are set out on page 71.

Regulatory reporting

We reviewed and were supportive of the changes across people, processes and systems that were put in place to ensure that we met our 2017/18 regulatory financial obligations.

Goodwill impairment

The judgements in regards to impairment testing continue to relate primarily to the assumptions underlying the calculation of the value in use of the group’s businesses. During the year and in May 2018, we reviewed the processes and consistency of applying the methodology for assessing the carrying value of goodwill. We also considered the cash flow forecasts for the group’s cash generating units (CGUs) that hold goodwill, being BT Consumer, EE, Business and Public Sector, Global Services, and Wholesale and Ventures.

We considered the key assumptions, resulting headroom and the sensitivity analysis performed by management in forming its assessment and agreed that no goodwill impairment charges were required this year. The committee was satisfied with the appropriateness of the analysis performed by management. With regards to Global Services, we reviewed the impact of the deterioration in international corporate markets. We also discussed and agreed with management’s disclosures in respect of the headroom in Global Services in note 12 to the financial statements.

BT Pension Scheme

We reviewed the assumptions underlying the valuation of the pension liabilities in the financial statements and considered the financial assumptions, including the refinement to the approach used to calculate the discount rate and assumptions for future inflation, salary increase expectations and pension increases, as summarised in note 20 to the financial statements. We also considered sensitivities around the assumptions and the impact of the assumptions on the 2017/18 balance sheet and 2017/18 income statement and the related disclosures.

Major contracts

In addition to our review of the appropriateness of accounting policies, management provided regular updates on the performance of major contracts within Business and Public Sector, Global Services and the Emergency Services Network contract in EE. Management regularly monitor BT’s exposure in regards to major centres and the updates to the committee included an overview of the trading and operational performance of the contracts, an assessment of the recoverability of dedicated contract assets, an assessment of the future performance of the contracts and any requirement for loss provisions.

Asset verification and asset lives

We considered the results of management’s annual asset life review, asset verification exercise and review of fully depreciated assets. We considered the judgements taken in relation to asset lives and the methodology applied to consider asset verification. We were satisfied that the proposed adjustments were appropriate.

 

 

 
147    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Audit & Risk Committee continued

Chairman’s report continued

 

Other matters

Each quarter, as part of our review of the quarterly results, we’re provided with a summary of specific items and management’s view of the quality of earnings and of the effective tax rate. We considered whether specific items are appropriately categorised.

At the half year and full year, a detailed assessment of provisions is also provided and discussed. In each quarter and for the full year, the committee was satisfied with the information, analysis and explanations provided in relation to the results.

External audit

The committee:

 

considered and approved the auditors’ group audit plan – this followed discussion with the auditors on the scope of the work to be undertaken, as well as their consideration of risk informing their plan

 

reviewed reports on audit fees, external audit findings and the letter of engagement

 

considered and approved the letter of representation.

The committee and the external auditors have discussed the issues addressed by the committee during the year and the areas of particular audit focus, as described in the Independent auditors’ report on pages 190 to 200.

Auditor effectiveness

The committee discussed the quality of the audit throughout the year and typically considers the performance of the external auditors annually. As detailed below, the company put its external audit out for tender this year. Given that the audit was put out to tender and the current auditor did not participate in the process, it was decided that there was limited value in conducting an effectiveness review of the external auditor this year.

Audit tender

PwC and its predecessor firms have been BT’s auditors since BT listed on the London Stock Exchange in 1984. I reported to you last year that in our annual review of the external audit arrangements, we recommended to the Board that the audit tender process be accelerated with a view to appointing new auditors for the financial year 2018/19.

Two firms, EY and KPMG, were invited to submit tenders. PwC would not be able to act as auditors beyond 2020/21 and did not participate. Deloitte are embedded in our IFRS 15 implementation project and replacing them would have presented an unacceptable business risk to the company.

The audit tender process was led by me as Audit & Risk Committee chairman. A robust process was carried out and a summary of this is shown below.

We had a common set of criteria for evaluating the proposals including:

 

audit approach and quality

 

the lead partner and their audit team

 

sector experience

 

approach to resolving issues or matters of judgement

 

values alignment and cultural fit.

The proposals presented to us by EY and KPMG were subject to detailed evaluation and discussion which enabled us to recommend to the Board, who endorsed the appointment of KPMG as the preferred new auditor.

In February 2018, KPMG became independent and planning activities commenced for the 2018/19 audit.

The company confirms that it complied with the provisions of the Competition and Markets Authority’s Order, for the financial year under review.

Independence and objectivity

BT has agreed policies in place on what non-audit services can be provided by the external auditors. The external auditors are not permitted to perform any work which they may be later required to audit or which might affect their objectivity and independence, or create a conflict of interest. There are internal procedures in place for the approval of work to be performed by the external auditors.

During the year, we have considered independence matters and areas which could give rise to a conflict of interest. We noted the safeguards that the external auditors have in place to prevent compromising their independence and objectivity.

 

 

LOGO

 

* The panel included some members of the committee (the lead audit partners from both EY and KPMG presented separately to committee members who were unable to attend this session), the chairman, chief executive, chief financial officer, group general counsel & company secretary and group financial controller.

 

 
148    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

We reviewed and approved changes to BT’s non-audit fee policy during 2016/17, in light of the FRC Revised Ethical Standard for auditors. This came into effect for BT’s auditors from 1 April 2017. The changes included: extending the categories of prohibited non-audit services, in particular, to include tax services, reducing the categories of pre-approved services, and lowering the limit below which non-audit services can be pre-approved. This applied to PwC throughout the year and to KPMG from the point they became independent to commence their audit planning.

We monitored compliance with the agreed policies and the level of non-audit fees paid to the auditors in order to satisfy ourselves that the types of services being provided and the fees incurred were appropriate. You can see details of non-audit services carried out by the external auditors in note 7 to the consolidated financial statements. In this context, audit-related assurance services, which included the audit of the Regulatory Financial Statements, are considered to pose a low threat to auditor independence and therefore the proportion of other non-audit services to total services is considered the most suitable measure of the non-audit services provided. These represented 6% of the total fees (2016/17: 20%). Further details of the non-audit services that are prohibited and allowed under the policy can be found on our website.

Internal audit

We approve the internal annual audit plan at the start of each year and receive regular updates from the director, group internal audit on audit activities, progress against plan, details of unsatisfactory audits and action plans to address these. Twice annually, the committee also reviews a paper from the director, group internal audit on the performance of the function, and we periodically commission external effectiveness reviews of internal audit; the next such review is scheduled for the full year 2018/19.

During the year, I highlighted to the Board that the committee was disappointed to note that the positive trend in reducing the volume of overdue audit recommendations had not been maintained and that the long-term overdue recommendations had also increased. We were assured that management were closely monitoring this trend and that it has been appropriately overseen by the Executive Committee. As a result of this oversight, we have seen a drop in both overdue audit recommendations and long-term overdue audit recommendations in recent quarters, and year on year, compared with 2016/17.

Internal controls and risk management

In accordance with the provisions of the current UK Corporate Governance Code, BT has in place an internal controls environment to protect the business from material risks which have been identified within the group. Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal controls over financial reporting and we have responsibility for ensuring the effectiveness of these controls. To enable us to do this, each quarter the customer-facing units certify compliance with the FRC’s risk management guidance and Sarbanes-Oxley controls. The outcomes of these reviews are reported to us.

As previously reported, the investigations into the improper practices in our Italian business identified a number of control deficiencies. More details on BT Italy can be found on page 145. Management have taken steps to improve systems, processes and controls, not only in Italy, but also in our shared service centres, in Global Services and across the group. Management have also enhanced our controls and compliance programmes to

strengthen awareness of the standards we expect, and reinforced the importance of doing business in an ethical and disciplined way. Management have also sought to enhance the capabilities of our people.

BT’s risk management processes, which have been in place throughout the period under review, identify and monitor the risks facing the group. We have also introduced enhanced integrated financial risk and assurance reviews. The risks which are considered material are reviewed regularly by the Executive Committee and the Board.

During the year, the committee heard from the chief executive on the enterprise-wide risk management process, the key risks facing the group as a whole, and the three lines of defence. Each customer-facing unit CEO presented on the three lines of defence and how they operate, culture and the escalation of issues, and how material risks are identified, evaluated and managed.

The Board is ultimately responsible for the group’s systems of internal controls and risk management. You can find details of the Board’s and our review of the group’s systems of internal control and risk management on page 185 and for details of the assessment of internal controls, for the purposes of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, see US Regulation on page 183.

Governance & compliance

We received and considered reports from management on:

 

our ethics and compliance priorities and plan of work

 

Speak Up (BT’s confidential hotline service) reports, including statistics, trends outcomes and material investigations. We ensure that arrangements are in place for the proportionate, independent investigation and follow up of these matters

 

regulatory compliance and privacy and data governance

 

anti-corruption and bribery

 

learning and culture across BT, and results from the group-wide 2017 ethics survey

 

the effectiveness of our regional governance committees, which monitor governance and compliance in their respective regions. We were also updated on the work of several of these committees.

Committee evaluation 2017/18

As part of the Board evaluation we reviewed the committee’s effectiveness, having regard to the findings of the external facilitator and the inputs of others. We concluded that the committee is open, with a good level of discussion between members and attendees. We have seen significant improvements in the materials that are presented to us and this has helped aid more focused debate at our meetings. The attendance of both the chairman and chief executive at some of our meetings has benefited the committee, as they provide an additional overview of and insight into the business.

We concluded that the committee would benefit from the appointment of an additional financial expert and this is being addressed through discussions with the chairman and at the Nominating & Governance Committee.

Nick Rose

Chairman of the Audit & Risk Committee

9 May 2018

 

 

 
149    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Nominating & Governance Committee

Chairman’s report

 

LOGO

“As we transform our business, it continues to be vitally important that our Board members and executive team have the right balance of skills, experience, independence and knowledge, supported by robust governance processes, to allow them to lead the company effectively.”

Our key responsibilities

 

Lead the appointment process for new directors and make recommendations to the Board

 

Ensure our Board and committee members have the right balance of skills, experience, diversity, independence and knowledge to effectively discharge their duties

 

Oversee BT’s governance framework

 

Provide input on the chief executive’s plans for executive succession and executive changes.

Membership and attendance

 

                                                         
      Meetings
   Member    Eligible
to attend
   Attended

  Jan du Plessis (chairman) a

   2    2

  Sir Michael Rake b

   1    1

  Tony Ball

   3    2

  Iain Conn

   3    3

  Isabel Hudson

   3    3

  Nick Rose

   3    3

 

a  Jan du Plessis joined the committee as a member on 1 June 2017, and has chaired it since 1 November 2017.
b  Sir Michael Rake chaired the committee until he stepped down on 31 October 2017.

The company secretary attends our meetings, as does the chief executive where appropriate.

I would also like to welcome Mike Inglis, Jasmine Whitbread and Tim Höttges to the committee. Jasmine and Mike were appointed from 1 April 2018, and Tim from 1 May 2018.

Activities in 2017/18

Succession and Board composition

Board and committee composition

Our role is to ensure our Board and committees have the right balance of skills, experience, diversity, independence and knowledge to effectively discharge their duties.

The committee recommended to the Board that Isabel Hudson and Karen Richardson’s appointments as non-executive directors be extended for a further three-year term, both starting from 1 November 2017. Karen subsequently decided to step down from the Board at the end of the 2018 AGM. In line with the current UK Corporate Governance Code, the extension of a non-executive director’s term beyond six years is subject to particularly careful review. Our recommendation followed detailed consideration of Isabel’s and Karen’s performance, as well as the experience and skills they both bring to the Board and the respective committees of which they are members. We consider that both continue to be independent in character and judgement, and are valued members of the Board.

All non-executive appointments can be terminated on three months’ notice and are subject to automatic termination if a director isn’t elected or re-elected by shareholders at the AGM.

We believe we have an appropriate composition for the Board and each of our Board committees. We keep this under constant review, and reflect potential future requirements in our succession plans.

Succession

As some of our non-executive directors near nine years of service we have turned our attention toward succession planning. We have evaluated the balance of skills, experience, independence and knowledge on the Board, and the distinctive strengths each director brings to the Board. Tony Ball and Karen Richardson will step down from the Board at the end of the 2018 AGM. In order to replace the valuable skills and experience that Tony and Karen bring to the Board and to meet future requirements, we have discussed the skills we will look for in candidates, prepared briefs, and appointed MWM Consulting as external search consultants to assist with the search process. BT instructs MWM Consulting from time to time for search assignments, but they otherwise have no connection with BT Group.

We will consider potential candidates against the briefs. Members of the committee and Board will then meet with candidates, before we recommend appointments to the Board for approval. We will report fully on the steps taken after we conclude the process in next year’s committee report.

Board diversity

We want a diverse workforce that matches our customers and delivers our business goals. As part of this, we consider the diversity of Board and committee members carefully to ensure we benefit from the range of experience, knowledge and understanding each member is able to contribute. We currently have three female Board members out of eleven, which represents 27% female representation. We continue to work towards achieving the Hampton-Alexander review target of at least 33% female Board representation by 2020, and the Parker review target of at least one director of colour by 2021. We challenge our external search consultants where necessary to ensure that diversity is always considered when drawing up candidate shortlists. When considering appointments to the Board, we are mindful of diversity and meritocracy.

 

 

 
150    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

You can read more about our approach to diversity, including our targets for senior female roles, on page 45.

Governance structure and effectiveness

This year, we’ve reshaped our governance framework to establish clearer accountability and personal ownership for decisions across the business. To support this transition, we recommended a number of governance changes that the Board approved, including the replacement of the Operating Committee with the Executive Committee on 2 October 2017. We recommended an amended delegations policy that clearly sets out the authority delegated from the Board to the chief executive, and the principles our people must observe when delegating authority within the group and when exercising authority under BT’s delegations of authority.

The role of the Executive Committee is to advise the chief executive and other members on the decisions for which they’re individually accountable. Unlike the Operating Committee, the Executive Committee has no collective decision-making authority. We’ve made this change at the senior executive level to encourage and promote more efficient decision-making and clearer accountabilities across the business.

On our recommendation the Board has tasked the Nominating & Governance Committee as the forum that considers and agrees:

 

appointments to and removals from the Executive Committee, and changes in other executive direct reports to the chief executive

 

proposals to restructure the Executive Committee.

The committee retains its existing duties, including receiving reports and providing input on the chief executive’s plans for executive succession and development.

During the year we recommended, and the Board approved:

 

that the BT Investment Board replace the Design Council. This body provides recommendations and input to support the chief executive with his decision-making on investment proposals

 

the creation of the BT Compliance Committee (BTCC) as a sub-committee of the Audit & Risk Committee. The role of the BTCC is to help ensure that BT delivers the goals of the DCR Settlement with Ofcom.

Committee evaluation 2017/18

As part of the Board evaluation, we evaluated the committee’s effectiveness, having regard to the findings of the external facilitator and the inputs of others. The committee concluded that it operates efficiently, and that the process to appoint the new BT Group chairman was professional, inclusive and transparent. Details of the appointment process can be found in our Annual Report & Form 20-F 2017.

This table summarises our key areas of focus and the progress we have made:

 

Key areas of focus   Actions

Succession planning – executive appointments

 

As detailed above, the committee plays a key role in agreeing new appointments and changes to the Executive Committee. The chief executive reports to the committee on plans for executive succession and development.

 

Succession planning – non-executive directors

 

We are developing a more systematic approach to succession planning. We keep under review the length of service of Board members, together with our Board skills matrix. We also proactively monitor the market for talented individuals who may bring relevant skills and experience to the Board.

 

Communications of our activities to all Board members

 

We recognise the importance of ensuring all Board members are aware of the committee’s activities. The chairman reports back to the Board after each meeting.

 

Board evaluation 2018/19

The company secretary will facilitate the 2018/19 Board and committee evaluation, which we’ll carry out by electronic questionnaire. Each of the Board committees will complete separate, tailored evaluations. The chairman will conduct individual evaluations of each director to make sure they continue to contribute effectively and demonstrate commitment to the role. The senior independent director will lead the chairman’s performance evaluation, taking into account the views of both non-executive and executive directors.

Jan du Plessis

Chairman of the Nominating & Governance Committee

9 May 2018

 

 

 
151    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

BT Pensions Committee

Chair’s report

 

LOGO

“We dealt with four significant issues this year - the 30 June 2017 funding valuation, a review of pension benefits for UK employees, the implications of the Digital Communications Review on the BT Pension Scheme (BTPS), and the changes to the administration of the BTPS.”

Our key responsibilities

BT’s interactions with the BTPS Trustee, including:

 

agreeing BT’s payments to the BTPS and overseeing interactions with the Trustee on investment strategy

 

monitoring and, where appropriate, mitigating the risks associated with the BTPS.

Membership and attendance

As a result of the high workload concerning pensions during the year, the committee held a number of extra meetings.

 

                                                         
      Meetings
   Member    Eligible
to attend
   Attended

  Isabel Hudson (chair)

   8    8

  Sir Michael Rake a

   4    3

  Jan du Plessis b

   4    4

  Alison Wilcox

   8    6

  Simon Lowth

   8    8

 

a  Sir Michael Rake retired from the committee on 31 October 2017.
b  Jan du Plessis was appointed to the committee on 1 November 2017, but joined two meetings as an attendee before he became a member.

I’d like to welcome Jan du Plessis who joined the committee during the year. I’d also like to thank Sir Mike Rake, who stepped down on 31 October 2017, for his contribution to the committee’s work.

Activities in 2017/18

Funding and 30 June 2017 funding valuation

During the year the BT team held constructive discussions with the Trustee on BT’s future contributions to the BTPS. I’m pleased that this process was successfully concluded on 9 May 2018. You can read more about the outcome in note 20 to the consolidated financial statements.

Review of pension benefits

On 30 May 2017, BT announced a review of pension benefits in the BTPS and this review was subsequently extended to include the main defined contribution arrangement, the BT Retirement Savings Scheme (BTRSS). We spent a lot of time and carefully considered the proposals to close the BTPS to future benefits, bearing in mind that over 50% of UK eligible employees are now in the BTRSS and making sure that there is fairness for all. The aim was to help all current and future BT people to build up retirement benefits that are fair, flexible, and affordable to BT and the employee. BT communicated and consulted extensively with employees during the process and we gave careful consideration to appropriate education and advice for scheme members needing to make important decisions. The BT team worked closely with the recognised trade unions, both of which supported the planned changes in relation to the BTPS which are due to be implemented on 1 July 2018. You can find more about the review in note 20 to the consolidated financial statements.

Risk management and investment strategy

Over the course of the year, we received regular information and presentations from the BTPS management team on the investment performance and risk associated with the BTPS. The investment return for the year to 31 March 2018 was 2.4%. We also discussed temporary changes to asset strategy during the year with the Trustee in order to reduce investment volatility over the period.

Governance, legal and regulatory

As part of the DCR settlement, we considered the potential implications for the BTPS. We also dealt with a range of governance matters, including reviewing trustee appointments.

BTPS administration

During the year, the Trustee announced that it would be bringing the administration of the BTPS in-house. We monitored this process closely and received regular presentations from the BTPS executive team on progress. We also received updates on the Trustee’s implementation of a new, improved administration platform designed to deliver a better service to members in future.

Further information

You can find out more about BT’s pension schemes in note 20 to the consolidated financial statements.

Isabel Hudson

Chair of the BT Pensions Committee

9 May 2018

 

 

 
152    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

Committee for Sustainable and Responsible Business

Chair’s report

 

LOGO

“BT’s purpose is to use the power of communications to make a better world. This is at the heart of everything we do, and inspires our customers, partners and employees to make a lasting, positive impact on society and the environment.”

Our key responsibilities

 

Provide strategic direction on how to bring BT’s purpose to life

 

Assess progress on delivering positive societal and environmental impacts while delivering sustainable revenue growth

 

Evaluate progress on BT’s 2020 ambitions and provide guidance to management on plans and areas of risk and opportunity.

Membership and attendance

 

                                                     
      Meetings
   Member    Eligible
to attend
   Attended

Jasmine Whitbread (chair) a, h

   2    2

Sir Michael Rake b

   1    1

Jan du Plessis c

   1    1

Niall Dunne d, e

   1    1

Phil Hodkinson f

   2    2

Baroness Margaret Jay f, g

   0    0

Lisa MacCallum f

   2    2

Gavin Patterson e

   2    2

Gunhild Stordalen f

   2    2

Alison Wilcox e

   2    1

 

a  Jasmine Whitbread was appointed chair on 1 November 2017.
b  Sir Michael Rake stepped down as chair of the CSRB on 31 October 2017.
c  Jan du Plessis became a member of the CSRB on 1 November 2017.
d  Niall Dunne stepped down from the CSRB on 1 November 2017. The interim chief sustainability officer attended the meeting in December.
e  BT employee.
f  Independent member.
g  Baroness Margaret Jay stepped down from the CSRB on 14 April 2017.
h  Non-executive director.

As the new chair, I’m delighted to welcome Jan as a member of the CSRB and I would like to particularly thank Sir Mike Rake for his years of commitment leading this committee. Over the year, we’ve also said goodbye to Margaret and Niall, and I thank them both for their valued contributions.

Activities in 2017/18

Purposeful business strategy

The committee reviewed management recommendations on all areas of the purposeful business strategy for BT globally, and provided guidance and direction on the main priorities.

2020 ambitions

We assessed progress towards each of our 2020 ambitions. Find out more in our Delivering Our Purpose Report 2017/18.

Investment in society

We agreed to make an investment in society of £35.9m, made up of a mix of cash, time volunteered by BT people, and in-kind contributions.

Tech literacy and social inclusion

We assessed progress with the Tech Literacy programme, which aims to reach 5 million children by 2020. The committee approved the strategy for the year ahead, which aims to develop a culture of tech literacy in the UK. Regarding progress towards our goal to help 10 million people overcome social disadvantage, the committee noted that we’ve now reached 4.6 million people since announcing this initiative in 2015.

Environment

The committee approved a new science-based target to reduce our carbon emissions intensity by 87% by 2030 (compared with 2016/17 levels). Find out more information on page 54.

Volunteering and good causes

The committee assessed the progress on our ambition to inspire two thirds of our people to volunteer by 2020. Participation increased throughout the year, enabled by programmes such as tech literacy and charity partner campaigns. The committee spent time discussing our new charity and community approach and our ambition to generate £1bn for good causes by 2020, as well as providing guidance on how to link this to employee engagement activities.

Field trip 2018

This year, the committee visited the East of England region to hear first hand how BT’s purpose is brought to life locally. This included visiting a school to see our Tech Literacy programme in action.

Jasmine Whitbread

Chair of the Committee for Sustainable and Responsible Business

9 May 2018

 

 

 
153    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Investigatory Powers Governance Committee

Chairman’s report

 

LOGO

“BT supports the government’s important role in protecting society from crime and terrorism. To protect legal privacy rights, the committee makes sure all requests we receive to obtain, retain or disclose information to public bodies are lawfully made.”

Our key responsibilities

 

Assessing and responding to all investigatory powers requests made to BT in the UK and overseas, for example under the Investigatory Powers Act 2016

 

Overseeing all operational activities undertaken by BT in relation to any such requests

 

Ownership of policies regarding BT’s response to such requests

 

Ownership of key stakeholder relationships, for example with government, the Investigatory Powers Commissioner and the intelligence agencies.

Membership and attendance

 

                                                     
      Meetings
   Member    Eligible
to attend
   Attended

Jan du Plessis (chairman) a

   2    2

Sir Michael Rake b

   3    3

Gavin Patterson

   4    4

Senior executive, BT

   4    4

Senior executive, BT

   4    4

Legal adviser

   4    4

External member

   4    4

 

a  Jan du Plessis joined the committee as a member on 1 June 2017, and has chaired it since 1 November 2017.
b  Sir Michael Rake chaired the committee until he stepped down on 31 October 2017.

Certain committee members remain unnamed as it is BT’s policy to protect our people who work on security-cleared matters.

Activities in 2017/18

Review of operational activities

We reviewed previous and current operational activities relating to requests BT has received to assist public authorities in relation to exercising investigatory power.

Review of governance

In December 2016, the committee was formally established as a committee of the Board. This year, we adopted new Terms of Reference setting out the governance arrangements for the committee.

Update on legal developments

We considered updates on UK and EU legal challenges to the UK’s investigatory powers regime, for example the Watson/Tele2 decisions in the European Court of Justice and the UK Court of Appeal, and the Privacy International Investigatory Tribunal case. We formed our own internal legal view of these developments and obtained expert external legal opinions where necessary.

Security update

We received regular updates on BT’s security practices and policies, including the security of our assets, estate, products and services, as well as cyber incidents and other security issues. We shared information on cyber risks with government as part of our work to protect society from cyber crime.

Jan du Plessis

Chairman of the Investigatory Powers Governance Committee

9 May 2018

 

 

 
154    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

Technology Committee

Chairman’s report

 

LOGO

“This year we’ve launched exciting new ultrafast broadband technology and laid the groundwork to launch 5G. I believe these will play an important role in boosting the UK’s digital economy and enable our customers to do more than ever before.”

Our key responsibilities

 

Agree the development and implementation of BT’s major technology innovation strategies

 

Review BT’s technology risk exposure and how management monitors and controls such exposures.

Membership and attendance

 

                                                     
      Meetings
   Member    Eligible
to attend
   Attended

Gavin Patterson (chairman)

   3    3

Tony Ball

   3    3

Iain Conn

   3    3

Mike Inglis

   3    3

Karen Richardson

   3    3

Howard Watson a

   3    3

 

a  BT employee.

The company secretary also attends our meetings.

 

Activities in 2017/18

Technology strategy

All IP

We reviewed our transformation plans to migrate all customers from the ageing PSTN network to All IP based voice networks and services. Moving towards an All IP future for voice services means we’ll create a more flexible way for consumers and businesses to communicate, unlock the potential for converged services, and create network efficiencies.

5G

We’ve continued to monitor and discuss our 5G launch plan in the UK, including identifying key dependencies and risks for delivery. BT has worked closely with industry bodies on the development of the 5G standard, and we’re on track to deliver our launch plan.

Technology trends and innovation

We considered emerging technology trends to ensure we’re at the forefront of technological change. Members of BT’s innovation team join our meetings on a regular basis to present new technologies and innovations that could help us improve our network access, security, performance and efficiency, create new ways of working, and identify opportunities for new services and products. An area we have followed with interest is Artificial Intelligence and Machine Learning. This will help us leverage the power of analytics and automation to enhance BT’s protection against emerging threats, and augment business efficiencies.

Technology risk

Cyber Security

We continued to monitor the evolving threat of cyber attacks in order to protect our systems, people and customers. We are progressing well with our security programmes. These include proactive monitoring of our systems and networks, providing ongoing assurance that our IT controls are robust, and running awareness campaigns so our people can take steps to protect themselves and others against cyber threats.

Technology investment

We reviewed the trends, drivers and forecasts for technology-related capital expenditure, as well as investigating ways to reduce costs and run our networks more efficiently.

Gavin Patterson

Chairman of the Technology Committee

9 May 2018

 

 

 
155    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Report on directors’ remuneration

Chairman’s report

 

LOGO

“My report this year sets out how we have implemented our Remuneration Policy, a framework which is intended to appropriately incentivise our high-calibre executive team to drive company success and deliver shareholder value.”

Our key responsibilities

 

Determine the salary and benefits for both executive directors and monitor the relationship between pay and benefits of other employees
Operation of the annual bonus scheme, including setting performance targets and objectives for the year ahead
Determine awards under the annual bonus scheme for both executive directors and review the awards of other senior executives
Governance of the long-term incentive plans, including target setting
Review and approve the Annual Remuneration Report for inclusion in the Annual Report & Form 20-F
Review, approve and ensure operation within the Remuneration Policy including seeking shareholder approval, on a binding basis, at least every three years.

Membership and attendance

 

                                                     
      Meetings
   Member    Eligible
to attend
   Attended

Tony Ball (chairman)

   8    8

Isabel Hudson

   8    6

Mike Inglis

   8    6

Karen Richardson

   8    6

Nick Rose

   8    8

In addition to the committee members, the chairman and chief executive are invited to attend meetings, except in instances where their own remuneration is discussed or other circumstances where their attendance would not be appropriate.

The committee regularly consults the chief executive, the group HR director, and the HR director, reward, pensions and employee relations.

The company secretary is secretary to the committee and attends all meetings.

 

The contents of this report are as follows:

Chairman’s letter

Review of the year; committee decisions; key outturns and plans for the year ahead

Focus on remuneration

The key aspects of our remuneration structure, risk accountability, how we have performed, how we applied the Remuneration Policy during 2017/18 and application in 2018/19

Annual Remuneration Report

More detail on how we have applied our Remuneration Policy during 2017/18 including the single figure of remuneration for each director

How we intend to apply the Remuneration Policy in 2018/19

Remuneration Policy

We set out our Remuneration Policy, as approved by shareholders at our 2017 AGM

 

 

 

 
156    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

Review of the year

This has been a challenging year for the company but some good progress has been made in key areas of the business.

The committee has continued to make sure that its approach to remuneration provides a competitive pay package and one that aims to align management’s interests with those of shareholders.

At the 2017 AGM shareholders endorsed our approach to remuneration with over 96% of votes cast in favour of both the Annual Remuneration Report 2016/17 and the Remuneration Policy.

Business performance

The business has continued to work towards delivering on its strategic plans and to this end has made important investments for the future. Although the market environment has become more challenging during the past year BT remains well positioned in its markets and has met the challenges and taken opportunities in a disciplined way.

Outcomes for the year

Application of malus: As reported in 2017, following our investigations into accounting irregularities in our Italian business and publication of revised results for 2014/15 and 2015/16, the committee exercised its discretion to apply the malus provisions in the Deferred Bonus Plan to reduce the number of shares under award for certain participants. This was actioned in May 2017 and further detail is shown on page 166.

In addition, following further consideration regarding the impact of the accounting irregularities in our Italian business, the sanctions arising from Ofcom’s findings regarding the application of Deemed Consent in the Openreach business and the fact that both of these issues involved the finance function, the committee has decided to exercise its discretion to apply the malus provisions in respect of the remaining Deferred Bonus Plan awards of the former group finance director, Tony Chanmugam, given his role as head of the finance function, to reduce those awards to zero. In doing so the committee accepted that Tony Chanmugam was not personally implicated in or culpable for either issue.

2017/18 bonus: The annual bonus is based on performance against key financial and non-financial metrics, and personal objectives. Key measures under the financial and non-financial elements include profit, cash flow, revenue, and customer experience. Overall, the formulaic results against the targets set under these measures produced an above-target outcome, as set out on page 162. In particular, this reflected outperformance against the cash flow and customer experience measures. In reviewing whether this level of payout was appropriate, the committee welcomed and agreed the chief executive’s proposal to cap the outcome of the financial and non-financial measures at target, taking into account the underlying financial and operating performance of the business during the year. The committee also reviewed the personal performance of both executive directors against their key objectives for the year.

Overall, this resulted in an annual bonus of 54% of maximum for the chief executive and 72% of maximum for the chief financial officer.

2015-2018 ISP vesting: The group returned below-threshold performance against all of the performance measures for the 2015 ISP. This resulted in the award lapsing in full. More information on the 2015 ISP is on page 163.

Looking ahead

Base salary review: The committee considered the base salaries of the executive directors in the context of the UK employee population. BT has agreed a 3.1% annualised pay settlement for team members in the UK in 2018, and a 2.5% pay review budget for increases for the UK managerial and professional team in 2018.

We reviewed the performance of the executive directors and, in line with the increases agreed for our managerial employees, we agreed 2.5% salary increases for both the chief executive and the chief financial officer, to take effect from June 2018.

The committee proposes no changes to how benefits and pension will be operated for the executive directors, and no changes to the structure of the annual bonus, which will have the same opportunity and weightings as for 2017.

We reviewed the level of ISP award for the executive directors. In the case of the chief executive the committee carefully considered reverting to an award of 400% of salary however, in light of the share price fall in the year, we decided that an award of 350% of salary was fair. It is the committee’s intention to revert to an award of 400% of salary next year assuming overall performance supports that move. An ISP award of 350% of salary will also be made to the chief financial officer.

Finally, as I step down as a director of BT and after almost nine years as a member of the committee, half of which as chairman, I would like to take this opportunity to thank our shareholders for their support and guidance as we have strived to develop and deliver best practice in remuneration matters at BT.

Tony Ball

Chairman of the Remuneration Committee

9 May 2018

 

 

 
157    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Focus on remuneration

How we align our remuneration policy with shareholders’

interests and risk management

 

 

Base salary and core benefits

 

  
Alignment with shareholders’ interests       Risk accountability

 

   

 

 

–  Forms a key part of the remuneration framework required to attract, retain and motivate the calibre of executives needed to shape and execute our strategy and generate shareholder value.

   

 

–  Loss of existing talent and an inability to recruit new talent would represent a risk to the business

 

–  Mitigated by setting salary and benefits at a level that is competitive against relevant businesses and recognises breadth of the role and individual experience.

 

 

   

 

Application in 2017/18       Application for 2018/19

 

   

 

 

–  No change to base salaries for Gavin Patterson (£996,825) and Simon Lowth (£700,000)

 

–  Both executive directors received a cash pensions allowance of 30% of salary

 

–  Benefits include company car, fuel or driver, personal telecommunication facilities and home security, medical and dental cover (for the directors and immediate family), life cover, professional subscriptions, personal tax advice and financial counselling.

 

   

 

–  An increase of 2.5% for both executive directors to be applied in June 2018

 

–  The new base salary for Gavin Patterson will be £1,022,000 and for Simon Lowth £717,500

 

–  There are no changes being proposed to the benefit framework or pension arrangements for 2018/19.

 

Annual bonus

 

  
Alignment with shareholders’ interests        Risk accountability

 

    

 

 

–  Financial and personal objectives are set with reference to our business strategy approved by the Board

 

–  They capture KPIs for the business, including:

 

–  EPS, free cash flow and revenue (excluding transit)

 

–  Delivering great customer service

 

–  Personal objectives linked to key operational and strategic projects

 

–  Deferral of one third of the bonus for three years provides retention and alignment over the longer term.

 

    

 

–  The Board seeks to ensure that the budget balances achievable goals without encouraging undue risk. Incentive targets are then linked to the budget

 

–  The financial metrics reflect how well management mitigates our principal business risks

 

–  The committee retains absolute discretion to reduce variable compensation in light of risk and the group’s overall performance

 

–  Bonus deferral encourages a focus on long-term outcomes

 

–  Malus and clawback provisions are in place.

 

 

    

 

Application in 2017/18        Application for 2018/19

 

    

 

 

–  The maximum level of bonus opportunity was 240% for the chief executive, and 180% for the chief financial officer

 

–  The committee welcomed and agreed the chief executive’s proposal to cap the overall outcome of the key financial and customer experience measures at target. Coupled with performance against personal objectives, this resulted in an annual bonus of 54% of maximum for the chief executive and 72% of maximum for the chief financial officer.

 

    

 

–  No changes are being proposed to either the maximum bonus opportunities or the overall structure of the plan.

 

Incentive Share Plan (ISP)

 

  
Alignment with shareholders’ interests        Risk accountability

 

    

 

 

–  Based on performance against three measures critical to BT’s long-term success

 

–  Total shareholder return (TSR) metric provides a direct measure of our relative performance against peers.

    

 

–  Metrics balance financial performance (cash flow and revenue (excluding transit)) with total return, producing a rounded view of performance and effective risk management over the longer term

 

–  Two year holding period ensures individuals retain exposure to the share price for at least five years in total.

 

 

    

 

Application in 2017/18        Application for 2018/19

 

    

 

 

–  Chief executive: received an award of 350% of salary (reduced from 400% as a result of the share price fall over the previous year)

 

–  Chief financial officer: received an award of 350% of salary.

    

 

–  Chief executive: the same approach will be applied as taken in 2017/18 and the chief executive will receive an award of 350% of salary

 

–  Chief financial officer: will receive an award of 350% of salary

 

–  Following committee review, a revised TSR comparator group will be used for the 2018 ISP awards.

 

 

Shareholding guidelines

 

    
Alignment with shareholders’ interests        Risk accountability

 

    

 

 

–  Shareholding guidelines ensure appropriate alignment between executives and investors

 

–  Current shareholding levels are set out on page 165.

    

 

–  Encourages executives to build and hold a material, personal stake in the business

 

–  Ensures that they have significant equity at stake in the event of adverse risk-related events.

 

 

    

 

Application in 2017/18        Application for 2018/19

 

    

 

 

– Chief executive: equivalent to 300% of salary

 

– Chief financial officer: equivalent to 250% of salary.

    

 

– No changes are being proposed.

 

 
158    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents

LOGO

 

 
159    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Remuneration Principles

 

Our remuneration principles are to maintain a competitive remuneration package that promotes the long-term success of the business, avoids excessive or inappropriate risk-taking and aligns management’s interests with those of shareholders.

We believe in pay for performance against challenging targets and stretching goals for the annual bonus (including deferred shares) and long-term incentive shares. A significant proportion of the total remuneration package is therefore variable and linked to corporate performance.

The committee:

 

determines the remuneration policy for the executive directors and the chairman. The chairman is not currently a member of the committee

 

reviews the performance targets regularly to ensure that they are both challenging and closely linked to the group’s strategic priorities. Furthermore, because a large part of the remuneration package is delivered in shares and senior executives are required to build up a significant shareholding themselves, they are directly exposed to the same gains or losses as all other shareholders

 

takes account of the pay and employment conditions of all our employees, the performance of the group and the individual, the current views and guidelines of shareholders and their representatives, and general market conditions. Remuneration arrangements at other companies of a similar size and complexity are also reviewed for guidance

 

continues to keep under review the relationship of risk to remuneration. The chair of the Audit & Risk Committee is currently a member of the Remuneration Committee

 

is also satisfied that the incentive structure for senior executives does not raise environmental, social or governance risks by inadvertently motivating irresponsible behaviour. Part of the annual bonus depends upon an assessment of each senior executive’s personal contribution which typically includes the environmental, social, health and safety and governance agenda

 

retains absolute discretion to reduce variable compensation in light of risk and the group’s overall performance. We would only use this in exceptional circumstances.

 

 

 

 
160    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

Annual remuneration report

This section summarises all elements of the directors’ remuneration in 2017/18.

Single total figure of remuneration (audited)

The following sets out all emoluments received by directors for the financial years 2017/18 and 2016/17, including bonus and deferred bonus, long-term incentive plans and pension arrangements.

 

                                                                                                                                                                                                  
      Basic salary
and fees
(2017/18)
£000
     Basic salary
and fees
(2016/17)
£000
     Benefit
excluding
pension
(2017/18)
£000
     Benefit
excluding
pension
(2016/17)
£000
     Annual
Bonusa
(2017/18)
£000
     Annual
Bonusa
(2016/17)
£000
     ISPb
(2017/18)
£000
     ISPc
(2016/17)
£000
     Malusd
(2017/18)
    Pension
(2017/18)
£000
     Pensione
(2016/17)
£000
     Total
2017/18
£000
     Total
2016/17
£000
 

Chairman

                                                                                                                   

Jan du Plessisf

     322               43                                                                             365         

Executive Directors

                                                                                                                   

Gavin Patterson

     997        993        57        54        1,292                             (338     299        298        2,307        1,345  

Simon Lowthg

     700        499        23        17        907        343                            210        151        1,840        1,010  
Non-executive directors                                                                                                                    

Tony Ball

     138        124        2                                                                               140        124  

Iain Conn

     122        121                                                                                        122        121  

Tim Höttgesh

                                                                                                   0        0  

Isabel Hudsoni

     188        179        1        1                                                                      189        180  

Mike Inglisi

     105        86        2        1                                                                      107        87  

Karen Richardsoni,j

     127        126        31        18                                                                      158        144  

Nick Rosei

     173        159        2        2                                                                      175        161  

Jasmine Whitbread

     107        102                                                                                        107        102  

Sub-total

     2,979        2,389        161        93        2,199        343                        (338     509        449        5,510        3,274  

Former director

                                                                                                                   

Sir Michael Rakek

     394        675        20        35                                                                      413        710  

Total

     3,373        3,064        181        128        2,199        343                        (338     509        449        5,923        3,984  

 

a  Annual bonus shown includes both the cash and deferred share element. The deferred element of the 2017/18 bonus includes the value of deferred shares to be granted in June 2018. Further details of the deferred element are set out below.
b  The ISP 2015 granted in June 2015 will lapse in full in May 2018. Further details are provided on page 163.
c  The ISP 2014 granted in June 2014 lapsed in full in May 2017.
d  As a result of investigations into improper accounting practices in BT’s Italian business, the committee exercised its discretion and applied the malus provisions under the Deferred Bonus Plan. This was applied in May 2017 and the figure was calculated based on the share price at the time of the original grant. Further details are provided on page 166.
e  Pension allowance paid in cash for the financial year net of pensions contributions – see ‘Total pension entitlements’ on page 163.
f  Jan du Plessis joined the Board on 1 June 2017 and became chairman on 1 November 2017.
g  Simon Lowth was appointed as a director on 12 July 2016.
h  Under the terms of the Relationship Agreement between BT and Deutsche Telekom and Tim Höttges’s letter of appointment, no remuneration is payable for this position.
i  Value shown relates to reimbursement of reasonable travelling and other expenses (including any relevant tax) incurred in carrying out their duties.
j  Includes an additional fee for regular inter-continental travel to Board and Board Committee
  meetings.
k  Sir Michael Rake retired as a director on 31 October 2017 and the remuneration he received in performing that role is set out in the table above. No termination payment was made. Sir Michael Rake will provide advisory services on specific matters to the company from November 2017 until June 2018.
 

 

 
161    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Annual remuneration report continued

 

Additional disclosures relating to the single figure table (audited)

Salaries

Executive directors’ salaries are reviewed annually, with increases typically effective from 1 June. We reviewed the salaries for Gavin Patterson and Simon Lowth during the year and agreed that they should remain unchanged at £996,825 and £700,000 respectively. The annualised pay settlement for our team members in the UK in 2017/18 was 2.1%.

Benefits

Benefits provided to the executive directors and the chairman include company car, fuel or driver, personal telecommunication facilities and home security, medical and dental cover (for the directors and immediate family), life cover (executive directors only), professional subscriptions, personal tax advice and financial counselling.

Annual bonus

The annual bonus opportunities (expressed as a percentage of salary) for the executive directors in 2017/18 were as follows:

 

LOGO

We set out below the weighting of the annual bonus structure for the executive directors in 2017/18.

Chief executive and chief financial officer

 

LOGO

The annual bonus is based on performance against key financial and non-financial metrics, and personal objectives. Key measures under the financial and non-financial elements include profit, cash flow, revenue (excluding transit) and customer experience.

As set out in the table below, overall the formulaic results against the targets set under these measures produced an above-target outcome. In particular, this reflected outperformance against the cash flow and customer experience measures. In reviewing whether this level of payout was appropriate, the committee welcomed and agreed the chief executive’s proposal to cap the combined outcome of the financial and customer experience measures at target, taking into account the underlying financial and operating performance of the business during the year.

 

Measure    Threshold      Target      Maximum      Actual      Outcome  
Adjusted EPS (p)a      26.5        27.9        30        27.9        Target  
Normalised free cash flow (£m)b      2,621        2,759        2,966        2,973        Maximum  
Revenue (excluding transit) (£m)c      23,689        23,928        24,287        23,487       
Below
threshold
 
 
Customer experience      50        100        200        176.66       

Between
target and
maximum
 
 
 

 

a  Adjusted EPS is defined on page 25.
b  Normalised free cash flow is defined on page 25.
c  Revenue (excluding transit) is defined on page 24.

The chairman assessed the chief executive, and the chief executive assessed the chief financial officer on personal contribution targets and performance against personal objectives. These assessments were based on a number of factors including BT’s regular employee surveys and performance against personal objectives set at the start of the year.

The chief executive achieved 70% of maximum for his personal contribution score. The personal contribution score reflected the progress on developing BT’s strategic transformation programme which will underpin the future business performance, including the completion of the important milestones in the governance review following the learnings from the Italy and Deemed Consent issues from the prior year and leading the significant refresh of BT’s executive team during the year.

The chief financial officer achieved 90% of maximum for his personal contribution score. This reflects his exceptional contribution this year in leading BT’s pension review and driving our transformation agenda in BT including the Board strategy, as well as his substantial progress on transforming the structure, capability and culture within the finance function.

For both executive directors, one-third of any bonus paid is deferred into shares for three years with the remaining two-thirds paid in cash. Deferred shares are not subject to performance conditions.

The chief executive’s bonus, paid both in cash and deferred shares, represented 130% of salary (2016/17: 0%) and 54% of the maximum bonus opportunity (2016/17: 0%).

 

 

 
162    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

 

The chief financial officer’s bonus, paid both in cash and deferred shares represented 130% of salary (2016/17: 68.8% (pro-rated to reflect the period he was in full-time employment during the year)) and 72% of the maximum bonus opportunity (2016/17: 38.2% pro-rated to reflect the period he was in full-time employment during the year).

The deferred shares will be granted in June 2018.

Total bonus

 

Name    % of bonus
due to
business
score
     % of bonus
due to
personal
score
 

Chief executive

     74%        26%  

Chief financial officer

     69%        31%  

Incentive share plan 2015 (audited)

The ISP is a conditional share award. The committee assesses the performance conditions to 31 March 2018 and the awards would ordinarily vest in May 2018. The performance conditions are based 40% on relative TSR, 40% on normalised free cash flow, and 20% on growth in underlying revenue (excluding transit) over a three-year performance period. As disclosed in the 2016 Directors’ Remuneration Report, after completion of the EE acquisition in January 2016, the free cash flow and revenue measures were adjusted to reflect the enlarged group.

As set out in the table below, the threshold performance target in respect of each measure was not met and therefore the awards will lapse in full in May 2018.

 

40% Total shareholder return    40% Normalised free cash flow    20% Underlying revenue growth (excluding transit)
Performance    Outcome    Performance    Outcome    Performance    Outcome
Threshold    20th =    Threshold    £8.58bn =    Threshold    0.72% =
target 12th    target not    target    target not    target    target not
     met    £10.25bn    met    5.79%    met

Total pension entitlements (audited)

We closed the BT Pension Scheme (BTPS) to new entrants on 31 March 2001. None of the executive directors participate in future service accrual in the BTPS.

New UK employees are eligible to join a defined contribution scheme, typically a personal pension plan. For executive directors, the company agrees to pay a fixed percentage of the executive’s salary each year which can be put towards the provision of retirement benefits.

Gavin Patterson receives an annual allowance equal to 30% of salary in lieu of pension provision as set out in the table on page 161. Gavin has previously been a member of the BTRSS but neither he nor the company has made any contribution to the scheme during 2017/18. BT also provides death in service cover consisting of a lump sum equal to four times his salary plus a dependant’s pension equal to 30% of his capped salary.

Simon Lowth receives an annual allowance equal to 30% of salary in lieu of pension provision as set out in the table on page 161. Simon has not previously been a member of any of the company pension schemes. BT also provides death in service cover consisting of a lump sum equal to four times his salary plus a dependant’s pension equal to 30% of his capped salary.

Jan du Plessis is not a member of any of the company pension schemes. The company has made no payments towards his retirement provision and provided no life cover benefit.

 

 

 
163    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Annual remuneration report continued

 

Awards granted during the year (audited)

2017 ISP awards

The 2017 ISP awards were made in June 2017 as set out below and on page 167. As agreed by the committee in 2017, as a result of the fall in BT’s share price over the previous year, the committee reduced the award to Gavin Patterson from 400% of salary to 350% of salary. The award for Simon Lowth was 350% of salary.

 

Director    Date of award      ISP award
(shares)
     Face value
of awarda
 

Gavin Patterson

     22 June 2017        1,218,186      £ 3,488,884  

Simon Lowth

     22 June 2017        855,446      £ 2,449,997  

 

a  Face value based on share price at the date of grant of 286.40p. The grant price is calculated using the average middle-market price of a BT share for the three days prior to grant.

The ISP is a conditional share award. Performance conditions attached to the awards are based 40% on relative TSR, 40% on normalised free cash flow, and 20% on growth in underlying revenue excluding transit over a three-year performance period from 1 April 2017 to 31 March 2020. The performance conditions are the same for both directors. The table below sets out the target ranges for TSR, the normalised free cash flow and underlying revenue growth excluding transit for the three-year performance period 2017/18 to 2019/20.

TSR vesting schedule 2017 awards

 

LOGO

The TSR comparator group is unchanged from the 2016 awards.

Financial targets

 

Measure

2017/18–2019/20

   Threshold      Level of
vesting
     Maximum      Level of  
vestinga
 
Normalised free cash flow      £7.92bn        25%        £8.92bn        100%  
Underlying revenue growth (excluding transit)      1.8%        25%        4.0%        100%  

 

a  Vesting levels between threshold and maximum will be on a straight line basis.

The committee believes that the free cash flow and revenue performance measures are challenging, and the financial performance necessary to achieve the upper end of the range for each target is stretching.

When ISP awards vest, additional shares representing the value of reinvested dividends on the underlying shares are added.

The awards are subject to a further holding period of two years, commencing from the end of the performance period and applied to the net number of shares received after tax and other statutory deductions. During the holding period, no further performance measures will apply.

2017 deferred shares (DBP)

We awarded a proportion of the 2016/17 annual bonus in deferred shares. The table below provides further details.

As disclosed in the 2017 Directors’ Remuneration Report, despite some of the bonus performance targets being met, the committee exercised discretion and determined that no bonus would be awarded to the chief executive and he therefore received no deferred share awards.

 

Director    Date of award      DBP award
(shares)
     Face value
of awarda
 

Gavin Patterson

     N/A        N/A        N/A  

Simon Lowth

     22 June 2017        42,014      £ 120,328  

 

a  Face value based on share price at grant of 286.40p. The grant price is calculated using the average middle-market price of a BT share for the three days prior to grant.

The DBP is a conditional share award. Deferred shares are not subject to performance conditions and will vest in three years subject only to continued employment. Details of all interests in deferred shares are set out on page 166.

When DBP awards vest, additional shares representing the value of reinvested dividends on the underlying shares are added.

Former directors (audited)

Tony Chanmugam started drawing his retirement benefits on 6 April 2017. During 2017/18 Tony received a total of £574,929 from the BT Pension Scheme. This consisted of a pension commencement lump sum payment of £375,000 and monthly pension payments totalling £199,929. In addition, all benefits were commuted under the pre-existing unfunded pension arrangement from BT, and Tony received a one-off taxable lump sum of £1,610,411.

Phil Hodkinson retired as a non-executive director on 31 January 2016 but continues to be a member of the Committee for

Sustainable and Responsible Business, for which he receives an annual fee of £10,000.

Payments for loss of office (audited)

No payments were made during the year for loss of office.

Directors’ share ownership (audited)

The committee believes that the interests of the executive directors should be closely aligned with those of shareholders.

To this end, the chief executive is required to build up a shareholding equal to 300% of salary, and the chief financial officer 250% of salary. The aim is to encourage the build up of a meaningful shareholding in the company over time by retaining shares received under an executive share plan (other than shares sold to meet tax and other statutary deductions) or from purchases in the market.

We use the average BT share price over the preceding 12 months (or the share price at acquisition date if higher) to determine whether the minimum shareholding requirement has been reached.

 

 

 
164    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

The table below sets out the shareholding requirement position as at 31 March 2018. As a relatively new director, Simon has not yet received any vested shares under the executive share plans and did not receive a buyout on appointment. Simon’s current shareholding is as a result of personal purchases in the market.

 

Executive director    Personal shareholding as a percentage
of salary
 

Gavin Patterson

     939%  

Simon Lowth

     4%  

The following table shows the total unvested interests held by the executive directors in the ISP and DBP. The numbers represent the maximum possible vesting levels. The ISP awards will only vest to the extent the performance conditions are met over the three-year period. Full details of all ISP and DBP awards, including performance periods and vesting conditions, are set out on pages 166 to 167.

Unvested interests in shares (audited)

 

     ISP (subject to performance)             DBP (not subject to
performance)
 
     

1 April

2017

     Total number
of award
shares
31 March
2018
             1 April
2017
     Total number
of award
shares
31 March
2018
 

Gavin Patterson

     3,046,654        3,354,841                 334,944        127,638  

Simon Lowtha

     628,928        1,568,600                 N/A        44,397  

 

a  Simon Lowth joined the Board in July 2016 and was granted his first DBP award in June 2017.

During the period 1 April 2018 to 9 May 2018, there were no movements in unvested interests in shares.

The table below shows share options held by the directors under the company’s all-employee saveshare plans as at 31 March 2018. None of the directors held share options with performance conditions.

Share options held without performance conditions – saveshare (audited)

 

      Share
options
at 1 April
2017
     Options
granted
during
year
     Options
exercised
during
year
     Value at
date of
exercise
(£)
     31 March
2018
 

Gavin Patterson

     5,642                             5,642  

Former director

                                            

Sir Michael Rakea

     5,172                             5,172  

 

a  Sir Michael Rake retired as a director on 31 October 2017 and the number reflects his options at that date.

The directors exercised no saveshare options during the year. There were no vested but unexercised options at the year-end.

Directors’ interests at 31 March 2018 or date of retirement, if earlier (audited)

The following table shows the beneficial interests of directors holding office at the end of the year (or at the point of leaving for directors who retired during the year), and their families, in the company’s shares at 31 March 2018 and 1 April 2017, or at date of appointment if later.

 

     Number of shares  
Beneficial holdings    31 March 2018      1 April 2017  

Jan du Plessisa

     400,000        N/A  

Gavin Pattersonb

     2,943,453        2,871,032  

Simon Lowth

     10,536         

Sir Michael Rakeb c

     166,061        148,721  

Tony Ball

     193,871        93,871  

Iain Conn

     19,442        19,442  

Tim Höttges

             

Isabel Hudson

     15,090        8,424  

Mike Inglis

     4,599        2,600  

Karen Richardsond

     13,525        13,525  

Nick Rose

     300,000        125,000  

Jasmine Whitbread

     11,289        7,990  

Total

     4,077,866        3,290,605  

 

a  Jan du Plessis joined the Board on 1 June 2017 and become chairman on 1 November 2017.
b  Includes shares purchased under directshare and free shares awarded under UK allshare. Directshare is an HMRC approved plan that allows BT employees to buy shares out of gross pay. Prior to 2008 BT awarded free shares to UK employees (UK allshare).
c  Sir Michael Rake retired as a director on 31 October 2017 and the number reflects his holding at that date.
d  Shares are held as 2,705 American Depositary Shares (ADS). One ADS equates to five BT ordinary shares.

During the period 1 April 2018 to 9 May 2018, there were no movements in directors’ beneficial holdings. The directors, as a group, beneficially own less than 1% of the company’s shares.

The company encourages the chairman and independent non-executive directors to purchase, on a voluntary basis, BT shares with an aggregate value of £5,000 on average each year to further align the interests of non-executive directors with those of our shareholders. The directors are asked to hold these shares until they retire from the Board. This policy is not mandatory.

This policy does not apply to Tim Höttges who was appointed to the Board as a non-independent, non-executive director following completion of the EE acquisition in January 2016. This helps avoid any conflict of interest in relation to Tim’s ongoing employment as CEO of Deutsche Telekom.

 

 

 
165    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Annual remuneration report continued

Deferred bonus plan awards at 31 March 2018 (audited)

The following DBP awards have been granted to the directors. These shares will normally be transferred to participants at the end of the three-year deferred period.

Tony Chanmugam retired from the Board on 13 July 2016. All payments made to Tony in respect of 2015/16 were reported in the 2016 Directors’ Remuneration Report. The committee considered the treatment of Tony’s outstanding share awards under the DBP. Given that his departure was by mutual agreement with the company and an orderly transition was put in place, he was considered a good leaver for the purposes of the DBP. Subject to the application of malus as described in footnote b below, his unvested DBP awards were preserved until their normal vesting date. Following further committee discussion and consideration, the committee exercised its discretion and applied the malus provisions under the DBP to reduce the number of shares under Tony’s outstanding DBP awards to zero. This will be applied in 2018/19.

 

                                                                                                                                                                                             
      1 April 2017      Awardeda     

Dividends

re-invested

     Vested      Lapsedb
    Total number
of award shares
31 March 2018
     Vesting date      Price at
grant
     Market
price at
vesting
     Monetary
value of
vested award
£000
 

Gavin Patterson

                                                                                        

DBP 2014

     138,952                      131,709        (7,243            01/08/2017        384.20p        312.5p        412  

DBP 2015

     105,028               5,059               (15,867     94,220        01/08/2018        449.50p                

DBP 2016

     90,964               1,793               (59,339     33,418        01/08/2019        403.18p                

DBP 2017c

                                                                    

Simon Lowthd

                                                                                        

DBP 2017

            42,014        2,383                     44,397        01/08/2020        286.40p                

Former director

                                                                                        

Tony Chanmugam

                                                                                        

DBP 2014

     147,828               8,196               (3,367     152,657        01/08/2017        384.20p                

DBP 2015

     56,739               2,696               (9,214     50,221        01/08/2018        449.50p                

DBP 2016

     50,537               909               (34,490     16,956        01/08/2019        403.18p                

 

a  Awards granted on 22 June 2017.The number of shares subject to awards was calculated using the average middle market price of a BT share for the three days prior to the grant. Awards of deferred shares in respect of 2018 will be calculated using the average middle market price of a BT share for the three days prior to grant.
b  As a result of investigations into improper accounting practices in BT’s Italian business, as reported in 2017, the committee exercised discretion and applied the malus provisions in the Deferred Bonus Plan to reduce the number of shares under award. The application of the malus provisions was calculated based on the share price at the original grant.
c  The committee exercised its discretion and determined that no bonus would be awarded to Gavin Patterson in respect of 2016/17. This resulted in no 2017 DBP award being made.
d  Simon Lowth joined the Board in July 2016 and was granted his first DBP award in June 2017.

 

 
166    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

Share awards under long-term incentive schemes held at 31 March 2018 (audited)

Details of the company’s ordinary shares under conditional share awards made to directors, as participants under the ISP are as follows:

 

                                                                                                                                                                                             
      1 April 2017      Awarded      Dividends
re-invested
     Vested      Lapsed     Total number
of award shares
31 March 2018
     Performance
period end
     Price on
grant
     Market
price at
vesting
     Monetary
value of
vested
award
£000
 

Gavin Patterson

                                                                                        

ISP 2014a

     1,090,141                             (1,090,141            31/03/2017        384.20p                

ISP 2015b

     927,367               52,621                     979,988        31/03/2018        449.50p                

ISP 2016c

     1,029,146               58,397                     1,087,543        31/03/2019        403.18p                

ISP 2017e

            1,218,186        69,124                     1,287,310        31/03/2020        286.40p                

Simon Lowth

                                                                                        

ISP 2016d

     628,928               35,686                     664,614        31/03/2019        405.38p                

ISP 2017e

            855,446        48,540                     903,986        31/03/2020        286.40p                

 

a  Award granted on 19 June 2014.The number of shares subject to award was calculated using the average middle-market price of a BT share for the three days prior to grant of 384.20p. 40% of the award is linked to TSR compared with a group of 22 other companies, 40% is linked to a three-year normalised free cash flow measure and 20% to a measure of underlying revenue growth (excluding transit) over three years. Performance against the TSR, normalised free cash flow and revenue targets resulted in the threshold targets not being met and none of the shares vesting under the 2014 ISP. The award lapsed in May 2017.
b  Award granted on 18 June 2015.The number of shares subject to award was calculated using the average middle-market price of a BT share for the three days prior to grant of 449.50p. 40% of the award is linked to TSR compared with a group of 22 other companies, 40% is linked to a three-year normalised free cash flow measure and 20% to a measure of underlying revenue growth (excluding transit) over three years. Performance against the TSR, normalised free cash flow and revenue targets resulted in the threshold targets not being met and none of the shares vesting under the 2015 ISP. The award will lapse in May 2018.
c  Award granted on 20 June 2016.The number of shares subject to award was calculated using the average middle-market price of a BT share for the three days prior to grant of 403.18p. 40% of the award is linked to TSR compared with a group of 21 other companies, 40% is linked to a three-year normalised free cash flow measure and 20% to a measure of underlying revenue growth (excluding transit) over three years.
d  Award granted on 29 July 2016.The number of shares subject to award was calculated using the average middle-market price of a BT share for the three days prior to grant of 405.38p. 40% of the award is linked to TSR compared with a group of 21 other companies, 40% is linked to a three-year normalised free cash flow measure and 20% to a measure of underlying revenue growth (excluding transit) over three years.
e  Awards granted on 22 June 2017.The number of shares subject to awards was calculated using the average middle-market price of a BT share for the three days prior to grant of 286.40p. 40% of the award is linked to TSR compared with a group of 21 other companies, 40% is linked to a three-year normalised free cash flow measure and 20% to a measure of underlying revenue growth (excluding transit) over three years.

Share options held at 31 March 2018 (audited)

 

Number of shares under option:                                      Market price      Usual date         
      1 April 2017         Granted          Lapsed          Exercised          31 March 2018          Option price
per share
    

at date of

exercise

    

from which

    exercisable

     Usual expiry
date
 

Gavin Patterson

     5,642 a                           5,642        319p               01/08/2019        01/02/2020  

Former director

                                                                               

Sir Michael Rakeb

     5,172 a                           5,172        319p               01/08/2019        01/02/2020  

All of the above options were granted for nil consideration.

a  Option granted on 26 June 2014 under the employee saveshare scheme, in which all employees of the company are entitled to participate.
b  Sir Michael Rake retired as a director on 31 October 2017 and the number reflects the number of shares under option at that date. The options were exercisable up to 30 April 2018.

 

 

 
167    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Annual remuneration report continued

 

Comparison of chief executive remuneration to total shareholder return (unaudited)

Total shareholder return (TSR) is the measure of the returns that a company has provided for its shareholders, reflecting share price movements and assuming reinvestment of dividends. The graph below illustrates the performance of BT Group plc measured by TSR relative to a broad equity market index over the past nine years. We consider the FTSE100 to be the most appropriate index against which to measure performance, as BT has been a member of the FTSE100 throughout the nine-year period, and the index is widely-used.

BT’s TSR performance vs the FTSE100

 

LOGO

History of chief executive remuneration

 

Year end    Chief Executive      Total rem
£000
     Annual bonus
(% of max)
     ISP vesting
(% of max)
 

2018

     Gavin Patterson        2,307        54%        0%  

2017

     Gavin Patterson        1,345        0%        0%  

2016a

     Gavin Patterson        5,396        45%        82.01%  

2015

     Gavin Patterson        4,562        58%        67.4%  

2014b

     Gavin Patterson        2,901        62%        78.7%  
       Ian Livingston        4,236        35%        63.4%  

2013

     Ian Livingston        9,402        65%        100%  

2012

     Ian Livingston        8,520        73%        100%  

2011

     Ian Livingston        4,009        79%        0%  

2010

     Ian Livingston        3,556        71%        0%  

 

a  The total remuneration figure includes the ISP award as CEO BT Retail and the first award as chief executive, granted in 2013.
b  Ian Livingston stepped down on 10 September 2013 and Gavin Patterson took over from that date.

Percentage change in chief executive remuneration (unaudited)

The table below illustrates the increase in salary, benefits and annual bonus for the chief executive and that of a representative group of the company’s employees. For these purposes, we’ve used the UK management and technical employee population representing around 23,209 people. We believe this broad group provides the most meaningful comparison as they have similar performance related pay arrangements as our executive directors.

 

          Salary          Benefita          Bonusb  
% Change in chief executive remuneration      2.5%        +5.5%        N/A  
% Change in comparator groupc      2.5%        0%        +89.1%  

 

a  The increase in benefits for the chief executive was around £3,000.
b  The bonus comparator is based on cash bonus only to give a better like-for-like comparison. No bonus was awarded to the chief executive in 2017.
c  Comparator group is the UK management and technical employee population representing around 23,209 individuals.

Relative importance of spend on pay (unaudited)

The table below illustrates the change in total remuneration and dividends and share buyback paid.

 

Area    2017/18 (£m)          2016/17 (£m)          % Change  
Remuneration paid to all employees      5,400        5,189        4.07%  
Dividends/share buybacks      1,746        1,642        6.33%  
 

 

 
168    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

Implementation of remuneration policy in 2018/19 (unaudited)

Base salary

Having agreed no increases in 2017, the committee considered the base salaries for both executive directors. In line with the increases agreed for our managerial employees, we agreed 2.5% salary increases for both executive directors.

The table below sets out the 2018/19 base salaries for both executive directors. The increases are effective in June 2018.

 

      Base salary          % change  

Chief executive

   £ 1,022,000        +2.5%  

Chief financial officer

     £717,500        +2.5%  

Benefits

The committee has set benefits in line with the remuneration policy set out on pages 173 to 180. We propose no changes to the benefit framework for 2018/19.

Pension

Levels of pension provision for 2018/19 are the same as for 2017/18. Executive directors receive an annual amount equal to 30% of salary in lieu of pension provision.

Clawback and malus

Clawback provisions will apply to annual bonus payments relating to the 2018/19 financial year, and for the ISP awards that are expected to be made in June 2018.

The annual bonus clawback will apply for one year following payment. The ISP clawback arrangements may be enforced by the committee in the two year period post-vesting of any awards.

Annual bonus

The table below describes the level of bonus opportunity (expressed as a percentage of salary) for the chief executive and chief financial officer. One third of any bonus will be deferred into shares for a period of three years.

 

LOGO

The 2018/19 annual bonus structure and weighting is set out below.

Chief executive and chief financial officer

 

LOGO

Adjusted earnings per share, normalised free cash flow, and revenue (excluding transit) have a direct impact on shareholder value. Customer experience (measured through our RFT and the customer perception measure) is vital to the company’s long-term health and growth. All four of these measures are KPIs for BT and are defined on pages 24 to 25.

We don’t publish details of the financial targets in advance as these are commercially confidential. We will publish achievement against these targets at the same time as we disclose bonus payments in the 2019 Directors’ Remuneration Report so shareholders can evaluate performance against those targets.

The personal contribution measure is aligned to our strategy and is assessed by the chairman for the chief executive and by the chief executive for the chief financial officer and each senior executive, eg, CFU CEO. Performance against the personal contribution element is assessed individually and is based on achievement against individual objectives, organisational culture and growth measures.

Incentive Share Plan

The committee reviewed the level of ISP award for both executive directors. In 2017 the level of ISP award for the chief executive was reduced from 400% of salary to 350% of salary in light of the share price fall in the year. This year the committee carefully considered reverting to an award of 400% of salary. However, in the light of the share price fall in the year it decided that an award of 350% of salary was fair. It is the committee’s intention to revert to an award of 400% of salary next year assuming overall performance supports that move. An award of 350% of salary will also be made to the chief financial officer.

We expect to grant the awards in June 2018. Any shares acquired on the vesting of the 2018 ISP awards will be subject to a holding period of two years, commencing from the end of the three-year performance period.

The holding period will apply to the number of shares received on vesting after tax and other statutory deductions. No further performance measures will apply during the holding period as performance will have already been assessed.

The performance conditions will be the same as for the 2017 ISP: 40% based on relative TSR; 40% based on normalised free cash flow; and 20% growth in underlying revenue (excluding transit) over a three-year performance period.

 

 

 
169    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Annual remuneration report continued

 

The committee reviewed BT’s approach to TSR and the comparator group during the year following a number of changes to the business. The changes include strategic developments, the acquisition of EE and its integration into the consumer business, substantial investment in BT Sport and the legal separation of Openreach. The committee agreed a revised comparator group of 16 other companies for the 2018 awards as set out below.

BT’s TSR comparator group for the 2018 ISP will comprise the companies listed below.

 

Centrica    Proximus    Telecom Italia
Deutsche Telekom    Sky    Telefónica
KPN    SSE    Telenor
Liberty Global    Swisscom    Telia Company
National Grid    TalkTalk    Vodafone
Orange          

TSR vesting schedule 2018 awards

For the 2018 ISP awards, 40% of the potential outcome is based on relative TSR. The following graph shows the potential vesting of awards based on the TSR element.

 

LOGO

Financial targets

The table below sets out the target ranges for the normalised free cash flow and underlying revenue growth (excluding transit).

 

Measure

2018/19–2020/21

   Threshold      Level of
vesting
     Maximum      Level of
vestinga
 
Normalised free cash flowb      £6.4bn        25%        £7.4bn        100%  

Underlying revenue

(excluding transit)c

     0.2%        25%        1.9%        100%  

 

a  Vesting level between threshold and maximum will be on a straight line basis.
b  Normalised free cash flow is defined on page 25.
c  Growth in underlying revenue (excluding transit) is defined on page 24.

The committee aims to set stretching targets that require strong outperformance for maximum vesting, yet remain realistic in the context of the significant investments in our networks that we need to make over the next three years. The committee recognises that the financial targets are lower than the 2017 ISP awards but considers that in the current economic and regulatory environment these targets represent an equivalent stretch to those set in prior years.

The targets above have been set on an IAS basis. The committee will review any impact arising from BT’s transition to IFRS 15, applicable from 1 April 2018, during 2018/19. Any adjustments required as a result of the standard will be reported in the 2019 Directors’ Remuneration Report.

Chairman and non-executive director remuneration

The fees for non-executive directors were reviewed during the year. The last review of non-executive director fees was in January 2017 when no changes were made. In accordance with the Articles of Association, the chairman and executive directors conducted the review, and considered the role and requirements of BT, together with the fees paid to non-executive directors at companies of a similar size and complexity. Following the review, the basic fee for a non-executive director was increased to £75,000 per year (from £72,000) from 1 January 2018. The chair and membership fees of the BT Compliance Committee, a sub-committee of the Audit & Risk committee formed during the year, were also agreed. Further detail on the BT Compliance Committee can be found on page 145.

Following the change in chairmanship of the Committee for Responsible & Sustainable Business, a chair fee of £12,000 was agreed. The chairman of the Board previously held this position and as such no chair fee was payable.

The committee agreed an increase to £4,000 (from £2,000) for the fee paid per trip to those non-executive directors travelling on an inter-continental basis to Board and Board committee meetings.

The Integration Committee was disbanded during the year. See page 139 for further detail.

The table below sets out the fees for membership of, or chairing a Board committee (including the changes agreed during the year):

 

Committee    Chairman’s fee             Member’s fee  
Audit & Risk      £35,000       £25,000  
BT Compliancea      £25,000 b      £12,000  
Nominating & Governance      n/a c       £10,000  
BT Pensions      £25,000       £10,000  
Remuneration      £28,000       £15,000  
Sustainable & Responsible Business      £12,000 d      £5,000  
Technology      n/a c       £14,000  
Equality of Access Boarde      £72,500       n/a  

 

a  A sub-committee of the Audit & Risk Committee.
b  Nil if the Equality of Access Board chair also chairs the BT Compliance Committee.
c  Where the chairman or chief executive acts as chair of a Board committee, no additional committee chair fee is payable.
d  External members of the CSRB receive a fee of £10,000 a year.
e  External members of the Equality of Access Board receive an annual fee of £37,000.

The senior independent director receives an additional fee of £27,000 a year for that position.

No element of non-executive director remuneration is performance-related. Non-executive directors do not participate in BT’s bonus or employee share plans and are not members of any of the company pension schemes.

No review of the chairman’s fee was undertaken. The committee agreed a five year fixed fee of £700,000 per year, on Jan du Plessis’s appointment as chairman.

 

 

 
170    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

Other remuneration matters

Advisers

During the year, the committee received independent advice on executive remuneration matters from Deloitte LLP. Deloitte received £174,625 in fees for these services. The fees are charged on a time-spent basis in delivering advice. That advice materially assisted the committee in their consideration of matters relating to executive remuneration.

Deloitte is a founder member of the Remuneration Consultants Group and as such, voluntarily operates under the code of conduct in relation to executive remuneration consulting in the UK. The committee appointed Deloitte to the role of independent advisers to the committee in 2012 following a competitive tender exercise conducted by the committee.

The committee is comfortable that the Deloitte engagement partner and team, who provide remuneration advice to the committee, have no connections with BT that may impair their independence or objectivity.

In addition, during 2017/18, Deloitte provided the company with advice on corporate and indirect taxes, assistance with regulatory, risk and compliance issues and additional consultancy services.

Dilution

For a number of years we generally used treasury shares to satisfy the exercise of share options and the vesting of share awards under our employee share plans. We intend to use both treasury shares and shares purchased by the BT Group Employee Share Ownership Trust (the Trust) for share option exercises, and shares purchased by the Trust for the vesting of executive share awards in 2018/19. Shares held in the Trust do not have any voting rights.

At the end of 2017/18, shares equivalent to 1.76% (2016/17: 1.89%) of the issued share capital (excluding treasury shares) would be required for all share options and awards outstanding.

Of these, we estimate that for 2018/19, shares equivalent to approximately 0.28% (2017/18: 0.45%) of the issued share capital (excluding treasury shares) will be required for the all-employee share plans.

Outside appointments

The committee believes that there are significant benefits, to both the company and the individual, from executive directors accepting non-executive directorships of companies outside BT. The committee will consider up to two external appointments (of which only one may be to the board of a major company), for which a director may retain the fees.

Gavin Patterson is a non-executive director of British Airways for which he receives an annual fee of £50,000 and the benefit of free BA flights.

From 2018/19, the Nominating & Governance Committee will consider proposed external directorships and other external interests by executive directors, members of the ExCo and other senior direct reports to the chief executive.

Voting at the 2017 Annual General Meeting

The table below sets out the votes cast in respect of the Annual Remuneration Report and the Remuneration Policy at the Annual General Meeting held on 12 July 2017.

 

      Votes cast
in favour
     %      Votes cast
against
     %  
Approve Annual Remuneration Report      6,711,751,544        96.85%        218,449,483        3.15%  
Approve Remuneration Policy      6,654,431,173        96.12%        268,487,768        3.88%  

7,604,373 votes were withheld against approving the Annual Remuneration Report while 14,886,907 votes were withheld against approving the Directors’ Remuneration Policy. Withheld votes are not counted when calculating voting outcomes.

Committee evaluation 2017/18

As part of the Board evaluation, we evaluated the committee’s effectiveness, having regard to the findings of the external facilitator and the inputs of others. We concluded that the committee operates efficiently and has benefited from the recent addition of two new members.

Independent non-executive directors’ letters of appointment

Each independent non-executive director has an appointment letter setting out the terms of his or her appointment. They do not have service contracts. The letter includes membership of any Board committees, the fees to be paid and the time commitment expected. We ask each non-executive director to allow a minimum commitment of 22 days each year, subject to committee responsibilities, and to allow slightly more in the first year in order to take part in the induction programme. The actual time commitment required in any year may vary depending on business. We make clear that additional time may be required during periods of increased activity.

Appointments are for an initial period of three years. During that period, either party can give the other at least three months’ notice of termination. All Board appointments automatically terminate in the event of a director not being elected or re-elected by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting. The appointment of a non-executive director is terminable on notice by the company without compensation. At the end of the period, the appointment may be continued by mutual agreement.

See page 172 for further details of appointment arrangements for independent non-executive directors.

The appointment letter also covers matters such as confidentiality, data protection and BT’s share dealing code.

Tim Höttges was appointed as a non-independent non-executive director in January 2016 following Deutsche Telekom’s nomination, and his appointment letter reflects the terms of the Relationship Agreement between BT and Deutsche Telekom.

 

 

 
171    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Annual remuneration report continued

Directors’ service agreements and letters of appointment

The following table sets out the dates on which directors’ service agreements/initial letters of appointment commenced and the current expiry dates:

 

Chairman and executive directors    Commencement date    Expiry date of current service agreement or letter of appointment

Jan du Plessis

   1 June 2017   

The agreement is terminable by the company on 12 months’ notice and by the director on six months’ notice.

 

Gavin Patterson

   10 September 2013   

Initial term until 10 September 2014, and thereafter terminable by the company on 12 months’ notice and by the director on six months’ notice.

 

Simon Lowth

   6 July 2016   

Terminable by the company on 12 months’ notice and by the director on six months’ notice.

 

Non-executive directors

 

         

Tony Ball

   16 July 2009   

Letter of appointment was for an initial period of three years. The appointment was extended for a further three years in June 2015 following extension in 2012.

 

Iain Conn

   1 June 2014   

Letter of appointment was for an initial period of three years. The appointment was extended for a further three years in May 2017.

 

Tim Höttges

   29 January 2016   

Appointed as a non-independent non-executive director under the terms of the Relationship Agreement between BT and Deutsche Telekom. The appointment is terminable immediately by either party.

 

Isabel Hudson

   1 November 2014   

Letter of appointment was for an initial period of three years. The appointment was extended for a further three years in October 2017.

 

Mike Inglis

   1 September 2015   

Letter of appointment was for an initial period of three years.

 

Karen Richardson

   1 November 2011   

Letter of appointment was for an initial period of three years. The appointment was extended for a further three years in October 2017 following extension in 2014.

 

Nick Rose

   1 January 2011   

Letter of appointment was for an initial period of three years. The appointment was extended for a further three years in December 2016 following extension in 2013.

 

Jasmine Whitbread

   19 January 2011   

Letter of appointment was for an initial period of three years. The appointment was extended for a further three years in December 2016 following extension in 2013.

 

There are no other service agreements, letters of appointment or material contracts, existing or proposed, between the company and any of the directors. There are no arrangements or understandings between any director or executive officer and any other person pursuant to which any director or executive officer was selected to serve. There are no family relationships between the directors.

Inspection by the public

The service agreements and letters of appointment are available for inspection by the public at BT’s registered office. They will also be available for inspection commencing one hour prior to the start of our AGM, to be held in Edinburgh on 11 July 2018.

Tony Ball

Chairman of the Remuneration Committee

9 May 2018

 

 
172    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

 

Remuneration policy

The following pages set out our directors’ remuneration policy (the ‘Policy’) which was approved by shareholders at the AGM on 12 July 2017 in accordance with section 439A of the Companies Act 2006.

The votes cast in respect of the Policy at the 2017 AGM were as set out on page 171.

The Policy on pages 174 to 180 is a repeat of the Policy set out on pages 138 to 145 in the Annual Report & Form 20-F 2017. As such all page cross-references within the repeated Policy are to the respective pages in the Annual Report & Form 20-F 2017. The Policy, as approved, is also available online at bt.com/downloadcentre

We are repeating the Policy this year because we believe it’s helpful when reading the Annual Remuneration Report.

Legacy matters

The committee reserves the right to make any remuneration payments and/or payments for loss of office (including exercising any discretions available to it in connection with such payments) notwithstanding that they are not in line with the Policy where the terms of the payment were agreed (i) before the AGM in 2014 (the date the company’s first shareholder-approved directors’ remuneration policy came into effect); (ii) before this Policy came into effect, provided that the terms of the payment were consistent with the shareholder-approved directors’ remuneration policy in force at the time they were agreed; or (iii) at a time when the relevant individual was not a director of the company and, in the opinion of the committee, the payment was not in consideration for the individual becoming a director of the company. For these purposes “payments” includes the committee satisfying awards of variable remuneration and, in relation to an award over shares, the terms of the payment are “agreed” at the time the award is granted. Any legacy payments would be disclosed in the Annual Remuneration Report for the relevant year.

Minor amendments

The committee may make minor amendments to the arrangements for the directors as described in the Policy, for regulatory, exchange control, tax or administrative purposes, or to take account of a change in legislation.

 

 

 
173    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Remuneration Policy

Executive Directors and Chairman

 

  Policy Element

 

  

Operation and Opportunity

 

  

Performance measures or basis of payment

 

 

Base salary

Purpose - a core element of remuneration, used to attract and retain executive directors of the calibre required to develop and deliver our business strategy.

 

  

Salaries for the executive directors and the chairman are reviewed annually, although an out-of-cycle review may be conducted if the committee determines it appropriate. A review may not necessarily lead to an increase in salary. Salaries are paid monthly in cash.

 

The pay and conditions for all UK employees are considered when setting salaries for executive directors and the chairman.

  

Whilst there is no maximum salary level, any increase will typically be broadly in line with BT’s UK employee population.

 

For the executive directors, higher increases may be made under certain circumstances, such as:

 

–  increase in the scope and/or responsibility of the individual’s role;

–  development of the individual within their role; and

–  where an executive director has been appointed to the Board at a lower than typical level of salary, for example to reflect less experience, larger increases may be awarded to move them closer to market practice as their experience develops.

 

Individual and business performance are taken into account in deciding salary levels.

 

 

Benefits

Purpose – to support health and wellbeing and provide employees with a market competitive level of benefits.

  

Executive directors and the chairman receive benefits which typically include (but are not limited to) company car (or monthly allowance in lieu of a car or part of such allowance not used for a car), fuel and/or driver, personal telecommunication facilities and home security, medical and dental cover for the directors and their immediate family, life cover, professional subscriptions, personal tax advice and financial counselling up to a maximum of £5,000 (excluding VAT) a year.

 

Where executive directors are required to relocate, the committee may offer additional expatriate benefits, if considered appropriate.

 

The company purchases directors’ and officers’ liability insurance to cover the directors, and has in place a directors’ and officers’ indemnity. The insurance operates to protect the directors in circumstances where, by law, BT cannot provide the indemnity.

 

Further details of the directors’ and officers’ liability insurance and indemnity are set out on page 147.

 

  

While no maximum level of benefits is prescribed, they are generally set at an appropriate market competitive level determined by the committee, taking into account a number of factors including:

 

–  the jurisdiction in which the employee is based;

–  the level of benefits provided for other employees within the group; and

–  market practice for comparable roles within appropriate pay comparators in that jurisdiction.

 

The committee keeps the benefit policy and benefit levels under regular review.

 

Annual bonus

Purpose – to incentivise and reward delivery of our business plan on an annual basis.

  

Executive directors are eligible for an annual bonus. The chairman is not eligible for an annual bonus. Awards are based on performance in the relevant financial year. The annual bonus is paid in two elements, a cash element, and a deferred element awarded in shares. Annual bonus amounts are not pensionable.

 

The committee sets annual bonus performance targets each year, taking into account key strategic priorities and the approved budget for the year.

 

The committee ensures that targets set are appropriately stretching in the context of the corporate plan and that there is an appropriate balance between incentivising executive directors to meet targets, while ensuring that they do not drive unacceptable levels of risk or inappropriate behaviours.

 

At least one-third of the annual bonus will be granted in the form of deferred shares to strengthen further the alignment of management interests with the long-term interests of shareholders. The deferred element in shares must be held for a deferral period which will not be less than three years. If following the grant of an award, facts subsequently become known to the committee which would justify a reduction in the award, the committee may reduce the number of deferred shares, including to nil. Further information on the malus and clawback provisions is set out on page 145. The maximum annual bonus opportunity is 240% of base salary.

 

  

The committee seeks to effectively reward performance against the key elements of our strategy. Measures used typically include, but are not limited to:

 

–  financial performance measures – these are chosen carefully to ensure alignment between reward and underlying financial performance. As an example, such measures may include free cash flow and earnings per share; and

–  non-financial performance measures

–  these reflect key company, strategic and individual goals. For example, such measures may include customer experience, purposeful company and personal objectives.

 

In terms of weighting, non-financial measures will typically account for no more than 50% of the total annual bonus.

 

A sliding scale between 0% and 100% of the maximum award applies for achievement between threshold and maximum performance under the bonus plan.

 

 
174    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

 

  Policy Element

 

  

Operation and Opportunity

 

  

Performance measures or basis of payment

 

 

Incentive Share Plan (ISP)

Purpose – to incentivise executive directors over the longer-term, by rewarding delivery of stretching targets linked to our strategy and long-term value creation.

  

Executive directors are eligible to participate in the ISP. The chairman is not eligible to participate. The ISP forms the long-term variable element of executive remuneration. Awards are discretionary and normally vest subject to performance measured over a period of at least three years.

 

Under the terms of the plan rules the current ISP has no maximum award level. The committee have determined that it will impose limits for executive directors to apply to future awards. The maximum normal ISP award that may be awarded to an executive director in respect of any financial year of the company will be 400% of basic salary. In exceptional circumstances, for example recruitment, this limit may be increased to 500% of basic salary.

 

The proposed award levels for 2017/18 are set out on page 134.

 

In respect of ISP awards made to executive directors there is normally a further holding period of two years, commencing from the end of the performance period applicable to the net number of shares received after tax and other statutory deductions. During the holding period, no further performance measures will apply.

 

If following the grant of an award, facts subsequently become known to the committee which would justify a reduction in the award, the committee may reduce the number of shares, including to nil. Further information on the malus and clawback provisions is set out on page 145.

  

The committee aligns the performance measures under the ISP with the long-term strategy of the company and considers that strong performance under the chosen measures should result in sustainable value creation:

 

–  financial measures – to reflect the financial performance of our business and a direct and focused measure of company success and, for example, may include free cash flow and revenue measures. We set targets to be appropriately stretching, with regard to a number of internal and external reference points including our business plan and consensus market expectations; and

–  share price performance measures, to reflect the ultimate delivery of shareholder returns which may, for example, include TSR. This promotes alignment between executive director reward and shareholder value creation. Targets are set with reference to wider market practice and positioned at a level which we consider represents stretching performance. Targets will be measured against a comparator group containing other telecommunication companies and/or companies which are either similar in size or market capitalisation and/or have a similar business mix and spread as BT or operate in comparable markets.

 

In terms of weighting, share price performance measures will typically account for no more than 50% of the total award.

 

Under each performance measure, performance below threshold levels would result in nil vesting for that element. For threshold levels of performance, no more than 25% of the maximum for that element would typically vest, rising to 100% for maximum performance.

 

 

Pension

Purpose – to attract and retain executive directors of the right calibre by providing market competitive post-retirement income.

  

Executive directors currently receive a cash allowance in lieu of pension.

 

The committee may determine that alternative pension provisions will operate for new appointments to the Board. When determining pension arrangements for new appointments, the committee will give regard to:

 

–  the cost of the arrangements;

–  pension arrangements received elsewhere in the group; and

–  relevant market practice.

 

The chairman does not receive a pension benefit or payment in lieu of such benefit, but may receive a lump sum death in service benefit of £1m.

 

For executive directors, the maximum cash allowance (or equivalent contribution to an executive director’s pension) may not exceed 30% of salary.

 

Executive directors who are not members of the BT Pension Scheme benefit from a death in service cover of a lump sum of 4x salary and a dependant’s pension of 30% of capped salary.

 

  

 

 
175    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Remuneration Policy

Executive Directors and Chairman continued

    

 

 

  Policy Element

 

  

Operation and Opportunity

 

  

Performance measures or basis of payment

 

 

Save As You Earn Saveshare Scheme

Purpose – to encourage employee share ownership.

 

  

Executive directors and the chairman may participate in the all-employee saveshare (HMRC approved savings related share option plan) on the same basis as other eligible employees.

 

All participants may invest up to the limits operated by the company at the time set in line with HMRC guidance.

   There are no performance measures attached to these awards.

 

ESIP (directshare)

Purpose – to encourage employee share ownership.

 

  

Executive directors and the chairman may participate in the Directshare (HMRC approved purchase of shares from gross salary) on the same basis as other eligible employees.

 

All participants may invest up to the limits operated by the company at the time set in line with HMRC guidance.

   There are no performance measures attached to these awards.

Notes to the policy table

 

1. For further information on the performance measures applicable to the annual bonus and ISP see pages 139 and 140.
2. No performance measures are applicable to salary, benefits, pension, BT saveshare and BT directshare in line with market practice.
3. Common award terms

Awards under any of the company’s share plans referred to in this report may:

 

incorporate the right to receive the value of dividends that would have been paid on the shares subject to an award that vests, which may be calculated assuming the shares were reinvested in shares on a cumulative basis. This value will normally be delivered in the form of additional shares;
be granted as conditional share awards or in such other form that the committee determines has the same economic effect;
have any performance conditions applicable to them varied or substituted by the committee if an event occurs which causes the committee to determine that the performance conditions no longer achieve their original purpose, provided that the varied or substituted performance condition would be not be materially less difficult to satisfy;
be settled in cash at the committee’s discretion; and
be adjusted in the event of any variation of the company’s share capital or any demerger, special dividend or other event that may affect the current or future value of awards.

 

 
176    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Remuneration arrangements throughout the company

BT operates in a number of different environments and has many employees who carry out diverse jobs across a number of countries:

 

all employees, including directors, are paid by reference to the market rate;

 

performance for managers is measured and rewarded through a number of performance-related bonus schemes across the group;

 

business unit performance measures are cascaded down through the organisation;

 

BT offers employment conditions that reflect our values and are commensurate with a large publicly listed company, including high standards of health and safety and equal opportunities;

 

BT operates all employee share plans in many countries. These are open to all employees where offered; and

 

BT offers a range of employee benefits many of which are available to everyone.

Recruitment

Our recruitment policy is based on a number of key principles:

 

we aim to provide a remuneration package which is sufficient to attract, retain and motivate key talent, while at all times ensuring that we pay no more than is necessary, with due regard to the best interests of the company and our shareholders;

 

the committee will take a number of factors into account in determining the appropriate remuneration package. For example, these may typically include the candidate’s experience and calibre, their circumstances, external market influences and arrangements for existing executive directors;

 

the ongoing remuneration package offered to new directors will only include those elements listed within the policy table;

 

the committee may also consider providing additional benefits to expatriate appointments, where appropriate; and

 

the committee will provide full details of the recruitment package for new executive directors in the next Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration and will provide shareholders with the rationale for the decisions that were taken.

The maximum level of variable pay (excluding buyouts for which see below) which may be awarded in respect of a recruitment event (internal or external), will not exceed 740% of base salary, representing the current maximum award under the annual bonus and ISP.

In addition, to facilitate recruitment, the committee may make awards to buy-out variable incentives which the individual would forfeit at their current employer. The committee will give consideration to any relevant factors, typically including the form of the award (eg cash or shares), the proportion of the performance/vesting period outstanding and the potential value of the forfeited remuneration, including performance conditions attached to the awards, the likelihood of those conditions being met, and the timing of any potential payments.

In making buying-out awards, the committee may use the relevant provision in the Financial Conduct Authority Listing Rules.

This allows for the granting of awards specifically to facilitate, in unusual circumstances, the recruitment of an executive director, without seeking prior shareholder approval. In doing so, the committee will comply with the relevant provisions in force at the date of this report.

Where an executive director is appointed from within the organisation, the company will honour legacy arrangements in line with the original terms and conditions.

In the event of the appointment of a new non-executive director, remuneration arrangements will be in line with those detailed on page 135.

Payment for loss of office

In a departure event, the committee will typically consider:

 

whether any element of annual bonus should be paid for the financial year. Any bonus paid will normally be limited to the period served during the financial year in which the departure occurs;

 

whether any of the share element of deferred bonus awarded in prior years should be preserved either in full or in part; and

 

whether any awards under the ISP should be preserved either in full or in part and, if relevant, whether the post vesting holding period should apply.

The committee has historically maintained a discretionary approach to the treatment of leavers, on the basis that the facts and circumstances of each case are unique.

In an exit situation, the committee will consider: the individual circumstances; any mitigating factors that might be relevant; the appropriate statutory and contractual position and the requirements of the business for speed of change.

The default position is that an unvested ISP or DBP award or entitlement lapses on cessation of employment, unless the committee applies discretion to preserve some or all of the awards.

This provides the committee with the maximum flexibility to review the facts and circumstances of each case, allowing differentiation between good and bad leavers and avoiding ‘payment for failure’.

When considering a departure event, there are a number of factors which the committee takes into account in determining appropriate treatment for outstanding incentive awards.

These include:

 

the position under the relevant plan documentation;

 

the individual circumstances of the departure;

 

the performance of the company/individual during the year to date; and

 

the nature of the handover process.
 

 

 
177    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Remuneration Policy

Executive Directors and Chairman continued

    

 

In some cases, the treatment is formally prescribed under the rules of the relevant plan so that where there are ‘good leaver’ circumstances awards, which would otherwise lapse by default, vest either on the normal vesting date or on cessation of employment. These circumstances include death, injury, ill-health, disability, redundancy or sale of the company or business. If the director dies or leaves due to ill health, injury or disability, ISP awards which have less than 12 months of the performance period remaining or DBP awards which have less than 12 months of the deferred period to run, vest automatically on leaving. In other leaver circumstances the committee has discretion to determine whether, when, and to what extent, awards vest. Where a director leaves where some of his shares acquired under an ISP award are subject to a holding period, that holding period will continue to apply unless the committee determines otherwise.

The committee considers the leaver circumstances along a continuum, ranging from ‘bad leaver’ scenarios such as termination of employment for gross misconduct or resignation, through to the ‘good leaver’ scenarios outlined above. Accordingly the committee may apply (or disapply) such performance conditions or time pro-rating to awards vesting in these circumstances as it considers appropriate.

All-employee plans – leavers

The treatment of saveshare options and directshare shares on leaving is as determined under the respective HMRC approved rules. For saveshare, someone who ceases to be an employee in special circumstances (for example injury, disability, death, or following sale of the company or business where they work) may exercise the option within six months after leaving (or 12 months in the case of death) or the relevant corporate event. If someone leaves for a reason not falling within special circumstances, the option lapses on the date the individual leaves.

ISP/DBP – change of control

In the event of a takeover or scheme of arrangement involving the company, ISP and DBP awards will vest, at a minimum, to

the extent that any applicable performance measures have been satisfied at the time (subject to the committee’s discretion to determine the appropriate level of vesting, having regard to such relevant factors as it decides to take into account). If the acquiring company offers to exchange awards over BT shares for awards over its shares (or shares in another company), awards will normally be exchanged and continue under the rules of the relevant plan. If within 12 months of a change of control, a participant’s employment is terminated by his employer other than for misconduct or performance or he or she resigned as a result of a reduction of his or her duties or responsibilities constituting a material breach of the individual’s contract, the participant is entitled to receive an amount equal to the difference between the value he or she received on the change of control he would have received if the relevant performance condition had been met in full.

In the event of a voluntary winding up of the company, awards may vest on the members’ resolution to voluntarily wind-up the company being passed.

Employment conditions elsewhere in the group

The committee considers the pay and conditions of employees throughout the company when determining the remuneration arrangements for executive directors although no direct comparison metrics are applied.

In particular, the committee considers the relationship between general changes to UK employees’ remuneration and executive director reward.

Whilst the committee does not directly consult with our employees as part of the process of determining executive pay, the Board does receive feedback from employee surveys that takes into account remuneration in general. The committee also receives updates from the group HR director.

 

 

 

  Provision

 

  

Policy

 

 

Notice period

  

–  12 months’ notice by the company, six months’ notice by the executive director or chairman (there is no fixed expiry date).

 

Termination payment

  

–  In lieu of giving an executive director or the chairman 12 months’ notice, BT may terminate the director’s contract and make a payment in lieu of notice to which the director was entitled if he or she had received salary and the value of contractual benefits for the period.

  

–  In respect of the executive directors, the payments in lieu will be payable in equal monthly instalments until the date on which the notice period would have expired or (if earlier) the date on which the director secures alternate employment with the same or higher basic salary or fee. In the event that the director secures alternate employment at a basic salary of £30,000 or higher, but lower than their salary, payment in lieu will be reduced by the amount of the new lower salary received. The Board retains the right to lower the payment in lieu of the directors new employment if it considers the new employment terms of the director are not appropriately balanced between basic salary and other elements, and may cease making payments entirely where the Board is not satisfied the director is making reasonable efforts to secure alternative employment.

  

–  In respect of the chairman, the payment in lieu will be payable in equal monthly instalments until the earlier of 12 months from the date of termination or the date the chairman secures alternate full-time employment.

 

 

 

Remuneration and benefits

  

 

–  Participation in the incentive plans, ISP, DBP and annual bonus, saveshare and directshare, is non- contractual. The chairman does not participate in the ISP, DBP or any annual bonus.

  

–  Other benefits include pension (including life cover), dental cover, company car, fuel or driver, private health care (including spouse and children under age of 18 or 21 if in full time education), telecommunication facilities, home security and professional subscriptions. The chairman does not receive pension benefits but is entitled to all other benefits.

  

–  The chairman receives an all-inclusive fee for the role.

  

 

 
178    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Executive director and chairman service contracts

The other key terms of the service contracts for the current executive directors and the chairman are set out below. The termination provisions described above are without prejudice to BT’s ability in appropriate circumstances to terminate in breach of the notice period referred to above, and thereby be liable for damages to the executive director or chairman.

In the event of termination by BT, each executive director and the chairman may have entitlement to compensation in respect of his or her statutory rights under employment protection legislation in the UK.

Where appropriate, BT may also meet a director’s reasonable legal expenses in connection with either his or her appointment or termination of his or her appointment.

There are no other service agreements, letters of appointment or material contracts, existing or proposed, between the company and any of the executive directorIllustration of executive director pay scenarios.

Our remuneration policy aims to ensure that a significant proportion of pay is dependent on the achievement of stretching performance targets. The committee has considered the level of total remuneration that would be payable under different performance scenarios and is satisfied that, as the graph below illustrates, executive pay is appropriate in the context of the performance required and is aligned with shareholders’ interests.

The illustrative scenarios below set out the total remuneration that might be received by each executive director for different levels of performance, based on our remuneration policy.

The minimum reflects base salary, pension and benefits only which are not performance related.

 

    

Performance

 

  

Assumptions

 

 

Fixed pay

   All scenarios    Consists of total fixed pay – base salary, benefits and pension:
     

–  Base salary – salary effective as at June 2017

     

–  Benefits – amount received by each director in 2016/17

     

–  Pension – cash supplement in lieu of pension provision for 2016/17

 

 

Variable

   Minimum   

–  No payout under the annual bonus

pay

     

–  No vesting under the ISP

 

  

 

   On-target   

–  On target payout under the annual bonus

     

–  25% of maximum vesting under the ISP

 

  

 

   Maximum   

–  100% of the maximum payout under the annual bonus

     

–  100% of maximum vesting under the ISP

 

 

 

For the purposes of the scenarios chart for the group finance director, we have increased the amount received in 2016/17 on a pro-rata basis to reflect a full financial year. The chief executive has a target bonus of 120% of salary, with a maximum bonus of 240% of salary. The group finance director has a target bonus of 120% of salary, with a maximum bonus of 180% of salary.

 

For these purposes, we have assumed a usual maximum ISP award of 400% of base salary for the chief executive and 350% of base salary for the group finance director. The absolute maximum ISP award under our remuneration policy is 500% of base salary.

ISP awards have been shown at face value, with no share price growth or discount rate assumptions. All-employee share plans (saveshare and directshare) have been excluded, as have any legacy awards held by executive directors.

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

Fixed pay is calculated as follows:

 

     

Salary

£000

       Benefits
£000
       Pension
£000
       Total  
fixed pay  
 
Chief executive      997          54          298          1,349    
Group finance director      700          24          210          934    
 

 

 
179    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Remuneration Policy

Executive Directors and Chairman continued

    

 

Other Remuneration Policies

Malus and clawback

Under the terms of the DBP and ISP, if following the grant of an award, facts subsequently become known to the committee which would justify a reduction in the award, the committee may reduce the number of shares under award to take account of this, including to nil. In order to retain flexibility, the events under which this may apply are not formally stipulated in the rules. However, for illustration, such events may include, for example, mis-statement of the financial accounts, fraud or material failure of risk management.

Clawback provisions are also in place for the cash part of the annual bonus and ISP awards granted from June 2015 onwards. Under the annual bonus, clawback will normally apply for one year following payment. The ISP clawback arrangements may be enforced by the committee in the two year period post-vesting of any awards. The circumstances in which the committee may consider it appropriate to apply clawback include, but are not limited to i) the behaviour of the participant which fails to reflect the company’s governance and business values; ii) material adverse change in the financial performance of the company

or any division in which the participant works and/or worked; iii) a material misstatement of the company’s audited financial accounts (other than as a result of a change in accounting practices); iv) misconduct of a participant which results in or is likely to result in reputational damage to the company; v) a material failure in risk management; vi) negligence or gross misconduct of a participant; and/or vii) fraud effected by or with knowledge of a participant.

Other elements of remuneration are not subject to recovery arrangements.

Consideration of shareholder views

The committee is strongly committed to an open and transparent dialogue with shareholders on remuneration matters. We believe that it is important to meet regularly with our key shareholders to understand their views on our remuneration arrangements and discuss our approach going forward.

The committee will continue to engage with shareholders going forward and will aim to consult on any material changes to the Policy or other relevant matters.

 

 

Non-executive director fees

 

 

 Element/purpose and link to strategy

 

  

Operation

 

  

Opportunity

 

 

Purpose

Core element of remuneration, paid for fulfilling the relevant role

  

–  NEDs receive a basic fee, paid monthly in respect of their board duties.

–  Further fees may be paid for chairmanship or membership of Board committees or to the senior independent director.

  

–  Current fee levels can be found in the Annual Report on Remuneration on page 135.

–  Fees are set at a level which is considered appropriate to attract and retain NEDs of the necessary calibre.

  

–  Additional fees of up to £6,000 may also be payable to NEDs travelling regularly from overseas on an intercontinental basis to Board and committee meetings.

–  NEDs are not eligible for annual bonus, share incentives, pensions or other benefits.

–  Expenses incurred in the performance of non-executive duties for the company may be reimbursed (including any relevant tax) or paid directly by the company, as appropriate.

  

–  Fee levels are normally set by reference to the level of fees paid to NEDs serving on boards of similarly-sized, UK-listed companies, taking into account the size, responsibility and time commitment required of the role.

–  The company’s Articles of Association provide the maximum fee level payable. The maximum is based on NED fees benchmarked as at 1 April 1999 with increases linked to the Retail Price Index.

     

 

 
180    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc

 


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

Directors’ information

    

 

 

Statement of directors’ responsibilities

Our directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report, the Report on directors’ remuneration and the financial statements in accordance with applicable law and regulation. Company law requires the directors to prepare financial statements for each financial year. Under that law the directors have prepared the group financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), as adopted by the European Union and company financial statements in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (United Kingdom Accouting Standards Comprising FRS 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework”) and applicable law. In preparing the group financial statements, the directors have also elected to comply with IFRS, issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB). Under company law, the directors must not approve the financial statements unless they are satisfied that they give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the group and company, and of the profit or loss of the group and company for that period.

In preparing the financial statements, the directors are required to:

 

select suitable accounting policies and apply them consistently

 

state whether applicable IFRSs, as adopted by the European Union and IFRSs issued by IASB have been followed for the group financial statements and United Kingdom Accounting Standards comprising FRS 101 have been followed for the company financial statements, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the financial statements

 

make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable and prudent

 

prepare financial statements on a ‘going concern’ basis unless it’s inappropriate to presume that the group and the company will continue in business.

The directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the group and company’s transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the group and company as well as ensuring that the financial statements and the Report on directors’ remuneration comply with the Companies Act 2006 and, as regards the group financial statements, Article 4 of the IAS Regulation.

The directors are also responsible for safeguarding the assets of the group and company, and for taking reasonable steps to prevent and detect fraud and other irregularities.

The directors are responsible for the maintenance and integrity of the company’s website. Legislation in the United Kingdom governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.

 

Each of the directors, whose names and functions are listed on pages 134 to 135, confirms that, to the best of their knowledge:

 

the company financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (United Kingdom Accounting Standards, comprising FRS 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework”, and applicable law), give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit of the company

 

the group financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with IFRSs as adopted by the European Union - Dual IFRS (European Union and IASB) - give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit of the group

 

the Strategic Report on pages 1 to 130 includes a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position of the group and company, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that it faces.

Fair, balanced and understandable

In accordance with the principles of the UK Corporate Governance Code, we’ve put processes and procedures in place to ensure the information presented in the Annual Report is fair, balanced and understandable. We describe these processes and procedures on page 147.

On the advice of the Audit & Risk Committee, the Board considers that the Annual Report, as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable, and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the group and company’s position, performance, business model and strategy.

Critical accounting estimates, key judgements and significant accounting policies

Our critical accounting estimates, key judgements and significant accounting policies conform with IFRSs, as adopted by the European Union and IFRSs issued by IASB, and are set out on pages 208 to 214 of the consolidated financial statements. The directors have reviewed these policies and applicable estimation techniques, and have confirmed they’re appropriate for the preparation of the 2017/18 consolidated financial statements.

Disclosure of information to auditors

As far as each of the directors is aware, there is no relevant audit information (as defined by section 418(3) of the Companies Act

2006) that hasn’t been disclosed to the auditors. Each of the directors believes that all steps have been taken that ought to have been taken to make them aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that the auditors have been made aware of that information.

 

 

 
181    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

    

    

    

 

Going concern

The Strategic Report on pages 1 to 130 includes information on the group structure, strategy and business model, the performance of each customer-facing unit, the impact of regulation and competition, and principal risks and uncertainties. The Group Performance section on pages 118 to 130 includes information on our group financial results, financial outlook, cash flow and net debt, and balance sheet position. Notes 23, 24, 25 and 27 of the consolidated financial statements include information on the group’s investments, cash and cash equivalents, borrowings, derivatives, financial risk management objectives, hedging policies and exposure to interest, foreign exchange, credit, liquidity and market risks.

In line with IAS 1 ‘Presentation of financial statements’, and revised FRC guidance on ‘risk management, internal control and related financial and business reporting’, management has taken into account all available information about the future for a period of at least, but not limited to, 12 months from the date of approval of the financial statements when assessing the group’s ability to continue as a going concern.

The directors carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks affecting the group, including any that could threaten our business model, future performance, insolvency or liquidity. Details of those risks and how we manage and mitigate them are set out in Our principal risks and uncertainties on pages 57 to 70.

Having assessed the principal risks, the directors considered it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting when preparing the financial statements. This assessment covers the period to May 2019, which is consistent with the FRC guidance.

Independent advice

The Board has a procedure that allows directors to seek independent professional advice at BT’s expense.

All directors also have access to the advice and services of the company secretary.

Directors’ and officers’ liability insurance and indemnity

For some years, BT has bought insurance cover for directors, officers and employees in positions of managerial supervision of BT Group plc and its subsidiaries. This is intended to protect against defence costs, civil damages and, in some circumstances, civil fines and penalties following an action brought against them in their personal capacity. The policy also covers individuals serving as directors of other companies or of joint ventures or on boards of trade associations or charitable organisations at BT’s request. The insurance protects the directors and officers directly in circumstances where, by law, BT cannot provide an indemnity. It also provides BT, subject to a retention, with cover against the cost of indemnifying a director or officer. One layer of insurance is ring-fenced for the directors of BT Group plc.

As at 4 May 2018, and throughout 2017/18, the company’s wholly-owned subsidiary, British Telecommunications plc, has provided an indemnity for a group of people similar to the group covered by the above insurance. Neither the insurance nor the indemnity provides cover where the person is proven to have acted fraudulently or dishonestly.

Interest of management in certain transactions

During and at the end of 2017/18, none of BT’s directors was materially interested in any material transaction in relation to the group’s business. None is materially interested in any currently proposed material transactions.

As set out below, Tim Höttges is a member of the Board as well as the CEO of Deutsche Telekom.

Power to authorise conflicts

All directors have a duty under the Companies Act 2006 (“the 2006 Act”) to avoid a situation in which he or she has, or can have, a direct or indirect interest that conflicts, or possibly may conflict, with the interests of the company. The company’s Articles of Association include provisions for dealing with directors’ conflicts of interest in accordance with the 2006 Act. The company has procedures in place, which it follows, to deal with such situations. These require the Board to:

 

consider each conflict situation separately on its particular facts

 

consider the conflict situation in conjunction with its other duties under the 2006 Act

 

keep records and Board minutes on any authorisations granted by directors and the scope of any approvals given

 

regularly review conflict authorisation.

We also have a Conflicted Matters Committee. Tim Höttges owes duties to both BT and Deutsche Telekom, and the Conflicted Matters Committee helps him comply with his fiduciary duties (although ultimate responsibility rests with him).

 

 

 
182    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

General information

    

 

US regulation

New York Stock Exchange

BT, as a foreign issuer with American Depositary Shares listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE), is obliged to disclose any significant ways in which its corporate governance practices differ from the corporate governance listing standards of the NYSE.

We’ve reviewed the NYSE’s listing standards and believe that our corporate governance practices are consistent with them, with the following exception where we don’t meet the strict requirements in the standards. These state that companies must have a nominating/ corporate governance committee composed entirely of independent directors and with written terms of reference which, in addition to identifying individuals qualified to become board members, develops and recommends to the Board a set of corporate governance principles applicable to the company. We have a Nominating & Governance Committee whose terms of reference include governance and compliance issues (see Nominating & Governance Committee chairman’s report on pages 150 to 151). The Nominating & Governance Committee’s terms of reference are in line with the requirements set out in the standards. However, the committee is chaired by the chairman, Jan du Plessis, who isn’t considered independent under the NYSE’s listing standards. Tim Höttges, our non-independent, non-executive director, joined the committee on 1 May 2018. The Board and the Nominating & Governance Committee are made up of a majority of independent, non-executive directors.

The US Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Sarbanes-Oxley Act), the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and NYSE listing standards require companies to comply with certain provisions relating to their audit committee. These include the independence of audit committee members and procedures for the treatment of complaints regarding accounting or auditing matters. We comply fully with these requirements.

US Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

BT has securities registered with the SEC. As a result, we must comply with those provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act which apply to foreign issuers. We comply with the legal and regulatory requirements introduced under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, in so far as they apply.

The Audit & Risk Committee includes Nick Rose who, in the opinion of the Board, is an ‘audit committee financial expert’ and is independent (as defined for this purpose). The Board considers that the committee’s members have broad commercial knowledge and extensive business leadership experience, having held between them various prior roles in major business, financial management, and financial function supervision and that this constitutes a broad and suitable mix of business and financial experience on the committee.

The code of ethics we have adopted for the purposes of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act applies to the chief executive, chief financial officer and senior finance managers.

 

Controls and procedures

Background and status of remediation of material weakness reported in 2017

In October 2016 we reported that following an initial investigation we had identified improper accounting practices in our Italian business. We had appointed KPMG, with support and oversight from our Legal, Governance and Compliance function and Freshfields Bruckhaus Deringer, reporting directly to both the chair of the Audit & Risk Committee and BT Group chairman, to perform an independent investigation, alongside our own investigation and detailed balance sheet review. In January 2017 we reported that the investigations had revealed that the extent and complexity of the improper practices were greater than previously identified and that these had resulted in an overstatement of profits over a number of years.

The investigations uncovered that individuals in our Italian business colluded to override the period end financial close controls and overstate the results, and the monitoring controls which include the review of reconciliations, journals, results and financial position, did not operate effectively to identify the overstatement in a timely manner. Management concluded that the group did not maintain effective controls to prevent or detect the collusive circumvention or override of controls related to our Italian business. Specifically management identified the following internal control deficiencies related to our Italian business and the failure to detect the circumvention or override of controls: (i) failure in the review of reconciliations, (ii) failure in the review of journals and (iii) failure in our monitoring controls over the results and financial position of our Italian business. Together, these deficiencies constituted a material weakness in the control environment, and management concluded that, as of 31 March 2017, our internal control over financial reporting was not effective.

Remediation

Beginning in October 2016, and later informed by the results of the KPMG investigation and management’s own review, management implemented a series of remedial and compensating actions, including suspending key members of the management team in Italy (who have now left the business) and appointing a new senior management team in Italy, strengthening the monitoring controls and escalation mechanisms in our finance shared service centres, transferring Italy in-country managed customer billing activities to the group customer billing team and performing detailed substantive reviews of the balance sheet of our Italian business and other large country operations outside the UK. The active engagement in the design and implementation of remediation efforts intended to address the material weakness in the control environment as of 31 March 2017 has continued during 2017/18 as described below. The design and implementation of these and other remedial efforts are the responsibility of management.

We have implemented a number of changes across the group including steps to improve processes and controls, not only in Italy, but also in our shared service centres, in Global Services and across the wider group.

 

 

 
183    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

General information continued

    

    

 

In relation to the matters that gave rise to the material weakness in the control environment, that existed as of 31 March 2017, we have strengthened our review of reconciliations, journals, results and the financial position for Italy. Specifically:

 

we introduced enhanced and detailed policies and procedures including a detailed checklist that must be followed when reviewing any journals in Italy and in our Budapest shared service centre

 

we enhanced the review of reconciliations including the review of significant and aged reconciling items within balance sheet account reconciliations

 

we introduced new detailed oversight controls to holistically review the results and financial position of Italy and other material overseas territories.

We also introduced similar enhancements to journals, reconciliation and oversight controls (assessing the results and financial position) in relation to other material overseas territories and provided additional control guidance and procedures to local finance teams, including a clear policy as to when and whom concerns should be escalated.

Each of these enhanced and new controls is operating effectively.

We have also sought to improve the capabilities of our functions outside the UK. We have reviewed the talent mix on international leadership teams, including establishing an ex-pat programme. Within Italy, we have made further senior finance appointments, including a new deputy CFO and financial controller. We have established monitoring to detect early warning signs and assessed target setting and remuneration to ensure it reflects balanced risks and opportunities.

We have continued our programme of detailed balance sheet reviews in our operations in Global Services outside of the UK. Combined with the reviews performed in 2016/17, these have now covered around 80% by asset value of the operations outside the UK. These reviews have not identified any similar issues or areas of concern elsewhere, giving us comfort that the inappropriate behaviours were isolated to Italy.

Across the group, we have enhanced our controls and compliance programmes to strengthen awareness of the standards we expect, and reinforced the importance of doing business in an ethical and disciplined way. We have also sought to enhance the capabilities of our people. All finance employees have completed Financial Statement Fraud awareness training which includes a module on how to escalate concerns. We have redefined and communicated our three lines of defence model and developed and communicated these enhanced controls, policies and procedures.

At the group level, we have introduced enhanced integrated financial risk and assurance reviews which combine a review of controls and compliance issues, external and internal audit findings, risk registers and legal matters, alongside the reviews of performance, financial position, business and accounting issues and quality of earnings analysis of each of our customer-facing units and corporate units.

As a result of these remediation efforts, including allowing for a sufficient period of time to confirm that the new processes and controls put in place as part of the remediation are operating effectively, management has concluded that we have remediated the material weakness identified as of 31 March 2017. While we are satisfied with the improvements to processes and controls we have implemented in the year, we recognise that further system and process improvement opportunities exist which will continue to be a focus in 2018/19.

Disclosure controls and procedures

We maintain disclosure controls and procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in our reports under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Exchange Act), and the rules and regulations thereunder, is recorded, processed, summarised and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms and that such information is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our chief executive and chief financial officer to allow for timely decisions regarding required disclosure. In designing and evaluating the disclosure controls and procedures, management recognises that any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving their objectives and management necessarily applies its judgement and makes assumptions about the likelihood of future events. There can be no assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions, regardless of how remote.

We have evaluated the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures. Based upon that evaluation, our chief executive and chief financial officer concluded that, as of 31 March 2018, our disclosure controls and procedures are effective to provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file or furnish under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarised and reported, within the time periods specified in the applicable rules and forms.

 

 

 
184    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the group. Internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of consolidated financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB and IFRS as adopted by the EU.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Therefore even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of 31 March 2018 based on the criteria established in “Internal Control – Integrated Framework” (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

Following this assessment, management has concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of 31 March 2018.

Audit of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting

Our independent registered public accounting firm, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, has audited the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting, as stated in their report as of 31 March 2018, which is included herein.

Changes in internal control over financial reporting

Changes in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during 2017/18, which have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting are described above under Remediation, on page 183.

UK internal control and risk management

The Board is responsible for the group’s systems of internal control and risk management, and for reviewing the effectiveness of those systems each year. These systems are designed to manage, rather than eliminate, risks we face that may prevent us achieving our business objectives; any system can provide only reasonable, and not absolute, assurance against material misstatement or loss.

For details of our assessment of our internal controls for the purposes of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, see US Regulation on page 183.

The Board also takes account of significant social, environmental and ethical matters that relate to BT’s businesses, and reviews BT’s corporate responsibility policy every year. We describe our workplace practices, specific environmental, social and ethical risks and opportunities, and details of underlying governance processes on pages 1 to 130 in the Strategic Report.

We’ve enterprise-wide risk management processes in place for identifying, evaluating and managing the principal risks faced by the group. These processes have been in place throughout the year and have continued up to the date on which this document was approved. The processes are in accordance with the FRC guidance on risk management, internal control and related financial and business reporting.

Risk assessment and evaluation take place as an integral part of BT’s annual strategic planning cycle. We’ve a detailed risk management process which identifies the key risks facing the group, our customer-facing units and TSO.

The key features of our enterprise-wide risk management and internal control process (covering financial, operational and compliance controls) are:

 

senior executives collectively review the group’s key risks, and have created a Group Risk Register describing the risks, their owners and associated mitigation strategies. The Group Risk Panel and the Executive Committee reviews this before it’s reviewed and approved by the Board

 

our customer-facing units and TSO carry out risk assessments of their operations, create risk registers relating to those operations and ensure that the key risks are addressed

 

senior executives with responsibility for major group operations report quarterly their opinion on the effectiveness of the operation of internal controls in their areas of responsibility

 

the group’s internal auditors carry out ongoing assessments of the quality of risk management and control, report to management and the Audit & Risk Committee on the status of specific areas identified for improvement, and promote effective risk management in customer-facing units and TSO

 

the Audit & Risk Committee, on behalf of the Board, considers the effectiveness of the group’s internal control procedures during the financial year. It reviews reports from the internal and external auditors, and reports its conclusions to the Board. The Audit & Risk Committee has carried out these actions for 2017/18

 

the Audit & Risk Committee, on behalf of the Board, reviews the effectiveness of risk management arrangements across the group. In support of this, the chief executive and the CEOs of each customer-facing unit hold an annual review meeting.

We haven’t included joint ventures and associates, which BT doesn’t control, as part of the group risk management process. Third parties we enter into joint ventures with are responsible for their own internal control assessment.

We’ve set out our significant accounting policies on pages 209 to 214. The consistent application of those policies is subject to ongoing verification through management review and independent review by internal and external auditors.

The processes supporting the preparation and consolidation of the financial statements have been documented and are subject to annual verification through the programme of testing completed by our internal auditors. This serves to confirm the operation of internal controls over financial reporting, and compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. The Audit & Risk Committee reviews BT’s published financial results, related disclosures and accounting judgements. The committee’s activities are set out on pages 144 to 149.

 

 

 
185    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

General information continued

    

    

 

The Board has approved the formal statement of matters reserved to it for consideration, approval or oversight. It’s also approved the group’s corporate governance framework, which sets out the high level principles by which BT is managed and the responsibilities and powers of the chief executive and the group’s senior executives. As part of this framework, the development and implementation of certain powers relating to group-wide policies and practices are reserved to identified senior executives.

Capital management and funding policy

The objective of our capital management policy is to target an overall level of debt consistent with our credit rating objectives, while investing in the business, supporting the pension fund and paying progressive dividends.

The Board reviews the group’s capital structure regularly. Management proposes actions which reflect the group’s investment plans and risk characteristics, as well as the macro-economic conditions in which we operate.

Our funding policy is to raise and invest funds centrally to meet the group’s anticipated requirements. We use a combination of capital market bond issuance, commercial paper borrowing and committed borrowing facilities to fund the group. When issuing debt, in order to avoid refinancing risk, group treasury will take into consideration the maturity profile of the group’s debt portfolio as well as forecast cash flows.

See note 27 to the consolidated financial statements for details of our treasury policy.

Financial instruments

Details of the group’s financial risk management objectives and policies of the group and exposure to interest risk, credit risk, liquidity risk and foreign exchange are given in note 27 to the consolidated financial statements.

Credit risk management policy

We take proactive steps to minimise the impact of adverse market conditions on our financial instruments. In managing investments and derivative financial instruments, the group’s central treasury function monitors the credit quality across treasury counterparties and actively manages any exposures which arise. Management within the business units also actively monitors any exposures arising from trading balances.

Off-balance sheet arrangements

Other than the financial commitments and contingent liabilities disclosed in note 30 to the consolidated financial statements, there are no off-balance sheet arrangements that have, or are reasonably likely to have, a current or future material effect on:

 

our financial condition

 

changes in financial condition

 

revenues or expenses

 

results of operations

 

liquidity

 

capital expenditure

 

capital resources.

Legal proceedings

The group is involved in various legal proceedings, including actual or threatened litigation and government or regulatory investigations. For further details of legal and regulatory proceedings to which the group is party please see note 30 to the consolidated financial statements on pages 262 to 263.

Apart from the information disclosed in note 30 to the consolidated financial statements, the group does not currently believe that there are any legal proceedings, government or regulatory investigations that may have a material adverse impact on the operations or financial condition of the group. In respect of each of the claims described in note 30, the nature and progression of such proceedings and investigations can make it difficult to predict the impact they will have on the group. Many factors prevent us from making these assessments with certainty, including that the proceedings or investigations are in early stages, no damages or remedies have been specified, and/or the often slow pace of litigation.

 

 

 
186    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

       

 

   

 

 

    

    

    

 

Other information – Listing Rules

For the purposes of LR 9.8.4CR, the information required to be disclosed by LR 9.8.4R is on the following pages:

 

Section Information    Page

  (1)

   Interest capitalised    Not material for the group

  (2)

   Publication of unaudited financial information    24 to 25

  (4)

   Details of unusual long-term incentive schemes    Not applicable

  (5)

   Waiver of emoluments by a director    Not applicable

  (6)

   Waiver of future emoluments by a director    Not applicable

  (7)

   Non pre-emptive issues of equity for cash    Not applicable

  (8)

   Non pre-emptive issue by a major subsidiary undertaking    Not applicable

  (9)

   Parent participation in a placing by a listed subsidiary    Not applicable

  (10)

   Contracts of significance involving a director or controlling shareholder    Not applicable

  (11)

   Provision of services by a controlling shareholder    Not applicable

  (12)

   Shareholder waiver of dividends    See below

  (13)

   Shareholder waiver of future dividends    See below

  (14)

   Agreements with controlling shareholders    Not applicable  

In respect of LR 9.8.4R (12) and (13), the Trustee of the BT Group Employee Share Ownership Trust agrees to waive dividends payable on the BT shares it holds for satisfying awards under various BT executive share plans. Under the rules of these share plans, the dividends are reinvested in BT shares that are added to the relevant share awards.

Other statutory information – Companies Act 2006

Certain provisions of the 2006 Act require us to make additional disclosures. These are described on the pages listed below:

 

Information    Page

Structure of BT’s share capital (including the rights and obligations attaching to the shares)

   204 and 302 to 304

Restrictions on the transfer of BT shares and voting rights

   302 to 304

Significant direct or indirect shareholdings

   143

Appointment and replacement of directors

   172 and 304  

Significant agreements to which BT Group plc is a party that take effect, alter or terminate upon a change of control following a takeover

   Not applicable  

The following disclosures aren’t covered elsewhere in this Annual Report:

 

BT has two employee share ownership trusts that hold BT shares for satisfying awards under our various employee share plans. The Trustee of the BT Group Employee Share Investment Plan may invite participants, on whose behalf it holds shares, to direct it how to vote in respect of those shares. If there’s an offer for the shares or other transaction which would lead to a change of control of BT, participants may direct the Trustee to accept the offer or agree to the transaction. In respect of shares held in the BT Group Employee Share Ownership Trust, the Trustee abstains from voting those shares

 

if there’s an offer for the shares, the Trustee doesn’t have to accept or reject the offer but will have regard to the interests of the participants, may consult them to obtain their views on the offer, and may otherwise take the action with respect to the offer it thinks fair

 

no person holds securities carrying special rights with regard to control of the company

 

proxy appointment and voting instructions must be received by the registrars no less than 48 hours before a general meeting (see also page 302)

 

any amendment of BT’s Articles of Association requires shareholder approval in accordance with applicable legislation

 

the powers of the directors are determined by UK legislation and the Articles of Association. The directors are authorised to issue and allot shares, and to undertake purchases of BT shares subject to shareholder approval at the AGM

 

we’ve no agreements with directors providing for compensation for loss of office or employment as a result of a takeover. Similarly, there’s no provision for this in our standard employee contracts

 

we aren’t aware of any agreements between shareholders that may result in restrictions on the transfer of shares or on voting rights.
 

 

 
187    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

    

    

    

 

Political donations

Our policy is that no company in the group will make contributions in cash or kind to any political party, whether by gift or loan. However, the definition of political donations used in the 2006 Act is very much broader than the sense in which these words are ordinarily used. For example, it could cover things like making members of parliament and others in the political world aware of key industry issues and matters affecting the company, enhancing their understanding of BT.

The authority for political donations we’re requesting at the AGM isn’t intended to change this policy. It will, however, ensure that the group continues to act within the provisions of the 2006 Act requiring companies to obtain shareholder authority before they make donations to EU political parties and/or political organisations as defined in the 2006 Act. During 2017/18, the company’s wholly owned subsidiary, British Telecommunications plc, paid the costs of attending corporate days at (i) the Conservative party conference; (ii) the Labour party conference; and (iii) the Scottish National Party conference. These costs totalled £3,829 (2016/17: £6,870). No company in the BT group made any loans to any political party.

Cross reference to the Strategic Report

In line with the Companies Act, we’ve chosen to include the following information in the Strategic Report (required by law to be included in the Report of the Directors):

 

the final dividend proposed by the Board (page 120)

 

an indication of likely future developments in the business of the company (see the Strategic Report on pages 1 to 130)

 

an indication of our R&D activities (page 37)

 

information about our people (page 43)

 

information about greenhouse gas emissions (page 54).

By order of the Board

Dan Fitz

Company Secretary

9 May 2018

 

 

 
188    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

 

 

LOGO

 

    

      Financial

      statements

Detailed analysis of our statutory accounts, independently audited and providing in-depth disclosure on the financial performance and position of the group.

Financial statements

     

Auditors’ reports

     
 

consolidated financial statements

  
 

United Kingdom opinion

   190   
 

United States opinion

   200   

Group income statement

   201   

Group statement of comprehensive income

   202   

Group balance sheet

   203   

Group statement of changes in equity

   204                    

Group cash flow statement

   205   

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

     
 

Basis of preparation

   206   
 

Critical accounting estimates and key judgements

   208   
 

Significant accounting policies

   209   
 

Segment information

   215   
 

Operating costs

   219   
 

Employees

   220   
 

Audit, audit related and other non-audit services

   221   
 

Specific items

   222   
 

Taxation

   223   
 

Earnings per share

   226   
 

Dividends

   227   
 

Intangible assets

   227   
 

Property, plant and equipment

   230   
 

Business combinations

   231   
 

Programme rights

   231   
 

Inventories

   232   
 

Trade and other receivables

   232   
 

Trade and other payables

   234   
 

Provisions

   234   
 

Retirement benefit plans

   235   
 

Own shares

   247   
 

Share-based payments

   247   
 

Investments

   249   
 

Cash and cash equivalents

   250   
 

Loans and other borrowings

   250   
 

Finance expense

   254   
 

Financial instruments and risk management

   255   
 

Other reserves

   261   
 

Related party transactions

   261   
 

Financial commitments and contingent liabilities

   262   
 

Post balance sheet events

   264   
Financial statements of BT Group plc    267   
Related undertakings    271   
Additional information    287   
 

 

 


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Independent auditors’ report to the members of BT Group plc

Report on the audit of the financial statements

 

Report on the audit of the financial statements

Opinion

In our opinion:

BT Group plc’s group financial statements and parent company financial statements (the “financial statements”) give a true and fair view of the state of the group’s and of the parent company’s affairs as at 31 March 2018 and of the group’s profit and cash flows for the year then ended;
the group financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with IFRSs as adopted by the European Union;
the parent company financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (United Kingdom Accounting Standards, comprising FRS 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework”, and applicable law); and
the financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006 and, as regards the group financial statements, Article 4 of the IAS Regulation.

We have audited the financial statements, included within the Annual Report & Form 20-F 2018 (the “Annual Report”), which comprise: the group and BT Group plc company balance sheets as at 31 March 2018; the group income statement, the group statement of comprehensive income, the group cash flow statement, and the group and BT Group plc company statements of changes in equity for the year then ended; and the notes to the financial statements, which include a description of the significant accounting policies.

Our opinion is consistent with our reporting to the Audit & Risk Committee.

Separate opinion in relation to IFRSs as issued by the IASB

As explained in note 1 to the group financial statements, the group, in addition to applying IFRSs as adopted by the European Union, has also applied IFRSs as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB).

In our opinion, the group financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with IFRSs as issued by the IASB.

Basis for opinion

We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) and applicable law. Our responsibilities under ISAs (UK) are further described in the Auditors’ responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements section of our report. We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion.

Independence

We remained independent of the group in accordance with the ethical requirements that are relevant to our audit of the financial statements in the UK, which includes the FRC’s Ethical Standard, as applicable to listed public interest entities, and we have fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with these requirements.

To the best of our knowledge and belief, we declare that non-audit services prohibited by the FRC’s Ethical Standard were not provided to the group or the parent company.

Other than those disclosed in note 7 to the group financial statements, we have provided no non-audit services to the group or the parent company in the period from 1 April 2017 to 31 March 2018.

Our audit approach

Overview

Materiality  

– Overall group materiality: £130m (2016/17: £130m), based on 5% of profit before tax.

   

– Overall parent company materiality: £130m (2016/17: £130m), based on 1% of total assets, limited so as not to exceed the group’s materiality.

Audit scope  

– The locations included and work performed were:

 

– Full scope audits of British Telecommunications plc and EE in the UK, and the principal reporting unit in Italy.

 

– Audit of certain financial statement line items in Germany, Ireland, Spain, the US and an additional reporting unit in the UK.

   

– Specified procedures on certain financial statement line items in Switzerland.

Key audit matters    

– Assessment of the carrying value of goodwill in Global Services;

 

– Major contracts in Global Services, Business and Public Sector and EE;

 

– Accuracy of revenue due to complex billing systems;

 

– Valuation of pension scheme obligations and unquoted investments in the BT Pension Scheme;

 

– Adequacy of regulatory and other provisions;

 

– Recognition and measurement of potential tax exposures and deferred tax assets;

 

– BT Italy – changes to the control environment and review of estimates made in 2016/17; and

   

– Cost capitalisation and asset lives for property, plant and equipment and software intangible assets.

The scope of our audit

As part of designing our audit, we determined materiality and assessed the risks of material misstatement in the financial statements. In particular, we looked at where the directors made subjective judgements, for example in respect of significant

 

 

 
190     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

accounting estimates that involved making assumptions and considering future events that are inherently uncertain. We gained an understanding of the legal and regulatory framework applicable to the group and the industry in which it operates, and considered the risk of acts by the group which were contrary to applicable laws and regulations, including fraud. We designed audit procedures at group and significant component level to respond to the risk, recognising that the risk of not detecting a material misstatement due to fraud is higher than the risk of not detecting one resulting from error, as fraud may involve deliberate concealment by, for example, forgery or intentional misrepresentations, or through collusion. We focused on laws and regulations that could give rise to a material misstatement in the group and parent company financial statements, including, but not limited to, the Companies Act 2006, the UK Listing Rules and certain requirements from the Communications Act 2003. Our tests included, but were not limited to, agreement of the financial statement disclosures to underlying supporting documentation, review of correspondence with regulators, review of correspondence with legal advisors, enquiries of management, review of significant component auditors’ working papers and review of internal audit reports in so far as they related to the financial statements. There are inherent limitations in the audit

procedures described above and the further removed non-compliance with laws and regulations is from the events and transactions reflected in the financial statements, the less likely we would become aware of it.

As in all of our audits we also addressed the risk of management override of internal controls, including testing journals and evaluating whether there was evidence of bias by the directors that represented a risk of material misstatement due to fraud.

Key audit matters

Key audit matters are those matters that, in the auditors’ professional judgement, were of most significance in the audit of the financial statements of the current period and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) identified by the auditors, including those which had the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the engagement team. These matters, and any comments we make on the results of our procedures thereon, were addressed in the context of our audit of the financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion on these matters. This is not a complete list of all risks identified by our audit.

 

 

 
191     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Independent auditors’ report to the members of BT Group plc continued

Report on the audit of the financial statements continued

    

 

 

Key audit matter

 

   How our audit addressed the key audit matter

Assessment of the carrying value of goodwill in Global Services

Page 147 in the Audit & Risk Committee section of the Annual Report and note 12 in the notes to the financial statements. (relevant to the group financial statements)

As at 31 March 2018, goodwill relating to the Global Services CGU amounted to £490m out of a total goodwill balance of £7,945m. Management prepared an impairment assessment for the Global Services cash generating unit (“CGU”), as required under accounting standards, which was based on a value in use calculation. Similar assessments were performed by the directors for the other goodwill balances. Management concluded that there was no impairment of goodwill in any CGU, including Global Services.

 

We focused on the impairment assessment for Global Services as the headroom (of value in use over carrying value) was limited and, as disclosed by management in note 12 to the financial statements, the calculation of recoverable amount is sensitive to changes in assumptions (in particular the long term growth rate, the discount rate and the assumptions underlying future operating cash flows).

  

 

We evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of management’s controls in assessing the carrying value of goodwill. We determined that we could rely on these controls for the purposes of our audit.

 

We then focused on the key assumptions included in the impairment assessment, being the cash flows for each year of management’s detailed forecast, the long-term growth rate and the discount rate.

 

To determine the appropriateness of the future operating cash flows, we:

– Agreed the cash flow forecasts used in the impairment model to Board approved forecasts;

– Considered management’s expectations in respect of developments in the business and corroborated certain information with third party sources. We considered planned operational improvements and the reasonableness of these in generating future cash flows and whether these were appropriately reflected in the cash flow forecasts; and

– Compared actual historical cash flow results for the Global Services CGU with previous forecasts to assess forecasting accuracy.

 

We used internal specialists to independently corroborate the long-term growth rate and the discount rate used by management by reference to market data.

 

We recalculated the sensitivity analysis performed by management and performed our own sensitivity analyses, focusing on what we considered to be reasonably possible changes in the key assumptions. We also considered the appropriateness of the disclosures in note 12.

 

Overall, we considered the assumptions made to be within a supportable range and the disclosures appropriate.

Major contracts in Global Services, Business and Public Sector and EE

Page 147 in the Audit & Risk Committee section of the Annual Report and notes 17 and 19 in the notes to the financial statements. (relevant to the group financial statements)

We focused on these contracts as they involve significant estimates in respect of:

– the completeness and valuation of provisions against contracts projected to be loss making; and

– the recoverability of contract-specific assets, including deferred costs and property, plant and equipment.

 

Consideration of the completeness and valuation of provisions against contracts and the recoverability of contract-specific assets is dependent on the assumptions underpinning the lifetime profitability forecasts for the contracts.

  

 

We stratified the population and tested a sample of major contracts, focusing our work on those which we regarded as higher risk because of the nature of the contract, its stage of delivery or the quantum of the related assets on the balance sheet, and then by those which were material by size. In performing this testing, we assessed the appropriateness of the assumptions and estimates underpinning the accounting for these major contracts as follows:

– We evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of controls that operate across the contract life cycle for major contracts.

– We obtained and read the relevant sections of certain contracts agreed between the group and the customer, to identify the contracted revenues, key provisions in the event of contract termination (such as penalties or the ability for the group to recover costs) and other significant obligations. We ensured the future forecasts reflected the contract terms, testing any significant changes (such as new services) to changes notices or other supporting documentation.

– We tested a sample of recorded revenue and cost transactions by tracing them to supporting evidence, which for revenue included evidence of delivery and/or customer acceptance.

 

192     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

 

Key audit matter

 

   How our audit addressed the key audit matter
    

 

– We compared the historical forecast results of certain contracts with the actual results to assess the performance of the contract and the historical accuracy of forecasting.

– We performed sensitivity analysis to reflect reasonable downside risks that may impact the contract.

– We also assessed the contract terms to identify any financial compensation the group is entitled to if the contract is terminated early by the customer for convenience to support our assessment of the recoverability of any associated contract assets.

 

We considered the future forecast profitability, including sensitivity analysis, and the contractual terms to assess the recoverability of the contract-specific assets and to determine if any contracts required loss provisions.

 

Based on our work we considered management’s estimates in respect of contract loss provisions and the recoverability of contract specific assets to be supportable and recorded in line with the group’s accounting policies as set out in note 3.

Accuracy of revenue due to complex billing systems

Note 4 in the notes to the financial statements.

(relevant to the group financial statements)

The accuracy of revenue amounts recorded is an inherent risk. This is because the group’s billing systems are complex and process large volumes of data with a combination of different products sold and price changes in the year, through a number of different systems.

  

 

We evaluated the relevant IT systems and the design of controls, and tested the operating effectiveness of controls over the:

– Capture and recording of revenue transactions;

– Authorisation of rate changes and the input of this information into the billing systems; and

– Calculation of amounts billed to customers.

 

We determined that we could rely on these controls for the purposes of our audit. We also tested a sample of customer bills and checked these to supporting evidence (eg customer orders, contracts or subsequent communications from the group to customers confirming changes to prices, and call detail records where applicable) and cash received. Our testing included agreeing amounts to customer bills for consumers, corporate customers and wholesale customers.

 

Based on our work, we noted no material issues in the accuracy of revenue recorded in the year.

Valuation of pension scheme obligations and unquoted investments in the BT Pension Scheme

Page 147 in the Audit & Risk Committee section of the Annual Report and note 20 in the notes to the financial statements. (relevant to the group financial statements)

We focused on the BT Pension Scheme (BTPS) because the valuation of the BTPS obligations (£55.8bn at 31 March 2018) and unquoted assets (which comprised unquoted equity investments, property assets and other assets totalling £20.2bn at 31 March 2018) require the use of estimates and significant judgement, and a small change in the key assumptions can have a material impact on the financial statements.

  

We evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of controls in respect of the determination of the BTPS net deficit. We determined that we could rely on these controls for the purposes of our audit.

 

We used our actuarial experts to assess the appropriateness of the actuarial assumptions used in valuing the BTPS obligations. This included comparing the assumptions used with our internally developed benchmarks. We also focused on the update to the discount rate model made at 31 March 2018 to assess its compliance with IAS 19 and considered the adequacy of the disclosure of the impact.

 

All the assumptions used by management fell within acceptable ranges.

 

We tested the valuation of the unquoted assets on a sample basis. Specifically:

 

– For property assets, we:

– Obtained and read valuation reports prepared by third party expert valuers for management. We assessed the methods and assumptions used by the valuers and the competence and objectivity of those third party experts; and

 

 
193     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Independent auditors’ report to the members of BT Group plc continued

Report on the audit of the financial statements continued

    

 

 

Key audit matter

 

   How our audit addressed the key audit matter
  

 

– Tested the carrying amount of other property assets by validating these to audited financial statements.

  

– For direct investments held by the BTPS, the valuations of the investments are derived from discounted cash flow models. These models use assumptions including discount rates and cash flow forecasts. We assessed the assumptions used in a sample of the valuations by checking that the assumptions used were consistent with our internally developed range of discount rates (with the support of internal specialists), by comparing the cash flows with historical results and by considering the impact of other external information. We tested the accuracy of the calculations and assessed whether the assumptions used were in line with other market participants and reflected the particular status of the investment shareholding; and

  

– For other unquoted investments, in addition to testing internal controls related to their valuation, we obtained confirmations of the valuation from the custodians and the investment managers, and tested the carrying amount by validating these to audited financial statements.

 

     Based on the audit work we performed as described above, we considered the estimates and judgements used by management for the obligations and the unquoted investments to be within an acceptable range. We also satisfied ourselves as to the appropriateness of the disclosures in note 20.

Adequacy of regulatory and other provisions

Page 148 in the Audit & Risk Committee section and note 19 in the notes to the financial statements.

(relevant to the group financial statements)

The group has regulatory provisions of £320m relating to regulatory risks. The group has seen an increased frequency, and magnitude, of matters considered by Ofcom and the Competition Appeal Tribunal (CAT) in the UK.

 

The group has litigation provisions of £64m. The group is involved in various legal proceedings, including actual or threatened litigation and regulatory investigations.

 

The magnitude of litigation and regulatory exposures means that a change in management’s judgement as to the likely outcome could have a material impact on the financial statements.

  

 

We evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of controls in respect of the determination of the provisions. We determined that we could rely on these controls for the purposes of our audit.

 

For regulatory provisions, we read correspondence and pronouncements from the regulator Ofcom and the CAT and correspondence from other communication providers (CPs).

 

We evaluated the regulatory risk exposures identified by management, and where relevant the provisions recorded, against observable data. We also considered management’s assessment of the likelihood of regulatory risks crystallising, and therefore the completeness of the provisions recorded, by comparing its assessment against historical disputes, open claims from CPs, current pronouncements issued by Ofcom and the CAT, and by considering the nature of the identified regulatory risk exposure.

 

For litigation provisions, we read the summary of major litigation matters provided by management and held discussions with the group’s general counsel and head of litigation. For a sample of matters, we held discussions with the group’s external legal advisors with respect to the matters included in the summary. Where appropriate we examined correspondence between the group’s external legal advisors and the relevant court or other regulatory body. We also tested a sample of legal expenses to identify any other potential litigation matters.

 

For regulatory provisions, we tested the calculation of a sample of the provisions, assessed the key assumptions against third party data where available, and assessed the estimates against historical trends, including an overall assessment of the provision against the aggregate risk exposures.

 

 
194     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

 

Key audit matter

 

   How our audit addressed the key audit matter
    

 

We considered management’s estimates of the level of provisioning to be appropriately supported based on the work we have performed. We also satisfied ourselves as to the appropriateness of the disclosures in note 19.

Recognition and measurement of potential tax exposures and deferred tax assets

Page 148 in the Audit & Risk Committee section of the Annual Report and note 9 in the notes to the financial statements.

(relevant to the group financial statements)

The group operates in a complex multinational tax environment and is subject to a range of tax risks. There is inherent judgement involved in determining provisions for uncertain tax positions (£240m as at 31 March 2018).

 

The group has material unrecognised deferred tax assets in respect of brought forward trading losses and other temporary differences, as set out in note 9. The recognition of deferred tax assets involves estimation regarding the likelihood of the realisation of these assets, in particular whether there will be taxable profits in future periods that support recognition of these assets.

  

 

We evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of controls in place for the determination and recognition of deferred tax balances and uncertain tax positions balances. We determined that we could rely on these controls for the purposes of our audit.

 

We tested the underlying data in support of the key deferred tax and uncertain tax provision calculations.

 

In conjunction with our tax specialists, we evaluated management’s conclusions in relation to uncertain tax positions and the related level of tax provisions. We considered the status of recent and current tax audits and enquiries as well as the results of previous claims, and changes to the tax environments in the markets in which the group operates. We utilised our specialist tax knowledge and experience of similar situations elsewhere to examine tax planning arrangements and the global transfer pricing model and assess management’s judgements. We found that the level of provisioning overall was supportable.

 

In assessing management’s conclusions with respect to the recognition of deferred tax assets, we evaluated the amount of tax losses recognised in light of the future projected profitability of the relevant subsidiary companies, by assessing the forecasts against past results and expectations of future trading performance.

 

We determined that the tax balances were supportable. We also satisfied ourselves as to the appropriateness of the disclosure in note 9.

BT Italy – changes to the control environment and review of estimates made in 2016/17

Page 145 in the Audit & Risk Committee section of the Annual Report.

(relevant to the group financial statements)

In 2016/17, the group disclosed the results of its investigations into irregular accounting practices in Italy and reported control deficiencies related to the Italian business as at 31 March 2017.

 

In 2017/18, the group made a number of changes to the control environment as it relates to its Italian business, including enhancing the controls that had not operated effectively in the prior year and implementing new controls.

 

Following the prior year investigations, and as previously reported, the group recorded an aggregate adjustment of £513m in respect of the Italian business in 2016/17, of which £245m was recognised as a specific item charge in the 2016/17 income statement and £268m related to years prior to 2016/17.

 

The nature of the irregular accounting practices and control weaknesses required management to make a number of estimates and judgements in determining the adjustments recorded in 2016/17. During 2017/18 management has undertaken additional work to reassess the estimates previously made and determined no further material adjustments were necessary.

  

 

We evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of the enhanced controls and the new controls related to the Italian business.

 

Our Italian component team performed a full scope audit for the purposes of the group audit for the year ended 31 March 2018 and reported to us thereon. With the assistance of the Italian component team we also assessed whether there was any evidence of events or circumstances arising in the year ended 31 March 2018 that provided new information which necessitated further adjustments to be made to the financial information of the Italian business, either in the current year or in respect of prior years.

 

We satisfied ourselves that the critical estimates recorded in respect of the Italian business in the group balance sheet at 31 March 2018, including any reassessments of the amounts previously recognised, were appropriately supported.

 

 
195     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Independent auditors’ report to the members of BT Group plc continued

Report on the audit of the financial statements continued

    

 

 

Key audit matter

 

   How our audit addressed the key audit matter

Cost capitalisation and asset lives for property, plant and equipment and software intangible assets

Page 147 in the Audit & Risk Committee section of the Annual Report and note 13 in the notes to the financial statements.

(relevant to the group financial statements)

Capitalisation of costs involves management judgement and the useful lives assigned to assets are a key management estimate. These manifest themselves in the following two audit risks:

– that amounts being capitalised do not meet capitalisation criteria, including the recognition and deferral of related grants; and

– that the useful economic lives assigned to assets are inappropriate.

 

We also focused on the recognition of capital grants associated with the Broadband Delivery UK (BDUK) and Superfast Extension (SEP) programmes, as the grants may be subject to re-investment or repayment depending on the level of take-up requiring calculation of grant income to be deferred.

  

 

We evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of controls around the property, plant and equipment cycle and software intangible assets cycle, including the controls over whether engineering (labour) activity is capital or operating in nature. We determined that we could rely on these controls for the purposes of our audit.

 

We tested costs capitalised in the year and considered the ageing of assets in the course of construction. We assessed the nature of costs incurred in capital projects through testing of amounts recorded and considering whether the expenditure met the criteria for capitalisation under accounting standards.

 

We tested the controls over the annual review of asset lives. In addition, we considered whether management’s views on asset lives are supportable by considering our knowledge of the business and of the wider telecoms industry. We also tested whether the prior year asset life review has been appropriately applied and assessed the judgements made by management in the current year review. We found that the asset lives were consistent with those commonly used in the industry and appropriately reflected technological developments.

 

We tested the controls in place over the recording and reconciliation of grant income deferral. We assessed the key assumption of the forecast level of end user take-up applied by management to calculate the deferral. In addition, we tested other key inputs to supporting evidence as well as the accuracy of the calculation. We determined that management’s conclusions were supportable.

We determined that there were no key audit matters applicable to the parent company to communicate in our report.

 

How we tailored the audit scope

We tailored the scope of our audit to ensure that we performed enough work to be able to give an opinion on the financial statements as a whole, taking into account the structure of the group and the parent company, the accounting processes and controls, and the industry in which they operate.

 

The group’s accounting process is structured around a finance function in each of the reporting units who are supported by one of the group’s shared service centres. The reporting units are responsible for their own accounting records and controls and report to the head office finance team in London through an integrated consolidation system.

 

In establishing the overall approach to the group audit, we determined the type of work that needed to be performed at reporting units by us, as the group engagement team, or component auditors from other PwC network firms operating under our instruction (including PwC UK for EE). Where the work was performed by component auditors, we determined the level of involvement we needed to have in the audit work at those reporting units to be able to conclude whether sufficient appropriate audit evidence had been obtained as a basis for our opinion on the financial statements as a whole.

  

For three reporting units (the main BT UK trading company (British Telecommunications plc), EE and the principal reporting unit in Italy) an audit of the complete financial information was performed.

 

These accounted for over 80% of the group’s revenue and the group’s profit before tax.

 

In five reporting units (Germany, Ireland, Spain, the US and an additional UK reporting unit) audits of the revenue financial statement line item and related balance sheet accounts was performed. The work performed on these five reporting units accounted for 7% of the group’s revenue. For the additional UK reporting unit audit procedures on certain operating costs and related balance sheet accounts were also performed. In addition, specified procedures were performed on revenue and certain balance sheet accounts in Switzerland.

 

This, together with additional procedures performed on centralised functions and at the group level (on the consolidation and other areas of significant judgement including tax and goodwill), gave us the evidence we needed for our opinion on the financial statements as a whole.

 

The group engagement team performed the audit of British Telecommunications plc. The group engagement team also performed the work on the US reporting unit and the other UK reporting unit.

 

 
196     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

For EE, the group engagement team met regularly with the component audit team, who are UK based, and attended meetings with management, including the year end clearance meeting.

Senior members of the group engagement team also visited Italy, Germany, Ireland and Spain and communicated with our component audit teams on a regular basis. We also reviewed certain component auditor working papers and participated in the audit clearance meetings for Italy, Germany, Ireland and Spain either in person or by conference call. In addition, the group engagement team visited the shared service centres relevant to those reporting units in scope for the group audit.

Materiality

The scope of our audit was influenced by our application of materiality. We set certain quantitative thresholds for materiality. These, together with qualitative considerations, helped us to determine the scope of our audit and the nature, timing and extent of our audit procedures on the individual financial statement line items and disclosures and in evaluating the effect of misstatements, both individually and in aggregate, on the financial statements as a whole.

Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality for the financial statements as a whole as follows:

 

     Group financial
statements
  Parent company financial
statements

Overall materiality

  £130m (2016/17: £130m).  

£130m

(2016/17: £130m).

How we determined it

  5% of profit before tax.   1% of total assets, limited so as not to exceed the group’s materiality.

Rationale for   benchmark applied

  The Group is profit   orientated and we consider profit before tax to be an appropriate benchmark as it represents a key statutory measure used by shareholders to assess the financial performance of the group.   We consider total assets as the appropriate benchmark as the parent is the holding company for the group’s operations and does not trade. Its primary purpose is to hold investments in subsidiary undertakings. We therefore consider that an asset measure (total assets) is an appropriate benchmark. However, materiality levels have been capped at the same level as that for the group.

For each component in the scope of our group audit, we allocated a materiality that was less than our overall group materiality. For British Telecommunications plc and EE, the materiality allocated to these units was £110m and £100m respectively. For all other

reporting units the materiality allocated was between £10m and £20m.

We agreed with the Audit & Risk Committee that we would report to them misstatements identified during our audit above £10m (group audit) (2016/17: £10m) and £10m (parent company audit) (2016/17: £10m) as well as misstatements below those amounts that, in our view, warranted reporting for qualitative reasons.

The parent company was not determined as an in scope component for group audit purposes.

Going concern

In accordance with ISAs (UK) we report as follows:

 

 

Reporting obligation

 

  Outcome
We are required to report if we have anything material to add or draw attention to in respect of the directors’ statement in the financial statements about whether the directors considered it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in preparing the financial statements and the directors’ identification of any material uncertainties to the group’s and the parent company’s ability to continue as a going concern over a period of at least twelve months from the date of approval of the financial statements.   We have nothing material to add or to draw attention to. However, because not all future events or conditions can be predicted, this statement is not a guarantee as to the group’s and parent company’s ability to continue as a going concern.
We are required to report if the directors’ statement relating to Going Concern in accordance with Listing Rule 9.8.6R(3) is materially inconsistent with our knowledge obtained in the audit.   We have nothing to report.

Reporting on other information

The other information comprises all of the information in the Annual Report other than the financial statements and our auditors’ report thereon. The directors are responsible for the other information. Our opinion on the financial statements does not cover the other information and, accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion or, except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in this report, any form of assurance thereon.

 

 

 
197     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Independent auditors’ report to the members of BT Group plc continued

Report on the audit of the financial statements continued

    

 

In connection with our audit of the financial statements, our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether the other information is materially inconsistent with the financial statements or our knowledge obtained in the audit, or otherwise appears to be materially misstated. If we identify an apparent material inconsistency or material misstatement, we are required to perform procedures to conclude whether there is a material misstatement of the financial statements or a material misstatement of the other information. If, based on the work we have performed, we conclude that there is a material misstatement of this other information, we are required to report that fact. We have nothing to report based on these responsibilities.

With respect to the Strategic Report and Report of the Directors, we also considered whether the disclosures required by the UK Companies Act 2006 have been included.

Based on the responsibilities described above and our work undertaken in the course of the audit, the Companies Act 2006, (CA06), ISAs (UK) and the Listing Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) require us also to report certain opinions and matters as described below (required by ISAs (UK) unless otherwise stated).

 

Strategic Report and Report of the Directors

 

In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the course of the audit, the information given in the Strategic Report and Report of the Directors for the year ended 31 March 2018 is consistent with the financial statements and has been prepared in accordance with applicable legal requirements. (CA06)

 

In light of the knowledge and understanding of the group and parent company and their environment obtained in the course of the audit, we did not identify any material misstatements in the Strategic Report and Report of the Directors. (CA06)

 

The directors’ assessment of the prospects of the group and of the principal risks that would threaten the solvency or liquidity of the group

We have nothing material to add or draw attention to regarding:

– The directors’ confirmation on page 181 of the Annual Report that they have carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks facing the group, including those that would threaten its business model, future performance, solvency or liquidity.

– The disclosures in the Annual Report that describe those risks and explain how they are being managed or mitigated.

– The directors’ explanation on page 71 of the Annual Report as to how they have assessed the prospects of the group, over what period they have done so and why they consider that period to be appropriate, and their statement as to whether they have a reasonable expectation that the group will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the period of their assessment, including any related disclosures drawing attention to any necessary qualifications or assumptions.

 

We have nothing to report having performed a review of the directors’ statement that they have carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks facing the group and statement in relation to the longer-term viability of the group. Our review was substantially less in scope than an audit and only consisted of making inquiries and considering the directors’ process supporting their statements; checking that the statements are in alignment with the relevant provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code (the “Code”); and considering whether the statements are consistent with the knowledge and understanding of the group and parent company and their environment obtained in the course of the audit. (Listing Rules)

 

 

 

 
198     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

 

Other Code Provisions

We have nothing to report in respect of our responsibility to report when:

– The statement given by the directors, on page 181, that they consider the Annual Report taken as a whole to be fair, balanced and understandable, and provides the information necessary for the members to assess the group’s and parent company’s position and performance, business model and strategy is materially inconsistent with our knowledge of the group and parent company obtained in the course of performing our audit.

– The section of the Annual Report on pages 144-149 describing the work of the Audit & Risk Committee does not appropriately address matters communicated by us to the Audit & Risk Committee.

– The directors’ statement relating to the parent company’s compliance with the Code does not properly disclose a departure from a relevant provision of the Code specified, under the Listing Rules, for review by the auditors.

Directors’ Remuneration

In our opinion, the part of the Report on Directors’ Remuneration to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006. (CA06)

Responsibilities for the financial statements and the audit

Responsibilities of the directors for the financial statements

As explained more fully in the Statement of directors’ responsibilities set out on page 181, the directors are responsible for the preparation of the financial statements in accordance with the applicable framework and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view. The directors are also responsible for such internal control as they determine is necessary to enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.

In preparing the financial statements, the directors are responsible for assessing the group’s and the parent company’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing as applicable, matters related to going concern and using the going concern basis of accounting unless the directors either intend to liquidate the group or the parent company or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.

Auditors’ responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements

Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements as a whole are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue an auditors’ report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance, but is not a guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detect a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or

 

in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of these financial statements.

A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements is located on the FRC’s website at: frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. This description forms part of our auditors’ report.

Use of this report

This report, including the opinions, has been prepared for and only for the parent company’s members as a body in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006 and for no other purpose. We do not, in giving these opinions, accept or assume responsibility for any other purpose or to any other person to whom this report is shown or into whose hands it may come save where expressly agreed by our prior consent in writing.

Other required reporting

Companies Act 2006 exception reporting

Under the Companies Act 2006 we are required to report to you if, in our opinion:

we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit; or
adequate accounting records have not been kept by the parent company, or returns adequate for our audit have not been received from branches not visited by us; or
certain disclosures of directors’ remuneration specified by law are not made; or
the parent company financial statements and the part of the Report on Directors’ Remuneration to be audited are not in agreement with the accounting records and returns.

We have no exceptions to report arising from this responsibility.

Appointment

We were appointed by the members in 1984 to audit the financial statements for the year ended 31 March 1985 and subsequent financial periods. The period of total uninterrupted engagement is 34 years, covering the years ended 31 March 1985 to 31 March 2018.

Richard Hughes (Senior Statutory Auditor)

for and on behalf of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

Chartered Accountants and Statutory Auditors

London

9 May 2018

 

 

 
199     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of BT Group plc

Opinions on the Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited the accompanying group balance sheets of BT Group plc and its subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of 31 March 2018 and 31 March 2017, and the related group income statements, group statements of comprehensive income, group statements of changes in equity and group cash flow statements for each of the three years in the period ended 31 March 2018, including the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”). We also have audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 March 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”).

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of 31 March 2018 and 31 March 2017, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 31 March 2018 in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board and International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of 31 March 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the COSO.

Basis for Opinions

The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting on page 185 of the Report of the Directors, General Information of the BT Group plc Annual Report & Form 20-F 2018. Our responsibility is to express opinions on the Company’s financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.

Our audits of the financial statements included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorisations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorised acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

London, United Kingdom

9 May 2018

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 1984.

 

 
200     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

Group income statement

Year ended 31 March 2018

 

     Notes          

Before

specific

items

£m

 

 

 

 

      

Specific

items

£m

 

 a 

 

      

Total

£m

 

 

Revenue

   4                  23,746          (23        23,723  

Operating costs

   5           (19,755        (587        (20,342

Operating profit (loss)

   4           3,991          (610        3,381  

Finance expense

   26         (558        (218        (776

Finance income

               12                   12  

Net finance expense

           (546        (218        (764

Share of post tax profit (loss) of associates and joint ventures

               (1                 (1

Profit (loss) before taxation

           3,444          (828        2,616  

Taxation

   9           (671        87          (584

Profit (loss) for the year

               2,773          (741        2,032  

Earnings per share

   10                

Basic

                     20.5p  

Diluted

                                     20.4p  
Year ended 31 March 2017                   
     Notes          


Before
specific
items

£m

 
 
 

 

      

Specific
items

£m

 
 a  

 

      

Total

£m

 

 

Revenue

   4         24,082          (20        24,062  

Operating costs

   5           (19,947        (948        (20,895

Operating profit (loss)

   4           4,135          (968        3,167  

Finance expense

   26         (607        (210        (817

Finance income

               13                   13  

Net finance expense

           (594        (210        (804

Share of post tax profit (loss) of associates and joint ventures

               (9                 (9

Profit (loss) before taxation

           3,532          (1,178        2,354  

Taxation

   9           (663        217          (446

Profit (loss) for the year

               2,869          (961        1,908  

Earnings per share

   10                

Basic

                     19.2p  

Diluted

                                     19.1p  

 

a For a definition of specific items, see page 288. An analysis of specific items is provided in note 8.

 

 
201     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Group income statement

Year ended 31 March 2016

 

       Notes            


Before
specific
items

£m

 
 
 

 

      

Specific
items

£m

 
 a  

 

      

Total

£m

 

 

Revenue

     4           18,879          133          19,012  

Operating costs

     5                    (15,051        (348        (15,399

Operating profit (loss)

     4             3,828          (215        3,613  

Finance expense

     26           (520        (229        (749

Finance income

                   37                   37  

Net finance expense

           (483        (229        (712

Share of post tax profit (loss) of associates and joint ventures

                   6                   6  

Profit (loss) before taxation

           3,351          (444        2,907  

Taxation

     9             (607        166          (441

Profit (loss) for the year

                   2,744          (278        2,466  

Earnings per share

     10                  

Basic

                     28.5p  

Diluted

                                         28.2p  

 

a  For a definition of specific items, see page 288. An analysis of specific items is provided in note 8.

   

Group statement of comprehensive income  
Year ended 31 March  

    

 

      Notes           

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Profit for the year

                   2,032          1,908          2,466  

Other comprehensive income (loss)

                  

Items that will not be reclassified to the income statement

                  

Remeasurements of the net pension obligation

     20           2,160          (2,789        755  

Tax on pension remeasurements

     9           (346        416          (240

Items that have been or may be reclassified to the income statement

                  

Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations

     28           (188        237          29  

Fair value movements on available-for-sale assets

     28           11          (3        (2

Fair value movements on cash flow hedges:

                  

– net fair value gains (losses)

     28           (368        884          381  

– recognised in income and expense

     28           277          (938        (230

Tax on components of other comprehensive income that have been or may be reclassified

     9, 28             1          29          5  

Other comprehensive income (loss) for the year, net of tax

                   1,547          (2,164        698  

Total comprehensive income (loss) for the year

                   3,579          (256        3,164  

 

 
202     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

Group balance sheet

At 31 March

 

      Notes             

2018

£m

           

2017

£m

           

2016

£m

 

Non-current assets

                  

Intangible assets

     12                    14,447                   15,029                   15,450  

Property, plant and equipment

     13           17,000          16,498          15,971  

Derivative financial instruments

     27           1,312          1,818          1,462  

Investments

     23           53          44          46  

Associates and joint ventures

           38          31          24  

Trade and other receivables

     17           317          360          218  

Deferred tax assets

     9                 1,243                1,717                1,247  
                         34,410                35,497                34,418  

Current assets

                  

Programme rights

     15           272          264          225  

Inventories

     16           239          227          189  

Trade and other receivables

     17           4,014          3,835          3,978  

Current tax receivable

           77          73          65  

Derivative financial instruments

     27           197          428          177  

Investments

     23           3,022          1,520          2,918  

Cash and cash equivalents

     24                 528                528                996  
                         8,349                6,875                8,548  

Current liabilities

                  

Loans and other borrowings

     25           2,281          2,632          3,736  

Derivative financial instruments

     27           50          34          48  

Trade and other payables

     18           7,168          7,437          7,418  

Current tax liabilities

           83          197          271  

Provisions

     19                 603                625                178  
                         10,185                10,925                11,651  

Total assets less current liabilities

                       32,574                31,447                31,315  

Non-current liabilities

                  

Loans and other borrowings

     25           11,994          10,081          11,025  

Derivative financial instruments

     27           787          869          863  

Retirement benefit obligations

     20           6,371          9,088          6,382  

Other payables

     18           1,326          1,298          1,106  

Deferred tax liabilities

     9           1,340          1,240          1,262  

Provisions

     19                 452                536                565  
                         22,270                23,112                21,203  

Equity

                  

Ordinary shares

           499          499          499  

Share premium

           1,051          1,051          1,051  

Own shares

     21           (186        (96        (115

Merger reserve

           6,647          6,647          8,422  

Other reserves

     28           534          884          685  

Retained profit (loss)

                       1,759                (650              (430

Total equity

                       10,304                8,335                10,112  
                         32,574                31,447                31,315  

The consolidated financial statements on pages 201 to 286 were approved by the Board of Directors on 9 May 2018 and were signed on its behalf by:

Jan du Plessis

Chairman

Gavin Patterson

Chief Executive

Simon Lowth

Chief Financial Officer

 

 
203     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Group statement of changes in equity

 

       Notes                

Share
capital

£m

 
 a  

 

    

Share

premium

£m

 

 b 

 

    

Own
share

£m

 
c  

 

   

Merger
reserve

£m

 
 d  

 

    

Other

reserves

£m

 

 e 

 

    


Retained
(loss)
earnings
£m
 
 
 
 
    


Total
equity
(deficit)
£m
 
 
 
 

At 1 April 2015

           419        1,051        (165     998        502        (2,124      681  

Profit for the year

                                             2,466        2,466  

Other comprehensive income (loss) – before tax

                                      408        755        1,163  

Tax on other comprehensive income (loss)

     9                                      5        (240      (235

Transferred to the income statement

                                                  (230             (230

Total comprehensive income (loss) for the year

                                      183        2,981        3,164  

Issue of new sharesf

           80                     7,424                      7,504  

Dividends to shareholders

     11                                             (1,078      (1,078

Share-based payments

     22                                             58        58  

Tax on share-based payments

     9                                             12        12  

Net buyback of own shares

     21                         50                     (275      (225

Other movements

                                                         (4      (4

At 1 April 2016

                       499        1,051        (115     8,422        685        (430      10,112  

Profit for the year

                                             1,908        1,908  

Other comprehensive income (loss) – before tax

                                      1,108        (2,779      (1,671

Tax on other comprehensive income (loss)

     9                                      29        416        445  

Transferred to the income statement

                                                  (938             (938

Total comprehensive income (loss) for the year

                                      199        (455      (256

Transfers to realised profit

                               (1,775             1,775         

Dividends to shareholders

     11                                             (1,436      (1,436

Share-based payments

     22                                             57        57  

Tax on share-based payments

     9                                             (6      (6

Net buyback of own shares

     21                               19                     (155      (136

At 1 April 2017

                       499        1,051        (96     6,647        884        (650      8,335  

Profit for the year

                                             2,032        2,032  

Other comprehensive income (loss) – before tax

                                      (545      2,160        1,615  

Tax on other comprehensive income (loss)

     9                                      1        (346      (345

Transferred to the income statement

                                                  277               277  

Total comprehensive income (loss) for the year

                                      (267      3,846        3,579  

Dividends to shareholders

     11                                             (1,524      (1,524

Share-based payments

     22                                             84        84  

Tax on share-based payments

     9                                             (2      (2

Net buyback of own shares

     21                         (90                   (78      (168

Transfer to realised profit

                                                  (83      83         

At 31 March 2018

                       499        1,051        (186     6,647        534        1,759        10,304  

 

a  The allotted, called up, and fully paid ordinary share capital of BT Group plc at 31 March 2018 was £499m comprising 9,968,127,681 ordinary shares of 5p each (2017: £499m comprising 9,968,127,681 ordinary shares of 5p each).

 

b  The share premium account, comprising the premium on allotment of shares, is not available for distribution.

 

c  For further analysis of own shares, see note 21.

 

d  The merger reserve balance at 1 April 2015 arose on the group reorganisation that occurred in November 2001 and represented the difference between the nominal value of shares in the new parent company, BT Group plc, and the aggregate of the share capital, share premium account and capital redemption reserve of the prior parent company, British Telecommunications plc. On 29 January 2016, the company issued 1,594,900,429 ordinary shares of 5p at 470.7p per share. These shares were used as part consideration for the acquisition of EE. As a result of this transaction the merger reserve was credited with £7,424m net of £3m issue costs. In 2016/17, there was a transfer of £1,775m of merger reserve to realised profit following the settlement of an intercompany loan by qualifying consideration.

 

e  For further analysis of other reserves, see note 28.

 

f  On 29 January 2016, the company issued 1,594,900,429 ordinary shares of 5p at 470.7p per share, raising £7,504m net of issue costs. Share capital increased by £80m and merger reserve by £7,424m.

 

 
204     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

Group cash flow statement

Year ended 31 March

 

      Notes             

2018

£m

           

2017

£m

           

2016

£m

 

Cash flow from operating activities

                  

Profit before taxation

                    2,616                   2,354                   2,907  

Share of post tax loss (profit) of associates and joint ventures

           1          9          (6

Net finance expense

                       764                804                712  

Operating profit

           3,381          3,167          3,613  

Other non-cash charges

           33          20          39  

Profit on disposal of businesses

           (1        (16         

Depreciation and amortisation

           3,514          3,572          2,631  

Increase in inventories

           (14        (33         

Increase in programme rights

           (34        (95        (44

(Increase) decrease in trade and other receivablesa

           (156        168          (83

(Decrease) increase in trade and other payables

           (345        (152        124  

Decrease in other liabilitiesb

           (775        (307        (810

(Decrease) increase in provisionsc

     19                 (203              401                (63

Cash generated from operations

                       5,400                6,725                5,407  

Income taxes paid

                       (473              (551              (256

Net cash inflow from operating activities

                       4,927                6,174                5,151  

Cash flow from investing activities

                  

Interest received

           7          7          10  

Dividends received from associates and joint ventures

                    2          17  

Acquisition of subsidiariesd

     14           (16        18          (3,371

Proceeds on disposal of subsidiariesd, associates and joint ventures

           2          46           

Acquisition of joint ventures

           (9        (13        (8

Proceeds on disposal of current financial assetse

           11,134          10,834          8,918  

Purchases of current financial assetse

           (12,629        (9,411        (8,252

Proceeds on disposal of non-current asset investmentsf

           19                    

Purchases of non-current asset investmentsf

                    (22         

Proceeds on disposal of property, plant and equipment

           21          26          7  

Purchases of property, plant and equipment and software

                       (3,362              (3,145              (2,438

Net cash outflow from investing activities

                       (4,833              (1,658              (5,117

Cash flow from financing activities

                  

Equity dividends paid

           (1,523        (1,435        (1,075

Interest paid

           (555        (629        (558

Repayment of borrowingsg

           (1,401        (1,805        (1,283

Proceeds from bank loans and bonds

           3,760          3          3,023  

Cash flows from derivatives related to net debt

           (188        119          79  

Drawdown on acquisition facility

                             3,200  

Repayment of acquisition facility

                    (181        (3,019

Repayment of EE revolving credit facility

                    (438        (100

Proceeds from issue of own shares

           53          70          90  

Repurchase of ordinary share capital

                       (221              (206              (315

Net cash (outflow) inflow from financing activities

                       (75              (4,502              42  

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

                       19                14                76  

Opening cash and cash equivalentsh

           511          459          407  

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

           19          14          76  

Effect of exchange rate changes

                       (31              38                (24

Closing cash and cash equivalentsh

     24                 499                511                459  

 

a  Includes a prepayment of £325m (2016/17: £nil, 2015/16: £nil) in respect of the acquisition of Spectrum.
b  Includes pension deficit payments of £872m (2016/17: £274m, 2015/16: £880m).
c  Included within the change in provisions is the settlement of Deemed Consent, part of which is non-cash and is offset by movements in working capital.
d  Acquisitions and disposals of subsidiaries are shown net of cash acquired or disposed of and in 2017 included £20m true-up of consideration following the audit of the completion balance sheet relating to the acquisition of EE.
e  Primarily consists of investment in and redemption of amounts held in liquidity funds.
f  Relates to assets held for sale classified within trade and other receivables.
g  Repayment of borrowings includes the impact of hedging and repayment of lease liabilities.
h  Net of bank overdrafts of £29m (2016/17: £17m, 2015/16: £537m).

 

 
205     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

1. Basis of preparation

Preparation of the financial statements

These consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006 as applicable to companies using International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), Article 4 of the IAS Regulation and International Accounting Standards (IAS) and IFRS and related interpretations, as adopted by the European Union. The consolidated financial statements are also in compliance with IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (the IASB) and interpretations as issued by the IFRS Interpretations Committee. The consolidated financial statements are prepared on a going concern basis.

These financial statements consolidate BT Group plc, the parent company, and its subsidiaries (together the ‘group’).

The consolidated financial statements are prepared on the historical cost basis, except for certain financial and equity instruments that have been measured at fair value. The consolidated financial statements are presented in Sterling, the functional currency of BT Group plc.

New and amended accounting standards

effective during the year

Note 25 of these consolidated financial statements reflect the amendments of IAS 7 ‘Statement of Cash Flows’ requiring the disclosure of changes in liabilities arising from financing activities.

There have been no other new or amended standards or interpretations adopted during the year that have a significant impact on the financial statements.

New and amended accounting standards that

have been issued but are not yet effective

The following standards have been issued and are effective for accounting periods ending on or after 1 April 2018 and are expected to have an impact on the group financial statements.

IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’

Background

In May 2014, IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’ was issued. It was subsequently amended in September 2015 and April 2016. It is effective for periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018. Transition to IFRS 15 for BT Group plc will take place on 1 April 2018. Results in the 2018/19 financial year will comply with IFRS 15, with the first Annual Report and Form 20-F published in accordance with IFRS 15 being that for the year ended 31 March 2019.

IFRS 15 sets out the requirements for recognising revenue and costs from contracts with customers and includes extensive disclosure requirements. The standard requires entities to apportion revenue earned from contracts to individual promises, or performance obligations, on a relative stand-alone selling price basis, based on a five-step model.

 

Transition

We previously disclosed in our Annual Report & Form 20-F 2017 that we were planning to adopt IFRS 15 retrospectively. This meant applying the new standard to each prior reporting period presented, ie 2016/17 and 2017/18, in accordance with IAS 8 ‘Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors’. Having considered further the factors that would influence our approach (including the time, effort and cost of adopting IFRS 15 retrospectively), as disclosed in the prior year Annual Report, we have decided to adopt the new standard on a modified retrospective basis and the group will recognise the cumulative effect of initially applying the standard as an adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings at 1 April 2018, ie the date of initial application. Under this transition method:

the standard will be applied only to contracts in progress but not completed at the date of initial application
for contracts that were modified before 1 April 2018, the group shall reflect the aggregate effect of all of the modifications that occur before this date at 1 April 2018
we will not restate prior year comparatives for the effect of IFRS 15 but will instead restate our 1 April 2018 opening retained earnings for the full cumulative impact of adopting this standard
for the year ended 31 March 2019 we will provide a reconciliation of our primary financial statements under IFRS 15 to those in accordance with IAS 18.

IFRS 15 Project

The group has deployed a cross-functional project team dedicated to the implementation of IFRS 15. This team has been engaged in determining accounting policies under the new standard, quantifying the transitional adjustments and selecting and implementing suitable systems solutions. The team is also reviewing the impact on tax, intragroup trading, forecasting, the bid and tender process and HR and remuneration plans. There is a significant impact on the group’s billing data and accounting platforms.

Performance obligations

IFRS 15 requires that at contract inception, we assess the goods or services promised in a contract with a customer and identify as a performance obligation each promise to transfer to the customer the good or service. Promises in a contract can be explicit, or implicit if the promises create a valid expectation to provide a good or service based on the customary business practices, published policies, or specific statements.

The stand-alone selling prices of the group’s products and services have been determined. These may be regulated prices, list prices, a cost-plus derived price, the price of similar products when sold on a stand-alone basis by BT or a competitor or in some cases the contract price where the price contracted represents a bespoke price that would be the same for a similar customer in a similar circumstance.

 

 

 
206     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

1. Basis of preparation continued

Financial Impact

The group is in the process of finalising the impact of the standard including the final transition adjustment to retained earnings. We have estimated that the likely impact on transition at 1 April 2018 will produce a cumulative increase in retained earnings of between £1.1bn and £1.5bn before tax. The corresponding impact will primarily be recorded as contract asset and will lead to an additional one-off cash tax payment equally split between 2018/19 and 2019/20. The cumulative increase in retained earnings is mainly due to the acceleration of handset revenues and, to a lesser extent, deferral of costs (notably third party contract acquisition costs primarily associated with post pay contracts).

The financial impact of each business area is as follows:

Under our current accounting policy, mobile handset revenue is recognised based on the amount the customer pays for the handset when it is delivered to the customer. Generally mobile handsets are either provided for free or for a small upfront charge.

Under IFRS 15, additional revenue will be allocated to the mobile handset at the start of the contract. This is calculated with reference to its relative standalone value within the contract, regardless of the contract pricing. For each mobile handset contract the revenue recognition profile will change with greater day one recognition of revenue for the handset and a corresponding reduction in ongoing mobile service revenue over the contract period. The difference between the mobile handset revenue recognised and the amounts charged to the customer will be recognised as a contract asset. On adoption of IFRS 15, we will recognise a contract asset for all open contracts at 1 April 2018.

Over time, we expect the contract asset generated to remain at similar levels as old contracts expire and new ones are signed. However, we will see short-term volatility, for example around key handset launches.

This will be the most significant impact of the IFRS 15 adoption on the group and will primarily impact EE. To a lesser extent this will also impact mobile handset revenues in Business and Public Sector, in respect of the legacy EE business division, and BT Consumer. The impact in these customer-facing units is less significant due to this lower handset base.

We expect to see a similar trend in respect of subsidised equipment although we expect this to have a less significant impact due to the lower relative standalone value for this equipment.

Currently, sales commissions and other third party acquisition costs resulting directly from securing contracts with customers are expensed when incurred.

Under IFRS 15 sales commissions and other third party contract acquisition costs will be recognised as an asset, and amortised over the period in which the corresponding benefit is received, resulting in earlier profit recognition.

The impact is greatest in EE in respect of third-party acquisition costs partially associated with post pay contracts.

The above two impacts will be partly offset by amended accounting for connections revenue. Currently, the group recognises connections revenue upon performance of the connection activity. Under IFRS 15 connections revenue will be
 

deferred and recognised on a straight-line basis over the associated line/circuit contractual period. This will mean that revenue and profits will be recognised later and on transition leads to the recognition of a contract liability as revenue and profits are deferred to future periods. Wholesale and Ventures and Openreach deliver the majority of this service and therefore will experience the majority of the impact. Over time, this liability is expected to remain at similar levels as old contracts expire and new ones are signed.

On the adoption date we expect the impact of this deferral to be significantly less than the impact of handset revenue and third party acquisition costs noted above.

We will provide for expected lifetime losses on recognised contract assets as required by IFRS 9 as set out below.

IFRS 15 will impact other areas but we do not expect the impact to be material. These include certain contract fulfilment costs which will be recognised as an asset and amortised over the period in which benefit is received and certain expenses will be recognised as a deduction from revenue.

IFRS 15 also provides more detailed guidance on how to account for contract modifications than the current revenue standards IAS 18 and IAS 11. Changes must be accounted for either as a retrospective change (creating either a catch up or deferral of previously recorded revenues), prospectively with a reallocation of revenues amongst identified performance obligations, or prospectively as separate contracts which will not require any reallocation. We expect contract modifications would primarily relate to changes in the agreed products and services to be provided to customers for long-term IT and networking solution contracts.

Disclosures

The adoption of IFRS 15 would also result in changes to our Annual Report disclosures. They key changes expected are as follows:

we will amend our existing revenue disclosures to comply with the requirements to disaggregate revenue recognised from contracts with customers into categories that depict how the nature, amount, timing and uncertainty of revenue and associated cash flows are affected by economic factors
we will provide further detail around contract balances and their movements
we will provide an aggregate amount of the transaction price allocated to the performance obligation that are unsatisfied as of the end of the reporting period and an explanation of when the entity expects the amounts to be recognised as revenue.

IFRS 9 ‘Financial instruments’

IFRS 9 is effective for BT from 1 April 2018. It is applicable to financial assets and financial liabilities and covers the classification, measurement, impairment and de-recognition of financial assets and liabilities together with a new hedge accounting model.

With the exception of the impact on IFRS 15 contract assets we do not expect the standard to have a material impact on our results, with the key issues for BT being around documentation of policies, hedging strategy and new hedge documentation.

 

 

 
207     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

1. Basis of preparation continued

IFRS 9 operates an expected credit loss model rather than an incurred credit loss model. Providing for loss allowances on our existing financial assets is not expected to have a material impact. We have included the impact of providing for losses on our contract assets within the estimated impact of the adoption of IFRS 15 set out above.

IFRS 16 ‘Leases’

IFRS 16 was published in January 2016 and will be effective for BT from 1 April 2019, replacing IAS 17 ‘Leases’. We are planning to adopt IFRS 16 on a modified retrospective basis and the group will recognise the cumulative effect of initially applying the standard as an adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings at 1 April 2019, ie the date of initial application. Results in the 2019/20 financial year will be IFRS 16 compliant and the Annual Report and Form 20-F 2020 will be the first to include the results on this basis.

The standard requires lessees to recognise assets and liabilities for all leases unless the lease term is 12 months or less, or the underlying asset is of low value.

The group is still in the process of quantifying the implications of this standard. However, we expect the following indicative impacts:

there is expected to be an increase in total assets, as leased assets which are currently accounted for off balance sheet (ie classified as operating leases under IAS 17) will be recognised on balance sheet valued in accordance with the principles of IFRS 16. The biggest asset category impacted for the group is expected to be land and buildings
there is expected to be an increase in debt, as liabilities relating to existing operating leases are recognised. The increase in total debt will have an impact on gearing ratios
operating lease expenditure will be reclassified and split between depreciation and finance costs. Therefore EBITDA will increase. Future depreciation and finance costs are also expected to increase as a result of increased assets and liabilities
there is an expected temporary reduction in profit after tax as result of the above changes. This is expected to be driven by an increase in finance costs as a result of the new leases. These finance costs will have an accelerated profile which will reduce once the leases are settled
there may be a corresponding effect on tax balances in relation to all of the above impacts.

This standard will require us to make key accounting judgements in particular around the likelihood of lease renewals.

Details of our existing operating lease commitments are set out in note 30.

Presentation of specific items

Our income statement and segmental analysis separately identify trading results before specific items. The directors believe that presentation of our results in this way is relevant to an understanding of our financial performance, as specific items are identified by virtue of their size, nature or incidence.

This presentation is consistent with the way that financial performance is measured by management and reported to the Board and the Executive Committee and assists in providing a meaningful analysis of our trading results. In determining whether an event or transaction is specific, management considers quantitative as well as qualitative factors such as the frequency or predictability of occurrence.

Furthermore, we consider a columnar presentation to be appropriate, as it improves the clarity of the presentation and is consistent with the way that financial performance is measured by management and reported to the Board and the

Executive Committee.

Specific items may not be comparable to similarly titled measures used by other companies. Examples of charges or credits meeting the above definition and which have been presented as specific items in the current and/or prior years include acquisitions/disposals of businesses and investments, regulatory settlements, historical insurance or litigation claims, business restructuring programmes, asset impairment charges, property rationalisation programmes, net interest on pensions and the settlement of multiple tax years. In the event that other items meet the criteria, which are applied consistently from year to year, they are also treated as specific items.

Specific items for the current and prior years are disclosed in note 8.

2. Critical accounting estimates

and key judgements

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires the use of accounting estimates and assumptions. It also requires management to exercise its judgement in the process of applying our accounting policies. We continually evaluate our estimates, assumptions and judgements based on available information and experience. As the use of estimates is inherent in financial reporting, actual results could differ from these estimates. Management has discussed its critical accounting estimates and associated disclosures with the Audit and Risk Committee. The areas involving a higher degree of judgement or complexity are described in the applicable notes to the financial statements. Critical accounting estimates and key judgements can be identified throughout the notes by the following symbol. LOGO

We have the following critical accounting estimates (E) and key judgements (J):

Revenue from multiple element arrangements, see note 4 (J).
Subscriber acquisition and retention costs, see note 5 (J).
Current and deferred income tax, see note 9 (E, J).
Goodwill, see note 12 (E).
Government grants relating to Broadband Delivery UK (BDUK) contracts, see note 13 (E, J).
Long-term customer contracts, see note 17 (E).
Provisions and contingent liabilities, see note 19 (E, J).
Pension obligations, see note 20 (E, J).
 

 

 
208     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

3. Significant accounting policies

The significant accounting policies applied in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements are set out below. These policies have been consistently applied to all the years presented, unless otherwise stated.

Basis of consolidation

The group financial statements consolidate the financial statements of BT Group plc and its subsidiaries, and include its share of the results of associates and joint ventures using the equity method of accounting. The group recognises its direct rights to (and its share of) jointly held assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses of joint operations under the appropriate headings in the consolidated financial statements.

A subsidiary is an entity that is controlled by another entity, known as the parent or investor. An investor controls an investee when the investor is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the investee.

Non-controlling interests in the net assets of consolidated subsidiaries, which consist of the amounts of those interests at the date of the original business combination and non-controlling share of changes in equity since the date of the combination, are not material to the group’s financial statements.

The results of subsidiaries acquired or disposed of during the year are consolidated from and up to the date of change of control. Where necessary, accounting policies of subsidiaries have been aligned with the policies adopted by the group. All intra-group transactions including any gains or losses, balances, income or expenses are eliminated in full on consolidation.

When the group loses control of a subsidiary, the profit or loss on disposal is calculated as the difference between (i) the aggregate of the fair value of the consideration received and the fair value of any retained interest and (ii) the previous carrying amount of the assets (including goodwill), and liabilities of the subsidiary and any non-controlling interests. The profit or loss on disposal is recognised as a specific item.

Revenue

Revenue represents the fair value of the consideration received or receivable for communications services and equipment sales, net of discounts and sales taxes. Revenue is recognised when it is probable that the economic benefits associated with a transaction will flow to the group and the amount of revenue and associated costs can be measured reliably. The accounting for revenue sharing arrangements depends on the analysis of the facts and circumstances surrounding these transactions.

Where we act as an agent in a transaction, we recognise revenue net of directly attributable costs.

Services

Revenue arising from separable installation and connection services is recognised when it is earned, upon activation. Revenue from the rental of analogue and digital lines and private circuits as well as wholesale access revenue is recognised on a straight line basis over the period to which it relates. Revenue from calls is recognised at the time the call is made over our network. Subscription fees, consisting primarily of monthly charges for access to broadband and other internet access or voice services, are recognised as revenue as

the service is provided. Revenue from the interconnection of voice and data traffic between other telecommunications operators is recognised at the time of transit across our network.

Equipment sales

Revenue from the sale of equipment is recognised when all the significant risks and rewards of ownership are transferred to the customer, which is normally the date the equipment is delivered and accepted by the customer.

Long-term contractual arrangements

Revenue from long-term contractual arrangements, including fixed price contracts to design and build software solutions, is recognised based on the percentage of completion method. The stage of completion is estimated using an appropriate measure according to the nature of the contract such as the proportion of costs incurred relative to the estimated total contract costs, or other measures of completion such as the achievement of contract milestones and customer acceptance. In the case of time and materials contracts, revenue is recognised as the service is rendered.

Costs related to delivering services under long-term contractual arrangements are expensed as incurred except for an element of costs incurred in the initial contract set-up, transition or transformation phase, which is deferred and recorded within non-current assets. These costs are then recognised in the income statement on a straight line basis over the remaining contract term, unless the pattern of service delivery indicates a different profile is more appropriate. These costs are directly attributable to specific contracts, relate to future activity, will generate future economic benefits and are assessed for recoverability on a regular basis.

The percentage of completion method relies on estimates of total expected contract revenues and costs, as well as reliable measurement of the progress made towards completion. Unless the financial outcome of a contract can be estimated with reasonable certainty, no attributable profit is recognised. In such circumstances, revenue is recognised equal to the costs incurred to date, to the extent that such revenue is expected to be recoverable, or costs are accrued to bring the margin to nil. Recognised revenue and profits are subject to revisions during the contract if the assumptions regarding the overall contract outcome are changed. The cumulative impact of a revision in estimates is recorded in the period in which such revisions become likely and can be estimated. Where the actual and estimated costs to completion exceed the estimated revenue for a contract, the full contract life loss is recognised immediately.

Multiple element arrangements and bundles

Revenue from multiple element arrangements and bundles is described in note 4.

Operating and reportable segments

Our operating segments are reported based on financial information provided to the Executive Committee, as detailed on pages 18 to 19, which is the key management committee and represents the ‘chief operating decision maker’.

Our organisational structure reflects the different customer groups to which we provide communications products and services via our customer-facing units: BT Consumer, EE, Business and Public Sector, Global Services, Wholesale and Ventures and Openreach. The customer-facing units are supported by an internal service unit: Technology, Service & Operations (TSO).

 

 

 
209     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

3. Significant accounting policies continued

The customer-facing units are our reportable segments and generate substantially all of our revenue. We aggregate the remaining operations and include within the ‘Other’ category to reconcile to the consolidated results of the group. The ‘Other’ category includes TSO and our corporate units including procurement and property management.

Provisions for the settlement of significant legal, commercial and regulatory disputes, which are negotiated at a group level, are initially recorded in the ‘Other’ segment. On resolution of the dispute, the full impact is recognised in the results of the relevant customer-facing unit and offset in the group results through the utilisation of the provision previously charged to the ‘Other’ segment. Settlements which are particularly significant or cover more than one financial year may fall within the definition of specific items as detailed on page 288.

The costs incurred by TSO are recharged to the customer-facing units to reflect the services it provides to them. Depreciation and amortisation incurred by TSO in relation to the networks and systems it manages and operates on behalf of the customer-facing units is allocated to the customer-facing units based on their respective utilisation. Capital expenditure incurred by TSO for specific projects undertaken on behalf of the customer-facing units is allocated based on the value of the directly attributable expenditure incurred. Where projects are not directly attributable to a particular customer-facing unit, capital expenditure is allocated between them based on the proportion of estimated future economic benefits. TSO and the group’s corporate functions are not reportable segments as they did not meet the quantitative thresholds as set out in IFRS 8 ‘Operating Segments’ for any of the years presented.

Performance of each reportable segment is measured based on adjusted EBITDA, defined as EBITDA before specific items, as included in the internal financial reports reviewed by the Executive Committee. EBITDA is defined as the operating profit or loss before depreciation, amortisation, net finance expense and taxation. Adjusted EBITDA is considered to be a useful measure of the operating performance of the customer-facing units because it approximates the underlying operating cash flow by eliminating depreciation and amortisation and also provides a meaningful analysis of trading performance by excluding specific items, which are disclosed separately by virtue of their size, nature or incidence. Specific items are detailed in note 8 and are not allocated to the reportable segments as this reflects how they are reported to the Executive Committee. Finance expense and income are not allocated to the reportable segments, as the central treasury function manages this activity, together with the overall net debt position of the group.

On 1 April 2018, our BT Consumer and EE customer-facing units were brought together to drive converged products and accelerate transformation. Additionally, Business and Public Sector and Wholesale and Ventures will be brought together from 1 October 2018. Each of these businesses operated separately throughout 2017/18 and therefore have been presented as four separate operating segments throughout these financial statements, unless explicitly stated otherwise. For further information see note 31.

Retirement benefits

The group’s net obligation in respect of defined benefit pension plans is the present value of the defined benefit obligation less the fair value of the plan assets.

The calculation of the obligation is performed by a qualified actuary using the projected unit credit method and key actuarial assumptions at the balance sheet date.

The income statement expense is allocated between an operating charge and net finance income or expense. The operating charge reflects the increase in the defined benefit obligation resulting from the pension benefit earned by active employees in the current period, the costs of administering the plans and any past service costs/credits such as those arising from curtailments or settlements. The net finance income or expense reflects the interest on the net retirement benefit obligations recognised in the group balance sheet, based on the discount rate at the start of the year. Actuarial gains and losses are recognised in full in the period in which they occur and are presented in the group statement of comprehensive income.

The group also operates defined contribution pension plans and the income statement expense represents the contributions payable for the year.

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment are included at historical cost, net of accumulated depreciation, government grants and any impairment charges. Property, plant and equipment acquired through business combinations are initially recorded at fair value and subsequently accounted for on the same basis as the group’s existing assets. An item of property, plant and equipment is derecognised on disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from the continued use of the asset. The difference between the sale proceeds and the net book value at the date of disposal is recognised in operating costs in the income statement.

Included within the cost of network infrastructure and equipment are direct and indirect labour costs, materials and directly attributable overheads.

Depreciation is provided on property, plant and equipment on a straight line basis from the time the asset is available for use, to write off the asset’s cost over the estimated useful life taking into account any expected residual value. Freehold land is not depreciated.

 

 

 
210     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

3. Significant accounting policies continued

The estimated useful lives assigned to principal categories of assets are as follows:

 

   

Land and buildings

 
– Freehold buildings     14 to 50 years  
– Short-term leasehold improvements    

Shorter of 10 years or

lease term

 

 

– Leasehold land and buildings    

Unexpired portion of lease or

40 years, whichever is the shorter

 

 

Network infrastructure

 

Transmission equipment

 
– Duct     40 years
– Cable     3 to 25 years  
– Fibre     5 to 20 years  
Exchange equipment     2 to 13 years  
Other network equipment     2 to 20 years  

Other assets

 
– Motor vehicles     2 to 9 years  
– Computers and office equipment     3 to 7 years  

Assets held under finance leases are depreciated over the shorter of the lease term or their useful economic life. Residual values and useful lives are reassessed annually and, if necessary, changes are recognised prospectively.

Network share assets

Certain assets have been contributed to a network share arrangement by both EE and Hutchison 3G UK Limited, with legal title remaining with the contributor. This is considered to be a reciprocal arrangement. The group’s share of the assets on acquisition of EE was recognised at fair value within tangible assets, and depreciated in line with the group’s policy. Subsequent additions are recorded at cost. For further information see note 13.

Intangible assets

Identifiable intangible assets are recognised when the group controls the asset, it is probable that future economic benefits attributable to the asset will flow to the group and the cost of the asset can be reliably measured. All intangible assets, other than goodwill, are amortised over their useful economic life. The method of amortisation reflects the pattern in which the assets are expected to be consumed. If the pattern cannot be determined reliably, the straight line method is used.

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of the group’s share of the identifiable net assets (including intangible assets) of the acquired business.

For the purpose of impairment testing, goodwill acquired in a business combination is allocated to each of the Cash Generating Units (CGUs) that is expected to benefit from the business combination. Each CGU to which goodwill is allocated represents the lowest level within the group at which the goodwill is monitored for internal management purposes.

Acquired intangible assets – customer relationships and brands

Intangible assets such as customer relationships or brands acquired through business combinations are recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition and subsequently carried at amortised cost. Assumptions are used in estimating the fair values of these relationships or brands and include management’s estimates of revenue and profits to be generated by them.

Telecommunications licences

Licence fees paid to governments, which permit telecommunications activities to be operated for defined periods, are initially recorded at cost and amortised from the time the network is available for use to the end of the licence period or where our usage can extend beyond the initial licence period, over the period we expect to benefit from the use of the licences, which is typically 20 years. Licences acquired through business combinations are recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition and subsequently carried at amortised cost. The fair value is based on management’s assumption of future cash flows using market expectations at acquisition date.

Computer software

Computer software comprises computer software licences purchased from third parties, and also the cost of internally developed software. Computer software licences purchased from third parties are initially recorded at cost.

Costs directly associated with the production of internally developed software, including direct and indirect labour costs of development, are capitalised only where it is probable that the software will generate future economic benefits, the cost of the asset can be reliably measured and technical feasibility can be demonstrated, in which case it is capitalised as an intangible asset on the balance sheet. Costs which do not meet these criteria and research costs are expensed as incurred.

The group’s development costs which give rise to internally developed software include upgrading the network architecture or functionality and developing service platforms aimed at offering new services to the group’s customers. See research and development on page 37.

Other

Other intangible assets include website development costs and other licences. Items are capitalised at cost and amortised on a straight line basis over their useful economic life or the term of the contract.

Estimated useful economic lives

The estimated useful economic lives assigned to the principal categories of intangible assets are as follows:

 

– Computer software

    2 to 10 years  

– Telecommunications licences

    2 to 20 years  

– Customer relationships and brands

    1 to 15 years  

Programme rights

Programme rights are recognised on the balance sheet from the point at which the legally enforceable licence period begins. Rights for which the licence period has not started are disclosed as contractual commitments in note 30. Payments made to receive commissioned or acquired programming in advance of the legal right to broadcast the programmes are classified as prepayments.

 

 

 
211     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

3. Significant accounting policies continued

Programme rights are initially recognised at cost and are amortised from the point at which they are available for use, on a straight line basis over the programming period, or the remaining licence term, as appropriate, this is generally 12 months. The amortisation charge is recorded within operating costs in the income statement.

Programmes produced internally are charged to the income statement over the period of the related broadcast.

Programme rights are tested for impairment in accordance with the group’s policy for impairment of non-financial assets set out below. Related cash outflows are classified as operating cash flows in the cash flow statement.

Inventories

Network maintenance equipment and equipment to be sold to customers are stated at the lower of cost or net realisable value, taking into account expected revenues from the sale of packages comprising a mobile handset and a subscription. Cost corresponds to purchase or production cost determined by either the first in first out (FIFO) or average cost method.

Provisions

Provisions are recognised when the group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of past events, it is probable that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligation and the amount can be reliably estimated. Provisions are determined by discounting the expected future cash flows at a pre-tax rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the liability. Financial liabilities within provisions are initially recognised at fair value and subsequently carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method. Onerous lease provisions are measured at the lower of the cost to fulfil or to exit the contract.

Current and deferred income tax

Current income tax is calculated on the basis of the tax laws enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date in the countries where the group’s subsidiaries, associates and joint ventures operate and generate taxable income. The group periodically evaluates positions taken in tax returns with respect to situations in which applicable tax regulation is subject to interpretation, and the group establishes provisions where appropriate on the basis of the amounts expected to be paid to tax authorities.

Deferred tax is recognised, using the liability method, in respect of temporary differences between the carrying amount of the group’s assets and liabilities and their tax base. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets against current tax liabilities and when the deferred income tax assets and liabilities relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation authority on either the taxable entity or different taxable entities where there is an intention to settle the balances on a net basis. Any remaining deferred tax asset is recognised only when, on the basis of all available evidence, it can be regarded as probable that there will be suitable taxable profits, within the same jurisdiction, in the foreseeable future against which the deductible temporary difference can be utilised.

Deferred tax is determined using tax rates that are expected to apply in the periods in which the asset is realised or liability settled, based on tax rates and laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date.

Impairment of non-financial assets

Intangible assets with finite useful lives and property, plant and equipment are tested for impairment if events or changes in circumstances (assessed at each reporting date) indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. When an impairment test is performed, the recoverable amount is assessed by reference to the higher of the net present value of the expected future cash flows (value in use) of the relevant cash generating unit and the fair value less costs to dispose.

Goodwill is reviewed for impairment at least annually. Impairment losses are recognised in the income statement, as a specific item. If a cash generating unit is impaired, impairment losses are allocated firstly against goodwill, and secondly on a pro-rata basis against intangible and other assets.

Government grants

Government grants are recognised when there is reasonable assurance that the conditions associated with the grants have been complied with and the grants will be received.

Grants for the purchase or production of property, plant and equipment are deducted from the cost of the related assets and reduce future depreciation expense accordingly. Grants for the reimbursement of operating expenditure are deducted from the related category of costs in the income statement. Government grants received relating to the BDUK programme and other rural superfast broadband contracts are accounted for as described under ‘Critical accounting estimates and key judgements’.

Once a government grant is recognised, any related deferred income is treated in accordance with IAS 20 ‘Accounting for Government Grants and Disclosure of Government Assistance’.

Foreign currencies

Foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the date of the transaction. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of transactions and the translation of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies at period end exchange rates are recognised in the income statement line which most appropriately reflects the nature of the item or transaction.

On consolidation, assets and liabilities of foreign undertakings are translated into Sterling at year end exchange rates. The results of foreign undertakings are translated into Sterling at average rates of exchange for the year (unless this average is not a reasonable approximation of the cumulative effects of the rates prevailing on the transaction dates, in which case income and expenses are translated at the dates of the transactions). Foreign exchange differences arising on the retranslation of foreign undertakings are recognised directly in a separate component of equity, the translation reserve.

In the event of the disposal of an undertaking with assets and liabilities denominated in a foreign currency, the cumulative translation difference associated with the undertaking in the translation reserve is charged or credited to the gain or loss on disposal recognised in the income statement.

 

 

 
212     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

3. Significant accounting policies continued

Research and development

Research expenditure is recognised in the income statement in the period in which it is incurred. Development expenditure, including the cost of internally developed software, is recognised in the income statement in the period in which it is incurred unless it is probable that economic benefits will flow to the group from the asset being developed, the cost of the asset can be reliably measured and technical feasibility can be demonstrated, in which case it is capitalised as an intangible asset on the balance sheet.

Capitalisation ceases when the asset being developed is ready for use. Research and development costs include direct and indirect labour, materials and directly attributable overheads.

Leases

The determination of whether an arrangement is, or contains, a lease is based on the substance of the arrangement and requires an assessment of whether the fulfilment of the arrangement is dependent on the use of a specific asset or assets and whether the arrangement conveys the right to use the asset.

Leases of property, plant and equipment where the group holds substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are classified as finance leases. Finance lease assets are capitalised at the commencement of the lease term at the lower of the present value of the minimum lease payments or the fair value of the leased asset. The obligations relating to finance leases, net of finance charges in respect of future periods, are recognised as liabilities. Leases are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method.

Leases where a significant portion of the risks and rewards are held by the lessor are classified as operating leases. Rentals are charged to the income statement on a straight line basis over the period of the lease.

Own shares

Own shares represent the shares of the parent company BT Group plc that are held in treasury or by employee share ownership trusts. Own shares are recorded at cost and deducted from equity. When shares vest unconditionally or are cancelled they are transferred from the own shares reserve to retained earnings at their weighted average cost.

Share-based payments

The group operates a number of equity settled share-based payment arrangements, under which the group receives services from employees in consideration for equity instruments (share options and shares) of the group. Equity settled share-based payments are measured at fair value at the date of grant. Market-based performance criteria and non-vesting conditions (for example, the requirement for employees to make contributions to the share purchase programme) are reflected in this measurement of fair value. The fair value determined at the grant date is recognised as an expense on a straight line basis over the vesting period, based on the group’s estimate of the options or shares that will eventually vest and adjusted for the effect of non market-based vesting conditions. Fair value is measured using either the Binomial options pricing model or Monte Carlo simulations, whichever is more appropriate to the share-based payment arrangement.

Service and performance conditions are vesting conditions. Any other conditions are non-vesting conditions which have to be taken into account to determine the fair value of equity

instruments granted. In the case that an award or option does not vest as a result of a failure to meet a non-vesting condition that is within the control of either counterparty, this is accounted for as a cancellation. Cancellations are treated as accelerated vesting and all remaining future charges are immediately recognised in the income statement. As the requirement to save under an employee saveshare arrangement is a non-vesting condition, employee cancellations, other than through a termination of service, are treated as an accelerated vesting.

No adjustment is made to total equity for awards that lapse or are forfeited after the vesting date.

Termination benefits

Termination benefits (leaver costs) are payable when employment is terminated before the normal retirement date, or when an employee accepts voluntary redundancy in exchange for these benefits. The group recognises termination benefits when it is demonstrably committed to the affected employees leaving the group.

Financial instruments

Financial liabilities at amortised cost

Trade and other payables

Financial liabilities within trade and other payables are initially recognised at fair value, which is usually the original invoiced amount, and subsequently carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method.

Loans and other borrowings

Loans and other borrowings are initially recognised at the fair value of amounts received net of transaction costs. Loans and other borrowings are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method and, if included in a fair value hedge relationship, are re-valued to reflect the fair value movements on the hedged risk associated with the loans and other borrowings. The resulting amortisation of fair value movements, on de-designation of the hedge, is recognised in the income statement.

Available-for-sale investments

Liquid and other investments are classified as available-for-sale investments and are initially recognised at fair value plus direct transaction costs. These are re-measured at subsequent reporting dates to fair value, with unrealised gains and losses (except for changes in exchange rates for monetary items, interest, dividends and impairment losses, which are recognised in the income statement) recognised in equity. When the financial asset is derecognised, the cumulative gain or loss previously recognised in equity is taken to the income statement, in the line that most appropriately reflects the nature of the item or transaction. On disposal or impairment of the investments, any gains and losses that have been deferred in other comprehensive income are reclassified to the income statement. Dividends on equity investments are recognised in the income statement when the group’s right to receive payment is established. Equity investments are recorded in non-current assets unless they are expected to be sold within one year.

Loans and receivables

Trade and other receivables

Trade and other receivables are initially recognised at fair value, which is usually the original invoiced amount, and are subsequently carried at amortised cost, using the effective interest method, less provisions made for doubtful receivables. Provisions are made specifically where there is evidence of a risk of non-payment, taking into account ageing, previous losses experienced and general economic conditions.

 

 

 
213     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

3. Significant accounting policies continued

Cash and cash equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash in hand and current balances with banks and similar institutions, which are readily convertible to cash and are subject to insignificant risk of changes in value and have an original maturity of three months or less. For the purpose of the consolidated cash flow statement, cash and cash equivalents are as defined above net of outstanding bank overdrafts. Bank overdrafts are included within loans and other borrowings, in current liabilities on the balance sheet.

Financial assets and liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

All of the group’s derivative financial instruments are held for trading and classified as fair value through profit or loss.

Derivative financial instruments

The group uses derivative financial instruments mainly to reduce exposure to foreign exchange and interest rate risks. The group’s policy is not to use derivatives for trading purposes. However, derivatives that do not qualify for hedge accounting or are specifically not designated as a hedge where natural offset is more appropriate are initially recognised and subsequently measured at fair value through profit and loss. Any direct transaction costs are recognised immediately in the income statement. Gains and losses on re-measurement are recognised in the income statement in the line that most appropriately reflects the nature of the item or transaction to which they relate. Derivative financial instruments are classified as current assets or current liabilities where they have a maturity period within 12 months. Where derivative financial instruments have a maturity period greater than 12 months, they are classified within either non-current assets or non-current liabilities.

Where the fair value of a derivative contract at initial recognition is not supported by observable market data and differs from the transaction price, a day one gain or loss will arise which is not recognised in the income statement. Such gains and losses are deferred and amortised to the income statement based on the remaining contractual term and as observable market data becomes available.

Hedge accounting

Where derivatives qualify for hedge accounting, recognition of any resultant gain or loss depends on the nature of the hedge. To qualify for hedge accounting, hedge documentation must be prepared at inception and the hedge must be expected to be highly effective both prospectively and retrospectively. The hedge is tested for effectiveness at inception and in subsequent periods in which the hedge remains in operation. Hedge accounting is discontinued when the hedging instrument expires, or is sold, terminated or no longer qualifies for hedge accounting or the group chooses to end the hedge relationship. The group designates certain derivatives as either cash flow hedges or fair value hedges.

Cash flow hedges

When a derivative financial instrument is designated as a hedge of the variability in cash flows of a recognised asset or liability, or a highly probable transaction, the effective part of any gain or loss on the derivative financial instrument is recognised directly in equity, in the cash flow reserve. For cash flow hedges of recognised assets or liabilities, the associated cumulative gain or loss is removed from equity and recognised in the same line of the income statement and in the same period or periods that the hedged transaction affects the income statement. Any ineffectiveness arising on a cash flow hedge of a recognised asset or liability is recognised immediately in the same income statement line as the hedged item. Where ineffectiveness arises on highly probable transactions, it is recognised in the income statement line which most appropriately reflects the nature of the item or transaction.

Fair value hedges

When a derivative financial instrument is designated as a hedge of the variability in fair value of a recognised asset or liability, or unrecognised firm commitment, the change in fair value of the derivative that is designated as a fair value hedge is recorded in the income statement at each reporting date, together with any changes in fair value of the hedged asset or liability that is attributable to the hedged risk.

 

 

 
214     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

4. Segment information

The definition of our operating and reportable segments is provided on page 209. We have set out below information regarding the results of each reportable segment.

Segment revenue and profit

 

Year ended 31 March 2018   

BT

Consumer

£m

   

EE

£m

   

Business

and Public

Sector

£m

   

Global

Services

£m

   

Wholesale

and

Ventures

£m

   

Openreach

£m

   

Other

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Segment revenue

     5,066       5,294       4,563       5,013       2,009       5,123       8       27,076  

Internal revenue

     (66     (37     (115           (134     (2,978           (3,330

Revenue from external customersa

     5,000       5,257       4,448       5,013       1,875       2,145       8       23,746  

EBITDAb

     1,023       1,353       1,418       434       754       2,520       3       7,505  

Depreciation and amortisation

     (216     (776     (365     (424     (311     (1,360     (62     (3,514

Operating profit (loss)a

     807       577       1,053       10       443       1,160       (59     3,991  

Specific items (note 8)

                   (610

Operating profit

                   3,381  

Net finance expensec

                   (764

Share of post tax profit (loss) of associates and joint ventures

                                                             (1

Profit before tax

                                                             2,616  
Year ended 31 March 2017   

BT

Consumer

£m

   

EE

£m

   

Business

  and Public

Sector

£m

   

Global

  Services

£m

   

  Wholesale

and

Ventures

£m

   

  Openreach

£m

   

      Other

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Segment revenue

     4,934       5,090       4,758       5,479       2,109       5,098       10       27,478  

Internal revenue

     (63     (37     (122           (138     (3,036           (3,396

Revenue from external customersa

     4,871           5,053       4,636       5,479       1,971       2,062       10         24,082  

EBITDAb

     1,012       1,156       1,528       495       834       2,633       (13     7,645  

Depreciation and amortisation

     (209     (780     (352     (439     (306     (1,369     (55     (3,510

Operating profit (loss)a

     803       376       1,176       56       528       1,264       (68     4,135  

Specific items (note 8)

                   (968

Operating profit

                   3,167  

Net finance expensec

                   (804

Share of post tax profit (loss) of associates and joint ventures

                                                             (9

Profit before tax

                                                             2,354  
Year ended 31 March 2016     

BT

Consumer

£m

 

 

 

   

EE

£m

 d 

 

   

Business

and Public

Sector

£m

 

 

 

 

   

Global

Services

£m

 

 

 

   

Wholesale

and

Ventures

£m

 

 

 

 

   

Openreach

£m

 

 

   

Other

£m

 

 

   

Total

£m

 

 

Segment revenue

     4,608       841       4,294       5,074       2,274       5,100       11       22,202  

Internal revenue

     (65     (7     (99           (94     (3,058           (3,323

Revenue from external customersa

     4,543       834       4,195       5,074       2,180       2,042       11       18,879  

EBITDAb

     1,055       173       1,414       479       755       2,659       (76     6,459  

Depreciation and amortisation

     (207     (146     (284     (422     (253     (1,301     (18     (2,631

Operating profit (loss)a

     848       27       1,130       57       502       1,358       (94     3,828  

Specific items (note 8)

                   (215

Operating profit

                   3,613  

Net finance expensec

                   (712

Share of post tax profit (loss) of associates and joint ventures

                                                             6  

Profit before tax

                                                             2,907  

 

a  Before specific items.
b  EBITDA is stated before specific items and is the group’s profitability measure for segments.
c  Net finance expense includes specific item expense of £218m (2016/17: £210m, 2015/16: £229m). See note 8.
d  EE reflects results for the period from acquisition on 29 January 2016 to 31 March 2016.

 

 
215     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

4. Segment information continued

What are our internal revenue and costs?

Most of our internal trading relates to Openreach and arises on rentals, and any associated connection or migration charges, of the UK access lines and other network products to the customer-facing units. This occurs both directly, and also indirectly, through TSO which is included within the ‘Other’ segment. Wholesale and Ventures internal revenue arises from EE for mobile ethernet access and TSO for transmission planning services. Internal revenue in Business and Public Sector relates primarily to the use of BT Ireland’s network by other customer-facing units. Internal revenue arising in BT Consumer relates primarily to employee broadband and wi-fi services.

Intra-group revenue generated from the sale of regulated products and services is based on market price. Intra-group revenue from the sale of other products and services is agreed between the relevant customer-facing units and therefore customer-facing units profitability may be impacted by transfer pricing levels.

The tables below show internal revenue and costs recorded by each reportable segment.

 

     Internal cost recorded by  
Year ended 31 March 2018   

BT

Consumer

£m

    

            EE

£m

   

Business

and Public

Sector

£m

    

Global

Services

£m

    

Wholesale

and Ventures

£m

    

Openreach

£m

    

Other

£m

    

Total

£m

 

Internal revenue recorded by

                      

BT Consumer

                  24        20        4               18        66  

EE

                                37                      37  

Business and Public Sector

     62        2              32        19                      115  

Global Services

                                                      

Wholesale and Ventures

     1        2       13        10               42        66        134  

Openreach

     896              210        125        232               1,515        2,978  

Total

     959        4       247        187        292        42          1,599          3,330  
     Internal cost recorded by  
Year ended 31 March 2017   

BT

Consumer

£m

    

EE

£m

   

Business

and Public

Sector

£m

    

Global

Services

£m

    

Wholesale

and Ventures

£m

    

Openreach

£m

    

Other

£m

    

Total

£m

 

Internal revenue recorded by

                      

BT Consumer

                  21        20        4               18        63  

EE

                                37                      37  

Business and Public Sector

     60        3              39        20                      122  

Global Services

                                                      

Wholesale and Ventures

                  2        23               39        74        138  

Openreach

     910              236        158        260               1,472        3,036  

Total

     970        3       259        240        321        39        1,564        3,396  
     Internal cost recorded by  
Year ended 31 March 2016     

BT

Consumer

£m

 

 

 

    

EE

£m

 a 

 

   

Business

and Public

Sector

£m

 

 

 

 

    

Global

Services

£m

 

 

 

    

Wholesale

and Ventures

£m

 

 

 

    

Openreach

£m

 

 

    

Other

£m

 

 

    

Total

£m

 

 

Internal revenue recorded by

                      

BT Consumer

                  20        23        4               18        65  

EEa

                                7                      7  

Business and Public Sector

     60        1              18        19        1               99  

Global Services

                                                      

Wholesale and Ventures

            12       5        22               55               94  

Openreach

     905              262        173        264               1,454        3,058  

Total

     965        13       287        236        294        56        1,472        3,323  

 

a  EE reflects results for the period from acquisition on 29 January 2016 to 31 March 2016.

Revenue by products and services

LOGO What critical accounting judgements do we make when we have revenue from multiple element arrangements?

Where a contractual arrangement consists of two or more separate elements that have value to a customer on a standalone basis, revenue is recognised for each element as if it were an individual contract. Total contract consideration is allocated between the separate elements based on their fair value. We apply judgement in both identifying separate elements and allocating consideration between them.

 

 
216     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

4. Segment information continued

Sales of bundled offers in our mobile businesses frequently include a handset and a telecommunications service contract. There is objective and reliable evidence of fair value for the telecommunications service to be delivered and this represents the revenue recognised in respect of the services delivered. The residual value of the bundled offer therefore represents the revenue in respect of the handset. Revenue allocated to the deliverables is restricted to the amount that is receivable without the delivery of additional goods or services.

For offers that cannot be separated into identifiable elements, revenues are recognised in full over the life of the contract. The main example is connection to a service where this does not represent a separately identifiable transaction from the subscription.

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

ICT and managed networks

     5,530        5,927        6,193  

Broadband and TV

     4,655        4,477        3,535  

Mobile

     6,451        6,358        1,326  

Calls, lines and connections

     5,126        5,069        5,920  

Transit

     265        404        419  

Other products and services

     1,719        1,847        1,486  

Revenuea

           23,746              24,082              18,879  

 

a Before specific items.

Capital expenditure

 

Year ended 31 March 2018   

BT

Consumer

£m

    

EE

£m

   

Business

and Public

Sector

£m

    

Global

Services

£m

    

Wholesale

and Ventures

£m

    

Openreach

£m

    

Other

£m

    

Total

£m

 

Intangible assets

     106        130       93        92        87        70        64        642  

Property, plant and equipment

     185        498       211        186        142        1,588        70        2,880  

Capital expenditurea

     291        628       304        278        229        1,658        134        3,522  
Year ended 31 March 2017   

BT

Consumer

£m

    

          EE

£m

   

Business

and Public

Sector

£m

    

Global

Services

£m

    

Wholesale

and Ventures

£m

    

Openreach

£m

    

      Other

£m

    

Total

£m

 

Intangible assets

     92        133       64        126        77        74        55        621  

Property, plant and equipment

     145        483       211        235        149        1,499        111        2,833  

Capital expenditurea

     237        616       275        361        226        1,573        166          3,454  
Year ended 31 March 2016     

BT
Consumer
£m
 
 
 
    

EE

£m

 b 

 

   

Business

and Public

Sector

£m

 

 

 

 

    

Global

Services

£m

 

 

 

    

Wholesale

and Ventures

£m

 

 

 

    

Openreach

£m

 

 

    

Other

£m

 

 

    

Total

£m

 

 

Intangible assets

     88        29       36        62        70        62        65        412  

Property, plant and equipment

     119        67       117        293        139        1,385        90        2,210  

Capital expenditurea

     207        96       153        355        209        1,447        155        2,622  

 

a Net of government grants.
b EE reflects results for the period from acquisition on 29 January 2016 to 31 March 2016.

 

 
217     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

4. Segment information continued

How do we determine our geographic information?

The UK is our country of domicile and we generate the majority of our revenue from external customers in the UK. The geographic analysis of revenue is based on the country of origin in which the customer is invoiced. The geographic analysis of non-current assets, which exclude derivative financial instruments, investments and deferred tax assets, is based on the location of the assets.

Revenue from external customers

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

UK

     19,687        19,421        14,814  

Europe, Middle East and Africa, excluding the UK

     2,489        2,841        2,442  

Americas

     996        1,148        1,011  

Asia Pacific

     574        672        612  

Revenuea

             23,746                24,082                18,879  

a  Before specific items.

        
Non-current assets         
At 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

UK

     28,835        28,810        28,575  

Europe, Middle East and Africa, excluding the UK

     2,527        2,535        2,349  

Americas

     331        424        548  

Asia Pacific

     109        149        191  

Non-current assets

     31,802        31,918        31,663  

 

 
218     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

5. Operating costs

 

Year ended 31 March    Notes                     

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

   

2016

£m

 

Operating costs by nature

               

Staff costs:

               

Wages and salaries

              4,229       4,134       3,689  

Social security costs

              461       477       398  

Other pension costs

     20              624       521       494  

Share-based payment expense

     22                          84       57       58  

Total staff costs

              5,398       5,189       4,639  

Own work capitalised

                                (798     (813     (720

Net staff costs

              4,600       4,376       3,919  

Net indirect labour costsa

                                315       399       304  

Net labour costs

              4,915       4,775       4,223  

Payments to telecommunications operators

              2,306       2,653       2,183  

Property and energy costs

              1,285       1,202       1,024  

Network operating and IT costs

              963       983       644  

TV programme rights charges

              763       714       544  

Other operating costs

              6,233       6,297       4,017  

Other operating income

              (224     (187     (215

Depreciation of property, plant and equipment

               

Owned assets

     13              2,381       2,382       2,000  

Held under finance leases

     13              10       10       10  

Amortisation of intangible assetsb

     12                          1,123       1,118       621  

Total operating costs before specific items

                                19,755       19,947       15,051  

Specific items

     8                          587       948       348  

Total operating costs

                                        20,342               20,895               15,399  

Operating costs before specific items include the following:

               

Leaver costsc

              50       86       109  

Research and development expenditured

              632       638       574  

Operating lease charges

              732       692       441  

Foreign currency gains

                    (12     (1

Government grants

                                (3     (5     (6

 

a  Net of capitalised indirect labour costs of £612m (2016/17: £463m, 2015/16: £430m).
b  Excludes £nil (2016/17: £62m, 2015/16: £nil) of amortisation presented as specific items which relate to a write-off of software costs as a result of the integration of EE. Refer to note 8.
c  Leaver costs are included within wages and salaries, except for leaver costs of £168m (2016/17: £37m, 2015/16: £nil) associated with restructuring and EE integration costs, which have been recorded as specific items.
d  Research and development expenditure reported in the income statement includes amortisation of £573m (2016/17: £577m, 2015/16: £501m) in respect of internally developed computer software and operating expenses of £59m (2016/17: £61m, 2015/16: £73m). In addition, the group capitalised software development costs of £450m (2016/17: £457m, 2015/16: £399m).

LOGO Why is the treatment of our subscriber acquisition and retention costs a critical judgement?

Subscriber acquisition and retention costs are recognised as an expense within other operating costs for the period in which they are incurred. If subscriber acquisition and retention costs are paid in advance they are recognised as prepayments provided the amounts are able to be measured reliably and are expected to be recoverable. In some cases, contractual clauses with retailers provide for profit-sharing based on the recognised and paid revenue. In these cases we recognise an expense when the revenue is earned from the customer and a corresponding liability to pay that retailer. In some cases we need to exercise judgement in assessing whether we have an upfront obligation based on the contractual terms.

 

 
219     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

5. Operating costs continued

Who are our key management personnel and how are they compensated?

Key management personnel comprise executive and non-executive directors and members of the Executive Committee.

Compensation of key management personnel is shown in the table below:

 

Year ended 31 March   

          2018

£m

    

          2017

£m

    

          2016

£m

 

Short-term employee benefits

     11.8        10.5        9.4  

Post employment benefits

     1.3        1.3        1.1  

Share-based payments

     6.2        5.6        5.5  

Termination benefits

     2.2               0.6  
       21.5        17.4        16.6  

More detailed information concerning directors’ remuneration, shareholdings, pension entitlements, share options and other long-term incentive plans is shown in the audited part of the Report on Directors’ Remuneration (see page 156), which forms part of these consolidated financial statements.

6. Employees

 

     2018          2017          2016  
Number of employees in the groupa   

    Year end

000

    

      Average

000

         

    Year end

000

    

      Average

000

         

    Year end

000

    

      Average

000

 

UK

     82.2        82.5          82.8        82.2          81.4        71.8  

Non-UK

     23.6        23.7            23.6        22.8            21.1        19.2  

Total employees

     105.8        106.2            106.4        105.0            102.5        91.0  
     2018          2017          2016  
Number of employees in the groupa   

Year end

000

    

Average

000

         

Year end

000

    

Average

000

         

Year end

000

    

Average

000

 

BT Consumer

     8.8        8.8          8.7        7.7          6.7        6.3  

EE

     9.4        9.2          9.2        9.1          9.0        1.3  

Business and Public Sector

     10.1        10.3          10.3        10.2          10.3        9.3  

Global Services

     16.9        17.3          17.5        17.4          16.8        16.5  

Wholesale and Ventures

     3.8        3.9          3.8        3.7          3.7        3.8  

Openreach

     30.5        30.4          30.2        30.9          31.5        32.1  

Other

     26.3        26.3            26.7        26.0            24.5        21.7  

Total employees

     105.8        106.2            106.4        105.0            102.5        91.0  

 

a These reflect the full-time equivalent of full and part-time employees.

 

 
220     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

7. Audit, audit related and other non-audit services

The following fees were paid or are payable to the company’s auditors, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP and other firms in the PricewaterhouseCoopers network.

 

                                                                    
Year ended 31 March    2018
£000
     2017
£000
     2016
£000
 

Fees payable to the company’s auditors and its associates for:

        

Audit servicesa

        

The audit of the parent company and the consolidated financial statements

     5,418        4,316        3,915  

The audit of the company’s subsidiaries

     5,877        5,675        5,084  
     11,295        9,991        8,999  

Audit related assurance servicesb

     1,771        1,865        2,210  

Other non-audit services

        

Taxation compliance servicesc

            366        412  

Taxation advisory servicesd

            111        156  

All other assurance servicese

     211        200        1,611  

All other servicesf

     592        2,332        1,665  
       803        3,009        3,844  

Total services

     13,869        14,865        15,053  

 

a  Services in relation to the audit of the parent company and the consolidated financial statements, including fees for reports under section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. This also includes fees payable for the statutory audits of the financial statements of subsidiary companies.
b  Services in relation to other statutory filings or engagements that are required by law or regulation to be carried out by an appointed auditor. This includes fees for the review of interim results, the audit of the group’s regulatory financial statements and reporting associated with the group’s US debt shelf registration.
c  Services relating to tax returns, tax audits, monitoring and enquiries.
d Fees payable for all taxation advisory services not falling within taxation compliance.
e  All other assurance services include fees payable to PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as Reporting Accountants in 2015/16 in relation to the Listing Prospectus, which was issued on 26 January 2016 for the issue of new shares.
f  Fees payable for all non-audit services not covered above, principally comprising other advisory services.

The BT Pension Scheme is an associated pension fund as defined in the Companies (Disclosure of Auditor Remuneration and Liability Limitation Agreements) (Amendment) Regulations 2011. In the year ended 31 March 2018 PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP received total fees from the BT Pension Scheme of £2.1m (2016/17: £2.1m, 2015/16: £1.7m) in respect of the following services:

 

                                                                    
Year ended 31 March    2018
£000
     2017
£000
     2016
£000
 

Audit of financial statements of associates

     345        251        213  

Audit-related assurance services

                   10  

Taxation compliance services

     153        210        198  

Taxation advisory services

     1,074        493        681  

Other non-audit services

     565        1,168        603  

Total services

     2,137        2,122        1,705  

 

 
221     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

8. Specific items

 

                                                                    
Year ended 31 March    2018
£m
    2017
£m
    2016
£m
 

Revenue

      

Italian business investigation

           22        

Regulatory matters

     23       (2     (203

EE fair value adjustment

                 70  
       23       20       (133

Operating costs

      

EE acquisition warranty claims

     225              

Restructuring charges

     241              

EE acquisition and integration costs

     46       215       116  

Property rationalisation costs

     28             29  

Regulatory matters

     26       481       203  

Italian business investigation

     22       238        

Out of period irrecoverable VAT

           30        

Profit on disposal of businesses

     (1     (16      
       587       948       348  

Operating loss

     610       968       215  

Net finance expense

      

Interest expense on retirement benefit obligation

     218       209       221  

EE related finance cost

                 8  

Interest on out of period irrecoverable VAT

           1        
       218       210       229  

Net specific items charge before tax

     828       1,178       444  

Taxation

      

Tax credit on specific items above

     (87     (154     (70

Tax credit on re-measurement of deferred tax

           (63     (96
       (87     (217     (166

Net specific items charge after tax

     741       961       278  

EE acquisition warranty claims

In the year we reached settlements with Deutsche Telekom and Orange in respect of any warranty claims under the 2015 EE acquisition agreement, arising from the issues previously announced regarding our operations in Italy. This represents a full and final settlement of these issues and resulted in a specific item charge of £225m (2016/17: £nil, 2015/16: £nil).

Restructuring charges

During the year we incurred charges of £241m (2016/17: £nil, 2015/16: £nil), primarily relating to leaver costs. These costs reflect projects within the first phase of our group-wide cost transformation programme (which was announced in May 2017 and is expected to total £300m). Further associated charges relating to the first phase will be recognized in 2018/19 as part of our wider restructuring activity. See note 31 for further details.

EE acquisition and integration costs

We incurred £46m (2016/17: £215m, 2015/16: £116m) of acquisition and integration related costs for EE. Integration costs include EE related restructuring and leaver costs in the year. In 2016/17, this included a £62m (2015/16: £nil) amortisation charge relating to the write-off of IT assets as we integrated the EE and BT IT infrastructure.

Property rationalisation costs

We have recognised a charge of £28m (2016/17: £nil, 2015/16: £29m) relating to the rationalisation of the group’s property portfolio.

Regulatory matters

We’ve recognised a net charge of £49m (2016/17: £479m, 2015/16: £nil) in relation to regulatory matters in the year. Of this, £23m is recognised in revenue and £26m in operating costs. These are made up of the following:

Deemed Consent

In 2016/17 a charge of £342m was recognised (2015/16: £nil) in relation to Ofcom’s March 2017 findings of its investigation into our historical practices on Deemed Consent by Openreach. This included a fine of £42m. We have agreed the majority of compensation payments to other Communications Providers in the year and continue to estimate the total compensation payments will amount to £300m.

 

 
222     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

8. Specific items continued

 

Ladder pricing agreements

In 2016/17 we recognised revenue and costs of £8m (2015/16: £203m) being the prior year impacts of ladder pricing agreements with the other UK mobile operators following a Supreme Court judgment in July 2014.

Other regulatory matters

We re-assessed our regulatory risk provision in light of recent regulatory decisions by Ofcom. As a result we have increased our net charge by £49m (2016/17: £137m) for the year. £51m is recognised in provisions offset by a release of £2m in trade and other payables.

Italian business investigation

In 2017/18, we have incurred professional costs relating to the investigation of our Italian business of £22m.

As part of the investigation into our Italian business in 2016/17, we reviewed the carrying value of the assets and liabilities on the balance sheet of our Italian business including reassessing the recoverability of trade and other receivables and reconsidering other exposures, principally tax penalties. We took into account any changes in facts or circumstances since 31 March 2016 in determining whether there was a need to change an estimate and whether additional exposures had arisen. In the prior year we recognised a charge of £245m in relation to this as well as fees in relation to the investigation of £15m.

During 2017/18 we have reassessed the prior year judgements and estimates we made as a result of the investigation into our Italian business. We concluded that the total adjustments recorded in 2016/17, either as part of the prior year revision or as a specific item, remain appropriate and thus no further adjustment is required. We identified offsetting movements in individual balance sheet line items which were not material either individually or in aggregate. These movements have been adjusted in the 2017/18 balance sheet.

Profit on disposal of businesses

During the year we disposed of non-core businesses with a gain on disposal of £1m (2016/17: £16m, 2015/16: £nil).

EE fair value adjustment

In 2015/16 we recognised a fair value adjustment on the acquisition of EE which reduced the amount of deferred income in relation to its prepaid subscriber base by £70m with no cash impact. The step down reflects the difference between the amount recorded by EE on acquisition and the fair value calculated based on the incremental cost that a market participant would incur to take on the liability plus a reasonable profit margin. This amount was released as a reduction to revenue in the period between acquisition and 31 March 2016, reflecting the period over which EE provided the related service.

Out of period irrecoverable VAT

In 2016/17, we recorded a charge of £30m for out of period irrecoverable VAT. We also recorded a further £1m related interest charge.

Interest expense on retirement benefit obligation

See note 20 for more details.

Tax credit on re-measurement of deferred tax

See note 9 for more details.

9. Taxation

Current and deferred income tax

LOGO What critical judgements and estimates do we make in accounting for taxation?

We seek to pay tax in accordance with the laws of the countries where we do business. However, in some areas these laws are unclear, and it can take many years to agree an outcome with a tax authority or through litigation. We estimate our tax on country-by-country and issue-by-issue bases. Our key uncertainties are whether EE’s tax losses will be available to us, whether our intra-group trading model will be accepted by a particular tax authority and whether intra-group payments are subject to withholding taxes. We provide for the most likely outcome where an outflow is probable, but the agreed amount can differ materially from our estimates. Approximately 80% by value of the provisions are under active tax authority examination and are therefore likely to be re-estimated or resolved in the coming 12 months. £240m (2016/17: £281m) is included in current tax liabilities in relation to these uncertainties.

Under a downside case an additional amount of £471m could be required, of which £382m would relate to EE losses. This amount is not provided as we don’t consider this outcome to be probable.

Deciding whether to recognise deferred tax assets is judgemental. We only recognise them when we consider it is probable that they can be recovered. In making this judgement we consider evidence such as historical financial performance, future financial plans and trends, the duration of existing customer contracts and whether our intra-group pricing model has been agreed by the relevant tax authority.

 

 
223     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

9. Taxation continued

The value of the group’s income tax assets and liabilities is disclosed on the Group balance sheet on page 203. The value of the group’s deferred tax assets and liabilities, including the deferred tax asset recognised in respect of EE Limited’s historical tax losses, is disclosed below.

Analysis of our taxation expense for the year

 

                                                              
Year ended 31 March    2018
£m
    2017
£m
    2016
£m
 

United Kingdom

      

Corporation tax at 19% (2016/17: 20%, 2015/16: 20%)

     (578     (555     (617

Adjustments in respect of earlier years

     37       33       59  

Non-UK taxation

      

Current

     (66     (109     (80

Adjustments in respect of earlier years

     23             29  

Total current tax expense

     (584     (631     (609

Deferred taxation

      

Origination and reversal of temporary differences

     46       96       70  

Adjustments in respect of earlier years

     (57     26       2  

Impact of change in UK corporation tax rate to 17% (2016/17: 17%, 2015/16: 19%)

           63       96  

Remeasurement of temporary differences

     11              

Total deferred taxation credit

           185       168  

Total taxation expense

     (584     (446     (441

Factors affecting our taxation expense for the year

The taxation expense on the profit for the year differs from the amount computed by applying the UK corporation tax rate to the profit before taxation as a result of the following factors:

 

                                                              
Year ended 31 March    2018
£m
    2017
£m
    2016
£m
 

Profit before taxation

     2,616       2,354       2,907  

Expected taxation expense at UK rate of 19% (2016/17: 20%, 2015/16: 20%)

     (497     (471     (581

Effects of:

      

(Higher) lower taxes on non-UK profits

     (8     (29     4  

Net permanent differences between tax and accountinga

     (100     (183     (12

Adjustments in respect of earlier yearsb

     3       59       90  

Prior year non-UK losses used against current year profits

     16       120       9  

Non-UK losses not recognisedc

     (9     (8     (34

Other deferred tax assets not recognised

                 6  

Lower taxes on profit on disposal of business

           3        

Re-measurement of deferred tax balances

     11       63       96  

Other non-recurring items

                 (19

Total taxation expense

     (584     (446     (441

Exclude specific items (note 8)

     (87     (217     (166

Total taxation expense before specific items

     (671     (663     (607

 

a  Includes income that is not taxable or UK income taxable at a different rate, and expenses for which no tax relief is received. Examples include some types of depreciation and amortisation and the benefit of R&D tax incentives.
b  Reflects the differences between initial accounting estimates and tax returns submitted to tax authorities, including the release and establishment of provisions for uncertain tax positions.
c  Reflects losses made in countries where it has not been considered appropriate to recognise a deferred tax asset, as future taxable profits are not probable.

 

 
224     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

9. Taxation continued    

Tax components of other comprehensive income    

 

                                                              
Year ended 31 March    2018
Tax credit
(expense)
£m
    2017
Tax credit
(expense)
£m
    2016
Tax credit
(expense)
£m
 

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to the income statement

      

Pension remeasurements

     (346     416       (240

Tax on items that have been or may be reclassified subsequently to the income statement

      

Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations

     (9     21       38  

Fair value movements on cash flow hedges

      

– net fair value gains or losses

     57       (131     (72

– recognised in income and expense

     (47     139       39  
       (345     445       (235

Current tax credita

     203       122       231  

Deferred tax (expense) credit

     (548     323       (466
       (345     445       (235

a  Includes £212m (2016/17: £110m, 2015/16: £217m) relating to cash contributions made to reduce retirement benefit obligations.

   

 

Tax (expense) credit recognised directly in equity

 

 

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

   

2016

£m

 

Tax (expense) credit relating to share-based payments

     (2     (6     12  

Deferred taxation

 

                                                                                                                      
      


Fixed asset
temporary
differences
£m
 
 
 
 
   

Retirement
benefit
obligations

£m

 
 
 a 

 

   


Share-
based

payments
£m

 
 

 
 

   

Tax
losses
£m
 
 
 
   
Other
£m
 
 
   

Jurisdictional
offset

£m

 
 

 

   

Total

£m

 

 

At 1 April 2016

     1,618       (1,149     (54     (325     (75           15  

(Credit) expense recognised in the income statement

     (181     (82     14       65       (1           (185

(Credit) expense recognised in other comprehensive income

     (5     (306           (3     (9           (323

Expense recognised in equity

                 23                         23  

Exchange differences

                       (7                 (7

At 31 March 2017

     1,432       (1,537     (17     (270     (85           (477

Non-current

              

Deferred tax asset

     (117     (1,537     (17     (270     (96     320       (1,717

Deferred tax liability

     1,549                         11       (320     1,240  

At 1 April 2017

     1,432       (1,537     (17     (270     (85           (477

Expense (credit) recognised in the income statement

     11       (104     4       89                    

Expense (credit) recognised in other comprehensive income

           558                   (10           548  

Expense recognised in equity

                 6                         6  

Exchange differences

                       (2     5             3  

Transfer to current tax

     17                                     17  

At 31 March 2018

     1,460       (1,083     (7     (183     (90           97  

Non-current

              

Deferred tax asset

     (41     (1,083     (7     (183     (90     161       (1,243

Deferred tax liability

     1,501                               (161     1,340  

At 31 March 2018

     1,460       (1,083     (7     (183     (90           97  

 

a  Includes a deferred tax asset of £2m (2016/17: £2m) arising on contributions payable to defined contribution pension plans.

The majority of the deferred tax assets and liabilities noted above are anticipated to be realised after more than 12 months.

We’ve recognised a deferred tax asset at 31 March 2018 of £92m in respect of EE Limited’s historical tax losses. We expect to be able to utilise these against future taxable profits in EE Limited. If EE Limited’s business had been subject to a major change in the nature or conduct of trade on or before 5 February 2018, these losses would have been forfeited and a current tax liability of £382m would have been created. We do not consider it probable that major change arose.

Deferred tax balances for which there is a right of offset within the same jurisdiction are presented net on the face of the group balance sheet as permitted by IAS 12, with the exception of deferred tax related to our pension schemes which is disclosed within deferred tax assets.

 

 
225     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

9. Taxation continued

What factors affect our future tax charges?

The rate of UK corporation tax will change from 19% to 17% on 1 April 2020. As deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the rates that are expected to apply in the periods of the reversal, deferred tax balances at 31 March 2018 have been calculated at the rate at which the relevant balance is expected to be recovered or settled. The impact of the reduction in rate was recognised as a deferred tax credit specific item of £63m in the 2016/17 income statement and as a deferred tax expense in reserves.

What are our unrecognised tax losses and other temporary differences?

At 31 March 2018 we had operating losses and other temporary differences carried forward in respect of which no deferred tax assets were recognised amounting to £4.1bn (2016/17: £4.5bn). Our other temporary differences have no expiry date restrictions. The expiry date of operating losses carried forward is dependent upon the tax law of the various territories in which the losses arose. A summary of expiry dates for losses in respect of which restrictions apply is set out below:

 

                                         
At 31 March 2018    £m      Expiry  

Restricted losses

     

Europe

     14        2019–2027  

Americas

     204        2019–2037  

Other

     2        2019–2027  

Total restricted losses

     220           

Unrestricted operating losses

     3,784        No expiry  

Other temporary differences

     77        No expiry  

Total

     4,081           

At 31 March 2018 we had UK capital losses carried forward in respect of which no deferred tax assets were recognised amounting to £16.9bn (2016/17: £17.0bn). These losses have no expiry date, but we consider the future utilisation of these losses to be remote.

At 31 March 2018 the undistributed earnings of non-UK subsidiaries were £2.4bn (2016/17: £3.5bn). No deferred tax liabilities have been recognised in respect of these unremitted earnings because the group is in a position to control the timing of any dividends from subsidiaries and hence any tax consequences that may arise. Under current tax rules, tax of £23.0m (2016/17: £26.2m) would arise if these earnings were to be repatriated to the UK. On 29 March 2017, the UK Government notified the EU of its intention to withdraw membership from the EU. Depending on the outcome of negotiations we could cease to benefit from the EU Parent Subsidiary directive on dividends paid by our EU subsidiaries. In this event, additional tax of up to £23.9m could arise if the undistributed earnings of EU subsidiaries of £940m were to be repatriated to the UK.

10. Earnings per share

How are earnings per share calculated?

Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the profit after tax attributable to equity shareholders by the weighted average number of shares in issue after deducting the own shares held by employee share ownership trusts and treasury shares.

In calculating the diluted earnings per share, share options outstanding and other potential shares have been taken into account where the impact of these is dilutive. Options over 23m shares (2016/17: 27m shares, 2015/16: 15m shares) were excluded from the calculation of the total diluted number of shares as the impact of these is antidilutive.

 

                                                              
Year ended 31 March    2018      2017      2016  

Basic weighted average number of shares (millions)

     9,911        9,938        8,619  

Dilutive shares from share options (millions)

     2        27        58  

Dilutive shares from executive share awards (millions)

     48        29        37  

Diluted weighted average number of shares (millions)

     9,961        9,994        8,714  

Basic earnings per share

     20.5p        19.2p        28.5p  

Diluted earnings per share

     20.4p        19.1p        28.2p  

The earnings per share calculations are based on profit after tax attributable to equity shareholders of the parent company which excludes non-controlling interests. Profit after tax was £2,032m (2016/17: £1,908m, 2015/16: £2,466m) and profit after tax attributable to non-controlling interests was £4m (2016/17: £1m, 2015/16: £7m). Profit attributable to non-controlling interests is not presented separately in the financial statements as it is not material.

 

 
226     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

11. Dividends

What dividends have been paid and proposed for the year?

The Board recommends that a final dividend in respect of the year ended 31 March 2018 of 10.55p per share will be paid to shareholders on 3 September 2018, taking the full year proposed dividend per share in respect of 2017/18 to 15.4p (2016/17: 15.4p, 2015/16: 14.0p) which amounts to approximately £1,524m (2016/17: £1,532m, 2015/16: £1,324m). This final dividend is subject to approval by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting and therefore the liability of approximately £1,044m (2016/17: £1,050m, 2015/16: £954m) has not been included in these financial statements. The proposed dividend will be payable to all shareholders on the Register of Members on 10 August 2018.

The value of £1,524m (2016/17: £1,436m, 2015/16: £1,078m) for the final and interim dividends is disclosed in our statement of changes in equity. This value may differ from the amount shown for equity dividends paid in the group cash flow statement, which represents the actual cash paid in relation to dividend cheques that have been presented over the course of the financial year.

 

     2018           2017           2016  
Year ended 31 March    pence
per share
     £m            pence
per share
     £m            pence
per share
     £m  

Final dividend in respect of the prior year

     10.55        1,044           9.60        954           8.50        710  

Interim dividend in respect of the current year

     4.85        480             4.85        482             4.40        368  
           15.40              1,524                   14.45              1,436                   12.90              1,078  

12. Intangible assets    

 

                                                                                                     
      Goodwill
£m
    Customer
relationships
and brands
£m
    Telecoms
licences
and other
£m
    Internally
developed
software
£m
    Purchased
software
£m
    Total
£m
 

Cost

            

At 1 April 2016

     7,907       3,401       2,930       4,073       1,610       19,921  

Acquisitions

     5                               5  

Additions

                       483       138       621  

Disposals and adjustmentsa

     (23                 (131     2       (152

Transfers

                       (66     62       (4

Exchange differences

     145       21       15       4       41       226  

At 31 March 2017

     8,034       3,422       2,945       4,363       1,853       20,617  

Additions

                       517       125       642  

Acquisitions

     14             3                   17  

Disposals and adjustmentsa

     (3           (3     (55     (413     (474

Exchange differences

     (100     (12     6       (3     9       (100

At 31 March 2018

     7,945       3,410       2,951       4,822       1,574       20,702  

Accumulated amortisation

            

At 1 April 2016

           418       131       2,747       1,175       4,471  

Charge for the yearb

           383       140       556       101       1,180  

Disposals and adjustmentsa

                       (114     (7     (121

Exchange differences

           12       9       4       33       58  

At 31 March 2017

           813       280       3,193       1,302       5,588  

Charge for the yearb

           379       141       525       78       1,123  

Disposals and adjustmentsa

                 (3     (36     (426     (465

Exchange differences

           (1     3       (2     9       9  

At 31 March 2018

           1,191       421       3,680       963       6,255  
                                                  

Carrying amount

            

At 31 March 2018

     7,945       2,219       2,530       1,142       611       14,447  

At 31 March 2017

     8,034       2,609       2,665       1,170       551       15,029  

 

a  Fully depreciated assets in the group’s fixed asset registers were reviewed during the year, as part of the group’s annual asset verification exercise, and certain assets that were no longer in use have been written off, reducing cost and accumulated depreciation by £0.4bn (2016/17: £nil).
b  Includes a £nil (2016/17: £62m) specific item amortisation charge relating to the write-off of internally developed software as we integrate the EE and BT IT infrastructure.

 

 
227     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

12. Intangible assets continued

Goodwill

Goodwill recognised in a business combination does not generate cash flows independently of other assets or groups of assets. As a result, the recoverable amount, being the value in use, is determined at a cash generating unit (CGU) level.

LOGO How do we determine our CGUs?

The determination of our CGUs is judgemental. The identification of CGUs involves an assessment of whether the asset or group of assets generate largely independent cash inflows. This involves consideration of how our core assets are operated and whether these generate independent revenue streams. Our CGUs are deemed to be BT Consumer, EE, Business and Public Sector, Global Services and Wholesale and Ventures which are the same units we report in our segmental reporting.

For impairment purposes goodwill is tested at the lowest level within the entity at which the goodwill is monitored for internal management purposes, and cannot be larger than our operating segments. We test goodwill at the CGU level.

LOGO What critical estimates and assumptions have we made?

In 2016/17 we re-allocated goodwill among our CGUs based on the relative fair value of the business transferred to reflect our new customer-facing units structure effective as of 1 April 2016. We estimated the relative fair values on a discounted cash flow basis using the three-year financial plans effective at the time of the re-organisation. The assumptions used were set in the same way as those used in our value in use calculations as set out below.

Our value in use calculations require estimates in relation to uncertain items, including management’s expectations of future revenue growth, operating costs, profit margins, operating cash flows, and the discount rate for each CGU.

Future cash flows used in the value in use calculations are based on our latest Board approved five-year financial plans. Expectations about future growth reflect the expectations of growth in the markets to which the CGU relates. The future cash flows are discounted using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money. The discount rate used in each CGU is adjusted for the risk specific to the asset, including the countries in which cash flow will be generated, for which the future cash flow estimates have not been adjusted.

The group is required to test goodwill acquired in a business combination annually for impairment. This was carried out as at 31 January 2018. The carrying value of goodwill and the key assumptions used in performing the annual impairment assessment and sensitivities are disclosed below.

How have we carried out our goodwill impairment review?

We perform an annual goodwill impairment review, based on our CGUs.

These CGUs represent the smallest identifiable groups of assets that generate cash inflows that are largely independent of the cash inflows from other groups of assets, and to which goodwill is allocated. From 1 April 2016, we re-organised our customer-facing units resulting in the change of the CGUs that have associated goodwill. We allocated goodwill to BT Consumer, EE, Business and Public Sector, Global Services and Wholesale and Ventures. Previously no goodwill was allocated to Wholesale and Ventures. In addition to goodwill being allocated to this CGU for the first time, there were changes to the amount allocated to the other CGUs as a result of the re-organisation. Goodwill is allocated to these CGUs as follows:

 

                                                                                                                 
  Cost    BT
Consumer
£m
    

EE

£m

   

Business
and Public
Sector

£m

    Global
Services
£m
    Wholesale
and Ventures
£m
     Total
£m
 

At 1 April 2016

     1,183        4,917       662       1,145              7,907  

Re-organisation

            (2,149     1,921       (709     937         

Exchange differences

                  10       135              145  

Acquisitions and disposals

                  (23           5        (18

At 31 March 2017

     1,183        2,768       2,570       571       942        8,034  

Exchange differences

                  (8     (92            (100

Acquisitions and disposals

                        11              11  

At 31 March 2018

     1,183        2,768       2,562       490       942        7,945  

How do we calculate the recoverable amount?

The value in use of each CGU is determined using cash flow projections derived from financial plans approved by the Board covering a five-year period. They reflect management’s expectations of revenue, EBITDA growth, capital expenditure, working capital and operating cash flows, based on past experience and future expectations of business performance. Cash flows beyond the fifth year have been extrapolated using perpetuity growth rates.

 

 
228     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

12. Intangible assets continued

What discount rate have we used?

The pre-tax discount rates applied to the cash flow forecasts are derived from our post-tax weighted average cost of capital. The assumptions used in the calculation of the group’s weighted average cost of capital are benchmarked to externally available data. The pre-tax discount rate used in performing the value in use calculation in 2017/18 was 8.4% (2016/17: 8.6%). We’ve used the same discount rate for all CGUs except Global Services where we have used 8.8% (2016/17: 9.0%) reflecting higher risk in some of the countries in which Global Services operates.

What growth rates have we used?

The perpetuity growth rates are determined based on the forecast market growth rates of the regions in which the CGU operates, and they reflect an assessment of the long-term growth prospects of that market. The growth rates have been benchmarked against external data for the relevant markets. None of the growth rates applied exceed the expected long-term average growth rates for those markets or sectors. The perpetuity growth rate for Global Services was 2.3% (2016/17: 2.4%) and 2.0% (2016/17: 2.0%) for Business and Public Sector, BT Consumer, EE and Wholesale and Ventures.

What sensitivities have we applied?

There is significant headroom in Business and Public Sector, BT Consumer, Wholesale and Ventures and EE. No reasonably possible changes in the key assumptions would cause the carrying amount of the CGUs to exceed the recoverable amount. For Global Services, the value in use exceeds the carrying value of the CGU by approximately £776m (2016/17: £594m). Any of the following changes in assumptions in isolation would cause the recoverable amount for the CGU to equal its carrying amount:

  reduction in the perpetuity growth rate from the 2.3% assumption applied to a revised assumption of a decline of 1.4%.
  an increase in the discount rate from the 8.8% assumption applied to a revised assumption of 11.5%.
  shortfalls in trading performance against forecast resulting in operating cash flows decreasing by 34% each year and in perpetuity.

 

 
229     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

13. Property, plant and equipment

The plant and equipment in our networks is long-lived with cables and switching equipment operating for over ten years and underground ducts being used for decades. We also develop software for use in IT systems and platforms that support the products and services provided to our customers.

The carrying values of software, property, plant and equipment are disclosed below and in note 12. The useful lives applied to the principal categories of assets are disclosed on page 211.

 

                                                                                              
      

Land and
buildings
£m
 
 a 
 
   

Network
infrastructure

£m

 
 a 

 

   

Other

£m

 b 

 

   


Assets in
course of
construction
£m
 
 
 
 
   
Total
£m
 
 

Cost

          

At 31 March 2016

     1,278       48,194       1,870       1,108       52,450  

Additionsc

     6       40       128       2,672       2,846  

Transfers

     14       2,393       (1     (2,402     4  

Disposals and adjustmentsd

     (45     (1,637     (106     30       (1,758

Exchange differences

     49       382       47       5       483  

At 31 March 2017

     1,302       49,372       1,938       1,413       54,025  

Additionsc

     12       193       92       2,597       2,894  

Transfers

     36       2,793       16       (2,845      

Disposals and adjustmentsd

     (82     (1,540     (119     (48     (1,789

Exchange differences

     (6     (35     (13     1       (53

At 31 March 2018

     1,262       50,783       1,914       1,118       55,077  

Accumulated depreciation

          

At 31 March 2016

     750       34,287       1,513             36,550  

Charge for the year

     64       2,224       104             2,392  

Disposals and adjustmentsd

     (36     (1,627     (104           (1,767

Exchange differences

     39       330       41             410  

At 31 March 2017

     817       35,214       1,554             37,585  

Charge for the year

     57       2,213       121             2,391  

Disposals and adjustmentsd

     (96     (1,613     (107           (1,816

Exchange differences

     (5     (24     (10           (39

At 31 March 2018

     773       35,790       1,558             38,121  
                                          

Carrying amount

          

At 31 March 2018

     489       14,993       356       1,118       16,956  

Engineering stores

                       44       44  

Total at 31 March 2018

     489       14,993       356       1,162       17,000  

At 31 March 2017

     485       14,158       384       1,413       16,440  

Engineering stores

                       58       58  

Total at 31 March 2017

     485       14,158       384       1,471       16,498  

 

a  The carrying amount of the group’s property, plant and equipment includes an amount of £53m (2016/17: £73m) in respect of assets held under finance leases, comprising land and buildings of £42m (2016/17: £45m) and network infrastructure of £11m (2016/17: £28m). The depreciation expense on those assets in 2017/18 was £10m (2016/17: £10m), comprising land and buildings of £3m (2016/17: £3m) and network infrastructure of £7m (2016/17: £7m).
b  Other mainly comprises motor vehicles, computers and fixtures and fittings.
c  Net of grant funding of £74m (2016/17: £28m net grant deferral).
d  Fully depreciated assets in the group’s fixed asset registers were reviewed during the year, as part of the group’s annual asset verification exercise, and certain assets that were no longer in use have been written off, reducing cost and accumulated depreciation by £1.3bn (2016/17: £1.1bn).

 

 
230     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

13. Property, plant and equipment continued

 

At 31 March   

                    2018

£m

    

                    2017

£m

 

The carrying amount of land and buildings, including leasehold improvements, comprised:

     

Freehold

     261        269  

Leasehold

     228        216  

Total land and buildings

     489        485  

Network infrastructure

Some of our network assets are jointly controlled by EE Limited with Hutchison 3G UK Limited. These relate to shared 3G network and certain elements of network for 4G rural sites. The net book value of the group’s share of assets controlled by its joint operation MBNL is £526m (2016/17: £591m) and is recorded within network infrastructure. Included within this is £132m (2016/17: £179m), being the group’s share of assets owned by its joint operation MBNL.

Within network infrastructure are assets with a net book value of £8.3bn (2016/17: £8.0bn) which have useful economic lives of more than 18 years.

LOGO What estimates and critical judgements have we made in accounting for our BDUK contracts?

The group receives government grants in relation to the BDUK programme and other rural superfast broadband contracts. Where we’ve achieved certain service levels, or delivered the network more efficiently than anticipated, we’ve an obligation to either re-invest or repay grant funding. Where this is the case, we assess and defer the income with a corresponding increase in capital expenditure. Assessing the timing of whether and when we change the estimated take-up assumption is judgemental as it involves considering information which is not always observable. Our consideration on whether and when to change the base case assumption is dependent on our expectation of the long-term take-up trend.

Our assessment of how much grant income to defer includes consideration of the difference between the take-up percentage agreed with the local authority and the likelihood of actual take-up. The value of the government grants deferred is disclosed in note 18.

In the current year we had a net grant funding of £74m (2016/17: £28m net grant deferral) mainly related to our activity on the BDUK programme. Our base case assumption for take-up in BDUK areas has been increased to 41% (2016/17: 39%) following our review of the level of customer take-up. Based on the current build, a change in the take-up assumption of 4% would result in approximately a £50m movement in the amount deferred. To date we have a grant funding liability of £536m (2016/17: £446m).

14. Business combinations

All business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method regardless of whether equity instruments or other assets are acquired. We didn’t make any material acquisitions in the year ended 31 March 2018 (2016/17: no material acquisitions). The acquisition of EE was completed in 2015/16 with the provisional acquisition accounting at 31 March 2016 and the final acquisition accounting was reflected during 2016/17.

15. Programme rights

 

     

Total

£m

 

At 1 April 2016

     225  

Additions

     753  

Amortisation

     (714

At 1 April 2017

     264  

Additions

     771  

Amortisation

     (763

At 31 March 2018

                     272  

Additions reflect TV programme rights for which the legally enforceable licence period has started during the year. Payments made for programme rights for which the legally enforceable licence period has not yet started are included within prepayments (see note 17).

TV programme rights commitments are disclosed in note 30.

 

 
231     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

16. Inventories

 

At 31 March   

                2018

£m

    

                2017

£m

    

                2016

£m

 

Consumables

     22        24        26  

Work in progress

     6        23        11  

Finished goods

     211        180        152  
       239        227        189  

Inventories recognised as an expense during the year ended 31 March 2018 amounted to £2,588m (2016/17: £2,680m). These were included in ‘Other operating costs’ in note 5.

17. Trade and other receivables

We’ve made various judgements in accounting for trade and other receivables. These include long-term contracts and bad debt provisions.

Long-term customer contracts

Long-term customer contracts can extend over a number of financial years. During the contractual period recognition of costs and profits may be impacted by judgements and estimates made.

LOGO What critical estimates and assumptions have we made?

Estimates are required in assessing the lifetime profitability of a contract when determining whether we have an onerous contract liability. Where we have an onerous contract liability this would be classified in provisions and include an impairment of any receivables relating to these contracts.

The level of uncertainty in the estimates and assumptions supporting expected future revenues and costs can vary with the complexity of each contract and with the form of service delivery.

We’ve exercised judgement in assessing when the transition or transformation phase of a contract ends. This influences the timing of recognition of revenue and costs which are deferred until the transition or transformation phase ends unless these elements of a contract have standalone value.

How do we estimate and recognise contract losses?

We estimate and recognise immediately the entire estimated loss for a contract when we have evidence that the contract is unprofitable. Also if these estimates indicate that any contract will be less profitable than previously forecast, contract assets may have to be written down to the extent they are no longer considered to be fully recoverable. We perform ongoing profitability reviews of our contracts in order to determine whether the latest estimates are appropriate. Key factors reviewed include:

Transaction volumes or other inputs affecting future revenues which can vary depending on customer requirements, plans, market position and other factors such as general economic conditions.
Our ability to achieve key contract milestones connected with the transition, development, transformation and deployment phases for customer contracts.
The status of commercial relations with customers and the implication for future revenue and cost projections.
Our estimates of future staff and third-party costs and the degree to which cost savings and efficiencies are deliverable.

The carrying value of assets comprising the costs of the initial set-up, transition or transformation phase of long-term networked IT services contracts is disclosed below.

 

At 31 March   

                2018

£m

    

                2017

£m

    

                2016

£m

 

Non-current

        

Other assetsa

     317        360        218  

 

a  Other assets includes costs relating to the initial set-up, transition or transformation phase of long-term networked IT services contracts of £145m (2016/17: £163m, 2015/16: £111m), and prepayments and leasing debtors of £172m (2016/17: £197m, 2015/16: £107m).

 

At 31 March   

                2018

£m

    

                2017

£m

    

                2016

£m

 

Current

        

Trade receivables

     1,741        1,774        1,803  

Prepaymentsa

     1,103        733        702  

Accrued income

     777        955        1,072  

Other receivablesb

     393        373        401  
       4,014        3,835        3,978  

 

a  Prepayments includes £325m (2016/17: £nil, 2015/16: £nil) in respect of the acquisition of spectrum in April 2018. The spectrum auction bidding cut across the 2017/18 and 2018/19 financial years. Whilst £325m was on deposit with Ofcom at 31 March 2018, we went on to win spectrum for a total price of £304m and the excess deposit balance has since been refunded. This will be transferred to intangible assets in 2018/19.
b  Other receivables includes assets held for sale of £nil (2016/17: £22m, 2015/16: £nil).

 

 
232     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

17. Trade and other receivables continued

Trade receivables are stated after deducting allowances for doubtful debts, as follows:

 

     

                2018

£m

   

                2017

£m

   

                2016

£m

 

At 1 April

     303       195       196  

Expense

     129       211       77  

Utilised

     (61     (114     (89

Exchange differences

     4       11       11  

At 31 March

     375       303       195  

Included within the 2016/17 expense above are amounts for exposures relating to the Italian business investigation, as set out in note 8.

How do we assess recoverability of our receivables?

We provide services to consumer and business customers, mainly on credit terms. We know that certain debts due to us will not be paid through the default of a small number of our customers. Judgements are required in assessing the recoverability of trade receivables and whether a provision for doubtful debts may be required.

In estimating a provision for doubtful debts we consider historical experience alongside other factors such as the current state of the economy and particular industry issues. The value of the provision for doubtful debts is disclosed above.

Trade receivables are continuously monitored and allowances applied against trade receivables consist of both specific impairments and collective impairments based on our historical loss experiences for the relevant aged category as well as taking into account general economic conditions. Historical loss experience allowances are calculated by a customer-facing unit in order to reflect the specific nature of the customers relevant to that customer-facing unit.

Trade and other receivables are classified as loans and receivables and are held at amortised cost. The carrying amount of these balances approximates to fair value due to the short maturity of amounts receivable.

Note 27 provides further disclosure regarding the credit quality of our gross trade receivables. Trade receivables are due as follows:

 

                   Past due and not specifically impaired         
At 31 March   

Not past due

£m

    

Trade

receivables

specifically

  impaired net

of provision

£m

    

  Between

0 and 3

months

£m

    

  Between

3 and 6

months

£m

    

  Between

6 and 12

months

£m

    

  Over 12

months

£m

    

Total

£m

 

2018

     1,251        61        293        44        25        67           1,741  

2017

     1,184        146        292        17        41        94        1,774  

2016

     1,152        98        368        51        44        90        1,803  

Gross trade receivables which have been specifically impaired amounted to £124m (2016/17: £238m, 2015/16: £192m).

Trade receivables not past due and accrued income are analysed below by customer-facing unit.

 

     Trade receivables not past due             Accrued income  
At 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

            

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

BT Consumer

     157        128        138           86        90        83  

EE

     206        335        267           122        170        312  

Business and Public Sector

     253        200        115           134        151        146  

Global Services

     477        444        555           222        297        351  

Wholesale and Ventures

     92        75        76           145        167        99  

Openreach

     61        1        1           67        78        79  

Other

     5        1                        1        2        2  

Total

          1,251             1,184             1,152                        777               955             1,072  

Given the broad and varied nature of our customer base, the analysis of trade receivables not past due and accrued income by customer-facing unit is considered the most appropriate disclosure of credit concentrations. Cash collateral held against trade and other receivables amounted to £6m (2016/17: £4m, 2015/16: £4m).

 

 
233     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

18. Trade and other payables

 

At 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

Current

        

Trade payables

     3,991        4,205        4,331  

Other taxation and social security

     704        704        682  

Other payables

     456        672        552  

Accrued expenses

     492        382        418  

Deferred incomea

     1,525        1,474        1,435  
       7,168        7,437        7,418  
At 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

Non-current

        

Other payablesb

     871        885        876  

Deferred incomea

     455        413        230  
               1,326                    1,298                    1,106  

 

a Includes £132m (2016/17: £71m, 2015/16: £71m) current and £404m (2016/17: £375m, 2015/16: £187m) non-current liabilities relating to the Broadband Delivery UK programme, for which grants received by the group may be subject to re-investment or repayment depending on the level of take-up.
b Other payables relate to operating lease liabilities and deferred gains on a 2001 sale and finance leaseback transaction.

19. Provisions

Provisions and contingent liabilities

As disclosed below, our provisions principally relate to obligations arising from property rationalisation programmes, restructuring programmes, asset retirement obligations, network assets, insurance claims, litigation and regulatory risks.

LOGO What critical judgements have we made in accounting for provisions?

We exercise judgement in determining the timing and quantum of all provisions to be recognised. Our assessment includes consideration of whether we have a present obligation, whether payment is probable and if so whether the amount can be estimated reliably. As part of this assessment, we also assess the likelihood of contingent liabilities occurring in the future which are not recognised as liabilities on our balance sheet. By their nature, contingencies will be resolved only when one or more uncertain future events occur or fail to occur. We assess the likelihood that a potential claim or liability will arise and also quantify the possible range of financial outcomes where this can be reasonably determined. We’ve disclosed our assessment of contingent liabilities in note 30.

LOGO What other critical estimates and assumptions have we made?

Restructuring programmes involve estimation of the direct cost necessary for the restructuring and exclude items that are associated with ongoing activities. The amounts below exclude restructuring costs for which the timing and amount are certain. These are recognised as part of trade and other payables.

Under our property rationalisation programmes we’ve identified a number of surplus properties. Although efforts are being made to sublet this space, this is not always possible. Estimates have been made of the cost of vacant possession and of any shortfall arising from any potential sub-lease income being lower than the lease costs. Any such shortfall is recognised as a provision.

Asset retirement obligations involve an estimate of the cost to dismantle equipment and restore sites upon vacation and the timing of the event. The provision represents the group’s best estimate of the amount that may be required to settle the obligation.

Network asset provisions represent our future operational costs and vacant site rentals arising from obligations relating to network share agreements. Costs are expected to be incurred over a period of up to 20 years.

Our regulatory provision represents our best estimate of the cost to settle our present obligation in relation to historical regulatory matters. The charge for the year represents the outcome of management’s re-assessment of the estimates and regulatory risks across a range of issues, including price and service issues. The prices at which certain services are charged are regulated and may be subject to retrospective adjustment by regulators. Estimates are used in assessing the likely value of the regulatory risk.

In 2016/17 we recognised a £300m charge in relation to estimated Deemed Consent compensation payments. The precise amount of the compensation payments will result from discussions with the affected parties and as of 31 March 2018, we still consider this estimate to be appropriate. In 2016/17 a related fine of £42m was imposed and was recognised as a payable rather than as a provision. The fine and associated compensation payments totalling £342m were treated as a specific item charge in last year’s income statement. The remaining provision increases also reflected management’s estimates of regulatory risks across a range of issues, including price and service issues. These increased by £51m (2016/17: £126m), also treated as specific items, resulting from our reassessment of these other regulatory risks and in light of the regulatory decisions by Ofcom.

 

 
234     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

19. Provisions continued

In respect of claims, litigation and regulatory risks, the group provides for anticipated costs where an outflow of resources is considered probable and a reasonable estimate can be made of the likely outcome.

Included within Other are contract loss provisions of £38m (2016/17 £29m) relating to the anticipated total losses in respect of certain contracts. It is expected that the majority of these provisions will be utilised in the next few years. Given the short period remaining to the finalisation of these contracts, any potential future changes to key assumptions made when estimating their future losses are not expected to have a significant impact. There is no single change in key variables that could materially affect future expected losses on these contracts. Also included in Other are amounts provided for constructive obligations arising from insurance claims which will be utilised as the obligations are settled and amounts provided for exposures relating to the Italian business investigation, principally potential tax penalties.

For all risks, the ultimate liability may vary from the amounts provided and will be dependent upon the eventual outcome of any settlement. The estimates are discounted using a rate that reflects the passage of time and risk specific to the liability. An estimate is also required in assessing the timing of when a provision is recognised. The outcome of our estimate of the provisions is disclosed below.

 

    

 

  Restructuring

£m

 a 

 

 

 

  Property

£m

 

 

   

    Network

ARO

£m

 

 

 

   

    Network

share

£m

 

 

 

 

 

      Regulatory

£m

 

 

 

 

  Litigation

£m

 

 

 

 

        Other

£m

 

 

 

 

        Total

£m

 

 

At 31 March 2016

     20       296       78       60       64       73       152       743  

Income statement expense

           38       27       5       426       6       34       536  

Unwind of discount

           12       2       2                         16  

Utilised or released

     (10     (54     (24     (17     (11     (11     (8     (135

Transfers

                                         (3     (3

Exchange differences

     1                               1       2       4  

At 31 March 2017

     11       292       83       50       479       69       177       1,161  

Income statement expense

     4       37       2             51       6       33       133  

Unwind of discount

           11       2       2                         15  

Utilised or released

     (2     (46     (16     (19     (210     (11     (32     (336

Transfers

                                         85       85  

Exchange differences

     (1                                   (2     (3

At 31 March 2018

     12       294       71       33       320       64       261       1,055  

 

a Restructuring costs for which the timing and amount are certain are reflected in trade and other payables.

 

At 31 March

  

              2018

£m

    

              2017

£m

    

              2016

£m

 

Analysed as:

        

Current

     603        625        178  

Non-current

     452        536        565  
       1,055        1,161        743  

20. Retirement benefit plans

Background to BT’s pension plans

The group has both defined benefit and defined contribution retirement benefit plans. The group’s main plans are in the UK and the largest by membership is the BT Pension Scheme (BTPS) which is a defined benefit plan that was closed to new entrants on 31 March 2001. After that date new entrants to BT in the UK have been able to join a defined contribution plan, currently the BT Retirement Saving Scheme (BTRSS), a contract-based arrangement.

In March 2018, BT announced the closure of Sections B and C of the BTPS to future benefit accrual (which represents over 99% of the BTPS active membership), having reached agreement with the relevant Unions. BT currently expects to close the BTPS from 30 June 2018 when employees will join the BTRSS for future pension accrual.

 

 
235     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

EE operates the EE Pension Scheme (EEPS), which has a defined benefit section that was closed to future benefit accrual in 2014 and a defined contribution section which is open to new joiners.

 

     What are they?   How do they impact BT’s financial statements?

Defined contribution plans 

 

Benefits in a defined contribution plan are linked to:

– contributions paid

– the performance of each individual’s chosen investments

– the form in which individuals choose to take their benefits.

 

Contributions are paid into an independently administered fund.

 

The income statement charge in respect of defined contribution plans represents the contribution payable by the group based upon a fixed percentage of employees’ pay.

 

The group has no exposure to investment and other experience risks.

Defined benefit plans

 

Benefits in a defined benefit plan are:

– determined by the plan rules, dependent on factors such as age, years of service and pensionable pay

– not dependent upon actual contributions made by the company or members.

 

The income statement service cost in respect of defined benefit plans represents the increase in the defined benefit liability arising from pension benefits earned by active members in the current period.

 

The group is exposed to investment and other experience risks and may need to make additional contributions where it is estimated that the benefits will not be met from regular contributions, expected investment income and assets held.

Amounts in the financial statements

Group income statement

The expense or income arising from all group retirement benefit arrangements recognised in the group income statement is shown below.

 

Year ended 31 March

  

              2018

£m

   

            2017

£m

    

              2016

£m

 

Recognised in the income statement before specific items

       

Service cost (including administration expenses & PPF levy):

       

– defined benefit plans

     376       281        301  

– defined contribution plans

     265       240        193  

Past service credita

     (17             

Total operating expense

     624       521        494  

Net interest expense on pensions deficit included in specific items (note 8)

     218       209        221  

Total recognised in the income statement

     842       730        715  

 

a  Past service credit relates to pension plans operating outside the UK.

Group statement of comprehensive income

Remeasurements of the net pension obligation are recognised in full in the group statement of comprehensive income in the year in which they arise. These comprise the impact on the defined benefit obligation of changes in demographic and financial assumptions compared with the start of the year, actual experience being different to those assumptions and the return on plan assets being above or below the amount included in the net pension interest expense.

Group balance sheet

The net pension obligation in respect of defined benefit plans reported in the group balance sheet is set out below.

 

     2018            2017  
At 31 March   

Assets

£m

    

 Present value

of liabilities

£m

   

Deficit

£m

           

Assets

£m

    

 Present value

of liabilities

£m

   

Deficit

£m

 

BTPS

     49,894        (55,783     (5,889        50,090        (58,649     (8,559

EEPS

     763        (920     (157        748        (973     (225

Other plansa

     299        (624     (325              274        (578     (304

Retirement benefit obligation

      50,956        (57,327     (6,371         51,112        (60,200     (9,088

Adjustments due to effect of asset ceiling (IFRIC 14)

                         

Deferred tax asset

                            1,081                                       1,535  

Net pension obligation

                      (5,290                               (7,553

 

a  Included in the present value of obligations of other plans is £97m (2016/17: £104m) related to unfunded pension arrangements.

 

 
236     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

Included within trade and other payables in the group balance sheet is £17m (2016/17: £15m) in respect of contributions payable to defined contribution plans.

What is IFRIC 14 and how does it impact BT?

For some pension schemes, IFRIC 14 potentially:

limits the amount of accounting surplus in a pension scheme that can be recognised as an asset on the balance sheet; and/or
requires additional pension liabilities to be recognised where scheduled future deficit contributions are greater than the unadjusted accounting deficit.

BT is not required to limit any pensions surplus or recognise additional pensions liabilities in individual plans as economic benefits are available in the form of either future refunds or reductions to future contributions.

This is on the basis that paragraph 11(b) of IFRIC 14 applies enabling a refund of surplus following the gradual settlement of the liabilities over time until there are no members remaining in the scheme.

Movements in defined benefit plan assets and liabilities

The table below shows the movements on the pension assets and liabilities and shows where they are reflected in the financial statements.

 

     

Assets

£m

   

Liabilities

£m

   

Deficit

£m

 

At 31 March 2016

     43,968       (50,350     (6,382

Service cost (including administration expenses and PPF levy)

     (44     (237     (281

Interest on pension deficit

     1,413       (1,622     (209

Included in the group income statement

                     (490

Return on plan assets above the amount included in the group income statement

     7,475             7,475  

Actuarial loss arising from changes in financial assumptionsa

           (10,221     (10,221

Actuarial loss arising from changes in demographic assumptionsa

           (206     (206

Actuarial gain arising from experience adjustmentsb

           163       163  

Included in the group statement of comprehensive income

                     (2,789

Regular contributions by employer

     313             313  

Deficit contributions by employer

     274             274  

Included in the group cash flow statement

                     587  

Contributions by employees

     8       (8      

Benefits paid

     (2,315     2,315        

Foreign exchange

     20       (34     (14

Other movements

                     (14

At 31 March 2017

           51,112                 (60,200                 (9,088

Service cost (including administration expenses and PPF levy)

     (67     (309     (376

Past service credit

           17       17  

Interest on pension deficit

     1,201       (1,419     (218

Included in the group income statement

                     (577

Return on plan assets above the amount included in the group income statement

     10             10  

Actuarial gain arising from changes in financial assumptionsa

           2,251       2,251  

Actuarial loss arising from changes in demographic assumptionsa

           (221     (221

Actuarial gain arising from experience adjustmentsb

           120       120  

Included in the group statement of comprehensive income

                     2,160  

Regular contributions by employer

     264             264  

Deficit contributions by employer

     872             872  

Included in the group cash flow statement

                     1,136  

Contributions by employees

     2       (2      

Benefits paid

     (2,449     2,449        

Foreign exchange

     11       (13     (2

Other movements

                     (2

At 31 March 2018

     50,956       (57,327     (6,371

 

a  The actuarial gain or loss arises from changes in the assumptions used to value the defined benefit liabilities at the end of the year compared with the assumptions used at the start of the year. This includes both financial assumptions, which are based on market conditions at the year end, and demographic assumptions such as life expectancy.
b  The actuarial loss or gain arising from experience adjustments on defined benefit liabilities represents the impact on the liabilities of differences between actual experience during the year compared with the assumptions made at the start of the year. Such differences might arise, for example, from members choosing different benefit options at retirement, actual salary increases being different from those assumed or actual benefit increases being different to the pension increase assumption.

 

 
237     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

How do we value our retirement benefit plans?

Valuation methodology

The IAS 19 liabilities are measured as the present value of the estimated future benefit cash flows to be paid by each scheme, calculated using the projected unit credit method. These calculations are performed for the group by professionally qualified independent actuaries.

The expected future benefit payments are based on a number of assumptions including future inflation, retirement ages, benefit options chosen and life expectancy and are therefore inherently uncertain. Actual benefit payments in a given year may be higher or lower, for example if members retire sooner or later than assumed, or take a greater or lesser cash lump sum at retirement than assumed.

LOGO What are our critical judgements, estimates and assumptions?

The accounting cost of these benefits and the present value of our pension liabilities involve judgements about uncertain events including the life expectancy of the members, the salary progression of our current employees, price inflation and the discount rate used to calculate the net present value of the future pension payments. We use estimates for all of these uncertain events in determining the pension costs and liabilities in our financial statements. Our assumptions reflect historical experience, external advice and our judgement regarding future expectations.

The fair value of some of our pension assets are made up of quoted and unquoted investments. The latter require more judgement as their values are not directly observable. The assumptions used in valuing unquoted investments are affected by current market conditions and trends which could result in changes in fair value after the measurement date.

How do we value the assets?

Under IAS 19, plan assets must be valued at the bid market value at the balance sheet date. For the main asset categories:

Equities listed on recognised stock exchanges are valued at closing bid prices.
Properties are valued on the basis of open market value.
Bonds are measured using a combination of broker quotes and pricing models making assumptions for credit risk, market risk and market yield curves.
Holdings in investment funds are valued at fair value which is typically the Net Asset Value provided by the investment manager.
Certain unlisted investments are valued using a model based valuation such as a discounted cash flow.
The value of the longevity insurance contract held by the BTPS is measured by discounting the projected cash flows payable under the contract (projected by an actuary, consistent with the terms of the contract).

Review of pension benefits

Following consultation with employees and the relevant unions, we announced a number of key changes to our main UK pension arrangements in March 2018:

An increase to BT’s standard maximum contribution rate to 10% for employees building up benefits in the BTRSS, taking effect from 1 June 2018.
The closure of Sections B and C of the BTPS (representing over 99% of the BTPS active membership) to future benefit accrual, with the employees impacted by the change able to join the BTRSS for future pension provision, taking effect from 30 June 2018.
All employees impacted by the closure of the BTPS will receive transition payments into their BTRSS account for a period, as well as having a higher maximum BT contribution rate of 11% for a temporary period. The transition payments are 2% of pensionable salary for a period depending on the employee’s age.
We will establish a new ‘hybrid’ pension arrangement over the coming year for non-management employees in the BTPS at closure. This new arrangement will combine elements of both defined benefit and defined contribution pension arrangements and support those employees on lower pay scales, giving them another option for their retirement savings. We are aiming to have this in place by no later than 1 April 2019.

These changes keep our pensions fair, flexible and affordable across BT in the UK.

Overview and governance of the BTPS

What is the profile of the BTPS?

At 31 March 2018 there were 293,000 members of the BTPS. Members belong to one of three sections depending upon the date they first joined the BTPS. The membership is analysed below.

Analysis of BTPS

 

     

Active

            members

    

Deferred

            members

    

            Pensioners

    

                Total

 

Sections A and B liabilities (£bn)a

     4.9        4.3        29.6        38.8  

Section C liabilities (£bn)

     7.7        5.7        3.6        17.0  

Total IAS 19 liabilities (£bn)

     12.6        10.0        33.2        55.8  

Total number of members

     30,000        60,500        202,500        293,000  

 

a Sections A and B have been aggregated in this table as Section A members have typically elected to take Section B benefits at retirement.    

 

 
238     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

The estimated duration of the BTPS liabilities, which is an indicator of the weighted average term of the liabilities, is around 16 years although the benefits payable by the BTPS are expected to be paid over more than 70 years. Whilst benefit payments are expected to increase over the earlier years, the value of the liabilities is expected to reduce.

The chart below illustrates the estimated benefits payable from the BTPS forecast using the IAS 19 assumptions.

Forecast benefits payable by the BTPS at 31 March 2018 (unaudited)

 

LOGO

 

a  Based on accrued benefits to 30 June 2017.

What are the benefits under the BTPS?

Benefits earned for pensionable service prior to 1 April 2009 are based upon a member’s final salary and a normal pensionable age of 60.

Between 1 April 2009 and 30 June 2018, Section B and C active members accrue benefits based upon a career average re-valued earnings (CARE) basis and a normal pensionable age of 65. On a CARE basis benefits are built up based upon earnings in each year and the benefit accrued for each year is increased by the lower of inflation or the individual’s actual pay increase in each year to retirement.

Under the Scheme rules the determination of the rate of inflation for statutory minimum rates of revaluation and indexation for the majority of benefits is based upon either the Retail Prices Index (RPI) or the Consumer Prices Index (CPI) which apply to each category of member as shown below.

 

     Active members   Deferred members   Pensioners
   Section Ba   Benefits accrue on a CARE basis increasing at the lower of RPI or the individual’s actual pensionable pay increase   Preserved benefits are revalued before retirement based upon CPI   Increases in benefits in payment are currently based upon CPI
Section C       Increases in benefits in payment are currently based upon RPI up to a maximum of 5%

 

a  Section A members have typically elected to take Section B benefits at retirement.

In December 2017, we sought a decision from the High Court as to whether it would be possible to change the index used to calculate pension increases paid in the future to members of Section C of the BTPS from RPI to another index.

In its judgment handed down on 19 January 2018, the High Court decided that it is currently not possible to change from RPI to another index. BT was then granted permission to appeal the decision to the Court of Appeal. The Court of Appeal hearing is due to take place in October 2018.

How is the BTPS governed and managed?

BT Pension Scheme Trustees Limited (the Trustee) has been appointed by BT as an independent trustee to administer and manage the BTPS on behalf of the members in accordance with the terms of the BTPS Trust Deed and Rules and relevant legislation (principally the Pension Schemes Act 1993, the Pensions Act 1995 and the Pensions Act 2004).

 

 
239     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

Under the terms of the Trust Deed there are nine Trustee directors, all of whom are appointed by BT, as illustrated below. Trustee directors are usually appointed for a three-year term but are then eligible for re-appointment.

 

LOGO

BTPS assets

Asset allocation

The allocation of assets between different classes of investment is reviewed regularly and is a key factor in the Trustee’s investment policy. The allocations reflect the Trustee’s views on the appropriate balance to be struck between seeking returns and incurring risk, and on the extent to which the assets should be allocated to match liabilities. Current market conditions and trends are regularly assessed which may lead to adjustments in the asset allocation.

The fair value of the assets of the BTPS analysed by asset category are shown below. These are subdivided by assets that have a quoted market price in an active market and those that do not (such as investment funds).

 

          2018a            2017a  
           

Total

assets

£bn

 

 

 

   

      of which

quoted

£bn

 

b 

 

   

          Total

%

 

 

            

Total

assets

£bn

 

 

 

   

      of which

quoted

£bn

 

b 

 

   

          Total

%

 

 

Growth

                  

Equities

   UK      0.5       0.5       1          0.7       0.6       2  
   Overseas developed      7.8       7.3       16          9.1       8.6       18  
   Emerging markets      0.5       0.4       1          0.5       0.1       1  

Private Equity

        1.9             4          1.9             4  

Property

   UK      3.9             8          4.1             8  
   Overseas      1.2             2          1.7             3  

Other growth assets

   Absolute Return fundsc      1.5             3          2.3             5  
   Non Core Creditd      3.4       1.0       7          3.5       1.1       7  
     Mature Infrastructure      1.4             3                1.7             3  

Liability matching

                  

Government bonds

   UK Index Linked      12.5       12.5       25          12.3       12.0       25  

Investment grade credit

   Global      10.0       8.0       20                7.6       5.9       15  

Cash, derivatives and other

                  

Cash balances

        3.8             7          1.7             3  

Longevity insurance contracte

        (0.4           (1        (0.3           (1

Other non-physical cashf

          1.9             4                3.3             7  

Total

                49.9       29.7       100                      50.1       28.3       100  

 

a  At 31 March 2018, the Scheme’s assets included equity issued by the group of £3m (2016/17: £nil). The Scheme also held £10m (2016/17: £10m) of index-linked bonds issued by the group.
b  Assets with a quoted price in an active market.
c  This allocation seeks to generate returns irrespective of the direction of markets. Managers within this allocation will typically manage their portfolios without close regard to a specific market benchmark.
d  This allocation includes a range of credit investments, including emerging market, sub-investment grade and unrated credit. The allocation seeks to exploit investment opportunities within credit markets using the expertise of a range of specialist investment managers.
e  The Trustee has hedged some of the Scheme’s longevity risk through a longevity insurance contract which was entered into in 2014. The value reflects experience to date on the contract from higher than expected deaths. This amount partly offsets a reduction recognised in the Scheme’s liabilities.
f  Non-physical cash includes offsets in future positions and cash collateral posted in relation to derivatives held by the Scheme.

 

 
240     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

IAS 19 assumptions

The table below summarises the approach used to set the key IAS 19 assumptions for the BTPS.

 

      Approach to set the assumption

 

Discount rate

  

 

IAS 19 requires that the discount rate is determined by reference to market yields at the reporting date on high quality corporate bonds. The currency and term of these should be consistent with the currency and estimated term of the pension obligations.

 

The assumption is calculated by applying the projected BTPS benefit cash flows to a corporate bond yield curve constructed based on the yield on AA-rated corporate bonds.

 

In setting the yield curve, judgement is required on the selection of appropriate bonds to be included in the universe and the approach used to then derive the yield curve.

 

At 31 March 2018, the discount rate model used to select bonds and derive the yield curve was updated to better reflect yields on corporate bonds over the life of the Scheme. A key difference is that the revised model excludes bonds which have either an implicit or explicit Government guarantee, which is more consistent with the requirements of IAS19, and reflects developing practice. Both the old and revised models are standard models developed by our external actuary. The impact of this change is a £2.1bn reduction in the BTPS liabilities.

 

RPI inflation   

The RPI inflation assumption is set using the entire inflation curve, weighted by projected BTPS benefit cash flows, and making an adjustment for an inflation risk premium (to reflect the extra premium paid by investors for inflation protection), which is currently assumed to be 20bps.

 

CPI inflation   

CPI is assessed at a margin below RPI taking into account market forecasts and independent estimates of the expected difference.

 

Salary increases   

Long-term salary increases for BTPS members are assumed to be equal to CPI inflation.

 

Pension increases   

Benefits are assumed to increase in line with the RPI or CPI inflation assumptions, based on the relevant index for increasing benefits, as prescribed by the rules of the BTPS and summarised above.

 

Longevity    The longevity assumption has been updated to take into account:
  

– the actual mortality experience of the BTPS pensioners, based on a formal review conducted at the 2014 triennial funding valuation

    

– future improvements in longevity based on a model published by UK actuarial profession’s Continuous Mortality Investigation (using the CMI 2016 Mortality Projections model with a 1.25% per year long-term improvement parameter).

 

The key financial assumptions used to measure the liabilities of the BTPS are shown below.

 

     Nominal rates (per year)            Real rates (per year)a  
At 31 March        2018
%
          2017
%
          2016
%
                2018
%
          2017
%
          2016
%
 

Rate used to discount liabilities

     2.65       2.40       3.30          (0.44     (0.78     0.44  

Inflation – increase in RPI

     3.10       3.20       2.85                       

Inflation – increase in CPI

     2.00 b      2.00 c      1.65 d               (1.1 )b      (1.2 )c      (1.2 )d 

 

a  The real rate is calculated relative to RPI inflation.
b  Assumed to be 0.1% higher until 31 March 2023.
c  Assumed to be 0.5% higher until 31 March 2019.
d  Assumed to be 0.2% higher until 31 March 2017.

The BTPS represents over 97% of the group’s retirement benefit obligation. While the financial assumptions may vary for each plan, the nominal financial assumptions weighted by liabilities across all plans are equal to the figures shown in the table above (to the nearest 0.05%).

 

 
241     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

Based on the IAS 19 longevity assumptions, the forecast life expectancies for BTPS members aged 60 are as follows:

 

At 31 March    2018
        Number of
years
    2017
            Number of
years
 

 

Male in lower pay bracket

     25.8       26.2  

Male in medium pay bracket

     27.1       27.5  

Male in higher pay bracket

     28.5       28.9  

Female in lower pay bracket

     28.5       28.9  

Female in higher pay bracket

     28.7       29.2  

Average improvement for a member retiring at age 60 in 10 years’ time

     0.7       1.0  

Risks underlying the assumptions

Background

The BTPS faces similar risks to other UK DB schemes: things like future low investment returns, high inflation, longer life expectancy and regulatory changes may all mean the BTPS becomes more of a financial burden. Further details are set out on page 64.

Changes in external factors, such as interest rates, can have an impact on the IAS 19 assumptions, impacting the measurement of BTPS liabilities. These factors can also impact the Scheme assets. The BTPS hedges some of these risks, including longevity and currency using financial instruments and insurance contracts.

Some of the key financial risks, and mitigations, for the BTPS are set out in the table below.

 

    Changes in bond yields  

A fall in yields on AA-rated corporate bonds, used to set the IAS 19 discount rate, will lead to an increase in the IAS 19 liabilities.

 

The BTPS’s assets include corporate bonds, government bonds and interest rate derivatives which are expected to partly offset the impact of movements in the discount rate. However, yields on these assets may diverge compared with the discount rate in some scenarios.

    Changes in inflation
    expectations
 

A significant proportion of the benefits paid to members are currently increased in line with RPI or CPI inflation. An increase in long-term inflation expectations will lead to an increase in the IAS 19 liabilities.

 

The BTPS’s assets include index-linked government bonds and inflation derivatives which are expected to partly offset the impact of movements in inflation expectations.

    Changes in life expectancy          

An increase in the life expectancy of members will result in benefits being paid out for longer, leading to an increase in the BTPS liabilities.

 

The BTPS holds a longevity insurance contract which covers around 25% of the BTPS’s total exposure to improvements in longevity, providing long-term protection and income to the BTPS in the event that members live longer than currently expected.

Other risks include volatile asset returns (ie where asset returns differ from the discount rate) and changes in legislation or regulation which impact the value of the liabilities or value of the assets.

Quantification

BT’s independent actuary has assessed the potential negative impact of the key risks that might occur no more than once in every 20 years illustrated as the following three scenarios:

 

     1-in-20 events  
Scenario    2018      2017  

 

1. Fall in discount ratea

     1.10%        1.00%  

2. Increase to inflation rateb

     0.70%        0.90%  

3. Increase to life expectancy

             1.35 years                1.35 years  

 

a  Scenario assumes a fall in the yields on both government and corporate bonds.
b  Assuming RPI, CPI, pension increases and salary increases all increase by the same amount.

 

 
242     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

The impact shown under each scenario looks at each event in isolation – in practice a combination of events could arise.

Sensitivity analysis of the principal assumptions to 1-in-20

events used to measure BTPS liabilities

 

LOGO

The sensitivity of the deficit allows for both the change in the liabilities and the assumed change in the assets. For example, the increase in the deficit under the life expectancy scenario incorporates the expected movement in the value of the insurance contract held to hedge longevity risk.

The sensitivities have been prepared using a similar approach as 2016/17 which involves calculating the liabilities and deficit using the alternative assumptions stated.

BTPS funding

Triennial funding valuation

The triennial valuation is carried out for the Trustee by a professionally qualified independent actuary. The purpose of the valuation is to design a funding plan to ensure that the BTPS has sufficient funds available to meet future benefit payments. The latest funding valuation was performed as at 30 June 2017. The next funding valuation will have an effective date of no later than 30 June 2020.

The valuation methodology for funding purposes, which is based on prudent assumptions, is broadly as follows:

Assets are valued at market value at the valuation date.
Liabilities are measured on an actuarial funding basis using the projected unit credit method and discounted to their present value.

The results of the two most recent triennial valuations are shown below.

 

     

June

2017
            valuation
£bn

    

June    

2014    
            valuation    
£bn     

 

BTPS liabilities

     (60.4)        (47.2)      

Market value of BTPS assets

     49.1        40.2      

Funding deficit

     (11.3)        (7.0)      

Percentage of accrued benefits covered by BTPS assets at the valuation date

     81.3%        85.2%      

Percentage of accrued benefits on a solvency basis covered by the BTPS assets at the valuation date

     62.2%        63.0%      

Between June 2014 and June 2017, the Scheme benefited from asset returns of 10.5% a year, that were higher than assumed under the 2014 funding assumptions, and £2.0bn of deficit contributions. The fall in long-term real interest rates resulted in an increase in liabilities, which has more than offset the improvements in the Scheme’s assets. There has been a reduction in the liabilities as a result of allowing for slower improvements to life expectancy being forecast by actuaries. This impact has been broadly offset by the impact of changes to the investment strategy that have reduced the current and future level of investment risk in the Scheme.

 

 
243     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

Key assumptions – funding valuation

These valuations were determined using the following prudent long-term assumptions.

 

     Nominal rates (per year)             Real rates (per year)a  
     

June

2017
        valuation
%

    

June

2014
        valuation
%

            

June

2017
        valuation
%

    

June

2014
        valuation
%

 

Average single equivalent discount rate

     2.6        4.5           (0.8)        1.0  

Average long-term increase in RPI

     3.4        3.5                   

Average long-term increase in CPI

     2.4        2.5                 (1.0)        (1.0

 

a  The real rate is calculated relative to RPI inflation and is shown as a comparator.

The discount rate at 30 June 2017 was derived from prudent return expectations above a risk-free yield curve based on gilt and swap rates. The discount rate reflects views of future returns at the valuation date, allowing for the Scheme to hold 45% of its investments in growth assets initially, before de-risking to a low risk investment approach by 2034. This gives a prudent discount rate of 1.4% per year above the yield curve initially, trending down to 0.7% per year above the curve in the long-term. The assumption is equivalent to using a flat discount rate of 1.0% per year above the yield curve.

At the 2014 valuation, the funding approach assumed the Scheme would hold 60% of its investments in growth assets (such as equities and property) for a period, before de-risking to a low-risk investment approach by 2034.

The average life expectancy assumptions at the valuation dates, for members 60 years of age, are as follows.

 

                                                 
Number of years from valuation date   

June

2017
assumptions

      

June

2014
assumptions

 

Male in lower pay bracket

     25.9          26.1  

Male in medium pay bracket

     27.2          27.5  

Male in high pay bracket

     28.6          29.0  

Female in lower pay bracket

     28.6          28.9  

Female in high pay bracket

     28.9          29.2  

Average improvement for a member retiring at age 60 in 10 years’ time

     0.9          1.3  

Payments made to the BTPS

 

                                                 
Year ended 31 March    2018
£m
       2017
£m
 

Ordinary contributions

     248          303  

Deficit contributions

     850          250  

Total contributions in the year

     1,098          553  

Future funding obligations and recovery plan

Under the terms of the Trust Deed, the group is required to have a funding plan, determined at the conclusion of the triennial funding valuation, which is a legal agreement between BT and the Trustee and should address the deficit over a maximum period of 20 years.

In May 2018, the 2017 triennial funding valuation was finalised, agreed with the Trustee and certified by the Scheme Actuary. The funding deficit at 30 June 2017 was £11.3bn. The deficit will be met over a 13 year period, maintaining the remaining period of the previous plan.

The deficit contributions have three components:

Payments by BT over the three years to 31 March 2020 totalling £2.1bn. This is equal to the amount due over the same period under the previous recovery plan. £850m of this was paid in March 2018 and the remaining £1,250m is to be paid by 30 June 2019.
A further £2.0bn contribution, due to be funded from the proceeds of the issuance of bonds, which will be held by the BTPS. The bonds will be:
  issued as soon as practicable under BT’s Euro Medium Term Note Programme
  sterling denominated and have maturities ranging from 2033 to 2042
  £1.0bn fixed interest and £1.0bn CPI-linked.
For the 10 years from 1 April 2020 to 31 March 2030, BT will make annual payments of around £900m, typically by 31 March each year.
  £400m of BT’s contribution in the financial year 2020/21 will be made by 30 June 2020.

This means that the recovery plan includes material contributions by BT to the Scheme of £4.5bn by 30 June 2020, when the next valuation is expected to take place.

 

 
244     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

BT is scheduled to make future deficit payments to the BTPS in line with the table below.

 

                                                                                                                                                                        
Year to 31 March    2018      2019     2020     2021     2022     2023      2024      2025      2026      2027      2028      2029      2030  

Deficit contribution (£m)

     850        2,000 a      1,250 b      900 c      900 d      907        907        907        907        907        907        907        907  

a due to be paid shortly but no later than 30 June 2019.

b payable by 30 June 2019.

c £400m payable by 30 June 2020.

d £200m payable by 30 June 2021.

Based on the 2017 funding valuation agreement, the group expects to make contributions of approximately £2,075m to the BTPS in 2018/19, comprising ordinary contributions of approximately £75m and deficit contributions of £2,000m. The reduction in the level of ordinary contributions primarily reflects the closure of the BTPS to Section B and C members, which is currently intended to take place on 30 June 2018. In addition, contributions towards the cost of administering the Scheme, PPF levies and providing future benefits for the remaining members will continue to be made after this date.

Other protections

The 2017 funding agreement with the Trustee included additional features for BT to provide support to the BTPS. These include:

 

Feature       Detail
Shareholder
distributions
   

BT will provide additional payments to the BTPS by the amount that shareholder distributions exceed a threshold. The threshold allows for 10% per year dividend per share growth plus £200m per year of share buybacks on a cumulative basis.

 

This will apply until 30 June 2021, or until the finalisation of the next valuation if earlier.

 

BT will also consult with the Trustee if it considers share buybacks in excess of £200m per year or making a special dividend. This obligation is on-going until otherwise terminated.

Material
corporate events
    In the event that BT generates net cash proceeds greater than £1.0bn from disposals (net of acquisitions) in any 12-month period ending 30 June, BT will make additional contributions to the BTPS equal to one third of those net cash proceeds. This obligation applies until the next valuation is signed.
    BT will consult with the Trustee if:
   

– it considers making acquisitions with a total cost of more than £1.0bn in any 12-month period; or

   

– it considers making disposals of more than £1.0bn; or

   

– it considers making a Class 1 transaction (acquisition or disposal); or

   

– it is subject to a takeover offer.

    This obligation is on-going until otherwise terminated.
      BT will advise the Trustee should there be other material corporate events which would materially impact BT’s covenant to the BTPS. This obligation is on-going until otherwise terminated.
Negative pledge     A negative pledge that future creditors will not be granted superior security to the BTPS in excess of a £1.5bn threshold, to cover both British Telecommunications plc and BT Group plc.
      This provision applies until the deficit reduces to below £2.0bn at any subsequent funding valuation.

 

 
245     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

20. Retirement benefit plans continued

In the highly unlikely event that the group were to become insolvent there are additional protections of BTPS members’ benefits:

 

Feature       Detail
Crown Guarantee     The Crown Guarantee was granted by the Government when the group was privatised in 1984 and would only come into effect upon the insolvency of BT.
    The Trustee brought court proceedings to clarify the scope and extent of the Crown Guarantee. The Court of Appeal judgment on 16 July 2014 established that:
   

– the Crown Guarantee covers BT’s funding obligation in relation to the benefits of members of the BTPS who joined post-privatisation as well as those who joined pre-privatisation (subject to certain exceptions)

   

– the funding obligation to which the Crown Guarantee relates is measured with reference to BT’s obligation to pay deficit contributions under the rules of the BTPS.

      The Crown Guarantee is not taken into account for the purposes of the actuarial valuation of the BTPS and is an entirely separate matter, only being relevant in the highly unlikely event that BT became insolvent.
Pension
Protection Fund
(PPF)
    The Pension Protection Fund (PPF) may take over the BTPS and pay benefits not covered by the Crown Guarantee to members.
      There are limits on the amounts paid by the PPF and the PPF would not provide exactly the same benefits as those provided under the BTPS Rules.

Other benefit plans

In addition to the BTPS, the group maintains benefit plans around the world with a focus on these being appropriate for the local market and culture.

EE Pension Scheme (EEPS)

The EEPS is the second largest defined benefit plan sponsored by the group with defined benefit liabilities of around £0.9bn. The EEPS also has a defined contribution section with around 11,500 active members.

At 31 March 2018, the defined benefit section’s assets are invested across a number of asset classes including global equities (28%), property & illiquid alternatives (22%), an absolute return portfolio (25%) and a liability driven investment portfolio (25%).

The triennial valuation of the defined benefit section was performed as at 31 December 2015, and agreed in March 2017. This showed a funding deficit of £141m. The group is scheduled to contribute £1.875m each month between 1 April 2018 and November 2020.

The next funding valuation will have an effective date of no later than 31 December 2018.

BTRSS

The BTRSS is the largest defined contribution scheme maintained by the group with around 35,000 active members. In the year to 31 March 2018, the group contributed £167m to the BTRSS.

Other schemes

BT operates a number of overseas pension schemes. In December 2017, BT closed two defined benefit plans which operate in the Netherlands. This resulted in a c£14m past service credit arising from the change in future indexation obligations. A further £3m past service credit was recognised in 2017/18 relating to various other pension plans operating outside the UK.

 

 
246     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

21. Own shares

 

     Treasury sharesa          Employee share
ownership trusta
         Total  
      millions                 £m           millions                 £m           millions                 £m  

At 31 March 2016

     8       (39        17       (76        25       (115

Own shares purchasedb

     35       (151        12       (55        47       (206

Share options exercisedb

     (35     155                         (35     155  

Executive share awards vested

                      (15     70            (15     70  

At 31 March 2017

     8       (35          14       (61          22       (96

Own shares purchasedb

     43       (125        32       (96        75       (221

Share options exercisedb

     (1     2          (29     100          (30     102  

Transfer of shares to satisfy US share scheme

     (4     13                         (4     13  

Executive share awards vested

                      (5     16            (5     16  

At 31 March 2018

     46       (145          12       (41          58       (186

 

a  At 31 March 2018, 46,224,966 shares (2016/17: 7,690,097) with an aggregate nominal value of £2m (2016/17: £nil) were held at cost as treasury shares and 12,855,378 shares (2016/17: 14,303,068) with an aggregate nominal value of £1m (2016/17: £1m) were held in the Trust.
b  See group cash flow statement on page 205. In 2017/18 the cash paid for the repurchase of ordinary share capital was £221m (2016/17: £206m). The cash received for proceeds on the issue of treasury shares was £53m (2016/17: £70m).

The treasury shares reserve represents BT Group plc shares purchased directly by the group. The BT Group Employee Share Ownership Trust (the Trust) also purchases BT Group plc shares.

The treasury shares and the shares in the Trust are being used to satisfy our obligations under employee share plans. Further details on Employee Saveshare Plans and Executive share plans are provided in note 22.

22. Share-based payments

What share incentive arrangements do we have?

Our plans include savings-related share option plans for employees and those of participating subsidiaries, further share option plans for selected employees and a stock purchase plan for employees in the US. We also have several share plans for executives. All share-based payment plans are equity-settled. Details of these plans and an analysis of the total charge by type of award is set out below.

 

                                                              
Year ended 31 March    2018
£m
     2017
£m
     2016
£m
 

Employee Saveshare Plans

     42        40        27  

Executive Share Plans:

        

Incentive Share Plan (ISP)

     16               21  

Deferred Bonus Plan (DBP)

     4        9        4  

Retention Share Plan (RSP)a

     21        8        1  

Other plans

     1               5  
       84        57        58  

 

a  Re-presented to show RSPs separately from other plans.

Employee Saveshare Plans

Under an HMRC-approved savings-related share option plan, employees save on a monthly basis, over a three or five-year period, towards the purchase of shares at a fixed price determined when the option is granted. This price is usually set at a 20% discount to the market price for five-year plans and 10% for three-year plans. The options must be exercised within six months of maturity of the savings contract, otherwise they lapse. Similar plans operate for our overseas employees.

Incentive Share Plan (ISP)

Under the ISP, participants are only entitled to these shares in full at the end of a three-year period if the company has met the relevant pre-determined corporate performance measures and if the participants are still employed by the group. For ISP awards granted in 2017/18, 2016/17 and 2015/16: 40% of each award is linked to a total shareholder return (TSR) target for a comparator group of companies from the beginning of the relevant performance period; 40% is linked to a three-year cumulative normalised free cash flow measure; and 20% to growth in underlying revenue excluding transit.

Deferred Bonus Plan (DBP)

Under the DBP, awards are granted annually to selected employees. Shares in the company are transferred to participants at the end of three years if they continue to be employed by the group throughout that period.

Retention Share Plan (RSP)

Under the RSP, awards are granted to selected employees. Shares in the company are transferred to participants at the end of a specified retention period if they continue to be employed by the group throughout that period.

 

 
247     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

22. Share-based payments continued

Under the terms of the ISP, DBP and RSP, dividends or dividend equivalents earned on shares during the conditional periods are reinvested in company shares for the potential benefit of the participants.

Employee Saveshare Plans

Movements in Employee Saveshare options are shown below.

 

     Movement in the number of share options            Weighted average exercise price  
Year ended 31 March    2018
        millions
    2017
        millions
    2016
        millions
            2018
        pence
     2017
        pence
     2016
        pence
 

Outstanding at 1 April

     189       197       226          313        287        226  

Granted

     69       44       47          250        362        385  

Forfeited

     (41     (18     (12        328        345        306  

Exercised

     (30     (33     (63        169        208        139  

Expired

     (12     (1     (1              353        345        247  

Outstanding at 31 March

     175       189       197                306        313        287  

Exercisable at 31 March

                                320        237        140  

The weighted average share price for all options exercised during 2017/18 was 311p (2016/17: 357p, 2015/16: 463p).

The following table summarises information relating to options outstanding and exercisable under Employee Saveshare plans at

31 March 2018.

 

                                                                           
Normal dates of vesting and exercise (based on calendar years)    Exercise price
per share
     Weighted
average
exercise
price
     Number of
outstanding
options
millions
     Weighted
average
remaining
    contractual life
 

2018

     249p – 423p        306p        25        10 months  

2019

     319p – 397p        333p        53        22 months  

2020

     243p – 376p        307p        44        34 months  

2021

     353p        353p        17        46 months  

2022

     243p        243p        36        58 months  

Total

              306p        175        33 months  

Executive share plans

Movements in executive share plan awards during 2017/18 are shown below:

 

                                                                           
     Number of shares (millions)  
      ISP     DBP     RSP     Total  

At 1 April 2017

     45       7       4       56  

Awards granted

     26       2       10       38  

Awards vested

           (3     (2     (5

Awards lapsed

     (20           (1     (21

Dividend shares reinvested

     3             1       4  

At 31 March 2018

     54       6       12       72  

Fair values

The following table summarises the fair values and key assumptions used for valuing grants made under the Employee Saveshare plans and ISP in 2017/18, 2016/17 and 2015/16.

 

     2018             2017             2016  
Year ended 31 March    Employee
Saveshare
     ISP              Employee
Saveshare
     ISP              Employee
Saveshare
     ISP  

Weighted average fair value

     56p        202p           72p        328p           81p        364p  

Weighted average share price

     296p        281p           422p        426p           454p        451p  

Weighted average exercise price

     250p        n/a           362p        n/a           385p        n/a  

Expected dividend yield

     3.12% – 3.21%        n/a           2.9% – 3.4%        n/a           3.2% –3.7%        n/a  

Risk free rates

     0.1% – 0.2%        0.2%               0.5% – 0.8%        0.6%           0.7% – 1.6%        0.7%  

Expected volatility

         23.1% – 24.3%            23.6%                     19.0% – 21.5%            21.8%                     19.7% – 22.7%            22.0%  

Employee Saveshare grants are valued using a Binomial options pricing model. Awards under the ISP are valued using Monte Carlo simulations. TSRs are generated for BT and the comparator group at the end of the three-year performance period, using each company’s volatility and the cross correlation between pairs of stocks.

 

 
248     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

22. Share-based payments continued

Volatility has been determined by reference to BT’s historical volatility which is expected to reflect the BT share price in the future. An expected life of three months after vesting date is assumed for Employee Saveshare options. For all other awards the expected life is equal to the vesting period. The risk-free interest rate is based on the UK gilt curve in effect at the time of the grant, for the expected life of the option or award.

The fair values for the DBP and RSP were determined using the market price of the shares at the grant date. The weighted average share price for DBP awards granted in 2017/18 was 282p (2016/17: 421p, 2015/16: 451p) and for RSP awards granted in 2017/18 it was 282p (2016/17: 417p, 2015/16: 420p).

23. Investments

 

                                                                    
At 31 March    2018
£m
     2017
£m
     2016
£m
 

Non-current assets

        

Available-for-sale

     46        37        39  

Fair value through profit or loss

     7        7        7  
       53        44        46  

Current assets

        

Available-for-sale

     2,575        1,437        2,878  

Loans and receivables

     447        83        40  
       3,022        1,520        2,918  

Loans and receivables are held on the balance sheet at amortised cost and this approximates fair value. Loans and receivables consist of investments in term deposits denominated in Sterling of £416m (2016/17: £35m, 2015/16: £10m), in US Dollars of £27m (2016/17: £30m, 2015/16: £30m) and in other currencies £4m (2016/17: £18m, 2015/16: £nil).

 

                                                                                           

Fair value hierarchy

At 31 March 2018

   Level 1
£m
     Level 2
£m
     Level 3
£m
     Total held at
fair value
£m
 

Non-current and current investments

           

Available-for-sale investments

     32        2,575        14        2,621  

Fair value through profit or loss

     7                      7  

Total

     39        2,575        14        2,628  
At 31 March 2017    Level 1
£m
     Level 2
£m
     Level 3
£m
     Total held at
fair value
£m
 

Non-current and current investments

           

Available-for-sale investments

     21        1,437        16        1,474  

Fair value through profit or loss

     7                      7  

Total

     28        1,437        16        1,481  
At 31 March 2016    Level 1
£m
     Level 2
£m
     Level 3
£m
     Total held at
fair value
£m
 

Non-current and current investments

           

Available-for-sale investments

     24        2,878        15        2,917  

Fair value through profit or loss

     7                      7  

Total

     31        2,878        15        2,924  

The three levels of valuation methodology used are:

Level 1 – uses quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.

Level 2 – uses inputs for the asset or liability other than quoted prices, that are observable either directly or indirectly.

Level 3 – uses inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data, such as internal models or other valuation methods.

Level 2 balances classified as available-for-sale consist of investments in liquidity funds denominated in Sterling of £2,180m (2016/17: £900m, 2015/16: £2,430m) and in Euros of £395m (2016/17: £537m, 2015/16: £448m). The fair value of liquidity fund is calculated by using notional currency amounts adjusted by year end spot exchange rates.

Level 3 balances consist of available-for-sale investments of £14m (2016/17: £16m, 2015/16: £15m) which represent investments in a number of private companies. In the absence of specific market data, these investments are held at cost, adjusted as necessary for impairments, which approximates to fair value.

 

 
249     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

24. Cash and cash equivalents

 

                                                                    
At 31 March    2018
£m
    2017
£m
    2016
£m
 

Cash at bank and in hand

     446       469       900  

Cash equivalents

      

Loans and receivables

      

US deposits

     26       32       44  

UK deposits

     31       1       20  

Other deposits

     25       26       32  

Total cash equivalents

     82       59       96  

Total cash and cash equivalents

     528       528       996  

Bank overdrafts (note 25)

     (29     (17     (537

Cash and cash equivalents per the cash flow statement

     499       511       459  

The group’s cash and cash equivalents include restricted cash of £32m (2016/17: £43m, 2015/16: £51m), of which £29m (2016/17: £41m, 2015/16: £44m) was held in countries where local capital or exchange controls currently prevent us from accessing cash balances. The remaining balance of £3m (2016/17: £2m, 2015/16: £7m) was held in escrow accounts, or in commercial arrangements akin to escrow.

Cash equivalents are classified as loans and receivables and are held on the group balance sheet at amortised cost which equates to fair value.

25. Loans and other borrowings

What’s our capital management policy?

The objective of our capital management policy is to target an overall level of debt consistent with our credit rating target while investing in the business, supporting the pension scheme and paying progressive dividends. In order to meet this objective, we may issue or repay debt, issue new shares, repurchase shares, or adjust the amount of dividends paid to shareholders. We manage the capital structure and make adjustments to it in the light of changes in economic conditions and the risk characteristics of the group. The Board regularly reviews the capital structure. No changes were made to these objectives and processes during 2017/18, 2016/17 or 2015/16. For details of share issues and repurchases in the year see note 21.

Our capital structure consists of net debt and shareholders’ equity. The analysis below summarises the components which we manage as capital.

 

                                                                    
At 31 March    2018
£m
     2017
£m
     2016
£m
 

Net debt

     9,627        8,932        9,838  

Total parent shareholders’ equitya

     10,270        8,305        10,090  
       19,897        17,237        19,928  

 

a  Excludes non-controlling interests of £34m (2016/17: £30m, 2015/16: £22m).

 

 
250     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

25. Loans and other borrowings continued

Net debt

Net debt consists of loans and other borrowings (both current and non-current), less current asset investments and cash and cash equivalents. Loans and other borrowings are measured at the net proceeds raised, adjusted to amortise any discount over the term of the debt. For the purpose of this measure, current asset investments and cash and cash equivalents are measured at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Currency denominated balances within net debt are translated to Sterling at swapped rates where hedged.

Net debt is considered to be an alternative performance measure as it is not defined in IFRS. The most directly comparable IFRS measure is the aggregate of loans and other borrowings (current and non-current), current asset investments and cash and cash equivalents.

A reconciliation from the most directly comparable IFRS measure to net debt is given below.

 

At 31 March   

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Loans and other borrowings

     14,275          12,713          14,761  

Less:

            

Cash and cash equivalents

     (528        (528        (996

Current asset investments

     (3,022        (1,520        (2,918
     10,725          10,665          10,847  

Adjustments:

            

To retranslate debt balances at swap rates where hedged by currency swaps

     (874        (1,419        (652

To remove accrued interest applied to reflect the effective interest method and fair value adjustments

     (224        (314        (357

Net debt

     9,627          8,932          9,838  

The table below shows the key components of net debt and of the increase of £695m this year.

 

     At                           Transfer      Accrued         At  
     1 April      Issuance/      Fair value      Foreign      to within      interest         31 March  
     2017      (maturities)      movements      exchange      one year      movements         2018  
      £m      £m      £m      £m      £m      £m          £m  

Debt due within one yeara

     2,632        (1,401      (18      (95      1,163                2,281  

Debt due after one year

     10,081        3,760        (60      (440      (1,347              11,994  

Cash flows from derivatives related to net debt

            (188                    188                 

Overdrafts

            4                      (4               

Impact of cross-currency swapsb

     (1,419                    545                       (874

Removal of the accrued interest and fair value adjustmentsc

     (314             78                      10           (226

Gross debt

     10,980        2,175               10               10         13,175  

Less:

                     

Cash and cash equivalents

     (528      (23             23                       (528

Current asset investments

     (1,520      (1,495             (7                     (3,022

Removal of the accrued interestc

                                        2           2  

Net debt

     8,932        657               26               12           9,627  

 

a  Including accrued interest and bank overdrafts.
b  Translation of debt balances at swap rates where hedged by cross currency swaps.
c  Removal of accrued interest applied to reflect the effective interest rate method and removal of fair value adjustments.

 

 
251     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

25. Loans and other borrowings continued

The table below gives details of the listed bonds and other debt.

 

At 31 March   

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

1.625% US$600m bond due June 2016a

                       419  

8.50% £678m bond due December 2016 (minimum 7.50%b)

                       696  

3.5% 500m bond due February 2017a

                       398  

1.25% US$500m bond due February 2017a

                       348  

6.625% £500m bond due June 2017a

              526          525  

5.95% US$1,100m bond due January 2018a

              891          775  

3.25% 600m bond due August 2018a

     541          539          510  

2.35% US$800m bond due February 2019a

     572          642          558  

4.38% £450m bond due March 2019

     455          460          464  

1.125% 1,000m bond due June 2019a

     883          863          800  

8.625% £300m bond due March 2020

     300          300          300  

0.625% 1,500m bond due March 2021a

     1,309          1,282          1,190  

0.5% 575m bond due June 2022a

     502                    

1.125% 1,100m bond due March 2023a

     961          942          873  

1% 575m bond due June 2024a

     506                    

1% 1,100m bond due November 2024a

     959                    

3.50% £250m index linked bond due April 2025

     419          403          396  

1.75% 1,300m bond due March 2026a

     1,137          1,113          1,032  

1.5% 1,150m bond due June 2027a

     1,009                    

5.75% £600m bond due December 2028

     721          731          741  

9.125% US$2,670m bond due December 2030a (minimum 8.625%b)

     1,943          2,191          1,910  

3.125% £500m bond due November 2031

     502                    

6.375% £500m bond due June 2037a

     522          522          522  

3.625% £250m bond due November 2047

     250                    

Total listed bonds

     13,491          11,405          12,457  

Finance leases

     223          229          233  

LIBOR + 0.95% £438m Syndicated loan facilities due April 2016

                       438  

2.21% £350m bank loan due December 2017

              352          354  

Acquisition facility

                       181  

Other loans

     532          710          561  

Bank overdrafts (note 24)

     29          17          537  

Total other loans and borrowings

     561          1,079          2,071  

Total loans and borrowings

         14,275            12,713            14,761  

 

a  Designated in a cash flow hedge relationship.
b  The interest rate payable on this bond attracts an additional 0.25% for a downgrade by one credit rating by either Moody’s or S&P to the group’s senior unsecured debt below A3/A–respectively. In addition, if Moody’s or S&P subsequently increase the ratings then the interest rate will be decreased by 0.25% for each rating category upgrade by each rating agency. In no event will the interest rate be reduced below the minimum rate reflected in the above table.

Unless previously designated in a fair value hedge relationship, all loans and other borrowings are carried on our balance sheet at amortised cost and in the table above. The fair value of listed bonds and other long-term borrowings is £14,878m (2016/17: £13,496m, 2015/16: £14,500m) and the fair value of finance leases is £253m (2016/17: £273m, 2015/16: £284m).

The fair value of our bonds and other long-term borrowings is estimated on the basis of quoted market prices (Level 1), or based on similar issuances where they exist (Level 2).

The carrying amount of other loans and bank overdrafts equates to fair value due to the short maturity of these items (Level 3).

 

 
252     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

25. Loans and other borrowings continued

The interest rates payable on loans and borrowings disclosed above reflect the coupons on the underlying issued loans and borrowings and not the interest rates achieved through applying associated cross-currency and interest rate swaps in hedge arrangements.

Loans and other borrowings are analysed as follows:

 

At 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

    

2016

£m

 

Current liabilities

        

Listed bonds

     1,702        1,539        2,013  

Finance leases

     18        15        8  

Bank loans

            352         

Syndicated loan facilities

                   619  

Other loans and bank overdraftsa

     561        726        1,096  

Total current liabilities

     2,281        2,632        3,736  

Non-current liabilities

        

Listed bonds

     11,789        9,866        10,444  

Finance leases

     205        214        225  

Bank loans

                   354  

Other loans

            1        2  

Total non-current liabilities

     11,994        10,081        11,025  

Total

         14,275              12,713              14,761  

 

a  Includes collateral received on swaps of £525m (2016/17: £702m, 2015/16: £553m).

The carrying values disclosed in the above table reflect balances at amortised cost adjusted for accrued interest and fair value adjustments to the relevant loans or borrowings. These do not reflect the final principal repayments that will arise after taking account of the relevant derivatives in hedging relationships which are reflected in the table below. Apart from finance leases, all borrowings as at 31 March 2018, 2017 and 2016 were unsecured.

The principal repayments of loans and borrowings at hedged rates amounted to £13,175m (2016/17: £10,980m, 2015/16: £13,752m) and repayments fall due as follows:

 

                  2018                       2017                       2016  
          Effect of     Principal               Effect of     Principal               Effect of     Principal  
          hedging     repayments               hedging     repayments               hedging     repayments  
    Carrying     and     at hedged         Carrying     and     at hedged         Carrying     and     at hedged  
    amount     interest     rates         amount     interest     rates         amount     interest     rates  
At 31 March   £m     £m     £m          £m     £m     £m          £m     £m     £m  

Within one year, or on demand

    2,272       (291     1,981           2,632       (498     2,134           3,736       (232     3,504  

Between one and two years

    1,192       (66     1,126         1,614       (197     1,417         1,632       (216     1,416  

Between two and three years

    1,332       (154     1,178         1,166       (43     1,123         1,488       (72     1,416  

Between three and four years

    18             18         1,295       (121     1,174         1,103       18       1,121  

Between four and five years

    1,489       (111     1,378         12             12         1,199       (26     1,173  

After five years

    7,899       (405     7,494           5,844       (724     5,120           5,424       (302     5,122  

Total due for repayment after more than one year

    11,930       (736     11,194           9,931       (1,085     8,846           10,846       (598     10,248  

Total repayments

    14,202       (1,027     13,175         12,563       (1,583     10,980         14,582       (830     13,752  

Fair value adjustments

    73                           150                           179                  

Total loans and other borrowings

    14,275                           12,713                           14,761                  

Obligations under finance leases are analysed as follows:

 

       2018        2017        2016        2018        2017        2016  
       Minimum lease payments        Repayment of outstanding
lease obligations
 
At 31 March                £m        £m                  £m        £m  

Amounts payable under finance leases:

                             

Due within one year

       33          29          13          18          14          8  

Between two to five years

       122          102          105          71          50          51  

After five years

       193          237          265          130          165          174  
       348          368          383          219          229          233  

Less: future finance charges

       (129        (139        (150                           

Fair value adjustments for purchase price adjustment

       4                            4                    

Total finance lease obligations

       223          229          233          223          229          233  

Assets held under finance leases mainly consist of buildings and network assets. Our obligations under finance leases are secured by the lessors’ title to the leased assets.

 

 
253     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

26. Finance expense

 

Year ended 31 March     

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Finance expense

              

Interest on:

              

Financial liabilities at amortised cost and associated derivatives

       478          567          489  

Finance leases

       16          15          14  

Derivatives

       14          12          11  

Fair value movements on derivatives not in a designated hedge relationship

       1          (2        (5

Reclassification of cash flow hedge from other comprehensive income

       34          (1        3  

Unwinding of discount on provisions

       15          16          8  

Total finance expense before specific items

       558          607          520  

Specific items (note 8)

       218          210          229  

Total finance expense

       776          817          749  

Reconciliation of net finance expense to net interest cash outflow

Net interest cash outflow of £548m (2016/17: £622m, 2015/16: £548m) is £2m higher (2016/17: £28m, 2015/16: £65m) than the net finance expense in the income statement.

 

Year ended 31 March     

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Finance expense before specific items

       558          607          520  

Finance income before specific items

       (12        (13        (37

Net finance expense before specific items

       546          594          483  

Timing differences:

              

– Derivative restructuring costs

                1          (1

– Timing of coupon payments on bonds

       (6        19          27  

– Timing of interest receipts

                         22  

– Deferred income

       8          8          9  

Specific item – EE-related financing costs (note 8)

                         8  

Net interest cash outflow

       548          622          548  

 

 
254     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

27. Financial instruments and risk management

We issue or hold financial instruments mainly to finance our operations; to finance corporate transactions such as dividends, share buybacks and acquisitions; for the temporary investment of short-term funds; and to manage currency and interest rate risks. In addition, various financial instruments, for example trade receivables and payables arise directly from operations.

How do we manage financial risk?

Our activities expose us to a variety of financial risks: market risk (including interest rate risk and foreign exchange risk), credit risk and liquidity risk.

Treasury operation

We have a centralised treasury operation whose primary role is to manage liquidity and funding requirements as well as our exposure to associated financial and market risks, including credit risk, interest rate risk and foreign exchange risk.

Treasury policy

Treasury policy is set by the Board. Group treasury activities are subject to a set of controls appropriate for the magnitude of borrowing, investments and group-wide exposures. The Board has delegated authority to operate these policies to a series of panels responsible for the management of key treasury risks and operations. Appointment to and removal from the key panels requires approval from two of the following: the chairman, the chief executive or the chief financial officer.

There has been no change in the nature of our risk profile between 31 March 2018 and the date of approval of these financial statements.

How do we manage interest rate risk?

Management policy

Interest rate risk arises primarily from our long-term borrowings. Interest cash flow risk arises from borrowings issued at variable rates, partially offset by cash held at variable rates. Fair value interest rate risk arises from borrowings issued at fixed rates.

Our policy, as set by the Board, is to ensure that at least 70% of ongoing net debt is at fixed rates. Short-term interest rate management is delegated to the treasury operation while long-term interest rate management decisions require further approval by the chief financial officer, group director tax, treasury and insurance or the group treasurer who each have been delegated such authority from the Board.

Hedging strategy

In order to manage our interest rate profile, we have entered into cross-currency and interest rate swap agreements to vary the amounts and periods for which interest rates on borrowings are fixed. The duration of the swap agreements matches the duration of the debt instruments. The majority of the group’s long-term borrowings are subject to fixed Sterling interest rates after applying the impact of these hedging instruments.

How do we manage foreign exchange risk?

Management policy

Foreign currency hedging activities protect the group from the risk that changes in exchange rates will adversely affect future net cash flows.

The Board’s policy for foreign exchange risk management defines the types of transactions typically covered, including significant operational, funding and currency interest exposures, and the period over which cover should extend for each type of transaction.

The Board has delegated short-term foreign exchange management to the treasury operation and long-term foreign exchange management decisions require further approval from the chief financial officer, group director tax, treasury and insurance or the group treasurer.

Hedging strategy

A significant proportion of our external revenue and costs arise within the UK and are denominated in Sterling. Our non-UK operations generally trade and are funded in their functional currency which limits their exposure to foreign exchange volatility.

We enter into forward currency contracts to hedge foreign currency capital purchases, purchase and sale commitments, interest expense and foreign currency investments. The commitments hedged are principally denominated in US Dollar, Euro and Asia Pacific region currencies. As a result, our exposure to foreign currency arises mainly on non-UK subsidiary investments and on residual currency trading flows.

We use cross-currency swaps to swap foreign currency borrowings into Sterling.

 

 
255     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

27. Financial instruments and risk management continued

The table below reflects the currency and interest rate profile of our loans and borrowings after the impact of hedging.

 

           2018                       2017                       2016         
          Floating                     Floating                     Floating        
    Fixed rate     rate               Fixed rate     rate               Fixed rate     rate        
    interest     interest     Total         interest     interest     Total         interest     interest     Total  
At 31 March   £m     £m     £m          £m     £m     £m          £m     £m     £m  

Sterling

    11,990       676       12,666         9,633       706       10,339         11,417       1,748       13,165  

Euro

          509       509               641       641               587       587  

Total

    11,990       1,185       13,175           9,633       1,347       10,980           11,417       2,335       13,752  

Ratio of fixed to floating

    91%       9%       100%         88%       12%       100%         83%       17%       100%  

Weighted average effective

fixed interest rate – Sterling

    4.4%                           4.9%                           6.0%                  

The floating rate loans and borrowings bear interest rates fixed in advance for periods ranging from one day to one year, primarily by reference to LIBOR quoted rates.

Sensitivity analysis

The income statement and shareholders’ equity are exposed to volatility arising from changes in interest rates and foreign exchange rates. To demonstrate this volatility, management have concluded that the following are reasonable benchmarks for performing sensitivity analysis:

For interest, a 1% increase in interest rates and parallel shift in yield curves across Sterling, US Dollar and Euro currencies.
For foreign exchange, a 10% strengthening/weakening in Sterling against other currencies.

The impact on equity, before tax, of a 1% increase in interest rates and a 10% strengthening in Sterling against other currencies is as detailed below:

 

At 31 March   

2018

£m

Increase

(reduce)

   

2017

£m

Increase

(reduce)

   

2016

£m

Increase

(reduce)

 

Sterling interest rates

                 628                   554                   626  

US Dollar interest rates

     (267     (348     (374

Euro interest rates

     (401     (229     (263

Sterling strengthening

     (236     (269     (98

A 1% decrease in interest rates and 10% weakening in Sterling against other currencies would have broadly the same impact in the opposite direction.

The impact of a 1% change in interest rates on the group’s annual net finance expense and our exposure to foreign exchange volatility in the income statement, after hedging, (excluding translation exposures) would not have been material in 2017/18, 2016/17 and 2015/16.

Credit ratings

We continue to target a BBB+/Baa1 credit rating over the cycle. We regularly review the liquidity of the group and our funding strategy takes account of medium-term requirements. These include the pension deficit and shareholder distributions.

Our December 2030 bond contains covenants which require us to pay higher rates of interest since our credit ratings fell below A3 in the case of Moody’s or A– in the case of Standard & Poor’s (S&P). Additional interest of 0.25% per year accrues for each ratings category downgrade by each agency below those levels effective from the next coupon date following a downgrade. Based on the total notional value of debt outstanding of £1.9bn at 31 March 2018, our finance expense would increase/decrease by approximately £10m a year if the group’s credit rating were to be downgraded/upgraded, respectively, by one credit rating category by both agencies.

Our credit ratings were as detailed below:

 

     2018                  2017                  2016          
At 31 March    Rating        Outlook           Rating        Outlook           Rating        Outlook  

Rating agency

                           

Moody’s

     Baa2          Stable          Baa1          Negative          Baa2          Positive  

Standard & Poor’s

           BBB+                Negative                  BBB+                Negative                  BBB                Positive  

 

 
256     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

27. Financial instruments and risk management continued

How do we manage liquidity risk?

Management policy

We maintain liquidity by entering into short and long-term financial instruments to support operational and other funding requirements, determined using short and long-term cash forecasts. These forecasts are supplemented by a financial headroom analysis which is used to assess funding adequacy for at least a 12-month period. On at least an annual basis the Board reviews and approves the long-term funding requirements of the group and on an ongoing basis considers any related matters. We manage refinancing risk by limiting the amount of borrowing that matures within any specified period and having appropriate strategies in place to manage refinancing needs as they arise. The maturity profile of our loans and borrowings at 31 March 2018 is disclosed in note 25. We have term debt maturities of £1.6bn in 2018/19.

Our treasury operation reviews and manages our short-term requirements within the parameters of the policies set by the Board. We hold cash, cash equivalents and current investments in order to manage short-term liquidity requirements. At 31 March 2018 we had undrawn committed borrowing facilities of £2.1bn (2016/17: £2.1bn, 2015/16: £1.5bn) maturing in September 2021.

The group has no material debt factoring arrangements in place. In the UK, the group has arranged for a funder to offer a supplier financing scheme to the group’s suppliers. This enables suppliers who sign up to the arrangement to sell their invoices to the funder and to be paid earlier than the invoice due date. The group assesses the arrangement against indicators to assess if debts which vendors have sold to the funder under the supplier financing scheme continue to meet the definition of trade payables or should be classified as borrowings. At 31 March 2018 the payables met the criteria of trade payables.

Maturity analysis

The following table provides an analysis of the remaining contractually-agreed cash flows including interest payable for our non-derivative financial liabilities on an undiscounted basis, which therefore differs from both the carrying value and fair value.

 

Non-derivative financial liabilities

At 31 March 2018

  

Loans and
other
borrowings

£m

      

Interest on

loans

and other

borrowings

£m

    

Trade and
other
payables

£m

      

Provisions

£m

    

Total

£m

 

Due within one year

     2,120          452        4,939          54        7,565  

Between one and two years

     1,192          404                 34        1,630  

Between two and three years

     1,332          365                 25        1,722  

Between three and four years

     18          357                 43        418  

Between four and five years

     1,489          355                 19        1,863  

After five years

     7,899          2,714                 197        10,810  
       14,050          4,647        4,939          372        24,008  

Interest payments not yet accrued

              (4,495                      (4,495

Fair value adjustment

     73                                 73  

Impact of discounting

                              (72      (72

Carrying value on the balance sheeta

     14,123          152        4,939          300        19,514  

Non-derivative financial liabilities

At 31 March 2017

  

Loans and
other
borrowings

£m

      

Interest on

loans

and other

borrowings

£m

    

Trade and
other
payables

£m

      

Provisions

£m

    

Total

£m

 

Due within one year

     2,468          507        5,259          62        8,296  

Between one and two years

     1,614          415                 41        2,070  

Between two and three years

     1,166          364                 21        1,551  

Between three and four years

     1,295          327                 18        1,640  

Between four and five years

     12          319                 17        348  

After five years

     5,844          2,726                 310        8,880  
       12,399          4,658        5,259          469        22,785  

Interest payments not yet accrued

              (4,494                      (4,494

Fair value adjustment

     150                                 150  

Impact of discounting

                              (177      (177

Carrying value on the balance sheeta

     12,549          164        5,259          292        18,264  

 

a Foreign currency-related cash flows were translated at closing rates as at the relevant reporting date. Future variable interest rate cash flows were calculated using the most recent rate applied at the relevant balance sheet date.

 

 
257     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

27. Financial instruments and risk management continued

 

Non-derivative financial liabilities

At 31 March 2016

  

Loans

and other
borrowings

£m

      

Interest on
loans

and other
borrowings

£m

    

Trade
and other
payables

£m

      

Provisions

£m

    

Total

£m

 

Due within one year

     3,558          491        5,301          50        9,400  

Between one and two years

     1,632          435                 30        2,097  

Between two and three years

     1,488          357                 25        1,870  

Between three and four years

     1,103          343                 15        1,461  

Between four and five years

     1,199          308                 16        1,523  

After five years

     5,424          2,885                 326        8,635  
       14,404          4,819        5,301          462        24,986  

Interest payments not yet accrued

              (4,641                      (4,641

Fair value adjustment

     179                                 179  

Impact of discounting

                              (166      (166

Carrying value on the balance sheeta

     14,583          178        5,301          296        20,358  

 

a  Foreign currency-related cash flows were translated at closing rates as at the relevant reporting date. Future variable interest rate cash flows were calculated using the most recent rate applied at the relevant balance sheet date.

Trade and other payables are held at amortised cost. The carrying amount of these balances approximates to fair value due to the short maturity of amounts payable.

The following table provides an analysis of the contractually agreed cash flows in respect of the group’s derivative financial instruments. Cash flows are presented on a net or gross basis in accordance with the settlement arrangements of the instruments.

 

    Derivatives – Analysed by earliest payment datea         Derivatives – Analysed based on holding instrument to maturity  

Derivative financial liabilities

At 31 March 2018

 

Net settled

£m

   

Gross settled
outflows

£m

   

Gross settled
inflows

£m

   

Total

£m

        

Net settled

£m

   

Gross settled
outflows

£m

   

Gross settled

inflows

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Due within one year

    140       587       (547     180         91       587       (547     131  

Between one and two years

    135       183       (166     152         91       183       (166     108  

Between two and three years

    156       442       (446     152         85       69       (47     107  

Between three and four years

    143       52       (29     166         80       68       (47     101  

Between four and five years

    161       52       (29     184         80       68       (47     101  

After five years

    291       2,234       (2,149     376           599       2,575       (2,512     662  

Totalb

    1,026       3,550       (3,366     1,210           1,026       3,550       (3,366     1,210  
    Derivatives – Analysed by earliest payment datea         Derivatives – Analysed based on holding instrument to maturity  

Derivative financial liabilities

At 31 March 2017

 

Net settled

£m

   

Gross settled
outflows

£m

   

Gross settled
inflows

£m

   

Total

£m

        

Net settled

£m

    Gross settled
outflows £m
   

Gross settled

inflows £m

   

Total

£m

 

Due within one year

    291       582       (576     297         92       582       (576     98  

Between one and two years

    296       1,139       (1,097     338         92       1,139       (1,097     134  

Between two and three years

    198                   198         92                   92  

Between three and four years

    114                   114         88                   88  

Between four and five years

    104                   104         83                   83  

After five years

    123                   123           679                   679  

Totalb

    1,126       1,721       (1,673     1,174           1,126       1,721       (1,673     1,174  
    Derivatives – Analysed by earliest payment datea         Derivatives – Analysed based on holding instrument to maturity  

Derivative financial liabilities

At 31 March 2016

 

Net settled

£m

   

Gross settled
outflows

£m

   

Gross settled
inflows

£m

   

Total

£m

        

Net settled

£m

   

Gross settled
outflows

£m

   

Gross settled

inflows

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Due within one year

    268       263       (250     281         91       263       (250     104  

Between one and two years

    386       38       (27     397         88       38       (27     99  

Between two and three years

    371       38       (27     382         88       38       (27     99  

Between three and four years

    60       838       (836     62         90       838       (836     92  

Between four and five years

    81       17       (18     80         84       17       (18     83  

After five years

          165       (180     (15         725       165       (180     710  

Totalb

    1,166       1,359       (1,338     1,187           1,166       1,359       (1,338     1,187  

 

a  Certain derivative financial instruments contain break clauses whereby either the group or bank counterparty can terminate the swap on certain dates and the mark to market position is settled in cash.
b  Foreign currency-related cash flows were translated at closing rates as at the relevant reporting date. Future variable interest rate cash flows were calculated using the most recent rate applied at the relevant balance sheet date.

 

 
258     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

27. Financial instruments and risk management continued

How do we manage credit risk?

Management policy

Our exposure to credit risk arises from financial assets transacted by the treasury operation (primarily derivatives, investments, cash and cash equivalents) and from trading-related receivables.

For treasury-related balances, the Board’s defined policy restricts exposure to any one counterparty by setting credit limits based on the credit quality as defined by Moody’s and S&P. The minimum credit ratings permitted with counterparties in respect of new transactions are A3/A– for long-term and P1/A1 for short-term investments. If counterparties in respect of existing transactions fall below the permitted criteria we will take action where appropriate.

The treasury operation continuously reviews the limits applied to counterparties and will adjust the limit according to the nature and credit standing of the counterparty, and in response to market conditions, up to the maximum allowable limit set by the Board.

Operational management policy

Our credit policy for trading-related financial assets is applied and managed by each of the customer-facing units to ensure compliance. The policy requires that the creditworthiness and financial strength of customers are assessed at inception and on an ongoing basis. Payment terms are set in accordance with industry standards. Where appropriate, we may minimise risks by requesting securities such as deposits, guarantees and letters of credit. We take proactive steps including constantly reviewing credit ratings of counterparties to minimise the impact of adverse market conditions on trading-related financial assets.

Exposures

The maximum credit risk exposure of the group’s financial assets at the balance sheet date is as follows:

 

At 31 March    Notes            

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Derivative financial assets

          1,509          2,246          1,639  

Investments

     23          3,075          1,564          2,964  

Trade and other receivablesa

     17          2,518          2,729          2,875  

Cash and cash equivalents

     24                528          528          996  
                              7,630                  7,067                  8,474  

 

a  The carrying amount excludes £317m (2016/17: £360m, 2015/16: £218m) of non-current trade and other receivables which relate to non-financial assets, and £1,496m (2016/17: £1,106m, 2015/16: £1,103m) of prepayments and other receivables.

The credit quality and credit concentration of cash equivalents, current asset investments and derivative financial assets are detailed in the tables below. Where the opinion of Moody’s and S&P differ, the lower rating is used.

 

Moody’s/S&P credit rating of counterparty  

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Aa2/AA and above

    2,575          1,444          2,878  

Aa3/AA–

    313          208          120  

A1/A+a

    651          952          64  

A2/Aa

    628          370          939  

A3/A–a

    180          204          160  

Baa1/BBB+a

    59          561          492  

Baa2/BBB and belowa

    207          86           
              4,613          3,825          4,653  

 

a  We hold cash collateral of £492m (2016/17: £702m, 2015/16: £553m) in respect of derivative financial assets with certain counterparties.

The concentration of credit risk for our trading balances is provided in note 17, which analyses outstanding balances by customer-facing unit. Where multiple transactions are undertaken with a single financial counterparty or group of related counterparties, we enter into netting arrangements to reduce our exposure to credit risk by making use of standard International Swaps and Derivatives Association (ISDA) documentation. We have also entered into credit support agreements with certain swap counterparties whereby, on a daily, weekly and monthly basis, the fair value position on notional £3,162m of long dated cross-currency swaps and interest rate swaps is collateralised. The related net cash outflow during the year was £220m (2016/17: inflow £100m, 2015/16: inflow £79m). The collateral paid and received is recognised within current asset investments and loans and other borrowings, respectively.

 

 
259     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

27. Financial instruments and risk management continued

Offsetting of financial instruments

The table below shows our financial assets and liabilities that are subject to offset in the group’s balance sheet and the impact of enforceable master netting or similar agreements.

 

                  Related amounts not set off in the balance sheet    

Financial assets and liabilities

At 31 March 2018

  

Amounts
presented in the
balance sheet

£m

         

Right of set off
with derivative
counterparties

£m

   

Cash

collateral

£m

   

Net

amount

£m

 

Derivative financial assets

     1,509          (754     (492     263  

Derivative financial liabilities

     (837          754       60       (23

Total

     672                  (432     240  
                Related amounts not set off in the balance sheet  

Financial assets and liabilities

At 31 March 2017

  

Amounts
presented in the
balance sheet

£m

         

Right of set off
with derivative
counterparties

£m

   

Cash

collateral

£m

   

Net

amount

£m

 

Derivative financial assets

     2,246          (693     (702     851  

Derivative financial liabilities

     (903          693       64       (146

Total

     1,343                  (638     705  
                Related amounts not set off in the balance sheet  

Financial assets and liabilities

At 31 March 2016

   Amounts
presented in the
balance sheet
£m
         

Right of set off
with derivative
counterparties

£m

   

Cash

            collateral

£m

   

Net

                 amount

£m

 

Derivative financial assets

     1,639          (456     (553     630  

Derivative financial liabilities

     (911          456       40       (415

Total

     728                  (513     215  

Derivatives

All of our derivative financial instruments are held at fair value on the balance sheet. The fair values of outstanding swaps and foreign exchange contracts are estimated using discounted cash flow models and market rates of interest and foreign exchange at the balance sheet date.

 

At 31 March 2018     

Current
asset

£m

      

Non-current

asset

£m

      

Current

liability

£m

      

Non-current

liability

£m

 

Designated in a cash flow hedge

       187          1,061          41          587  

Other

       10          251          9          200  

Total derivatives

       197          1,312          50          787  
At 31 March 2017     

Current

asset

£m

      

Non-current
asset

£m

       Current
liability
£m
      

Non-current

liability

£m

 

Designated in a cash flow hedge

       417          1,508          25          616  

Other

       11          310          9          253  

Total derivatives

       428          1,818          34          869  
At 31 March 2016     

Current

asset

£m

      

Non-current

asset

£m

      

Current

liability

£m

      

Non-current

liability

£m

 

Designated in a cash flow hedge

       166          1,158          40          618  

Other

       11          304          8          245  

Total derivatives

       177          1,462          48          863  

All derivative financial instruments are categorised at Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy as defined in note 23, with the exception of a derivative energy contract which is classified at Level 3. The energy derivative was renegotiated during 2016/17 and has been designated as a cash flow hedge. On initial recognition of this contract a loss of £8m was deferred. The fair value of the energy derivative at 31 March 2018 was a liability of £1m (2016/17: liability of £8m, 2015/16: £nil ). It has been valued using assumptions on volumes, inflation and energy prices.

 

 
260     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

27. Financial instruments and risk management continued

Hedging activities

Derivatives may qualify as hedges for accounting purposes if they meet the criteria for designation as fair value hedges or cash flow hedges in accordance with IAS 39.

Cash flow hedges

Instruments designated in a cash flow hedge include interest rate swaps and cross-currency swaps hedging Euro- and US Dollar-denominated borrowings. Forward currency contracts are taken out to hedge step-up interest on currency denominated borrowings relating to the group’s 2030 US Dollar bond. The hedged cash flows will affect the group’s income statement as interest and principal amounts are repaid over the remaining term of the borrowings (see note 25).

We hedge forecast foreign currency purchases, principally denominated in US Dollar, Euro and Asia Pacific currencies 12 months forward with certain specific transactions hedged further forward. The related cash flows are recognised in the income statement over this period.

All cash flow hedges were effective in the period. See note 28 for details of the movements in the cash flow reserve.

Other derivatives

Our policy is not to use derivatives for speculative purposes. However, due to the complex nature of hedge accounting under IAS 39, some derivatives may not qualify for hedge accounting, or are specifically not designated as a hedge where natural offset is more appropriate. Derivative instruments that do not qualify for hedge accounting are classified as held for trading and held at fair value through profit or loss under IAS 39.

28. Other reserves

 

                   Other comprehensive income               
      

Capital

  redemption

reserve

£m

 

 

 

 

             

  Cash flow

reserve

£m

 

 a 

 

   

  Available-

for-sale

reserve

£m

 

 

 b 

 

   

  Translation

reserve

£m

 

 c 

 

            
        Total
£m
 
 

At 1 April 2015

     27           55       18       402          502  

Exchange differencesd

                           29          29  

Net fair value gain on cash flow hedges

               381                      381  

Recognised in income and expense

               (230                    (230

Fair value movement on available-for-sale assets

                     (2              (2

Tax recognised in other comprehensive income

                     (33           38                5  

At 1 April 2016

     27                 173       16       469                685  

Exchange differencesd

                           227          227  

Net fair value gain on cash flow hedges

               884                      884  

Recognised in income and expense

               (938                    (938

Fair value movement on available-for-sale assets

                     (3              (3

Tax recognised in other comprehensive income

                     8             21                29  

At 31 March 2017

     27                 127       13       717                884  

Exchange differencesd

                           (188        (188

Net fair value loss on cash flow hedges

               (368                    (368

Recognised in income and expense

               277                      277  

Fair value movement on available-for-sale assets

                     11                11  

Tax recognised in other comprehensive income

               10             (9        1  

Transfer to realised profit

                     (83                          (83

At 31 March 2018

     27                 (37     24       520                534  

 

a  The cash flow reserve is used to record the effective portion of the cumulative net change in the fair value of cash flow hedging instruments related to hedged transactions that have not yet occurred. Amounts ‘recognised in income and expense’ include a net credit to the cash flow reserve of £295m (2016/17: charge of £941m, 2015/16: charge of £255m) relating to fair value movements on derivatives. The items generating these foreign exchange movements are in designated cash flow hedge relationships.
b  The available-for-sale reserve is used to record the cumulative fair value gains and losses on available-for-sale financial assets. The cumulative gains and losses are recycled to the income statement on disposal of the assets.
c  The translation reserve is used to record cumulative translation differences on the net assets of foreign operations. The cumulative translation differences are recycled to the income statement on disposal of the foreign operation.
d  Excludes £1m (2016/17: £10m, 2015/16: £nil) of exchange differences in relation to retained earnings attributed to non-controlling interests.

29. Related party transactions

Key management personnel comprise executive and non-executive directors and members of the Executive Committee. Compensation of key management personnel is disclosed in note 5.

Amounts paid to the group’s retirement benefit plans are set out in note 20.

 

 
261     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

30. Financial commitments and contingent liabilities

Financial commitments were as follows:

 

At 31 March   

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

 

Capital commitments

     993        889  

Other commitments

     362        367  

Device purchase commitments

     262        423  

TV programme rights commitments

     2,823        2,644  

Total

               4,440                  4,323  

TV programme rights commitments, mainly relating to football broadcast rights, are those for which the licence period has not yet started.

Future minimum operating lease payments were as follows:

 

  Payable in the year ending 31 March:

  

2018

£m

    

2017

£m

 

2018

            650  

2019

     600        610  

2020

     550        558  

2021

     513        532  

2022

     486        505  

2023

     463        475  

Thereafter

     3,985        3,830  

Total future minimum operating lease payments

               6,597                  7,160  

Operating lease commitments were mainly in respect of land and buildings which arose from a sale and operating leaseback transaction in 2001. Leases have an average term of 14 years (2016/17: 15 years) and rentals are fixed for an average of 14 years (2016/17: 15 years).

Other than as disclosed below, there were no contingent liabilities or guarantees at 31 March 2018 other than those arising in the ordinary course of the group’s business and on these no material losses are anticipated. We have insurance cover to certain limits for major risks on property and major claims in connection with legal liabilities arising in the course of our operations. Otherwise, the group generally carries its own risks.

Commitments and guarantees

BDUK

Under the Broadband Delivery UK programme, grants received by the group may be subject to reinvestment or repayment to the local authority depending on the level of take-up.

Telefónica UK Limited leases

We’ve provided guarantees relating to certain leases entered into by Telefónica UK Limited (formerly O2 UK Limited) prior to the demerger of mmO2 from BT on 19 November 2001. mmO2 plc (now part of the Telefónica Group) has given BT a counter indemnity for these guarantees. There is no exposure in the event of credit default in respect of amounts used to defease future lease obligations. The guarantee lasts until Telefónica UK Limited has discharged all its obligations.

Legal proceedings

The group is involved in various legal proceedings, including actual or threatened litigation, and government or regulatory investigations. However, save as disclosed below, the group does not currently believe that there are any legal proceedings, or government or regulatory investigations that may have a material adverse impact on the operations or financial condition of the group. In respect of each of the claims below, the nature and progression of such proceedings and investigations can make it difficult to predict the impact they will have on the group. There are many reasons why we cannot make these assessments with certainty, including, among others, that they are in early stages, no damages or remedies have been specified, and/or the often slow pace of litigation.

Italian business

Following the group’s announcement with respect to our investigation into our Italian business in January 2017, three purported securities class action complaints were filed against the company and certain current and former officers in United States courts. The two actions brought in New York have since been voluntarily dismissed by the plaintiffs in those actions. On 21 November 2017, the lead plaintiff in the District of New Jersey action filed an amended complaint brought on behalf of purchasers of BT Group ADRs between May 2013 and January 2017, regarding allegations that the company made materially false and/or misleading statements during the class period. On 22 January 2018 we filed our motion to dismiss the amended complaint and the plaintiffs filed their reply to that motion on 23 March 2018. We filed our response to their reply on 7 May 2018 and expect the court to schedule oral argument on the motion.

 

 
262     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

30. Financial commitments and contingent liabilities continued

The issues in Italy have also resulted in engagement with certain of our regulators and other authorities. We are cooperating fully with these bodies.

Phones 4U

In December 2016, the administrators of Phones 4U Limited (P4U) started legal proceedings in the High Court in the United Kingdom against EE, claiming payments under a retail trading agreement for sums then due in respect of revenues (net of costs) from certain customers prior to P4U entering administration. This sharing of revenue under the retail trading agreement was due to continue until September 2019, with related payments continuing until April 2021. On 8 May 2018 we reached a confidential agreement with the administrators of P4U to settle this matter. This settlement is in line with the accruals we held to cover potential payments required by EE.

Since 2015 the administrators have separately made allegations that EE and other mobile network operators colluded to procure P4U’s insolvency. We dispute these allegation vigorously and to date no proceedings have been issued.

Hutchinson 3G Limited

In May 2016, Hutchinson 3G Limited (H3G) brought legal proceedings in the High Court in the United Kingdom against EE, alleging breach of contract relating to alleged delays in the roll out of certain free carrier coverage to H3G. H3G is entitled to this free carrier coverage under arrangements agreed following the merger of Orange and T-Mobile, predecessors of EE. H3G claimed damages relating to loss of business of £167m. During the year the parties have resolved this matter to their mutual satisfaction and have discontinued the High Court proceedings.

Brazilian tax claims

The Brazilian state tax authorities have made tax demands against certain Brazilian subsidiaries relating to the Tax on Distribution of Goods and Services (ICMS), an indirect tax imposed on the provision of telecommunications services in Brazil. The state tax authorities are seeking to impose ICMS on revenues earned on activities that the company does not consider as being part of the provision of telecommunications services, such as equipment rental and managed services. We have disputed the basis on which ICMS is imposed and the rate which the tax authorities are seeking to apply. We currently have 32 ICMS cases with a current potential value of £219m all covering assessments made for the period up to 2012, except for one case valued at £1.2m that covers the period 2013 to 2016. The judicial process is likely to take many years. There are eight cases, worth approximately £43m, that are pending appeal before the Sao Paulo Court of Appeal. A hearing for these eight cases took place on 21 February 2018 and a further hearing will take place in the coming months.

Regulatory matters

In respect of regulatory risks, the group provides for anticipated costs where an outflow of resources is considered probable and a reasonable estimate can be made of the likely outcome. Estimates are used in assessing the likely value of the regulatory risk. The ultimate liability may vary from the amounts provided and will be dependent upon the eventual outcome of any settlement.

We hold provisions for regulatory risks. These provisions cover the following issues:

Deemed Consent

Deemed Consent is an agreed process between Openreach and its Communications Provider (CP) customers, which allows Openreach to halt the installation and reschedule the delivery date for providing dedicated business services (known as Ethernet) in a number of specific circumstances where it is beyond its control. Ofcom found that Openreach had breached its contractual and regulatory obligations by inadequately and retrospectively applying Deemed Consent to reduce compensation payments to CPs between January 2013 and December 2014.

We continue to estimate the total compensation payments will amount to around £300m. However, the precise amount will result from discussions with affected parties, and could result in lower or higher payments.

Other regulatory matters

The remaining provision reflects management’s estimates of regulatory risks across a range of issues, including price and service issues. The precise outcome of each matter depends on whether it becomes an active issue, and the extent to which negotiation or regulatory decisions will result in financial settlement.

 

 
263     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

31. Post balance sheet events

Changes to our segments

From 1 April 2018, our existing BT Consumer and EE divisions have been brought together into a combined division, Consumer, to drive converged products and accelerate transformation. From 1 October 2018, our existing Business and Public Sector and Wholesale and Ventures divisions will be brought together into a combined division, Enterprise, to accelerate transformation, simplify our operating model and strengthen accountabilities.

These businesses operated and were reported separately throughout 2017/18 and therefore have been presented as separate operating segments throughout these accounts.

These organisational changes do not impact the results of Global Services or Openreach and there is no impact on the total group results, balance sheet or cash flows. There are no internal revenue and costs between EE and BT Consumer. In 2017/18, there were £32m (2016/17: £22m, 2015/16: £24m) of internal revenue and costs between Business and Public Sector and Wholesale and Ventures.

We have set out below the segment analysis outlining the impacts of this change that will be applicable to the annual financial statements for 2018/19. Full details of the internal revenue and costs at the disaggregated level are provided in Note 4.

Segment revenue and profit

 

Year ended 31 March 2018

  

    Consumer

£m

   

      Enterprise

£m

   

Global

      Services

£m

   

      Openreach

£m

   

            Other

£m

   

              Total

£m

 

Segment revenue

     10,360       6,540       5,013       5,123       8       27,044  

Internal revenue

     (103     (217           (2,978           (3,298

Revenue from external customersa

     10,257       6,323       5,013       2,145       8       23,746  

EBITDAb

     2,376       2,172       434       2,520       3       7,505  

Depreciation and amortisation

     (992     (676     (424     (1,360     (62     (3,514

Operating profit (loss)a

     1,384       1,496       10       1,160       (59     3,991  

Specific items

               (610

Operating profit

               3,381  

Net finance expensec

               (764

Share of post tax loss of associates and joint ventures

                                             (1

Profit before tax

                                             2,616  

Year ended 31 March 2017

  

Consumer

£m

   

Enterprise

£m

   

Global

Services

£m

   

Openreach

£m

   

Other

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Segment revenue

     10,024       6,845       5,479       5,098       10       27,456  

Internal revenue

     (100     (238           (3,036           (3,374

Revenue from external customersa

     9,924       6,607       5,479       2,062       10       24,082  

EBITDAb

     2,168       2,362       495       2,633       (13     7,645  

Depreciation and amortisation

     (989     (658     (439     (1,369     (55     (3,510

Operating profit (loss)a

     1,179       1,704       56       1,264       (68     4,135  

Specific items

               (968

Operating profit

               3,167  

Net finance expensec

               (804

Share of post tax loss of associates and joint ventures

                                             (9

Profit before tax

                                             2,354  

 

a Before specific items.
b EBITDA is stated before specific items and is the group’s profitability measure for segments.
c Net finance expense includes specific item expense of £218m (2016/17: £210m, 2015/16: £229m).

 

 
264     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

31. Post balance sheet events continued

 

Year ended 31 March 2016

  

    Consumer

£m

   

      Enterprise

£m

   

Global

      Services

£m

   

      Openreach

£m

   

            Other

£m

   

              Total

£m

 

Segment revenue

     5,449       6,544       5,074       5,100       11       22,178  

Internal revenue

     (72     (169           (3,058           (3,299

Revenue from external customersa

     5,377       6,375       5,074       2,042       11       18,879  

EBITDAb

     1,228       2,169       479       2,659       (76     6,459  

Depreciation and amortisation

     (353     (537     (422     (1,301     (18     (2,631

Operating profit (loss)a

     875       1,632       57       1,358       (94     3,828  

Specific items

               (215

Operating profit

               3,613  

Net finance expensec

               (712

Share of post tax loss of associates and joint ventures

                                             6  

Profit before tax

                                             2,907  

a  Before specific items.

b  EBITDA is stated before specific items and is the group’s profitability measure for segments.

c Net finance expense includes specific item expense of £218m (2016/17: £210m, 2015/16: £229m).

 

Internal revenue and costs

 

   

   

  

 

     

Year ended 31 March 2018

  

Consumer

£m

   

Enterprise

£m

   

Global

Services

£m

   

Openreach

£m

   

Other

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Internal revenue recorded by

            

Consumer

           65       20             18       103  

Enterprise

     67             42       42       66       217  

Global Services

                                    

Openreach

     896       442       125             1,515       2,978  

Total

     963       507       187       42       1,599       3,298  

Year ended 31 March 2017

  

Consumer

£m

   

Enterprise

£m

   

Global

Services

£m

   

Openreach

£m

   

Other

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Internal revenue recorded by

            

Consumer

           62       20             18       100  

Enterprise

     63             62       39       74       238  

Global Services

                                    

Openreach

     910       496       158             1,472       3,036  

Total

     973       558       240       39       1,564       3,374  

Year ended 31 March 2016

  

Consumer

£m

   

Enterprise

£m

   

Global

Services

£m

   

Openreach

£m

   

Other

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Internal revenue recorded by

            

Consumer

           31       23             18       72  

Enterprise

     73             40       56             169  

Global Services

                                    

Openreach

     905       526       173             1,454       3,058  

Total

     978       557       236       56       1,472       3,299  
Capital expenditure             

Year ended 31 March 2018

  

Consumer

£m

   

Enterprise

£m

   

Global

Services

£m

   

Openreach

£m

   

Other

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Intangible assets

     236       180       92       70       64       642  

Property, plant and equipment

     683       353       186       1,588       70       2,880  

Capital expenditurea

     919       533       278       1,658       134       3,522  

Year ended 31 March 2017

  

Consumer

£m

   

Enterprise

£m

   

Global

Services

£m

   

Openreach

£m

   

Other

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Intangible assets

     225       141       126       74       55       621  

Property, plant and equipment

     628       360       235       1,499       111       2,833  

Capital expenditurea

     853       501       361       1,573       166       3,454  

 

a Net of government grants.

 

 
265     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the consolidated financial statements continued

    

    

 

31. Post balance sheet events continued

 

Year ended 31 March 2016

  

    Consumer

£m

    

      Enterprise

£m

    

Global

      Services

£m

    

      Openreach

£m

    

            Other

£m

    

              Total

£m

 

Intangible assets

     117        106        62        62        65        412  

Property, plant and equipment

     186        256        293        1,385        90        2,210  

Capital expenditurea

     303        362        355        1,447        155        2,622  

 

a  Net of government grants.

As at 31 March 2018, Consumer had 18,200 (2016/17: 17,900, 2015/16: 15,700) employees and an average of 18,000 (2016/17: 16,800, 2015/16: 7,600) for the year on a full-time equivalent basis. Enterprise had 13,900 as at 31 March 2018 (2016/17: 14,100, 2015/16: 14,000) and an average of 14,200 for the year ended 31 March 2018 (2016/17: 13,900, 2015/16: 13,100).

Consumer had trade receivables not passed due of £363m (2016/17: £463m, 2015/16: £405m) and accrued income of £208m (2016/17: £260m, 2015/16: £395m) as at 31 March 2018. Enterprise had trade receivables not passed due of £345m (2016/17: £275m, 2015/16: £191m) and accrued income of £279m (2016/17: £318m, 2015/16: £245m).

Contingent liabilities

Since the reporting date, we have reached a confidential settlement with the administrators of P4U regarding its claim for revenue share which relates to certain customers prior to P4U insolvency. This settlement is in line with the accruals we held to cover potential payments required by EE.

Acquisition of spectrum

In April 2018 we secured 40MHz of 3.4GHz spectrum at a cost of £304m allowing us to progress with our 5G plans and strengthening our position as the mobile network leader. The spectrum auction bidding cut across the 2017/18 and 2018/19 financial years. We had £325m on deposit with Ofcom at 31 March 2018, the excess deposit balance of £21m has since been refunded.

Strategy update

In May 2018 we are announcing an update to our strategy to accelerate leadership in converged connectivity and services. Our strategy will drive sustainable growth in value by focusing on delivering differentiated customer experiences, investing in integrated network leadership, and transforming our operating model and includes the repositioning of Global Services as a more focused digital business. This also includes the next phase of our restructuring programme. This programme involves the reduction of c13,000 mainly back office and middle management roles at a cost of £800m with a two-year payback and expected year three cash cost reduction of £1.5bn. The balances of the first phase of our restructuring programme (£60m of cost and removal of 1,200 FTE roles) and our EE integration programme (further run rate synergies of £110m) are included in this wider transformation programme.

Triennial valuation of BT Pension Scheme

In May 2018 we concluded the 30 June 2017 triennial valuation of the BT Pension Scheme. Details are set out in note 20.

 

 
266     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

Financial Statements of BT Group plc

BT Group plc company balance sheet

Registered number 04190816

 

At 31 March

  

Notes

                    

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

 

Non-current assets

             

Investments

     2                10,885       10,801  

Trade and other receivablesa

                                6,928       6,783  
                                        17,813                 17,584  

Current assets

             

Trade and other receivablesa

              112       283  

Cash and cash equivalents

                                6       2  
                                  118       285  

Current liabilities

             

Trade and other payablesb

                                75       78  
                                  75       78  

Total assets less current liabilities

                                17,856       17,791  

Non-current liabilities

             

Loans and other borrowingsc

                                2,983       1,371  
                                  2,983       1,371  

Equity

             

Ordinary shares

              499       499  

Share premium

              1,051       1,051  

Capital redemption reserve

              27       27  

Merger reserve

     3                5,649       5,649  

Own shares

              (186     (96

Retained profitd

                                7,833       9,290  

Total equity

                                14,873       16,420  
                                  17,856       17,791  

 

a  Trade and other receivables primarily relate to a £1,010m equity placing raised in February 2015 and net proceeds of £7,507m, before £3m of issue costs, relating to the sale of EE to British Telecommunications plc on 29 January 2016, subsequently £1,775m of the loan receivable relating to the sale of EE has been repaid. The balance consists of two loans to group undertakings of £1,044m (2016/17: £1,024m) repayable on 31 January 2058 and £5,884m (2016/17: £5,578m) repayable on 21 December 2064. The loans attract interest of LIBOR plus 90 basis points (2016/17: Libor plus 90 basis points). Accrued interest of £112m (2016/17: £150m) is included in current trade and other receivables.
b  Trade and other payables consists of loans from group undertakings of £34m (2016/17: £32m) and other creditors of £41m (2016/17: £46m).
c  Loans and other borrowings consist of a loan from group undertakings of £2,983m (2016/17: £1,371m). The loan is repayable on 31 January 2058 and attracts interest of LIBOR plus 90 basis points (2016/17: LIBOR plus 90 basis points).
d  As permitted by Section 408(3) of the Companies Act 2006, no profit and loss account of the company is presented. The profit for the financial year, dealt with in the profit and loss account of the company was £61m (2016/17: £97m).

The financial statements of the company on pages 267 to 270 were approved by the Board of Directors on 9 May 2018 and were signed on its behalf by:

Jan du Plessis

Chairman

Gavin Patterson

Chief Executive

Simon Lowth

Chief Financial Officer

 

 
267     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

BT Group plc company statement of changes in equity

 

       Note      

Called up share

capital

£m

 

 a 

 

   

Share

premium

account

£m

 

 

 

 

   

Capital

redemption

reserve

£m

 

 

 

 

   

Merger

reserve

£m

 

 

 

   

Own shares

£m

 b 

 

   

Profit

and loss

account

£m

 

 

 b,c 

 

   

Total

£m

 

 

At 1 April 2016

       499       1,051       27       7,424       (115     8,952         17,838  

Profit for the financial year

                                     97       97  

Transfer to realised profit

     3                         (1,775           1,775        

Dividends paid

                                     (1,436     (1,436

Capital contribution in respect of share-based payments

                                     57       57  

Net buyback of own shares

                                     19       (155     (136

At 1 April 2017

       499       1,051       27       5,649       (96     9,290       16,420  

Profit for the financial year

                                     61       61  

Dividends paid

                                     (1,524     (1,524

Capital contribution in respect of share-based payments

                                     84       84  

Net buyback of own shares

                                     (90     (78     (168

At 31 March 2018

             499       1,051       27       5,649       (186     7,833       14,873  

 

a  The allotted, called up and fully paid ordinary share capital of the company at 31 March 2018 was £499m (31 March 2017: £499m), representing 9,968,127,681 (31 March 2017: 9,968,127,681) ordinary shares of 5p each.
b  In 2017/18, 38,627,352 shares (2016/17: 49,758,963) were issued from Own shares to satisfy obligations under employee share schemes and executive share awards at a cost of £130m (2016/17: £225m). At 31 March 2018, 59,249,666 shares (31 March 2017: 21,993,165) with an aggregate nominal value of £1m (31 March 2017: £1m) were held as part of Own shares at cost.
c  As permitted by Section 408(3) of the Companies Act 2006, no profit and loss account of the company is presented. The profit for the financial year, dealt with in the profit and loss account of the company was £61m (2016/17: £97m).

 

 
268     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

Notes to the company financial statements

 

1. BT Group plc accounting policies

Principal activity

The principal activity of the company is to act as ultimate holding company of the BT group.

Accounting basis

As used in these financial statements and associated notes, the term ‘company’ refers to BT Group plc (a public company limited by shares). These separate financial statements of the company are prepared in accordance with, and presented as required by, the Companies Act 2006 as applicable to companies using Financial Reporting Standard 101 (FRS 101). These financial statements have been prepared in accordance with FRS 101. FRS 101 incorporates, with limited amendments, International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS).

Financial statements

The financial statements are prepared on a going concern basis and under the historical cost convention.

As permitted by Section 408(3) of the Companies Act 2006, the company’s profit and loss account has not been presented.

New and amended accounting standards

effective during the year

There have been no new or amended accounting standards or interpretations adopted during the year that have a significant impact on the financial statements.

Exemptions

As permitted by FRS 101, the company has taken advantage of the disclosure exemptions available under that standard in relation to business combinations, share-based payments, non-current assets held for sale, financial instruments, capital management, and presentation of comparative information in respect of certain assets, presentation of a cash flow statement, standards not yet effective, impairment of assets and related party transactions. The company intends to continue to take advantage of these exemptions in future years. Further detail is provided below.

Where required, equivalent disclosures have been given in the consolidated financial statements of BT Group plc.

The BT Group plc consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 March 2018 contain a consolidated cash flow statement. Consequently, as permitted by IAS 7 ‘Statement of Cash flow’, the company has not presented its own cash flow statement.

The BT Group plc consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 March 2018 contain related party disclosures.

Consequently, the company has taken advantage of the exemption in IAS 24, ‘Related Party Disclosures’ not to disclose transactions with other members of the BT Group. The BT Group plc consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 March 2018 contain financial instrument disclosures which comply with IFRS 7, ‘Financial Instruments: Disclosures’. Consequently, the company is exempt from the disclosure requirements of IFRS 7 in respect of its financial instruments.

Investments

Investments are stated at cost and reviewed for impairment if there are indicators that the carrying value may not be recoverable. An impairment loss is recognised to the extent that the carrying amount cannot be recovered either by selling the asset or by continuing to hold the asset and benefiting from the net present value of the future cash flows of the investment.

Taxation

Full provision is made for deferred taxation on all temporary differences which have arisen but not reversed at the balance sheet date. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is regarded as more likely than not that there will be sufficient taxable profits from which the underlying timing differences can be deducted. The deferred tax balances are not discounted.

Dividends

Dividend distributions are recognised as a liability in the year in which the dividends are approved by the company’s shareholders. Interim dividends are recognised when they are paid; final dividends when authorised in general meetings by shareholders. Dividend income is recognised on receipt.

Share capital

Ordinary shares are classified as equity. Repurchased shares of the company are recorded in the balance sheet as part of Own shares and presented as a deduction from shareholders’ equity at cost.

Cash

Cash includes cash on hand and bank deposits repayable on demand.

Share-based payments

The company does not incur a charge for share-based payments. However, the issuance by the company of share options and awards to employees of its subsidiaries represents additional capital contributions to its subsidiaries. An addition to the company’s investment in subsidiaries is recorded with a corresponding increase in equity shareholders’ funds. The additional capital contribution is determined based on the fair value of options and awards at the date of grant and is recognised over the vesting period.

 

 

 
269     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes to the company financial statements continued

    

    

 

2. Investments

 

Cost   

Total

£m

 

At 1 April 2016

     10,744  

Additions

     57  

At 31 March 2017

     10,801  

Additions

     84  

At 31 March 2018

                 10,885  

Additions of £84m (2016/17: £57m) comprise capital contributions in respect of share-based payments.

The company held a 100% investment in BT Group Investments Limited, a company registered in England and Wales, throughout 2017/18 and 2016/17.

3. Merger reserve

On 29 January 2016, the company issued 1,594,900,429 ordinary shares of 5p at 470.70p per share resulting in a total of £80m being credited to the share capital.

These shares were used as part consideration for the acquisition of EE, which completed on 29 January 2016. As a result of this transaction, a merger reserve was created of £7,424m net of £3m issue costs. The acquisition of EE was structured by way of a share-for-share exchange. This transaction fell within the provisions of Section 612 of the Companies Act 2006 (merger relief) such that no share premium was recorded in respect of the shares issued. The company chose to record its investment in EE at fair value and therefore recorded a merger reserve equal to the value of the share premium which would have been recorded had Section 612 of the Companies Act 2006 not been applicable ie equal to the difference between the fair value of EE and the aggregate nominal value of the shares issued).

This merger reserve was initially considered unrealised on the basis it was represented by the investment in EE. This was not considered to represent qualifying consideration (in accordance with Tech 02/10 (Guidance on the determination of realised profits and losses in the context of distributions under the Companies Act 2006)), as superseded by Tech 02/17 (Guidance on realised and distributable profits under the Companies Act 2006).

Immediately following the acquisition of EE, the company’s investment in EE was transferred to BT in exchange for an intercompany loan. To the extent the loan is settled in qualifying consideration, the related proportion of the merger reserve is considered realised. Hence the merger reserve is an unrealised reserve until it is realised by the settlement of the intercompany loan by qualifying consideration.

4. Other information

Dividends

The Board recommends that a final dividend in respect of the year ended 31 March 2018 of 10.55p per share will be paid to shareholders on 3 September 2018, taking the full year proposed dividend in respect of 2017/18 to 15.4p (2016/17: 15.4p, 2015/16: 14.0p) which amounts to approximately £1,524m (2016/17: £1,532m, 2015/16: £1,324m). This final dividend is subject to approval by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting and therefore the liability of approximately £1,044m (2016/17: £1,050m, 2015/16: £954m) has not been included in these financial statements. The proposed dividend will be payable to all shareholders on the Register of Members on 10 August 2018.

Employees

The chairman, the executive directors and the group general counsel and company secretary of BT Group plc were the only employees of the company during 2017/18 and 2016/17. The costs relating to qualifying services provided to the company’s principal subsidiary, British Telecommunications plc, are recharged to that company.

 

 
270     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

Related undertakings

Subsidiaries

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

Held directly

           

BT Group Investments Limited

  Holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Held via other group companies

           

British Telecommunications plc

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

América Inalámbrica S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Calle 113, 7 - 21 Piso 11, Torre A. Oficina 1112, Bogota, Colombia

Atlanet SpA

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   99% ordinary   Via Pianezza n° 123, Torino, Italy

Autumnwindow Limited

  Property company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Autumnwindow No.2 Limited

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Autumnwindow No.3 Limited

  Property company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

B. Telecomunicações, Cabo Verde, Sociedade Unipessoal, SA

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   Avenida Andrade Corvo, 30, Praia, CP63, Cabo Verde

B.T. Communication Israel Ltd

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Beit Oz, 14 Abba Hillel Silver Rd, Ramat Gan, 52506, Israel

Basictel SpA

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   99% ordinary   Via Tucidide 56, Torre 7, 20134, Milano, Italy

Belmullet Limited

  Investment company   100% ordinary   Third Floor, St Georges Court, Upper Church Street, Douglas, IM1 1EE, Isle of Man

BPSLP Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Bruning Limited

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT (Barbados) Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   The Gabbles, Haggatt Hall, St Michael, Barbados

BT (Germany) GmbH & Co. oHG

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   Barthstraße 4, 80339, Munich, Germany

BT (Gibraltar) Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   Montagu Pavilion, 8-10 Queensway, Gibraltar

BT (India) Private Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   11th Floor, Eros Corporate Tower, Opp. International Trade Tower, Nehru Place, New Delhi, 110019, India

BT (India) Private Limited Singapore Branchb

  Trade and export of network IT equipment   100% –   8 Changi Business Park Ave (South Tower), #08-51 UE Bizhub East, Singapore, 486018, Singapore

BT (International) Holdings Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT (International) Holdings Limited (Jordan)

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Al Mirad Building – Second Floor, Wadi Saqra Street Amman – P.O.Box 962178 Amman 11196, Jordan

BT (Netherlands) Holdings B.V.

  Holding company   100% ordinary   Minerva & Mercurius building, Herikerbergweg 2, 1101CM, Amsterdam Zuidoost, Netherlands

BT (Nigeria) Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   ADOL House, 15 CIPM Avenue, Central Business District, Alausa, Ikeja, Lagos, Nigeria

BT (RRS LP) Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

 

 
271     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Related undertakings continued

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT (SL) Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   84 Dundas Street, Freetown, Sierra Leone

BT (Vietnam) Co. Ltd.

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   16th Floor, Saigon Tower, 29 Le Duan Road, District 1 Ho Chi Minh City, Socialist Republic of Vietnam

BT Albania Limited SH.P.K

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   Rr. Murat Toptani, Eurocol Center, Kati 8, Tirana, Albania

BT Algeria Communications SARL

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   20 Micro zone d’Activités Dar El Madina, Bloc B, Loc N01 Hydra, Alger, 16000, Algeria

BT Americas Holdings Inc.

  Holding company   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Americas Inc.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Argentina S.R.L.

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   Lola Mora 421, 15th Floor, Puerto Madero, Buenos Aires, C1107DDA, Argentina

BT Australasia Pty Limited

  Communications related services and products provider  

100% ordinary

100% preference

  Level 1, 76 Berry Street, North Sydney NSW 2060, Australia

BT Australasia Pty Limited – New Zealand Branchb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   c/- BDO Auckland, Level 4, 4 Graham Street, Auckland, 1010, New Zealand

BT Austria GmbH

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Louis-Häfliger-Gasse 10, 1210, Wien, Austria

BT Azerbaijan Limited, Limited Liability Company

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   The Landmark III Building, 8th Floor, c/o Deloitte & Touche, 96 Nizami Street, Baku, AZ 1010, Azerbaijan

BT Belgrade d.o.o

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Dimitrija Georgijevica Starike 20, Belgrade, 11070, Serbia, Republic of

BT BELRUS Foreign Limited Liability Company

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   58 Voronyanskogo St, Office 89, Minsk 220007, Belarus

BT Bilisim Hizmetleri Anonim Şirketi

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Yenisahra Mahallesi, Yavuz Selim Caddesi No 19/A, Atasehir, Istanbul, Turkey

BT Brasil Serviços de Telecomunicações Ltda

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% quotas   Rodovia SP 101, KM 9,5, Trecho Campinas- Monte Mor, Unidade 27, Bloco Beta, Distrito Industrial, Hortolandia - SP- CEP, Sao Paolo, 13185-900, Brazil

BT Broadband Luxembourg Sàrl

  Holding company   100% ordinary   12 rue Eugene Ruppert, L 2453, Luxembourg

BT Bulgaria EOOD

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   51B Bulgaria Blvd., fl. 4, Sofia, 1404, Bulgaria

BT Business Direct Limited

  Technology equipment retailer   100% ordinary   Alpha & Beta House, Enterprise Park, Horwich, Bolton, Lancs, BL6 6PE, United Kingdom

BT Cables Limited

  Manufacture of telecommunications and rail signalling cables   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Cables MEA FZE

  Sale of telecommunications and rail signalling cables   100% ordinary   Office No. TPOFCB0505, Jabal Ali, Dubai, United Arab Emirates

BT Canada Inc.

  Communications related services   100% common   200 King St W, Suite 1904, Toronto ON M5H 3T4, Canada

BT Centre Nominee 2 Limited

  Property company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT China Communications Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   50% ordinary   Unit 1537B, Floor 15th, No. 55, Xili Road, Shanghai Free Trade Zone, Shanghai, China

BT China Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% registered   Room 702A, Tower W3, Oriental Plaza, 1 East Chang An Avenue, Dongcheng, Beijing, 100738, China

 

 
272     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT China Limited – Shanghai Branch Officeb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Room 2101-2103, 21/F, International Capital Plaza, No. 1318 North Sichuan Road, Hong Kou District, Shanghai, 200080, China

BT Colombia Limitada

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% quotas   Calle 113 , 7 - 21 Piso 11, Torre A. Oficina 1112, Bogota, Colombia

BT Communications Bangladesh Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   House 51 (3rd Floor), Road 9, Block F, Banani, Dhaka, 1213, Bangladesh

BT Communications do Brasil Limitada

  Communications related services, technology consulting and products provider   100% quotas   Avenida Das Naçôes Unidas, 4777- 14 andar- Parte- Jardim Universidade, São Paulo- SP- CEP, 05477- 000, Brazil

BT Communications Ireland Group Limited

  Holding company   100% ordinary   2 Grand Canal Plaza, Upper Grand Canal Street, Dublin 4, Republic of Ireland

BT Communications Ireland Group Limited – UK Branchb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Communications Ireland Holdings Limited

  Holding company   100% ordinary   2 Grand Canal Plaza, Upper Grand Canal Street, Dublin 4, Republic of Ireland

BT Communications Ireland Limited

  Telecommunications service provider   100% ordinary   2 Grand Canal Plaza, Upper Grand Canal Street, Dublin 4, Republic of Ireland

BT Communications Kenya Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   6th Floor, Virtual Offices, Morningside Office Park,Ngong Road, Nairobi, Kenya

BT Communications Lanka (Private) Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   65/2, Sir Chittampalam A., Gardiner Mawatha, Colombo, 2, Sri Lanka

BT Communications Philippines Incorporated

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   18th Floor, Philamlife Tower, 8767 Paseo de Roxas, Makati City, 1226, Philippines

BT Communications Sales LLC

  Communications related services   100% units   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Communications Sales, LLC Puerto Rico branchb

  Communications related services   100% –   The Prentice-Hall Corporation System, Puerto Rico, Inc., c/o Fast Solutions, LLC , Citi Tower, 252 Ponce de Leon Avenue, Floor 20, San Juan, Puerto Rico, 00918, Puerto Rico

BT Communications Services South Africa (Pty) Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   70% ordinary   BT Building, Woodmead North Office Park, 54 Maxwell Drive, Woodmead, South Africa

BT Conferencing Video Inc.

  Audio, video and web collaboration service provider   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Cornwall Limited

  Employment company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Corporate Trustee Limited

  Finance company   100% limited by guarantee   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Cote D’Ivoire

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   29 Boulevard Clozel, 01 BP 3586, Abidjan 01, Cote d’Ivoire

BT de Panama, S.R.L.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Edificio Credicorp Bank, Piso 3, Oficina 301, Cuidad de Panama, Panama

BT Denmark ApS

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Havnegade 39, 1058, Kobenhavn K, Denmark

BT Deutschland GmbH

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Barthstraße 4, 80339, Munich, Germany

BT Directories Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

 

 
273     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Related undertakings continued

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT Dominican Republic, S. A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Av. Abraham Lincoln Esq. Jose Amado Soler, Edif. Progresso, Local 3-A, Sector Ens. Serralles, Santo Domingo, Dominican Republic

BT e-Serv (India) Private Limited

  Provision of IT enabled services   100% equity   11th Floor, Eros Corporate Tower, Opp. International Trade Tower, Nehru Place, New Delhi, 110019, India

BT Eighty-Four Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   1 More London Place, London, SE1 2AF

BT El Salvador, Limitada de Capital Variable

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Edificio Centro Profesional Madre Tierra, Local 10, Piso 1, Santa Elena, Antiguo Cuscatlan, El Salvador

BT Enìa Telecomunicazioni S.P.A.

  Communications related services   87% ordinary   Strada S. Margherita n° 6/a, Parma, Italy

BT ESPAÑA, Compañia de Servicios Globales de Telecommunicaciones, S.A

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   C/ Isabel Colbrand 6-8, 28050, Madrid, Spain

BT European Investments Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Facilities Services Limited

  Provision of facilities management services   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Federal Inc.

  Communications related services for US federal government   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Fifty

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Fifty-One

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Fifty-Three Limited

  Holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Fleet Limited

  Fleet management   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Forty-Nine

  Holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT France S.A.S.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Tour Ariane, 5 place de la Pyramide, La Defense Cedex, 92088 PARIS, France

BT Frontline Outsourcing Sdn Bhd

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   Menara BT, Level 8, Tower 3, Avenue 7, Bangsar South, No.8, Jalan Kerinchi, 59200, Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

BT Gabon Limited

  In liquidation   100% Franc CFA   Centre Ville Avenue Alfred, Marche Imm. 2 AG BP 3927, Libreville, Gabon

BT Garrick GmbH

  Holding company   100% ordinary   Barthstraße 4, 80339, Munich, Germany

BT Georgia Limited LLC

  Communications related services, systems and products provider   100% –   74 Ilia Chavchavadze Avenue, Tbilisi, Georgia

BT Ghana Limited

  Provision of IT network services and IT solutions   100% ordinary   11 Adaman Loop, Tesano, Accra, Ghana

BT Global (Venezuela) S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Edificio Parque Cristal, Torre Este, Piso 1, Ofic. 06, Av. Francisco de Miranda, Los Palos Grandes, Caracas, Venezuela

BT Global Business Services Private Limited

  Provision of IT enabled services   100% ordinary   11th Floor, Eros Corporate Tower, Opp. International Trade Tower, Nehru Place, New Delhi, 110019, India

BT Global Communications (Ireland) Limited

  Property company   100% ordinary   2 Grand Canal Plaza, Upper Grand Canal Street, Dublin 4, Republic of Ireland

BT Global Communications (Mauritius) Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   10 Frere Felix De Valois Street, Port Louis, Mauritius

BT Global Communications do Brasil Limitadaa

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% quotas   Avenida Das Naçôes Unidas, 4777- 17 andar- Parte- Jardim Universidade, São Paulo- SP- CEP, 05477- 000, Brazil

BT Global Communications India Private Limited

  Communications related services   74% ordinary   11th Floor, Eros Corporate Tower, Opp. International Trade Tower, Nehru Place, New Delhi, 110019, India

 

 
274     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT Global Costa Rica SRL

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Centro Corporativo Internacional, Piso 1, Avenida 6 y 8, Calle 26 y 28, Barrio Don Bosco, Costa Rica

BT Global Japan Corporation

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   ARK Mori Building, 12-32 Akasaka, 1-Chome, Minato- Ku, Tokyo, 107 - 6024, Japan

BT Global Services (Dalian) Co. Ltd.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% registered   No. 31 Software Park Road, Tower A, Science & Technology Building, Dalian Software Park, Dalian, 116023, China

BT Global Services (M) Sdn Bhd

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Menara BT, Level 8, Tower 3, Avenue 7, Bangsar South, No.8, Jalan Kerinchi, 59200, Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

BT Global Services Botswana (Proprietary) Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Plot 113, Unit 28 Kgale Mews, Gaborone International Finance Park, Gaborone, PO BOX 1839, Botswana

BT Global Services Korea Limited.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   8th Floor, KTB Building, 66 Yeoui-daero, Yeongdeungpo-gu, Seoul, 07325, Republic of Korea

BT Global Services Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Via Mario Bianchini 15, 00142 Roma, Italy

BT Global Services Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Global Services Limited Londra Sucursala Bucurestib

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   35-37 Oltenitei Str., Cladirea A1, Biroul Nr. 52, Bucharest, Sector 4, Romania

BT Global Services Luxembourg SARL

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   12 rue Eugene Ruppert, L 2453, Luxembourg

BT Global Services Solutions Sdn Bhd

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Menara BT, Level 8, Tower 3, Avenue 7, Bangsar South, No.8, Jalan Kerinchi, 59200, Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

BT Global Services Technologies Pte. Ltd.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   8 Changi Business Park Ave (South Tower), #08-51 UE Bizhub East, Singapore, 486018, Singapore

BT Global Solutions Pte. Ltd.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   8 Changi Business Park Ave (South Tower), #08-51 UE Bizhub East, Singapore, 486018, Singapore

BT Global Technology (M) Sdn. Bhd.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Menara BT, Level 8, Tower 3, Avenue 7, Bangsar South, No.8, Jalan Kerinchi, 59200, Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

BT GLOBALNE STORITVE, telekomunikacijske storitve, obdelava podatkov, podatkovnih baz; d.o.o.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   CESTA V MESTNI LOG 1, 1000 LJUBLJANA, Slovenia

BT Group Nominees Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Guatemala S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% unique   3 Avenida 13-78, Zona 10, Torre CitiBank, Nivel 2, Oficina 206, Guatemala, Guatemala

BT Holdings Limited

  Investment holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Hong Kong Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   39% ordinary 61% preference   38 Floor Dorset House, Taikoo Place, 979 King’s Road, Quarry Bay, Hong Kong

BT Hong Kong Ltd. – Macau Branchb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Avenida da.Praia Grande, No. 367-371, Keng Ou Building, 15th andar C, em Macao, Macau

BT International Holdings Limited & Co. LLC

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   413, 4th Floor, Maktabi Building, Wattayah, PC 112, Muscat, 2188, Oman

BT IT Services Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

 

 
275     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Related undertakings continued

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT Italia S.p.A.

  Communications related services and products provider   99% ordinary   Via Tucidide 56, Torre 7, 20134, Milano, Italy

BT Jamaica Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   26 Beechwood Avenue, Kingston 5, Jamaica

BT Japan Corporation

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   ARK Mori Building, 12-32 Akasaka, 1-Chome, Minato- Ku, Tokyo, 107 - 6024, Japan

BT Jersey Limited

  Communications related services   100% ordinary   PO Box 264, Forum 4, Grenville Street, St Helier, JE4 8TQ, Jersey

BT Kazakhstan LLP

  Communications related services and products provider   100% –   36 Al Farabi Ave., Bldg. B, Almaty Financial District, Almaty, Republic of Kazakhstan, 050059, Kazakhstan

BT Lancashire Services Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT LatAm (BVI) Corporation

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Sea Meadow House, P.O. Box 116, Road Town, Tortola, British Virgin Islands

BT LatAm (Nevada) Corp.

  Communications related services   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 2215-B Renaissance Drive, Las Vegas, NV 89119, United States

BT Latam Argentina S.A

  Communications related services and products provider   100% common   Lola Mora 421, 15th Floor, Puerto Madero, Buenos Aires, Buenos Aires, C1107DDA, Argentina

BT LatAm Brasil Ltda.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% quotas   Rodovia SP 101, KM 9,5, Trecho Campinas- Monte Mor, Unidade 27, Bloco Beta, Distrito Industrial, Hortolandia - SP- CEP, Sao Paolo, 13185-900, Brazil

BT LatAm Colombia S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Calle 113 , 7 - 21 Piso 11, Torre A. Oficina 1112, Bogota, Colombia

BT LatAm Costa Rica, S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Centro Corporativo Internacional, Piso 1, Avenida 6 y 8, Calle 26 y 28, Barrio Don Bosco, Costa Rica

BT LatAm Dominicana, S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Av. Abraham Lincoln Esq. Jose Amado Soler, Edif. Progresso, Local 3-A, Sector Ens. Serralles, Santo Domingo, Dominican Republic

BT LatAm El Salvador, S.A. de CV

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Edificio Centro Profesional Madre Tierra, Local 10, Piso 1, Santa Elena, Antiguo Cuscatlan, El Salvador

BT LatAm Guatemala, S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   3 Avenida 13-78, Zona 10, Torre CitiBank, Nivel 2, Oficina 206, Guatemala, Guatemala

BT LatAm Holdings (Colombia) S. A.

  Holding company   100% common   Calle 113, 7 - 21 Piso 11, Torre A. Oficina 1112, Bogota, Colombia

BT LatAm Holdings Brasil Ltda

  Holding company   100% common   Avenida Das Naçôes Unidas, 4777- 14 andar- Parte- Jardim Universidade, São Paulo- SP- CEP, 05477- 000, Brazil

BT LatAm Holdings One, Inc.

  Holding company   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT LatAm Holdings Three, Inc.

  Holding company   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT LatAm Holdings Two, Inc.

  Holding company   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT LatAm Honduras, S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Edificio Plaza Azul, Piso 2 do Nivel, Local No. 26, Colonia Lomas del Guijarro Sur, Avenida Paris, Calle Viena, Tegucigalpa, Honduras

BT LatAm México, S.A. de C.V.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Av. Renato Leduc 321, Col. Toriello Guerra, 14050 Mexico D.F.

 

 
276     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT LatAm Nicaragua, S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Edificio Invercasa, 5to Piso, Suite 505, Via Fontana, frente al colegio La Salle, Managua, Nicaragua

BT LatAm Panama, Inc.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Edificio Credicorp Bank, Piso 3, Oficina 301, Cuidad de Panama, Panama

BT LatAm Peru S.A.C.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Calle Martir Olaya, 129 of 1901, Miraflores, Lima, Peru

BT LatAm Services, Inc.

  Holding company   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT LatAm Venezuela, S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Av. Francisco de Miranda, Edificio Parque Cristal, Torre Este, Mezz 2, Local 28, Los Palos Grandes, Caracas 1060, Venezuela

BT LatAm, Inc.

  Communications related services   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Latvia Limited, Sabiedriba ar ierobezotu atbildibu

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Muitas iela 1A, Riga, LV-1010, Latvia

BT Law Limited

  Provision of third party claims handling services   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Lease Holdings Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

BT Leasing Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

BT Lebanon S.A.L.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Abou Hamad, Merheb, Nohra & Chedid Law Firm, Chbaro Street, 22nd Achrafieh Warde Building, 1st Floor, Beirut, P.O.BOX 165126, Lebanon

BT LGS Limited

  Employment company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Telecomlaan 9, 1831 Diegem, Belgium

BT Limited

  International telecommunications network systems provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Limitedb

  Dormant   100% –   First Floor, Culross Court North, 16 Culross Road, Bryanston 2021, 2021, South Africa

BT Limited Magyarorszagi Fioktelepeb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Budafoki U. 91-93, Budapest, 1117, Hungary

BT Limited Taiwan Branchb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Shin Kong Manhattan Building, 14F, No. 8, Sec. 5, Xinyi Road, Taipei, 11049, Taiwan

BT Limited, Beijing Officeb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   No. 3 Dong San Huan Bei Lu, Chao Yang District, Beijing, 100027, China

BT Limited, organizacni slozkab

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Štětkova 1638, 18, Nusle, 140 00 Praha 4 , Czech Republic

BT Luxembourg Investment Holdings Sarl

  Holding company   100% ordinary   12 rue Eugene Ruppert, L 2453, Luxembourg

BT Malawi Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   BDO Tax & Advisory Services (Pvt) Ltd, 6th Floor Unit House, 12 Victoria Street PO BOX 3038, Blantyre, Malawi

BT Managed Services (No.2) Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Managed Services Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT MDV Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   MD-2001, 65 Stefan cel Mare si Sfant Boulevard, office 806, Chisinau, Republic of Moldova

 

 
277     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Related undertakings continued

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT MEA FZ-LLC

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Office No G03, Ground Floor, EIB Building No 04, Dubai, United Arab Emirates

BT Montenegro DOO

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Bulevar revolucije 7, Podgorica, 81000, Montenegro

BT Moorgate LLC

  Communications related services   100% units   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Moorgate LLC – UK Branchb

  Communications related services   100% –   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Moorgate One Limited

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Moorgate Two Limited

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Mozambique, Limitada

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% quotas   Av. 25 de Setembro, 1230, 3º, Bloco 5, Caixa Postal 4200, Maputo, 4200, Mozambique

BT Multimedia (Malaysia) Sdn Bhd

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   Level 1 to 8, Tower 3, Avenue 7, Bangsar South, No. 8 Jalan Kerinchi, 59200 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

BT Nederland N.V.

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   Minerva & Mercurius building, Herikerbergweg 2, 1101CM, Amsterdam Zuidoost, Netherlands

BT Nederland N.V.b

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Via Tucidide 56, Torre 7, 20134, Milano, Italy

BT Newco France S.A.S.

  Dormant   100% ordinary   5, Place de la Pyramide, Tour Ariane, 92088, Paris la Defense CEDEX, France

BT Newgate LLC

  Communications related services   100% units   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Newgate LLC – UK Branchb

  Communications related services   100% –   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Nicaragua S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% capital   Edificio Invercasa, 5to Piso, Suite 505, Via Fontana, frente al colegio La Salle, Managua, Nicaragua

BT Niger

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   57, Rue des Sorkhos, BP 616, Niamey-Niger

BT Nominees Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Nordics Finland Oy

  Communications related services   100% ordinary   Mannerheimvägen 12 B 6, 00100 Helsinki, Finland

BT Nordics Sweden AB

  Communications related services   100% ordinary   Box 30005, 104 25, Stockholm, Sweden

BT Pakistan (Private) Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   2nd Floor, Block C, Lakson Square, Building No. 1, Sarwar Shaheed Road, Karachi, 74200, Pakistan

BT Paraguay S.R.L.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% quotas   Calle Humaita c/Ntra. Sra. de la Asuncion numero 145, Asuncion, Paraguay

BT Peru S.R.L.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Calle Martir Olaya, 129 of 1901, Miraflores, Lima, Peru

BT Poland Spólka Z Ograniczoną Odpowiedzialnością

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Al. Armii Ludowej 14, 00-638 Warszawa, International Business Center, Poland

BT Portugal – Telecomunicações, Unipessoal, Lda.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Rua D. Francisco Manuel de Melo 21-1, 1070-085 Lisboa, Portugal

BT Procure L.L.C.

  Dormant   100% units   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BT Professional Services (Germany) GmbH

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Unterster Zwerchweg 61, 60599 Frankfurt am Main, Germany

 

 
278     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT Professional Services (Holdings) N.V.

  Holding company   100% ordinary   Telecomlaan 9, 1831 Diegem, Belgium

BT Professional Services (India) Private Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   602, Tower B, RMZ Infinity, Municipal No. 3, Old Madras Road, Benninganahalli, Bengaluru, Karnataka, 560016, India

BT Professional Services (Luxembourg) S.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   12 rue Eugene Ruppert, L 2453, Luxembourg

BT Professional Services Nederland B.V.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Minerva & Mercurius building, Herikerbergweg 2, 1101CM, Amsterdam Zuidoost, Netherlands

BT Property Holdings (Aberdeen) Limited

  Property/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Property Holdings (Oxford) Limited

  Property/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Property Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT ROC Kft

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% business   Budafoki út 91-13, 1117 Budapest, Hungary

BT Services S.A.S.

  Technology consulting and engineering services   100% ordinary   Tour Ariane, 5 place de la Pyramide, La Defense Cedex, 92088 PARIS, France

BT Seventy-Four Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

BT Seventy-Three

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

BT Siam Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   69% preference   Athenee Tower, 23rd Floor, (CEO Suite, Suite 38 & 40), 63 Wireless Road, Lumpini, Pathumwan, Bangkok, 10330, Thailand

BT Singapore Pte. Ltd.

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   8 Changi Business Park Ave (South Tower), #08-51 UE Bizhub East, Singapore, 486018, Singapore

BT Sixty-Four Limited

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Sle Euro Limited

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Sle USD Limited

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Slovakia s.r.o.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Dvorakovo nabrezie 4, 811 02, Bratislava, Slovakia

BT Sociedad De Responsabilidad Limitada

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Colonia Lomas Del Guijarro sur, edificio Plaza azul, 2do. Nivel, local #26, Tegucigalpa, Honduras

BT Solutions Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   236 Strovolos Avenue, Strovolos 2048, Nicosia, Cyprus

BT Solutions Limited (Sucursal Ecuador)b

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Av. Amazonas N21-252 y Carrión, Edificio Londres, 4° Piso, Quito, Ecuador

BT Solutions Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Tower Gate Place, Tal-Qroqq Street, Msida MSD 1703, Malta

BT Solutions Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   PO Box 2184, 61 Bismarck Street, Windhoek, Namibia

BT Solutions Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   2nd Floor CIC Building, 122-124 Frederick Street, Port of Spain, Trinidad and Tobago

BT Solutions Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   c/o BDO East Africa, Plot 22 Mbuya Road, Bugolobi, Kampala, P.O. BOX 9113, Uganda

 

 
279     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Related undertakings continued

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT Solutions Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Solutions Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100%   Plot No. 4015A, , Frost Building, Gallery Office Park, Lagos Road, Rhodespark, Lusaka, Lusaka Province, Zambia

BT Solutions Limited (Bahrain Branch)b

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Suite #650, 6th floor, Building No. 247, Road 1704, Diplomatic Area 317, Bahrain

BT Solutions Limited – Kuwait Branchb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Block 2-A, 9th Floor, Ahmad Al Jaber Street, Sharq, Kuwait

BT Solutions Limited – Morocco Branchb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   193, Avenue HASSAN II, Casablanca, MAROC s/c Domicilia services, Morocco

BT Solutions Limited – Tanzania Branchb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   BDO East Africa, 1st Floor-Wing B, Infotech Place, Mwai Kibaki Road, Dar es Salaam, Tanzania

BT Solutions Limited Branch Office in Skopjeb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Str. Dame Gruev no.8, 5th floor, Building “Dom na voenite invalidi”, SKOPJE 1000, Macedonia

BT Solutions Limited Eesti Filiaalb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   A.H. Tammsaare tee 47, Tallinn, 11316, Estonia

BT Solutions Limited Liability Company

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Pravdy, 26, 127137, Moscow, Russian Federation

BT Solutions Limited Podruznica Hrvatskab

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Savska 64, 10 000 Zagreb, Croatia

BT Solutions Limited Sucursal Boliviab

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Avenida Arce esquina Rosendo Gutierrez, Edifico Multicentre Torre B, Piso 12, La Paz, Bolivia

BT Solutions Limited Sucursal Uruguayb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Rincón 487 Piso 11, Montevideo, ZIP CODE 11.000, Uruguay

BT Solutions Limited Útibú á Íslandib

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Skútuvogi 1e, 104 Reykjavík, Iceland

BT Solutions Limited-Greek Branchb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   75 Patision Street, Athens, 10434, Greece

BT Solutions Norway AS

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Munkedamsveien 45, c/o BDO AS, 0121 Oslo, Norway

BT South Tyneside Limited

  Employment company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT Stemmer GmbH

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Peter Henlein Straße 2, 82140 Olching, Germany

BT Switzerland AG

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   Richtistrasse 5, 8304 Wallisellen, Switzerland

BT Systems (Malaysia) Sdn Bhd

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Menara BT, Level 8, Tower 3, Avenue 7, Bangsar South, No.8, Jalan Kerinchi, 59200, Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

BT Technology (Dalian) Company Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% registered   Building 16, 6th Floor, Room 602-B, No. 269 Wuyi Road, Hi-tech Park, Dalian, 116023, China

 

 
280     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

BT Telconsult Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

BT Telecom Egypt LLC

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% stakes   1 Wadi El Nile St., Mohandessin, Giza, Cairo, Egypt

BT Telecom India Private Limited

  Investment/holding company   74% ordinary   11th Floor, Eros Corporate Tower, Opp. International TradeTower, Nehru Place, New Delhi, 110019, India

BT Telecommunications Kenya Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   P.O. BOX 10032-00100, Nairobi, Kenya

BT Telekom Hizmetleri Anonim Şirketi

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% common   Barbaros Mahallesi, Yavuz Selim Caddesi No: 17/1 Ataşehir, İstanbul, Turkey

BT Tunisia S.A.R.L

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   BT chez BDO Tunisie, Immeuble, ENNOUR BUILDING 3ème étage, Centre Urbain Nord 1082, Mahrajène Tunis, Tunisia

BT UAE Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT UAE Limited – Abu Dhabi Branchb

  Dormant   100% –   Office No. (F6) International Business Center, Building No. (27W10), Three Sails Tower, Cornish, Abu Dhabi, United Arab Emirates

BT UAE Limited – Dubai Branch (1)b

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Office no.206 BLOCK B, Diamond Business Center 1, Al Barsha South Third, Dubai, P.O.BOX 25205, United Arab Emirates

BT UAE Limited – Dubai Branch (2)b

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Office no.206 BLOCK B, Diamond Business Center 1, Al Barsha South Third, Dubai, P.O.BOX 25205, United Arab Emirates

BT Ukraine Limited Liability Company

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% stakes   Office 702, 34, Lesi Ukrayinky Blvd., Kiev, Ukraine, 01042

BT US Investments Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   Ogier House, The Esplanade, Parish, St Helier, JE4 9WG, Jersey

BT US Investments Limited – UK branchb

  Investment company   100% –   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BT United States L.L.C.

  Holding company   100% units   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

BTexact Technologies Limited

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BTexact Venturing Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

BTIH Teleconsult Drustvo sa organicenom odgovornoscu za posredovanje i zastupanje d.o.o. Sarajevo

  Architectural and engineering activities and technical consulting   100% –   ul. Despiceva broj 3/II, Sarajevo, Sarajevo-Stari Grad, 71000, Bosnia and Herzegovina

Canal Capital Investment Limited

  Investment company   100% ordinary   2 Grand Canal Plaza, Upper Grand Canal Street, Dublin 4, Republic of Ireland

Communications Global Network Services Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   Century House, 16 Par-la-Ville Road, Hamilton, HM08, Bermuda

Communications Global Network Services Limited – UK Branchb

  Communications related services and products provider   100% –   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Communications Networking Services (UK)

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Communicator (IOM) Limited - UK Branchb

  Insurance   100% –   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Communicator Insurance Company Limited

  Investment company  

99% ordinary

1% preference

  Third Floor, St Georges Court, Upper Church Street, Douglas, IM1 1EE, Isle of Man

Communicator Limited

  Investment company   100% ordinary   Third Floor, St Georges Court, Upper Church Street, Douglas, IM1 1EE, Isle of Man

Comsat de Guatemala S.A.

  Dormant   100% common   3 Avenida 13-78, Zona 10, Torre CitiBank, Nivel 2, Oficina 206, Guatemala, Guatemala

 

 
281     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Related undertakings continued

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

dabs.com plc

  Technology equipment retailer   100% ordinary   Alpha & Beta House, Enterprise Park, Horwich, Bolton, Lancs, BL6 6PE, United Kingdom

Deleteway Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   1 More London Place, London, SE1 2AF, United Kingdom

Dublin London Network Limited

  In liquidation   55% ordinary   2 Grand Canal Plaza, Upper Grand Canal Street, Dublin 4, Republic of Ireland

EE (Group) Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

EE Communications (South Africa) Proprietary Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   24-18th Street, Menlo Park, Pretoria, 0081, South Africa

EE Finance plc

  Finance company   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

EE Limited

  Telecommunications   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

EE Pension Trustee Limited

  Pension trustee company   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

EE Services Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

ERPTech S.p.A.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   99% ordinary   Via Charles Robert Darwin, no 85, 20019, Settimo Milanese, Italy

ESAT Telecommunications (UK) Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Everything Everywhere Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

Extraclick Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Green House Group Pte Ltd

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   600 North Bridge Road, #23-01 Parkview Square, 188778, Singapore

Green House Solution Sdn Bhd

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   Menara BT, Level 8, Tower 3, Avenue 7, Bangsar South, No.8, Jalan Kerinchi, 59200, Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

groupBT Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Holland House (Northern) Limited

  Property/holding company   100% ordinary   Alexander Bain House, 15 York Street, Glasgow, G2 8LA, Scotland

iASPire.Net Pte Ltd

  In liquidation   95% ordinary   8 Changi Business Park Ave (South Tower), #08-51 UE Bizhub East, Singapore, 486018, Singapore

Ilford Trustees (Jersey) Limited

  Investment company   100% ordinary   26 New Street, St Helier, JE2 3RA, Jersey

Infocom Telecom LLC

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% charter   Miusskaya Square 7, 125811, Moscow, Russia

Infonet China Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   38th floor, Dorset House, Taikoo Place, 979 King’s Road, Island East, Hong Kong

Infonet China Limited Beijing Representative Officeb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   Room 4C, 7/F, Tower W3, Oriental Plaza, 1 East Chang An Avenue, Dong Cheng District, Beijing, P. R. China

Infonet Italia S.p.A

  Dormant   100% ordinary   Via Tucidide 56, Torre 7, 20134, Milano, Italy

Infonet Primalliance Beijing Co. Ltd.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   66% ordinary   Room 4B, 7/F, Tower W3, Oriental Plaza, 1 East Chang An Avenue, Dong Cheng District, Beijing, P. R. China

Infonet Primalliance Co., Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   38 Floor Dorset House, Taikoo Place, 979 King’s Road, Quarry Bay, Hong Kong

Infonet Primalliance Holding Co. Ltd.

  Holding company   100% ordinary   Room 635-3, No. 2 BLDG, 351 Guo Shou Jing Road, Zhang Jiang High Technology Park, Shanghai, P. R. China

 

 
282     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

Infonet Services (Hong Kong) Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   38 Floor Dorset House, Taikoo Place, 979 King’s Road, Quarry Bay, Hong Kong

Infonet Services Corporation

  Communications related services   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

IP Trade Financial SA

  Finance company   100% ordinary   Rue de L’Aêropostale 8, 4460 Grâce-Hollogne, Belgium

IP Trade Network Corp

  Provision of IT communication services   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808 , United States

IP Trade Networks GmbH

  Provision of IT communication services   100% ordinary   Franfurterstrasse 21-25, 65760 Eschborn Taunus, Germany

IP Trade Networks Limited

  Provision of IT communication services   100% ordinary   Room 1102, Lee Garden One, 33 Hysan Avenue, Causeway Bay, Hong Kong

IP Trade Networks Ltd

  Wired telecommunications activities   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

IP Trade SA

  Provision of IT communication services   100% category   Rue de L’Aêropostale 8, 4460 Grâce-Hollogne, Belgium

IT Holdings, Inc

  Dormant   100% ordinary   11th Floor, Page one Building,, 1215 Acacia Ave, Madrigal Business Park, Ayala Alabang, Muntinlupa city, Metro Manila, 1780, Philippines

Mainline Communications Group Limited

  Holding company   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

Mainline Digital Communications Limited

  Distribution of mobile telephones and services   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

Mobilise Telecoms Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

M-Viron Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

Newgate Communication (Sudan) Co. Ltd

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   Alskheikh Mustafa Building, Parlman Street, Khartoum, Sudan

Newgate Leasing Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

Newgate Street Secretaries Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Numberrapid Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Numberrapid Limitedb

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% –   3 Baines Avenue, Box 334, Harare, Zimbabwe

Nuova Societa di Telecomunicazioni SpA

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   99% ordinary   Via Tucidide 56, Torre 7, 20134, Milano, Italy

Openreach Limited

  Wired telecommunications activities   100% ordinary   Kelvin House , 123 Judd Street, London, WC1H 9NP United Kingdom

Opimus S.A. de C.V.

  Dormant   100% common   Av. Renato Leduc 321, Col. Toriello Guerra, 14050 Mexico D.F.

Orange FURBS Trustees Limited

  Pension trustee company   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

Orange Home UK Limited

  Dormant   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

Orange Personal Communications Services Limited

  Holding company   100% ordinary   Trident Place, Mosquito Way, Hatfield, Hertfordshire, AL10 9BW, United Kingdom

Orange Services India Private Limited

  Provision of call centre services   100% ordinary   A-47, Hauz Khas, New Delhi, Delhi-DL, 110016, India

Pelipod Ltd

  Supplier of delivery pods for supply chain solution   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Plusnet plc

  Broadband service provider   100% ordinary   The Balance, 2 Pinfold Street, Sheffield, S1 2GU, United Kingdom

Postgate Holding Company

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

 

 
283     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Related undertakings continued

    

    

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest in

allotted capitala

 

Registered Address and

Country of incorporation

Priestgate Limited

  Holding company   100% ordinary   Third Floor, St Georges Court, Upper Church Street, Douglas, IM1 1EE, Isle of Man

PSPI-Subic, Inc

  Dormant   51% ordinary   c/o Sun Microsystems Phil Inc., 8767 Paseo de Roxas, Makati City, Philippines

PT BT Communications Indonesia

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   95% ordinary   World Trade Centre 5, Lantai. 13, Jl. Jend. Sudirman Kav. 29-31, Kel. Karet Setiabudi, Jakarta Selatan, Jakarta, 12920, Indonesia

PT BT Indonesia

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   World Trade Centre 5, Lantai. 13, Jl. Jend. Sudirman Kav. 29-31, Kel. Karet Setiabudi, Jakarta Selatan, Jakarta, 12920, Indonesia

PT Sun Microsystems Indonesia

  Dormant   60% ordinary   World Trade Centre 5, Lantai. 13, Jl. Jend. Sudirman Kav. 29-31, Kel. Karet Setiabudi, Jakarta Selatan, Jakarta, 12920, Indonesia

Radianz Americas Inc.

  Communications related services   100% common   c/o Corporation Service Company, 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington DE 19808, United States

Radianz Italia S.r.l.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Via Correggio 5, 20097, San Donato Milanese, Milan, Italy

Radianz Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Radianz Spain S.L.

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   C/ Isabel Colbrand 6-8, 28050, Madrid, Spain

RDZ Netherlands BV

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Minerva & Mercurius building, Herikerbergweg 2, 1101CM, Amsterdam Zuidoost, Netherlands

Sama Empreedimentos e Participações Limitada

  Dormant   100% common   Rua Arnaldo Quintela - 96, 1 Andar - Botafogo, CEP 22.280-070, Rio de Janeiro, Brazil

Servicios de Telecomunicaciones BT Global Networks Chile Limitada

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   100% ordinary   Coronel Pereira Nº 62 Of. 207, Comuna Las Condes, Ciudad Santiago, Chile

SEV Automotive and Plant Limited

  Maintenance and repair of motor vehicles   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Skeegle App Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

Skeegle Holdings Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

Skeegle Operations Limited

  In liquidation   100% ordinary   BDO LLP, 55 Baker Street, London, W1U 7EU, United Kingdom

Southgate Developments Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Sun Microsystems Philippines, Inc

  Dormant   51% common   11th Floor, Page One Building, 1215 Acacia Avenue, Madrigal, Business park, Ayala Alabany, Muntinlupa city, 1780 City, Manila, 1780, Philippines

Sun Vietnam Co., Ltd.

  Dormant   60% ordinary   7th Floor, ESTAR Building, 147-149 Vo Van Tan Street, Ward 6, District 3, HCM City, Viet Nam

Sun Vietnam Pte. Ltd.

  Dormant   60% ordinary   8 Changi Business Park Ave (South Tower), #08-51 UE Bizhub East, Singapore, 486018, Singapore

Syntone S.A.R.L.

  Dormant   99% ordinary   Espace Jet Business Class, 16/18 Lot Attoufik Sidi Maarouf, Casablanca, 20190, Morocco

Tikit Limited

  Software services products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Tikit, Inc.

  Software services products provider   100% ordinary   200 King Street W, Suite 1904, Toronto ON M5H 3TA, Canada

Transcomm UK Limited

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

Tudor Minstrel

  Finance company   100% ordinary   81 Newgate Street, London, EC1A 7AJ, United Kingdom

UAB BTH Vilnius

  Communications related services and products provider   100% ordinary   Aludariu str 2-33, LT-01113 Vilnius, Lithuania

Whitestream Industries Limited

  Investment/holding company   100% ordinary   2 Grand Canal Plaza, Upper Grand Canal Street, Dublin 4, Republic of Ireland

 

 
284     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

       

 

 

    

    

    

 

Joint ventures and joint operationsc

 

Company name    Activity    Group interest
in allotted
capitala
   Country of
    incorporation
  

Financial

year end

   Registered Address

Held via other group companies

                        

BT OnePhone Limited

   Communications related services and products provider    70% ordinary    UK    31 March   

81 Newgate Street,

London, EC1A 7AJ,

United Kingdom

Mobile Broadband Network Limited

   Joint venture between EE and Hutchison 3G UK Limited to manage network    50% ordinary    UK        31 December   

6 Anglo Office

Park, 67 White Lion

Road, Amersham,

Buckinghamshire,

HP7 9FB,

United Kingdom

Rugby Radio Station (General Partner) Limited

   Property investment    50% ordinary    UK    31 December   

St Helen’s

1 Undershaft,

London, EC3P 3DQ,

United Kingdom

Rugby Radio Station (Nominee) Limited

   Property company    50% ordinary    UK    31 December   

St Helen’s

1 Undershaft,

London, EC3P 3DQ,

United Kingdom

Rugby Radio Station LP

   Property company    50% –    UK    31 December   

St Helen’s

1 Undershaft,

London, EC3P 3DQ,

United Kingdom

Interests in joint operations

EE Limited and Hutchison 3G UK Limited (together ‘the Companies’) each have a 50% share in the joint operation Mobile Broadband Network Limited (‘MBNL’). MBNL’s ongoing purpose is the operation and maintenance of mobile networks through a sharing arrangement. This includes the efficient management of shared infrastructure and networks on behalf of the Companies, acquiring certain network elements for shared use, and coordinating the deployment of new infrastructure and networks on either a shared or a unilateral basis (unilateral elements being network assets or services specific to one company only). The group is committed to incurring 50% of costs in respect of restructuring the Shared Network, a similar proportion of the operating costs (which varies in line with usage), and 100% of any unilateral elements.

Guarantees for the joint operation are given by Deutsche Telekom AG and Hutchison Whampoa Limited. Deutsche Telekom, Orange and BT have agreed between them to manage any potential liability by arrangements between themselves.

The principal place of business of the joint operation is in the UK.

 

 
285     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Related undertakings continued

    

    

 

Associates

 

Company name   Activity  

Group interest

in allotted

capitala

  Registered Address

Held via other group companies

           

British Telecom Al-Saudia Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   49% other   New Acaria Commercial Complex, Al-Siteen Street, Malaz, Riyadh, Saudi Arabia

BT Global Services (North Gulf) LLC

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   49% ordinary   1413, 14th Floor, Al Fardan Office Tower, Doha, 31316, Qatar

BT Siam Communications Co. Ltd.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   49% class B   Athenee Tower, 23rd Floor, (CEO Suite, Suite 38 & 40), 63 Wireless Road, Lumpini, Pathumwan, Bangkok, 10330, Thailand

Collectively Limited

  In liquidation   20% –   Kings Orchard, 1 Queen Street, Bristol, BS2 0HQ, United Kingdom

Digital Mobile Spectrum Limited

  Mitigation of interference to digital terrestrial television   25% ordinary   83 Baker Street, London, W1U 6AG, United Kingdom

Ecquaria Limited

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   50% ordinary   Craigmuir Chambers, PO Box 71, Road Town, Tortora, British Virgin Islands

ePLDTSunphilcox JV, Inc

  Dormant   20% ordinary   32F Philam Life Tower, 8767 Paseo de Roxas, Makati City, Philippines

I2 S.r.l

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   23% –   Via XII Ottobre 2N, 16121, Genova, Liguria, Italy

Infonet Primalliance Shanghai Co. Ltd.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   28% ordinary   Room 601, No. 2 BLDG, 750 West Zhong Shan Rd., Shanghai, 200051, P R China

Infonet Primalliance Shenzhen Co. Ltd.

  Communications related services, systems integration and products provider   35% ordinary   Room 1206, Tower A, United Plaza, 5022 Bin He Avenue, Fu Tian District, Shenzhen, P. R. China

Internet Matters Limited

  Not for profit venture   25% –   6th Floor, One London Wall, London, EC2Y 5EB, United Kingdom

Mahindra – BT Investment Company (Mauritius) Limited

  Investment/holding company   43% ordinary   c/o IFS, IFS Court, TwentyEight, Cybercity, Ebene, Mauritius

Midland Communications Distribution Limited

  Distribution and retailing of mobile telephones, associated equipment and airtime connections   35% ordinary   Unit 1, Colwick Quays Business Park, Colwick, Nottingham, Nottinghamshire, NG4 2JY, United Kingdom

QXN S.c.p.A.

  Communications related services and products provider   25% ordinary   Piazzale Luigi Sturzo, 23, 00144, Roma, Italy

Real Time Content, Inc.

  Provision of Cloud based video services   21% common   Corporation Trust Center, 1209 Orange Street, City of Wilmington, County of New Castle 19801, United States of America

SunPhilcox JV, Inc

  Dormant   20% ordinary   32F Philam Life Tower, 8767 Paseo de Roxas, Makati City, Philippines

Youview TV Limited

  Not for profit venture – Development of software to provide TV platform services   14% voting   10 Lower Thames Street, Third Floor, London, EC3R 6YT, United Kingdom

 

a  The proportion of voting rights held corresponds to the aggregate interest in percentage held by the holding company and subsidiary undertakings.
b  No shares issued for a branch.
c  All joint ventures are governed by a joint venture agreement or shareholder agreement. MBNL (page 285) is accounted for as a joint operation.

 

 
286     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

    

    

    

 

Additional Information

In this section you’ll find more financial and operational statistics. There’s also information for shareholders on subjects like dividends and our Articles of Association. We’ve also included a glossary of terms we use in this report.

Additional information  
Alternative performance measures    288  
Selected financial data    291  
Financial and operation statistics    293  
Information for shareholders    296  
Cross reference to Form 20-F    309  
Glossary of terms    313  
 

 

LOGO

 


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Alternative performance measures

Introduction

We assess the performance of the group using a variety of alternative performance measures. We principally discuss the group’s results on an ‘adjusted’ basis. The rationale for using adjusted measures is explained below. Results on an adjusted basis are presented before specific items.

We also explain financial performance using measures that are not defined under IFRS and are therefore termed ‘non-GAAP’ measures. The non-GAAP measures we use are: the trend in underlying revenue excluding transit; adjusted EBITDA; normalised free cash flow; and net debt. A reconciliation from these non-GAAP measures to the nearest measure prepared in accordance with IFRS is presented below. The alternative performance measures we use may not be directly comparable with similarly titled measures used by other companies.

Specific items

The group’s income statement and segmental analysis separately identify trading results before specific items. The directors believe that presentation of the group’s results in this way is relevant to an understanding of the group’s financial performance, as specific items are identified by virtue of their size, nature or incidence. This presentation is consistent with the way that financial performance is measured by management and reported to the Board and the Executive Committee and assists in providing a meaningful analysis of the trading results of the group. In determining whether an event or transaction is specific, management considers quantitative as well as qualitative factors such as the frequency or predictability of occurrence.

Examples of charges or credits meeting the above definition and which have been presented as specific items in the current and/or prior years include acquisitions/disposals of businesses and investments, regulatory settlements, historical insurance or litigation claims, business restructuring programmes, asset impairment charges, property rationalisation programmes, net interest on pensions and the settlement of multiple tax years. In the event that other items meet the criteria, which are applied consistently from year to year, they are also treated as specific items.

Specific items are disclosed in note 8 to the consolidated financial statements.

Trends in underlying revenue excluding transit

Underlying revenue excluding transit is a measure that seeks to reflect the underlying performance of the group that will contribute to long-term sustainable profitable growth. As such this excludes the impact of acquisitions or disposals, foreign exchange movements and specific items. We exclude transit from the trends as transit traffic is low-margin and is affected by reductions in mobile termination rates. Given the significance of the EE acquisition to the group, in 2016/17 we calculated underlying revenue excluding transit adjusted for the acquisition of EE, as though EE had been part of the group from 1 April 2015. This is different from how we usually adjust for acquisitions.

A reconciliation from the movement in reported revenue, the most directly comparable IFRS measures, to the movement in underlying revenue, is set out below.

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

%

   

2017

%

 

(Decrease)/increase in reported revenue

     (1.4     26.6  

Specific items

           1.0  

(Decrease)/increase in adjusted revenue

     (1.4     27.6  

Adjusted for the acquisition of EEa

           (25.9

(Decrease)/increase in adjusted revenue

     (1.4     1.7  

Transit revenue

                         0.6                           0.1  

Acquisitions and disposals

     0.1       0.1  

Foreign exchange movements

     (0.3     (2.1

Decrease in underlying revenue

     (1.0     (0.2

 

a  Includes EE’s historical financial information for 2016/17 as though it had been part of the group from 1 April 2015.

EBITDA

In addition to measuring financial performance of the group and customer-facing units based on operating profit, we also measure performance based on EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA. EBITDA is defined as the group profit or loss before depreciation, amortisation, net finance expense and taxation. Adjusted EBITDA is defined as EBITDA before specific items. EBITDA is a common measure used by investors and analysts to evaluate the operating financial performance of companies, particularly in the telecommunications sector.

We consider EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA to be useful measures of our operating performance because they approximate the underlying operating cash flow by eliminating depreciation and amortisation. EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA are not direct measures of our liquidity, which is shown by our cash flow statement, and need to be considered in the context of our financial commitments.

 

 
288     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

    

    

    

 

Year ended 31 March     

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Operating profit

       3,381          3,167          3,613  

Depreciation and amortisation

       3,514          3,572          2,631  

EBITDA

       6,895          6,739          6,244  

Specific itemsa

       610          906          215  

Adjusted EBITDA

       7,505          7,645          6,459  

 

a  Excludes amortisation specifics of £nil (2016/17: £62m, 2015/16: £nil). Specific items are set out in note 8 to the consolidated financial statements.

Earnings per share

We also measure financial performance based on adjusted earnings per share, which excludes specific items. Basic and adjusted earnings per share, and the per share impact of specific items, are as follows:

 

               2018                    2017                    2016  
Year ended 31 March    Pence
per share
       £m           Pence
per share
       £m           Pence
per share
       £m  

Basic earnings per share/profit

     20.5          2,032          19.2          1,908          28.5          2,466  

Specific itemsa

     7.4          741            9.7          961            3.3          278  

Adjusted basic earnings per share/profit

     27.9          2,773            28.9          2,869            31.8          2,744  

 

a  Specific items are set out in note 8 to the consolidated financial statements.

We disclose reported earnings per share, both basic and diluted, in note 10 to the consolidated financial statements.

Free cash flow

Normalised free cash flow is one of the group’s key performance indicators by which our financial performance is measured. Normalised free cash flow is defined as the net increase in cash and cash equivalents less: cash flows from financing activities (except net interest paid), the acquisition or disposal of group undertakings and the net sale of short-term investments and excluding: the cash impact of specific items, purchases of telecommunications licences, and the cash tax benefit of pension deficit payments. For non-tax related items the adjustments are made on a pre-tax basis.

Normalised free cash flow is primarily a liquidity measure. However, we also believe it is an important indicator of our overall operational performance as it reflects the cash we generate from operations after capital expenditure and financing costs, both of which are significant ongoing cash outflows associated with investing in our infrastructure and financing our operations. In addition, normalised free cash flow excludes cash flows that are determined at a corporate level independently of ongoing trading operations such as dividends, share buybacks, acquisitions and disposals, and repayment and raising of debt. Normalised free cash flow is not a measure of the funds that are available for distribution to shareholders.

A reconciliation from net cash inflow from operating activities, the most directly comparable IFRS measure, to free cash flow and normalised free cash flow, is set out below.

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Net cash inflow from operating activities

     4,927          6,174          5,151  

Add back pension deficit payments

     872          274          880  

Included in cash flows from investing activities

            

Net capital expenditure

     (3,341        (3,119        (2,431

Interest received

     7          7          10  

Net sales (purchases) of non-current asset investments and dividends received from associates and joint ventures

     19          (20        17  

Included in cash flows from financing activities

            

Interest paid

     (555        (629        (558

Free cash flow

     1,929          2,687          3,069  

Net cash outflow from specific items

     828          205          232  

Payments in respect of acquisition of spectrum

     325                    

Cash tax benefit of pension deficit payments

     (109        (110        (203

Normalised free cash flow

             2,973          2,782          3,098  

Net debt

Net debt consists of loans and other borrowings (both current and non-current), less current asset investments and cash and cash equivalents. Loans and other borrowings are measured as the net proceeds raised, adjusted to amortise any discount over the term of the debt. For the purpose of this measure, current asset investments and cash and cash equivalents are measured at the lower of cost and net realisable value.

 

 
289     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Alternative performance measures continued

    

    

 

Our net debt calculation starts from the expected future undiscounted cash flows that should arise when our financial instruments mature. We adjust these cash flows to reflect hedged risks that are re-measured under fair value hedges, as well as for the impact of the effective interest method. Currency-denominated balances within net debt are translated to Sterling at swap rates where hedged.

Net debt is a measure of the group’s net indebtedness that provides an indicator of the overall balance sheet strength. It is also a single measure that can be used to assess both the group’s cash position and its indebtedness. The use of the term ‘net debt’ does not necessarily mean that the cash included in the net debt calculation is available to settle the liabilities included in this measure.

Net debt is considered to be an alternative performance measure as it is not defined in IFRS. A reconciliation from loans and other borrowings, cash and cash equivalents, and current asset investments, the most directly comparable IFRS measures to net debt, is set out below.

 

At 31 March   

2018

£m

      

2017

£m

      

2016

£m

 

Loans and other borrowingsa

     14,275          12,713          14,761  

Cash and cash equivalents

     (528        (528        (996

Current investments

     (3,022        (1,520        (2,918
     10,725          10,665          10,847  

Adjustments:

            

To retranslate currency denominated balances at swapped rates where hedgedb

     (874        (1,419        (652

To remove fair value adjustments and accrued interest applied to reflect the effective interest methodc

     (224        (314        (357

Net debt

               9,627          8,932          9,838  

 

a  Includes overdrafts of £29m at 31 March 2018 (31 March 2017: £17m, 31 March 2016: £537m).
b  The translation difference between spot rate and hedged rate of loans and borrowings denominated in foreign currency.
c  Includes remaining fair value adjustments made on certain loans and other borrowings and accrued interest at the balance sheet date.

 

 
290     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Selected financial data

Summary group income statement

 

Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

   

2016

£m

   

2015

£m

   

2014

£m

 

Revenue

          

Adjusted

     23,746       24,082       18,879       17,840       18,287  

Specific items

     (23     (20     133       128        
     23,723       24,062       19,012       17,968       18,287  

Operating costs

          

Adjusted

     (19,755     (19,947     (15,051     (14,185     (14,866

Specific items

     (587     (948     (348     (381     (276
     (20,342     (20,895     (15,399     (14,566     (15,142

Operating profit

          

Adjusted

     3,991       4,135       3,828       3,655       3,421  

Specific items

     (610     (968     (215     (253     (276
     3,381       3,167       3,613       3,402       3,145  

Net finance expense

          

Adjusted

     (546     (594     (483     (560     (591

Specific items

     (218     (210     (229     (299     (235
     (764     (804     (712     (859     (826

Share of post tax (loss) profit of associates and joint ventures

          

Adjusted

     (1     (9     6       (1     (3

Profit (loss) on disposal of interest in associates and joint ventures – specific items

                       25       (4

Profit before taxation

          

Adjusted

     3,444       3,532       3,351       3,094       2,827  

Specific items

     (828     (1,178     (444     (527     (515
     2,616       2,354       2,907       2,567       2,312  

Taxation expense

          

Adjusted

     (671     (663     (607     (631     (613

Specific items

     87       217       166       121       319  
     (584     (446     (441     (510     (294

Profit for the year

          

Adjusted

     2,773       2,869       2,744       2,463       2,214  

Specific items

     (741     (961     (278     (406     (196
       2,032       1,908       2,466       2,057       2,018  

Basic earnings per share

          

Adjusted

     27.9p       28.9p       31.8p       30.6p       28.2p  

Specific items

     (7.4)p       (9.7)p       (3.3)p       (5.1)p       (2.5)p  
       20.5p       19.2p       28.5p       25.5p       25.7p  

Average number of shares used in basic earnings per share (millions)

     9,911       9,938       8,619       8,056       7,857  

Average number of shares used in diluted earnings per share (millions)

     9,961       9,994       8,714       8,191       8,231  

Diluted earnings per share

     20.4p       19.1p       28.2p       25.1p       24.5p  

Dividends per sharea

     15.4p       15.4p       14.0p       12.4p       10.9p  

Dividends per share, US centsa,b

              21.6c                19.3c                20.1c                18.4c                18.2c  

 

a  Dividends per share represents the dividend paid and proposed in respect of the relevant financial year. Under IFRS, interim dividends are recognised as a deduction from shareholders’ equity when they are paid, final dividends when they are approved.
b  Based on actual dividends paid and/or year end exchange rate on proposed dividends.

 

 
291     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Selected financial data continued

Summary group balance sheet

 

                                                                                                        
At 31 March   

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

   

2016

£m

   

2015

£m

   

2014

£m

 

Intangible assets

     14,447       15,029       15,450       3,170       3,087  

Property, plant and equipment

     17,000       16,498       15,971       13,498       13,840  

Other non-current assets

     2,963       3,970       2,997       3,040       2,265  

Total non-current assets

     34,410       35,497       34,418       19,708       19,192  

Current assets less current liabilities

     (1,836     (4,050     (3,103     (356     (1,981

Total assets less current liabilities

     32,574       31,447       31,315       19,352       17,211  

Non-current loans and other borrowings

     (11,994     (10,081     (11,025     (7,862     (7,941

Retirement benefit obligations

     (6,371     (9,088     (6,382     (7,583     (7,022

Other non-current liabilities

     (3,905     (3,943     (3,796     (3,226     (2,840

Total assets less liabilities

     10,304       8,335       10,112       681       (592

Ordinary shares

     499       499       499       419       408  

Share premium account

     1,051       1,051       1,051       1,051       62  

Own shares

     (186     (96     (115     (165     (829

Merger reserve

     6,647       6,647       8,422       998       998  

Other reserves

     534       884       685       502       449  

Retained loss

     1,759       (650     (430     (2,124     (1,680

Total equity (deficit)

     10,304       8,335       10,112       681       (592

 

 
292     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Financial and operational statistics

Financial statistics

 

                                                                                                        
Year ended 31 March   

2018

£m

   

2017

£m

   

2016

£m

   

2015

£m

   

2014

£m

 

(Decrease) increase in underlying revenue excluding transita,b

     (1.0)%       (0.2)%       1.9%       (0.4)%       0.5%  

Adjusted EBITDAa,b

     7,505       7,645       6,459       6,193       6,116  

Cash flowa

          

– Free cash flow

     1,929       2,687       3,069       2,782       2,171  

– Normalised free cash flow

     2,973       2,782       3,098       2,830       2,450  

Net debt at 31 Marcha

     9,627       8,932       9,838       5,113       7,028  

Operating costs excluding depreciation and amortisationb

     16,241       16,437       12,420       11,647       12,171  

Expenditure on research and development

          

Research and development operating expense

     59       61       73       87       170  

Capitalised software development costs

     450       457       399       421       365  

Total expenditure on research and development

     509       518       472       508       535  

Capital expenditure

          

Additions to property, plant and equipment comprised:

          

Land and buildings

     31       42       31       31       44  

Network infrastructure

          

Transmission equipment

     1,687       1,592       1,531       1,463       1,126  

Exchange equipment

     121       126       41       33       24  

Other network equipment

     1,015       917       652       455       657  

Other

          

Computers and office equipment

     83       119       48       85       112  

Motor vehicles and other

     31       22       19       75       8  

Total additions to property, plant and equipment

     2,968       2,818       2,322       2,142       1,971  

(Increase) decrease in engineering stores

     (14     (13     (3     6       (5
     2,954       2,805       2,319       2,148       1,966  

Software additions

     642       621       412       561       506  

Total capital expenditure before government grants

     3,596       3,426       2,731       2,709       2,472  

Government grants

     (74     28       (109     (392     (126

Total capital expenditure net of government grants

     3,522       3,454       2,622       2,317       2,346  

(Decrease) increase in net payables and receivables

     (160     (309     (184     93       10  

Cash outflow from capital expenditure before purchases of telecommunications licences

     3,362       3,145       2,438       2,410       2,356  

Purchases of telecommunications licencesc

     325                          

Cash outflow from total capital expenditure

     3,687       3,145       2,438       2,410       2,356  

 

a  Defined on pages 288 to 290.
b  Before specific items.
c  Relates to the prepayment of spectrum licences.

 

 
293     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Financial and operational statistics continued

Financial ratios

 

                                                                                                        
Year ended 31 March    2018      2017      2016      2015      2014  

Return on capital employed – %a

     11.8        11.2        12.7        23.3        21.1  

Adjustedb – %

     14.0        14.6        13.5        24.9        22.9  

Interest cover – timesc

     4.4        3.9        5.1        4.0        3.8  

Adjustedb – times

     7.3        7.0        7.9        6.5        5.8  

Net debt to adjusted EBITDAb – times

     1.3        1.2        1.5        0.8        1.1  

Capital expenditure as a percentage of revenueb – %

     14.8        14.3        13.9        13.0        12.8  

 

a  The ratio is based on profit before taxation and net finance expense to capital employed. Capital employed is represented by total assets less current liabilities (excluding corporation tax, current borrowings, derivative financial liabilities and finance lease creditors) less deferred and current tax assets, retirement benefit asset, cash and cash equivalents, derivative financial assets and investments.
b  Before specific items.
c  The number of times net finance expense is covered by operating profit.

 

 
294     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Operational statistics

All values in thousands unless otherwise stated

 

                                                                                                        
Year ended 31 March    2018      2017      2016      2015      2014  

BT Consumer

              

Average revenue per user (ARPU)a (£)

     41.7        39.9        37.1        34.6        32.6  

Business and Public Sector

              

Order intake (£m)

     3,391        3,369        3,163        3,781        2,098  

Global Services

              

Order intake (£m)

     3,845        4,604        5,124        5,000        6,963  

Wholesale and Ventures

              

Order intake (£m)

     1,418        1,956        1,421        1,887        1,910  

Ethernet circuits

     46.6        43.8        38.5        31.7         

Openreach

              

Physical lines

              

Internal

     12,322        12,657        12,915        12,274        12,700  

External

     3,610        3,541        3,563        4,509        4,580  

Fully unbundled

     9,191        9,047        8,921        8,586        7,846  

Total physical lines

     25,124        25,245        25,399        25,370        25,126  

BT Group

              

TV customers

     1,738        1,750        1,561        1,142        1,002  

Broadband lines

              

Total retail

     9,339        9,276        9,041        7,713        7,281  

Wholesale and Ventures (external)

     849        886        906        1,831        1,872  

Openreach

     10,189        10,162        9,947        9,544        9,302  

Broadband market share

              

Total retail share of net asset additionsb

     22%        55%        65%        51%        69%  

Total retail share of installed base

     45%        46%        45%        40%        39%  

Lines sold through BT lines of businessc

              

Consumer/EE

     10,134        10,313        10,411        9,633        9,908  

Business/corporate

     2,651        2,937        3,228        3,481        3,784  

Total exchange lines

     12,785        13,250        13,639        13,114        13,692  

Mobile based

     29,558        29,911        30,445        n/a        n/a  

Mobile churn (%)

              

Total

     2.3        2.1        n/a        n/a        n/a  

Postpaid

     1.2        1.1        n/a        n/a        n/a  

Mobile ARPU (£)

              

Postpaid

     26.0        26.3        26.0        n/a        n/a  

Prepaid

     4.8        4.4        4.0        n/a        n/a  

Total

     20.8        19.8        18.3        n/a        n/a  

 

a  BT Consumer revenue per-month, less mobile POLOs, less BT Sport revenue from: satellite customers paying for the channels, our wholesale deals and from commercial premises. This is divided by the average number of primary lines.
b  DSL and fibre excluding cable.
c  Lines sold through BT customer-facing units include analogue lines and digital channels sold through Global Services, Business and Public Sector, BT Consumer, EE and Wholesale and Ventures.
d  2016/17 figures restated to remove inactive base.

 

 
295     Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Information for shareholders

 

Cautionary statement regarding forward-looking statements

This Annual Report contains certain forward-looking statements which are made in reliance on the safe harbour provisions of the US Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. These statements relate to analyses and other information which are based on forecasts of future results and estimates of amounts not yet determinable. These statements include, without limitation, those concerning: current and future years’ outlook; underlying revenue and revenue trends; EBITDA; free cash flow; capital expenditure; shareholder returns including dividends and share buyback; net debt; credit ratings; our group-wide transformation and restructuring programme, cost transformation plans and restructuring costs; investment in and roll out of our fibre network, and its reach, innovations, increased speeds and speed availability; our broadband-based service and strategy; investment in 5G; our investment in TV, enhancing our TV service and BT Sport; the recovery plan, operating charge, regular cash contributions and interest expense for our defined benefit pension schemes; effective tax rate; growth opportunities in networked IT services, the pay-TV services market, broadband, and mobility and future voice; growth of, and opportunities available in, the communications industry and BT’s positioning to take advantage of those opportunities; further financial and other benefits to be realised from the EE acquisition; expectations regarding competition, market shares, prices and growth; expectations regarding the convergence of technologies; plans for the launch of new products and services; network performance and quality; the impact of regulatory initiatives, decisions and outcomes on operations, including the regulation of the UK fixed wholesale and retail businesses and the impact of the agreement reached with Ofcom, as a result of which BT formed Openreach Limited as a subsidiary with enhanced independence; BT’s possible or assumed future results of operations and/or those of its associates and joint ventures; investment plans; adequacy of capital; financing plans and refinancing requirements; demand for and access to broadband and the promotion of broadband by third-party service providers; improvements to the control environment; and those statements preceded by, followed by, or that include the words ‘aims’, ‘believes’, ‘expects’, ‘anticipates’, ‘intends’, ‘will’, ‘should’ ‘plans’, ‘strategy’, ‘future’, ‘likely’, ‘seeks’, ‘projects’, ‘estimates’ or similar expressions.

Although BT believes that the expectations reflected in these forward-looking statements are reasonable, it can give no assurance that these expectations will prove to have been correct. Because these statements involve risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements. Factors that could cause differences between actual results and those implied by the forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to: material adverse changes in economic conditions in the markets served by BT whether as a result of the uncertainties arising from the UK’s exit from the EU or otherwise; future regulatory and legal actions, decisions, outcomes of appeal and conditions or requirements in BT’s operating areas, as well as competition from others; the impact of the agreement reached with Ofcom, as a result of which BT formed Openreach Limited as a subsidiary with enhanced independence; the results of any future spectrum auctions; selection by BT and its customer-facing units of the appropriate trading and marketing models for its products and services; technological innovations, including the cost of developing new products, networks and solutions and the need to increase expenditures for improving the quality of service; the anticipated benefits and advantages of new technologies, products and services not being realised; developments in the convergence of technologies; external threats to cyber security, data or resilience; political and geo-political risks; prolonged adverse weather conditions resulting in a material increase in overtime, employee or other costs or impact on customer service; the timing of entry and profitability of BT in certain markets; significant changes in market shares for BT or its principal products and services; fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates or interest rates; the underlying assumptions and estimates made in respect of major customer contracts proving unreliable; the aims and anticipated savings of our group-wide transformation and restructuring programme not being achieved; the anticipated benefits and synergies of the EE integration not being delivered; the improvements to the control environment following the investigations into BT’s Italian business being ineffective; and general financial market conditions affecting BT’s performance and ability to raise finance. Certain of these factors are discussed in more detail elsewhere in this Annual Report including, without limitation, in Our risks on pages 56 to 71. BT undertakes no obligation to update any forward-looking statements whether written or oral that may be made from time to time, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.

 

 

 
296    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Stock exchange listings

The principal listing of BT Group’s ordinary shares is on the London Stock Exchange. Trading on the London Stock Exchange is under the symbol ‘BT.A’. American Depositary Shares (ADSs), have been issued by JPMorgan Chase & Co, as Depositary for the American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) evidencing the ADSs, and are listed on the New York Stock Exchange. Trading on the New York Stock Exchange is under the symbol ‘BT’.

In December 2015 BT changed the ratio of its NYSE-listed American Depositary Receipt (ADR) programme from the previous ratio of one ADR per ten ordinary shares to one ADR per five ordinary shares. These changes to the ADR ratio have brought the ADR price broadly in line with the market average. To implement the change, ADR holders on the record at the close of business on 30 November 2015 received two ADRs for every one ADR held. There was no change to the underlying ordinary shares.

Share and ADS prices

 

     Pence per ordinary share            US$ per ADS  
     

High

        pence

     Low
pence
           

            High

US$

     Low
US$
 

Financial years ended 31 March

             

2013

     281.00        200.70          42.76          31.02  

2014

     418.10        265.70          69.75        40.70  

2015

     470.55        356.20          70.18        57.99  

2016a

     499.80        404.00          37.49        31.18  

2017a

     454.90        302.10          33.46        19.29  

2018

     318.30        218.10                21.07        15.45  

Financial year ended 31 March 2017a

             

1 April – 30 June 2016

     454.90        375.85          33.46        25.21  

1 July – 30 September 2016

     414.35        375.30          27.66        24.93  

1 October – 31 December 2016

     389.20        346.70          24.89        22.05  

1 January – 31 March 2017

     396.85        302.10                24.57        19.29  

Financial year ended 31 March 2018

             

1 April – 30 June 2017

     318.30        282.00          20.71        18.15  

1 July – 30 September 2017

     316.90        282.50          21.07        18.78  

1 October – 31 December 2017

     283.90        243.70          19.24        16.22  

1 January – 31 March 2018

     275.80        218.10                18.91        15.45  

Monthsa

             

November 2017

     260.70        243.70          17.69        16.22  

December 2017

     277.40        257.10          18.58        17.27  

January 2018

     275.80        255.50          18.91        18.22  

February 2018

     256.10        225.50          18.73        16.01  

March 2018

     240.50        218.10          16.85        15.45  

April 2018

     249.40        225.30          17.47        15.92  

4 May 2018

     245.00        232.10                16.87        15.97  

 

a  The ADS prices stated for 2016/17 reflect the change in ADR ratio.

The prices are the highest and lowest closing middle market prices for BT ordinary shares, as derived from the Daily Official List of the London Stock Exchange and the highest and lowest closing sales prices of ADSs, as reported on the New York Stock Exchange.

Fluctuations in the exchange rate between Sterling and the US Dollar affect the US Dollar equivalent of the Sterling price of the company’s ordinary shares on the London Stock Exchange and, as a result, are likely to affect the market price of the ADSs on the New York Stock Exchange.

Background

BT Group plc is a public limited company registered in England and Wales and listed on the London and New York Stock Exchanges. It was incorporated in England and Wales on 30 March 2001 as Newgate Telecommunications Limited with the registered number 4190816. Its registered office address is 81 Newgate Street, London EC1A 7AJ. The company changed its name to BT Group plc on 11 September 2001.

Following the demerger of mmO2 from BT in November 2001, the continuing activities of BT were transferred to BT Group plc.

British Telecommunications plc is a wholly-owned subsidiary of BT Group plc and encompasses virtually all the businesses and assets of the group. The successor to the statutory corporation British Telecommunications, it was incorporated in England and Wales as a public limited company, wholly owned by the Government, as a result of the Telecommunications Act 1984. Between November 1984 and July 1993, the Government sold all of its shareholding in British Telecommunications plc in three public offerings.

 

 
297    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Information for shareholders continued

 

 

Analysis of shareholdings at 31 March 2018

 

    

Ordinary shares of 5p each

 
Range    Number of
holdings
    

Percentage

of total

%

    

Number of

shares held

millions

    

Percentage

of total

%

 

 1 – 399

     302,212        39.58        63        0.64  

 400 – 799

     199,682        26.15        111        1.11  

 800 – 1,599

     145,320        19.04        163        1.64  

 1,600 – 9,999

     110,598        14.49        341        3.42  

 10,000 – 99,999

     4,533        0.59        86        0.86  

 100,000 – 999,999

     669        0.09        253        2.53  

 1,000,000 – 4,999,999

     293        0.04        670        6.72  

 5,000,000 and abovea,b,c,d

     185        0.02        8,281        83.08  

 Totale

     763,492        100.00        9,968        100.00  

 

a  12.8m shares were held in trust by Ilford Trustees (Jersey) Limited for allocation to employees under the employee share plans.
b  Under the BT Group Employee Share Investment Plan, 59.01m shares were held in trust on behalf of 41,611 participants who were beneficially entitled to the shares. 386.2m shares were held in the corporate nominee BT Group EasyShare on behalf of 91,968 beneficial owners.
c  159.9m shares were represented by ADSs. An analysis by size of holding is not available for these.
d  46.2m shares were held as treasury shares.
e  7.27% of the shares were in 755,123 individual holdings, of which 48,505 were joint holdings, and 92.73% of the shares were in 8,369 institutional holdings.

As far as the company is aware, the company is not directly or indirectly owned or controlled by another corporation or by the UK Government or any other foreign government or by any other natural or legal person severally or jointly. There are no arrangements known to the company, the operation of which may at a subsequent date result in a change in control of the company.

The company’s major shareholders do not have different voting rights to those of other shareholders.

At 9 May 2018, there were 9,968,127,681 ordinary shares outstanding, including 46,224,781 shares held as treasury shares. At the same date, approximately 31.9m ADSs (equivalent to 159.6m ordinary shares, or approximately 1.6% of the total number of ordinary shares outstanding on that date) were outstanding and were held by 1,412 record holders of ADRs.

At 31 March 2018, there were 3,432 shareholders with a US address on the register of shareholders who in total hold 0.02% of the ordinary shares of the company.

 

 
298    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Dividends

A final dividend in respect of the year ended 31 March 2017 was paid on 4 September 2017 to shareholders on the register on 11 August 2017, and an interim dividend in respect of the year ended 31 March 2018 was paid on 5 February 2018 to shareholders on the register on 29 December 2017. The final proposed dividend in respect of the year ended 31 March 2018, if approved by shareholders, will be paid on 3 September 2018 to shareholders on the register on 10 August 2018.

The dividends paid or payable on BT shares and ADSs for the last five financial years are shown in the following table. The dividends on the ordinary shares exclude the associated tax credit. The amounts shown are not those that were actually paid to holders of ADSs. For the tax treatment of dividends paid, see Taxation of dividends on page 305. Dividends have been translated from Sterling into US Dollars using exchange rates prevailing on the date the ordinary dividends were paid.

 

            Per ordinary share                    Per ADS                    Per ADS  
Financial years ended 31 March    Interim
pence
     Final
pence
     Total
pence
    

Interim

£

    

Final

£

    

Total

£

     Interim
US$
     Final
US$
     Total
US$
 

 2014

     3.40        7.50        10.90        0.340        0.750        1.090        0.534        1.187        1.721  

 2015

     3.90        8.50        12.40        0.390        0.850        1.240        0.573        1.285        1.858  

 2016

     4.40        9.60        14.00        0.220a        0.480a        0.700a        0.296a        0.623        0.919  

 2017

     4.85        10.55        15.40        0.2425        0.5275        0.770        0.281          0.6658          0.9468  

 2018

     4.85          10.55          15.40          0.2425          0.5275          0.770          0.319        b        b  

 

a  The reduction in the dividend payment is to reflect the ratio change to BT ADRs.
b  Qualifying holders of ADSs on record as of 10 August 2018 are entitled to receive the final dividend which will be paid to ADS holders on 11 September 2018, subject to approval at the AGM. The US Dollar amount of the final dividend of 52.75 pence per ADS to be paid to holders of ADSs will be based on the exchange rate in effect on 3 September 2018, the date of payment to holders of ordinary shares.

As dividends paid by the company are in Sterling, exchange rate fluctuations will affect the US Dollar amounts received by holders of ADSs on conversion by the Depositary of such cash dividends.

Dividend mandate

Any shareholder wishing dividends to be paid directly into a bank or building society account should contact the Shareholder Helpline (see page 308), or go to the Shareholder information page of our website.

Dividends paid in this way will be paid through the Bankers Automated Clearing System (BACS).

Share buyback

 

Calendar montha     

Total number

of shares

purchased

 

 

 

    

Average price paid

per share (pence –

  net of dealing costs)

 

 

 

    

  Total number of shares

purchased as part of

publicly announced

plans or programmes

 

 

 

 

    

Maximum number

of shares yet to be

  purchased under the

AGM authority

 

 

 

b  

 April 2017

     nil        n/a        nil        988,729,595  

 May

     nil        n/a        nil        988,729,595  

 June

     43,402,777        288        43,402,777        945,326,818  

 July

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  

 August

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  

 September

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  

 October

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  

 November

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  

 December

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  

 January 2018

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  

 February

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  

 March

     nil        n/a        nil        945,326,818  
       43,402,777        288        43,402,777        945,326,818  

 

a  Purchases made from 1 April 2017 to 12 July 2017 were made in accordance with a resolution passed at the AGM held on 13 July 2016. Own share purchases by BT from 13 July 2017 to 31 March 2018 were made in accordance with a resolution passed at the AGM on 12 July 2017.
b  Authority was given to purchase up to 792m shares on 13 July 2016 and 837m shares on 12 July 2017. These authorities expire at the close of the following AGM.

A total of 43.4m own shares were purchased during 2017/18. Of these, 43.4m shares were purchased for a total consideration of £125m (under the authority given at the 2016 AGM), and 32.4m shares were purchased by the BT Group Employee Share Ownership Trust for a consideration of £95m. Please see note 21 to the consolidated financial statements for further details.

 

 
299    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Information for shareholders continued

Dividend investment plan

Under the Dividend investment plan, cash from participants’ dividends is used to buy further BT shares in the market. Shareholders could elect to receive additional shares in lieu of a cash dividend for the following dividends:

 

      Date paid                    Price per share
pence
 

 2012/13 interim

             4 February 2013        265.01  

 2012/13 final

     2 September 2013        339.38  

 2013/14 interim

     3 February 2014        385.76  

 2013/14 final

     8 September 2014        387.00  

 2014/15 interim

     9 February 2015        436.92  

 2014/15 final

     7 September 2015        428.17  

 2015/16 interim

     8 February 2016        469.41  

 2015/16 final

     5 September 2016        394.44  

 2016/17 interim

     6 February 2017        309.41  

 2016/17 final

     4 September 2017        291.07  

 2017/18 interim

     5 February 2018        248.73  

Global Invest Direct

Details of the direct purchase plan run by the ADR Depositary, JPMorgan Chase & Co, Global Invest Direct, including reinvestment of dividends, are available from JPMorgan Chase & Co on +1 800 428 4237 (toll free within the US), or on written request to the ADR Depositary.

Total shareholder return

Total Shareholder Return (TSR) is the measure of the returns that a company has generated for its shareholders, reflecting both movement in the share price and dividends, which are assumed to be reinvested. We compare this against indexes for the UK market (FTSE100) and the European telecommunications sector (FTSEurofirst 300 Telco Index). BT’s TSR for 2017/18 was negative 25.1%, compared with the market which was positive 23.3% and the sector which was negative 3.1%. Over the last five financial years BT’s TSR was positive 65.1%, compared with the market’s TSR of positive 53.0% and the sector’s TSR of positive 54.1%.

BT’s TSR performance vs the FTSE100 and the Sector

over the last 9 years

31 March 2009=100

 

LOGO

Source: Datastream.

NB: Sector index is shown in Euro terms.

However the performance in Sterling is the same as in the graph shown above.

 

 
300    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Results announcements

Expected announcements of results:

 

Results for the 2018/19 financial year    Datea

 1st quarter

     27 July 2018  

 2nd quarter and half year

     November 2018  

 3rd quarter and nine months

     February 2019  

 4th quarter and full year

     May 2019  

 Annual Report 2019 published

     May 2019  

 

a  Dates may be subject to change.

ShareGift

Small parcels of shares, which may be uneconomic to sell on their own, can be donated to ShareGift – the share donation charity (Registered Charity number 1052686). ShareGift transfers these holdings into their name, aggregates them, and uses the proceeds to support a wide range of UK registered charities based on donor suggestion. They can also accept larger donations of shares.

If you would like further details about ShareGift, please visit sharegift.org email help@sharegift.org or telephone them on 020 7930 3737.

Exchange rates

BT publishes its consolidated financial statements expressed in Sterling. The following tables provide certain information concerning the exchange rates between Sterling and US Dollars based on the noon buying rate in New York City for cable transfers in Sterling as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (the Noon Buying Rate).

 

Year ended 31 March                2018              2017              2016              2015              2014  

 Period end

     1.40        1.25        1.44        1.49        1.67  

 Averagea

     1.33        1.31        1.50        1.61        1.60  

 High

     1.43        1.47        1.59        1.72        1.68  

 Low

     1.24        1.21        1.39        1.47        1.48  

a  The average of the Noon Buying Rates in effect on the last day of each month during the relevant period.

   

                                     Month  
     

  April

2018

       March
2018
       February
2018
       January
2018
       December
2017
 

 High

     1.43        1.42        1.42        1.43        1.35  

 Low

     1.37        1.37        1.38        1.35        1.33  

On 4 May 2018, the latest practicable date for this Annual Report, the Noon Buying Rate was US$1.35 to £1.00.

 

 
301    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Information for shareholders continued

 

Articles of Association (Articles)

The following is a summary of the principal provisions of BT’s Articles, a copy of which has been filed with the Registrar of Companies. A ‘holder of shares’ and a ’shareholder’ is, in either case, the person entered on the company’s register of members as the holder of the relevant shares. Shareholders can choose whether their shares are to be evidenced by share certificates (ie in certificated form) or held in electronic (ie uncertificated) form in CREST (the electronic settlement system in the UK).

BT adopted new Articles of Association with effect from July 2015, to provide additional flexibility for BT when trying to trace shareholders and to amend the provisions in line with the UK Corporate Governance code by providing for automatic retirement of all the directors at each AGM.

(a) Voting rights

Subject to the restrictions described below, on a show of hands, every shareholder present in person or by proxy at any general meeting has one vote and, on a poll, every shareholder present in person or by proxy has one vote for each share which they hold.

Voting at any meeting of shareholders is by a show of hands unless a poll is demanded by the chairman of the meeting or by at least five shareholders at the meeting who are entitled to vote (or their proxies), or by one or more shareholders at the meeting who are entitled to vote (or their proxies) and who have, between them, at least 10% of the total votes of all shareholders who have the right to vote at the meeting.

No person is, unless the Board decides otherwise, entitled to attend or vote at any general meeting or to exercise any other right conferred by being a shareholder if they or any person appearing to be interested in those shares has been sent a notice under section 793 of the Companies Act 2006 (which confers upon public companies the power to require information with respect to interests in their voting shares) and they or any interested person has failed to supply to the company the information requested within 14 days after delivery of that notice.

These restrictions end seven days after the earlier of the date the shareholder complies with the request satisfactorily or the company receives notice that there has been an approved transfer of the shares.

(b) Variation of rights

Whenever the share capital of the company is split into different classes of shares, the special rights attached to any of those classes can be varied or withdrawn either:

 

(i) with the sanction of a special resolution passed at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class; or
(ii) with the consent in writing of the holders of at least 75% in nominal value of the issued shares of that class.

At any separate meeting, the necessary quorum is two persons holding or representing by proxy not less than one-third in nominal amount of the issued shares of the class in question (but at any adjourned meeting, any person holding shares of the class or his proxy is a quorum).

The company can issue new shares and attach any rights and restrictions to them, as long as this is not restricted by special rights previously given to holders of any existing shares. Subject to this, the rights of new shares can take priority over the rights of

existing shares, or existing shares can take priority over them, or the new shares and the existing shares can rank equally.

(c) Changes in capital

The company may by ordinary resolution:

 

(i) divide all or any of its share capital into shares with a smaller nominal value; and
(ii) consolidate and divide all or part of its share capital into shares of a larger nominal value.

The company may also:

 

(i) buy back its own shares; and
(ii) by special resolution reduce its share capital, any capital redemption reserve and any share premium account.

(d) Dividends

The company’s shareholders can declare dividends by passing an ordinary resolution provided that no dividend can exceed the amount recommended by the directors. Dividends must be paid out of profits available for distribution. If the Board considers that the profits of the company justify such payments, they can pay interim dividends on any class of shares of the amounts and on the dates and for the periods they decide. Fixed dividends will be paid on any class of shares on the dates stated for the payments of those dividends.

The directors can offer ordinary shareholders the right to choose to receive new ordinary shares, which are credited as fully paid, instead of some or all of their cash dividend. Before they can do this, the company’s shareholders must have passed an ordinary resolution authorising the directors to make this offer.

Any dividend which has not been claimed for ten years after it was declared or became due for payment will be forfeited and will belong to the company.

(e) Distribution of assets on winding up

If the company is wound up (whether the liquidation is voluntary, under supervision of the court or by the court) the liquidator can, with the authority of a special resolution passed by the shareholders, divide among the shareholders all or any part of the assets of the company. This applies whether the assets consist of property of one kind or different kinds. For this purpose, the liquidator can place whatever value the liquidator considers fair on any property and decide how the division is carried out between shareholders or different groups of shareholders. The liquidator can also, with the same authority, transfer any assets to trustees upon any trusts for the benefit of shareholders which the liquidator decides. The liquidation of the company can then be finalised and the company dissolved. No past or present shareholder can be compelled to accept any shares or other property under the Articles which could give that shareholder a liability.

(f) Transfer of shares

Certificated shares of the company may be transferred in writing either by an instrument of transfer in the usual standard form or in another form approved by the Board. The transfer form must be signed or made effective by or on behalf of the person making the transfer. The person making the transfer will be treated as continuing to be the holder of the shares transferred until the name of the person to whom the shares are being transferred is entered in the register of members of the company.

 

 

 
302    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

 

The Board may refuse to register any transfer of any share held in certificated form:

 

(i) which is in favour of more than four joint holders; or
(ii) unless the transfer form to be registered is properly stamped to show payment of any applicable stamp duty and delivered to the company’s registered office or any other place the Board decide. The transfer must have with it: the share certificate for the shares to be transferred; any other evidence which the Board ask for to prove that the person wanting to make the transfer is entitled to do this; and if the transfer form is executed by another person on behalf of the person making the transfer, evidence of the authority of that person to do so.

Transfers of uncertificated shares must be carried out using a relevant system (as defined in the Uncertificated Securities

Regulations 2001 (the Regulations)). The Board can refuse to register a transfer of an uncertificated share in the circumstances stated in the Regulations.

If the Board decide not to register a transfer of a share, the Board must notify the person to whom that share was to be transferred giving reasons for its decision. This must be done as soon as possible and no later than two months after the company receives the transfer or instruction from the operator of the relevant system.

(g) Untraced shareholders

The company may sell any shares if the shares have been in issue for at least ten years, during that period at least three dividends have become payable on them and have not been cashed and BT has not heard from the shareholder or any person entitled to the dividends by transmission. BT must take all reasonable steps in the circumstances, to trace shareholders. This can include engaging an asset reunification company or other tracing agent to search for shareholders who have not kept their details up-to date, or taking any other steps the company considers appropriate. Shareholders whose shares are sold following this process will not be able to claim the proceeds of the sale. BT will be able to use the proceeds in any way the Board from time to time thinks fit.

(h) General meetings of shareholders

Every year the company must hold an annual general meeting. The Board can call a general meeting at any time and, under general law, must call one on a shareholders’ requisition. At least 21 clear days’ written notice must be given for every annual general meeting. For every other general meeting, at least 14 clear days’ written notice must be given. The Board can specify in the notice of meeting a time by which a person must be entered on the register of shareholders in order to have the right to attend or vote at the meeting. The time specified must not be more than 48 hours before the time fixed for the meeting.

(i) Limitations on rights of non-resident or foreign shareholders

The only limitation imposed by the Articles on the rights of non-resident or foreign shareholders is that a shareholder whose registered address is outside the UK and who wishes to receive notices of meetings of shareholders or documents from BT must give the company an address within the UK to which they may be sent.

(j) Directors

Directors’ remuneration

Excluding remuneration referred to below, each director will be paid such fee for his services as the Board decide, not exceeding £65,000 a year and increasing by the percentage increase of the retail prices index (as defined by section 833(2) Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988) for any 12-month period beginning 1 April 1999 or an anniversary of that date. The company may by ordinary resolution decide on a higher sum. This resolution can increase the fee paid to all or any directors either permanently or for a particular period. The directors may be paid their expenses properly incurred in connection with the business of the company.

The Board can award extra fees to a director who: holds an executive position; acts as chairman or deputy chairman; serves on a Board committee at the request of the Board; or performs any other services which the Board consider extend beyond the ordinary duties of a director.

The directors may grant pensions or other benefits to, among others, any director or former director or persons connected with them. However, BT can only provide these benefits to any director or former director who has not been an employee or held any other office or executive position in the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings, or to relations or dependants of, or people connected to, those directors or former directors, if the shareholders approve this by passing an ordinary resolution.

Directors’ votes

A director need not be a shareholder, but a director who is not a shareholder can still attend and speak at shareholders’ meetings.

Unless the Articles say otherwise, a director cannot vote on a resolution about a contract in which the director has an interest (this will also apply to interests of a person connected with the director).

If the legislation allows, a director can vote and be counted in the quorum on a resolution concerning a contract:

 

(i) in which the director has an interest of which the director is not aware; or which cannot reasonably be regarded as likely to give rise to a conflict of interest;
(ii) in which the director has an interest only because the director is a holder of shares, debentures or other securities of BT, or by reason of any other interest in or through BT;
(iii) which involves: the giving of any security, guarantee or indemnity to the director or any other person for money lent or obligations incurred by the director or by any other person at the request of or for the benefit of BT or the benefit of any of its subsidiary undertakings; or a debt or other obligation which is owed by BT or any of its subsidiary undertakings to that other person if the director has taken responsibility for all or any part of that debt or obligation by giving a guarantee, security or indemnity;
(iv) where BT or any of its subsidiary undertakings is offering any shares, debentures or other securities for subscription or purchase to which the director is or may be entitled to participate as a holder of BT securities; or where the director will be involved in the underwriting or sub-underwriting;
 

 

 
303    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Information for shareholders continued

 

(v) relating to any other company in which the director has an interest, directly or indirectly (including holding a position in that company) or is a shareholder, creditor, employee or otherwise involved in that company – these rights do not apply if the director owns 1% or more of that company or of the voting rights in that company;
(vi) relating to an arrangement for the benefit of BT employees or former BT employees or any of BT’s subsidiary undertakings which only gives the directors the same benefits that are generally given to the employees or former employees to whom the arrangement relates;
(vii) relating to BT buying or renewing insurance for any liability for the benefit of directors or for the benefit of persons who include directors;
(viii) relating to the giving of indemnities in favour of directors;
(ix) relating to the funding of expenditure by any director or directors: on defending criminal, civil or regulatory proceedings or actions against the director or the directors; in connection with an application to the court for relief; or on defending the director or the directors in any regulatory investigations; or which enables any director or directors to avoid incurring expenditure as described in this paragraph; and
(x) in which the director’s interest, or the interest of directors generally, has been authorised by an ordinary resolution.

Subject to the relevant legislation, the shareholders can, by passing an ordinary resolution, ratify any particular contract carried out in breach of those provisions.

Directors’ appointment and retirement

Under BT’s Articles there must be at least two directors, who manage the business of the company. The shareholders can vary this minimum and/or decide a maximum by ordinary resolution. The Board and the shareholders (by ordinary resolution) may appoint a person who is willing to be elected as a director, either to fill a vacancy or as an additional director.

At every annual general meeting, all directors must automatically retire. A retiring director is eligible for re-election.

In addition to any power of removal under the 2006 Act, the shareholders can pass an ordinary resolution to remove a director, even though his or her time in office has not ended. They can elect a person to replace that director subject to the Articles, by passing an ordinary resolution. A person so appointed is subject to retirement by rotation when the director replaced would have been due to retire.

Directors’ borrowing powers

To the extent that the legislation and the Articles allow, the Board can exercise all the powers of the company to borrow money, to mortgage or charge its business, property and assets (present and future) and to issue debentures and other securities, and give security either outright or as collateral security for any debt, liability or obligation of the company or another person. The Board must limit the borrowings of the company and exercise all the company’s voting and other rights or powers of control exercisable by the company in relation to its subsidiary undertakings so as to ensure that the aggregate amount of all borrowings by the group outstanding, net of amounts borrowed intragroup among other things, at any time does not exceed £35bn. These borrowing powers may only be varied by amending the Articles.

(k) Sinking fund, liability to further calls and change of control

BT’s shares are not subject to any sinking fund provision under the Articles or as a matter of the laws of England and Wales. No shareholder is currently liable to make additional contributions of capital in respect of BT’s ordinary shares in the future. There are no provisions in the Articles or of corporate legislation in England and Wales that would delay, defer or prevent a change of control.

(l) Disclosure of interests in shares

Under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 and the UK Disclosure and Transparency Rules there is a statutory obligation on a person who acquires or ceases to have a notifiable interest in the relevant share capital of a public company like BT to notify the company of that fact. The disclosure threshold is 3%. These Rules also deal with the disclosure by persons of interests in shares or debentures of companies in which they are directors and certain associated companies. Under section 793 of the 2006 Act (referred to in (a) above), BT may ascertain the persons who are or have within the last three years been interested in its shares and the nature of those interests. The UK City Code on Takeovers and Mergers also imposes strict disclosure requirements with regard to dealings in the securities of an offeror or offeree company on all parties to a takeover and also on their respective associates during the course of an offer period.

Material Contracts

Excluding contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business, no contracts have been entered into in the two years preceding the date of this document by BT or another member of the group which are, or may be, material to the group or contain a provision under which a member of the group has an obligation or entitlement which is, or may be, material to BT or such other member of the group.

Taxation (US Holders)

This is a summary only of the principal US federal income tax and UK tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs by US Holders (as defined below) who hold their ordinary shares or ADSs as capital assets. It does not address all aspects of US federal income taxation and does not address aspects that may be relevant to persons who are subject to special provisions of US federal income tax law, including: US expatriates; insurance companies; tax-exempt organisations; banks; regulated investment companies; financial institutions; securities broker-dealers; traders in securities who elect a mark-to-market method of accounting; persons subject to alternative minimum tax; investors that directly, indirectly or by attribution own 10% or more of the total combined voting power or total value of share capital of BT; persons holding their ordinary shares or ADSs as part of a straddle, hedging transaction or conversion transaction; persons who acquired their ordinary shares or ADSs pursuant to the exercise of options or otherwise as compensation; or persons whose functional currency is not the US Dollar, amongst others. Those holders may be subject to US federal income tax consequences different from those set forth below. This summary does not address US federal taxes other than the income tax (such as estate or gift taxes) or US state and local taxes.

For the purposes of this summary, a US Holder is a beneficial owner of ordinary shares or ADSs that, for US federal income tax purposes, is: a citizen or individual resident of the United States; a corporation (or other entity taxable as a corporation for US federal income tax purposes) created or organised in or under the laws of the United States or any political subdivision thereof; an estate the income of which is subject to US federal income taxation regardless of its sources, or a trust if a US court can exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust and one or more US persons are authorised to control all substantial decisions of the trust. If a partnership holds ordinary shares or ADSs, the US tax treatment of a partner generally will depend upon the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. A partner in a partnership that holds ordinary shares or ADSs is urged to consult its own tax adviser regarding the specific tax consequences of owning and disposing of the ordinary shares or ADSs.

 

 

 
304    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

 

In particular, this summary is based on (i) current UK tax law and the practice of Her Majesty’s Revenue & Customs (HMRC) and US law and US Internal Revenue Service (IRS) practice, including the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, existing and proposed Treasury regulations, rulings, judicial decisions and administrative practice, all as currently in effect and available, (ii) the United Kingdom-United States Convention relating to estate and gift taxes, and (iii) the United Kingdom-United States Tax Convention that entered into force on 31 March 2003 and the protocol thereto (the Convention), all as in effect on the date of this Annual Report, all of which are subject to change or changes in interpretation, possibly with retroactive effect.

US Holders should consult their own tax advisers as to the applicability of the Convention and the consequences under UK, US federal, state and local, and other laws, of the ownership and disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs.

Taxation of dividends

Under current UK tax law, BT will not be required to withhold tax at source from dividend payments it makes. Unless a US Holder of ordinary shares or ADSs is resident for UK tax purposes in the UK or unless a US Holder of ordinary shares or ADSs carries on a trade, profession or vocation in the UK involving the ordinary shares or ADSs, the holder should not be liable for UK tax on dividends received in respect of ordinary shares and/or ADSs.

For US federal income tax purposes, a distribution will be treated as ordinary dividend income. The amount of the distribution includible in gross income of a US Holder will be the US Dollar value of the distribution calculated by reference to the spot rate in effect on the date the distribution is actually or constructively received by a US Holder of ordinary shares, or by the Depositary. In the case of ADSs, a US Holder who converts Sterling into US Dollars on the date of receipt generally should not recognise any exchange gain or loss. A US Holder who does not convert Sterling into US Dollars on the date of receipt generally will have a tax basis in Sterling equal to their US Dollar value on such date. Foreign currency gain or loss, if any, recognised by the US Holder on a subsequent conversion or other disposition of Sterling generally will be US source ordinary income or loss. Dividends paid by BT to a US Holder will not be eligible for the US dividends received deduction that may otherwise be available to corporate shareholders.

For purposes of calculating the foreign tax credit limitation, dividends paid on the ordinary shares or ADSs will be treated as income from sources outside the US and generally will constitute ‘passive income’. US Holders who do not elect to claim a credit with respect to any foreign taxes paid in a given taxable year may instead claim a deduction for foreign taxes paid. A deduction does not reduce US federal income tax on a Dollar for Dollar basis like a tax credit. The deduction, however, is not subject to the limitations applicable to foreign credits.

Following recent changes in UK tax law (effective from 6 April 2016), UK tax credits no longer attach to any dividends paid on the ordinary shares or ADSs, irrespective of the domicile or residence of the shareholder. No question therefore arises as to the entitlement of any US Holder to any UK tax credit.

Certain US Holders (including individuals) are eligible for reduced rates of US federal income tax (currently at a maximum of 20%) in respect of qualified dividend income. There could also be a 3.8% net investment income tax on dividends to individuals and other non-corporate holders with income above a certain amount. For these purposes, qualified dividend income generally includes dividends paid by a non-US corporation if, among other things, the US Holders meet certain minimum holding periods and the non-US corporation satisfies certain requirements, including that either (i) the shares or ADSs with respect to which the dividend has been paid are readily tradable on an established securities market in the US, or (ii) the non-US corporation is eligible for the benefits of a comprehensive US income tax treaty (such as the Convention) which provides for the exchange of information. BT currently believes that dividends paid with respect to its ordinary shares and ADSs should constitute qualified dividend income for US federal income tax purposes. Each individual US Holder of ordinary shares or ADSs is urged to consult his own tax adviser regarding the availability to him of the reduced dividend tax rate in light of his own particular situation and regarding the computations of his foreign tax credit limitation with respect to any qualified dividend income paid by BT to him, as applicable.

Taxation of capital gains

Unless a US Holder of ordinary shares or ADSs is resident for UK tax purposes in the UK or unless a US Holder of ordinary shares or ADSs carries on a trade, profession, or vocation in the UK through a branch, agency, or, in the case of a company, a permanent establishment in the UK, and the ordinary shares and/or ADSs have been used, held, or acquired for the purposes of that trade, profession or vocation, the holder should not be liable for UK tax on capital gains on a disposal of ordinary shares and/or ADSs.

A US Holder who is an individual and who has ceased to be resident for tax purposes in the UK on or after 17 March 1998 or who falls to be regarded as resident outside the UK for the purposes of any double tax treaty (Treaty non-resident) on or after 16 March 2005 and continues to not be resident in the UK or continues to be Treaty non-resident for a period of less than five years of assessment and who disposes of his ordinary shares or ADSs during that period may also be liable on his return to the UK to UK tax on capital gains, subject to any available exemption or relief, even though he is not resident in the UK or is Treaty non-resident at the time of disposal.

For US federal income tax purposes, a US Holder generally will recognise capital gain or loss on the sale, exchange or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs in an amount equal to the difference between the US Dollar value of the amount realised on the disposition and the US Holder’s adjusted tax basis (determined in US Dollars) in the ordinary shares or ADSs. Such gain or loss generally will be US source gain or loss, and will be treated as long-term capital gain or loss if the ordinary shares have been held for more than one year at the time of disposition. Long-term capital gains recognised by an individual US Holder generally are subject to US federal income tax at preferential rates. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to significant limitations. Non-corporate US Holders may also be subject to a 3.8% tax on net investment income in respect of any gains.

A US Holder’s tax basis in an ordinary share or ADS will generally be its US Dollar cost. The US Dollar cost of an ordinary share or ADS purchased with foreign currency will generally be the US Dollar value of the purchase price on the date of purchase, or the settlement date for the purchase, in the case of ordinary shares

 

 

 
305    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Information for shareholders continued

 

or ADSs traded on an established securities market, as defined in the applicable Treasury Regulations, that are purchased by a cash basis US Holder (or an accrual basis US Holder that so elects). Such an election by an accrual basis US Holder must be applied consistently from year to year and cannot be revoked without the consent of the IRS. The amount realised on a sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs for an amount in foreign currency will be the US Dollar value of this amount on the date of sale or disposition. On the settlement date, the US Holder will recognise US source foreign currency gain or loss (taxable as ordinary income or loss) equal to the difference (if any) between the US Dollar value of the amount received based on the exchange rates in effect on the date of sale or other disposition and the settlement date. However, in the case of ordinary shares or ADS traded on an established securities market that are sold by a cash basis US Holder (or an accrual basis US Holder that so elects), the amount realised will be based on the exchange rate in effect on the settlement date for the sale, and no exchange gain or loss will be recognised at that time.

Passive foreign investment company status

A non-US corporation will be classified as a passive foreign investment company (a PFIC) for US federal income tax purposes for any taxable year if at least 75% of its gross income consists of passive income or at least 50% of the average value of its assets consist of assets that produce, or are held for the production of, passive income.

BT currently believes that it did not qualify as a PFIC for the tax year ended 31 March 2018. If BT were to become a PFIC for any tax year, US Holders would suffer adverse tax consequences. These consequences may include having gains realised on the disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs treated as ordinary income rather than capital gains and being subject to punitive interest charges on certain dividends and on the proceeds of the sale or other disposition of the ordinary shares or ADSs. Furthermore, dividends paid by BT would not be ‘qualified dividend income’ which may be eligible for reduced rates of taxation as described above. US Holders should consult their own tax advisers regarding the potential application of the PFIC rules to BT.

US information reporting and backup withholding

Dividends paid on and proceeds received from the sale, exchange or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs may be subject to information reporting to the IRS and backup withholding at a current rate of 28% (which rate may be subject to change). Certain exempt recipients (such as corporations) are not subject to these information reporting requirements. In addition, non-corporate US Holders may be required to report their investment on a Form 8938. Backup withholding will not apply, however, to a US Holder who provides a correct taxpayer identification number or certificate of foreign status and makes any other required certification or who is otherwise exempt. Persons that are US persons for US federal income tax purposes who are required to establish their exempt status generally must furnish IRS Form W-9 (Request for Taxpayer Identification Number and Certification). Holders that are not US persons for US federal income tax purposes generally will not be subject to US information reporting or backup withholding. However, such holders may be required to provide certification of non-US status in connection with payments received in the US or through certain US-related financial intermediaries.

Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Amounts withheld as backup withholding may be credited against a holder’s US federal income tax liability. A holder may obtain a refund of any excess

amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules by timely filing the appropriate claim for refund with the IRS and furnishing any required information.

UK stamp duty

A transfer of or an agreement to transfer an ordinary share will generally be subject to UK stamp duty or UK stamp duty reserve tax (SDRT) at 0.5% of the amount or value of any consideration provided rounded up (in the case of stamp duty) to the nearest £5. SDRT is generally the liability of the purchaser. It is customarily also the purchaser who pays UK stamp duty.

A transfer of an ordinary share to, or to a nominee for, a person whose business is or includes the provision of clearance services or to, or to a nominee or agent of, a person whose business is or includes issuing depositary receipts may give rise to a charge to stamp duty or SDRT of 1.5% of the amount of the consideration provided rounded up (in the case of stamp duty) to the nearest £5. HMRC accept that this charge is in breach of EU law so far as it applies to transfers that are an integral part of a share issue, and it was confirmed in the Autumn 2017 Budget that the Government intends to continue this approach following Brexit. HMRC’s published view is that the 1.5% SDRT or stamp duty charge continues to apply to other transfers of shares into a clearance service or depositary receipt arrangement, although this has been disputed. In view of the continuing uncertainly, specific professional advice should be sought before incurring a 1.5% SDRT or stamp duty charge in any circumstances.

No SDRT will be payable on the transfer of an ADS (assuming it is not registered in the UK), provided that the transfer documents are executed and always retained outside the UK, no UK stamp duty should in practice be required to be paid on the transfer of an ADS.

Transfers of ordinary shares into CREST will generally not be subject to stamp duty or SDRT unless such a transfer is made for a consideration in money or money’s worth, in which case a liability to SDRT will arise, usually at the rate of 0.5% of the value of the consideration. Paperless transfers of ordinary shares within CREST are generally liable to SDRT at the rate of 0.5% of the value of the consideration. CREST is obliged to collect SDRT from the purchaser of the shares on relevant transactions settled within the system.

The above statements are intended as a general guide to the current position. Certain categories of person (including recognised market makers, brokers and dealers) may not be liable to stamp duty or SDRT or may, although not liable for the tax, be required to notify and account for it under the Stamp Duty Reserve Tax Regulations 1986.

UK inheritance and gift taxes in connection with ordinary shares and/or ADSs

The rules and scope of domicile for UK tax purposes are complex and action should not be taken without advice specific to the individual’s circumstances.

A lifetime gift or a transfer on death of ordinary shares and/or ADSs by an individual holder, who is US domiciled (for the purposes of the UK/US Estate and Gift Tax Convention) and who is not a UK national (as defined in the Convention) will not generally be subject to UK inheritance tax if the gift is subject to US federal gift or US estate tax unless the tax is not paid (otherwise than as a result of a specific exemption, deduction, exclusion, credit or allowance).

 

 

 
306    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

 

Further note on certain activities

In addition, under Section 219 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012, which added Section 13 (r) to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, we are required to disclose whether BT or any of its affiliates knowingly engaged in certain activities, transactions or dealings relating to Iran or certain designated individuals or entities. Disclosure is required even when the activities were conducted outside the US by non-US entities and even when they were conducted in compliance with applicable law.

During 2017/18, certain of the group’s non-US subsidiaries or other non-US entities conducted limited activities in, or with persons from, certain countries identified by the US Department of State as State Sponsors of Terrorism or otherwise subject to US sanctions. These activities, which generally relate to the provision of communications services to embassies and diplomatic missions of US-allied governments, other Communication Providers, news organisations, multinational corporations and other customers that require global communications connectivity, are insignificant to the group’s financial condition and results of operations.

BT has a contract in place with Telecommunication Infrastructure Company (TIC), to make and receive voice calls from Iran to the UK.

BT entered into a Framework Agreement with Rafsanjan Industrial Complex (RIC) for business consultancy services in May 2010 and provided an initial consultancy engagement under phase 1 of the agreement. In February 2011, phase 2 was agreed with RIC however BT stopped work in December 2011 due to the geopolitical situation. RIC made an advance payment to BT of 384,120 to carry out the phase 2 work. We continue to explore whether the amount can be refunded.

BT’s subsidiary, EE (the acquisition of which was completed on 29 January 2016), has in place roaming partner agreements with Mobile Company of Iran (MCI), and Taliya Company (also known as Rafsanjan Industrial Complex). These bilateral agreements allow the transmission of mobile calls. There has been no traffic with Taliya in 2017/18. The value of the gross revenue to EE under these contracts is less than £25,000, although no payments have been made or received in 2017/18.

Limitations affecting security holders

There are no government laws, decrees, regulations, or other UK legislation which have a material effect on the import or export of capital, including the availability of cash and cash equivalents for use by the company except as otherwise described in Taxation (US Holders) on page 304.

There are no limitations under UK law restricting the right of nonresidents to hold or to vote shares in the company.

 

 

 
307    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Information for shareholders continued

 

Documents on display

All reports and other information that BT files with the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) may be inspected at the SEC’s public reference facilities at Room 1580, 100 F Street NE, Washington, DC 20549, US.

These reports may be accessed via the SEC’s website at sec.gov

Publications

BT produces a series of reports on the company’s financial, compliance, and social and environmental performance.

 

Document    Publication date  

Notice of meeting

     May  

Annual Report & Form 20-F

     May  

Delivering our purpose report

     May  

EAB Annual Report

     May  

Expected quarterly results releases

     July, November, February and May  

Current Cost Financial Statements

     July  

The Way We Work, a statement of business practice

     July  

For printed copies, when available, contact the Shareholder Helpline on Freefone 0808 100 4141 or contact our Registrars in the UK, at the address opposite.

Most of these reports (as well as the EAB Annual Report on BT’s compliance with the Undertakings) can be accessed online at bt.com/aboutbt. More detailed disclosures on BT’s implementation of social, ethical and environmental policies and procedures are available online through our independently verified sustainability report at bt.com/deliveringourpurpose

Electronic communication

Shareholders can choose to receive their shareholder documents electronically rather than by post.

Shareholders may elect to receive documents in this way by going to bt.com/signup and following the online instructions, or by calling the Shareholder Helpline.

Shareholder communication

BT is committed to communicating openly with each of its stakeholder audiences in the manner most appropriate to their requirements.

All investors can visit our website at bt.com/investorcentre for more information about BT. There are direct links from this page to sites providing information particularly tailored for shareholders, institutional investors, financial analysts, industry analysts and journalists.

Private shareholders

If private shareholders have any enquiries about their shareholding, they should contact our Registrars, Equiniti, at the address below. Equiniti maintain BT Group’s share register and the separate BT Group EasyShare register. They also provide a Shareholder Helpline service on Freefone 0808 100 4141.

 

Shareholder Helpline

Tel: Freefone 0808 100 4141

Fax: 03713842100

Textphone: Freefone 0800 169 6907

https://help.shareview.co.uk

From outside the UK:

Tel: +44 121 415 7178

Fax: +44 3713842100

Textphone: +44 121 415 7028

https://help.shareview.co.uk

The Registrar

Equiniti

Aspect House

Spencer Road

Lancing

West Sussex

BN99 6DA

equiniti.com

ADR Depositary

JPMorgan Chase & Co

PO Box 64504

St Paul, MN 55164-0504, US

Tel: +1 800 990 1135 (General)

or +1 651 453 2128 (From outside the US)

or +1 800 428 4237 (Global Invest Direct)

email: jpmorgan.adr@eq-us.com

          adr.com

General enquiries

BT Group plc

BT Centre

81 Newgate Street

London EC1A 7AJ

United Kingdom

Tel: 020 7356 5000

Tel: +44 1793 596 931 (from outside the UK)

Institutional investors, financial and industry analysts

Institutional investors and financial analysts may contact BT Investor Relations on:

Tel: 020 7356 4909

email: ir@bt.com

Industry analysts and consultants may contact BT Analyst Relations on:

Tel: 020 7356 4909

email: industryenquiry@bt.com

 

LOGO  

Find out more about the BT Supplier Finance

scheme at: selling2bt.bt.com

LOGO  

You can find out more about the Better Payment

Practice Code at: payontime.co.uk

LOGO   btplc.com/TheWayWeWork

 

 

 

 
308    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Cross reference to Form 20-F

The information in this document that is referred to in the following table shall be deemed to be filed with the Securities and Exchange

Commission for all purposes. None of the websites referred to in this Annual Report 2018, including where a link is provided, nor any of the information contained on such websites is incorporated by reference in the Form 20-F.

 

Required item in Form 20-F

Item

  

Where information can be found in this Annual Report

Section

   Page  

 

 

3

   Key information      

 

 

3A

  

Selected financial data

     
     

Selected financial data

     291  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Exchange rates

     301  

 

 

4

   Information on the company      

 

 

4A

  

History and development of the company

  

Our customer-facing units

     72  
     

Our corporate units

     114  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Background

     297  
     

Group performance

  
     

    Capital expenditure

     124  
     

General information

  
     

    Capital management and funding policy

     186  

4B

  

Business overview

  

Review of the year

     157  
     

How we’re organised

     16  
     

Our strategy

     20  
     

What we do

     31  
     

Our networks and physical assets

     35  
     

Research and development

     37  
     

Brand and reputation

     39  
     

Our stakeholders

     42  
     

The environment

     54  
     

Our resources and culture

     35  
     

Our customer-facing units

     72  
     

Our corporate units

     114  
     

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

        Segment information

     215  
     

Financial and operational statistics

  
     

    Operational statistics

     295  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Cautionary statement regarding forward-looking statements

     296  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Further note on certain activities

     307  

4C

  

Organisational structure

  

Executive Committee

     18  
     

Our business model

     30  
     

Our customer-facing units

     72  
     

Our corporate units

     114  
     

Related undertakings

     271  

4D

  

Property, plant and equipment

  

Our networks and physical assets

     35  
     

Properties

     37  
     

The environment

     54  
     

Our resources and culture

     35  
     

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

        Property, plant and equipment

     230  
     

Financial and operational statistics

  
     

    Financial statistics

     293  

 

 

 

 
309    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Cross reference to Form 20-F continued

 

Required item in Form 20-F

Item

  

Where information can be found in this Annual Report

Section

   Page  

 

 

5

   Operating and financial review and prospects   

 

 

5A

   Operating results   

Our customer-facing units

     72  
     

Our corporate units

     114  
     

Group performancea b

     118  
     

HM Government

     50  
     

Regulators

     51  
     

The environment

     54  
     

Our resources and culture

     35  
     

Alternative performance measures

     288  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Cautionary statement regarding forward-looking statements

     296  

5B

  

Liquidity and capital resources

  

Group performancea b

     118  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Cautionary statement regarding forward-looking statements

     296  
     

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

        Loans and other borrowings

     250  
     

        Financial instruments and risk management

     255  
     

        Financial commitments and contingent liabilities

     262  

5C

  

Research and development, patents and licences

  

Research and development

     37  
     

Financial and operational statistics

  
     

    Financial statistics

     293  

5D

  

Trend information

  

Group performancea b

     118  
     

Selected financial data

     291  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Cautionary statement regarding forward-looking statements

     296  

5E

  

Off-balance sheet arrangements

  

General information

  
     

    Off-balance sheet arrangements

     186  

5F

  

Tabular disclosure of contractual obligations

  

Group performance

  
     

    Contractual obligations and commitments

     130  

 

 

6

   Directors, senior management and employees   

 

 

6A

  

Directors and senior management

  

Board of Directors

     134  
     

The Board

     136  

6B

  

Compensation

  

Reports of the Board committees

  
     

    Report on Directors’ Remuneration

     156  
     

    Focus on Remuneration

     158  
     

    Annual Remuneration Report

     161  
     

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

        Retirement benefit plans

     235  
     

        Share-based payments

     247  

6C

  

Board practices

  

Board of Directors

     134  
     

The Board

     136  
     

Reports of the Board committees

  
     

    Report on Directors’ Remuneration

     156  
     

    Focus on Remuneration

     158  
     

    Remuneration Principles

     160  
     

    Annual Remuneration Report

     161  
     

    Remuneration Policy

     173  

 

 

 

 
310    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

 

Required item in Form 20-F

Item

  

Where information can be found in this Annual Report

Section

   Page  

 

 

6D

  

Employees

  

Our people

     43  
     

Group performance

  
     

    Income statement

  
     

        Operating costs

     121  
     

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

        Employees

     220  

6E

  

Share ownership

  

Reports of the Board committees

  
     

    Report on Directors’ Remuneration

     156  
     

    Focus on Remuneration

     158  
     

    Annual Remuneration Report

     161  
     

    Remuneration Policy

     173  
     

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

        Share-based payments

     247  

 

 

7

   Major shareholders and related party transactions   

 

 

7A

  

Major shareholders

  

    Relations with shareholders

  
     

        Substantial shareholdings

     143  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Analysis of shareholdings at 31 March 2018

     298  

7B

  

Related party transactions

  

Directors’ information

  
     

    Interest of management in certain transactions

     182  
     

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

        Related party transactions

     261  

 

 

8

   Financial information   

 

 

8A

  

Consolidated statements and other financial

  

See Item 18 below

  
  

information

  

General information

  
     

    Legal proceedings

     186  
     

Group performance

  
     

    Dividendsb

     123  
     

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

        Specific items

     222  
     

        Financial commitments and contingent liabilities

     262  
     

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Dividends

     299  
     

    Articles of Association (Articles)

  
     

        Dividends

     302  

8B

  

Significant changes

  

Directors’ information

  
     

    Going concern

     182  

 

 

9

   The offer and listing   

 

 

9A

  

Offer and listing details

  

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Stock exchange listings

  
     

        Share and ADS prices

     297  

9C

  

Markets

  

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Stock exchange listings

     297  

 

 

10

   Additional information   

 

 

10B

  

Memorandum and articles of association

  

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Articles of Association (Articles)

     302  

10D

  

Exchange controls

  

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Limitations affecting security holders

     307  

10E

  

Taxation

  

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Taxation (US Holders)

     304  

10H

  

Documents on display

  

Information for shareholders

  
     

    Documents on display

     308  

 

 

 

 
311    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Cross reference to Form 20-F continued

 

Required item in Form 20-F

Item

  

Where information can be found in this Annual Report

Section

   Page  

 

 

11

  

Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about

     
  

market risk

  

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
              Significant accounting policies   
     

            Financial instruments

     213  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

            Financial instruments and risk management

     255  

 

 

15

  

Controls and procedures

  

General information

  
     

    US Regulation

     183  
     

    UK Internal control and risk management

     185  
     

Report of the independent auditors – Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    United States opinion

     200  

 

 

16A

  

Audit committee financial expert

  

General information

  
     

    US Regulation

  
     

            US Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

     183  

16B

  

Code of ethics

  

General information

  
     

    US Regulation

  
     

            US Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

     183  

16C

  

Principal accountants’ fees and services

  

Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
     

            Audit, audit related and other non-audit services

     221  
     

Reports of the Board committees

  
     

    Audit & Risk Committee chairman’s report

     144  

16E

  

Purchases of equity securities by the

  

Information for shareholders

  
  

issuer and affiliated purchasers

  

    Share buyback

     299  

16G

  

Corporate Governance

  

General information

  
     

    US Regulation

  
     

            New York Stock Exchange

     183  

 

 

18

  

Financial statements

  

Report of the independent auditors – Consolidated financial statements

  
     

    United States opinion

     200  
     

Financial statements

     201  

 

 

 

a  Excluding the information under the sub-heading “Outlook for 2018/19” on pages 119-120.
b Excluding the last sentence ending in “... in our Outlook on page 119.” under the sub-heading “Dividends” on page 123.

 

 
312    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Glossary of terms

 

 

LOGO    2G: the second generation of mobile telephony systems. It uses digital transmission to support voice, low-speed data communications and short messaging services.
   3G: the third generation of mobile systems. It provides high-speed data transmission and supports multimedia applications like video, audio and internet access as well as conventional voice services.
   4G: the fourth generation of mobile systems. It is designed to provide faster data download and upload speeds on mobile networks.
    

5G: the coming fifth generation wireless broadband technology which will provide better speeds and coverage than the current 4G.

 

 

LOGO

  

 

ADSL: asymmetric digital subscriber line – a digital technology that allows the use of a standard telephone line to provide high-speed data communications.

    

ARPU: average revenue per user.

 

 

LOGO

  

 

BDUK: Broadband Delivery UK – the UK Government body charged with helping to oversee the use of public money for rolling out fibre broadband in harder-to-reach parts of the country.

   BTPS: BT Pension Scheme – the defined benefit pension scheme which was closed to new members on 31 March 2001.
    

BTRSS: BT Retirement Saving Scheme – the scheme set up on 1 April 2009 as a successor to the BT Retirement Plan. It is a contract-based, defined contribution arrangement.

 

 

LOGO

  

 

Cloud of Clouds: Global Services’ portfolio strategy which brings together its six core product families and a network of partners to support the delivery of global network and IT infrastructure services.

   CP: communications provider – a provider of communications services – telephony, broadband, video on demand and other services.
   CFU: customer-facing unit.
   The Commitments: Certain commitments notified by BT plc to Ofcom in March 2017 relating to the operation of Openreach as a functionally seperate division of BT, and agreed as part of the DCR Settlement.
LOGO   

Dark fibre: an ‘unlit’ fibre-only connection provided with no associated electronics.

 

DCR: Digital Communications Review – Ofcom’s strategic review of the UK’s digital communication markets which focused on its approach to regulation for the next decade, and how best to promote competition, innovation and investment. It resulted in Ofcom agreeing to release us from the undertakings, once the new voluntary Commitments to further reform Openreach are fully in place.

 

DP: distribution point.

 

DSL: digital subscriber line – a broadband service where existing wires between the local telephone exchange and a customer’s telephone sockets are transformed into a high-speed digital line.

 

 

LOGO

  

 

EAD: Ethernet access direct – a point-to-point access product in the Openreach Ethernet portfolio offering high bandwidth connectivity, linking end-user sites, communications provider networks and BT exchanges.

 

Ethernet: high-capacity, high-speed digital connections available throughout the UK. They tend to be used by businesses and offices for which a domestic connection is inadequate when large numbers of devices have to be online.

    

ESN: Emergency Services Network.

 

 

LOGO

  

 

Flexible Co-mingling: allows CPs to place their equipment in our exchanges.

 

FTTC: fibre-to-the-cabinet – a variant of GEA which uses fibre to provide high connection speeds from the exchange to a street cabinet near to a customer premises, and a copper line for the final connection to the premises.

    

FTTP: fibre-to-the-premises – a variant of GEA which uses fibre to provide high connection speeds for the whole route from the exchange to the customer.

 

 

LOGO

  

 

GFast: an innovative technology that uses higher frequencies than FTTC to provide faster broadband speeds over copper.

 

GEA: generic Ethernet access – Openreach’s wholesale fibre broadband product.

 

 

 
313    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

 

Glossary of terms continued

 

LOGO   IoT: internet of things – the interconnection via the internet of computing devices embedded in everyday objects, enabling them to send and receive data.
  IP: internet protocol – a packet-based protocol for delivering data – including voice and video – across networks.
  IPTV: internet protocol television – the combination of broadcast content with broadband content, delivering both through the television.
   

IPX: IP exchange – a telecommunications interconnection model for the exchange of IP-based traffic between customers of separate mobile and fixed operators.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

Ladder pricing: Ladder pricing links the amounts that BT charges mobile operators for mobile calls to 0800, 0845 and 0870 numbers terminating on our network to the retail price charged by mobile operators to their customers.

   

LLU: local loop unbundling – the process by which CPs can rent the copper lines between BT’s exchanges and customer premises from Openreach to provide voice and broadband services using their own equipment.

 

 

LOGO   

 

 

M2M: machine-to-machine – M2M communications refers to connecting electronic devices to one another. This can streamline processes and enable tasks to be automated.

  Managed Ethernet Access Service: a product that uses pseudo-wire technology to carry Ethernet traffic between the mobile operators’ cell and core sites in a single converged packet network.
  MBNL: Mobile Broadband Network Limited is a joint venture arrangement between EE Limited and Hutchison 3G UK Limited with each company owning a 50% share.
  MiiS: mobile infill infrastructure solution – lets CPs install their radio equipment in special cabinets linked to antennas on telephone poles and use their spectrum to improve mobile coverage.
  MPF: metallic path facility – a circuit comprising a pair of twisted metal wires between an end-user’s premises and a main distribution frame.
  MPLS: multi-protocol label switching – supports the rapid transmission of data across network routers, enabling modern networks to achieve high quality of service.
  MSL: minimum service level – set by Ofcom in relation to the quality of service that Openreach offers.
  MVNO: mobile virtual network operator – an arrangement where a retailer sells mobile services under its own brand but uses a mobile network owned by another operator to do so.
LOGO  

NFV: network function virtualisation.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

Ofcom: the independent regulator and competition authority in the UK communications industries, with responsibilities across television, radio, telecommunications and wireless communications services.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

PCP: primary connection point.

  PIA: passive infrastructure access – this occurs when one company accesses ducts owned by another and installs its own fibre optic or other cables.
  POLOs: payments to other licensed operators – typically refers to payments by one CP to another CP when terminating voice traffic on their network to carry the call to the customer receiving the call.
  PoPs: points of presence – this refers to a location in a city where we have the ability to connect customers to one of our networks.
   

PPC: partial private circuit – a generic term used to describe a category of private circuits that terminate at a point of connection between two operators’ networks.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

RFT: Right First Time – the internal measure of whether we are keeping our promises to our customers and meeting or exceeding their expectations.

 

 

LOGO   

 

 

Sarbanes-Oxley: Legislation passed by the United States Congress in 2002 to protect investors from the possibility of fraudulent accounting activities by corporations.

  SDN: software defined networking – one of the new generation of networking technologies that are giving us a new way to build and manage corporate networks that are fit for the digital age.
  SEP: superfast extension programme.
  SIP: session initiation protocol – a method for creating, modifying and terminating sessions with one or more participants. These include internet telephone calls, multimedia distribution and multimedia conferences.
  SIP trunking: a way of making calls over an IP connection, rather than over traditional phone lines. Calls are translated into data packets and sent over the user’s data network.
  SME: small and medium enterprises.
  SMPF: shared metallic path facility – access to the non-voiceband frequencies of the metallic path facility.
  SON: self-organising network.
  SVoD: subscription video on demand.
 

 

 
314    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

 

LOGO   Undertakings: legally-binding commitments BT made to Ofcom, designed to bring greater transparency and certainty to the regulation of the telecommunications industry in the UK. They led to the formation of Openreach.
   

UHD: ultra high definition.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

VDSL: very high speed DSL – a high-speed variant of DSL technology. It provides a high headline speed by reducing the length of the access line copper by connecting to fibre at the cabinet.

  VoIP: voice over internet protocol – a method of transporting speech over the internet.
   

VPN: virtual private network – a secure way to create an apparent dedicated network between nodes over a network infrastructure, which is in reality shared with other services.

 

 

LOGO   

 

 

WAN: wide area network – a computer network that exists over a relatively large geographical area that connects two or more smaller networks. This enables computers and users in one location to communicate with computers and users in other locations.

  WLR: wholesale line rental – a product supplied by Openreach which is used by other CPs to offer telephony services using their own brand, pricing structure and billing, but using BT’s network.
 

 

 
315    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes

 

 

 

 
316    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
THE STRATEGIC REPORT     GOVERNANCE     FINANCIAL STATEMENTS     ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

Notes

 

 

 

 
317    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents
                
                
           

Notes

 

 

 

 
318    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

Notes

 

 

 

 
319    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

Notes

 

 

 

 

 
320    Annual Report 2018 BT Group plc


Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

BT Group plc

Registered office: 81 Newgate Street, London EC1A 7AJ

Registered in England and Wales No. 4190816

Produced by BT Group

 

PHME 82596

Printed in England by Pindar Scarborough Ltd

Design by emperor.works

Typeset by Donnelley Financial Solutions

Printed on Amadeus 50 Silk which is made from 50%

de-inked, post-consumer waste and 50% virgin fibre

 

bt.com

 

LOGO

  

LOGO